Part Number Hot Search : 
UF2007 MCH3376 BZX55C51 N25F80 D23C1 CP1001 ONTROL H1N60U
Product Description
Full Text Search
 

To Download AT91SAM9R641 Datasheet File

  If you can't view the Datasheet, Please click here to try to view without PDF Reader .  
 
 


  Datasheet File OCR Text:
 Features
* Incorporates the ARM926EJ-STM ARM(R) Thumb(R) Processor
- DSP Instruction Extensions - ARM Jazelle(R) Technology for Java(R) Acceleration - 4 Kbyte Data Cache, 4 Kbyte Instruction Cache, Write Buffer - 265 MIPS at 240 MHz - Memory Management Unit - EmbeddedICETM In-circuit Emulation, Debug Communication Channel Support Multi-layer AHB Bus Matrix for Large Bandwidth Transfers - Six 32-bit-layer Matrix - Boot Mode Select Option, Remap Command One 32-KByte internal ROM, Single-cycle Access at Maximum Speed One 64-KByte internal SRAM, Single-cycle Access at Maximum Speed - 4 Blocks of 16 Kbytes Configurable in TCM or General-purpose SRAM on the AHB Bus Matrix - Single-cycle Accessible on AHB Bus at Bus Speed - Single-cycle Accessible on TCM Interface at Processor Speed 2-channel DMA - Memory to Memory Transfer - 16 Bytes FIFO - LInked List External Bus Interface (EBI) - EBI Supports SDRAM, Static Memory, ECC-enabled NAND Flash and CompactFlash(R) LCD Controller (for AT91SAM9RL64 only) - Supports Passive or Active Displays - Up to 24 Bits per Pixel in TFT Mode, Up to 16 bits per Pixel in STN Color Mode - Up to 16M Colors in TFT Mode, Resolution Up to 2048x2048, Virtual Screen Support High Speed (480 Mbit/s) USB 2.0 Device Controller - On-Chip High Speed Transceiver, UTMI+ Physical Interface - Integrated FIFOs and Dedicated DMA - 4 Kbyte Configurable Integrated DPRAM Fully-featured System Controller, including - Reset Controller, Shutdown Controller - Four 32-bit Battery Backup Registers for a Total of 16 Bytes - Clock Generator and Power Management Controller - Advanced Interrupt Controller and Debug Unit - Periodic Interval Timer, Watchdog Timer and Real-time Timer and Real-time Clock Reset Controller (RSTC) - Based on Two Power-on Reset Cells - Reset Source Identification and Reset Output Control Shutdown Controller (SHDC) - Programmable Shutdown Pin Control and Wake-up Circuitry Clock Generator (CKGR) - Selectable 32768 Hz Low-power Oscillator or Internal Low-power RC Oscillator on Battery Backup Power Supply, Providing a Permanent Slow Clock - 12 MHz On-chip Oscillator for Main System Clock and USB Clock - One PLL up to 240 MHz
*
* *
AT91 ARM Thumb Microcontrollers AT91SAM9R64 AT91SAM9RL64 Preliminary
*
*
*
*
*
*
* *
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- One PLL 480 MHz Optimized for USB HS
* Power Management Controller (PMC)
- Very Slow Clock Operating Mode, Software Programmable Power Optimization Capabilities - Two Programmable External Clock Signals Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) - Individually Maskable, Eight-level Priority, Vectored Interrupt Sources - One External Interrupt Sources and One Fast Interrupt Source, Spurious Interrupt Protected Debug Unit (DBGU) - 2-wire UART and Support for Debug Communication Channel, Programmable ICE Access Prevention - Mode for General Purpose 2-wire UART Serial Communication Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) - 20-bit Interval Timer plus 12-bit Interval Counter Watchdog Timer (WDT) - Key-protected, Programmable Only Once, Windowed 16-bit Counter Running at Slow Clock Real-time Timer (RTT) - 32-bit Free-running Backup Counter Running at Slow Clock with 16-bit Prescaler Real-time Clock (RTC) - Time, Date and Alarm 32-bit Parallel Load - Low Power Consumption - Programmable Periodic Interrupt One 6-channel 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter - Touch Screen Interface Compatible with Industry Standard 4-wire Sensitive Touch Panels Four 32-bit Parallel Input/Output Controllers (PIOA, PIOB, PIOC and PIOD) - 118 Programmable I/O Lines Multiplexed with up to Two Peripheral I/Os for 217-ball BGA Package - Input Change Interrupt Capability on Each I/O Line - Individually Programmable Open-drain, Pull-up Resistor and Synchronous Output 22-channel Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) One MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI) - SDCard/SDIO 1.0 and MultiMediaCardTM 4.3 Compliant - Automatic Protocol Control and Fast Automatic Data Transfers with PDC Two Synchronous Serial Controllers (SSC) - Independent Clock and Frame Sync Signals for Each Receiver and Transmitter - IS Analog Interface Support, Time Division Multiplex Support - High-speed Continuous Data Stream Capabilities with 32-bit Data Transfer One AC97 Controller (AC97C) - 6-channel Single AC97 Analog Front End Interface, Slot Assigner Four Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver Transmitters (USART) - Individual Baud Rate Generator, IrDA(R) Infrared Modulation/Demodulation, Manchester Encoding/Decoding - Support for ISO7816 T0/T1 Smart Card, Hardware Handshaking, RS485 Support One Master/Slave Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) - 8- to 16-bit Programmable Data Length, Four External Peripheral Chip Selects - High-speed Synchronous Communications One Three-channel 16-bit Timer/Counter (TC) - Three External Clock Inputs, Two Multi-purpose I/O Pins per Channel - Double PWM Generation, Capture/Waveform Mode, Up/Down Capability One Four-channel 16-bit PWM Controller (PWMC) Two Two-wire Interfaces (TWI) - Compatible with Standard Two-wire Serial Memories - One, Two or Three Bytes for Slave Address - Sequential Read/Write Operations
*
*
* * * *
* *
* *
*
* *
*
*
* *
2
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Master, Multi-master and Slave Mode Operation Bit Rate: Up to 400 Kbits General Call Supported in Slave Mode Connection to Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers in Master Mode Only (TWI0 only) SAM-BA(R) Boot Assistant - Default Boot Program - Interface with SAM-BA Graphic User Interface IEEE(R) 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan on All Digital Pins Required Power Supplies: - 1.08 to 1.32V for VDDCORE, VDDUTMIC, VDDPLLB and VDDBU - 3.0V to 3.6V for VDDPLLA, VDDANA, VDDUTMII and VDDIOP - Programmable 1.65V to 1.95V or 3.0V to 3.6V for VDDIOM Available in a 144-ball BGA (AT91SAM9R64) and a 217-ball LFBGA (AT91SAM9RL64) Package - - - -
*
* *
*
1. Description
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 device is based on the integration of an ARM926EJ-S processor with a large fast SRAM and a wide range of peripherals. The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 embeds one USB Device High Speed Controller, one LCD Controller (for AT91SAM9RL64 only), one AC97 controller, a 2-channel DMA Controller, four USARTs, two SSCs, one SPI, two TWIs, three Timer Counter channels, a 4-channel PWM generator, one Multimedia Card interface and a 6-channel Analog-to-digital converter that also provides resistive touch screen management. The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 is architectured on a 6-layer bus matrix. It also features an External Bus Interface capable of interfacing with a wide range of memory and peripheral devices. Some features are not available for AT91SAM9R64 in the 144-ball BGA package. Separate block diagrams and PIO multiplexing are provided in this document. Table 1-1 lists the features and signals of AT91SAM9RL64 that are not available or partially available for AT91SAM9R64. When the signal is multiplexed on a PIO, the PIO line is specified. Table 1-1.
Feature
Unavailable or Partially Available Features and Signals in AT91SAM9R64
Full/Partial Signal AC97FS AC97CK AC97TX AC97RX D16-D31 NCS2 NCS5/CFCS1 LCDMOD LCDCC LCDVSYNC LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDDEN LCDD0-LCDD23 Peripheral A PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PB16-PB31 PD0 PD13 PC2 PC3 PC4 PC5 PC6 PC7 PC8-PC31 Peripheral B
AC97
Full
-
EBI
Partial
-
LCDC
Full
-
3
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 1-1.
Feature PWM SPI
Unavailable or Partially Available Features and Signals in AT91SAM9R64
Full/Partial Partial Partial Signal PWM2 NPCS2 NPCS3 RF1 RK1 TD1 RD1 TK1 TF1 AD3YM GPAD4 GPAD5 TIOA1 TIOB1 TCLK1 TIOA2 TIOB2 TWD1 TWCK1 SCK0 RTS0 CTS0 DSR0 DTR0 DCD0 RI0 SCK1 SCK2 RTS2 CTS2 SCK3 RTS3 CTS3 Peripheral A PD5 and PD12 PD8 PD9 and PD13 PA8 PA9 PA13 PA14 PA29 PA30 PC29 PC30 PC31 PD10 PD11 Peripheral B -
SSC1
Full
-
Touchscreen ADC
Partial
PA20 PD6 PD7
TC
Partial
-
TWI
Full
PD10 PD11 PA8 PA9 PA10 PD14 PD15 PD16 PD17 PD9 PA29 PA30 -
USART0
Partial
-
USART1 USART2
Partial Partial
PD2 PA20 PD3 PD4
USART3
Partial
4
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 2-1.
TD TI DO TM S T C RTK CK NT RS T J TA G SE L
2. Block Diagrams
MASTER
SLAVE
TST
System Controller
JTAG Selection and Boundary Scan
HS UTMI Transceiver
FIQ In-Circuit Emulator
BM
G
N
I II IC TM TM TM PMPM UU D D SD SD D D VDD VBG DFS DFS DH DH V
S
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
D U
AIC ARM926EJ-S Processor
TCM Interface ITCM DTCM ICache DCache 4 Kbytes 4 Kbytes CompactFlash NAND Flash & ECC
EBI
USB Device HS
IRQ
DRXD DTXD
DBGU
PDC
AT91SAM9R64 Block Diagram
PCK0-PCK1
PLLRCA
PLLA I D
DMA
XIN XOUT
12 MHz OSC
PMC
UPLL
5-layer AHB Bus Matrix
SDRAM Controller
D0-D15 A0/NBS0 A1/NBS2/NWR2 A2-A15 A16/BA0 A17/BA1 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE/CFWE NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW SDCK, SDCKE RAS, CAS SDWE, SDA10 NWAIT A23-A24, A18-A20
WDT
PIT
RC SRAM 64K Bytes ROM 32K Bytes APB Peripheral Bridge 2-channel DMA Peripheral DMA Controller
XIN32 XOUT32
32 kHz OSC
4 GPBREG
A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE A25/CFRNW
RTT
SHDN WKUP
SHDC PDC PDC
TWI0
RTC PDC PDC SPI
PWM
Static Memory Controller PDC SSC0 PDC
NCS4/CFCS0
VDDBU
POR
NCS3/NANDCS
VDDCORE
POR
RSTC MCI
NRST
USART0 USART1 USART2 USART3
TC0 TC1 TC2
3-channel 10-bit ADC
CFCE1-CFCE2 NANDOE, NANDWE
PIOA
PIOB
PIOC
PIOD
0 DA
A3 A K D0 K0 -D CD C W C T TW C
0 0 0 0 0 K0 TK TF TD RD RF R A TS
1 S1 33 013 0 2 A0 B0 S1 CK SI ISO MMM TS RT XD XD LK LK IO IO W PC SP MO M RT PW PW P 0- D0TC TC T T -N S0 XD TX R PC N
D
G0 12 TR AD AD AD
EF A N R AN DA DV DD GN SA V T
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
5
Figure 2-2.
TD TDI O TM S T C RTK CK NT RS T J TA G SE L
BM
S
MASTER
SLAVE
I II IC TM M M PMPM UTT D DU DU G SD SD SD SD N FFHH G VD VD VB D D D D
TST
System Controller
JTAG Selection and Boundary Scan
HS UTMI Transceiver
FIQ
LC LCDD 0 LCDV -LC S LD Y D CDHS NC D2 3 Y LD DO NC T LCDE CK N LCDC C LCDP DMWR O D
6
AIC
In-Circuit Emulator
EBI
ARM926EJ-S Processor LCDC
ICache DCache 4 Kbytes 4 Kbytes
IRQ
DRXD DTXD
PDC
DBGU
USB Device HS
AT91SAM9RL64 Block Diagram
PCK0-PCK1
CompactFlash NAND Flash & ECC
PLLRCA
PLLA PMC I D
TCM Interface ITCM DTCM
DMA
DMA
XIN XOUT
OSC 12M
UPLL
6-layer AHB Bus Matrix
PIT
SDRAM Controller
D0-D15 A0/NBS0 A1/NBS2/NWR2 A2-A15 A16/BA0 A17/BA1 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE/CFWE NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW SDCK, SDCKE RAS, CAS SDWE, SDA10 NWAIT A23-A24 A18-A20
WDT
RC
4 GPBREG
XIN32 XOUT32
OSC 32K
SRAM 64K Bytes ROM 32K Bytes APB
Peripheral Bridge
Peripheral DMA Controller
2-channel DMA
A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE A25/CFRNW D16-D31 NCS4/CFCS0
RTT RTC PDC PDC RSTC
MCI TWI0 TWI1
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Static Memory Controller PDC PDC PDC PDC SPI
PWM
SHDN WKUP
SHDC PDC AC97
VDDBU
POR
NCS5/CFCS1 NCS3/NANDCS NCS2
Touch Screen Controller SSC0 SSC1 6-channel 10-bit ADC
VDDCORE
POR
NRST
USART0 USART1 USART2 USART3
TC0 TC1 TC2
CFCE1-CFCE2 NANDOE, NANDWE
PIOA PIOB PIOD
PIOC
0 DA
3 3 222 K S X X 1 1 1 1 1 K1 G A3 A K 0 0 D1 1 S3 S K3 D3 3 D0 I0 0 0 S3 K I O FAN 45 LK A B C F R T K TF D D F R TR 0X P 1X M 2Y P 3Y M AD AD RE AN DA -D CD C WD CK W CK CT -RT SC RX TXD C R SR TR PC PC OSMIS WM C IO IO 97 97 97 97 0-T 0- -T -R -R 0D D -N S M T W T TW 0- S0 0- 0- 0- D -P -T 0-T 0-T AC AC AC AC TK TF TD0 D0RF0RK AD AD AD AD AD GP GP DV DD GN T 0 0 AV S R TS RT CK XD XD M LK0 OA OB S T C SR T TS I PC PW TC T TI N
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
3. Signal Description
Table 3-1 gives details on the signal name classified by peripheral. Table 3-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List
Function Type Power Supplies Active Level Comments
VDDIOM VDDIOP VDDUTMII VDDUTMIC GNDUTMI VDDBU GNDBU VDDPLLA GNDPLLA VDDPLLB GNDPLLB VDDANA GNDANA VDDCORE GNDCORE GND
EBI I/O Lines Power Supply Peripherals I/O Lines Power Supply USB UTMI+ Interface Power Supply USB UTMI+ Core Power Supply USB UTMI Ground Backup I/O Lines Power Supply Backup Ground PLL Power Supply PLL Ground UTMI PLL and OSC 12M Power Supply UTMI PLL and OSC 12M Ground ADC Analog Power Supply ADC Analog Ground Core Chip Power Supply Ground Ground
Power Power Power Power Ground Power Ground Power Ground Power Ground Power Ground Power Ground Ground Clocks, Oscillators and PLLs
1.65V to 3.6V 3.0V to 3.6V 3.0V to 3.6V 1.08V to 1.32V
1.08V to 1.32V
3.0V to 3.6V
1.08 V to 1.32V
3.0V to 3.6V
1.08V to 1.32V
XIN XOUT XIN32 XOUT32 VBG PLLRCA PCK0 - PCK1
Main Oscillator Input Main Oscillator Output Slow Clock Oscillator Input Slow Clock Oscillator Output Bias Voltage Reference PLL A Filter Programmable Clock Output
Input Output Input Output Analog Input Output Shutdown, Wakeup Logic
SHDN WKUP
Shutdown Control Wake-Up Input
Output Input ICE and JTAG
Driven at 0V only. 0: The device is in backup mode. 1: The device is running (not in backup mode.) Accept between 0V and VDDBU
TCK TDI TDO TMS JTAGSEL
Test Clock Test Data In Test Data Out Test Mode Select JTAG Selection
Input Input Output Input Input
No pull-up resistor No pull-up resistor
No pull-up resistor Pull-down resistor
7
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 3-1.
Signal Name NTRST
Signal Description List (Continued)
Function Test Reset Signal Type Input Reset/Test Active Level Low Comments Pull-up resistor.
NRST TST
Microcontroller Reset Test Mode Select
I/O Input
Low
Pull-up resistor Pull-down resistor Must be connected to GND or VDDIOP. No pullup resistor BMS = 0 when tied to GND BMS = 1 when tied to VDDIOP
BMS
Boot Mode Select
Input
Debug Unit - DBGU DRXD DTXD Debug Receive Data Debug Transmit Data Input Output Advanced Interrupt Controller - AIC IRQ FIQ External Interrupt Input Fast Interrupt Input Input Input PIO Controller - PIOA - PIOB - PIOC-PIOD PA0 - PA31 PB0 - PB31 PC0 - PC31 PD0 - PD21 Parallel IO Controller A Parallel IO Controller B Parallel IO Controller C Parallel IO Controller D I/O I/O I/O I/O External Bus Interface - EBI D0 - D31 A0 - A25 NWAIT Data Bus Address Bus External Wait Signal I/O Output Input Low Pulled-up input at reset. D16-D31 not present on AT91SAM9R64. 0 at reset Pulled-up input at reset Pulled-up input at reset Pulled-up input at reset Pulled-up input at reset
Static Memory Controller - SMC NCS0 - NCS5 NWR0 - NWR3 NRD NWE NBS0 - NBS3 Chip Select Lines Write Signal Read Signal Write Enable Byte Mask Signal Output Output Output Output Output Low Low Low Low Low NCS2, NCS5 not present on AT91SAM9R64.
CompactFlash Support CFCE1 - CFCE2 CFOE CFWE CFIOR CFIOW CFRNW CFCS0 - CFCS1 CompactFlash Chip Enable CompactFlash Output Enable CompactFlash Write Enable CompactFlash IO Read CompactFlash IO Write CompactFlash Read Not Write CompactFlash Chip Select Lines Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Low CFCS1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. Low Low Low Low Low
8
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 3-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List (Continued)
Function Type Active Level Comments
NAND Flash Support NANDCS NANDOE NANDWE NAND Flash Chip Select NAND Flash Output Enable NAND Flash Write Enable Output Output Output SDRAM Controller SDCK SDCKE SDCS BA0 - BA1 SDWE RAS - CAS SDA10 SDRAM Clock SDRAM Clock Enable SDRAM Controller Chip Select Bank Select SDRAM Write Enable Row and Column Signal SDRAM Address 10 Line Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Multimedia Card Interface MCI CK CDA DA0 - DA3 Multimedia Card Clock Multimedia Card Slot A Command Multimedia Card Slot A Data I/O I/O I/O Low Low High Low Low Low Low
Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter USARTx SCKx TXDx RXDx RTSx CTSx DTR0 DSR0 DCD0 RI0 USARTx Serial Clock USARTx Transmit Data USARTx Receive Data USARTx Request To Send USARTx Clear To Send USART0 Data Terminal Ready USART0 Data Set Ready USART0 Data Carrier Detect USART0 Ring Indicator I/O I/O Input Output Input I/O Input Output Input RTS0, RTS2, RTS3 not present on AT91SAM9R64. CTS0, CTS2, CTS3 not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. SCKx not present on AT91SAM9R64.
Synchronous Serial Controller - SSCx TD0 - TD1 RD0 - RD1 TK0 - TK1 RK0 - RK1 TF0 - TF1 RF0 - RF1 SSC Transmit Data SSC Receive Data SSC Transmit Clock SSC Receive Clock SSC Transmit Frame Sync SSC Receive Frame Sync Output Input I/O I/O I/O I/O TD1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. RD1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. TK1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. RK1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. TF1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. RF1 not present on AT91SAM9R64.
9
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 3-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List (Continued)
Function Type Active Level Comments
AC97 Controller - AC97C AC97RX AC97TX AC97FS AC97CK AC97 Receive Signal AC97 Transmit Signal AC97 Frame Synchronization Signal AC97 Clock signal Input Output Output Input Timer/Counter - TC TCLKx TIOAx TIOBx TC Channel x External Clock Input TC Channel x I/O Line A TC Channel x I/O Line B Input I/O I/O TCLK1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. TIOA1, TIOA2 not present on AT91SAM9R64. TIOB1, TIOB2 not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64.
Pulse Width Modulation Controller- PWMC PMWx Pulse Width Modulation Output Output PWM2 not present on AT91SAM9R64.
Serial Peripheral Interface - SPI MISO MOSI SPCK NPCS0 NPCS1 - NPCS3 Master In Slave Out Master Out Slave In SPI Serial Clock SPI Peripheral Chip Select 0 SPI Peripheral Chip Select I/O I/O I/O I/O Output Low Low NPCS2, NPCS3 not present on AT91SAM9R64.
Two-Wire Interface - TWIx TWDx TWCKx TWIx Two-wire Serial Data TWIx Two-wire Serial Clock I/O I/O TWD1 not present on AT91SAM9R64. TWCK1 not present on AT91SAM9R64.
Touch Screen Analog-to-Digital Converter GPAD0-GPAD5 AD0XP AD1XM AD2YP AD3YM TSADTRG TSADVREF Analog Inputs Touch Panel Right side Touch Panel Left side Touch Panel Top side Touch Panel Bottom side ADC Trigger ADC Reference Analog Analog Analog Analog Analog Input Analog LCD Controller - LCDC LCDD0 - LCDD23 LCDVSYNC LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDDEN LCDCC LCDPWR LCDMOD LCD Data Bus LCD Vertical Synchronization LCD Horizontal Synchronization LCD Dot Clock LCD Data Enable LCD Contrast Control LCD panel Power enable control LCD Modulation signal Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. Not present on AT91SAM9R64. GPAD4, GPAD5 not present on AT91SAM9R64. Multiplexed with AD0 Multiplexed with AD1 Multiplexed with AD2 Multiplexed with AD3. Not present on AT91SAM9R64.
10
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 3-1.
Signal Name
Signal Description List (Continued)
Function Type Active Level Comments
USB High Speed Device DFSDM DFSDP DHSDM DHSDP USB Device Full Speed Data USB Device Full Speed Data + USB Device High Speed Data USB Device High Speed Data + Analog Analog Analog Analog
11
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
4. Package and Pinout
The AT91SAM9R64 is available in a 144-ball BGA package. The AT91SAM9RL64 is available in a 217-ball LFBGA package.
4.1
144-ball BGA Package Outline
Figure 4-1 shows the orientation of the 144-ball BGA package.
Figure 4-1.
144-ball BGA Pinout (Top View)
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 ABCDEF GHJ
BALL A1
KLM
12
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
4.2 Pinout
AT91SAM9R64 Pinout for 144-ball BGA Package
Pin D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 E10 E11 E12 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F10 F11 F12 Signal Name PLLRCA VDDUTMII NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR JTAGSEL GNDBU TCK PA[26] PA[24] PA[13] PA[6] PD[20] GNDPLLA NWR0/NWE/CFWE NRD/CFOE NCS0 NCS1/SDCS PB[2] NRST BMS PA[25] PA[15] PA[5] PA[4] PB[5] PB[6] PB[7] PB[8] PB[3] PB[4] TST VDDUTMIC PA[3] PA[2] PA[0] PA[1] Pin G1 G2 G3 G4 G5 G6 G7 G8 G9 G10 G11 G12 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6 H7 H8 H9 H10 H11 H12 J1 J2 J3 J4 J5 J6 J7 J8 J9 J10 J11 J12 Signal Name PB[10] PB[11] PB[12] PB[9] PB[13] GND GND GND GNDUTMI VDDCORE VDDIOP VDDIOP PB[14] PB[15] A[0] A[2] SDA10 D[1] GND GND VDDIOM SDCKE VDDCORE VDDIOP A[4] A[1] A[3] A[14] CAS D[2] D[5] D[12] D[14] VDDIOM D[10] D[9] Pin K1 K2 K3 K4 K5 K6 K7 K8 K9 K10 K11 K12 L1 L2 L3 L4 L5 L6 L7 L8 L9 L10 L11 L12 M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 M6 M7 M8 M9 M10 M11 M12 Signal Name A[5] A[6] A[13] A[15] RAS D[3] D[6] D[13] VDDIOM VDDIOM D[11] PB[1] A[7] A[8] A[11] A[16] SDWE D[4] D[7] D[15] PC[1] PC[0] PB[0] GNDANA A[9] A[10] A[12] A[17] D[0] SDCK D[8] ADVREF VDDANA PA[17] PA[18] PA[19]
Table 4-1.
Pin A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 B10 B11 B12 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 C10 C11 C12 DFSDM DHSDM XIN XOUT XIN32
Signal Name
XOUT32 TDO PA[31] PA[22] PA[16] PA[14] PA[11] DFSDP DHSDP NC VDDPLLB GNDPLLB TMS RTCK PA[27] PA[21] PA[12] PD[21] PA[10] VDDPLLA VBG VDDBU SHDN WKUP NTRST TDI PA[28] PA[23] PA[7] PD[19] PD[18]
13
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
4.3
217-ball LFBGA Package Outline
Figure 4-2 shows the orientation of the 217-ball LFBGA package.
Figure 4-2.
217-ball LFBGA Pinout (Top View)
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 ABCDEF GHJ KL M NPRT U
BALL A1
14
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
4.4
Pin A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 B10 B11 B12 B13 B14 B15 B16 B17 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 C10 C11 C12 C13 C14 C15 C16 C17 D1 D2 D3 D4
Pinout
AT91SAM9RL64 Pinout for 217-ball LFBGA Package (1)
Signal Name DFSDM DHSDP VDDPLLB XIN XOUT GNDPLLB XOUT32 GND NRST RTCK PA[29] PA[26] PA[22] PA[14] PA[10] PD[20] PD[17] DFSDP DHSDM VBG NC NC XIN32 TST GND TMS VDDCORE PA[28] PA[25] PA[21] PA[13] PD[21] PD[19] PA[9] VDDPLLA VDDUTMII GND GNDUTMI VDDBU WKUP GNDBU TCK TDI PA[31] PA[27] PA[24] PA[16] PA[11] PD[18] PA[7] PA[6] PLLRCA NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR GND GND Pin D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 D16 D17 E1 E2 E3 E4 E14 E15 E16 E17 F1 F2 F3 F4 F14 F15 F16 F17 G1 G2 G3 G4 G14 G15 G16 G17 H1 H2 H3 H4 H8 H9 H10 H14 H15 H16 H17 J1 J2 J3 J4 J8 J9 J10 Signal Name SHDN JTAGSEL NTRST BMS TDO PA[30] GND PA[23] PA[15] PA[12] PA[8] PD[13] PD[16] GNDPLLA NCS1/SDCS NCS0 NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW PD[15] PD[14] PA[5] PA[4] NRD/CFOE PB[2] NWR0/NWE/CFWE PB[3] PA[1] PA[0] PA[2] PA[3] GND VDDIOM PB[5] PB[4] PD[12] PD[11] PD[10] PD[9] PB[8] PB[9] PB[7] PB[6] VDDCORE VDDIOP PD[4] PD[8] PD[5] PD[2] PD[3] PB[12] PB[13] PB[11] PB[10] VDDCORE VDDIOP PC[29] Pin J14 J15 J16 J17 K1 K2 K3 K4 K8 K9 K10 K14 K15 K16 K17 L1 L2 L3 L4 L14 L15 L16 L17 M1 M2 M3 M4 M14 M15 M16 M17 N1 N2 N3 N4 N14 N15 N16 N17 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 P8 P9 P10 P11 P12 P13 P14 P15 P16 Signal Name PD[1] PD[0] PC[30] PC[31] PB[14] PB[15] PB[17] PB[16] VDDUTMIC VDDIOP PC[28] PC[25] PC[24] PC[26] PC[27] PB[18] PB[19] PB[21] PB[20] PC[21] PC[20] PC[22] PC[23] PB[22] PB[23] PB[25] PB[24] PC[17] PC[16] PC[18] PC[19] PB[26] PB[27] PB[29] PB[28] PC[13] PC[12] PC[14] PC[15] PB[30] PB[31] A[1] A[11] A[15] CAS D[1] SDCKE D[5] D[8] D[15] PC[0] PB[0] PC[8] PC[9] PC[10] Pin P17 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 R14 R15 R16 R17 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T6 T7 T8 T9 T10 T11 T12 T13 T14 T15 T16 T17 U1 U2 U3 U4 U5 U6 U7 U8 U9 U10 U11 U12 U13 U14 U15 U16 U17 Signal Name PC[11] A[0] A[2] A[7] A[10] A[14] SDA10 D[0] VDDIOM D[6] D[9] NC VDDIOM PC[1] PB[1] PC[5] PC[6] PC[7] A[3] A[5] A[8] A[12] A[16] RAS D[2] D[4] D[7] D[10] D[14] VDDANA PA[17] PA[19] PC[2] PC[3] PC[4] A[4] A[6] A[9] A[13] A[17] SDWE D[3] SDCK D[11] D[12] D[13] TSADVREF PA[18] PA[20] PD[6] PD[7] GNDANA
Table 4-2.
Note:
1. Shaded cells define the pins powered by VDDIOM.
15
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
5. Power Considerations
5.1 Power Supplies
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 has several types of power supply pins: * VDDCORE pins: Power the core, including the processor, the embedded memories and the peripherals; voltage ranges from 1.08V and 1.32V, 1.2V nominal. * VDDIOM pins: Power the External Bus Interface; voltage ranges between 1.65V and 1.95V (1.8V nominal) or between 3.0V and 3.6V (3.3V nominal). * VDDIOP pins: Power the Peripherals I/O lines; voltage ranges from 3.0V and 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. * VDDBU pin: Powers the Slow Clock oscillator and a part of the System Controller; voltage ranges from 1.08V and 1.32V, 1.2V nominal. * VDDPLLA pin: Powers the PLL cell; voltage ranges from 3.0V and 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. * VDDPLLB pin: Powers the UTMI PLL (480MHz) and OSC 12M cells; voltage ranges from 1.08V and 1.32V, 1.2V nominal. * VDDUTMII pin: Powers the UTMI+ interface; voltage ranges from 3.0V and 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. * VDDUTMIC pin: Powers the UTMI+ core; voltage ranges from 1.08V and 1.32V, 1.2V nominal. * VDDANA pin: Powers the ADC cell; voltage ranges from 3.0V and 3.6V, 3.3V nominal. The power supplies VDDIOM and VDDIOP are identified in the pinout table and the PIO multiplexing tables. These supplies enable the user to power the device differently for interfacing with memories and for interfacing with peripherals. Ground pins GND are common to VDDCORE, VDDIOM and VDDIOP pins power supplies. Separated ground pins are provided for VDDBU, VDDPLLA, VDDPLLB and VDDANA. These ground pins are respectively GNDBU, GNDPLLA, GNDPLLB and GNDANA. A common ground pin is provided for VDDUTMII and VDDUTMIC. This ground pin is GNDUTMI. Caution: VDDCORE and VDDIO constraints at startup to be checked in the Core Power Supply POR Characteristics in the Electical Characteristics section of the datasheet. 5.1.1 USB Power Supply Considerations To achieve the best performances on the UDPHS, care must be taken in the power supplies choice and especially on VDDPLLB,VDDUTMIC and VDDUTMII. The USB High speed requires power supplies with a ripple voltage < 20 mV on VDDPLLB and VDDUTMIC. The VDDUTMII powering the UTMI transceiver must also be filtered. It is highly recommended to use an LDO linear regulator to generate the 1.2 volts for both VDDPLLB and VDDUTMIC. VDDUTMII can be connected on the 3.3 volts of the system via an LC filter. The figure below gives an example of VDDPLLB, VDDUTMIC and VDDUTMII.
16
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 5-1. Example of PLL and USB Power Supplies
VIN
VIN CE 10F VSS
VOUT 10F 1K ADJ 100K MIC5235YM5 0.1F
1V2_USB
2.2H 1V2_USB 0.1F VDDPLLB
2.2H 1V2_USB 0.1F VDDUTMIC
2.2H 3V3 0.1F VDDUTMII
5.2
Programmable I/O Lines Power Supplies
The power supplies pins VDDIOM support two voltage ranges. This allows the device to reach its maximum speed either out of 1.8V or 3.3V external memories. The maximum speed is MCK on the pin SDCK (SDRAM Clock) loaded with 30pF for power supply at 1.8V and 50 pF for power supply at 3.3V. The maximum speed on the other signals of the External Bus Interface (control, address and data signals) is 50 MHz. The voltage ranges are determined by programming registers in the Chip Configuration registers located in the Matrix User Interface. At reset, the selected voltage defaults to 3.3V nominal and power supply pins can accept either 1.8V or 3.3V. The user must make sure to program the EBI voltage range before getting the device out of its Slow Clock Mode. The PIO lines are supplied through VDDIOP and the speed of the signal that can be driven on them can reach 50 MHz with 50 pF load.
17
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
6. I/O Line Considerations
6.1 JTAG Port Pins
TMS, TDI and TCK are schmitt trigger inputs and have no pull-up resistors. TDO is an output, driven at up to VDDIOP, and have no pull-up resistor. The JTAGSEL pin is used to select the JTAG boundary scan when asserted at a high level. It integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 k to GNDBU, so that it can be left unconnected for normal operations. All the JTAG signals are supplied with VDDIOP except JTAGSEL supplied by VDDBU.
6.2
Test Pin
The TST pin is used for manufacturing test purposes when asserted high. It integrates a permanent pull-down resistor of about 15 k to GNDBU, so that it can be left unconnected for normal operations. Driving this line at a high level leads to unpredictable results. This pin is supplied with VDDBU.
6.3
Reset Pins
NRST is an open-drain output integrating a non-programmable pull-up resistor. It can be driven with voltage at up to VDDIOP. As the product integrates power-on reset cells, which manages the processor and the JTAG reset, the NRST and NTRST pin can be left unconnected. The NRST and NTRST pins integrates a permanent pull-up resistor of 100 k typical to VDDIOP. The NRST signal is inserted in the Boundary Scan.
6.4
PIO Controllers
All the I/O lines which are managed by the PIO Controllers integrate a programmable pull-up resistor. Refer to the section "AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Electrical Characteristics" in the product datasheet for more details. After reset, all the I/O lines default as inputs with pull-up resistors enabled, except those which are multiplexed with the External Bus Interface signals that require to be enabled as Peripheral at reset. This is explicitly indicated in the column "Reset State" of the PIO Controller multiplexing tables.
6.5
Shutdown Logic Pins
The pin WKUP is an input-only. It can accept voltages only between 0V and VDDBU.
7. Processor and Architecture
7.1 ARM926EJ-S Processor
* * RISC Processor Based on ARM v5TEJ Architecture with Jazelle technology for Java acceleration Two Instruction Sets
18
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- - * * ARM High-performance 32-bit Instruction Set Thumb High Code Density 16-bit Instruction Set
DSP Instruction Extensions 5-Stage Pipeline Architecture: - - - - - Instruction Fetch (F) Instruction Decode (D) Execute (E) Data Memory (M) Register Write (W) Virtually-addressed 4-way Associative Cache Eight words per line Write-through and Write-back Operation Pseudo-random or Round-robin Replacement Main Write Buffer with 16-word Data Buffer and 4-address Buffer DCache Write-back Buffer with 8-word Entries and a Single Address Entry Software Control Drain Access Permission for Sections Access Permission for large pages and small pages can be specified separately for each quarter of the page 16 embedded domains Arbitrates and Schedules AHB Requests Separate Masters for both instruction and data access providing complete Matrix system flexibility Separate Address and Data Buses for both the 32-bit instruction interface and the 32-bit data interface On Address and Data Buses, data can be 8-bit (Bytes), 16-bit (Half-words) or 32-bit (Words)
*
4-Kbyte Data Cache, 4-Kbyte Instruction Cache - - - -
*
Write Buffer - - -
*
Standard ARM v4 and v5 Memory Management Unit (MMU) - - -
*
Bus Interface Unit (BIU) - - - -
7.2
Matrix Masters
The Bus Matrix of the AT91SAM9R64/RL64 product manages 6 masters, which means that each master can perform an access concurrently with others, to an available slave. Each master has its own decoder, which is defined specifically for each master. In order to simplify the addressing, all the masters have the same decodings. Table 7-1.
Master 0 Master 1 Master 2
List of Bus Matrix Masters
DMA Controller USB Device High Speed DMA LCD Controller DMA
19
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 7-1.
Master 3 Master 4 Master 5
List of Bus Matrix Masters
Peripheral DMA Controller ARM926TM Instruction ARM926 Data
7.3
Matrix Slaves
The Bus Matrix of the AT91SAM9R64/RL64 product manages 6 slaves. Each slave has its own arbiter, allowing a different arbitration per slave. Table 7-2.
Slave 0 Slave 1 Slave 2 Slave 3 Slave 4 Slave 5
List of Bus Matrix Slaves
Internal ROM Internal SRAM LCD Controller User Interface UDP High Speed RAM External Bus Interface (EBI) Peripheral Bridge
7.4
Master to Slave Access
All the Masters can normally access all the Slaves. However, some paths do not make sense, for example allowing access from the USB Device High speed DMA to the Internal Peripherals. Thus, these paths are forbidden or simply not wired, and shown as "-" in the following table.
Table 7-3.
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Master to Slave Access
Masters Slaves 0
DMA Controller
1
USB HS Device DMA
2
LCD Controller DMA
3
Peripheral DMA
4
ARM926 Instruction
5
ARM926 Data
0 1 2 3 4 5
Internal ROM Internal SRAM LCD Controller User Interface UDP High Speed RAM External Bus Interface Peripheral Bridge
X X X X
X X X X X X X
X X X -
X X X X X -
X X X X X -
7.5
Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC)
* Acting as one AHB Bus Matrix Master * Allows data transfers from/to peripheral to/from any memory space without any intervention of the processor. * Next Pointer support, prevents strong real-time constraints on buffer management. The Peripheral DMA Controller handles transfer requests from the channel according to the following priorities (Low to High priorities):
20
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
a. TWI0 Transmit Channel b. DBGU Transmit Channel c. USART3 Transmit Channel d. USART2 Transmit Channel e. USART1 Transmit Channel f. USART0 Transmit Channel g. AC97 Transmit Channel h. SPI Transmit Channel i. j. k. l. SSC1 Transmit Channel SSC0 Transmit Channel TWI0 Receive Channel DBGU Receive Channel
m. ADC Receive Channel n. USART3 Receive Channel o. USART2 Receive Channel p. USART1 Receive Channel q. USART0 Receive Channel r. s. t. v. AC97 Receive Channel SPI Receive Channel SSC1 Receive Channel MCI Receive/Transmit Channel
u. SSC0 Transmit Channel
7.6
DMA Controller
* Acting as one Matrix Master * Embeds 2 channels * 16 bytes/FIFO for Channel Buffering * Linked List support with Status Write Back operation at End of Transfer * Word, Half-word, Byte transfer support
7.7
Debug and Test Features
* ARM926 Real-time In-circuit Emulator - Two real-time Watchpoint Units - Two Independent Registers: Debug Control Register and Debug Status Register - Test Access Port Accessible through JTAG Protocol - Debug Communications Channel * Debug Unit - Two-pin UART - Debug Communication Channel Interrupt Handling - Chip ID Register * IEEE1149.1 JTAG Boundary-scan on All Digital Pins
21
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
8. Memories
Figure 8-1. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Memory Mapping
Address Memory Space 0x0000 0000 Internal Memories
0x0FFF FFFF
Internal Memory Mapping
0x0000 0000 Boot Memory (1) 1 MBytes 1 MBytes Notes : (1) Can be SRAM, ROM depending on BMS and the REMAP Command (2) Software programmable
256M Bytes
0x0010 0000 ITCM(2) 0x0020 0000
0x1000 0000 EBI Chip Select 0
0x1FFF FFFF
DTCM(2)
1 MBytes
256M Bytes
0x0030 0000 SRAM(2) 1 MBytes
0x2000 0000 EBI Chip Select 1/ SDRAMC
0x0040 0000
256M Bytes
0x0050 0000
ROM
LCD Controller User Interface
1 MBytes
0x2FFF FFFF
0x3000 0000 EBI Chip Select 2
0x3FFF FFFF
1 MBytes
256M Bytes
0x0060 0000 UDPHS RAM 0x0070 0000 1 MBytes
0x4000 0000
EBI Chip Select 3/ NANDFlash EBI Chip Select 4/ Compact Flash Slot 0 EBI Chip Select 5/ Compact Flash Slot 1
256M Bytes
0x0FFF FFFF
Undefined (Abort) System Controller Mapping
0xFFFF C000
0x4FFF FFFF
0x5000 0000
256M Bytes Peripheral Mapping
0xF000 0000
0x5FFF FFFF
0x6000 0000
Reserved Reserved
0xFFFF E600
256M Bytes
0xFFFA 0000
0x6FFF FFFF
0x7000 0000
0xFFFA 4000
DMAC
TCO, TC1, TC2 16K Bytes 0xFFFF E800
512 Bytes
ECC
MCI 16K Bytes 0xFFFF EA00
512 Bytes
0xFFFA 8000 TWI0 0xFFFA C000 TWI1 0xFFFB 0000 USART0 0xFFFB 4000 USART1 0xFFFB 8000 USART2 16K Bytes 0xFFFF F400 16K Bytes 0xFFFF F200 16K Bytes 16K Bytes 0xFFFF EE00 0xFFFF EF10 0xFFFF F000 16K Bytes 0xFFFF EC00
SDRAMC SMC MATRIX AIC DBGU PIOA
UART3 16K Bytes 0xFFFF F600
512 Bytes
512 bytes
512 Bytes
512 Bytes
512 Bytes
Undefined (Abort)
0xFFFB C000
512 Bytes
0xFFFC 0000 SSC0 0xFFFC 4000 16K Bytes 0xFFFF F800
PIOB PIOC
SSC1 16K Bytes 0xFFFF FA00
512 Bytes
512 bytes
2,048M Bytes
0xFFFC 8000
PIOD
PWMC 16K Bytes 0xFFFF FC00
512 bytes
0xFFFC C000 SPI 0xFFFD 0000 ADC TouchScreen 0xFFFD 4000 UDPHS 0xFFFD 8000 AC97 0xFFFD C000 0xEFFF FFFF 16K Bytes 16K Bytes 16K Bytes 16K Bytes 0xFFFF FD00
PMC RSTC
0xFFFF FD10
256 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes 16 Bytes
SHDC
0xFFFF FD20
RTTC
0xFFFF FD30
PITC
0xFFFF FD40
WDTC
0xFFFF FD50 0xFFFF FD60
SCKCR GPBR Reserved RTCC
0xF000 0000
0xFFFF C000
Reserved Internal Peripherals 256M Bytes
0xFFFF FFFF SYSC 16K Bytes
0xFFFF FD70 0xFFFF FE00
128 Bytes
0xFFFF FFFF
0xFFFF FFFF
Reserved
22
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
A first level of address decoding is performed by the AHB Bus Matrix, i.e., the implementation of the Advanced High performance Bus (AHB) for its Master and Slave interfaces with additional features. Decoding breaks up the 4G bytes of address space into 16 banks of 256M bytes. The banks 1 to 8 are directed to the EBI that associates these banks to the external chip selects EBI_NCS0 to EBI_NCS5. The bank 0 is reserved for the addressing of the internal memories, and a second level of decoding provides 1M byte of internal memory area. The bank 15 is reserved for the peripherals and provides access to the Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). Other areas are unused and performing an access within them provides an abort to the master requesting such an access.
8.1
Embedded Memories
* 32 KB ROM - Single Cycle Access at full bus speed * 64 KB Fast SRAM - Single Cycle Access at full bus speed - Supports ARM926EJ-S TCM interface at full processor speed
8.1.1
Internal Memory Mapping Table 8-1 summarizes the Internal Memory Mapping for each Master, depending on the Remap status (RCBx bit) and the BMS state at reset. Table 8-1.
Address BMS = 1 0x0000 0000 Notes: ROM BMS =0 EBI_NCS0(2) SRAM
Internal Memory Mapping
RCBx(1) = 0 RCBx(1) = 1
1. x = 0 to maximum Master number. 2. EBI NCS0 is to be connected to a 16-bit non-volatile memory. The access configuration is defined by the reset state of SMC Setup, SMC Pulse, SMC Cycle and SMC Mode CS0 registers.
8.1.1.1
Internal SRAM The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 product embeds a total of 64Kbyte high-speed SRAM split in 4 blocks of 16KBytes. After reset and until the Remap Command is performed, the SRAM is only accessible at address 0x0030 0000. After Remap, the SRAM also becomes available at address 0x0. This Internal SRAM can be allocated to threes areas. Its Memory Mapping is detailed in Table 82. * Internal SRAM A is the ARM926EJ-S Instruction TCM. The user can map this SRAM block anywhere in the ARM926 instruction memory space using CP15 instructions and the TCR configuration register located in the Chip Configuration User Interface. This SRAM block is also accessible by the ARM926 Data Master and by the AHB Masters through the AHB bus at address 0x0010 0000.
23
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Internal SRAM B is the ARM926EJ-S Data TCM. The user can map this SRAM block anywhere in the ARM926 data memory space using CP15 instructions. This SRAM block is also accessible by the ARM926 Data Master and by the AHB Masters through the AHB bus at address 0x0020 0000. * Internal SRAM C is only accessible by all the AHB Masters. After reset and until the Remap Command is performed, this SRAM block is accessible through the AHB bus at address 0x0030 0000 by all the AHB Masters. After Remap, this SRAM block also becomes accessible through the AHB bus at address 0x0 by the ARM926 Instruction and the ARM926 Data Masters.
Within the 64Kbyte SRAM size available, the amount of memory assigned to each block is software programmable as a multiple of 16K Bytes according to Table 8-2. This Table provides the size of the Internal SRAM C according to the size of the Internal SRAM A and the Internal SRAM B. Table 8-2. Internal SRAM Block Size
Internal SRAM A (ITCM) Size Remaining Internal SRAM C 0 0 Internal SRAM B (DTCM) size 16K Bytes 32K Bytes 64K Bytes 48K Bytes 32K Bytes 16K Bytes 48K Bytes 32K Bytes 16K Bytes 32K Bytes 32K Bytes 16K Bytes 0K Bytes
At reset, the whole memory is assigned to Internal SRAM C. The memory blocks assigned to SRAM A, SRAM B and SRAM C areas are not contiguous and when the user dynamically changes the Internal SRAM configuration, the new 16-Kbyte block organization may affect the previous configuration from a software point of view. Table 8-3 illustrates different configurations and the related 16-Kbyte blocks (RB0 to RB3) assignments. Table 8-3.
Decoded Area
16-Kbyte Block Allocation example
Configuration examples and related 16-Kbyte block assignments Address I = 0K D = 0K A = 64K(1) I = 16K D = 0K A = 48K RB1 I =32K D = 0K A = 32K RB1 RB0 RB3 RB3 I = 0K D = 16K A = 48K I = 16K D = 16K A = 32K RB1 I = 32K D = 16K A = 16K RB1 RB0 RB3 RB3 RB2 RB3 RB2 RB1 RB0 RB3 RB2 RB0 RB3 RB2 RB2 RB1 RB0 RB2 RB0 RB2 RB1 RB0 RB3 RB2 RB0 I = 0K D = 32K A = 32K I = 16K D = 32K A = 16K RB1 I = 32K D = 32K A = 0K RB1 RB0 RB3 RB2
Internal SRAM A (ITCM) Internal SRAM B (DTCM)
0x0010 0000 0x0010 4000 0x0020 0000 0x0020 4000 0x0030 0000
Internal SRAM C (AHB) Note:
0x0030 4000 0x0030 8000 0x0030 C000
1. Configuration after reset.
24
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
When accessed from the AHB, the internal Fast SRAM is single cycle accessible at full matrix speed (MCK). When accessed from the processor's TCM Interface, they are also single cycle accessible at full processor speed. 8.1.1.2 Internal ROM The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 embeds an Internal ROM, which contains the SAM-BA program. At any time, the ROM is mapped at address 0x0040 0000. It is also accessible at address 0x0 (BMS =1) after the reset and before the Remap Command. 8.1.2 Boot Strategies The system always boots at address 0x0. To ensure maximum boot possibilities, the memory layout can be changed with two parameters. REMAP allows the user to layout the internal SRAM bank to 0x0 to ease the development. This is done by software once the system has boot. Refer to the Bus Matrix Section for more details. When REMAP = 0 BMS allows the user to lay out to 0x0, at his convenience, the ROM or an external memory. This is done by a hardware way at reset. Note: All the memory blocks can always be seen at their specified base addresses that are not concerned by these parameters. The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Bus Matrix manages a boot memory that depends on the level on the pin BMS at reset. The internal memory area mapped between address 0x0 and 0x000F FFFF is reserved to this effect. If BMS is detected at 1, the boot memory is the embedded ROM. If BMS is detected at 0, the boot memory is the memory connected on the Chip Select 0 of the External Bus Interface. 8.1.2.1 BMS = 1, boot on embedded ROM The system boots on Boot Program. * Boot on on-chip RC * Enable the 32768 Hz oscillator * Auto baudrate detection * Downloads and runs an application from external storage media into internal SRAM * Downloaded code size depends on embedded SRAM size * Automatic detection of valid application * Bootloader on a non-volatile memory - SDCard (boot ROM does not support high-capacity SDCards) - NAND Flash - SPI DataFlash(R) connected on NPCS0 of the SPI0 * SAM-BA Boot in case no valid program is detected in external NVM, supporting - Serial communication on a DBGU - USB Device HS Port 8.1.2.2 BMS = 0, boot on external memory * Boot on on-chip RC
25
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Boot with the default configuration for the Static Memory Controller, byte select mode, 16-bit data bus, Read/Write controlled by Chip Select, allows boot on 16-bit non-volatile memory. For optimization purposes, nothing else is done. To speed up the boot sequence user programmed software should perform a complete configuration: * Enable the 32768 Hz oscillator if best accuracy needed * Program the PMC (main oscillator enable or bypass mode) * Program and Start the PLL * Reprogram the SMC setup, cycle, hold, mode timings registers for CS0 to adapt them to the new clock * Switch the main clock to the new value
8.2
External Memories
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 features one External Bus Interface to offer interface to a wide range of external memories and to any parallel peripheral.
8.2.1
External Bus Interface * Integrates three External Memory Controllers: - Static Memory Controller - SDRAM Controller - SLC Nand Flash ECC Controller * Additional logic for NAND Flash and CompactFlashTM * Optional Full 32-bit External Data Bus * Up to 26-bit Address Bus (up to 64MBytes linear per chip select) * Up to 6 chips selects, Configurable Assignment: - Static Memory Controller on NCS0 - SDRAM Controller (SDCS) or Static Memory Controller on NCS1 - Static Memory Controller on NCS2 - Static Memory Controller on NCS3, Optional NAND Flash support - Static Memory Controller on NCS4 - NCS5, Optional CompactFlashM support
8.2.2
Static Memory Controller * 8-, 16- or 32-bit Data Bus * Multiple Access Modes supported - Byte Write or Byte Select Lines - Asynchronous read in Page Mode supported (4- up to 32-byte page size) * Multiple device adaptability - Control signals programmable setup, pulse and hold time for each Memory Bank * Multiple Wait State Management - Programmable Wait State Generation - External Wait Request - Programmable Data Float Time * Slow Clock mode supported
26
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
8.2.3 SDRAM Controller * Supported devices: - Standard and Low Power SDRAM (Mobile SDRAM) - 2K, 4K, 8K Row Address Memory Parts - SDRAM with two or four Internal Banks - SDRAM with 16- or 32-bit Data Path * Programming facilities - Word, half-word, byte access - Automatic page break when Memory Boundary has been reached - Multibank Ping-pong Access - Timing parameters specified by software - Automatic refresh operation, refresh rate is programmable * Energy-saving capabilities - Self-refresh, power down and deep power down modes supported * Error detection - Refresh Error Interrupt * SDRAM Power-up Initialization by software * SDRAM CAS Latency of 1, 2 and 3 supported * Auto Precharge Command not used 8.2.4 NAND Flash Error Corrected Code Controller * Tracking the accesses to a NAND Flash device by trigging on the corresponding chip select * Single bit error correction and 2-bit Random detection. * Automatic Hamming Code Calculation while writing - ECC value available in a register * Automatic Hamming Code Calculation while reading - Error Report, including error flag, correctable error flag and word address being detected erroneous - Support 8- or 16-bit NAND Flash devices with 512-, 1024-, 2048- or 4096-bytes pages
27
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
9. System Controller
The System Controller is a set of peripherals, which allow handling of key elements of the system, such as power, resets, clocks, time, interrupts, watchdog, etc. The System Controller User Interface embeds also the registers allowing to configure the Matrix and a set of registers configuring the EBI chip select assignment and the voltage range for external memories.
9.1
System Controller Mapping
As shown in Figure 8-1, the System Controller's peripherals are all mapped within the highest 16K bytes of the 4 Gbyte address space, between addresses 0xFFFF C000 and 0xFFFF FFFF. However, all the registers of System Controller are mapped on the top of the address space. This allows addressing all the registers of the System Controller from a single pointer by using the standard ARM instruction set, as the Load/Store instruction have an indexing mode of +/4kbytes.
28
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
9.2 Block Diagram
System Controller Block Diagram
System Controller VDDCORE Powered irq0-irq2 fiq periph_irq[2..24] pit_irq rtt_irq wdt_irq dbgu_irq pmc_irq rstc_irq MCK periph_nreset dbgu_rxd MCK debug periph_nreset SLCK debug idle proc_nreset Periodic Interval Timer Watchdog Timer wdt_fault WDRPROC rtt_alarm VDDCORE POR por_ntrst jtag_nreset Debug Unit Advanced Interrupt Controller int por_ntrst ntrst ARM926EJ-S nirq nfiq
Figure 9-1.
dbgu_irq dbgu_txd pit_irq
proc_nreset PCK debug
jtag_nreset wdt_irq MCK periph_nreset rstc_irq periph_nreset proc_nreset backup_nreset VDDBU Powered
Boundary Scan TAP Controller
Bus Matrix
NRST
Reset Controller
VDDBU
VDDBU POR SLCK Real-Time Clock Real-Time Timer rtc_irq rtc_alarm rtt_irq rtt_alarm HSCK periph_clk[22] Shutdown Controller 4 General-purpose Backup Registers SCKCR SLCK XIN XOUT int 12MHz MAIN OSC UPLL HSCK PLLRCA PLLA periph_nreset periph_nreset periph_nreset periph_clk[2..4] dbgu_rxd PA0-PA31 PB0-PB31 PC0-PC31 PD0-PD21 periph_irq[2..4] irq fiq dbgu_txd Embedded Peripherals periph_irq[6..24] in out enable PLLACK MAINCK PCK Power Management Controller MCK pmc_irq idle periph_clk[6..24] periph_nreset periph_irq[22] USB High Speed Device Port
SLCK backup_nreset SLCK backup_nreset SLCK SHDN WKUP backup_nreset rtc_alarm rtt_alarm
RC OSC XIN32 XOUT32 SLOW CLOCK OSC
periph_clk[2..24] pck[0-1]
PIO Controllers
29
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
9.3
Reset Controller
The Reset Controller is based on two Power-on-Reset cells, one on VDDBU and one on VDDCORE. The Reset Controller is capable to return to the software the source of the last reset, either a general reset (VDDBU rising), a wake-up reset (VDDCORE rising), a software reset, a user reset or a watchdog reset. The Reset Controller controls the internal resets of the system and the NRST pin output. It is capable to shape a reset signal for the external devices, simplifying to a minimum connection of a push-button on the NRST pin to implement a manual reset. The configuration of the Reset Controller is saved as supplied on VDDBU.
9.4
Shutdown Controller
The Shutdown Controller is supplied on VDDBU and allows a software-controllable shut down of the system through the pin SHDN. An input change of the WKUP pin or an alarm releases the SHDN pin, and thus wakes up the system power supply.
9.5
Clock Generator
The Clock Generator is made up of: * One low-power 32768 Hz Slow Clock Oscillator with bypass mode * One low-power RC oscillator * One 12 MHz Main Oscillator, which can be bypassed * One 480 MHz PLL (UPLL or PLLB) providing a clock for the USB High Speed Device Controller * One 80 to 240 MHz programmable PLL, providing the PLL Clock (PLLCK). This PLL has an input divider to offer a wider range of output frequencies from the 12 MHz input, the only limitation being the lowest input frequency shall be higher or equal to 1 MHz.
30
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 9-2. Clock Generator Block Diagram
Clock Generator RCEN On Chip RC OSC XIN32 XOUT32 Slow Clock Oscillator
Slow Clock SLCK OSCSEL OSC32EN OSC32BYP
XIN XOUT
12M Main Oscillator
Main Clock MAINCK
UPLL (PLLB) PLL and Divider
HSCK
PLLRCA
PLL Clock PLLCK
Status
Control
Power Management Controller
9.6
9.6.1
Slow Clock Selection
Description The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 slow clock can be generated either by an external 32768Hz crystal or the on-chip RC oscillator. The 32768Hz crystal oscillator can be bypassed to accept an external slow clock on XIN32. Configuration is located in the slow clock control register (SCKCR) located at address 0xFFFFFD50 in the backed up part of the system controller and so is preserved while VDDBU is present. Refer to the "Clock Generator" section for more details.
9.7
Power Management Controller
The Power Management Controller provides all the clock signals to the system. It provides: * the Processor Clock PCK * the Master Clock MCK, in particular to the Matrix and the memory interfaces * the USB Device HS Clock HSCK * independent peripheral clocks, typically at the frequency of MCK * two programmable clock outputs: PCK0 and PCK1 This allows the software control of five flexible operating modes: * Normal Mode, processor and peripherals running at a programmable frequency * Idle Mode, processor stopped waiting for an interrupt * Slow Clock Mode, processor and peripherals running at low frequency
31
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Standby Mode, mix of Idle and Backup Mode, peripheral running at low frequency, processor stopped waiting for an interrupt * Backup Mode, Main Power Supplies off, VDDBU powered by a battery Figure 9-3. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Power Management Controller Block Diagram
Processor Clock Controller Master Clock Controller
SLCK MAINCK PLLCK
PCK int
Idle Mode
MCK
Prescaler /1,/2,/4,...,/64 Peripherals Clock Controller ON/OFF
periph_clk[..]
Programmable Clock Controller ON/OFF Prescaler /1,/2,/4,...,/64
pck[..]
SLCK MAINCK PLLCK
9.8
Periodic Interval Timer
* Includes a 20-bit Periodic Counter, with less than 1 s accuracy * Includes a 12-bit Interval Overlay Counter * Real Time OS or Linux(R)/WindowsCE(R) compliant tick generator
9.9
Watchdog Timer
* 16-bit key-protected only-once-Programmable Counter * Windowed, prevents the processor to be in a dead-lock on the watchdog access
9.10
Real-Time Timer
* Real-Time Timer, allowing backup of time with different accuracies - 32-bit Free-running back-up Counter - Integrates a 16-bit programmable prescaler running on slow clock - Alarm Register capable to generate a wake-up of the system through the Shut Down Controller
9.11
Real-Time Clock
* Low power consumption * Full asynchronous design
32
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* Two hundred year calendar * Programmable Periodic Interrupt * Alarm and update parallel load * Control of alarm and update Time/Calendar Data In
9.12
General-Purpose Backed-up Registers
* Four 32-bit backup general-purpose registers
9.13
Advanced Interrupt Controller
* Controls the interrupt lines (nIRQ and nFIQ) of the ARM Processor * Thirty-two individually maskable and vectored interrupt sources - Source 0 is reserved for the Fast Interrupt Input (FIQ) - Source 1 is reserved for system peripherals (PIT, RTT, PMC, DBGU, etc.) - Programmable Edge-triggered or Level-sensitive Internal Sources - Programmable Positive/Negative Edge-triggered or High/Low Level-sensitive * One External Sources plus the Fast Interrupt signal * 8-level Priority Controller - Drives the Normal Interrupt of the processor - Handles priority of the interrupt sources 1 to 31 - Higher priority interrupts can be served during service of lower priority interrupt * Vectoring - Optimizes Interrupt Service Routine Branch and Execution - One 32-bit Vector Register per interrupt source - Interrupt Vector Register reads the corresponding current Interrupt Vector * Protect Mode - Easy debugging by preventing automatic operations when protect modeIs are enabled * Fast Forcing - Permits redirecting any normal interrupt source on the Fast Interrupt of the processor
9.14
Debug Unit
* Composed of two functions - Two-pin UART - Debug Communication Channel (DCC) support * Two-pin UART - Implemented features are 100% compatible with the standard Atmel USART - Independent receiver and transmitter with a common programmable Baud Rate Generator - Even, Odd, Mark or Space Parity Generation - Parity, Framing and Overrun Error Detection - Automatic Echo, Local Loopback and Remote Loopback Channel Modes 33
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- Support for two PDC channels with connection to receiver and transmitter * Debug Communication Channel Support - Offers visibility of and interrupt trigger from COMMRX and COMMTX signals from the ARM Processor's ICE Interface
9.15
Chip Identification
* Chip ID: 0x019B03A0 * JTAG ID: 0x05B2003F * ARM926 TAP ID: 0x0792603F
9.16
PIO Controllers
* 4 PIO Controllers, PIOA, PIOB, PIOC and PIOD, controlling a maximum of 118 I/O Lines * Each PIO Controller controls up to 32 programmable I/O Lines - PIOA has 32 I/O Lines - PIOB has 32 I/O Lines - PIOC has 32 I/O Lines - PIOD has 22 I/O Lines * Fully programmable through Set/Clear Registers * Multiplexing of two peripheral functions per I/O Line * For each I/O Line (whether assigned to a peripheral or used as general purpose I/O) - Input change interrupt - Glitch filter - Multi-drive option enables driving in open drain - Programmable pull up on each I/O line - Pin data status register, supplies visibility of the level on the pin at any time * Synchronous output, provides Set and Clear of several I/O lines in a single write
10. Peripherals
10.1 Peripheral Mapping
As shown in Figure 8-1, the Peripherals are mapped in the upper 256M bytes of the address space between the addresses 0xFFFA 0000 and 0xFFFC FFFF. Each User Peripheral is allocated 16K bytes of address space.
34
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
10.2 Peripheral Identifiers
The Table 10-1 defines the Peripheral Identifiers of the AT91SAM9R64/RL64. A peripheral identifier is required for the control of the peripheral interrupt with the Advanced Interrupt Controller and for the control of the peripheral clock with the Power Management Controller. Table 10-1. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Peripheral Identifiers
Peripheral Mnemonic AIC SYSC PIOA PIOB PIOC PIOD US0 US1 US2 US3 MCI TWI0 TWI1 SPI SSC0 SSC1 TC0 TC1 TC2 PWMC TSADCC DMAC UDPHS LCDC AC97 AIC Note: Peripheral Name Advanced Interrupt Controller System Controller Interrupt Parallel I/O Controller A, Parallel I/O Controller B Parallel I/O Controller C Parallel I/O Controller D USART 0 USART 1 USART 2 USART 3 Multimedia Card Interface Two-Wire Interface 0 Two-Wire Interface 1 Serial Peripheral Interface Synchronous Serial Controller 0 Synchronous Serial Controller 1 Timer Counter 0 Timer Counter 1 Timer Counter 2 Pulse Width Modulation Controller Touch Screen ADC Controller DMA Controller USB Device High Speed LCD Controller (AT91SAM9RL64 only) AC97 Controller Reserved Advanced Interrupt Controller IRQ External Interrupt FIQ
Peripheral ID 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25-30 31
Setting AIC, SYSIRQ, LCDC and IRQ bits in the clock set/clear registers of the PMC has no effect.
35
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
10.3
10.3.1
Peripheral Interrupts and Clock Control
System Interrupt The System Interrupt in Source 1 is the wired-OR of the interrupt signals coming from: * the SDRAM Controller * the Debug Unit * the Periodic Interval Timer * the Real-time Timer * the Real-time Clock * the Watchdog Timer * the Reset Controller * the Power Management Controller The clock of these peripherals cannot be deactivated and Peripheral ID 1 can only be used within the Advanced Interrupt Controller.
10.3.2
External Interrupts All external interrupt signals, i.e., the Fast Interrupt signal FIQ or the Interrupt signal IRQ, use a dedicated Peripheral ID. However, there is no clock control associated with these peripheral IDs.
10.4
Peripherals Signals Multiplexing on I/O Lines
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 features 4 PIO controllers, PIOA, PIOB, PIOC and PIOD, which multiplexes the I/O lines of the peripheral set. Each PIO Controller controls up to 32 lines. Each line can be assigned to one of two peripheral functions, A or B. The multiplexing tables in the following paragraphs define how the I/O lines of the peripherals A and B are multiplexed on the PIO Controllers. The two columns "Function" and "Comments" have been inserted in this table for the user's own comments; they may be used to track how pins are defined in an application. Note that some peripheral functions which are output only, might be duplicated within the both tables. The column "Reset State" indicates whether the PIO Line resets in I/O mode or in peripheral mode. If I/O is mentioned, the PIO Line resets in input with the pull-up enabled, so that the device is maintained in a static state as soon as the reset is released. As a result, the bit corresponding to the PIO Line in the register PIO_PSR (Peripheral Status Register) resets low. If a signal name is mentioned in the "Reset State" column, the PIO Line is assigned to this function and the corresponding bit in PIO_PSR resets high. This is the case for pins controlling memories, in particular the address lines, which require the pin to be driven as soon as the reset is released. Note that the pull-up resistor is also enabled in this case. The AT91SAM9RL64 and AT91SAM9R64 do not have the same peripheral signal multiplexing, each one follows.
36
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
10.4.1 10.4.1.1 Table 10-2. AT91SAM9RL64 PIO Multiplexing AT91SAM9RL64 PIO Controller A Multiplexing AT91SAM9RL64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller A
PIO Controller A I/O Line PA0 PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PA8 PA9 PA10 PA11 PA12 PA13 PA14 PA15 PA16 PA17 PA18 PA19 PA20 PA21 PA22 PA23 PA24 PA25 PA26 PA27 PA28 PA29 PA30 PA31 Peripheral A MC_DA0 MC_CDA MC_CK MC_DA1 MC_DA2 MC_DA3 TXD0 RXD0 SCK0 RTS0 CTS0 TXD1 RXD1 TXD2 RXD2 TD0 RD0 AD0 AD1 AD2 AD3 DRXD DTXD TWD0 TWCK0 MISO MOSI SPCK NPCS0 RTS2 CTS2 NWAIT TF1 TK1 IRQ RF0 RTS1 CTS1 SCK3 TD1 RD1 RF1 RK1 RK0 TCLK0 TIOA0 TIOB0 Peripheral B Reset State I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDANA VDDANA VDDANA VDDANA VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Application Usage Function Comments
37
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
10.4.1.2 Table 10-3.
AT91SAM9RL64 PIO Controller B Multiplexing AT91SAM9RL64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller B
PIO Controller B Application Usage Reset State I/O I/O A21 A22 I/O I/O I/O NPCS1 PWM0 PWM1 FIQ I/O I/O I/O A25 A18 A19 A20 PCK0 ADTRG A23 A24 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM Function Comments
I/O Line PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PB8 PB9 PB10 PB11 PB12 PB13 PB14 PB15 PB16 PB17 PB18 PB19 PB20 PB21 PB22 PB23 PB24 PB25 PB26 PB27 PB28 PB29 PB30 PB31
Peripheral A TXD3 RXD3 A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE NANDOE NANDWE NCS3/NANDCS NCS4/CFCS0 CFCE1 CFCE2 A25/CFRNW A18 A19 A20 A23 A24 D16 D17 D18 D19 D20 D21 D22 D23 D24 D25 D26 D27 D28 D29 D30 D31
Peripheral B
38
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
10.4.1.3 Table 10-4. AT91SAM9RL64 PIO Controller C Multiplexing AT91SAM9RL64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller C
PIO Controller C I/O Line PC0 PC1 PC2 PC3 PC4 PC5 PC6 PC7 PC8 PC9 PC10 PC11 PC12 PC13 PC14 PC15 PC16 PC17 PC18 PC19 PC20 PC21 PC22 PC23 PC24 PC25 PC26 PC27 PC28 PC29 PC30 PC31 Peripheral A TF0 TK0 LCDMOD LCDCC LCDVSYNC LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDDEN LCDD0 LCDD1 LCDD2 LCDD3 LCDD4 LCDD5 LCDD6 LCDD7 LCDD8 LCDD9 LCDD10 LCDD11 LCDD12 LCDD13 LCDD14 LCDD15 LCDD16 LCDD17 LCDD18 LCDD19 LCDD20 LCDD21 LCDD22 LCDD23 TIOA1 TIOB1 TCLK1 LCDD2 LCDD3 LCDD4 LCDD5 LCDD6 LCDD7 LCDD10 LCDD11 LCDD12 LCDD13 LCDD14 LCDD15 LCDD18 LCDD19 LCDD20 LCDD21 LCDD22 LCDD23 LCDPWR PWM0 PWM1 Peripheral B Reset State I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Application Usage Function Comments
39
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
10.4.1.4 Table 10-5.
AT91SAM9RL64 PIO Controller D Multiplexing AT91SAM9RL64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller D
PIO Controller D Application Usage Reset State I/O I/O SCK1 CTS3 RTS3 PWM2 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O PWM3 NPCS3 TIOA2 TIOB2 PCK1 NPCS3 PWM0 PWM1 PWM2 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDANA VDDANA VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Function Comments
I/O Line PD0 PD1 PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 PD6 PD7 PD8 PD9 PD10 PD11 PD12 PD13 PD14 PD15 PD16 PD17 PD18 PD19 PD20 PD21
Peripheral A NCS2 AC97_FS AC97_CK AC97_TX AC97_RX DTXD AD4 AD5 NPCS2 SCK2 TWD1 TWCK1 PWM2 NCS5/CFCS1 DSR0 DTR0 DCD0 RI0 PWM3 PCK0 PCK1 TCLK2
Peripheral B
Comments
40
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
10.4.2
Note:
AT91SAM9R64 PIO Multiplexing
In Table 10-6, Table 10-7, Table 10-8 and Table 10-9, shaded cells indicate I/O lines that are NOT available on the AT91SAM9R64.
10.4.2.1 Table 10-6.
AT91SAM9R64 PIO Controller A Multiplexing AT91SAM9R64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller A
PIO Controller A Application Usage Reset State I/O I/O I/O TCLK0 TIOA0 TIOB0 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O NA NA RK0 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O RTS1 CTS1 NA I/O RF0 I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O NA NA IRQ I/O VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Reserved Reserved I/O I/O VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Reserved Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP Reserved Reserved Function Comments
I/O Line PA0 PA1 PA2 PA3 PA4 PA5 PA6 PA7 PA8 PA9 PA10 PA11 PA12 PA13 PA14 PA15 PA16 PA17 PA18 PA19 PA20 PA21 PA22 PA23 PA24 PA25 PA26 PA27 PA28 PA29 PA30 PA31
Peripheral A MC_DA0 MC_CDA MC_CK MC_DA1 MC_DA2 MC_DA3 TXD0 RXD0 NA NA CTS0 TXD1 RXD1 TXD2 RXD2 TD0 RD0 AD0 AD1 AD2 NA DRXD DTXD TWD0 TWCK0 MISO MOSI SPCK NPCS0 NA NA NWAIT
Peripheral B
41
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
10.4.2.2 Table 10-7.
AT91SAM9R64 PIO Controller B Multiplexing AT91SAM9R64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller B
PIO Controller B Application Usage Reset State I/O I/O A21 A22 I/O I/O I/O NPCS1 PWM0 PWM1 FIQ I/O I/O I/O A25 A18 A19 A20 PCK0 ADTRG NA A23 A24 Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM VDDIOM Reserved Function Comments
I/O Line PB0 PB1 PB2 PB3 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PB8 PB9 PB10 PB11 PB12 PB13 PB14 PB15 PB16PB31
Peripheral A TXD3 RXD3 A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE NANDOE NANDWE NCS3/NANDCS NCS4/CFCS0 CFCE1 CFCE2 A25/CFRNW A18 A19 A20 A23 A24 NA
Peripheral B
42
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
10.4.2.3 Table 10-8. AT91SAM9R64 PIO Controller C Multiplexing AT91SAM9R64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller C
PIO Controller C I/O Line PC0 PC1 PC2PC31 Peripheral A TF0 TK0 NA NA Peripheral B Reset State I/O I/O Power Supply VDDIOP VDDIOP Reserved Application Usage Function Comments
10.4.2.4 Table 10-9.
AT91SAM9R64 PIO Controller D Multiplexing AT91SAM9R64 Multiplexing on PIO Controller D
PIO Controller D Application Usage Comments Reset State Power Supply Function Comments Reserved I/O I/O I/O I/O VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP VDDIOP
I/O Line PD0PD17 PD18 PD19 PD20 PD21
Peripheral A NA PWM3 PCK0 PCK1 TCLK2
Peripheral B NA
43
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
11. Embedded Peripherals Overview
11.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
* Supports communication with serial external devices - Four chip selects with external decoder support allow communication with up to 15 peripherals - Serial memories, such as DataFlash and 3-wire EEPROMs - Serial peripherals, such as ADCs, DACs, LCD Controllers, CAN Controllers and Sensors - External co-processors * Master or slave serial peripheral bus interface - 8- to 16-bit programmable data length per chip select - Programmable phase and polarity per chip select - Programmable transfer delays between consecutive transfers and between clock and data per chip select - Programmable delay between consecutive transfers - Selectable mode fault detection * Very fast transfers supported - Transfers with baud rates up to MCK - The chip select line may be left active to speed up transfers on the same device
11.2
Two-wire Interface (TWI)
* Compatibility with standard two-wire serial memory * One, two or three bytes for slave address * Sequential read/write operations * Supports either master or slave modes * Compatible with Standard Two-wire Serial Memories * Master, Multi-master and Slave Mode Operation * Bit Rate: Up to 400 Kbits * General Call Supported in Slave mode * Connection to Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) Channel Capabilities Optimizes Data Transfers in Master Mode Only - One Channel for the Receiver, One Channel for the Transmitter - Next Buffer Support
11.3
USART
* Programmable Baud Rate Generator * 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous or asynchronous serial communications - 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits in Asynchronous Mode or 1 or 2 stop bits in Synchronous Mode - Parity generation and error detection - Framing error detection, overrun error detection - MSB- or LSB-first
44
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- Optional break generation and detection - By 8 or by-16 over-sampling receiver frequency - Hardware handshaking RTS-CTS - Receiver time-out and transmitter timeguard - Optional Multi-drop Mode with address generation and detection - Optional Manchester Encoding * RS485 with driver control signal * ISO7816, T = 0 or T = 1 Protocols for interfacing with smart cards - NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit * IrDA modulation and demodulation - Communication at up to 115.2 Kbps * Test Modes - Remote Loopback, Local Loopback, Automatic Echo
11.4
Serial Synchronous Controller (SSC)
* Provides serial synchronous communication links used in audio and telecom applications (with CODECs in Master or Slave Modes, I2S, TDM Buses, Magnetic Card Reader, etc.) * Contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider * Offers a configurable frame sync and data length * Receiver and transmitter can be programmed to start automatically or on detection of different event on the frame sync signal * Receiver and transmitter include a data signal, a clock signal and a frame synchronization signal
11.5
AC97 Controller
* Compatible with AC97 Component Specification V2.2 * Capable to Interface with a Single Analog Front end * Three independent RX Channels and three independent TX Channels - One RX and one TX channel dedicated to the AC97 Analog Front end control - One RX and one TX channel for data transfers, associated with a PDC - One RX and one TX channel for data transfers with no PDC * Time Slot Assigner allowing to assign up to 12 time slots to a channel * Channels support mono or stereo up to 20 bit sample length - Variable sampling rate AC97 Codec Interface (48KHz and below)
11.6
Timer Counter (TC)
* Three 16-bit Timer Counter Channels * Wide range of functions including: - Frequency Measurement - Event Counting - Interval Measurement - Pulse Generation 45
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- Delay Timing - Pulse Width Modulation - Up/down Capabilities * Each channel is user-configurable and contains: - Three external clock inputs - Five internal clock inputs - Two multi-purpose input/output signals * Two global registers that act on all three TC Channels
11.7
Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM)
* 4 channels, one 16-bit counter per channel * Common clock generator, providing Thirteen Different Clocks - A Modulo n counter providing eleven clocks - Two independent Linear Dividers working on modulo n counter outputs * Independent channel programming - Independent Enable Disable Commands - Independent Clock Selection - Independent Period and Duty Cycle, with Double Bufferization - Programmable selection of the output waveform polarity - Programmable center or left aligned output waveform
11.8
Multimedia Card Interface (MCI)
* Compatibility with MultiMedia Card Specification Version 3.31 * Compatibility with SD Memory Card Specification Version 1.0 * Compatibility with SDIO Specification Version V1.1 * Cards clock rate up to Master Clock divided by 2 * Embedded power management to slow down clock rate when not used * MCI has one slot supporting - One MultiMediaCard bus (up to 30 cards) or - One SD Memory Card - One SDIO Card * Support for stream, block and multi-block data read and write
11.9
USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS)
* USB V2.0 high-speed compliant, 480 MBits per second * Embedded USB V2.0 UTMI+ high-speed transceiver * Embedded 4K-byte dual-port RAM for endpoints * Embedded 6 channels DMA controller * Suspend/Resume logic * Up to 3 banks for isochronous and bulk endpoints * Seven endpoints:
46
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- Endpoint 0: 64 bytes, 1 bank mode - Endpoint 1 & 2: 1024 bytes, 2 banks mode, HS isochronous capable, DMA - Endpoint 3 & 4: 1024bytes, 3 banks mode, DMA - Endpoint 5 & 6: 1024 bytes, 3 banks mode, HS isochronous capable, DMA
11.10 LCD Controller (LCDC)
* Single and Dual scan color and monochrome passive STN LCD panels supported * Single scan active TFT LCD panels supported. * 4-bit single scan, 8-bit single or dual scan, 16-bit dual scan STN interfaces supported * Up to 24-bit single scan TFT interfaces supported * Up to 16 gray levels for mono STN and up to 4096 colors for color STN displays * 1, 2 bits per pixel (palletized), 4 bits per pixel (non-palletized) for mono STN * 1, 2, 4, 8 bits per pixel (palletized), 16 bits per pixel (non-palletized) for color STN * 1, 2, 4, 8 bits per pixel (palletized), 16, 24 bits per pixel (non-palletized) for TFT * Single clock domain architecture * Resolution supported up to 2048x2048
11.11 Touch Screen Analog-to-digital Converter (TSADCC)
* 6-channel ADC * Support 4-wire resistive Touch Screen * 10-bit 384 Ksamples/sec. Successive Approximation Register ADC * -3/+3 LSB Integral Non Linearity, -2/+2 LSB Differential Non Linearity * Integrated 6-to-1 multiplexer, offering eight independent 3.3V analog inputs * External voltage reference for better accuracy on low voltage inputs * Individual enable and disable of each channel * Multiple trigger sources - Hardware or software trigger - External trigger pin - Timer Counter 0 to 2 outputs TIOA0 to TIOA2 trigger * Sleep Mode and conversion sequencer - Automatic wakeup on trigger and back to sleep mode after conversions of all enabled channels
47
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
48
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
12. ARM926EJ-S Processor Overview
12.1 Overview
The ARM926EJ-S processor is a member of the ARM9TM family of general-purpose microprocessors. The ARM926EJ-S implements ARM architecture version 5TEJ and is targeted at multitasking applications where full memory management, high performance, low die size and low power are all important features. The ARM926EJ-S processor supports the 32-bit ARM and 16-bit THUMB instruction sets, enabling the user to trade off between high performance and high code density. It also supports 8-bit Java instruction set and includes features for efficient execution of Java bytecode, providing a Java performance similar to a JIT (Just-In-Time compilers), for the next generation of Javapowered wireless and embedded devices. It includes an enhanced multiplier design for improved DSP performance. The ARM926EJ-S processor supports the ARM debug architecture and includes logic to assist in both hardware and software debug. The ARM926EJ-S provides a complete high performance processor subsystem, including: * an ARM9EJ-STM integer core * a Memory Management Unit (MMU) * separate instruction and data AMBA(R) AHB bus interfaces * separate instruction and data TCM interfaces
49
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
12.2
Block Diagram
Figure 12-1. ARM926EJ-S Internal Functional Block Diagram
ARM926EJ-S
TCM Interface Coprocessor Interface ETM Interface DEXT
Droute
Data AHB Interface
AHB
DCACHE Bus Interface Unit
WDATA
RDATA
ARM9EJ-S
DA
MMU
EmbeddedICE -RT
Processor
IA
Instruction AHB Interface
AHB
INSTR ICE Interface
ICACHE Iroute
IEXT
12.3
12.3.1
ARM9EJ-S Processor
ARM9EJ-S Operating States The ARM9EJ-S processor can operate in three different states, each with a specific instruction set: * ARM state: 32-bit, word-aligned ARM instructions. * THUMB state: 16-bit, halfword-aligned Thumb instructions. * Jazelle state: variable length, byte-aligned Jazelle instructions. In Jazelle state, all instruction Fetches are in words.
12.3.2
Switching State The operating state of the ARM9EJ-S core can be switched between: * ARM state and THUMB state using the BX and BLX instructions, and loads to the PC
50
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* ARM state and Jazelle state using the BXJ instruction All exceptions are entered, handled and exited in ARM state. If an exception occurs in Thumb or Jazelle states, the processor reverts to ARM state. The transition back to Thumb or Jazelle states occurs automatically on return from the exception handler. 12.3.3 Instruction Pipelines The ARM9EJ-S core uses two kinds of pipelines to increase the speed of the flow of instructions to the processor. A five-stage (five clock cycles) pipeline is used for ARM and Thumb states. It consists of Fetch, Decode, Execute, Memory and Writeback stages. A six-stage (six clock cycles) pipeline is used for Jazelle state It consists of Fetch, Jazelle/Decode (two clock cycles), Execute, Memory and Writeback stages. 12.3.4 Memory Access The ARM9EJ-S core supports byte (8-bit), half-word (16-bit) and word (32-bit) access. Words must be aligned to four-byte boundaries, half-words must be aligned to two-byte boundaries and bytes can be placed on any byte boundary. Because of the nature of the pipelines, it is possible for a value to be required for use before it has been placed in the register bank by the actions of an earlier instruction. The ARM9EJ-S control logic automatically detects these cases and stalls the core or forward data. 12.3.5 Jazelle Technology The Jazelle technology enables direct and efficient execution of Java byte codes on ARM processors, providing high performance for the next generation of Java-powered wireless and embedded devices. The new Java feature of ARM9EJ-S can be described as a hardware emulation of a JVM (Java Virtual Machine). Java mode will appear as another state: instead of executing ARM or Thumb instructions, it executes Java byte codes. The Java byte code decoder logic implemented in ARM9EJ-S decodes 95% of executed byte codes and turns them into ARM instructions without any overhead, while less frequently used byte codes are broken down into optimized sequences of ARM instructions. The hardware/software split is invisible to the programmer, invisible to the application and invisible to the operating system. All existing ARM registers are re-used in Jazelle state and all registers then have particular functions in this mode. Minimum interrupt latency is maintained across both ARM state and Java state. Since byte codes execution can be restarted, an interrupt automatically triggers the core to switch from Java state to ARM state for the execution of the interrupt handler. This means that no special provision has to be made for handling interrupts while executing byte codes, whether in hardware or in software. 12.3.6 ARM9EJ-S Operating Modes In all states, there are seven operation modes: * User mode is the usual ARM program execution state. It is used for executing most application programs * Fast Interrupt (FIQ) mode is used for handling fast interrupts. It is suitable for high-speed data transfer or channel process * Interrupt (IRQ) mode is used for general-purpose interrupt handling
51
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Supervisor mode is a protected mode for the operating system * Abort mode is entered after a data or instruction prefetch abort * System mode is a privileged user mode for the operating system * Undefined mode is entered when an undefined instruction exception occurs Mode changes may be made under software control, or may be brought about by external interrupts or exception processing. Most application programs execute in User Mode. The non-user modes, known as privileged modes, are entered in order to service interrupts or exceptions or to access protected resources. 12.3.7 ARM9EJ-S Registers The ARM9EJ-S core has a total of 37 registers: * 31 general-purpose 32-bit registers * 6 32-bit status registers Table 12-1 shows all the registers in all modes. Table 12-1.
User and System Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 R14 PC
ARM9TDMITM Modes and Registers Layout
Supervisor Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13_SVC R14_SVC PC Abort Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13_ABORT R14_ABORT PC Undefined Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13_UNDEF R14_UNDEF PC Interrupt Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13_IRQ R14_IRQ PC Fast Interrupt Mode R0 R1 R2 R3 R4 R5 R6 R7 R8_FIQ R9_FIQ R10_FIQ R11_FIQ R12_FIQ R13_FIQ R14_FIQ PC
CPSR
CPSR SPSR_SVC
CPSR SPSR_ABORT
CPSR SPSR_UNDEF
CPSR SPSR_IRQ
CPSR SPSR_FIQ
Mode-specific banked registers
The ARM state register set contains 16 directly-accessible registers, r0 to r15, and an additional register, the Current Program Status Register (CPSR). Registers r0 to r13 are general-purpose
52
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
registers used to hold either data or address values. Register r14 is used as a Link register that holds a value (return address) of r15 when BL or BLX is executed. Register r15 is used as a program counter (PC), whereas the Current Program Status Register (CPSR) contains condition code flags and the current mode bits. In privileged modes (FIQ, Supervisor, Abort, IRQ, Undefined), mode-specific banked registers (r8 to r14 in FIQ mode or r13 to r14 in the other modes) become available. The corresponding banked registers r14_fiq, r14_svc, r14_abt, r14_irq, r14_und are similarly used to hold the values (return address for each mode) of r15 (PC) when interrupts and exceptions arise, or when BL or BLX instructions are executed within interrupt or exception routines. There is another register called Saved Program Status Register (SPSR) that becomes available in privileged modes instead of CPSR. This register contains condition code flags and the current mode bits saved as a result of the exception that caused entry to the current (privileged) mode. In all modes and due to a software agreement, register r13 is used as stack pointer. The use and the function of all the registers described above should obey ARM Procedure Call Standard (APCS) which defines: * constraints on the use of registers * stack conventions * argument passing and result return The Thumb state register set is a subset of the ARM state set. The programmer has direct access to: * Eight general-purpose registers r0-r7 * Stack pointer, SP * Link register, LR (ARM r14) * PC * CPSR There are banked registers SPs, LRs and SPSRs for each privileged mode (for more details see the ARM9EJ-S Technical Reference Manual, ref. DDI0222B, revision r1p2 page 2-12). 12.3.7.1 Status Registers The ARM9EJ-S core contains one CPSR, and five SPSRs for exception handlers to use. The program status registers: * hold information about the most recently performed ALU operation * control the enabling and disabling of interrupts * set the processor operation mode
53
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 12-2. Status Register Format
31 30 29 28 27 24 765 0
NZCVQ
J
Reserved
I FT
Mode
Jazelle state bit Reserved Sticky Overflow Overflow Carry/Borrow/Extend Zero Negative/Less than
Mode bits Thumb state bit FIQ disable IRQ disable
Figure 12-2 shows the status register format, where: * N: Negative, Z: Zero, C: Carry, and V: Overflow are the four ALU flags * The Sticky Overflow (Q) flag can be set by certain multiply and fractional arithmetic instructions like QADD, QDADD, QSUB, QDSUB, SMLAxy, and SMLAWy needed to achieve DSP operations. The Q flag is sticky in that, when set by an instruction, it remains set until explicitly cleared by an MSR instruction writing to the CPSR. Instructions cannot execute conditionally on the status of the Q flag. * The J bit in the CPSR indicates when the ARM9EJ-S core is in Jazelle state, where: - J = 0: The processor is in ARM or Thumb state, depending on the T bit - J = 1: The processor is in Jazelle state. * Mode: five bits to encode the current processor mode 12.3.7.2 Exceptions Exception Types and Priorities
The ARM9EJ-S supports five types of exceptions. Each type drives the ARM9EJ-S in a privi-
leged mode. The types of exceptions are: * Fast interrupt (FIQ) * Normal interrupt (IRQ) * Data and Prefetched aborts (Abort) * Undefined instruction (Undefined) * Software interrupt and Reset (Supervisor) When an exception occurs, the banked version of R14 and the SPSR for the exception mode are used to save the state. More than one exception can happen at a time, therefore the ARM9EJ-S takes the arisen exceptions according to the following priority order: * Reset (highest priority) * Data Abort * FIQ * IRQ * Prefetch Abort * BKPT, Undefined instruction, and Software Interrupt (SWI) (Lowest priority) 54
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The BKPT, or Undefined instruction, and SWI exceptions are mutually exclusive. There is one exception in the priority scheme though, when FIQs are enabled and a Data Abort occurs at the same time as an FIQ, the ARM9EJ-S core enters the Data Abort handler, and proceeds immediately to FIQ vector. A normal return from the FIQ causes the Data Abort handler to resume execution. Data Aborts must have higher priority than FIQs to ensure that the transfer error does not escape detection. Exception Modes and Handling Exceptions arise whenever the normal flow of a program must be halted temporarily, for example, to service an interrupt from a peripheral. When handling an ARM exception, the ARM9EJ-S core performs the following operations: 1. Preserves the address of the next instruction in the appropriate Link Register that corresponds to the new mode that has been entered. When the exception entry is from: - ARM and Jazelle states, the ARM9EJ-S copies the address of the next instruction into LR (current PC(r15) + 4 or PC + 8 depending on the exception). - THUMB state, the ARM9EJ-S writes the value of the PC into LR, offset by a value (current PC + 2, PC + 4 or PC + 8 depending on the exception) that causes the program to resume from the correct place on return. 2. Copies the CPSR into the appropriate SPSR. 3. Forces the CPSR mode bits to a value that depends on the exception. 4. Forces the PC to fetch the next instruction from the relevant exception vector. The register r13 is also banked across exception modes to provide each exception handler with private stack pointer. The ARM9EJ-S can also set the interrupt disable flags to prevent otherwise unmanageable nesting of exceptions. When an exception has completed, the exception handler must move both the return value in the banked LR minus an offset to the PC and the SPSR to the CPSR. The offset value varies according to the type of exception. This action restores both PC and the CPSR. The fast interrupt mode has seven private registers r8 to r14 (banked registers) to reduce or remove the requirement for register saving which minimizes the overhead of context switching. The Prefetch Abort is one of the aborts that indicates that the current memory access cannot be completed. When a Prefetch Abort occurs, the ARM9EJ-S marks the prefetched instruction as invalid, but does not take the exception until the instruction reaches the Execute stage in the pipeline. If the instruction is not executed, for example because a branch occurs while it is in the pipeline, the abort does not take place. The breakpoint (BKPT) instruction is a new feature of ARM9EJ-S that is destined to solve the problem of the Prefetch Abort. A breakpoint instruction operates as though the instruction caused a Prefetch Abort. A breakpoint instruction does not cause the ARM9EJ-S to take the Prefetch Abort exception until the instruction reaches the Execute stage of the pipeline. If the instruction is not executed, for example because a branch occurs while it is in the pipeline, the breakpoint does not take place. 12.3.8 ARM Instruction Set Overview The ARM instruction set is divided into: * Branch instructions 55
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Data processing instructions * Status register transfer instructions * Load and Store instructions * Coprocessor instructions * Exception-generating instructions ARM instructions can be executed conditionally. Every instruction contains a 4-bit condition code field (bits[31:28]). Table 12-2 gives the ARM instruction mnemonic list. Table 12-2.
Mnemonic
MOV ADD SUB RSB CMP TST AND EOR MUL SMULL SMLAL MSR B BX LDR LDRSH LDRSB LDRH LDRB LDRBT LDRT LDM SWP MCR LDC CDP
ARM Instruction Mnemonic List
Operation
Move Add Subtract Reverse Subtract Compare Test Logical AND Logical Exclusive OR Multiply Sign Long Multiply Signed Long Multiply Accumulate Move to Status Register Branch Branch and Exchange Load Word Load Signed Halfword Load Signed Byte Load Half Word Load Byte Load Register Byte with Translation Load Register with Translation Load Multiple Swap Word Move To Coprocessor Load To Coprocessor Coprocessor Data Processing STRH STRB STRBT STRT STM SWPB MRC STC Store Half Word Store Byte Store Register Byte with Translation Store Register with Translation Store Multiple Swap Byte Move From Coprocessor Store From Coprocessor
Mnemonic
MVN ADC SBC RSC CMN TEQ BIC ORR MLA UMULL UMLAL MRS BL SWI STR
Operation
Move Not Add with Carry Subtract with Carry Reverse Subtract with Carry Compare Negated Test Equivalence Bit Clear Logical (inclusive) OR Multiply Accumulate Unsigned Long Multiply Unsigned Long Multiply Accumulate Move From Status Register Branch and Link Software Interrupt Store Word
56
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
12.3.9 New ARM Instruction Set . Table 12-3.
Mnemonic
BXJ BLX (1) SMLAxy SMLAL SMLAWy SMULxy SMULWy QADD QDADD QSUB QDSUB
New ARM Instruction Mnemonic List
Operation
Branch and exchange to Java Branch, Link and exchange Signed Multiply Accumulate 16 * 16 bit Signed Multiply Accumulate Long Signed Multiply Accumulate 32 * 16 bit Signed Multiply 16 * 16 bit Signed Multiply 32 * 16 bit Saturated Add Saturated Add with Double Saturated subtract Saturated Subtract with double
Mnemonic
MRRC MCR2 MCRR CDP2 BKPT PLD STRD STC2 LDRD LDC2 CLZ
Operation
Move double from coprocessor Alternative move of ARM reg to coprocessor Move double to coprocessor Alternative Coprocessor Data Processing Breakpoint Soft Preload, Memory prepare to load from address Store Double Alternative Store from Coprocessor Load Double Alternative Load to Coprocessor Count Leading Zeroes
Notes:
1. A Thumb BLX contains two consecutive Thumb instructions, and takes four cycles.
12.3.10
Thumb Instruction Set Overview The Thumb instruction set is a re-encoded subset of the ARM instruction set. The Thumb instruction set is divided into: * Branch instructions * Data processing instructions * Load and Store instructions * Load and Store multiple instructions * Exception-generating instruction Table 5 shows the Thumb instruction set. Table 12-4 gives the Thumb instruction mnemonic list. Table 12-4.
Mnemonic
MOV ADD SUB CMP TST AND
Thumb Instruction Mnemonic List
Operation
Move Add Subtract Compare Test Logical AND
Mnemonic
MVN ADC SBC CMN NEG BIC
Operation
Move Not Add with Carry Subtract with Carry Compare Negated Negate Bit Clear
57
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 12-4.
Mnemonic
EOR LSL ASR MUL B BX LDR LDRH LDRB LDRSH LDMIA PUSH BCC
Thumb Instruction Mnemonic List (Continued)
Operation
Logical Exclusive OR Logical Shift Left Arithmetic Shift Right Multiply Branch Branch and Exchange Load Word Load Half Word Load Byte Load Signed Halfword Load Multiple Push Register to stack Conditional Branch
Mnemonic
ORR LSR ROR BLX BL SWI STR STRH STRB LDRSB STMIA POP BKPT
Operation
Logical (inclusive) OR Logical Shift Right Rotate Right Branch, Link, and Exchange Branch and Link Software Interrupt Store Word Store Half Word Store Byte Load Signed Byte Store Multiple Pop Register from stack Breakpoint
12.4
CP15 Coprocessor
Coprocessor 15, or System Control Coprocessor CP15, is used to configure and control all the items in the list below: * ARM9EJ-S * Caches (ICache, DCache and write buffer) * TCM * MMU * Other system options To control these features, CP15 provides 16 additional registers. See Table 12-5.
Table 12-5.
Register 0 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 5 6 7
CP15 Registers
Name ID Code
(1)
Read/Write Read/Unpredictable Read/Unpredictable Read/Unpredictable Read/write Read/write Read/write None
(1) (1)
Cache type(1) TCM status Control Translation Table Base Domain Access Control Reserved Data fault Status
(1)
Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/Write
Instruction fault status Fault Address Cache Operations
58
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 12-5.
Register 8 9 9 10 11 12 13 13 14 15 Notes:
CP15 Registers
Name TLB operations cache lockdown TCM region TLB lockdown Reserved Reserved FCSE PID
(1) (2)
Read/Write Unpredictable/Write Read/write Read/write Read/write None None Read/write Read/Write None Read/Write
Context ID(1) Reserved Test configuration
1. Register locations 0,5, and 13 each provide access to more than one register. The register accessed depends on the value of the opcode_2 field. 2. Register location 9 provides access to more than one register. The register accessed depends on the value of the CRm field.
59
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
12.4.1
CP15 Registers Access CP15 registers can only be accessed in privileged mode by: * MCR (Move to Coprocessor from ARM Register) instruction is used to write an ARM register to CP15. * MRC (Move to ARM Register from Coprocessor) instruction is used to read the value of CP15 to an ARM register. Other instructions like CDP, LDC, STC can cause an undefined instruction exception. The assembler code for these instructions is:
MCR/MRC{cond} p15, opcode_1, Rd, CRn, CRm, opcode_2.
The MCR, MRC instructions bit pattern is shown below:
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
cond
23 22 21 20
1
19
1
18
1
17
0
16
opcode_1
15 14 13
L
12 11 10
CRn
9 8
Rd
7 6 5 4
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
0
opcode_2
1
CRm
* CRm[3:0]: Specified Coprocessor Action Determines specific coprocessor action. Its value is dependent on the CP15 register used. For details, refer to CP15 specific register behavior. * opcode_2[7:5] Determines specific coprocessor operation code. By default, set to 0. * Rd[15:12]: ARM Register Defines the ARM register whose value is transferred to the coprocessor. If R15 is chosen, the result is unpredictable. * CRn[19:16]: Coprocessor Register Determines the destination coprocessor register. * L: Instruction Bit 0 = MCR instruction 1 = MRC instruction * opcode_1[23:20]: Coprocessor Code Defines the coprocessor specific code. Value is c15 for CP15. * cond [31:28]: Condition For more details, see Chapter 2 in ARM926EJ-S TRM, ref. DDI0198B.
60
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
12.5 Memory Management Unit (MMU)
The ARM926EJ-S processor implements an enhanced ARM architecture v5 MMU to provide virtual memory features required by operating systems like Symbian OS(R), WindowsCE, and Linux. These virtual memory features are memory access permission controls and virtual to physical address translations. The Virtual Address generated by the CPU core is converted to a Modified Virtual Address (MVA) by the FCSE (Fast Context Switch Extension) using the value in CP15 register13. The MMU translates modified virtual addresses to physical addresses by using a single, two-level page table set stored in physical memory. Each entry in the set contains the access permissions and the physical address that correspond to the virtual address. The first level translation tables contain 4096 entries indexed by bits [31:20] of the MVA. These entries contain a pointer to either a 1 MB section of physical memory along with attribute information (access permissions, domain, etc.) or an entry in the second level translation tables; coarse table and fine table. The second level translation tables contain two subtables, coarse table and fine table. An entry in the coarse table contains a pointer to both large pages and small pages along with access permissions. An entry in the fine table contains a pointer to large, small and tiny pages. Table 7 shows the different attributes of each page in the physical memory. Table 12-6. Mapping Details
Mapping Size 1M byte 64K bytes 4K bytes 1K byte Access Permission By Section 4 separated subpages 4 separated subpages Tiny Page Subpage Size 16K bytes 1K byte -
Mapping Name Section Large Page Small Page Tiny Page
The MMU consists of: * Access control logic * Translation Look-aside Buffer (TLB) * Translation table walk hardware 12.5.1 Access Control Logic The access control logic controls access information for every entry in the translation table. The access control logic checks two pieces of access information: domain and access permissions. The domain is the primary access control mechanism for a memory region; there are 16 of them. It defines the conditions necessary for an access to proceed. The domain determines whether the access permissions are used to qualify the access or whether they should be ignored. The second access control mechanism is access permissions that are defined for sections and for large, small and tiny pages. Sections and tiny pages have a single set of access permissions whereas large and small pages can be associated with 4 sets of access permissions, one for each subpage (quarter of a page).
61
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
12.5.2
Translation Look-aside Buffer (TLB) The Translation Look-aside Buffer (TLB) caches translated entries and thus avoids going through the translation process every time. When the TLB contains an entry for the MVA (Modified Virtual Address), the access control logic determines if the access is permitted and outputs the appropriate physical address corresponding to the MVA. If access is not permitted, the MMU signals the CPU core to abort. If the TLB does not contain an entry for the MVA, the translation table walk hardware is invoked to retrieve the translation information from the translation table in physical memory.
12.5.3
Translation Table Walk Hardware The translation table walk hardware is a logic that traverses the translation tables located in physical memory, gets the physical address and access permissions and updates the TLB. The number of stages in the hardware table walking is one or two depending whether the address is marked as a section-mapped access or a page-mapped access. There are three sizes of page-mapped accesses and one size of section-mapped access. Pagemapped accesses are for large pages, small pages and tiny pages. The translation process always begins with a level one fetch. A section-mapped access requires only a level one fetch, but a page-mapped access requires an additional level two fetch. For further details on the MMU, please refer to chapter 3 in ARM926EJ-S Technical Reference Manual, ref. DDI0198B.
12.5.4
MMU Faults The MMU generates an abort on the following types of faults: * Alignment faults (for data accesses only) * Translation faults * Domain faults * Permission faults The access control mechanism of the MMU detects the conditions that produce these faults. If the fault is a result of memory access, the MMU aborts the access and signals the fault to the CPU core.The MMU retains status and address information about faults generated by the data accesses in the data fault status register and fault address register. It also retains the status of faults generated by instruction fetches in the instruction fault status register. The fault status register (register 5 in CP15) indicates the cause of a data or prefetch abort, and the domain number of the aborted access when it happens. The fault address register (register 6 in CP15) holds the MVA associated with the access that caused the Data Abort. For further details on MMU faults, please refer to chapter 3 in ARM926EJ-S Technical Reference Manual, ref. DDI0198B.
12.6
Caches and Write Buffer
The ARM926EJ-S contains a 4 KB Instruction Cache (ICache), a 4 KB Data Cache (DCache), and a write buffer. Although the ICache and DCache share common features, each still has some specific mechanisms. The caches (ICache and DCache) are four-way set associative, addressed, indexed and tagged using the Modified Virtual Address (MVA), with a cache line length of eight words with two dirty bits for the DCache. The ICache and DCache provide mechanisms for cache lockdown, cache pollution control, and line replacement.
62
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
A new feature is now supported by ARM926EJ-S caches called allocate on read-miss commonly known as wrapping. This feature enables the caches to perform critical word first cache refilling. This means that when a request for a word causes a read-miss, the cache performs an AHB access. Instead of loading the whole line (eight words), the cache loads the critical word first, so the processor can reach it quickly, and then the remaining words, no matter where the word is located in the line. The caches and the write buffer are controlled by the CP15 register 1 (Control), CP15 register 7 (cache operations) and CP15 register 9 (cache lockdown). 12.6.1 Instruction Cache (ICache) The ICache caches fetched instructions to be executed by the processor. The ICache can be enabled by writing 1 to I bit of the CP15 Register 1 and disabled by writing 0 to this same bit. When the MMU is enabled, all instruction fetches are subject to translation and permission checks. If the MMU is disabled, all instructions fetches are cachable, no protection checks are made and the physical address is flat-mapped to the modified virtual address. With the MVA use disabled, context switching incurs ICache cleaning and/or invalidating. When the ICache is disabled, all instruction fetches appear on external memory (AHB) (see Tables 4-1 and 4-2 in page 4-4 in ARM926EJ-S TRM, ref. DDI0198B). On reset, the ICache entries are invalidated and the ICache is disabled. For best performance, ICache should be enabled as soon as possible after reset. 12.6.2 Data Cache (DCache) and Write Buffer ARM926EJ-S includes a DCache and a write buffer to reduce the effect of main memory bandwidth and latency on data access performance. The operations of DCache and write buffer are closely connected. DCache The DCache needs the MMU to be enabled. All data accesses are subject to MMU permission and translation checks. Data accesses that are aborted by the MMU do not cause linefills or data accesses to appear on the AMBA ASB interface. If the MMU is disabled, all data accesses are noncachable, nonbufferable, with no protection checks, and appear on the AHB bus. All addresses are flat-mapped, VA = MVA = PA, which incurs DCache cleaning and/or invalidating every time a context switch occurs. The DCache stores the Physical Address Tag (PA Tag) from which every line was loaded and uses it when writing modified lines back to external memory. This means that the MMU is not involved in write-back operations. Each line (8 words) in the DCache has two dirty bits, one for the first four words and the other one for the second four words. These bits, if set, mark the associated half-lines as dirty. If the cache line is replaced due to a linefill or a cache clean operation, the dirty bits are used to decide whether all, half or none is written back to memory. DCache can be enabled or disabled by writing either 1 or 0 to bit C in register 1 of CP15 (see Tables 4-3 and 4-4 on page 4-5 in ARM926EJ-S TRM, ref. DDI0222B). The DCache supports write-through and write-back cache operations, selected by memory region using the C and B bits in the MMU translation tables.
12.6.2.1
63
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The DCache contains an eight data word entry, single address entry write-back buffer used to hold write-back data for cache line eviction or cleaning of dirty cache lines. The Write Buffer can hold up to 16 words of data and four separate addresses. DCache and Write Buffer operations are closely connected as their configuration is set in each section by the page descriptor in the MMU translation table. 12.6.2.2 Write Buffer The ARM926EJ-S contains a write buffer that has a 16-word data buffer and a four- address buffer. The write buffer is used for all writes to a bufferable region, write-through region and writeback region. It also allows to avoid stalling the processor when writes to external memory are performed. When a store occurs, data is written to the write buffer at core speed (high speed). The write buffer then completes the store to external memory at bus speed (typically slower than the core speed). During this time, the ARM9EJ-S processor can preform other tasks. DCache and Write Buffer support write-back and write-through memory regions, controlled by C and B bits in each section and page descriptor within the MMU translation tables. Write-though Operation When a cache write hit occurs, the DCache line is updated. The updated data is then written to the write buffer which transfers it to external memory. When a cache write miss occurs, a line, chosen by round robin or another algorithm, is stored in the write buffer which transfers it to external memory. Write-back Operation When a cache write hit occurs, the cache line or half line is marked as dirty, meaning that its contents are not up-to-date with those in the external memory. When a cache write miss occurs, a line, chosen by round robin or another algorithm, is stored in the write buffer which transfers it to external memory.
12.7
12.7.1
Tightly-Coupled Memory Interface
TCM Description The ARM926EJ-S processor features a Tightly-Coupled Memory (TCM) interface, which enables separate instruction and data TCMs (ITCM and DTCM) to be directly reached by the processor. TCMs are used to store real-time and performance critical code, they also provide a DMA support mechanism. Unlike AHB accesses to external memories, accesses to TCMs are fast and deterministic and do not incur bus penalties. The user has the possibility to independently configure each TCM size with values within the following ranges, [0KB, 32 KB] for ITCM size and [0KB, 32 KB] for DTCM size. TCMs can be configured by two means: HMATRIX TCM register and TCM region register (register 9) in CP15 and both steps should be performed. HMATRIX TCM register sets TCM size whereas TCM region register (register 9) in CP15 maps TCMs and enables them. The data side of the ARM9EJ-S core is able to access the ITCM. This is necessary to enable code to be loaded into the ITCM, for SWI and emulated instruction handlers, and for accesses to PC-relative literal pools.
64
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
12.7.2 Enabling and Disabling TCMs Prior to any enabling step, the user should configure the TCM sizes in HMATRIX TCM register. Then enabling TCMs is performed by using TCM region register (register 9) in CP15. The user should use the same sizes as those put in HMATRIX TCM register. For further details and programming tips, please refer to chapter 2.3 in ARM926EJ-S TRM, ref. DDI0222B. TCM Mapping The TCMs can be located anywhere in the memory map, with a single region available for ITCM and a separate region available for DTCM. The TCMs are physically addressed and can be placed anywhere in physical address space. However, the base address of a TCM must be aligned to its size, and the DTCM and ITCM regions must not overlap. TCM mapping is performed by using TCM region register (register 9) in CP15. The user should input the right mapping address for TCMs.
12.7.3
12.8
Bus Interface Unit
The ARM926EJ-S features a Bus Interface Unit (BIU) that arbitrates and schedules AHB requests. The BIU implements a multi-layer AHB, based on the AHB-Lite protocol, that enables parallel access paths between multiple AHB masters and slaves in a system. This is achieved by using a more complex interconnection matrix and gives the benefit of increased overall bus bandwidth, and a more flexible system architecture. The multi-master bus architecture has a number of benefits: * It allows the development of multi-master systems with an increased bus bandwidth and a flexible architecture. * Each AHB layer becomes simple because it only has one master, so no arbitration or masterto-slave muxing is required. AHB layers, implementing AHB-Lite protocol, do not have to support request and grant, nor do they have to support retry and split transactions. * The arbitration becomes effective when more than one master wants to access the same slave simultaneously.
12.8.1
Supported Transfers The ARM926EJ-S processor performs all AHB accesses as single word, bursts of four words, or bursts of eight words. Any ARM9EJ-S core request that is not 1, 4, 8 words in size is split into packets of these sizes. Note that the Atmel bus is AHB-Lite protocol compliant, hence it does not support split and retry requests.
65
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 8 gives an overview of the supported transfers and different kinds of transactions they are used for. Table 12-7.
HBurst[2:0]
Supported Transfers
Description Single transfer of word, half word, or byte:
* data write (NCNB, NCB, WT, or WB that has missed in DCache)
SINGLE Single transfer
* data read (NCNB or NCB) * NC instruction fetch (prefetched and non-prefetched) * page table walk read
Half-line cache write-back, Instruction prefetch, if enabled. Four-word burst NCNB, NCB, WT, or WB write. Full-line cache write-back, eight-word burst NCNB, NCB, WT, or WB write. Cache linefill
INCR4 INCR8 WRAP8
Four-word incrementing burst Eight-word incrementing burst Eight-word wrapping burst
12.8.2
Thumb Instruction Fetches All instructions fetches, regardless of the state of ARM9EJ-S core, are made as 32-bit accesses on the AHB. If the ARM9EJ-S is in Thumb state, then two instructions can be fetched at a time. Address Alignment The ARM926EJ-S BIU performs address alignment checking and aligns AHB addresses to the necessary boundary. 16-bit accesses are aligned to halfword boundaries, and 32-bit accesses are aligned to word boundaries.
12.8.3
66
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
13. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Debug and Test
13.1 Description
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 features a number of complementary debug and test capabilities. A common JTAG/ICE (In-Circuit Emulator) port is used for standard debugging functions, such as downloading code and single-stepping through programs. The Debug Unit provides a two-pin UART that can be used to upload an application into internal SRAM. It manages the interrupt handling of the internal COMMTX and COMMRX signals that trace the activity of the Debug Communication Channel. A set of dedicated debug and test input/output pins gives direct access to these capabilities from a PC-based test environment.
67
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
13.2
Block Diagram
Figure 13-1. Debug and Test Block Diagram
TMS TCK TDI
NTRST Boundary Port ICE/JTAG TAP JTAGSEL TDO
RTCK
Reset and Test
POR TST
ARM9EJ-S
ICE-RT
ARM926EJ-S
PDC
DBGU
PIO
DTXD DRXD
TAP: Test Access Port
68
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
13.3
13.3.1
Application Examples
Debug Environment Figure 13-2 on page 69 shows a complete debug environment example. The ICE/JTAG interface is used for standard debugging functions, such as downloading code and single-stepping through the program. The Trace Port interface is used for tracing information. A software debugger running on a personal computer provides the user interface for configuring a Trace Port interface utilizing the ICE/JTAG interface.
Figure 13-2. Application Debug and Trace Environment Example
Host Debugger ICE/JTAG Interface
ICE/JTAG Connector
AT91SAM9RL
RS232 Connector
Terminal
AT91SAM9RLbased Application
13.3.2
Test Environment Figure 13-3 on page 69 shows a test environment example. Test vectors are sent and interpreted by the tester. In this example, the "board in test" is designed using a number of JTAGcompliant devices. These devices can be connected to form a single scan chain.
Figure 13-3. Application Test Environment Example
Test Adaptor
Tester
JTAG Interface
ICE/JTAG Connector
Chip n
Chip 2
AT91SAM9RL
Chip 1
AT91SAM9RL-based Application Board In Test
69
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
13.4 Debug and Test Pin Description
Table 13-1.
Pin Name
Debug and Test Pin List
Function Reset/Test Type Active Level
NTRST NRST TST
Test Reset Signal Microcontroller Reset Test Mode Select ICE and JTAG
Input Input/Output Input
Low Low High
TCK TDI TDO TMS RTCK JTAGSEL
Test Clock Test Data In Test Data Out Test Mode Select Returned Test Clock JTAG Selection Debug Unit
Input Input Output Input Output Input
DRXD DTXD
Debug Receive Data Debug Transmit Data
Input Output
13.5
13.5.1
Functional Description
Test Pin One dedicated pin, TST, is used to define the device operating mode. The user must make sure that this pin is tied at low level to ensure normal operating conditions. Other values associated with this pin are reserved for manufacturing test.
13.5.2
Embedded In-circuit Emulator The ARM9EJ-S Embedded In-Circuit Emulator-RT is supported via the ICE/JTAG port. It is connected to a host computer via an ICE interface. Debug support is implemented using an ARM9EJ-S core embedded within the ARM926EJ-S. The internal state of the ARM926EJ-S is examined through an ICE/JTAG port which allows instructions to be serially inserted into the pipeline of the core without using the external data bus. Therefore, when in debug state, a storemultiple (STM) can be inserted into the instruction pipeline. This exports the contents of the ARM9EJ-S registers. This data can be serially shifted out without affecting the rest of the system. There are two scan chains inside the ARM9EJ-S processor which support testing, debugging, and programming of the Embedded ICE-RTTM. The scan chains are controlled by the ICE/JTAG port. Embedded ICE mode is selected when JTAGSEL is low. It is not possible to switch directly between ICE and JTAG operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed. For further details on the Embedded In-Circuit-Emulator-RT, see the ARM document: ARM9EJ-S Technical Reference Manual (DDI 0222A).
70
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
13.5.3 JTAG Signal Description TMS is the Test Mode Select input which controls the transitions of the test interface state machine. TDI is the Test Data Input line which supplies the data to the JTAG registers (Boundary Scan Register, Instruction Register, or other data registers). TDO is the Test Data Output line which is used to serially output the data from the JTAG registers to the equipment controlling the test. It carries the sampled values from the boundary scan chain (or other JTAG registers) and propagates them to the next chip in the serial test circuit. NTRST (optional in IEEE Standard 1149.1) is a Test-ReSeT input which is mandatory in ARM cores and used to reset the debug logic. On Atmel ARM926EJ-S-based cores, NTRST is a Power On Reset output. It is asserted on power on. If necessary, the user can also reset the debug logic with the NTRST pin assertion during 2.5 MCK periods. TCK is the Test ClocK input which enables the test interface. TCK is pulsed by the equipment controlling the test and not by the tested device. It can be pulsed at any frequency. Note the maximum JTAG clock rate on ARM926EJ-S cores is 1/6th the clock of the CPU. This gives 5.45 kHz maximum initial JTAG clock rate for an ARM9E running from the 32.768 kHz slow clock. RTCK is the Return Test Clock. Not an IEEE Standard 1149.1 signal added for a better clock handling by emulators. From some ICE Interface probes, this return signal can be used to synchronize the TCK clock and take not care about the given ratio between the ICE Interface clock and system clock equal to 1/6th. This signal is only available in JTAG ICE Mode and not in boundary scan mode. 13.5.4 Debug Unit The Debug Unit provides a two-pin (DXRD and TXRD) USART that can be used for several debug and trace purposes and offers an ideal means for in-situ programming solutions and debug monitor communication. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller channels permits packet handling of these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum. The Debug Unit also manages the interrupt handling of the COMMTX and COMMRX signals that come from the ICE and that trace the activity of the Debug Communication Channel.The Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ICE interface. A specific register, the Debug Unit Chip ID Register, gives information about the product version and its internal configuration. The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Debug Unit Chip ID value is 0x0196 07A0 on 32-bit width. For further details on the Debug Unit, see the Debug Unit section. 13.5.5 IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan allows pin-level access independent of the device packaging technology. IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Boundary Scan is enabled when JTAGSEL is high. The SAMPLE, EXTEST and BYPASS functions are implemented. In ICE debug mode, the ARM processor responds with a non-JTAG chip ID that identifies the processor to the ICE system. This is not IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-compliant. It is not possible to switch directly between JTAG and ICE operations. A chip reset must be performed after JTAGSEL is changed.
71
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
A Boundary-scan Descriptor Language (BSDL) file is provided to set up test. 13.5.6 ID Code Register Access: Read-only
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24
VERSION
23 22 21 20 19
PART NUMBER
18 17 16
PART NUMBER
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
PART NUMBER
7 6 5 4 3
MANUFACTURER IDENTITY
2 1 0
MANUFACTURER IDENTITY
1
* MANUFACTURER IDENTITY[11:1] Set to 0x01F. Bit[0] Required by IEEE Std. 1149.1. Set to 0x1. JTAG ID Code value is 0x05B2_003F. * PART NUMBER[27:12]: Product Part Number Product part Number is 0x5B20. * VERSION[31:28]: Product Version Number Set to 0x0.
72
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
14. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Boot Program
14.1 Description
The Boot Program integrates different programs that manage download and/or upload into the different memories of the product. First, it initializes the Debug Unit serial port (DBGU) and the USB High Speed Device Port. Then the SD Card Boot program is executed. It looks for a boot.bin file in the root directory of a FAT12/16/32 formatted SD Card. If such a file is found, code is downloaded into the internal SRAM. This is followed by a remap and a jump to the first address of the SRAM. If the SD Card is not formatted or if boot.bin file is not found, NAND Flash Boot program is then executed. The NAND Flash Boot program searches for a valid application in the NAND Flash memory. If a valid application is found, this application is loaded into internal SRAM and executed by branching at address 0x0000_0000 after remap. See "DataFlash Boot" on page 75 for more information on Valid Image Detection. If no valid ARM vector sequence is found, the DataFlash Boot program is then executed. It looks for a sequence of seven valid ARM exception vectors in a DataFlash connected to the SPI. All these vectors must be B-branch or LDR load register instructions except for the sixth vector. This vector is used to store the size of the image to download. If a valid sequence is found, code is downloaded into the internal SRAM. This is followed by a remap and a jump to the first address of the SRAM. If no valid ARM vector sequence is found, SAM-BA Boot is then executed. It waits for transactions either on the USB device, or on the DBGU serial port.
14.2
Flow Diagram
The Boot Program implements the algorithm in Figure 14-1.
73
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 14-1. Boot Program Algorithm Flow Diagram
Device Setup
SD Card Boot
Yes
Download from SD Card (MCI)
Run
SD Card Boot
No
Timeout < 1 s
NandFlash Boot
Yes
Download from NandFlash
Run
NandFlash Boot
No
Timeout < 1 s
SPI DataFlash Boot
Yes
Download from DataFlash (NPCS0)
Run
DataFlash Boot
No
Timeout < 1 s
No
USB Enumeration Successful ?
No
Character(s) received on DBGU ? SAM-BA Boot
Yes Run SAM-BA Boot
Yes Run SAM-BA Boot
14.3
Device Initialization
Initialization follows the steps described below: 1. Stack setup for ARM supervisor mode 2. Main Oscillator Frequency Detection 3. C variable initialization 4. UTMI PLL is enabled to generate a 480MHz clock necessary to use the USB High Speed Device. 5. PLL setup: PLL is initialized to generate a 96 MHz clock.
Note: A 12 MHz Crystal is mandatory in order to generate these clocks correctly.
6. MCK is configured to generate a 48MHz clock (PLL/2). 7. Initialization of the DBGU serial port (115200 bauds, 8, N, 1) 8. Enable the user reset
74
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
9. Jump to SD Card Boot sequence. If SD Card Boot succeeds, perform a remap and jump to 0x0. 10. Jump to NAND Flash Boot sequence. If NAND Flash Boot succeeds, perform a remap and jump to 0x0. 11. Jump to DataFlash Boot sequence through NPCS0. If DataFlash Boot succeeds, perform a remap and jump to 0x0. 12. Activation of the Instruction Cache 13. Jump to SAM-BA Boot sequence 14. Disable the WatchDog 15. Initialization of the USB Device Port Figure 14-2. Remap Action after Download Completion
0x0000_0000 Internal ROM REMAP 0x0030_0000 Internal SRAM Internal ROM 0x0010_0000 Internal SRAM 0x0000_0000
14.4
DataFlash Boot
The DataFlash Boot program searches for a valid application in the SPI DataFlash memory. If a valid application is found, this application is loaded into internal SRAM and executed by branching at address 0x0000_0000 after remap. This application may be the application code or a second-level bootloader. All the calls to functions are PC relative and do not use absolute addresses.
After reset, the code in internal ROM is mapped at both addresses 0x0000_0000 and 0x0040_0000:
400000 400004 400008 40000c 400010 400014 400018 ea000006 eafffffe ea00002f eafffffe eafffffe eafffffe eafffffe B B B B B B B 0x20 0x04 _main 0x0c 0x10 0x14 0x18 00ea000006B0x20 04eafffffeB0x04 08ea00002fB_main 0ceafffffeB0x0c 10eafffffeB0x10 14eafffffeB0x14 18eafffffeB0x18
14.4.1
Valid Image Detection The DataFlash Boot software looks for a valid application by analyzing the first 28 bytes corresponding to the ARM exception vectors. These bytes must implement ARM instructions for either branch or load PC with PC relative addressing. The sixth vector, at offset 0x14, contains the size of the image to download. The user must replace this vector with his own vector (see "Structure of ARM Vector 6" on page 76).
75
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 14-3. LDR Opcode
31 1 1 1 28 27 0 1 1 I 24 23 P U 1 W 20 19 0 Rn 16 15 Rd 12 11 0
Figure 14-4. B Opcode
31 1 1 1 28 27 0 1 0 1 24 23 0 Offset (24 bits) 0
Unconditional instruction: 0xE for bits 31 to 28 Load PC with PC relative addressing instruction: - Rn = Rd = PC = 0xF - I==1 - P==1 - U offset added (U==1) or subtracted (U==0) - W==1 14.4.2 Structure of ARM Vector 6 The ARM exception vector 6 is used to store information needed by the DataFlash boot program. This information is described below.
Figure 14-5. Structure of the ARM Vector 6
31 Size of the code to download in bytes 0
14.4.2.1
Example An example of valid vectors follows:
00 04 08 0c 10 14 18 ea000006 eafffffe ea00002f eafffffe eafffffe 00001234 eafffffe B 0x18 B B B B B 0x20 0x04 _main 0x0c 0x10
<- Code size = 4660 bytes
The size of the image to load into SRAM is contained in the location of the sixth ARM vector. Thus the user must replace this vector by the correct vector for his application. 14.4.3 DataFlash Boot Sequence The DataFlash boot program performs device initialization followed by the download procedure.
76
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The DataFlash boot program supports all Atmel DataFlash devices. Table 14-1 summarizes the parameters to include in the ARM vector 6 for all devices. Table 14-1.
Device AT45DB011 AT45DB021 AT45DB041 AT45DB081 AT45DB161 AT45DB321 AT45DB642
DataFlash Device
Density 1 Mbit 2 Mbits 4 Mbits 8 Mbits 16 Mbits 32 Mbits 64 Mbits Page Size (bytes) 264 264 264 264 528 528 1056 Number of Pages 512 1024 2048 4096 4096 8192 8192
The DataFlash has a Status Register that determines all the parameters required to access the device. The DataFlash boot is configured to be compatible with the future design of the DataFlash.
77
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 14-6. Serial DataFlash Download
Start
Send status command
Is status OK ?
No
Jump to next boot solution
Yes Read the first 7 instructions (28 bytes). Decode the sixth ARM vector
7 vectors (except vector 6) are LDR or Branch instruction
No
Yes Read the DataFlash into the internal SRAM. (code size to read in vector 6)
Restore the reset value for the peripherals. Set the PC to 0 and perform the REMAP to jump to the downloaded application
End
14.5
SD Card Boot
Boot ROM does not support high-capacity SDCards. The SD Card Boot program searches for a valid application in the SD Card memory. It looks for a boot.bin file in the root directory of a FAT12/16/32 formatted SD Card. If a valid file is found, this application is loaded into internal SRAM and executed by branching at address 0x0000_0000 after remap. This application may be the application code or a second-level bootloader.
14.6
NAND Flash Boot
The NAND Flash Boot program searches for a valid application in the NAND Flash memory. If a valid application is found, this application is loaded into internal SRAM and executed by branch-
78
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
ing at address 0x0000_0000 after remap. See "DataFlash Boot" on page 75 for more information on Valid Image Detection. 14.6.1 Supported NAND Flash Devices Any 8 or 16-bit NAND Flash devices.
14.7
SAM-BA Boot
If no valid DataFlash device has been found during the DataFlash boot sequence, the SAM-BA boot program is performed. The SAM-BA boot principle is to: - Check if USB High Speed Device enumeration has occurred. - Check if characters have been received on the DBGU. - Once the communication interface is identified, the application runs in an infinite loop waiting for different commands as in Table 14-2. Table 14-2.
Command O o H h W w S R G V
Commands Available through the SAM-BA Boot
Action write a byte read a byte write a half word read a half word write a word read a word send a file receive a file go display version Argument(s) Address, Value# Address,# Address, Value# Address,# Address, Value# Address,# Address,# Address, NbOfBytes# Address# No argument Example O200001,CA# o200001,# H200002,CAFE# h200002,# W200000,CAFEDECA# w200000,# S200000,# R200000,1234# G200200# V#
* Write commands: Write a byte (O), a halfword (H) or a word (W) to the target. - Address: Address in hexadecimal. - Value: Byte, halfword or word to write in hexadecimal. - Output: `>'. * Read commands: Read a byte (o), a halfword (h) or a word (w) from the target. - Address: Address in hexadecimal - Output: The byte, halfword or word read in hexadecimal following by `>' * Send a file (S): Send a file to a specified address - Address: Address in hexadecimal - Output: `>'.
Note: There is a time-out on this command which is reached when the prompt `>' appears before the end of the command execution.
* Receive a file (R): Receive data into a file from a specified address - Address: Address in hexadecimal
79
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- NbOfBytes: Number of bytes in hexadecimal to receive - Output: `>' * Go (G): Jump to a specified address and execute the code - Address: Address to jump in hexadecimal - Output: `>' * Get Version (V): Return the SAM-BA boot version - Output: `>' 14.7.1 DBGU Serial Port Communication is performed through the DBGU serial port initialized to 115200 Baud, 8, n, 1. The Send and Receive File commands use the Xmodem protocol to communicate. Any terminal performing this protocol can be used to send the application file to the target. The size of the binary file to send depends on the SRAM size embedded in the product. In all cases, the size of the binary file must be lower than the SRAM size because the Xmodem protocol requires some SRAM memory to work. 14.7.2 Xmodem Protocol The Xmodem protocol supported is the 128-byte length block. This protocol uses a two-character CRC-16 to guarantee detection of a maximum bit error. Xmodem protocol with CRC is accurate provided both sender and receiver report successful transmission. Each block of the transfer looks like: <255-blk #><--128 data bytes--> in which: - = 01 hex - = binary number, starts at 01, increments by 1, and wraps 0FFH to 00H (not to 01) - <255-blk #> = 1's complement of the blk#. - = 2 bytes CRC16 Figure 14-7 shows a transmission using this protocol.
80
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 14-7. Xmodem Transfer Example
Host C SOH 01 FE Data[128] CRC CRC ACK SOH 02 FD Data[128] CRC CRC ACK SOH 03 FC Data[100] CRC CRC ACK EOT ACK Device
14.7.3
USB High Speed Device Port A 480 MHz USB clock is necessary to use the USB High Speed Device port. It has been programmed earlier in the device initialization procedure with UTMI PLL configuration. The Vendor ID is Atmel's vendor ID 0x03EB. The product ID is 0x6124. These references are used by the host operating system to mount the correct driver. On Windows systems, the INF files contain the correspondence between vendor ID and product ID. Atmel provides an INF example to see the device as a new serial port and also provides another custom driver used by the SAM-BA application: atm6124.sys. Refer to the document "USB Basic Application", literature number 6123, for more details.
14.7.3.1
Enumeration Process The USB protocol is a master/slave protocol. This is the host that starts the enumeration sending requests to the device through the control endpoint. The device handles standard requests as defined in the USB Specification. Table 14-3.
Request GET_DESCRIPTOR SET_ADDRESS SET_CONFIGURATION GET_CONFIGURATION GET_STATUS SET_FEATURE CLEAR_FEATURE
Handled Standard Requests
Definition Returns the current device configuration value. Sets the device address for all future device access. Sets the device configuration. Returns the current device configuration value. Returns status for the specified recipient. Used to set or enable a specific feature. Used to clear or disable a specific feature.
81
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The device also handles some class requests defined in the CDC class. Table 14-4.
Request SET_LINE_CODING GET_LINE_CODING SET_CONTROL_LINE_STATE
Handled Class Requests
Definition Configures DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of character bits. Requests current DTE rate, stop bits, parity and number of character bits. RS-232 signal used to tell the DCE device the DTE device is now present.
Unhandled requests are STALLed. 14.7.3.2 Communication Endpoints There are two communication endpoints and endpoint 0 is used for the enumeration process. Endpoint 1 is a 512-byte Bulk OUT endpoint and endpoint 2 is a 512-byte Bulk IN endpoint. SAM-BA Boot commands are sent by the host through the endpoint 1. If required, the message is split by the host into several data payloads by the host driver. If the command requires a response, the host can send IN transactions to pick up the response.
14.8
Hardware and Software Constraints
* A 12 MHz Crystal is mandatory in order to generate correctly 480 MHz clock necessary for the USB High Speed Device and to generate the 48 MHz System clock. * No Bypass Mode. * The SD Card, NAND Flash and DataFlash downloaded code size must be inferior to 56 K bytes. * The code is always downloaded from the DataFlash or NAND Flash device address 0x0000_0000 to the address 0x0000_0000 of the internal SRAM (after remap). * The downloaded code must be position-independent or linked at address 0x0000_0000. * The DataFlash must be connected to NPCS0 of the SPI. The MCI, the SPI and NAND Flash drivers use several PIOs in alternate functions to communicate with devices. Care must be taken when these PIOs are used by the application. The devices connected could be unintentionally driven at boot time, and electrical conflicts between peripherals output pins and the connected devices may appear. To assure correct functionality, it is recommended to plug in critical devices to other pins. Table 14-5 contains a list of pins that are driven during the boot program execution. These pins are driven during the boot sequence for a period of less than 1 second if no correct boot program is found. For the DataFlash driven by the SPCK signal at 8 MHz, the time to download 60 K bytes is reduced to 200 ms.
82
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Before performing the jump to the application in internal SRAM, all the PIOs and peripherals used in the boot program are set to their reset state. Table 14-5.
Peripheral MCI MCI MCI MCI MCI MCI SPI SPI SPI SPI PIO Controller B PIO Controller B PIO Controller B Address Bus Address Bus DBGU DBGU
Pins Driven during Boot Program Execution
Pin MCDA0 MCCDA MCCK MCDA1 MCDA2 MCDA3 MISO MOSI SPCK NPCS0 NAND OE NAND WE NANDCS NAND ALE NAND CLE DRXD DTXD PIO Line PIOA0 PIOA1 PIOA2 PIOA3 PIOA4 PIOA5 PIOA25 PIOA26 PIOA27 PIOA28 PIOB4 PIOB5 PIOB6 A21 A22 PIOA21 PIOA22
83
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
84
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
15. Reset Controller (RSTC)
15.1 Description
The Reset Controller (RSTC), based on power-on reset cells, handles all the resets of the system without any external components. It reports which reset occurred last. The Reset Controller also drives independently or simultaneously the external reset and the peripheral and processor resets.
15.2
Block Diagram
Figure 15-1. Reset Controller Block Diagram
Reset Controller
Main Supply POR Backup Supply POR Startup Counter rstc_irq Reset State Manager proc_nreset
user_reset
NRST
nrst_out
NRST Manager
exter_nreset
periph_nreset
backup_neset WDRPROC wd_fault
SLCK
85
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
15.3
15.3.1
Functional Description
Reset Controller Overview The Reset Controller is made up of an NRST Manager, a Startup Counter and a Reset State Manager. It runs at Slow Clock and generates the following reset signals: * proc_nreset: Processor reset line. It also resets the Watchdog Timer. * backup_nreset: Affects all the peripherals powered by VDDBU. * periph_nreset: Affects the whole set of embedded peripherals. * nrst_out: Drives the NRST pin. These reset signals are asserted by the Reset Controller, either on external events or on software action. The Reset State Manager controls the generation of reset signals and provides a signal to the NRST Manager when an assertion of the NRST pin is required. The NRST Manager shapes the NRST assertion during a programmable time, thus controlling external device resets. The startup counter waits for the complete crystal oscillator startup. The wait delay is given by the crystal oscillator startup time maximum value that can be found in the section Crystal Oscillator Characteristics in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product documentation. The Reset Controller Mode Register (RSTC_MR), allowing the configuration of the Reset Controller, is powered with VDDBU, so that its configuration is saved as long as VDDBU is on.
15.3.2
NRST Manager The NRST Manager samples the NRST input pin and drives this pin low when required by the Reset State Manager. Figure 15-2 shows the block diagram of the NRST Manager.
Figure 15-2. NRST Manager
RSTC_MR RSTC_SR
URSTIEN rstc_irq
RSTC_MR
URSTS NRSTL
Other interrupt sources user_reset
URSTEN
NRST
RSTC_MR
ERSTL nrst_out External Reset Timer exter_nreset
15.3.2.1
NRST Signal or Interrupt The NRST Manager samples the NRST pin at Slow Clock speed. When the line is detected low, a User Reset is reported to the Reset State Manager. However, the NRST Manager can be programmed to not trigger a reset when an assertion of NRST occurs. Writing the bit URSTEN at 0 in RSTC_MR disables the User Reset trigger.
86
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The level of the pin NRST can be read at any time in the bit NRSTL (NRST level) in RSTC_SR. As soon as the pin NRST is asserted, the bit URSTS in RSTC_SR is set. This bit clears only when RSTC_SR is read. The Reset Controller can also be programmed to generate an interrupt instead of generating a reset. To do so, the bit URSTIEN in RSTC_MR must be written at 1. 15.3.2.2 NRST External Reset Control The Reset State Manager asserts the signal ext_nreset to assert the NRST pin. When this occurs, the "nrst_out" signal is driven low by the NRST Manager for a time programmed by the field ERSTL in RSTC_MR. This assertion duration, named EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH, lasts 2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This gives the approximate duration of an assertion between 60 s and 2 seconds. Note that ERSTL at 0 defines a two-cycle duration for the NRST pulse. This feature allows the Reset Controller to shape the NRST pin level, and thus to guarantee that the NRST line is driven low for a time compliant with potential external devices connected on the system reset. As the field is within RSTC_MR, which is backed-up, this field can be used to shape the system power-up reset for devices requiring a longer startup time than the Slow Clock Oscillator. 15.3.3 BMS Sampling The product matrix manages a boot memory that depends on the level on the BMS pin at reset. The BMS signal is sampled three slow clock cycles after the Core Power-On-Reset output rising edge. Figure 15-3. BMS Sampling
SLCK
Core Supply POR output XXX
BMS sampling delay = 3 cycles
BMS Signal
H or L
proc_nreset
87
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
15.3.4
Reset States The Reset State Manager handles the different reset sources and generates the internal reset signals. It reports the reset status in the field RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). The update of the field RSTTYP is performed when the processor reset is released.
15.3.4.1
General Reset A general reset occurs when VDDBU and VDDCORE are powered on. The backup supply POR cell output rises and is filtered with a Startup Counter, which operates at Slow Clock. The purpose of this counter is to make sure the Slow Clock oscillator is stable before starting up the device. The length of startup time is hardcoded to comply with the Slow Clock Oscillator startup time. After this time, the processor clock is released at Slow Clock and all the other signals remain valid for 3 cycles for proper processor and logic reset. Then, all the reset signals are released and the field RSTTYP in RSTC_SR reports a General Reset. As the RSTC_MR is reset, the NRST line rises 2 cycles after the backup_nreset, as ERSTL defaults at value 0x0. When VDDBU is detected low by the Backup Supply POR Cell, all resets signals are immediately asserted, even if the Main Supply POR Cell does not report a Main Supply shutdown. VDDBU only activates the backup_nreset signal. The backup_nreset must be released so that any other reset can be generated by VDDCORE (Main Supply POR output). Figure 15-4 shows how the General Reset affects the reset signals.
Figure 15-4. General Reset State
SLCK MCK Backup Supply POR output
Any Freq.
Startup Time
Main Supply POR output backup_nreset
Processor Startup = 3 cycles
proc_nreset RSTTYP periph_nreset
XXX
0x0 = General Reset
XXX
NRST (nrst_out)
BMS Sampling EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH = 2 cycles
88
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
15.3.4.2 Wake-up Reset The Wake-up Reset occurs when the Main Supply is down. When the Main Supply POR output is active, all the reset signals are asserted except backup_nreset. When the Main Supply powers up, the POR output is resynchronized on Slow Clock. The processor clock is then re-enabled during 3 Slow Clock cycles, depending on the requirements of the ARM processor. At the end of this delay, the processor and other reset signals rise. The field RSTTYP in RSTC_SR is updated to report a Wake-up Reset. The "nrst_out" remains asserted for EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH cycles. As RSTC_MR is backed-up, the programmed number of cycles is applicable. When the Main Supply is detected falling, the reset signals are immediately asserted. This transition is synchronous with the output of the Main Supply POR. Figure 15-5. Wake-up State
SLCK MCK Main Supply POR output
Any Freq.
backup_nreset
Resynch. 2 cycles Processor Startup = 3 cycles
proc_nreset
RSTTYP
XXX
0x1 = WakeUp Reset
XXX
periph_nreset
NRST (nrst_out)
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH = 4 cycles (ERSTL = 1)
89
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
15.3.4.3
User Reset The User Reset is entered when a low level is detected on the NRST pin and the bit URSTEN in RSTC_MR is at 1. The NRST input signal is resynchronized with SLCK to insure proper behavior of the system. The User Reset is entered as soon as a low level is detected on NRST. The Processor Reset and the Peripheral Reset are asserted. The User Reset is left when NRST rises, after a two-cycle resynchronization time and a 3-cycle processor startup. The processor clock is re-enabled as soon as NRST is confirmed high. When the processor reset signal is released, the RSTTYP field of the Status Register (RSTC_SR) is loaded with the value 0x4, indicating a User Reset. The NRST Manager guarantees that the NRST line is asserted for EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH Slow Clock cycles, as programmed in the field ERSTL. However, if NRST does not rise after EXTERNAL_RESET_LENGTH because it is driven low externally, the internal reset lines remain asserted until NRST actually rises.
Figure 15-6. User Reset State
SLCK MCK
Any Freq.
NRST
Resynch. 2 cycles Resynch. 2 cycles Processor Startup = 3 cycles
proc_nreset RSTTYP periph_nreset Any XXX 0x4 = User Reset
NRST (nrst_out)
>= EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH
90
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
15.3.4.4 Software Reset The Reset Controller offers several commands used to assert the different reset signals. These commands are performed by writing the Control Register (RSTC_CR) with the following bits at 1: * PROCRST: Writing PROCRST at 1 resets the processor and the watchdog timer. * PERRST: Writing PERRST at 1 resets all the embedded peripherals, including the memory system, and, in particular, the Remap Command. The Peripheral Reset is generally used for debug purposes. * EXTRST: Writing EXTRST at 1 asserts low the NRST pin during a time defined by the field ERSTL in the Mode Register (RSTC_MR). The software reset is entered if at least one of these bits is set by the software. All these commands can be performed independently or simultaneously. The software reset lasts 3 Slow Clock cycles. The internal reset signals are asserted as soon as the register write is performed. This is detected on the Master Clock (MCK). They are released when the software reset is left, i.e.; synchronously to SLCK. If EXTRST is set, the nrst_out signal is asserted depending on the programming of the field ERSTL. However, the resulting falling edge on NRST does not lead to a User Reset. If and only if the PROCRST bit is set, the Reset Controller reports the software status in the field RSTTYP of the Status Register (RSTC_SR). Other Software Resets are not reported in RSTTYP. As soon as a software operation is detected, the bit SRCMP (Software Reset Command in Progress) is set in the Status Register (RSTC_SR). It is cleared as soon as the software reset is left. No other software reset can be performed while the SRCMP bit is set, and writing any value in RSTC_CR has no effect.
91
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 15-7. Software Reset
SLCK MCK
Any Freq.
Write RSTC_CR
Resynch. 1 cycle Processor Startup = 3 cycles
proc_nreset if PROCRST=1 RSTTYP periph_nreset if PERRST=1 NRST (nrst_out) if EXTRST=1
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 8 cycles (ERSTL=2)
Any
XXX
0x3 = Software Reset
SRCMP in RSTC_SR
15.3.4.5
Watchdog Reset The Watchdog Reset is entered when a watchdog fault occurs. This state lasts 3 Slow Clock cycles. When in Watchdog Reset, assertion of the reset signals depends on the WDRPROC bit in WDT_MR: * If WDRPROC is 0, the Processor Reset and the Peripheral Reset are asserted. The NRST line is also asserted, depending on the programming of the field ERSTL. However, the resulting low level on NRST does not result in a User Reset state. * If WDRPROC = 1, only the processor reset is asserted. The Watchdog Timer is reset by the proc_nreset signal. As the watchdog fault always causes a processor reset if WDRSTEN is set, the Watchdog Timer is always reset after a Watchdog Reset, and the Watchdog is enabled by default and with a period set to a maximum. When the WDRSTEN in WDT_MR bit is reset, the watchdog fault has no impact on the reset controller.
92
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 15-8. Watchdog Reset
SLCK MCK
Any Freq.
wd_fault
Processor Startup = 3 cycles
proc_nreset RSTTYP periph_nreset Only if WDRPROC = 0 Any XXX 0x2 = Watchdog Reset
NRST (nrst_out)
EXTERNAL RESET LENGTH 8 cycles (ERSTL=2)
15.3.5
Reset State Priorities The Reset State Manager manages the following priorities between the different reset sources, given in descending order: * Backup Reset * Wake-up Reset * Watchdog Reset * Software Reset * User Reset Particular cases are listed below: * When in User Reset: - A watchdog event is impossible because the Watchdog Timer is being reset by the proc_nreset signal. - A software reset is impossible, since the processor reset is being activated. * When in Software Reset: - A watchdog event has priority over the current state. - The NRST has no effect. * When in Watchdog Reset: - The processor reset is active and so a Software Reset cannot be programmed. - A User Reset cannot be entered.
15.3.6
Reset Controller Status Register The Reset Controller status register (RSTC_SR) provides several status fields: * RSTTYP field: This field gives the type of the last reset, as explained in previous sections. 93
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* SRCMP bit: This field indicates that a Software Reset Command is in progress and that no further software reset should be performed until the end of the current one. This bit is automatically cleared at the end of the current software reset. * NRSTL bit: The NRSTL bit of the Status Register gives the level of the NRST pin sampled on each MCK rising edge. * URSTS bit: A high-to-low transition of the NRST pin sets the URSTS bit of the RSTC_SR register. This transition is also detected on the Master Clock (MCK) rising edge (see Figure 15-9). If the User Reset is disabled (URSTEN = 0) and if the interruption is enabled by the URSTIEN bit in the RSTC_MR register, the URSTS bit triggers an interrupt. Reading the RSTC_SR status register resets the URSTS bit and clears the interrupt. Figure 15-9. Reset Controller Status and Interrupt
MCK read RSTC_SR
Peripheral Access
2 cycle resynchronization NRST NRSTL
2 cycle resynchronization
URSTS rstc_irq if (URSTEN = 0) and (URSTIEN = 1)
94
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
15.4 Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface
Reset Controller (RSTC) Register Mapping
Register Control Register Status Register Mode Register Name RSTC_CR RSTC_SR RSTC_MR Access Write-only Read-only Read/Write Reset Value 0x0000_0001 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 Back-up Reset Value
Table 15-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 Note:
1. The reset value of RSTC_SR either reports a General Reset or a Wake-up Reset depending on last rising power supply.
95
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
15.4.1 Reset Controller Control Register Register Name: RSTC_CR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 KEY 27 26 25 24
23 - 15 - 7 -
22 - 14 - 6 -
21 - 13 - 5 -
20 - 12 - 4 -
19 - 11 - 3 EXTRST
18 - 10 - 2 PERRST
17 - 9
16 - 8 - 0 PROCRST
1 -
* PROCRST: Processor Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, resets the processor. * PERRST: Peripheral Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, resets the peripherals. * EXTRST: External Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, asserts the NRST pin. * KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
96
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
15.4.2 Reset Controller Status Register Register Name: RSTC_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 SRCMP 9 RSTTYP 1 - 24 - 16 NRSTL 8
2 -
0 URSTS
* URSTS: User Reset Status 0 = No high-to-low edge on NRST happened since the last read of RSTC_SR. 1 = At least one high-to-low transition of NRST has been detected since the last read of RSTC_SR. * RSTTYP: Reset Type Reports the cause of the last processor reset. Reading this RSTC_SR does not reset this field.
RSTTYP 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 Reset Type General Reset Wake Up Reset Watchdog Reset Software Reset User Reset Comments Both VDDCORE and VDDBU rising VDDCORE rising Watchdog fault occurred Processor reset required by the software NRST pin detected low
* NRSTL: NRST Pin Level Registers the NRST Pin Level at Master Clock (MCK). * SRCMP: Software Reset Command in Progress 0 = No software command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is ready for a software command. 1 = A software reset command is being performed by the reset controller. The reset controller is busy.
97
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
15.4.3 Reset Controller Mode Register Register Name: RSTC_MR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 KEY 27 26 25 24
23 - 15 - 7 -
22 - 14 - 6 -
21 - 13 - 5
20 - 12 - 4 URSTIEN
19 - 11
18 - 10 ERSTL
17 - 9
16
8
3 -
2 -
1 -
0 URSTEN
* URSTEN: User Reset Enable 0 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST does not generate a User Reset. 1 = The detection of a low level on the pin NRST triggers a User Reset. * URSTIEN: User Reset Interrupt Enable 0 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 has no effect on rstc_irq. 1 = USRTS bit in RSTC_SR at 1 asserts rstc_irq if URSTEN = 0. * ERSTL: External Reset Length This field defines the external reset length. The external reset is asserted during a time of 2(ERSTL+1) Slow Clock cycles. This allows assertion duration to be programmed between 60 s and 2 seconds. * KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
98
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
16. Real-time Timer (RTT)
16.1 Overview
The Real-time Timer is built around a 32-bit counter and used to count elapsed seconds. It generates a periodic interrupt and/or triggers an alarm on a programmed value.
16.2
Block Diagram
Figure 16-1. Real-time Timer
RTT_MR RTTRST RTT_MR RTPRES RTT_MR SLCK reload 16-bit Divider RTT_MR RTTRST 1 0 RTTINCIEN 0 RTT_SR set RTTINC reset rtt_int 32-bit Counter read RTT_SR RTT_MR ALMIEN RTT_VR CRTV RTT_SR reset ALMS set = RTT_AR ALMV rtt_alarm
16.3
Functional Description
The Real-time Timer is used to count elapsed seconds. It is built around a 32-bit counter fed by Slow Clock divided by a programmable 16-bit value. The value can be programmed in the field RTPRES of the Real-time Mode Register (RTT_MR). Programming RTPRES at 0x00008000 corresponds to feeding the real-time counter with a 1 Hz signal (if the Slow Clock is 32.768 Hz). The 32-bit counter can count up to 232 seconds, corresponding to more than 136 years, then roll over to 0. The Real-time Timer can also be used as a free-running timer with a lower time-base. The best accuracy is achieved by writing RTPRES to 3. Programming RTPRES to 1 or 2 is possible, but may result in losing status events because the status register is cleared two Slow Clock cycles after read. Thus if the RTT is configured to trigger an interrupt, the interrupt occurs during 2 Slow Clock cycles after reading RTT_SR. To prevent several executions of the interrupt handler, the interrupt must be disabled in the interrupt handler and re-enabled when the status register is clear.
99
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The Real-time Timer value (CRTV) can be read at any time in the register RTT_VR (Real-time Value Register). As this value can be updated asynchronously from the Master Clock, it is advisable to read this register twice at the same value to improve accuracy of the returned value. The current value of the counter is compared with the value written in the alarm register RTT_AR (Real-time Alarm Register). If the counter value matches the alarm, the bit ALMS in RTT_SR is set. The alarm register is set to its maximum value, corresponding to 0xFFFF_FFFF, after a reset. The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR is set each time the Real-time Timer counter is incremented. This bit can be used to start a periodic interrupt, the period being one second when the RTPRES is programmed with 0x8000 and Slow Clock equal to 32.768 Hz. Reading the RTT_SR status register resets the RTTINC and ALMS fields. Writing the bit RTTRST in RTT_MR immediately reloads and restarts the clock divider with the new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter.
Note: Because of the asynchronism between the Slow Clock (SCLK) and the System Clock (MCK): 1) The restart of the counter and the reset of the RTT_VR current value register is effective only 2 slow clock cycles after the write of the RTTRST bit in the RTT_MR register. 2) The status register flags reset is taken into account only 2 slow clock cycles after the read of the RTT_SR (Status Register).
Figure 16-2. RTT Counting
APB cycle APB cycle
MCK
RTPRES - 1 Prescaler 0
RTT
0
...
ALMV-1
ALMV
ALMV+1
ALMV+2
ALMV+3
RTTINC (RTT_SR) ALMS (RTT_SR) APB Interface
read RTT_SR
100
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
16.4
16.4.1
Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface
Register Mapping Real-time Timer Register Mapping
Register Mode Register Alarm Register Value Register Status Register Name RTT_MR RTT_AR RTT_VR RTT_SR Access Read/Write Read/Write Read-only Read-only Reset Value 0x0000_8000 0xFFFF_FFFF 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000
Table 16-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C
101
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
16.4.2 Real-time Timer Mode Register Register Name: RTT_MR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RTPRES 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 RTTRST 10 25 - 17 RTTINCIEN 9 24 - 16 ALMIEN 8
7
6
5
4 RTPRES
3
2
1
0
* RTPRES: Real-time Timer Prescaler Value Defines the number of SLCK periods required to increment the Real-time timer. RTPRES is defined as follows: RTPRES = 0: The prescaler period is equal to 216 RTPRES 0: The prescaler period is equal to RTPRES. * ALMIEN: Alarm Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit ALMS in RTT_SR asserts interrupt. * RTTINCIEN: Real-time Timer Increment Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit RTTINC in RTT_SR asserts interrupt. * RTTRST: Real-time Timer Restart 1 = Reloads and restarts the clock divider with the new programmed value. This also resets the 32-bit counter.
102
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
16.4.3 Real-time Timer Alarm Register Register Name: RTT_AR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 ALMV 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 ALMV
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 ALMV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 ALMV
3
2
1
0
* ALMV: Alarm Value Defines the alarm value (ALMV+1) compared with the Real-time Timer. 16.4.4 Real-time Timer Value Register Register Name: RTT_VR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 CRTV 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 CRTV
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 CRTV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CRTV
3
2
1
0
* CRTV: Current Real-time Value Returns the current value of the Real-time Timer.
103
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
16.4.5 Real-time Timer Status Register Register Name: RTT_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 RTTINC 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 ALMS
* ALMS: Real-time Alarm Status 0 = The Real-time Alarm has not occurred since the last read of RTT_SR. 1 = The Real-time Alarm occurred since the last read of RTT_SR. * RTTINC: Real-time Timer Increment 0 = The Real-time Timer has not been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR. 1 = The Real-time Timer has been incremented since the last read of the RTT_SR.
104
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
17. Periodic Interval Timer (PIT)
17.1 Overview
The Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) provides the operating system's scheduler interrupt. It is designed to offer maximum accuracy and efficient management, even for systems with long response time.
17.2
Block Diagram
Figure 17-1. Periodic Interval Timer
PIT_MR
PIV
=?
PIT_MR
PITIEN
set
0
PIT_SR
PITS
reset
pit_irq
0
0
1
0
1
12-bit Adder
read PIT_PIVR
MCK
20-bit Counter
Prescaler
MCK/16
CPIV
PIT_PIVR
PICNT
CPIV
PIT_PIIR
PICNT
105
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
17.3
Functional Description
The Periodic Interval Timer aims at providing periodic interrupts for use by operating systems. The PIT provides a programmable overflow counter and a reset-on-read feature. It is built around two counters: a 20-bit CPIV counter and a 12-bit PICNT counter. Both counters work at Master Clock /16. The first 20-bit CPIV counter increments from 0 up to a programmable overflow value set in the field PIV of the Mode Register (PIT_MR). When the counter CPIV reaches this value, it resets to 0 and increments the Periodic Interval Counter, PICNT. The status bit PITS in the Status Register (PIT_SR) rises and triggers an interrupt, provided the interrupt is enabled (PITIEN in PIT_MR). Writing a new PIV value in PIT_MR does not reset/restart the counters. When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Value Register (PIT_PIVR), the overflow counter (PICNT) is reset and the PITS is cleared, thus acknowledging the interrupt. The value of PICNT gives the number of periodic intervals elapsed since the last read of PIT_PIVR. When CPIV and PICNT values are obtained by reading the Periodic Interval Image Register (PIT_PIIR), there is no effect on the counters CPIV and PICNT, nor on the bit PITS. For example, a profiler can read PIT_PIIR without clearing any pending interrupt, whereas a timer interrupt clears the interrupt by reading PIT_PIVR. The PIT may be enabled/disabled using the PITEN bit in the PIT_MR register (disabled on reset). The PITEN bit only becomes effective when the CPIV value is 0. Figure 17-2 illustrates the PIT counting. After the PIT Enable bit is reset (PITEN= 0), the CPIV goes on counting until the PIV value is reached, and is then reset. PIT restarts counting, only if the PITEN is set again. The PIT is stopped when the core enters debug state.
106
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 17-2. Enabling/Disabling PIT with PITEN
APB cycle MCK 15 restarts MCK Prescaler MCK Prescaler 0 PITEN APB cycle
CPIV PICNT PITS (PIT_SR) APB Interface
0
1 0
PIV - 1
PIV 1
0 0
1
read PIT_PIVR
107
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
17.4
Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface
Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) Register Mapping
Register Mode Register Status Register Periodic Interval Value Register Periodic Interval Image Register Name PIT_MR PIT_SR PIT_PIVR PIT_PIIR Access Read/Write Read-only Read-only Read-only Reset Value 0x000F_FFFF 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000
Table 17-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C
108
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
17.4.1 Periodic Interval Timer Mode Register Register Name: PIT_MR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 PIV 27 - 19 26 - 18 PIV 11 10 9 8 25 PITIEN 17 24 PITEN 16
7
6
5
4 PIV
3
2
1
0
* PIV: Periodic Interval Value Defines the value compared with the primary 20-bit counter of the Periodic Interval Timer (CPIV). The period is equal to (PIV + 1). * PITEN: Period Interval Timer Enabled 0 = The Periodic Interval Timer is disabled when the PIV value is reached. 1 = The Periodic Interval Timer is enabled. * PITIEN: Periodic Interval Timer Interrupt Enable 0 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR has no effect on interrupt. 1 = The bit PITS in PIT_SR asserts interrupt. 17.4.2 Periodic Interval Timer Status Register Register Name: PIT_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 PITS
* PITS: Periodic Interval Timer Status 0 = The Periodic Interval timer has not reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR. 1 = The Periodic Interval timer has reached PIV since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
109
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
17.4.3 Periodic Interval Timer Value Register Register Name: PIT_PIVR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 PICNT 27 26 25 24
23
22 PICNT
21
20
19
18 CPIV
17
16
15
14
13
12 CPIV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CPIV
3
2
1
0
Reading this register clears PITS in PIT_SR. * CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer. * PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
17.4.4 Periodic Interval Timer Image Register Register Name: PIT_PIIR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 PICNT 27 26 25 24
23
22 PICNT
21
20
19
18 CPIV
17
16
15
14
13
12 CPIV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CPIV
3
2
1
0
* CPIV: Current Periodic Interval Value Returns the current value of the periodic interval timer. * PICNT: Periodic Interval Counter Returns the number of occurrences of periodic intervals since the last read of PIT_PIVR.
110
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
18. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
18.1 Description
The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in a deadlock. It features a 12-bit down counter that allows a watchdog period of up to 16 seconds (slow clock at 32.768 kHz). It can generate a general reset or a processor reset only. In addition, it can be stopped while the processor is in debug mode or idle mode.
18.2
Block Diagram
Figure 18-1. Watchdog Timer Block Diagram
write WDT_MR WDT_MR WDT_CR WDRSTT reload 1 0 WDV
12-bit Down Counter WDT_MR WDD Current Value reload 1/128 SLCK
<= WDD WDT_MR WDRSTEN =0 wdt_fault (to Reset Controller) wdt_int
set set read WDT_SR or reset WDERR reset WDUNF reset WDFIEN WDT_MR
111
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
18.3
Functional Description
The Watchdog Timer can be used to prevent system lock-up if the software becomes trapped in a deadlock. It is supplied with VDDCORE. It restarts with initial values on processor reset. The Watchdog is built around a 12-bit down counter, which is loaded with the value defined in the field WDV of the Mode Register (WDT_MR). The Watchdog Timer uses the Slow Clock divided by 128 to establish the maximum Watchdog period to be 16 seconds (with a typical Slow Clock of 32.768 kHz). After a Processor Reset, the value of WDV is 0xFFF, corresponding to the maximum value of the counter with the external reset generation enabled (field WDRSTEN at 1 after a Backup Reset). This means that a default Watchdog is running at reset, i.e., at power-up. The user must either disable it (by setting the WDDIS bit in WDT_MR) if he does not expect to use it or must reprogram it to meet the maximum Watchdog period the application requires. The Watchdog Mode Register (WDT_MR) can be written only once. Only a processor reset resets it. Writing the WDT_MR register reloads the timer with the newly programmed mode parameters. In normal operation, the user reloads the Watchdog at regular intervals before the timer underflow occurs, by writing the Control Register (WDT_CR) with the bit WDRSTT to 1. The Watchdog counter is then immediately reloaded from WDT_MR and restarted, and the Slow Clock 128 divider is reset and restarted. The WDT_CR register is write-protected. As a result, writing WDT_CR without the correct hard-coded key has no effect. If an underflow does occur, the "wdt_fault" signal to the Reset Controller is asserted if the bit WDRSTEN is set in the Mode Register (WDT_MR). Moreover, the bit WDUNF is set in the Watchdog Status Register (WDT_SR). To prevent a software deadlock that continuously triggers the Watchdog, the reload of the Watchdog must occur while the Watchdog counter is within a window between 0 and WDD, WDD is defined in the WatchDog Mode Register WDT_MR. Any attempt to restart the Watchdog while the Watchdog counter is between WDV and WDD results in a Watchdog error, even if the Watchdog is disabled. The bit WDERR is updated in the WDT_SR and the "wdt_fault" signal to the Reset Controller is asserted. Note that this feature can be disabled by programming a WDD value greater than or equal to the WDV value. In such a configuration, restarting the Watchdog Timer is permitted in the whole range [0; WDV] and does not generate an error. This is the default configuration on reset (the WDD and WDV values are equal). The status bits WDUNF (Watchdog Underflow) and WDERR (Watchdog Error) trigger an interrupt, provided the bit WDFIEN is set in the mode register. The signal "wdt_fault" to the reset controller causes a Watchdog reset if the WDRSTEN bit is set as already explained in the reset controller programmer Datasheet. In that case, the processor and the Watchdog Timer are reset, and the WDERR and WDUNF flags are reset. If a reset is generated or if WDT_SR is read, the status bits are reset, the interrupt is cleared, and the "wdt_fault" signal to the reset controller is deasserted. Writing the WDT_MR reloads and restarts the down counter. While the processor is in debug state or in idle mode, the counter may be stopped depending on the value programmed for the bits WDIDLEHLT and WDDBGHLT in the WDT_MR.
112
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 18-2. Watchdog Behavior
Watchdog Error Watchdog Underflow if WDRSTEN is 1 FFF Normal behavior WDV Forbidden Window WDD Permitted Window 0 WDT_CR = WDRSTT if WDRSTEN is 0
Watchdog Fault
113
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
18.4
Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface
Watchdog Timer Registers
Register Control Register Mode Register Status Register Name WDT_CR WDT_MR WDT_SR Access Write-only Read/Write Once Read-only Reset Value 0x3FFF_2FFF 0x0000_0000
Table 18-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08
18.4.1 Watchdog Timer Control Register Register Name: WDT_CR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 KEY 27 26 25 24
23 - 15 - 7 -
22 - 14 - 6 -
21 - 13 - 5 -
20 - 12 - 4 -
19 - 11 - 3 -
18 - 10 - 2 -
17 - 9 - 1 -
16 - 8 - 0 WDRSTT
* WDRSTT: Watchdog Restart 0: No effect. 1: Restarts the Watchdog. * KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
114
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
18.4.2 Watchdog Timer Mode Register Register Name: WDT_MR Access Type:
31
Read/Write Once
30 29 WDIDLEHLT 21 28 WDDBGHLT 20 WDD 27 26 WDD 19 18 17 16 25 24
23
22
15 WDDIS 7
14 WDRPROC 6
13 WDRSTEN 5
12 WDFIEN 4 WDV
11
10 WDV
9
8
3
2
1
0
* WDV: Watchdog Counter Value Defines the value loaded in the 12-bit Watchdog Counter. * WDFIEN: Watchdog Fault Interrupt Enable 0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on interrupt. 1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) asserts interrupt. * WDRSTEN: Watchdog Reset Enable 0: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) has no effect on the resets. 1: A Watchdog fault (underflow or error) triggers a Watchdog reset. * WDRPROC: Watchdog Reset Processor 0: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates all resets. 1: If WDRSTEN is 1, a Watchdog fault (underflow or error) activates the processor reset. * WDD: Watchdog Delta Value Defines the permitted range for reloading the Watchdog Timer. If the Watchdog Timer value is less than or equal to WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 restarts the timer. If the Watchdog Timer value is greater than WDD, writing WDT_CR with WDRSTT = 1 causes a Watchdog error. * WDDBGHLT: Watchdog Debug Halt 0: The Watchdog runs when the processor is in debug state. 1: The Watchdog stops when the processor is in debug state. * WDIDLEHLT: Watchdog Idle Halt 0: The Watchdog runs when the system is in idle mode. 1: The Watchdog stops when the system is in idle state. * WDDIS: Watchdog Disable 0: Enables the Watchdog Timer. 1: Disables the Watchdog Timer.
115
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
18.4.3 Watchdog Timer Status Register Register Name: WDT_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WDERR 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 WDUNF
* WDUNF: Watchdog Underflow 0: No Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. 1: At least one Watchdog underflow occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. * WDERR: Watchdog Error 0: No Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR. 1: At least one Watchdog error occurred since the last read of WDT_SR.
116
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
19. Shutdown Controller (SHDWC)
19.1 Description
The Shutdown Controller controls the power supplies VDDIO and VDDCORE and the wake-up detection on debounced input lines.
19.2
Block Diagram
Figure 19-1. Shutdown Controller Block Diagram
SLCK Shutdown Controller
SHDW_MR read SHDW_SR reset
CPTWK0 WKMODE0 WKUP0
WAKEUP0 SHDW_SR
set
read SHDW_SR
Wake-up
reset
RTTWKEN RTT Alarm
SHDW_MR
RTTWK
set
SHDW_SR
Shutdown Output Controller
SHDW_CR
SHDN
read SHDW_SR reset
SHDW
Shutdown
RTCWKEN RTC Alarm
SHDW_MR
RTCWK
set
SHDW_SR
19.3
I/O Lines Description
I/O Lines Description
Description Wake-up 0 input Shutdown output Type Input Output
Table 19-1.
Name WKUP0 SHDN
19.4
19.4.1
Product Dependencies
Power Management The Shutdown Controller is continuously clocked by Slow Clock. The Power Management Controller has no effect on the behavior of the Shutdown Controller.
117
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
19.5
Functional Description
The Shutdown Controller manages the main power supply. To do so, it is supplied with VDDBU and manages wake-up input pins and one output pin, SHDN. A typical application connects the pin SHDN to the shutdown input of the DC/DC Converter providing the main power supplies of the system, and especially VDDCORE and/or VDDIO. The wake-up inputs (WKUP0) connect to any push-buttons or signal that wake up the system. The software is able to control the pin SHDN by writing the Shutdown Control Register (SHDW_CR) with the bit SHDW at 1. The shutdown is taken into account only 2 slow clock cycles after the write of SHDW_CR. This register is password-protected and so the value written should contain the correct key for the command to be taken into account. As a result, the system should be powered down. A level change on WKUP0 is used as wake-up. Wake-up is configured in the Shutdown Mode Register (SHDW_MR). The transition detector can be programmed to detect either a positive or negative transition or any level change on WKUP0. The detection can also be disabled. Programming is performed by defining WKMODE0. Moreover, a debouncing circuit can be programmed for WKUP0. The debouncing circuit filters pulses on WKUP0 shorter than the programmed number of 16 SLCK cycles in CPTWK0 of the SHDW_MR register. If the programmed level change is detected on a pin, a counter starts. When the counter reaches the value programmed in the corresponding field, CPTWK0, the SHDN pin is released. If a new input change is detected before the counter reaches the corresponding value, the counter is stopped and cleared. WAKEUP0 of the Status Register (SHDW_SR) reports the detection of the programmed events on WKUP0 with a reset after the read of SHDW_SR. The Shutdown Controller can be programmed so as to activate the wake-up using the RTT alarm (the detection of the rising edge of the RTT alarm is synchronized with SLCK). This is done by writing the SHDW_MR register using the RTTWKEN fields. When enabled, the detection of the RTT alarm is reported in the RTTWK bit of the SHDW_SR Status register. It is reset after the read of SHDW_SR. When using the RTT alarm to wake up the system, the user must ensure that the RTT alarm status flag is cleared before shutting down the system. Otherwise, no rising edge of the status flag may be detected and the wake-up fails. The Shutdown Controller can be programmed so as to activate the wake-up using the RTC alarm (the detection of the rising edge of the RTC alarm is synchronized with SLCK). This is done by writing the SHDW_MR register using the RTCWKEN field. When enabled, the detection of the RTC alarm is reported in the RTCWK bit of the SHDW_SR Status register. It is reset after the read of SHDW_SR. When using the RTC alarm to wake up the system, the user must ensure that the RTC alarm status flag is cleared before shutting down the system. Otherwise, no rising edge of the status flag may be detected and the wake-up fails fail.
118
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
19.6 Shutdown Controller (SHDWC) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Shutdown Control Register Shutdown Mode Register Shutdown Status Register Name SHDW_CR SHDW_MR SHDW_SR Access Write-only Read-write Read-only Reset 0x0000_0003 0x0000_0000
Table 19-2.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08
119
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
19.6.1 Shutdown Control Register Register Name: SHDW_CR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 KEY 27 26 25 24
23 - 15 - 7 -
22 - 14 - 6 -
21 - 13 - 5 -
20 - 12 - 4 -
19 - 11 - 3 -
18 - 10 - 2 -
17 - 9 - 1 -
16 - 8 - 0 SHDW
* SHDW: Shutdown Command 0 = No effect. 1 = If KEY is correct, asserts the SHDN pin. * KEY: Password Should be written at value 0xA5. Writing any other value in this field aborts the write operation.
120
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
19.6.2 Shutdown Mode Register Register Name: SHDW_MR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 RTCWKEN 9 - 1 WKMODE0 0 24 - 16 RTTWKEN 8
7
6 CPTWK0
5
4
* WKMODE0: Wake-up Mode 0
WKMODE[1:0] 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1
Wake-up Input Transition Selection None. No detection is performed on the wake-up input Low to high level High to low level Both levels change
* CPTWK0: Counter on Wake-up 0 Defines the number of 16 Slow Clock cycles, the level detection on the corresponding input pin shall last before the wakeup event occurs. Because of the internal synchronization of WKUP0, the SHDN pin is released (CPTWK x 16 + 1) Slow Clock cycles after the event on WKUP. * RTTWKEN: Real-time Timer Wake-up Enable 0 = The RTT Alarm signal has no effect on the Shutdown Controller. 1 = The RTT Alarm signal forces the de-assertion of the SHDN pin. * RTCWKEN: Real-time Clock Wake-up Enable 0 = The RTC Alarm signal has no effect on the Shutdown Controller. 1 = The RTC Alarm signal forces the de-assertion of the SHDN pin.
121
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
19.6.3 Shutdown Status Register Register Name: SHDW_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 RTCWK 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 RTTWK 8 - 0 WAKEUP0
* WAKEUP0: Wake-up 0 Status 0 = No wake-up event occurred on the corresponding wake-up input since the last read of SHDW_SR. 1 = At least one wake-up event occurred on the corresponding wake-up input since the last read of SHDW_SR. * RTTWK: Real-time Timer Wake-up 0 = No wake-up alarm from the RTT occurred since the last read of SHDW_SR. 1 = At least one wake-up alarm from the RTT occurred since the last read of SHDW_SR. * RTCWK: Real-time Clock Wake-up 0 = No wake-up alarm from the RTC occurred since the last read of SHDW_SR. 1 = At least one wake-up alarm from the RTC occurred since the last read of SHDW_SR.
122
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20. Real-time Clock (RTC)
20.1 Description
The Real-time Clock (RTC) peripheral is designed for very low power consumption. It combines a complete time-of-day clock with alarm and a two-hundred-year Gregorian calendar, complemented by a programmable periodic interrupt. The alarm and calendar registers are accessed by a 32-bit data bus. The time and calendar values are coded in binary-coded decimal (BCD) format. The time format can be 24-hour mode or 12-hour mode with an AM/PM indicator. Updating time and calendar fields and configuring the alarm fields are performed by a parallel capture on the 32-bit data bus. An entry control is performed to avoid loading registers with incompatible BCD format data or with an incompatible date according to the current month/year/century.
20.2
Block Diagram
Figure 20-1. Block Diagram
Crystal Oscillator: SLCK
32768 Divider
Time
Date
Bus Interface
Bus Interface
Entry Control
Interrupt Control
RTC Interrupt
20.3
20.3.1
Product Dependencies
Power Management The Real-time Clock is continuously clocked at 32768 Hz. The Power Management Controller has no effect on RTC behavior. Interrupt The RTC Interrupt is connected to interrupt source 1 (IRQ1) of the advanced interrupt controller. This interrupt line is due to the OR-wiring of the system peripheral interrupt lines (System Timer, Real Time Clock, Power Management Controller, Memory Controller, etc.). When a system interrupt occurs, the service routine must first determine the cause of the interrupt. This is done by reading the status registers of the above system peripherals successively.
20.3.2
20.4
Functional Description
The RTC provides a full binary-coded decimal (BCD) clock that includes century (19/20), year (with leap years), month, date, day, hours, minutes and seconds.
123
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The valid year range is 1900 to 2099, a two-hundred-year Gregorian calendar achieving full Y2K compliance. The RTC can operate in 24-hour mode or in 12-hour mode with an AM/PM indicator. Corrections for leap years are included (all years divisible by 4 being leap years, including year 2000). This is correct up to the year 2099. After hardware reset, the calendar is initialized to Thursday, January 1, 1998. 20.4.1 Reference Clock The reference clock is Slow Clock (SLCK). During low power modes of the processor (idle mode), the oscillator runs and power consumption is critical. The crystal selection has to take into account the current consumption for power saving and the frequency drift due to temperature effect on the circuit for time accuracy. 20.4.2 Timing The RTC is updated in real time at one-second intervals in normal mode for the counters of seconds, at one-minute intervals for the counter of minutes and so on. Due to the asynchronous operation of the RTC with respect to the rest of the chip, to be certain that the value read in the RTC registers (century, year, month, date, day, hours, minutes, seconds) are valid and stable, it is necessary to read these registers twice. If the data is the same both times, then it is valid. Therefore, a minimum of two and a maximum of three accesses are required. 20.4.3 Alarm The RTC has five programmable fields: month, date, hours, minutes and seconds. Each of these fields can be enabled or disabled to match the alarm condition: * If all the fields are enabled, an alarm flag is generated (the corresponding flag is asserted and an interrupt generated if enabled) at a given month, date, hour/minute/second. * If only the "seconds" field is enabled, then an alarm is generated every minute. Depending on the combination of fields enabled, a large number of possibilities are available to the user ranging from minutes to 365/366 days. 20.4.4 Error Checking Verification on user interface data is performed when accessing the century, year, month, date, day, hours, minutes, seconds and alarms. A check is performed on illegal BCD entries such as illegal date of the month with regard to the year and century configured. If one of the time fields is not correct, the data is not loaded into the register/counter and a flag is set in the validity register. The user can not reset this flag. It is reset as soon as an acceptable value is programmed. This avoids any further side effects in the hardware. The same procedure is done for the alarm. The following checks are performed: 1. Century (check if it is in range 19 - 20) 2. Year (BCD entry check) 3. Date (check range 01 - 31) 4. Month (check if it is in BCD range 01 - 12, check validity regarding "date")
124
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
5. Day (check range 1 - 7) 6. Hour (BCD checks: in 24-hour mode, check range 00 - 23 and check that AM/PM flag is not set if RTC is set in 24-hour mode; in 12-hour mode check range 01 - 12) 7. Minute (check BCD and range 00 - 59) 8. Second (check BCD and range 00 - 59)
Note: If the 12-hour mode is selected by means of the RTC_MODE register, a 12-hour value can be programmed and the returned value on RTC_TIME will be the corresponding 24-hour value. The entry control checks the value of the AM/PM indicator (bit 22 of RTC_TIME register) to determine the range to be checked.
20.4.5
Updating Time/Calendar To update any of the time/calendar fields, the user must first stop the RTC by setting the corresponding field in the Control Register. Bit UPDTIM must be set to update time fields (hour, minute, second) and bit UPDCAL must be set to update calendar fields (century, year, month, date, day). Then the user must poll or wait for the interrupt (if enabled) of bit ACKUPD in the Status Register. Once the bit reads 1, the user can write to the appropriate register. Once the update is finished, the user must reset (0) UPDTIM and/or UPDCAL in the Control Register. When programming the calendar fields, the time fields remain enabled. This avoids a time slip in case the user stays in the calendar update phase for several tens of seconds or more. In successive update operations, the user must wait at least one second after resetting the UPDTIM/UPDCAL bit in the RTC_CR (Control Register) before setting these bits again. This is done by waiting for the SEC flag in the Status Register before setting UPDTIM/UPDCAL bit. After resetting UPDTIM/UPDCAL, the SEC flag must also be cleared.
20.5
Real-time Clock (RTC) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Control Register Mode Register Time Register Calendar Register Time Alarm Register Calendar Alarm Register Status Register Status Clear Command Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Valid Entry Register Version Register
(1)
Table 20-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0xFC Note:
Register Name RTC_CR RTC_MR RTC_TIMR RTC_CALR RTC_TIMALR RTC_CALALR RTC_SR RTC_SCCR RTC_IER RTC_IDR RTC_IMR RTC_VER RTC-VERSION
Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read-only Write-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read-only
Reset 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x01819819 0x0 0x01010000 0x0 ------0x0 0x0 0x-
1. Values in the Version Register vary with the version of the IP block implementation.
125
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
126
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.1 Name: RTC Control Register RTC_CR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10 9
CALEVSEL
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2 1
TIMEVSEL
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
UPDCAL
UPDTIM
* UPDTIM: Update Request Time Register 0 = No effect. 1 = Stops the RTC time counting. Time counting consists of second, minute and hour counters. Time counters can be programmed once this bit is set and acknowledged by the bit ACKUPD of the Status Register. * UPDCAL: Update Request Calendar Register 0 = No effect. 1 = Stops the RTC calendar counting. Calendar counting consists of day, date, month, year and century counters. Calendar counters can be programmed once this bit is set. * TIMEVSEL: Time Event Selection The event that generates the flag TIMEV in RTC_SR (Status Register) depends on the value of TIMEVSEL. 0 = Minute change. 1 = Hour change. 2 = Every day at midnight. 3 = Every day at noon. * CALEVSEL: Calendar Event Selection The event that generates the flag CALEV in RTC_SR depends on the value of CALEVSEL. 0 = Week change (every Monday at time 00:00:00). 1 = Month change (every 01 of each month at time 00:00:00). 2, 3 = Year change (every January 1 at time 00:00:00).
127
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.2 Name:
RTC Mode Register RTC_MR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
HRMOD
* HRMOD: 12-/24-hour Mode 0 = 24-hour mode is selected. 1 = 12-hour mode is selected.
All non-significant bits read zero.
128
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.3 Name: RTC Time Register RTC_TIMR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
AMPM
14 13 12 11
HOUR
10 9 8
-
7 6 5 4
MIN
3 2 1 0
-
SEC
* SEC: Current Second The range that can be set is 0 - 59 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens. * MIN: Current Minute The range that can be set is 0 - 59 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens. * HOUR: Current Hour The range that can be set is 1 - 12 (BCD) in 12-hour mode or 0 - 23 (BCD) in 24-hour mode. * AMPM: Ante Meridiem Post Meridiem Indicator This bit is the AM/PM indicator in 12-hour mode. 0 = AM. 1 = PM. All non-significant bits read zero.
129
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.4 Name:
RTC Calendar Register RTC_CALR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22 21 20 19
DATE
18 17 16
DAY
15 14 13 12 11
MONTH
10 9 8
YEAR
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
-
CENT
* CENT: Current Century The range that can be set is 19 - 20 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens. * YEAR: Current Year The range that can be set is 00 - 99 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens. * MONTH: Current Month The range that can be set is 01 - 12 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens. * DAY: Current Day The range that can be set is 1 - 7 (BCD). The coding of the number (which number represents which day) is user-defined as it has no effect on the date counter. * DATE: Current Date The range that can be set is 01 - 31 (BCD). The lowest four bits encode the units. The higher bits encode the tens.
All non-significant bits read zero.
130
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.5 Name: RTC Time Alarm Register RTC_TIMALR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
HOUREN
15
AMPM
14 13 12 11
HOUR
10 9 8
MINEN
7 6 5 4
MIN
3 2 1 0
SECEN
SEC
* SEC: Second Alarm This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded second counter. * SECEN: Second Alarm Enable 0 = The second-matching alarm is disabled. 1 = The second-matching alarm is enabled. * MIN: Minute Alarm This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded minute counter. * MINEN: Minute Alarm Enable 0 = The minute-matching alarm is disabled. 1 = The minute-matching alarm is enabled. * HOUR: Hour Alarm This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded hour counter. * AMPM: AM/PM Indicator This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded hour counter. * HOUREN: Hour Alarm Enable 0 = The hour-matching alarm is disabled. 1 = The hour-matching alarm is enabled.
131
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.6 Name:
RTC Calendar Alarm Register RTC_CALALR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
DATEEN
23
-
22 21 20 19
DATE
18 17 16
MTHEN
15
-
14
-
13 12 11
MONTH
10 9 8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
* MONTH: Month Alarm This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded month counter. * MTHEN: Month Alarm Enable 0 = The month-matching alarm is disabled. 1 = The month-matching alarm is enabled. * DATE: Date Alarm This field is the alarm field corresponding to the BCD-coded date counter. * DATEEN: Date Alarm Enable 0 = The date-matching alarm is disabled. 1 = The date-matching alarm is enabled.
132
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.7 Name: RTC Status Register RTC_SR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
CALEV
TIMEV
SEC
ALARM
ACKUPD
* ACKUPD: Acknowledge for Update 0 = Time and calendar registers cannot be updated. 1 = Time and calendar registers can be updated. * ALARM: Alarm Flag 0 = No alarm matching condition occurred. 1 = An alarm matching condition has occurred. * SEC: Second Event 0 = No second event has occurred since the last clear. 1 = At least one second event has occurred since the last clear. * TIMEV: Time Event 0 = No time event has occurred since the last clear. 1 = At least one time event has occurred since the last clear. The time event is selected in the TIMEVSEL field in RTC_CTRL (Control Register) and can be any one of the following events: minute change, hour change, noon, midnight (day change). * CALEV: Calendar Event 0 = No calendar event has occurred since the last clear. 1 = At least one calendar event has occurred since the last clear. The calendar event is selected in the CALEVSEL field in RTC_CR and can be any one of the following events: week change, month change and year change.
133
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.8 Name:
RTC Status Clear Command Register RTC_SCCR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
CALCLR
TIMCLR
SECCLR
ALRCLR
ACKCLR
* ACKCLR: Acknowledge Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding status flag in the Status Register (RTC_SR). * ALRCLR: Alarm Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding status flag in the Status Register (RTC_SR). * SECCLR: Second Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding status flag in the Status Register (RTC_SR). * TIMCLR: Time Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding status flag in the Status Register (RTC_SR). * CALCLR: Calendar Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding status flag in the Status Register (RTC_SR).
134
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.9 Name: RTC Interrupt Enable Register RTC_IER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
CALEN
TIMEN
SECEN
ALREN
ACKEN
* ACKEN: Acknowledge Update Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The acknowledge for update interrupt is enabled. * ALREN: Alarm Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The alarm interrupt is enabled. * SECEN: Second Event Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The second periodic interrupt is enabled. * TIMEN: Time Event Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The selected time event interrupt is enabled. * CALEN: Calendar Event Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. * 1 = The selected calendar event interrupt is enabled.
135
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.10 Name:
RTC Interrupt Disable Register RTC_IDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
CALDIS
TIMDIS
SECDIS
ALRDIS
ACKDIS
* ACKDIS: Acknowledge Update Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The acknowledge for update interrupt is disabled. * ALRDIS: Alarm Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The alarm interrupt is disabled. * SECDIS: Second Event Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The second periodic interrupt is disabled. * TIMDIS: Time Event Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The selected time event interrupt is disabled. * CALDIS: Calendar Event Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The selected calendar event interrupt is disabled.
136
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
20.5.11 Name: RTC Interrupt Mask Register RTC_IMR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
CAL
TIM
SEC
ALR
ACK
* ACK: Acknowledge Update Interrupt Mask 0 = The acknowledge for update interrupt is disabled. 1 = The acknowledge for update interrupt is enabled. * ALR: Alarm Interrupt Mask 0 = The alarm interrupt is disabled. 1 = The alarm interrupt is enabled. * SEC: Second Event Interrupt Mask 0 = The second periodic interrupt is disabled. 1 = The second periodic interrupt is enabled. * TIM: Time Event Interrupt Mask 0 = The selected time event interrupt is disabled. 1 = The selected time event interrupt is enabled. * CAL: Calendar Event Interrupt Mask 0 = The selected calendar event interrupt is disabled. 1 = The selected calendar event interrupt is enabled.
137
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
20.5.12 Name:
RTC Valid Entry Register RTC_VER Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
NVCALALR
NVTIMALR
NVCAL
NVTIM
* NVTIM: Non valid Time 0 = No invalid data has been detected in RTC_TIMR (Time Register). 1 = RTC_TIMR has contained invalid data since it was last programmed. * NVCAL: Non valid Calendar 0 = No invalid data has been detected in RTC_CALR (Calendar Register). 1 = RTC_CALR has contained invalid data since it was last programmed. * NVTIMALR: Non valid Time Alarm 0 = No invalid data has been detected in RTC_TIMALR (Time Alarm Register). 1 = RTC_TIMALR has contained invalid data since it was last programmed. * NVCALALR: Non valid Calendar Alarm 0 = No invalid data has been detected in RTC_CALALR (Calendar Alarm Register). 1 = RTC_CALALR has contained invalid data since it was last programmed.
138
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21. External Bus Interface (EBI)
21.1 Description
The External Bus Interface (EBI) is designed to ensure the successful data transfer between several external devices and the embedded Memory Controller of an ARM-based device. The Static Memory, SDRAM and ECC Controllers are all featured external Memory Controllers on the EBI. These external Memory Controllers are capable of handling several types of external memory and peripheral devices, such as SRAM, PROM, EPROM, EEPROM, Flash, and SDRAM. The EBI also supports the CompactFlash and the NAND Flash protocols via integrated circuitry that greatly reduces the requirements for external components. Furthermore, the EBI handles data transfers with up to six external devices, each assigned to six address spaces defined by the embedded Memory Controller. Data transfers are performed through a 16-bit or 32-bit data bus, an address bus of up to 26 bits, up to six chip select lines (NCS[5:0]) and several control pins that are generally multiplexed between the different external Memory Controllers.
139
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
21.2
21.2.1
Block Diagram
External Bus Interface 0 Figure 21-1 shows the organization of the External Bus Interface 0.
Figure 21-1. Organization of the External Bus Interface 0
Bus Matrix
External Bus Interface 0
D[15:0] AHB SDRAM Controller A0/NBS0 A1/NWR2/NBS2 A[15:2] A16/BA0 Static Memory Controller MUX Logic A17/BA1 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE/CFWE NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW CompactFlash Logic SDCK SDCKE RAS CAS NAND Flash Logic SDWE SDA10 NWAIT A[24:23], A[20:18] ECC Controller PIO A25/CFRNW Chip Select Assignor D[31:16] NCS2 NCS3/NANDCS NCS4/CFCS0 User Interface NCS5/CFCS1 CFCE1 - CFCE2 NANDOE, NANDWE A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE
Address Decoders
APB
140
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.3 I/O Lines Description
EBI I/O Lines Description
Function EBI EBI_D0 - EBI_D31 EBI_A0 - EBI_A25 EBI_NWAIT Data Bus Address Bus External Wait Signal SMC EBI_NCS0 - EBI_NCS5 EBI_NWR0 - EBI_NWR3 EBI_NRD EBI_NWE EBI_NBS0 - EBI_NBS3 Chip Select Lines Write Signals Read Signal Write Enable Byte Mask Signals EBI for CompactFlash Support EBI_CFCE1 - EBI_CFCE2 EBI_CFOE EBI_CFWE EBI_CFIOR EBI_CFIOW EBI_CFRNW EBI_CFCS0 - EBI_CFCS1 CompactFlash Chip Enable CompactFlash Output Enable CompactFlash Write Enable CompactFlash I/O Read Signal CompactFlash I/O Write Signal CompactFlash Read Not Write Signal CompactFlash Chip Select Lines EBI for NAND Flash Support EBI_NANDCS EBI_NANDOE EBI_NANDWE NAND Flash Chip Select Line NAND Flash Output Enable NAND Flash Write Enable SDRAM Controller EBI_SDCK EBI_SDCKE EBI_SDCS EBI_BA0 - EBI_BA1 EBI_SDWE EBI_RAS - EBI_CAS EBI_NWR0 - EBI_NWR3 EBI_NBS0 - EBI_NBS3 EBI_SDA10 SDRAM Clock SDRAM Clock Enable SDRAM Controller Chip Select Line Bank Select SDRAM Write Enable Row and Column Signal Write Signals Byte Mask Signals SDRAM Address 10 Line Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Low Low Low Low High Low Output Output Output Low Low Low Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Low Low Low Low Low Low Output Output Output Output Output Low Low Low Low Low I/O Output Input Low Type Active Level
Table 21-1.
Name
141
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The connection of some signals through the MUX logic is not direct and depends on the Memory Controller in use at the moment. Table 21-2 on page 142 details the connections between the two Memory Controllers and the EBI pins. Table 21-2. EBI Pins and Memory Controllers I/O Lines Connections
EBIx Pins(1) EBI_NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR EBI_A0/NBS0 EBI_A1/NBS2/NWR2 EBI_A[11:2] EBI_SDA10 EBI_A12 EBI_A[14:13] EBI_A[22:15] EBI_A[25:23] EBI_D[31:0] SDRAMC I/O Lines NBS1 Not Supported Not Supported SDRAMC_A[9:0] SDRAMC_A10 Not Supported SDRAMC_A[12:11] Not Supported Not Supported D[31:0] SMC I/O Lines NWR1/NUB SMC_A0/NLB SMC_A1 SMC_A[11:2] Not Supported SMC_A12 SMC_A[14:13] SMC_A[22:15] SMC_A[25:23] D[31:0]
142
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.4
21.4.1
Application Example
Hardware Interface Table 21-3 on page 143 details the connections to be applied between the EBI pins and the external devices for each Memory Controller. EBI Pins and External Static Devices Connections
Pins of the Interfaced Device
Table 21-3.
Signals: EBI_ Controller
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 D16 - D23 D24 - D31 A0/NBS0 A1/NWR2/NBS2 A2 - A22 A23 - A25 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NCS2 NCS3/NANDCS NCS4/CFCS0 NCS5/CFCS1 NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE NWR1/NBS1 NWR3/NBS3
8-bit Static Device
2 x 8-bit Static Devices
16-bit Static Device SMC
4 x 8-bit Static Devices
2 x 16-bit Static Devices
32-bit Static Device
D0 - D7 - - - A0 A1 A[2:22] A[23:25] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE - -
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 - - - A0 A[1:21] A[22:24] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE WE -
(1) (1)
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 - - NLB A0 A[1:21] A[22:24] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE NUB -
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 D16 - D23 D24 - D31 - WE(2) A[0:20] A[21:23] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE WE
(2) (2)
D0 - D7 D8 - 15 D16 - D23 D24 - D31 NLB
(3)
D0 - D7 D8 - 15 D16 - D23 D24 - D31 BE0(5) BE2(5) A[0:20] A[21:23] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE BE1(5) BE3(5)
NLB(4) A[0:20] A[21:23] CS CS CS CS CS CS OE WE NUB
(3)
WE(2)
NUB(4)
Notes:
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
NWR1 enables upper byte writes. NWR0 enables lower byte writes. NWRx enables corresponding byte x writes. (x = 0,1,2 or 3) NBS0 and NBS1 enable respectively lower and upper bytes of the lower 16-bit word. NBS2 and NBS3 enable respectively lower and upper bytes of the upper 16-bit word. BEx: Byte x Enable (x = 0,1,2 or 3)
143
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 21-4.
EBI Pins and External Devices Connections
Pins of the Interfaced Device
Signals: EBI_ Controller
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 D16 - D31 A0/NBS0 A1/NWR2/NBS2 A2 - A10 A11 SDA10 A12 A13 - A14 A15 A16/BA0 A17/BA1 A18 - A20 A21/NANDALE A22/NANDCLE A23 - A24 A25 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NCS2 NCS3/NANDCS NCS4/CFCS0 NCS5/CFCS1 NANDOE NANDWE NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE/CFWE NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW CFCE1 CFCE2 SDCK
SDRAM SDRAMC
D0 - D7 D8 - D15 D16 - D31 DQM0 DQM2 A[0:8] A9 A10 - A[11:12] - BA0 BA1 - - - - - - CS - - - - - - - - DQM1 DQM3 - - CLK
CompactFlash (EBI only)
CompactFlash True IDE Mode (EBI only) SMC
NAND Flash
D0 - D7 D8 - 15 - A0 A1 A[2:10] - - - - - - - - - REG - CFRNW - - - - CFCS0 CFCS1 - - OE WE IOR IOW CE1 CE2 -
(1) (1) (1)
D0 - D7 D8 - 15 - A0 A1 A[2:10] - - - - - - - - - REG - CFRNW - - - - CFCS0 CFCS1 - - - WE IOR IOW CS0 CS1 -
(1) (1) (1)
AD0-AD7 AD8-AD15 - - - - - - - - - - - - ALE CLE - - - - - - - - OE WE - - - - - - -
144
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 21-4. EBI Pins and External Devices Connections (Continued)
Pins of the Interfaced Device Signals: EBI_ Controller
SDCKE RAS CAS SDWE NWAIT Pxx Pxx Pxx
(2) (2) (2)
SDRAM SDRAMC
CKE RAS CAS WE - - - -
CompactFlash (EBI only)
CompactFlash True IDE Mode (EBI only) SMC
NAND Flash
- - - - WAIT CD1 or CD2 - -
- - - - WAIT CD1 or CD2 - -
- - - - - - CE RDY
Note:
1. Not directly connected to the CompactFlash slot. Permits the control of the bidirectional buffer between the EBI data bus and the CompactFlash slot. 2. Any PIO line.
145
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.4.2 Connection Examples Figure 21-2 shows an example of connections between the EBI and external devices.
Figure 21-2. EBI Connections to Memory Devices
EBI
D0-D31 RAS CAS SDCK SDCKE SDWE A0/NBS0 NWR1/NBS1 A1/NWR2/NBS2 NWR3/NBS3 NRD/NOE NWR0/NWE
D0-D7
2M x 8 SDRAM
D0-D7
D8-D15
2M x 8 SDRAM
D0-D7
CS CLK CKE SDWE WE RAS CAS DQM NBS0
A0-A9, A11 A10 BA0 BA1
A2-A11, A13 SDA10 A16/BA0 A17/BA1
CS CLK CKE SDWE WE RAS CAS DQM NBS1
A0-A9, A11 A10 BA0 BA1
A2-A11, A13 SDA10 A16/BA0 A17/BA1
SDA10 A2-A15 A16/BA0 A17/BA1 A18-A25
D16-D23 D0-D7 NCS0 NCS1/SDCS NCS2 NCS3 NCS4 NCS5 CS CLK CKE SDWE WE RAS CAS DQM NBS2
2M x 8 SDRAM
D24-D31
2M x 8 SDRAM
D0-D7
A0-A9, A11 A10 BA0 BA1
A2-A11, A13 SDA10 A16/BA0 A17/BA1
CS CLK CKE SDWE WE RAS CAS DQM NBS3
A0-A9, A11 A10 BA0 BA1
A2-A11, A13 SDA10 A16/BA0 A17/BA1
128K x 8 SRAM
D0-D7 D0-D7 A0-A16 A1-A17 D8-D15
128K x 8 SRAM
D0-D7 A0-A16 A1-A17
CS OE NRD/NOE WE A0/NWR0/NBS0
CS OE NRD/NOE WE NWR1/NBS1
21.5
21.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the External Bus Interface may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the External Bus Interface pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the External Bus Interface are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller.
21.6
Functional Description
The EBI transfers data between the internal AHB Bus (handled by the Bus Matrix) and the external memories or peripheral devices. It controls the waveforms and the parameters of the external address, data and control buses and is composed of the following elements: * the Static Memory Controller (SMC) * the SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)
146
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* the ECC Controller (ECC) * a chip select assignment feature that assigns an AHB address space to the external devices * a multiplex controller circuit that shares the pins between the different Memory Controllers * programmable CompactFlash support logic * programmable NAND Flash support logic 21.6.1 Bus Multiplexing The EBI and EBI1 offers a complete set of control signals that share the 32-bit data lines, the address lines of up to 26 bits and the control signals through a multiplex logic operating in function of the memory area requests. Multiplexing is specifically organized in order to guarantee the maintenance of the address and output control lines at a stable state while no external access is being performed. Multiplexing is also designed to respect the data float times defined in the Memory Controllers. Furthermore, refresh cycles of the SDRAM are executed independently by the SDRAM Controller without delaying the other external Memory Controller accesses. 21.6.2 Pull-up Control The EBI_CSA register in the Chip Configuration User Interface permit enabling of on-chip pullup resistors on the data bus lines not multiplexed with the PIO Controller lines. The pull-up resistors are enabled after reset. Setting the EBI_DBPUC bit disables the pull-up resistors on the D0 to D15 lines. Enabling the pull-up resistor on the D16-D31 lines can be performed by programming the appropriate PIO controller. Static Memory Controller For information on the Static Memory Controller, refer to the Static Memory Controller section. SDRAM Controller For information on the SDRAM Controller, refer to the SDRAM section. ECC Controller For information on the ECC Controller, refer to the ECC section. CompactFlash Support The External Bus Interface integrates circuitry that interfaces to CompactFlash devices. The CompactFlash logic is driven by the Static Memory Controller (SMC) on the NCS4 and/or NCS5 address space. Programming the EBI_CS4A and/or EBI_CS5A bit of the EBI_CSA Register in the Chip Configuration User Interface to the appropriate value enables this logic. For details on this register, refer to the in the Bus Matrix Section. Access to an external CompactFlash device is then made by accessing the address space reserved to NCS4 and/or NCS5 (i.e., between 0x5000 0000 and 0x5FFF FFFF for NCS4 and between 0x6000 0000 and 0x6FFF FFFF for NCS5). All CompactFlash modes (Attribute Memory, Common Memory, I/O and True IDE) are supported but the signals _IOIS16 (I/O and True IDE modes) and _ATA SEL (True IDE mode) are not handled.
21.6.3
21.6.4
21.6.5
21.6.6
147
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.6.6.1 I/O Mode, Common Memory Mode, Attribute Memory Mode and True IDE Mode Within the NCS4 and/or NCS5 address space, the current transfer address is used to distinguish I/O mode, common memory mode, attribute memory mode and True IDE mode. The different modes are accessed through a specific memory mapping as illustrated on Figure 21-3. A[23:21] bits of the transfer address are used to select the desired mode as described in Table 21-5 on page 148.
Figure 21-3. CompactFlash Memory Mapping
True IDE Alternate Mode Space Offset 0x00E0 0000 True IDE Mode Space Offset 0x00C0 0000 CF Address Space Offset 0x0080 0000 Common Memory Mode Space Offset 0x0040 0000 Attribute Memory Mode Space Offset 0x0000 0000 I/O Mode Space
Note:
The A22 pin is used to drive the REG signal of the CompactFlash Device (except in True IDE mode).
Table 21-5.
A[23:21] 000 010 100 110 111
CompactFlash Mode Selection
Mode Base Address Attribute Memory Common Memory I/O Mode True IDE Mode Alternate True IDE Mode
21.6.6.2
CFCE1 and CFCE2 Signals To cover all types of access, the SMC must be alternatively set to drive 8-bit data bus or 16-bit data bus. The odd byte access on the D[7:0] bus is only possible when the SMC is configured to drive 8-bit memory devices on the corresponding NCS pin (NCS4 or NCS5). The Chip Select Register (DBW field in the corresponding Chip Select Register) of the NCS4 and/or NCS5 address space must be set as shown in Table 21-6 to enable the required access type. NBS1 and NBS0 are the byte selection signals from SMC and are available when the SMC is set in Byte Select mode on the corresponding Chip Select.
148
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The CFCE1 and CFCE2 waveforms are identical to the corresponding NCSx waveform. For details on these waveforms and timings, refer to the Static Memory Controller section. Table 21-6.
Mode Attribute Memory
CFCE1 and CFCE2 Truth Table
CFCE2 NBS1 NBS1 CFCE1 NBS0 NBS0 0 NBS0 0 DBW 16 bits 16bits 8 bits 16 bits 8 bits Comment Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Odd Byte on D[15:8] Access to Odd Byte on D[7:0] Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Odd Byte on D[15:8] Access to Odd Byte on D[7:0] Byte Select SMC Access Mode Byte Select Byte Select
Common Memory 1 NBS1 I/O Mode 1 True IDE Mode Task File Data Register Alternate True IDE Mode Control Register Alternate Status Read Drive Address Standby Mode or Address Space is not assigned to CF 0 0 1 1 1 1 Don't Care 8 bits - 1 1 0 0 8 bits 16 bits
Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Odd Byte on D[7:0] Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Odd Byte on D[15:8] Byte Select
Access to Even Byte on D[7:0] Access to Odd Byte on D[7:0] -
Don't Care
-
21.6.6.3
Read/Write Signals In I/O mode and True IDE mode, the CompactFlash logic drives the read and write command signals of the SMC on CFIOR and CFIOW signals, while the CFOE and CFWE signals are deactivated. Likewise, in common memory mode and attribute memory mode, the SMC signals are driven on the CFOE and CFWE signals, while the CFIOR and CFIOW are deactivated. Figure 21-4 on page 150 demonstrates a schematic representation of this logic. Attribute memory mode, common memory mode and I/O mode are supported by setting the address setup and hold time on the NCS4 (and/or NCS5) chip select to the appropriate values. For details on these signal waveforms, please refer to the section: Setup and Hold Cycles of the Static Memory Controller section.
149
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 21-4. CompactFlash Read/Write Control Signals
External Bus Interface SMC A23 1 1 0 1 A22 NRD_NOE NWR0_NWE 1 1 0 1
CompactFlash Logic
0 0 1 1 CFOE CFWE
CFIOR CFIOW
Table 21-7.
CompactFlash Mode Selection
CFOE NRD 1 0 CFWE NWR0_NWE 1 1 CFIOR 1 NRD NRD CFIOW 1 NWR0_NWE NWR0_NWE
Mode Base Address Attribute Memory Common Memory I/O Mode True IDE Mode
21.6.6.4
Multiplexing of CompactFlash Signals on EBI Pins Table 21-8 on page 150 and Table 21-9 on page 151 illustrate the multiplexing of the CompactFlash logic signals with other EBI signals on the EBI pins. The EBI pins in Table 21-8 are strictly dedicated to the CompactFlash interface as soon as the EBI_CS4A and/or EBI_CS5A field of the EBI_CSA Register in the Chip Configuration User Interface is set. These pins must not be used to drive any other memory devices. The EBI pins in Table 21-9 on page 151 remain shared between all memory areas when the corresponding CompactFlash interface is enabled (EBI_CS4A = 1 and/or EBI_CS5A = 1).
Table 21-8.
Pins
Dedicated CompactFlash Interface Multiplexing
CompactFlash Signals CS4A = 1 CS5A = 1 CS4A = 0 NCS4 CFCS1 NCS5 EBI Signals CS5A = 0
NCS4/CFCS0 NCS5/CFCS1
CFCS0
150
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 21-9.
Shared CompactFlash Interface Multiplexing
Access to CompactFlash Device Access to Other EBI Devices EBI Signals NRD NWR0/NWE NWR1/NBS1 NWR3/NBS3 A25
Pins NRD/CFOE NWR0/NWE/CFWE NWR1/NBS1/CFIOR NWR3/NBS3/CFIOW A25/CFRNW
CompactFlash Signals CFOE CFWE CFIOR CFIOW CFRNW
21.6.6.5
Application Example Figure 21-5 on page 152 illustrates an example of a CompactFlash application. CFCS0 and CFRNW signals are not directly connected to the CompactFlash slot 0, but do control the direction and the output enable of the buffers between the EBI and the CompactFlash Device. The timing of the CFCS0 signal is identical to the NCS4 signal. Moreover, the CFRNW signal remains valid throughout the transfer, as does the address bus. The CompactFlash _WAIT signal is connected to the NWAIT input of the Static Memory Controller. For details on these waveforms and timings, refer to the Static Memory Controller Section.
151
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 21-5. CompactFlash Application Example
EBI CompactFlash Connector
D[15:0] DIR /OE A25/CFRNW NCS4/CFCS0
D[15:0]
_CD1 CD (PIO) _CD2 /OE A[10:0] A22/REG A[10:0] _REG
NOE/CFOE NWE/CFWE NWR1/CFIOR NWR3/CFIOW
_OE _WE _IORD _IOWR
CFCE1 CFCE2
_CE1 _CE2
NWAIT
_WAIT
21.6.7
NAND Flash Support External Bus Interface integrates circuitry that interfaces to NAND Flash devices. External Bus Interface The NAND Flash logic is driven by the Static Memory Controller on the NCS3 address space. Programming the EBI_CS3A field in the EBI_CSA Register in the Chip Configuration User Interface to the appropriate value enables the NAND Flash logic. For details on this register, refer to the Bus Matrix Section. Access to an external NAND Flash device is then made by accessing the address space reserved to NCS3 (i.e., between 0x4000 0000 and 0x4FFF FFFF). The NAND Flash Logic drives the read and write command signals of the SMC on the NANDOE and NANDWE signals when the NCS3 signal is active. NANDOE and NANDWE are invalidated as soon as the transfer address fails to lie in the NCS3 address space. See Figure "NAND Flash Signal Multiplexing on EBI Pins" on page 153 for more information. For details on these waveforms, refer to the Static Memory Controller section.
21.6.7.1
152
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 21-6. NAND Flash Signal Multiplexing on EBI Pins
SMC NAND Flash Logic
NCSx NRD
NANDOE
NANDOE
NANDWE NWR0_NWE
NANDWE
21.6.7.2
NAND Flash Signals The address latch enable and command latch enable signals on the NAND Flash device are driven by address bits A22 and A21 of the EBI address bus. The command, address or data words on the data bus of the NAND Flash device are distinguished by using their address within the NCSx address space. The chip enable (CE) signal of the device and the ready/busy (R/B) signals are connected to PIO lines. The CE signal then remains asserted even when NCSx is not selected, preventing the device from returning to standby mode.
Figure 21-7. NAND Flash Application Example
D[7:0] A[22:21]
AD[7:0] ALE CLE
NCSx/NANDCS
Not Connected
EBI NAND Flash
NANDOE NANDWE
NOE NWE
PIO PIO
CE R/B
Note:
The External Bus Interfaces 0 and 1 are also able to support 16-bit devices.
153
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.7 Implementation Examples
The following hardware configurations are given for illustration only. The user should refer to the memory manufacturer web site to check current device availability.
21.7.1 21.7.1.1
16-bit SDRAM Hardware Configuration
D[0..15] A[0..14]
(Not used A12)
U1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A13 SDA10 BA0 BA1 A14 SDCKE SDCK 1%6 1%6 CAS RAS SDWE SDA10 BA0 BA1
23 24 25 26 29 30 31 32 33 34 22 35 20 21 36 40
SDCKE SDCK A0 CFIOR_NBS1_NWR1 CAS RAS SDWE SDCS_NCS1
37 38 15 39 17 18 16 19
A0 MT48LC16M16A2 DQ0 A1 DQ1 A2 DQ2 A3 DQ3 A4 DQ4 A5 DQ5 A6 DQ6 A7 DQ7 A8 DQ8 A9 DQ9 A10 DQ10 A11 DQ11 DQ12 BA0 DQ13 BA1 DQ14 DQ15 A12 N.C VDD VDD CKE VDD VDDQ CLK VDDQ VDDQ DQML VDDQ DQMH VSS CAS VSS RAS VSS VSSQ VSSQ WE VSSQ CS VSSQ
2 4 5 7 8 10 11 13 42 44 45 47 48 50 51 53 1 14 27 3 9 43 49 28 41 54 6 12 46 52
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 3V3 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
TSOP54 PACKAGE
256 Mbits
21.7.1.2
Software Configuration The following configuration has to be performed: * Assign the EBI CS1 to the SDRAM controller by setting the bit EBI_CS1A in the EBI Chip Select Assignment Register located in the bus matrix memory space. * Initialize the SDRAM Controller depending on the SDRAM device and system bus frequency. The Data Bus Width is to be programmed to 16 bits. The SDRAM initialization sequence is described in the section "SDRAM Device Initialization" in "SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)".
154
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.7.2 21.7.2.1
D[0..31] A[0..14]
32-bit SDRAM Hardware Configuration
(Not used A12)
U1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A13 SDA10 BA0 BA1 A14 SDCKE SDCK 1%6 1%6 CAS RAS SDWE SDA10 BA0 BA1 23 24 25 26 29 30 31 32 33 34 22 35 20 21 36 40 SDCKE SDCK A0 CFIOR_NBS1_NWR1 CAS RAS SDWE 37 38 15 39 17 18 16 19 A0 MT48LC16M16A2 DQ0 A1 DQ1 A2 DQ2 A3 DQ3 A4 DQ4 A5 DQ5 A6 DQ6 A7 DQ7 A8 DQ8 A9 DQ9 A10 DQ10 A11 DQ11 DQ12 BA0 DQ13 BA1 DQ14 DQ15 A12 N.C VDD VDD CKE VDD VDDQ CLK VDDQ VDDQ DQML VDDQ DQMH VSS CAS VSS RAS VSS VSSQ VSSQ WE VSSQ CS VSSQ 2 4 5 7 8 10 11 13 42 44 45 47 48 50 51 53 1 14 27 3 9 43 49 28 41 54 6 12 46 52 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 3V3 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 SDA10 A13 BA0 BA1 A14 SDCKE SDCK A1 CFIOW_NBS3_NWR3 1%6 1%6 CAS RAS SDWE 23 24 25 26 29 30 31 32 33 34 22 35 20 21 36 40 37 38 15 39 17 18 16 19
U2 A0 MT48LC16M16A2 DQ0 A1 DQ1 A2 DQ2 A3 DQ3 A4 DQ4 A5 DQ5 A6 DQ6 A7 DQ7 A8 DQ8 A9 DQ9 A10 DQ10 A11 DQ11 DQ12 BA0 DQ13 BA1 DQ14 DQ15 A12 N.C VDD VDD CKE VDD VDDQ CLK VDDQ VDDQ DQML VDDQ DQMH VSS CAS VSS RAS VSS VSSQ VSSQ WE VSSQ CS VSSQ 2 4 5 7 8 10 11 13 42 44 45 47 48 50 51 53 1 14 27 3 9 43 49 28 41 54 6 12 46 52 D16 D17 D18 D19 D20 D21 D22 D23 D24 D25 D26 D27 D28 D29 D30 D31 3V3 C8 C9 C10 C11 C12 C13 C14 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF 100NF
SDCS_NCS1
256 Mbits
TSOP54 PACKAGE
256 Mbits
21.7.2.2
Software Configuration The following configuration has to be performed: * Assign the EBI CS1 to the SDRAM controller by setting the bit EBI_CS1A in the EBI Chip Select Assignment Register located in the bus matrix memory space. * Initialize the SDRAM Controller depending on the SDRAM device and system bus frequency. The Data Bus Width is to be programmed to 32 bits. The data lines D[16..31] are multiplexed with PIO lines and thus the dedicated PIOs must be programmed in peripheral mode in the PIO controller. The SDRAM initialization sequence is described in the section "SDRAM Device Initialization" in "SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)".
155
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
21.7.3 21.7.3.1
8-bit NAND Flash Hardware Configuration
D[0..7]
U1 CLE ALE NANDOE NANDWE (ANY PIO) (ANY PIO) 3V3 R1 R2 10K 10K 1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 14 15 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 16 17 8 18 9 7 19 CLE ALE RE WE CE R/B WP N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C
K9F2G08U0M I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7 N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C PRE N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C VCC VCC VSS VSS 29 30 31 32 41 42 43 44 48 47 46 45 40 39 38 35 34 33 28 27 37 12 36 13 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
3V3
C2 100NF C1 100NF
TSOP48 PACKAGE
2 Gb
21.7.3.2
Software Configuration The following configuration has to be performed: * Assign the EBI CS3 to the NAND Flash by setting the bit EBI_CS3A in the EBI Chip Select Assignment Register located in the bus matrix memory space * Reserve A21 / A22 for ALE / CLE functions. Address and Command Latches are controlled respectively by setting to 1 the address bit A21 and A22 during accesses. * NANDOE and NANDWE signals are multiplexed with PIO lines and thus the dedicated PIOs must be programmed in peripheral mode in the PIO controller. * A21/NANDALE and A22/NANDCLE signals are multiplexed with PIO lines and thus the dedicated PIOs must be programmed in peripheral mode in the PIO controller. * Configure a PIO line as an input to manage the Ready/Busy signal. * Configure Static Memory Controller CS3 Setup, Pulse, Cycle and Mode accordingly to NAND Flash timings, the data bus width and the system bus frequency.
156
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.7.4 21.7.4.1 16-bit NAND Flash Hardware Configuration
D[0..15]
U1 CLE ALE NANDOE NANDWE (ANY PIO) (ANY PIO) 3V3 R1 R2 10K 10K 1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 14 15 20 21 22 23 24 34 35 16 17 8 18 9 7 19 CLE ALE RE WE CE R/B WP N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C N.C
MT29F2G16AABWP-ET I/O0 26 I/O1 28 I/O2 30 I/O3 32 I/O4 40 I/O5 42 I/O6 44 I/O7 46 I/O8 27 I/O9 29 I/O10 31 I/O11 33 I/O12 41 I/O13 43 I/O14 45 I/O15 47 N.C PRE N.C VCC VCC VSS VSS VSS 39 38 36 37 12 48 25 13
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15
3V3
C2 100NF C1 100NF
TSOP48 PACKAGE
2 Gb
21.7.4.2
Software Configuration The software configuration is the same as for an 8-bit NAND Flash except the data bus width programmed in the mode register of the Static Memory Controller.
157
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
21.7.5 21.7.5.1
NOR Flash on NCS0 Hardware Configuration
D[0..15] A[1..22] U1 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22
25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 48 17 16 15 10 9 12 11 14 13 26 28
A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 RESET WE WP VPP CE OE
DQ0 DQ1 DQ2 DQ3 DQ4 DQ5 DQ6 DQ7 DQ8 DQ9 DQ10 DQ11 DQ12 DQ13 DQ14 DQ15
AT49BV6416
29 31 33 35 38 40 42 44 30 32 34 36 39 41 43 45
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15
3V3
NRST NWE 3V3 NCS0 NRD
VCCQ VCC VSS VSS
47 37 46 27
C2 100NF
TSOP48 PACKAGE
21.7.5.2
C1 100NF
Software Configuration The default configuration for the Static Memory Controller, byte select mode, 16-bit data bus, Read/Write controlled by Chip Select, allows boot on 16-bit non-volatile memory at slow clock. For another configuration, configure the Static Memory Controller CS0 Setup, Pulse, Cycle and Mode depending on Flash timings and system bus frequency.
158
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.7.6 21.7.6.1 Compact Flash Hardware Configuration
D[0..15] MN1A D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8
MEMORY & I/O MODE
J1
3V3 C1 100NF C2 100NF
A2 A1 B2 B1 C2 C1 D2 D1 A3 A4
1B1 1B2 1B3 1B4 1B5 1B6 1B7 1B8 1DIR 1OE
1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 1A5 1A6 1A7 1A8
A5 A6 B5 B6 C5 C6 D5 D6
CF_D15 CF_D14 CF_D13 CF_D12 CF_D11 CF_D10 CF_D9 CF_D8
74ALVCH32245 MN1B D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 A25/CFRNW CFCSx (CFCS0 or CFCS1) (ANY PIO) &$5' '(7(&7 A[0..10] MN1C A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 3V3
E2 E1 F2 F1 G2 G1 H2 H1 H3 H4
2B1 2B2 2B3 2B4 2B5 2B6 2B7 2B8 2DIR 2OE
2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 2A5 2A6 2A7 2A8
E5 E6 F5 F6 G5 G6 H5 H6
CF_D7 CF_D6 CF_D5 CF_D4 CF_D3 CF_D2 CF_D1 CF_D0
CF_D15 CF_D14 CF_D13 CF_D12 CF_D11 CF_D10 CF_D9 CF_D8 CF_D7 CF_D6 CF_D5 CF_D4 CF_D3 CF_D2 CF_D1 CF_D0 CD2 CD1 CF_A10 CF_A9 CF_A8 CF_A7 CF_A6 CF_A5 CF_A4 CF_A3 CF_A2 CF_A1 CF_A0 REG
31 30 29 28 27 49 48 47 6 5 4 3 2 23 22 21 25 26 8 10 11 12 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 44 36 9 35 34 32 7 24
D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CD2# CD1# A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 REG# WE# OE# IOWR# IORD# CE2# CE1# WP WAIT# RESET
VCC VCC GND GND
38 13 50 1
3V3
4 6 5
74ALVCH32245 MN2B SN74ALVC32
R1 MN2A 47K SN74ALVC32
R2 47K CD2 CD1
1 2
3
J5 J6 K5 K6 L5 L6 M5 M6 J3 J4
3A1 3A2 3A3 3A4 3A5 3A6 3A7 3A8 3DIR 3OE
3B1 3B2 3B3 3B4 3B5 3B6 3B7 3B8
J2 J1 K2 K1 L2 L1 M2 M1
CF_A10 CF_A9 CF_A8 CF_A7 CF_A6 CF_A5 CF_A4 CF_A3
WE OE IOWR IORD CE2 CE1
CSEL# INPACK# BVD2 BVD1
39 43 45 46
WAIT# RESET
42 41
VS2# VS1# RDY/BSY
40 33 37
RDY/BSY
74ALVCH32245 MN1D A2 A1 A0 A22/REG CFWE CFOE CFIOW CFIOR
N5 N6 P5 P6 R5 R6 T6 T5 T3 T4
4A1 4A2 4A3 4A4 4A5 4A6 4A7 4A8 4DIR 4OE
4B1 4B2 4B3 4B4 4B5 4B6 4B7 4B8
N2 N1 P2 P1 R2 R1 T1 T2
CF_A2 CF_A1 CF_A0 REG WE OE IOWR IORD
N7E50-7516VY-20
74ALVCH32245
1
CFCE2
2
MN3A SN74ALVC125 3
CE2
4
CFCE1
5
MN3B SN74ALVC125 6
CE1
10
(ANY PIO) CFRST
9
MN3C SN74ALVC125 RESET 8
13
(ANY PIO) CFIRQ
11
MN3D R3 SN74ALVC125 10K RDY/BSY 12
3V3
MN4 3V3 NWAIT
5 VCC 4
1 2 3
WAIT#
R4 10K 3V3
GND
SN74LVC1G125-Q1
159
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
21.7.6.2
Software Configuration The following configuration has to be performed: * Assign the EBI CS4 and/or EBI_CS5 to the CompactFlash Slot 0 or/and Slot 1 by setting the bit EBI_CS4A or/and EBI_CS5A in the EBI Chip Select Assignment Register located in the bus matrix memory space. * The address line A23 is to select I/O (A23=1) or Memory mode (A23=0) and the address line A22 for REG function. * A23, CFRNW, CFS0, CFCS1, CFCE1 and CFCE2 signals are multiplexed with PIO lines and thus the dedicated PIOs must be programmed in peripheral mode in the PIO controller. * Configure a PIO line as an output for CFRST and two others as an input for CFIRQ and CARD DETECT functions respectively. * Configure SMC CS4 and/or SMC_CS5 (for Slot 0 or 1) Setup, Pulse, Cycle and Mode accordingly to Compact Flash timings and system bus frequency.
160
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
21.7.7 21.7.7.1 Compact Flash True IDE Hardware Configuration
D[0..15] MN1A D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8
TRUE IDE MODE
J1
3V3
A2 A1 B2 B1 C2 C1 D2 D1 A3 A4
1B1 1B2 1B3 1B4 1B5 1B6 1B7 1B8 1DIR 1OE
1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 1A5 1A6 1A7 1A8
A5 A6 B5 B6 C5 C6 D5 D6
CF_D15 CF_D14 CF_D13 CF_D12 CF_D11 CF_D10 CF_D9 CF_D8
74ALVCH32245 MN1B D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 A25/CFRNW CFCSx (CFCS0 or CFCS1) (ANY PIO) &$5' '(7(&7 A[0..10] A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 3V3 MN1C CF_A10 CF_A9 CF_A8 CF_A7 CF_A6 CF_A5 CF_A4 CF_A3
E2 E1 F2 F1 G2 G1 H2 H1 H3 H4
2B1 2B2 2B3 2B4 2B5 2B6 2B7 2B8 2DIR 2OE
2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 2A5 2A6 2A7 2A8
E5 E6 F5 F6 G5 G6 H5 H6
CF_D7 CF_D6 CF_D5 CF_D4 CF_D3 CF_D2 CF_D1 CF_D0
CF_D15 CF_D14 CF_D13 CF_D12 CF_D11 CF_D10 CF_D9 CF_D8 CF_D7 CF_D6 CF_D5 CF_D4 CF_D3 CF_D2 CF_D1 CF_D0 CD2 CD1
31 30 29 28 27 49 48 47 6 5 4 3 2 23 22 21 25 26 8 10 11 12 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 44 36 9 35 34 32 7 24
D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 CD2# CD1# A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 REG# WE# ATA SEL# IOWR# IORD# CS1# CS0# IOIS16# IORDY RESET#
N7E50-7516VY-20
VCC VCC GND GND
38 13 50 1
C1 100NF C2 100NF
3V3
4 6 5
74ALVCH32245 MN2B SN74ALVC32
R1 MN2A 47K SN74ALVC32
R2 47K CD2 CD1 CF_A2 CF_A1 CF_A0 3V3
1 2
3
J5 J6 K5 K6 L5 L6 M5 M6 J3 J4
3A1 3A2 3A3 3A4 3A5 3A6 3A7 3A8 3DIR 3OE
3B1 3B2 3B3 3B4 3B5 3B6 3B7 3B8
J2 J1 K2 K1 L2 L1 M2 M1
CSEL# INPACK# DASP# PDIAG#
39 43 45 46
IOWR IORD CE2 CE1
IORDY RESET#
42 41
VS2# VS1# INTRQ
40 33 37
INTRQ
74ALVCH32245 MN1D A2 A1 A0 A22/REG CFWE CFOE CFIOW CFIOR
N5 N6 P5 P6 R5 R6 T6 T5 T3 T4
4A1 4A2 4A3 4A4 4A5 4A6 4A7 4A8 4DIR 4OE
4B1 4B2 4B3 4B4 4B5 4B6 4B7 4B8
N2 N1 P2 P1 R2 R1 T1 T2
CF_A2 CF_A1 CF_A0 REG WE OE IOWR IORD
74ALVCH32245
1
CFCE2
2
MN3A SN74ALVC125 3
CE2
4
CFCE1
5 10
MN3B SN74ALVC125 6
CE1
(ANY PIO)
CFRST
9 13
MN3C SN74ALVC125 RESET# 8
(ANY PIO)
CFIRQ
11
MN3D SN74ALVC125 INTRQ 12
R3 10K 3V3
MN4 3V3 NWAIT
5 VCC 4
1 2 3
IORDY
R4 10K 3V3
GND
SN74LVC1G125-Q1
161
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
21.7.7.2
Software Configuration The following configuration has to be performed: * Assign the EBI CS4 and/or EBI_CS5 to the CompactFlash Slot 0 or/and Slot 1 by setting the bit EBI_CS4A or/and EBI_CS5A in the EBI Chip Select Assignment Register located in the bus matrix memory space. * The address line A21 is to select Alternate True IDE (A21=1) or True IDE (A21=0) modes. * CFRNW, CFS0, CFCS1, CFCE1 and CFCE2 signals are multiplexed with PIO lines and thus the dedicated PIOs must be programmed in peripheral mode in the PIO controller. * Configure a PIO line as an output for CFRST and two others as an input for CFIRQ and CARD DETECT functions respectively. * Configure SMC CS4 and/or SMC_CS5 (for Slot 0 or 1) Setup, Pulse, Cycle and Mode accordingly to Compact Flash timings and system bus frequency.
162
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22. Static Memory Controller (SMC)
22.1 Description
The Static Memory Controller (SMC) generates the signals that control the access to the external memory devices or peripheral devices. It has 6 Chip Selects and a 26-bit address bus. The 32-bit data bus can be configured to interface with 8-, 16-, or 32-bit external devices. Separate read and write control signals allow for direct memory and peripheral interfacing. Read and write signal waveforms are fully parametrizable. The SMC can manage wait requests from external devices to extend the current access. The SMC is provided with an automatic slow clock mode. In slow clock mode, it switches from userprogrammed waveforms to slow-rate specific waveforms on read and write signals. The SMC supports asynchronous burst read in page mode access for page size up to 32 bytes.
22.2
I/O Lines Description
I/O Line Description
Description Static Memory Controller Chip Select Lines Read Signal Write 0/Write Enable Signal Address Bit 0/Byte 0 Select Signal Write 1/Byte 1 Select Signal Address Bit 1/Write 2/Byte 2 Select Signal Write 3/Byte 3 Select Signal Address Bus Data Bus External Wait Signal Type Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output I/O Input Low Active Level Low Low Low Low Low Low Low
Table 22-1.
Name NCS[7:0] NRD NWR0/NWE A0/NBS0 NWR1/NBS1
A1/NWR2/NBS2 NWR3/NBS3 A[25:2] D[31:0] NWAIT
22.3
Multiplexed Signals
Static Memory Controller (SMC) Multiplexed Signals
Related Function Byte-write or byte-select access, see "Byte Write or Byte Select Access" on page 165 8-bit or 16-/32-bit data bus, see "Data Bus Width" on page 165 Byte-write or byte-select access see "Byte Write or Byte Select Access" on page 165 NBS2 8-/16-bit or 32-bit data bus, see "Data Bus Width" on page 165. Byte-write or byte-select access, see "Byte Write or Byte Select Access" on page 165 Byte-write or byte-select access see "Byte Write or Byte Select Access" on page 165
Table 22-2.
Multiplexed Signals NWR0 A0 NWR1 A1 NWR3 NWE NBS0 NBS1 NWR2 NBS3
163
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.4
22.4.1
Application Example
Hardware Interface
Figure 22-1. SMC Connections to Static Memory Devices
D0-D31
A0/NBS0 NWR0/NWE NWR1/NBS1 A1/NWR2/NBS2 NWR3/NBS3
D0 - D7
128K x 8 SRAM
D0 - D7 CS A0 - A16 A2 - A18
D8-D15
128K x 8 SRAM
D0-D7 CS A0 - A16 A2 - A18
NCS0 NCS1 NCS2 NCS3 NCS4 NCS5 NCS6 NCS7
NRD NWR0/NWE
OE WE
NRD NWR1/NBS1
OE WE
D16 - D23 A2 - A25 CS
128K x 8 SRAM
D0 - D7
D24-D31
128K x 8 SRAM
D0-D7 CS A2 - A18 A0 - A16
A0 - A16 NRD A1/NWR2/NBS2 OE WE
A2 - A18 NRD OE NWR3/NBS3 WE
Static Memory Controller
22.5
22.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the Static Memory Controller may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the Static Memory Controller pins to their peripheral function. If I/O Lines of the SMC are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller.
164
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.6 External Memory Mapping
The SMC provides up to 26 address lines, A[25:0]. This allows each chip select line to address up to 64 Mbytes of memory. If the physical memory device connected on one chip select is smaller than 64 Mbytes, it wraps around and appears to be repeated within this space. The SMC correctly handles any valid access to the memory device within the page (see Figure 22-2). A[25:0] is only significant for 8-bit memory, A[25:1] is used for 16-bit memory, A[25:2] is used for 32-bit memory. Figure 22-2. Memory Connections for Eight External Devices
NCS[0] - NCS[7] NRD
NCS7 NCS6 NCS5 NCS4 NCS3 NCS2 NCS1 NCS0
Memory Enable Memory Enable
SMC
NWE A[25:0] D[31:0]
Memory Enable Memory Enable
Memory Enable Memory Enable
Memory Enable
Memory Enable Output Enable Write Enable A[25:0]
8 or 16 or 32
D[31:0] or D[15:0] or D[7:0]
22.7
22.7.1
Connection to External Devices
Data Bus Width A data bus width of 8, 16, or 32 bits can be selected for each chip select. This option is controlled by the field DBW in SMC_MODE (Mode Register) for the corresponding chip select. Figure 22-3 shows how to connect a 512K x 8-bit memory on NCS2. Figure 22-4 shows how to connect a 512K x 16-bit memory on NCS2. Figure 22-5 shows two 16-bit memories connected as a single 32-bit memory
22.7.2
Byte Write or Byte Select Access Each chip select with a 16-bit or 32-bit data bus can operate with one of two different types of write access: byte write or byte select access. This is controlled by the BAT field of the SMC_MODE register for the corresponding chip select.
165
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-3.
Memory Connection for an 8-bit Data Bus
D[7:0] A[18:2] A0 SMC A1 NWE NRD NCS[2] D[7:0]
A[18:2] A0 A1 Write Enable Output Enable Memory Enable
Figure 22-4.
Memory Connection for a 16-bit Data Bus
D[15:0] A[19:2] A1 SMC NBS0 NBS1 NWE NRD NCS[2] D[15:0] A[18:1] A[0] Low Byte Enable High Byte Enable Write Enable Output Enable Memory Enable
Figure 22-5. Memory Connection for a 32-bit Data Bus
D[31:16] D[15:0] A[20:2] D[31:16] D[15:0] A[18:0] Byte 0 Enable Byte 1 Enable Byte 2 Enable Byte 3 Enable Write Enable Output Enable Memory Enable
SMC
NBS0 NBS1 NBS2 NBS3 NWE NRD NCS[2]
166
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.7.2.1 Byte Write Access Byte write access supports one byte write signal per byte of the data bus and a single read signal. Note that the SMC does not allow boot in Byte Write Access mode. * For 16-bit devices: the SMC provides NWR0 and NWR1 write signals for respectively byte0 (lower byte) and byte1 (upper byte) of a 16-bit bus. One single read signal (NRD) is provided. Byte Write Access is used to connect 2 x 8-bit devices as a 16-bit memory. * For 32-bit devices: NWR0, NWR1, NWR2 and NWR3, are the write signals of byte0 (lower byte), byte1, byte2 and byte 3 (upper byte) respectively. One single read signal (NRD) is provided. Byte Write Access is used to connect 4 x 8-bit devices as a 32-bit memory. Byte Write option is illustrated on Figure 22-6. 22.7.2.2 Byte Select Access In this mode, read/write operations can be enabled/disabled at a byte level. One byte-select line per byte of the data bus is provided. One NRD and one NWE signal control read and write. * For 16-bit devices: the SMC provides NBS0 and NBS1 selection signals for respectively byte0 (lower byte) and byte1 (upper byte) of a 16-bit bus. Byte Select Access is used to connect one 16-bit device. * For 32-bit devices: NBS0, NBS1, NBS2 and NBS3, are the selection signals of byte0 (lower byte), byte1, byte2 and byte 3 (upper byte) respectively. Byte Select Access is used to connect two 16-bit devices. Figure 22-7 shows how to connect two 16-bit devices on a 32-bit data bus in Byte Select Access mode, on NCS3 (BAT = Byte Select Access).
167
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-6.
Connection of 2 x 8-bit Devices on a 16-bit Bus: Byte Write Option
D[7:0] D[15:8] A[24:2] A[23:1] A[0] Write Enable Read Enable Memory Enable D[7:0]
SMC
A1 NWR0 NWR1 NRD NCS[3]
D[15:8] A[23:1] A[0] Write Enable Read Enable Memory Enable
22.7.2.3
Signal Multiplexing Depending on the BAT, only the write signals or the byte select signals are used. To save IOs at the external bus interface, control signals at the SMC interface are multiplexed. Table 22-3 shows signal multiplexing depending on the data bus width and the byte access type. For 32-bit devices, bits A0 and A1 are unused. For 16-bit devices, bit A0 of address is unused. When Byte Select Option is selected, NWR1 to NWR3 are unused. When Byte Write option is selected, NBS0 to NBS3 are unused.
168
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-7. Connection of 2x16-bit Data Bus on a 32-bit Data Bus (Byte Select Option)
D[15:0] D[31:16] A[25:2] NWE NBS0 NBS1 A[23:0] Write Enable Low Byte Enable High Byte Enable D[15:0]
SMC
NBS2 NBS3 NRD NCS[3] Read Enable Memory Enable
D[31:16] A[23:0] Write Enable Low Byte Enable High Byte Enable Read Enable Memory Enable
Table 22-3.
Signal Name Device Type
SMC Multiplexed Signal Translation
32-bit Bus 1x32-bit Byte Select NBS0 NWE NBS1 NBS2 NBS3 2x16-bit Byte Select NBS0 NWE NBS1 NBS2 NBS3 NWR0 NWR1 NWR2 NWR3 4 x 8-bit Byte Write 16-bit Bus 1x16-bit Byte Select NBS0 NWE NBS1 A1 NWR0 NWR1 A1 A1 2 x 8-bit Byte Write A0 NWE 8-bit Bus 1 x 8-bit
Byte Access Type (BAT) NBS0_A0 NWE_NWR0 NBS1_NWR1 NBS2_NWR2_A1 NBS3_NWR3
22.8
Standard Read and Write Protocols
In the following sections, the byte access type is not considered. Byte select lines (NBS0 to NBS3) always have the same timing as the A address bus. NWE represents either the NWE signal in byte select access type or one of the byte write lines (NWR0 to NWR3) in byte write access type. NWR0 to NWR3 have the same timings and protocol as NWE. In the same way, NCS represents one of the NCS[0..5] chip select lines.
169
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.8.1
Read Waveforms The read cycle is shown on Figure 22-8. The read cycle starts with the address setting on the memory address bus, i.e.: {A[25:2], A1, A0} for 8-bit devices {A[25:2], A1} for 16-bit devices A[25:2] for 32-bit devices.
Figure 22-8. Standard Read Cycle
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0,NBS1, NBS2,NBS3, A0, A1 NRD
NCS
D[31:0] NRD_SETUP NRD_PULSE NRD_HOLD
NCS_RD_SETUP
NCS_RD_PULSE NRD_CYCLE
NCS_RD_HOLD
22.8.1.1
NRD Waveform The NRD signal is characterized by a setup timing, a pulse width and a hold timing. 1. NRD_SETUP: the NRD setup time is defined as the setup of address before the NRD falling edge; 2. NRD_PULSE: the NRD pulse length is the time between NRD falling edge and NRD rising edge; 3. NRD_HOLD: the NRD hold time is defined as the hold time of address after the NRD rising edge.
170
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.8.1.2 NCS Waveform Similarly, the NCS signal can be divided into a setup time, pulse length and hold time: 1. NCS_RD_SETUP: the NCS setup time is defined as the setup time of address before the NCS falling edge. 2. NCS_RD_PULSE: the NCS pulse length is the time between NCS falling edge and NCS rising edge; 3. NCS_RD_HOLD: the NCS hold time is defined as the hold time of address after the NCS rising edge. 22.8.1.3 Read Cycle The NRD_CYCLE time is defined as the total duration of the read cycle, i.e., from the time where address is set on the address bus to the point where address may change. The total read cycle time is equal to: NRD_CYCLE = NRD_SETUP + NRD_PULSE + NRD_HOLD = NCS_RD_SETUP + NCS_RD_PULSE + NCS_RD_HOLD All NRD and NCS timings are defined separately for each chip select as an integer number of Master Clock cycles. To ensure that the NRD and NCS timings are coherent, user must define the total read cycle instead of the hold timing. NRD_CYCLE implicitly defines the NRD hold time and NCS hold time as: NRD_HOLD = NRD_CYCLE - NRD SETUP - NRD PULSE NCS_RD_HOLD = NRD_CYCLE - NCS_RD_SETUP - NCS_RD_PULSE 22.8.1.4 Null Delay Setup and Hold If null setup and hold parameters are programmed for NRD and/or NCS, NRD and NCS remain active continuously in case of consecutive read cycles in the same memory (see Figure 22-9).
171
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-9. No Setup, No Hold On NRD and NCS Read Signals
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0,NBS1, NBS2,NBS3, A0, A1 NRD
NCS
D[31:0] NRD_PULSE NRD_PULSE NRD_PULSE
NCS_RD_PULSE
NCS_RD_PULSE
NCS_RD_PULSE
NRD_CYCLE
NRD_CYCLE
NRD_CYCLE
22.8.1.5
Null Pulse Programming null pulse is not permitted. Pulse must be at least set to 1. A null value leads to unpredictable behavior.
22.8.2
Read Mode As NCS and NRD waveforms are defined independently of one other, the SMC needs to know when the read data is available on the data bus. The SMC does not compare NCS and NRD timings to know which signal rises first. The READ_MODE parameter in the SMC_MODE register of the corresponding chip select indicates which signal of NRD and NCS controls the read operation.
22.8.2.1
Read is Controlled by NRD (READ_MODE = 1): Figure 22-10 shows the waveforms of a read operation of a typical asynchronous RAM. The read data is available tPACC after the falling edge of NRD, and turns to `Z' after the rising edge of NRD. In this case, the READ_MODE must be set to 1 (read is controlled by NRD), to indicate that data is available with the rising edge of NRD. The SMC samples the read data internally on the rising edge of Master Clock that generates the rising edge of NRD, whatever the programmed waveform of NCS may be.
172
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-10. READ_MODE = 1: Data is sampled by SMC before the rising edge of NRD
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0,NBS1, NBS2,NBS3, A0, A1 NRD
NCS tPACC D[31:0]
Data Sampling
22.8.2.2
Read is Controlled by NCS (READ_MODE = 0) Figure 22-11 shows the typical read cycle of an LCD module. The read data is valid tPACC after the falling edge of the NCS signal and remains valid until the rising edge of NCS. Data must be sampled when NCS is raised. In that case, the READ_MODE must be set to 0 (read is controlled by NCS): the SMC internally samples the data on the rising edge of Master Clock that generates the rising edge of NCS, whatever the programmed waveform of NRD may be.
Figure 22-11. READ_MODE = 0: Data is sampled by SMC before the rising edge of NCS
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0,NBS1, NBS2,NBS3, A0, A1 NRD
NCS tPACC D[31:0]
Data Sampling
173
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.8.3
Write Waveforms The write protocol is similar to the read protocol. It is depicted in Figure 22-12. The write cycle starts with the address setting on the memory address bus. NWE Waveforms The NWE signal is characterized by a setup timing, a pulse width and a hold timing. 1. NWE_SETUP: the NWE setup time is defined as the setup of address and data before the NWE falling edge; 2. NWE_PULSE: The NWE pulse length is the time between NWE falling edge and NWE rising edge; 3. NWE_HOLD: The NWE hold time is defined as the hold time of address and data after the NWE rising edge. The NWE waveforms apply to all byte-write lines in Byte Write access mode: NWR0 to NWR3.
22.8.3.1
22.8.3.2
NCS Waveforms The NCS signal waveforms in write operation are not the same that those applied in read operations, but are separately defined: 1. NCS_WR_SETUP: the NCS setup time is defined as the setup time of address before the NCS falling edge. 2. NCS_WR_PULSE: the NCS pulse length is the time between NCS falling edge and NCS rising edge; 3. NCS_WR_HOLD: the NCS hold time is defined as the hold time of address after the NCS rising edge.
Figure 22-12. Write Cycle
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NWE
NCS
NWE_SETUP NCS_WR_SETUP
NWE_PULSE
NWE_HOLD
NCS_WR_PULSE NWE_CYCLE
NCS_WR_HOLD
174
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.8.3.3 Write Cycle The write_cycle time is defined as the total duration of the write cycle, that is, from the time where address is set on the address bus to the point where address may change. The total write cycle time is equal to: NWE_CYCLE = NWE_SETUP + NWE_PULSE + NWE_HOLD = NCS_WR_SETUP + NCS_WR_PULSE + NCS_WR_HOLD All NWE and NCS (write) timings are defined separately for each chip select as an integer number of Master Clock cycles. To ensure that the NWE and NCS timings are coherent, the user must define the total write cycle instead of the hold timing. This implicitly defines the NWE hold time and NCS (write) hold times as: NWE_HOLD = NWE_CYCLE - NWE_SETUP - NWE_PULSE NCS_WR_HOLD = NWE_CYCLE - NCS_WR_SETUP - NCS_WR_PULSE 22.8.3.4 Null Delay Setup and Hold If null setup parameters are programmed for NWE and/or NCS, NWE and/or NCS remain active continuously in case of consecutive write cycles in the same memory (see Figure 22-13). However, for devices that perform write operations on the rising edge of NWE or NCS, such as SRAM, either a setup or a hold must be programmed.
Figure 22-13. Null Setup and Hold Values of NCS and NWE in Write Cycle
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NWE, NWR0, NWR1, NWR2, NWR3
NCS
D[31:0] NWE_PULSE NWE_PULSE NWE_PULSE
NCS_WR_PULSE
NCS_WR_PULSE
NCS_WR_PULSE
NWE_CYCLE
NWE_CYCLE
NWE_CYCLE
22.8.3.5
Null Pulse Programming null pulse is not permitted. Pulse must be at least set to 1. A null value leads to unpredictable behavior.
175
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.8.4
Write Mode The WRITE_MODE parameter in the SMC_MODE register of the corresponding chip select indicates which signal controls the write operation.
22.8.4.1
Write is Controlled by NWE (WRITE_MODE = 1): Figure 22-14 shows the waveforms of a write operation with WRITE_MODE set to 1. The data is put on the bus during the pulse and hold steps of the NWE signal. The internal data buffers are turned out after the NWE_SETUP time, and until the end of the write cycle, regardless of the programmed waveform on NCS.
Figure 22-14. WRITE_MODE = 1. The write operation is controlled by NWE
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NWE, NWR0, NWR1, NWR2, NWR3 NCS D[31:0]
22.8.4.2
Write is Controlled by NCS (WRITE_MODE = 0) Figure 22-15 shows the waveforms of a write operation with WRITE_MODE set to 0. The data is put on the bus during the pulse and hold steps of the NCS signal. The internal data buffers are turned out after the NCS_WR_SETUP time, and until the end of the write cycle, regardless of the programmed waveform on NWE.
176
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-15. WRITE_MODE = 0. The write operation is controlled by NCS
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NWE, NWR0, NWR1, NWR2, NWR3
NCS
D[31:0]
22.8.5
Coding Timing Parameters All timing parameters are defined for one chip select and are grouped together in one SMC_REGISTER according to their type. The SMC_SETUP register groups the definition of all setup parameters: * NRD_SETUP, NCS_RD_SETUP, NWE_SETUP, NCS_WR_SETUP The SMC_PULSE register groups the definition of all pulse parameters: * NRD_PULSE, NCS_RD_PULSE, NWE_PULSE, NCS_WR_PULSE The SMC_CYCLE register groups the definition of all cycle parameters: * NRD_CYCLE, NWE_CYCLE Table 22-4 shows how the timing parameters are coded and their permitted range.
Table 22-4.
Coding and Range of Timing Parameters
Permitted Range
Coded Value setup [5:0] pulse [6:0] cycle [8:0]
Number of Bits 6 7 9
Effective Value 128 x setup[5] + setup[4:0] 256 x pulse[6] + pulse[5:0] 256 x cycle[8:7] + cycle[6:0]
Coded Value 0 31 0 63 0 127
Effective Value 128 128+31 256 256+63 256 256+127 512 512+127 768 768+127
177
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.8.6
Reset Values of Timing Parameters Table 22-5 gives the default value of timing parameters at reset. Table 22-5.
Register SMC_SETUP SMC_PULSE SMC_CYCLE WRITE_MODE READ_MODE
Reset Values of Timing Parameters
Reset Value 0x00000000 0x01010101 0x00030003 1 1 All setup timings are set to 1 All pulse timings are set to 1 The read and write operation last 3 Master Clock cycles and provide one hold cycle Write is controlled with NWE Read is controlled with NRD
22.8.7
Usage Restriction The SMC does not check the validity of the user-programmed parameters. If the sum of SETUP and PULSE parameters is larger than the corresponding CYCLE parameter, this leads to unpredictable behavior of the SMC. For read operations: Null but positive setup and hold of address and NRD and/or NCS can not be guaranteed at the memory interface because of the propagation delay of theses signals through external logic and pads. If positive setup and hold values must be verified, then it is strictly recommended to program non-null values so as to cover possible skews between address, NCS and NRD signals. For write operations: If a null hold value is programmed on NWE, the SMC can guarantee a positive hold of address, byte select lines, and NCS signal after the rising edge of NWE. This is true for WRITE_MODE = 1 only. See "Early Read Wait State" on page 179. For read and write operations: a null value for pulse parameters is forbidden and may lead to unpredictable behavior. In read and write cycles, the setup and hold time parameters are defined in reference to the address bus. For external devices that require setup and hold time between NCS and NRD signals (read), or between NCS and NWE signals (write), these setup and hold times must be converted into setup and hold times in reference to the address bus.
22.9
Automatic Wait States
Under certain circumstances, the SMC automatically inserts idle cycles between accesses to avoid bus contention or operation conflict.
22.9.1
Chip Select Wait States The SMC always inserts an idle cycle between 2 transfers on separate chip selects. This idle cycle ensures that there is no bus contention between the de-activation of one device and the activation of the next one. During chip select wait state, all control lines are turned inactive: NBS0 to NBS3, NWR0 to NWR3, NCS[0..5], NRD lines are all set to 1. Figure 22-16 illustrates a chip select wait state between access on Chip Select 0 and Chip Select 2.
178
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-16. Chip Select Wait State between a Read Access on NCS0 and a Write Access on NCS2
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NRD NWE
NCS0
NCS2 NRD_CYCLE D[31:0] NWE_CYCLE
Read to Write Chip Select Wait State Wait State
22.9.2
Early Read Wait State In some cases, the SMC inserts a wait state cycle between a write access and a read access to allow time for the write cycle to end before the subsequent read cycle begins. This wait state is not generated in addition to a chip select wait state. The early read cycle thus only occurs between a write and read access to the same memory device (same chip select). An early read wait state is automatically inserted if at least one of the following conditions is valid: * if the write controlling signal has no hold time and the read controlling signal has no setup time (Figure 22-17). * in NCS write controlled mode (WRITE_MODE = 0), if there is no hold timing on the NCS signal and the NCS_RD_SETUP parameter is set to 0, regardless of the read mode (Figure 22-18). The write operation must end with a NCS rising edge. Without an Early Read Wait State, the write operation could not complete properly. * in NWE controlled mode (WRITE_MODE = 1) and if there is no hold timing (NWE_HOLD = 0), the feedback of the write control signal is used to control address, data, chip select and byte select lines. If the external write control signal is not inactivated as expected due to load capacitances, an Early Read Wait State is inserted and address, data and control signals are maintained one more cycle. See Figure 22-19.
179
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-17. Early Read Wait State: Write with No Hold Followed by Read with No Setup
MCK
A[25:2] NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NWE NRD no hold no setup D[31:0]
write cycle
Early Read wait state
read cycle
Figure 22-18. Early Read Wait State: NCS Controlled Write with No Hold Followed by a Read with No NCS Setup
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NCS
NRD no hold D[31:0] no setup
write cycle (WRITE_MODE = 0)
Early Read wait state
read cycle (READ_MODE = 0 or READ_MODE = 1)
180
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-19. Early Read Wait State: NWE-controlled Write with No Hold Followed by a Read with one Set-up Cycle
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 internal write controlling signal external write controlling signal (NWE) no hold NRD read setup = 1
D[31:0]
write cycle (WRITE_MODE = 1)
Early Read wait state
read cycle (READ_MODE = 0 or READ_MODE = 1)
22.9.3
Reload User Configuration Wait State The user may change any of the configuration parameters by writing the SMC user interface. When detecting that a new user configuration has been written in the user interface, the SMC inserts a wait state before starting the next access. The so called "Reload User Configuration Wait State" is used by the SMC to load the new set of parameters to apply to next accesses. The Reload Configuration Wait State is not applied in addition to the Chip Select Wait State. If accesses before and after re-programming the user interface are made to different devices (Chip Selects), then one single Chip Select Wait State is applied. On the other hand, if accesses before and after writing the user interface are made to the same device, a Reload Configuration Wait State is inserted, even if the change does not concern the current Chip Select.
22.9.3.1
User Procedure To insert a Reload Configuration Wait State, the SMC detects a write access to any SMC_MODE register of the user interface. If the user only modifies timing registers (SMC_SETUP, SMC_PULSE, SMC_CYCLE registers) in the user interface, he must validate the modification by writing the SMC_MODE, even if no change was made on the mode parameters. Slow Clock Mode Transition A Reload Configuration Wait State is also inserted when the Slow Clock Mode is entered or exited, after the end of the current transfer (see "Slow Clock Mode" on page 193).
22.9.3.2
181
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.9.4
Read to Write Wait State Due to an internal mechanism, a wait cycle is always inserted between consecutive read and write SMC accesses. This wait cycle is referred to as a read to write wait state in this document. This wait cycle is applied in addition to chip select and reload user configuration wait states when they are to be inserted. See Figure 22-16 on page 179.
182
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.10 Data Float Wait States
Some memory devices are slow to release the external bus. For such devices, it is necessary to add wait states (data float wait states) after a read access: * before starting a read access to a different external memory * before starting a write access to the same device or to a different external one. The Data Float Output Time (t DF ) for each external memory device is programmed in the TDF_CYCLES field of the SMC_MODE register for the corresponding chip select. The value of TDF_CYCLES indicates the number of data float wait cycles (between 0 and 15) before the external device releases the bus, and represents the time allowed for the data output to go to high impedance after the memory is disabled. Data float wait states do not delay internal memory accesses. Hence, a single access to an external memory with long t DF will not slow down the execution of a program from internal memory. The data float wait states management depends on the READ_MODE and the TDF_MODE fields of the SMC_MODE register for the corresponding chip select. 22.10.1 READ_MODE Setting the READ_MODE to 1 indicates to the SMC that the NRD signal is responsible for turning off the tri-state buffers of the external memory device. The Data Float Period then begins after the rising edge of the NRD signal and lasts TDF_CYCLES MCK cycles. When the read operation is controlled by the NCS signal (READ_MODE = 0), the TDF field gives the number of MCK cycles during which the data bus remains busy after the rising edge of NCS. Figure 22-20 illustrates the Data Float Period in NRD-controlled mode (READ_MODE =1), assuming a data float period of 2 cycles (TDF_CYCLES = 2). Figure 22-21 shows the read operation when controlled by NCS (READ_MODE = 0) and the TDF_CYCLES parameter equals 3.
183
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-20. TDF Period in NRD Controlled Read Access (TDF = 2)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 NRD
NCS tpacc D[31:0] TDF = 2 clock cycles
NRD controlled read operation
Figure 22-21. TDF Period in NCS Controlled Read Operation (TDF = 3)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NRD
NCS tpacc D[31:0]
TDF = 3 clock cycles NCS controlled read operation
184
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.10.2 TDF Optimization Enabled (TDF_MODE = 1) When the TDF_MODE of the SMC_MODE register is set to 1 (TDF optimization is enabled), the SMC takes advantage of the setup period of the next access to optimize the number of wait states cycle to insert. Figure 22-22 shows a read access controlled by NRD, followed by a write access controlled by NWE, on Chip Select 0. Chip Select 0 has been programmed with: NRD_HOLD = 4; READ_MODE = 1 (NRD controlled) NWE_SETUP = 3; WRITE_MODE = 1 (NWE controlled) TDF_CYCLES = 6; TDF_MODE = 1 (optimization enabled). Figure 22-22. TDF Optimization: No TDF wait states are inserted if the TDF period is over when the next access begins
MCK
A[25:2]
NRD NRD_HOLD= 4 NWE
NWE_SETUP= 3 NCS0
TDF_CYCLES = 6
D[31:0]
read access on NCS0 (NRD controlled)
Read to Write Wait State
write access on NCS0 (NWE controlled)
22.10.3
TDF Optimization Disabled (TDF_MODE = 0) When optimization is disabled, tdf wait states are inserted at the end of the read transfer, so that the data float period is ended when the second access begins. If the hold period of the read1 controlling signal overlaps the data float period, no additional tdf wait states will be inserted. Figure 22-23, Figure 22-24 and Figure 22-25 illustrate the cases: * read access followed by a read access on another chip select, * read access followed by a write access on another chip select, * read access followed by a write access on the same chip select, with no TDF optimization.
185
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 22-23. TDF Optimization Disabled (TDF Mode = 0). TDF wait states between 2 read accesses on different chip selects
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 read1 controlling signal (NRD)
read1 hold = 1
read2 setup = 1
read2 controlling signal (NRD) D[31:0]
TDF_CYCLES = 6
5 TDF WAIT STATES read1 cycle TDF_CYCLES = 6 Chip Select Wait State read 2 cycle TDF_MODE = 0 (optimization disabled)
Figure 22-24. TDF Mode = 0: TDF wait states between a read and a write access on different chip selects
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 read1 controlling signal (NRD)
read1 hold = 1
write2 setup = 1
write2 controlling signal (NWE)
TDF_CYCLES = 4
D[31:0]
read1 cycle TDF_CYCLES = 4 Read to Write Chip Select Wait State Wait State
2 TDF WAIT STATES
write2 cycle TDF_MODE = 0 (optimization disabled)
186
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-25. TDF Mode = 0: TDF wait states between read and write accesses on the same chip select
MCK
A[25:2] NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0, A1 read1 controlling signal (NRD)
read1 hold = 1
write2 setup = 1
write2 controlling signal (NWE)
TDF_CYCLES = 5
D[31:0]
4 TDF WAIT STATES read1 cycle TDF_CYCLES = 5 write2 cycle TDF_MODE = 0 (optimization disabled)
Read to Write Wait State
22.11 External Wait
Any access can be extended by an external device using the NWAIT input signal of the SMC. The EXNW_MODE field of the SMC_MODE register on the corresponding chip select must be set to either to "10" (frozen mode) or "11" (ready mode). When the EXNW_MODE is set to "00" (disabled), the NWAIT signal is simply ignored on the corresponding chip select. The NWAIT signal delays the read or write operation in regards to the read or write controlling signal, depending on the read and write modes of the corresponding chip select. 22.11.1 Restriction When one of the EXNW_MODE is enabled, it is mandatory to program at least one hold cycle for the read/write controlling signal. For that reason, the NWAIT signal cannot be used in Page Mode ("Asynchronous Page Mode" on page 196), or in Slow Clock Mode ("Slow Clock Mode" on page 193). The NWAIT signal is assumed to be a response of the external device to the read/write request of the SMC. Then NWAIT is examined by the SMC only in the pulse state of the read or write controlling signal. The assertion of the NWAIT signal outside the expected period has no impact on SMC behavior.
187
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
22.11.2
Frozen Mode When the external device asserts the NWAIT signal (active low), and after internal synchronization of this signal, the SMC state is frozen, i.e., SMC internal counters are frozen, and all control signals remain unchanged. When the resynchronized NWAIT signal is deasserted, the SMC completes the access, resuming the access from the point where it was stopped. See Figure 2226. This mode must be selected when the external device uses the NWAIT signal to delay the access and to freeze the SMC. The assertion of the NWAIT signal outside the expected period is ignored as illustrated in Figure 22-27.
Figure 22-26. Write Access with NWAIT Assertion in Frozen Mode (EXNW_MODE = 10)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 4 NWE 6 NCS 5 4 3 2 2 3 2 1 1
FROZEN STATE 1 1 0
2
2
1
0
D[31:0]
NWAIT
internally synchronized NWAIT signal
Write cycle
EXNW_MODE = 10 (Frozen) WRITE_MODE = 1 (NWE_controlled) NWE_PULSE = 5 NCS_WR_PULSE = 7
188
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-27. Read Access with NWAIT Assertion in Frozen Mode (EXNW_MODE = 10)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 4 3 2
FROZEN STATE 2 2 1 0 2 1 0 5 5 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 0
NCS
NRD
NWAIT
internally synchronized NWAIT signal
Read cycle
EXNW_MODE = 10 (Frozen) READ_MODE = 0 (NCS_controlled) NRD_PULSE = 2, NRD_HOLD = 6 NCS_RD_PULSE =5, NCS_RD_HOLD =3 Assertion is ignored
189
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.11.3 Ready Mode In Ready mode (EXNW_MODE = 11), the SMC behaves differently. Normally, the SMC begins the access by down counting the setup and pulse counters of the read/write controlling signal. In the last cycle of the pulse phase, the resynchronized NWAIT signal is examined. If asserted, the SMC suspends the access as shown in Figure 22-28 and Figure 22-29. After deassertion, the access is completed: the hold step of the access is performed. This mode must be selected when the external device uses deassertion of the NWAIT signal to indicate its ability to complete the read or write operation. If the NWAIT signal is deasserted before the end of the pulse, or asserted after the end of the pulse of the controlling read/write signal, it has no impact on the access length as shown in Figure 22-29. Figure 22-28. NWAIT Assertion in Write Access: Ready Mode (EXNW_MODE = 11)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1
Wait STATE 4 3 2 1 0 0 0
NWE 6 NCS 5 4 3 2 1 1 1 0
D[31:0]
NWAIT
internally synchronized NWAIT signal
Write cycle
EXNW_MODE = 11 (Ready mode) WRITE_MODE = 1 (NWE_controlled) NWE_PULSE = 5 NCS_WR_PULSE = 7
190
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-29. NWAIT Assertion in Read Access: Ready Mode (EXNW_MODE = 11)
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 6 NCS 5 4 3 2 1 0
Wait STATE 0
NRD
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
0
NWAIT
internally synchronized NWAIT signal
Read cycle
EXNW_MODE = 11(Ready mode) READ_MODE = 0 (NCS_controlled) Assertion is ignored NRD_PULSE = 7 NCS_RD_PULSE =7 Assertion is ignored
191
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.11.4 NWAIT Latency and Read/write Timings There may be a latency between the assertion of the read/write controlling signal and the assertion of the NWAIT signal by the device. The programmed pulse length of the read/write controlling signal must be at least equal to this latency plus the 2 cycles of resynchronization + 1 cycle. Otherwise, the SMC may enter the hold state of the access without detecting the NWAIT signal assertion. This is true in frozen mode as well as in ready mode. This is illustrated on Figure 22-30. When EXNW_MODE is enabled (ready or frozen), the user must program a pulse length of the read and write controlling signal of at least: minimal pulse length = NWAIT latency + 2 resynchronization cycles + 1 cycle Figure 22-30. NWAIT Latency
MCK A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 4 NRD minimal pulse length 3 2 1 0 0
WAIT STATE 0
NWAIT intenally synchronized NWAIT signal
NWAIT latency 2 cycle resynchronization
Read cycle EXNW_MODE = 10 or 11 READ_MODE = 1 (NRD_controlled) NRD_PULSE = 5
192
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.12 Slow Clock Mode
The SMC is able to automatically apply a set of "slow clock mode" read/write waveforms when an internal signal driven by the Power Management Controller is asserted because MCK has been turned to a very slow clock rate (typically 32kHz clock rate). In this mode, the user-programmed waveforms are ignored and the slow clock mode waveforms are applied. This mode is provided so as to avoid reprogramming the User Interface with appropriate waveforms at very slow clock rate. When activated, the slow mode is active on all chip selects. 22.12.1 Slow Clock Mode Waveforms Figure 22-31 illustrates the read and write operations in slow clock mode. They are valid on all chip selects. Table 22-6 indicates the value of read and write parameters in slow clock mode.
Figure 22-31. Read/write Cycles in Slow Clock Mode
MCK MCK
A[25:2] NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NRD 1 1 NCS NRD_CYCLE = 2 SLOW CLOCK MODE READ
NWE
1 1
1
NCS NWE_CYCLE = 3 SLOW CLOCK MODE WRITE
Table 22-6.
Read and Write Timing Parameters in Slow Clock Mode
Duration (cycles) 1 1 0 2 2 Write Parameters NWE_SETUP NWE_PULSE NCS_WR_SETUP NCS_WR_PULSE NWE_CYCLE Duration (cycles) 1 1 0 3 3
Read Parameters NRD_SETUP NRD_PULSE NCS_RD_SETUP NCS_RD_PULSE NRD_CYCLE
193
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.12.2 Switching from (to) Slow Clock Mode to (from) Normal Mode When switching from slow clock mode to the normal mode, the current slow clock mode transfer is completed at high clock rate, with the set of slow clock mode parameters.See Figure 22-32 on page 194. The external device may not be fast enough to support such timings. Figure 22-33 illustrates the recommended procedure to properly switch from one mode to the other. Figure 22-32. Clock Rate Transition Occurs while the SMC is Performing a Write Operation
Slow Clock Mode internal signal from PMC MCK A[25:2] NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NWE
1 NCS
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
2
NWE_CYCLE = 3 SLOW CLOCK MODE WRITE SLOW CLOCK MODE WRITE
NWE_CYCLE = 7 NORMAL MODE WRITE
This write cycle finishes with the slow clock mode set of parameters after the clock rate transition
Slow clock mode transition is detected: Reload Configuration Wait State
194
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-33. Recommended Procedure to Switch from Slow Clock Mode to Normal Mode or from Normal Mode to Slow Clock Mode
Slow Clock Mode internal signal from PMC
MCK
A[25:2]
NBS0, NBS1, NBS2, NBS3, A0,A1 NWE 1 NCS 1 1 2 3 2
SLOW CLOCK MODE WRITE
IDLE STATE
NORMAL MODE WRITE
Reload Configuration Wait State
195
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.13 Asynchronous Page Mode
The SMC supports asynchronous burst reads in page mode, providing that the page mode is enabled in the SMC_MODE register (PMEN field). The page size must be configured in the SMC_MODE register (PS field) to 4, 8, 16 or 32 bytes. The page defines a set of consecutive bytes into memory. A 4-byte page (resp. 8-, 16-, 32-byte page) is always aligned to 4-byte boundaries (resp. 8-, 16-, 32-byte boundaries) of memory. The MSB of data address defines the address of the page in memory, the LSB of address define the address of the data in the page as detailed in Table 22-7. With page mode memory devices, the first access to one page (tpa) takes longer than the subsequent accesses to the page (tsa ) as shown in Figure 22-34. When in page mode, the SMC enables the user to define different read timings for the first access within one page, and next accesses within the page. Table 22-7.
Page Size 4 bytes 8 bytes 16 bytes 32 bytes Notes:
Page Address and Data Address within a Page
Page Address(1) A[25:2] A[25:3] A[25:4] A[25:5] Data Address in the Page(2) A[1:0] A[2:0] A[3:0] A[4:0]
1. A denotes the address bus of the memory device 2. For 16-bit devices, the bit 0 of address is ignored. For 32-bit devices, bits [1:0] are ignored.
22.13.1
Protocol and Timings in Page Mode Figure 22-34 shows the NRD and NCS timings in page mode access.
Figure 22-34. Page Mode Read Protocol (Address MSB and LSB are defined in Table 22-7)
MCK A[MSB]
A[LSB] NRD NCS tpa tsa tsa
D[31:0]
NCS_RD_PULSE
NRD_PULSE
NRD_PULSE
The NRD and NCS signals are held low during all read transfers, whatever the programmed values of the setup and hold timings in the User Interface may be. Moreover, the NRD and NCS timings are identical. The pulse length of the first access to the page is defined with the 196
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
NCS_RD_PULSE field of the SMC_PULSE register. The pulse length of subsequent accesses within the page are defined using the NRD_PULSE parameter. In page mode, the programming of the read timings is described in Table 22-8: Table 22-8.
Parameter READ_MODE NCS_RD_SETUP NCS_RD_PULSE NRD_SETUP NRD_PULSE NRD_CYCLE
Programming of Read Timings in Page Mode
Value `x' `x' tpa `x' tsa `x' Definition No impact No impact Access time of first access to the page No impact Access time of subsequent accesses in the page No impact
The SMC does not check the coherency of timings. It will always apply the NCS_RD_PULSE timings as page access timing (tpa) and the NRD_PULSE for accesses to the page (tsa), even if the programmed value for tpa is shorter than the programmed value for tsa. 22.13.2 Byte Access Type in Page Mode The Byte Access Type configuration remains active in page mode. For 16-bit or 32-bit page mode devices that require byte selection signals, configure the BAT field of the SMC_REGISTER to 0 (byte select access type). Page Mode Restriction The page mode is not compatible with the use of the NWAIT signal. Using the page mode and the NWAIT signal may lead to unpredictable behavior. Sequential and Non-sequential Accesses If the chip select and the MSB of addresses as defined in Table 22-7 are identical, then the current access lies in the same page as the previous one, and no page break occurs. Using this information, all data within the same page, sequential or not sequential, are accessed with a minimum access time (tsa). Figure 22-35 illustrates access to an 8-bit memory device in page mode, with 8-byte pages. Access to D1 causes a page access with a long access time (tpa). Accesses to D3 and D7, though they are not sequential accesses, only require a short access time (tsa). If the MSB of addresses are different, the SMC performs the access of a new page. In the same way, if the chip select is different from the previous access, a page break occurs. If two sequential accesses are made to the page mode memory, but separated by an other internal or external peripheral access, a page break occurs on the second access because the chip select of the device was deasserted between both accesses.
22.13.3
22.13.4
197
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 22-35. Access to Non-sequential Data within the Same Page
MCK
A[25:3]
Page address
A[2], A1, A0
A1
A3
A7
NRD NCS
D[7:0] NCS_RD_PULSE
D1 NRD_PULSE
D3 NRD_PULSE
D7
198
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.14 Static Memory Controller (SMC) User Interface
The SMC is programmed using the registers listed in Table 22-9. For each chip select, a set of 4 registers is used to program the parameters of the external device connected on it. In Table 22-9, "CS_number" denotes the chip select number. 16 bytes (0x10) are required per chip select. The user must complete writing the configuration by writing any one of the SMC_MODE registers. Table 22-9. SMC Register Mapping
Offset 0x10 x CS_number + 0x00 0x10 x CS_number + 0x04 0x10 x CS_number + 0x08 0x10 x CS_number + 0x0C Register SMC Setup Register SMC Pulse Register SMC Cycle Register SMC Mode Register Name SMC_SETUP SMC_PULSE SMC_CYCLE SMC_MODE Access Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Reset State 0x00000000 0x01010101 0x00030003 0x10001000
199
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.14.1 SMC Setup Register Register Name: SMC_SETUP[0 ..5] Access Type: Read/Write
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 -
29
28
27
26
25
24
NCS_RD_SETUP 21 20 19 NRD_SETUP 13 12 11 10 9 8 18 17 16
NCS_WR_SETUP 5 4 3 NWE_SETUP 2 1 0
* NWE_SETUP: NWE Setup Length The NWE signal setup length is defined as: NWE setup length = (128* NWE_SETUP[5] + NWE_SETUP[4:0]) clock cycles * NCS_WR_SETUP: NCS Setup Length in WRITE Access In write access, the NCS signal setup length is defined as: NCS setup length = (128* NCS_WR_SETUP[5] + NCS_WR_SETUP[4:0]) clock cycles * NRD_SETUP: NRD Setup Length The NRD signal setup length is defined in clock cycles as: NRD setup length = (128* NRD_SETUP[5] + NRD_SETUP[4:0]) clock cycles * NCS_RD_SETUP: NCS Setup Length in READ Access In read access, the NCS signal setup length is defined as: NCS setup length = (128* NCS_RD_SETUP[5] + NCS_RD_SETUP[4:0]) clock cycles
200
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.14.2 SMC Pulse Register Register Name: SMC_PULSE[0..5] Access Type: Read/Write
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
30
29
28
27 NCS_RD_PULSE
26
25
24
22
21
20
19 NRD_PULSE
18
17
16
14
13
12
11 NCS_WR_PULSE
10
9
8
6
5
4
3 NWE_PULSE
2
1
0
* NWE_PULSE: NWE Pulse Length The NWE signal pulse length is defined as: NWE pulse length = (256* NWE_PULSE[6] + NWE_PULSE[5:0]) clock cycles The NWE pulse length must be at least 1 clock cycle. * NCS_WR_PULSE: NCS Pulse Length in WRITE Access In write access, the NCS signal pulse length is defined as: NCS pulse length = (256* NCS_WR_PULSE[6] + NCS_WR_PULSE[5:0]) clock cycles The NCS pulse length must be at least 1 clock cycle. * NRD_PULSE: NRD Pulse Length In standard read access, the NRD signal pulse length is defined in clock cycles as: NRD pulse length = (256* NRD_PULSE[6] + NRD_PULSE[5:0]) clock cycles The NRD pulse length must be at least 1 clock cycle. In page mode read access, the NRD_PULSE parameter defines the duration of the subsequent accesses in the page. * NCS_RD_PULSE: NCS Pulse Length in READ Access In standard read access, the NCS signal pulse length is defined as: NCS pulse length = (256* NCS_RD_PULSE[6] + NCS_RD_PULSE[5:0]) clock cycles The NCS pulse length must be at least 1 clock cycle. In page mode read access, the NCS_RD_PULSE parameter defines the duration of the first access to one page.
201
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.14.3 SMC Cycle Register Register Name: SMC_CYCLE[0..5] Access Type: Read/Write
31 - 23
30 - 22
29 - 21
28 - 20 NRD_CYCLE
27 - 19
26 - 18
25 - 17
24 NRD_CYCLE 16
15 - 7
14 - 6
13 - 5
12 - 4 NWE_CYCLE
11 - 3
10 - 2
9 - 1
8 NWE_CYCLE 0
* NWE_CYCLE: Total Write Cycle Length The total write cycle length is the total duration in clock cycles of the write cycle. It is equal to the sum of the setup, pulse and hold steps of the NWE and NCS signals. It is defined as: Write cycle length = (NWE_CYCLE[8:7]*256 + NWE_CYCLE[6:0]) clock cycles * NRD_CYCLE: Total Read Cycle Length The total read cycle length is the total duration in clock cycles of the read cycle. It is equal to the sum of the setup, pulse and hold steps of the NRD and NCS signals. It is defined as: Read cycle length = (NRD_CYCLE[8:7]*256 + NRD_CYCLE[6:0]) clock cycles
202
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.14.4 SMC MODE Register Register Name: SMC_MODE[0..5] Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 5 EXNW_MODE 21 - 13 DBW 4 29 PS 20 TDF_MODE 12 11 - 3 - 10 - 2 - 28 27 - 19 26 - 18 TDF_CYCLES 9 - 1 WRITE_MODE 8 BAT 0 READ_MODE 25 - 17 24 PMEN 16
* READ_MODE: 1: The read operation is controlled by the NRD signal. - If TDF cycles are programmed, the external bus is marked busy after the rising edge of NRD. - If TDF optimization is enabled (TDF_MODE =1), TDF wait states are inserted after the setup of NRD. 0: The read operation is controlled by the NCS signal. - If TDF cycles are programmed, the external bus is marked busy after the rising edge of NCS. - If TDF optimization is enabled (TDF_MODE =1), TDF wait states are inserted after the setup of NCS. * WRITE_MODE 1: The write operation is controlled by the NWE signal. - If TDF optimization is enabled (TDF_MODE =1), TDF wait states will be inserted after the setup of NWE. 0: The write operation is controlled by the NCS signal. - If TDF optimization is enabled (TDF_MODE =1), TDF wait states will be inserted after the setup of NCS. * EXNW_MODE: NWAIT Mode The NWAIT signal is used to extend the current read or write signal. It is only taken into account during the pulse phase of the read and write controlling signal. When the use of NWAIT is enabled, at least one cycle hold duration must be programmed for the read and write controlling signal.
EXNW_MODE 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 NWAIT Mode Disabled Reserved Frozen Mode Ready Mode
* Disabled Mode: The NWAIT input signal is ignored on the corresponding Chip Select. * Frozen Mode: If asserted, the NWAIT signal freezes the current read or write cycle. After deassertion, the read/write cycle is resumed from the point where it was stopped. * Ready Mode: The NWAIT signal indicates the availability of the external device at the end of the pulse of the controlling read or write signal, to complete the access. If high, the access normally completes. If low, the access is extended until NWAIT returns high. 203
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* BAT: Byte Access Type This field is used only if DBW defines a 16- or 32-bit data bus. * 1: Byte write access type: - Write operation is controlled using NCS, NWR0, NWR1, NWR2, NWR3. - Read operation is controlled using NCS and NRD. * 0: Byte select access type: - Write operation is controlled using NCS, NWE, NBS0, NBS1, NBS2 and NBS3 - Read operation is controlled using NCS, NRD, NBS0, NBS1, NBS2 and NBS3 * DBW: Data Bus Width
DBW 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Data Bus Width 8-bit bus 16-bit bus 32-bit bus Reserved
* TDF_CYCLES: Data Float Time This field gives the integer number of clock cycles required by the external device to release the data after the rising edge of the read controlling signal. The SMC always provide one full cycle of bus turnaround after the TDF_CYCLES period. The external bus cannot be used by another chip select during TDF_CYCLES + 1 cycles. From 0 up to 15 TDF_CYCLES can be set. * TDF_MODE: TDF Optimization 1: TDF optimization is enabled. - The number of TDF wait states is optimized using the setup period of the next read/write access. 0: TDF optimization is disabled. - The number of TDF wait states is inserted before the next access begins. * PMEN: Page Mode Enabled 1: Asynchronous burst read in page mode is applied on the corresponding chip select. 0: Standard read is applied. * PS: Page Size If page mode is enabled, this field indicates the size of the page in bytes.
PS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Page Size 4-byte page 8-byte page 16-byte page 32-byte page
204
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23. SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC)
23.1 Description
The SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC) extends the memory capabilities of a chip by providing the interface to an external 16-bit or 32-bit SDRAM device. The page size supports ranges from 2048 to 8192 and the number of columns from 256 to 2048. It supports byte (8-bit), half-word (16-bit) and word (32-bit) accesses. The SDRAM Controller supports a read or write burst length of one location. It keeps track of the active row in each bank, thus maximizing SDRAM performance, e.g., the application may be placed in one bank and data in the other banks. So as to optimize performance, it is advisable to avoid accessing different rows in the same bank. The SDRAM controller supports a CAS latency of 1, 2 or 3 and optimizes the read access depending on the frequency. The different modes available - self-refresh, power-down and deep power-down modes - minimize power consumption on the SDRAM device.
23.2
I/O Lines Description
Table 23-1.
Name SDCK SDCKE SDCS BA[1:0] RAS CAS SDWE NBS[3:0] SDRAMC_A[12:0] D[31:0]
I/O Line Description
Description SDRAM Clock SDRAM Clock Enable SDRAM Controller Chip Select Bank Select Signals Row Signal Column Signal SDRAM Write Enable Data Mask Enable Signals Address Bus Data Bus Type Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output Output I/O Low Low Low Low High Low Active Level
205
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.3
23.3.1
Application Example
Software Interface The SDRAM address space is organized into banks, rows, and columns. The SDRAM controller allows mapping different memory types according to the values set in the SDRAMC configuration register. The SDRAM Controller's function is to make the SDRAM device access protocol transparent to the user. Table 23-2 to Table 23-7 illustrate the SDRAM device memory mapping seen by the user in correlation with the device structure. Various configurations are illustrated.
23.3.2
32-bit Memory Data Bus Width SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 2K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Table 23-2.
27 26 25
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[10:0] Row[10:0] Row[10:0] Row[10:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0]
Table 23-3.
27 26 25
SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 4K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[11:0] Row[11:0] Row[11:0] Row[11:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0]
Table 23-4.
27 26 25
SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 8K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[12:0] Row[12:0] Row[12:0] Row[12:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0] M[1:0]
Notes:
1. M[1:0] is the byte address inside a 32-bit word. 2. Bk[1] = BA1, Bk[0] = BA0.
206
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.3.3 16-bit Memory Data Bus Width SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 2K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Table 23-5.
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[10:0] Row[10:0] Row[10:0] Row[10:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M0 M0 M0 M0
Table 23-6.
27 26 25
SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 4K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[11:0] Row[11:0] Row[11:0] Row[11:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M0 M0 M0 M0
Table 23-7.
27 26 25
SDRAM Configuration Mapping: 8K Rows, 256/512/1024/2048 Columns
CPU Address Line 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0] Bk[1:0]
Row[12:0] Row[12:0] Row[12:0] Row[12:0]
Column[7:0] Column[8:0] Column[9:0] Column[10:0]
M0 M0 M0 M0
Notes:
1. M0 is the byte address inside a 16-bit half-word. 2. Bk[1] = BA1, Bk[0] = BA0.
207
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.4
23.4.1
Product Dependencies
SDRAM Device Initialization The initialization sequence is generated by software. The SDRAM devices are initialized by the following sequence: 1. SDRAM features must be set in the configuration register: asynchronous timings (TRC, TRAS, etc.), number of columns, rows, CAS latency, and the data bus width. 2. For mobile SDRAM, temperature-compensated self refresh (TCSR), drive strength (DS) and partial array self refresh (PASR) must be set in the Low Power Register. 3. The SDRAM memory type must be set in the Memory Device Register. 4. A minimum pause of 200 s is provided to precede any signal toggle. 5.
(1)
A NOP command is issued to the SDRAM devices. The application must set Mode to 1 in the Mode Register and perform a write access to any SDRAM address.
6. An All Banks Precharge command is issued to the SDRAM devices. The application must set Mode to 2 in the Mode Register and perform a write access to any SDRAM address. 7. Eight auto-refresh (CBR) cycles are provided. The application must set the Mode to 4 in the Mode Register and perform a write access to any SDRAM location eight times. 8. A Mode Register set (MRS) cycle is issued to program the parameters of the SDRAM devices, in particular CAS latency and burst length. The application must set Mode to 3 in the Mode Register and perform a write access to the SDRAM. The write address must be chosen so that BA[1:0] are set to 0. For example, with a 16-bit 128 MB SDRAM (12 rows, 9 columns, 4 banks) bank address, the SDRAM write access should be done at the address 0x20000000. 9. For mobile SDRAM initialization, an Extended Mode Register set (EMRS) cycle is issued to program the SDRAM parameters (TCSR, PASR, DS). The application must set Mode to 5 in the Mode Register and perform a write access to the SDRAM. The write address must be chosen so that BA[1] or BA[0] are set to 1. For example, with a 16-bit 128 MB SDRAM, (12 rows, 9 columns, 4 banks) bank address the SDRAM write access should be done at the address 0x20800000 or 0x20400000. 10. The application must go into Normal Mode, setting Mode to 0 in the Mode Register and performing a write access at any location in the SDRAM. 11. Write the refresh rate into the count field in the SDRAMC Refresh Timer register. (Refresh rate = delay between refresh cycles). The SDRAM device requires a refresh every 15.625 s or 7.81 s. With a 100 MHz frequency, the Refresh Timer Counter Register must be set with the value 1562(15.652 s x 100 MHz) or 781(7.81 s x 100 MHz). After initialization, the SDRAM devices are fully functional.
Note: 1. It is strongly recommended to respect the instructions stated in Step 5 of the initialization process in order to be certain that the subsequent commands issued by the SDRAMC will be taken into account.
208
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 23-1. SDRAM Device Initialization Sequence
SDCKE tRP tRC tMRD
SDCK
SDRAMC_A[9:0]
A10
SDRAMC_A[12:11]
SDCS
RAS
CAS
SDWE
NBS Inputs Stable for 200 sec Precharge All Banks 1st Auto-refresh 8th Auto-refresh MRS Command Valid Command
23.4.2
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the SDRAM Controller may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the SDRAM Controller pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the SDRAM Controller are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller.
23.4.3
Interrupt The SDRAM Controller interrupt (Refresh Error notification) is connected to the Memory Controller. This interrupt may be ORed with other System Peripheral interrupt lines and is finally provided as the System Interrupt Source (Source 1) to the AIC (Advanced Interrupt Controller). Using the SDRAM Controller interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first.
209
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.5
23.5.1
Functional Description
SDRAM Controller Write Cycle The SDRAM Controller allows burst access or single access. In both cases, the SDRAM controller keeps track of the active row in each bank, thus maximizing performance. To initiate a burst access, the SDRAM Controller uses the transfer type signal provided by the master requesting the access. If the next access is a sequential write access, writing to the SDRAM device is carried out. If the next access is a write-sequential access, but the current access is to a boundary page, or if the next access is in another row, then the SDRAM Controller generates a precharge command, activates the new row and initiates a write command. To comply with SDRAM timing parameters, additional clock cycles are inserted between precharge/active (tRP) commands and active/write (tRCD) commands. For definition of these timing parameters, refer to the "SDRAMC Configuration Register" on page 221. This is described in Figure 23-2 below.
Figure 23-2. Write Burst, 32-bit SDRAM Access
tRCD = 3 SDCS
SDCK
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
Row n
col a
col b
col c
col d
col e
col f
col g
col h
col i
col j
col k
col l
RAS
CAS
SDWE
D[31:0]
Dna
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
Dne
Dnf
Dng
Dnh
Dni
Dnj
Dnk
Dnl
210
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.5.2 SDRAM Controller Read Cycle The SDRAM Controller allows burst access, incremental burst of unspecified length or single access. In all cases, the SDRAM Controller keeps track of the active row in each bank, thus maximizing performance of the SDRAM. If row and bank addresses do not match the previous row/bank address, then the SDRAM controller automatically generates a precharge command, activates the new row and starts the read command. To comply with the SDRAM timing parameters, additional clock cycles on SDCK are inserted between precharge and active commands (tRP) and between active and read command (tRCD). These two parameters are set in the configuration register of the SDRAM Controller. After a read command, additional wait states are generated to comply with the CAS latency (1, 2 or 3 clock delays specified in the configuration register). For a single access or an incremented burst of unspecified length, the SDRAM Controller anticipates the next access. While the last value of the column is returned by the SDRAM Controller on the bus, the SDRAM Controller anticipates the read to the next column and thus anticipates the CAS latency. This reduces the effect of the CAS latency on the internal bus. For burst access of specified length (4, 8, 16 words), access is not anticipated. This case leads to the best performance. If the burst is broken (border, busy mode, etc.), the next access is handled as an incrementing burst of unspecified length. Figure 23-3. Read Burst, 32-bit SDRAM Access
tRCD = 3 SDCS CAS = 2
SDCK
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
Row n
col a
col b
col c
col d
col e
col f
RAS
CAS
SDWE D[31:0] (Input)
Dna
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
Dne
Dnf
211
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.5.3
Border Management When the memory row boundary has been reached, an automatic page break is inserted. In this case, the SDRAM controller generates a precharge command, activates the new row and initiates a read or write command. To comply with SDRAM timing parameters, an additional clock cycle is inserted between the precharge/active (tRP) command and the active/read (tRCD) command. This is described in Figure 23-4 below.
Figure 23-4. Read Burst with Boundary Row Access
TRP = 3 SDCS TRCD = 3 CAS = 2
SDCK Row n
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
col a
col b
col c
col d
Row m
col a
col b
col c
col d
col e
RAS
CAS
SDWE
D[31:0]
Dna
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
Dma
Dmb
Dmc
Dmd
Dme
212
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.5.4 SDRAM Controller Refresh Cycles An auto-refresh command is used to refresh the SDRAM device. Refresh addresses are generated internally by the SDRAM device and incremented after each auto-refresh automatically. The SDRAM Controller generates these auto-refresh commands periodically. An internal timer is loaded with the value in the register SDRAMC_TR that indicates the number of clock cycles between refresh cycles. A refresh error interrupt is generated when the previous auto-refresh command did not perform. It is acknowledged by reading the Interrupt Status Register (SDRAMC_ISR). When the SDRAM Controller initiates a refresh of the SDRAM device, internal memory accesses are not delayed. However, if the CPU tries to access the SDRAM, the slave indicates that the device is busy and the master is held by a wait signal. See Figure 23-5. Figure 23-5. Refresh Cycle Followed by a Read Access
tRP = 3 SDCS tRC = 8 tRCD = 3 CAS = 2
SDCK Row n
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
col c col d
Row m
col a
RAS
CAS
SDWE
D[31:0] (input)
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
Dma
213
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.5.5
Power Management Three low-power modes are available: * Self-refresh Mode: The SDRAM executes its own Auto-refresh cycle without control of the SDRAM Controller. Current drained by the SDRAM is very low. * Power-down Mode: Auto-refresh cycles are controlled by the SDRAM Controller. Between auto-refresh cycles, the SDRAM is in power-down. Current drained in Power-down mode is higher than in Self-refresh Mode. * Deep Power-down Mode: (Only available with Mobile SDRAM) The SDRAM contents are lost, but the SDRAM does not drain any current. The SDRAM Controller activates one low-power mode as soon as the SDRAM device is not selected. It is possible to delay the entry in self-refresh and power-down mode after the last access by programming a timeout value in the Low Power Register.
214
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.5.6 Self-refresh Mode This mode is selected by programming the LPCB field to 1 in the SDRAMC Low Power Register. In self-refresh mode, the SDRAM device retains data without external clocking and provides its own internal clocking, thus performing its own auto-refresh cycles. All the inputs to the SDRAM device become "don't care" except SDCKE, which remains low. As soon as the SDRAM device is selected, the SDRAM Controller provides a sequence of commands and exits self-refresh mode. Some low-power SDRAMs (e.g., mobile SDRAM) can refresh only one quarter or a half quarter or all banks of the SDRAM array. This feature reduces the self-refresh current. To configure this feature, Temperature Compensated Self Refresh (TCSR), Partial Array Self Refresh (PASR) and Drive Strength (DS) parameters must be set in the Low Power Register and transmitted to the low-power SDRAM during initialization. After initialization, as soon as PASR/DS/TCSR fields are modified and self-refresh mode is activated, the Extended Mode Register is accessed automatically and PASR/DS/TCSR bits are updated before entry into self-refresh mode. The SDRAM device must remain in self-refresh mode for a minimum period of tRAS and may remain in self-refresh mode for an indefinite period. This is described in Figure 23-6. Figure 23-6. Self-refresh Mode Behavior
Self Refresh Mode SRCB = 1 Write SDRAMC_SRR SDRAMC_A[12:0] Row TXSR = 3
SDCK
SDCKE
SDCS
RAS
CAS
SDWE Access Request to the SDRAM Controller
215
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.5.7
Low-power Mode This mode is selected by programming the LPCB field to 2 in the SDRAMC Low Power Register. Power consumption is greater than in self-refresh mode. All the input and output buffers of the SDRAM device are deactivated except SDCKE, which remains low. In contrast to self-refresh mode, the SDRAM device cannot remain in low-power mode longer than the refresh period (64 ms for a whole device refresh operation). As no auto-refresh operations are performed by the SDRAM itself, the SDRAM Controller carries out the refresh operation. The exit procedure is faster than in self-refresh mode. This is described in Figure 23-7.
Figure 23-7. Low-power Mode Behavior
TRCD = 3 SDCS CAS = 2 Low Power Mode
SDCK
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
Row n
col a
col b
col c
col d
col e
col f
RAS
CAS
SDCKE
D[31:0] (input)
Dna
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
Dne
Dnf
216
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.5.8 Deep Power-down Mode This mode is selected by programming the LPCB field to 3 in the SDRAMC Low Power Register. When this mode is activated, all internal voltage generators inside the SDRAM are stopped and all data is lost. When this mode is enabled, the application must not access to the SDRAM until a new initialization sequence is done (See "SDRAM Device Initialization" on page 208). This is described in Figure 23-8. Figure 23-8. Deep Power-down Mode Behavior
tRP = 3 SDCS
SDCK Row n
SDRAMC_A[12:0]
col c
col d
RAS
CAS
SDWE CKE
D[31:0] (input)
Dnb
Dnc
Dnd
217
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.6
SDRAM Controller User Interface
SDRAM Controller Memory Map
Register SDRAMC Mode Register SDRAMC Refresh Timer Register SDRAMC Configuration Register SDRAMC Low Power Register SDRAMC Interrupt Enable Register SDRAMC Interrupt Disable Register SDRAMC Interrupt Mask Register SDRAMC Interrupt Status Register SDRAMC Memory Device Register Reserved Name SDRAMC_MR SDRAMC_TR SDRAMC_CR SDRAMC_LPR SDRAMC_IER SDRAMC_IDR SDRAMC_IMR SDRAMC_ISR SDRAMC_MDR - Access Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read - Reset State 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x852372C0 0x0 - - 0x0 0x0 0x0 -
Table 23-8.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 - 0xFC
218
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.6.1 SDRAMC Mode Register Register Name: SDRAMC_MR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write 0x00000000
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 MODE 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* MODE: SDRAMC Command Mode This field defines the command issued by the SDRAM Controller when the SDRAM device is accessed.
MODE 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 Description Normal mode. Any access to the SDRAM is decoded normally. The SDRAM Controller issues a NOP command when the SDRAM device is accessed regardless of the cycle. The SDRAM Controller issues an "All Banks Precharge" command when the SDRAM device is accessed regardless of the cycle. The SDRAM Controller issues a "Load Mode Register" command when the SDRAM device is accessed regardless of the cycle. The address offset with respect to the SDRAM device base address is used to program the Mode Register. For instance, when this mode is activated, an access to the "SDRAM_Base + offset" address generates a "Load Mode Register" command with the value "offset" written to the SDRAM device Mode Register. The SDRAM Controller issues an "Auto-Refresh" Command when the SDRAM device is accessed regardless of the cycle. Previously, an "All Banks Precharge" command must be issued. The SDRAM Controller issues an extended load mode register command when the SDRAM device is accessed regardless of the cycle. The address offset with respect to the SDRAM device base address is used to program the Mode Register. For instance, when this mode is activated, an access to the "SDRAM_Base + offset" address generates an "Extended Load Mode Register" command with the value "offset" written to the SDRAM device Mode Register. Deep power-down mode. Enters deep power-down mode.
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
219
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.6.2 SDRAMC Refresh Timer Register Register Name: SDRAMC_TR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
Read/Write 0x00000000
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 COUNT 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 COUNT 3 2 1 0 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* COUNT: SDRAMC Refresh Timer Count This 12-bit field is loaded into a timer that generates the refresh pulse. Each time the refresh pulse is generated, a refresh burst is initiated. The value to be loaded depends on the SDRAMC clock frequency (MCK: Master Clock), the refresh rate of the SDRAM device and the refresh burst length where 15.6 s per row is a typical value for a burst of length one. To refresh the SDRAM device, this 12-bit field must be written. If this condition is not satisfied, no refresh command is issued and no refresh of the SDRAM device is carried out.
220
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.6.3 SDRAMC Configuration Register Register Name: SDRAMC_CR Access Type: Reset Value:
31
Read/Write 0x852372C0
30 TXSR 29 28 27 26 TRAS 21 TRCD 20 19 18 TRP 13 TRC 12 11 10 TWR 5 CAS 4 NB 3 NR 2 1 NC 0 9 8 17 16 25 24
23
22
15
14
7 DBW
6
* NC: Number of Column Bits Reset value is 8 column bits.
NC 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Column Bits 8 9 10 11
* NR: Number of Row Bits Reset value is 11 row bits.
NR 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Row Bits 11 12 13 Reserved
* NB: Number of Banks Reset value is two banks.
NB 0 1 Number of Banks 2 4
221
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* CAS: CAS Latency Reset value is two cycles. In the SDRAMC, only a CAS latency of one, two and three cycles are managed. In any case, another value must be programmed.
CAS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 CAS Latency (Cycles) Reserved 1 2 3
* DBW: Data Bus Width Reset value is 16 bits 0: Data bus width is 32 bits. 1: Data bus width is 16 bits. * TWR: Write Recovery Delay Reset value is two cycles. This field defines the Write Recovery Time in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15. * TRC: Row Cycle Delay Reset value is seven cycles. This field defines the delay between a Refresh and an Activate Command in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15. * TRP: Row Precharge Delay Reset value is three cycles. This field defines the delay between a Precharge Command and another Command in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15. * TRCD: Row to Column Delay Reset value is two cycles. This field defines the delay between an Activate Command and a Read/Write Command in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15. * TRAS: Active to Precharge Delay Reset value is five cycles. This field defines the delay between an Activate Command and a Precharge Command in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15. * TXSR: Exit Self Refresh to Active Delay Reset value is eight cycles. This field defines the delay between SCKE set high and an Activate Command in number of cycles. Number of cycles is between 0 and 15.
222
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.6.4 SDRAMC Low Power Register Register Name: SDRAMC_LPR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write 0x0
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 TIMEOUT 5 PASR 4 3 - 28 - 20 - 12 27 - 19 - 11 DS 2 - 1 LPCB 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 TCSR 0 24 - 16 - 8
* LPCB: Low-power Configuration Bits
00 Low Power Feature is inhibited: no Power-down, Self-refresh or Deep Power-down command is issued to the SDRAM device. The SDRAM Controller issues a Self-refresh command to the SDRAM device, the SDCLK clock is deactivated and the SDCKE signal is set low. The SDRAM device leaves the Self Refresh Mode when accessed and enters it after the access. The SDRAM Controller issues a Power-down Command to the SDRAM device after each access, the SDCKE signal is set to low. The SDRAM device leaves the Power-down Mode when accessed and enters it after the access. The SDRAM Controller issues a Deep Power-down command to the SDRAM device. This mode is unique to low-power SDRAM.
01
10
11
* PASR: Partial Array Self-refresh (only for low-power SDRAM) PASR parameter is transmitted to the SDRAM during initialization to specify whether only one quarter, one half or all banks of the SDRAM array are enabled. Disabled banks are not refreshed in self-refresh mode. This parameter must be set according to the SDRAM device specification. After initialization, as soon as PASR field is modified and self-refresh mode is activated, the Extended Mode Register is accessed automatically and PASR bits are updated before entry in self-refresh mode. * TCSR: Temperature Compensated Self-Refresh (only for low-power SDRAM) TCSR parameter is transmitted to the SDRAM during initialization to set the refresh interval during self-refresh mode depending on the temperature of the low-power SDRAM. This parameter must be set according to the SDRAM device specification. After initialization, as soon as TCSR field is modified and self-refresh mode is activated, the Extended Mode Register is accessed automatically and TCSR bits are updated before entry in self-refresh mode. * DS: Drive Strength (only for low-power SDRAM) DS parameter is transmitted to the SDRAM during initialization to select the SDRAM strength of data output. This parameter must be set according to the SDRAM device specification.
223
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
After initialization, as soon as DS field is modified and self-refresh mode is activated, the Extended Mode Register is accessed automatically and DS bits are updated before entry in self-refresh mode. * TIMEOUT: Time to define when low-power mode is enabled
00 01 10 11 The SDRAM controller activates the SDRAM low-power mode immediately after the end of the last transfer. The SDRAM controller activates the SDRAM low-power mode 64 clock cycles after the end of the last transfer. The SDRAM controller activates the SDRAM low-power mode 128 clock cycles after the end of the last transfer. Reserved.
224
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.6.5 SDRAMC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: SDRAMC_IER Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RES
* RES: Refresh Error Status 0: No effect. 1: Enables the refresh error interrupt.
23.6.6 SDRAMC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: SDRAMC_IDR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RES
* RES: Refresh Error Status 0: No effect. 1: Disables the refresh error interrupt.
225
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.6.7 SDRAMC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: SDRAMC_IMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RES
* RES: Refresh Error Status 0: The refresh error interrupt is disabled. 1: The refresh error interrupt is enabled.
226
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
23.6.8 SDRAMC Interrupt Status Register Register Name: SDRAMC_ISR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RES
* RES: Refresh Error Status 0: No refresh error has been detected since the register was last read. 1: A refresh error has been detected since the register was last read.
227
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
23.6.9 SDRAMC Memory Device Register Register Name: SDRAMC_MDR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 MD 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* MD: Memory Device Type
00 01 10 11 SDRAM Low-power SDRAM Reserved Reserved.
228
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
24. Error Corrected Code (ECC) Controller
24.1 Description
NAND Flash/SmartMedia devices contain by default invalid blocks which have one or more invalid bits. Over the NAND Flash/SmartMedia lifetime, additional invalid blocks may occur which can be detected/corrected by ECC code. The ECC Controller is a mechanism that encodes data in a manner that makes possible the identification and correction of certain errors in data. The ECC controller is capable of single bit error correction and 2-bit random detection. When NAND Flash/SmartMedia have more than 2 bits of errors, the data cannot be corrected. The ECC user interface is compliant with the ARM Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB rev2).
24.2
Block Diagram
Figure 24-1. Block Diagram
Static Memory Controller NAND Flash SmartMedia Logic
ECC Controller
Ctrl/ECC Algorithm
User Interface
APB
24.3
Functional Description
A page in NAND Flash and SmartMedia memories contains an area for main data and an additional area used for redundancy (ECC). The page is organized in 8-bit or 16-bit words. The page size corresponds to the number of words in the main area plus the number of words in the extra area used for redundancy.
229
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The only configuration required for ECC is the NAND Flash or the SmartMedia page size (528/1056/2112/4224). Page size is configured setting the PAGESIZE field in the ECC Mode Register (ECC_MR). ECC is automatically computed as soon as a read (00h)/write (80h) command to the NAND Flash or the SmartMedia is detected. Read and write access must start at a page boundary. ECC results are available as soon as the counter reaches the end of the main area. Values in the ECC Parity Register (ECC_PR) and ECC NParity Register (ECC_NPR) are then valid and locked until a new start condition occurs (read/write command followed by address cycles). 24.3.1 Write Access Once the flash memory page is written, the computed ECC code is available in the ECC Parity Error (ECC_PR) and ECC_NParity Error (ECC_NPR) registers. The ECC code value must be written by the software application in the extra area used for redundancy. 24.3.2 Read Access After reading the whole data in the main area, the application must perform read accesses to the extra area where ECC code has been previously stored. Error detection is automatically performed by the ECC controller. Please note that it is mandatory to read consecutively the entire main area and the locations where Parity and NParity values have been previously stored to let the ECC controller perform error detection. The application can check the ECC Status Register (ECC_SR) for any detected errors. It is up to the application to correct any detected error. ECC computation can detect four different circumstances: * No error: XOR between the ECC computation and the ECC code stored at the end of the NAND Flash or SmartMedia page is equal to 0. No error flags in the ECC Status Register (ECC_SR). * Recoverable error: Only the RECERR flag in the ECC Status register (ECC_SR) is set. The corrupted word offset in the read page is defined by the WORDADDR field in the ECC Parity Register (ECC_PR). The corrupted bit position in the concerned word is defined in the BITADDR field in the ECC Parity Register (ECC_PR). * ECC error: The ECCERR flag in the ECC Status Register is set. An error has been detected in the ECC code stored in the Flash memory. The position of the corrupted bit can be found by the application performing an XOR between the Parity and the NParity contained in the ECC code stored in the flash memory. * Non correctable error: The MULERR flag in the ECC Status Register is set. Several unrecoverable errors have been detected in the flash memory page. ECC Status Register, ECC Parity Register and ECC NParity Register are cleared when a read/write command is detected or a software reset is performed. For Single-bit Error Correction and Double-bit Error Detection (SEC-DED) hsiao code is used. 32-bit ECC is generated in order to perform one bit correction per 512/1024/2048/4096 8- or 16bit words. Of the 32 ECC bits, 26 bits are for line parity and 6 bits are for column parity. They are generated according to the schemes shown in Figure 24-2 and Figure 24-3.
230
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 24-2. Parity Generation for 512/1024/2048/4096 8-bit Words1
1st byte 2nd byte 3rd byte 4 th byte Bit7 Bit7 Bit7 Bit7 Bit6 Bit6 Bit6 Bit6 Bit5 Bit5 Bit5 Bit5 Bit4 Bit4 Bit4 Bit4 Bit3 Bit3 Bit3 Bit3 Bit2 Bit2 Bit2 Bit2 Bit1 Bit1 Bit1 Bit1 Bit0 Bit0 Bit0 Bit0 P8 P8' P8 P8' P16 P32 P16' PX
(page size -3 )th byte (page size -2 )th byte (page size -1 )th byte Page size th byte
Bit7 Bit7 Bit7 Bit7 P1 P2
Bit6 Bit6 Bit6 Bit6 P1'
Bit5 Bit5 Bit5 Bit5 P1
Bit4 Bit4 Bit4 Bit4 P1' P2'
Bit3 Bit3 Bit3 Bit3 P1 P2
Bit2 Bit2 Bit2 Bit2 P1'
Bit1 Bit1 Bit1 Bit1 P1 P2' P4'
Bit0 Bit0 Bit0 Bit0 P1'
P8 P8' P8 P8'
P16 P32 P16' PX'
P4
Page size Page size Page size Page size
= 512 = 1024 = 2048 = 4096
Px = 2048 Px = 4096 Px = 8192 Px = 16384
P1=bit7(+)bit5(+)bit3(+)bit1(+)P1 P2=bit7(+)bit6(+)bit3(+)bit2(+)P2 P4=bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)P4 P1'=bit6(+)bit4(+)bit2(+)bit0(+)P1' P2'=bit5(+)bit4(+)bit1(+)bit0(+)P2' P4'=bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)P4'
To calculate P8' to PX' and P8 to PX, apply the algorithm that follows.
Page size = 2n for i =0 to n begin for (j = 0 to page_size_byte) begin if(j[i] ==1) P[2i+3]=bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)bit3(+) bit2(+)bit1(+)bit0(+)P[2i+3] else P[2i+3]'=bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)bit3(+) bit2(+)bit1(+)bit0(+)P[2i+3]' end end
231
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 24-3. Parity Generation for 512/1024/2048/4096 16-bit Words
232
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
(Page size -3 )th word (Page size -2 )th word (Page size -1 )th word Page size th word
1st word 2nd word
3rd word 4th word
(+)
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
To calculate P8' to PX' and P8 to PX, apply the algorithm that follows.
Page size = 2n for i =0 to n begin for (j = 0 to page_size_word) begin if(j[i] ==1) P[2i+3]= bit15(+)bit14(+)bit13(+)bit12(+) bit11(+)bit10(+)bit9(+)bit8(+) bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)bit3(+) bit2(+)bit1(+)bit0(+)P[2n+3] else P[2i+3]'=bit15(+)bit14(+)bit13(+)bit12(+) bit11(+)bit10(+)bit9(+)bit8(+) bit7(+)bit6(+)bit5(+)bit4(+)bit3(+) bit2(+)bit1(+)bit0(+)P[2i+3]' end end
233
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
24.4
Error Corrected Code (ECC) Controller User Interface
ECC Register Mapping
Register ECC Control Register ECC Mode Register ECC Status Register ECC Parity Register ECC NParity Register Register Name ECC_CR ECC_MR ECC_SR ECC_PR ECC_NPR Access Write-only Read/Write Read-only Read-only Read-only Reset 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0
Table 24-1.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10
234
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
24.4.1 Name: ECC Control Register ECC_CR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RST
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* RST: RESET Parity Provides reset to current ECC by software. 1 = Resets ECC Parity and ECC NParity register. 0 = No effect.
235
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
24.4.2 ECC Mode Register Register Name: ECC_MR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 PAGESIZE 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* PAGESIZE: Page Size This field defines the page size of the NAND Flash device.
Page Size 00 01 10 11 Description 528 words 1056 words 2112 words 4224 words
A word has a value of 8 bits or 16 bits, depending on the NAND Flash or SmartMedia memory organization.
236
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
24.4.3 ECC Status Register Register Name: ECC_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 MULERR 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 ECCERR 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RECERR
* RECERR: Recoverable Error 0 = No Errors Detected. 1 = Errors Detected. If MUL_ERROR is 0, a single correctable error was detected. Otherwise multiple uncorrected errors were detected. * ECCERR: ECC Error 0 = No Errors Detected. 1 = A single bit error occurred in the ECC bytes. Read both ECC Parity and ECC NParity register, the error occurred at the location which contains a 1 in the least significant 16 bits. * MULERR: Multiple Error 0 = No Multiple Errors Detected. 1 = Multiple Errors Detected.
237
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
24.4.4 ECC Parity Register Register Name: ECC_PR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 7
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 6 WORDADDR 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 WORDADDR 4 3 2 BITADDR 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Once the entire main area of a page is written with data, the register content must be stored at any free location of the spare area. * BITADDR During a page read, this value contains the corrupted bit offset where an error occurred, if a single error was detected. If multiple errors were detected, this value is meaningless. * WORDADDR During a page read, this value contains the word address (8-bit or 16-bit word depending on the memory plane organization) where an error occurred, if a single error was detected. If multiple errors were detected, this value is meaningless. 24.4.5 ECC NParity Register Register Name: ECC_NPR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 7
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 NPARITY 4 NPARITY 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* NPARITY: Once the entire main area of a page is written with data, the register content must be stored at any free location of the spare area.
238
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25. Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC)
25.1 Description
The Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) transfers data between on-chip serial peripherals and the on- and/or off-chip memories. The link between the PDC and a serial peripheral is operated by the AHB to ABP bridge. The PDC contains twenty-two channels. The full-duplex peripherals feature twenty-one monodirectional channels used in pairs (transmit only or receive only). The half-duplex peripherals feature one bi-directional channel. The user interface of each PDC channel is integrated into the user interface of the peripheral it serves. The user interface of mono directional channels (receive only or transmit only), contains two 32-bit memory pointers and two 16-bit counters, one set (pointer, counter) for current transfer and one set (pointer, counter) for next transfer. The bi-directional channel user interface contains four 32-bit memory pointers and four 16-bit counters. Each set (pointer, counter) is used by current transmit, next transmit, current receive and next receive. Using the PDC removes processor overhead by reducing its intervention during the transfer. This significantly reduces the number of clock cycles required for a data transfer, which improves microcontroller performance. To launch a transfer, the peripheral triggers its associated PDC channels by using transmit and receive signals. When the programmed data is transferred, an end of transfer interrupt is generated by the peripheral itself.
239
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.2
Block Diagram
Figure 25-1. Block Diagram
FULL DUPLEX PERIPHERAL THR PDC Channel A PDC
RHR
PDC Channel B
Control
Status & Control
HALF DUPLEX PERIPHERAL THR PDC Channel C RHR
Control
Control
Status & Control
RECEIVE or TRANSMIT PERIPHERAL RHR or THR PDC Channel D
Control
Status & Control
240
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.3
25.3.1
Functional Description
Configuration The PDC channel user interface enables the user to configure and control data transfers for each channel. The user interface of each PDC channel is integrated into the associated peripheral user interface. The user interface of a serial peripheral, whether it is full or half duplex, contains four 32-bit pointers (RPR, RNPR, TPR, TNPR) and four 16-bit counter registers (RCR, RNCR, TCR, TNCR). However, the transmit and receive parts of each type are programmed differently: the transmit and receive parts of a full duplex peripheral can be programmed at the same time, whereas only one part (transmit or receive) of a half duplex peripheral can be programmed at a time. 32-bit pointers define the access location in memory for current and next transfer, whether it is for read (transmit) or write (receive). 16-bit counters define the size of current and next transfers. It is possible, at any moment, to read the number of transfers left for each channel. The PDC has dedicated status registers which indicate if the transfer is enabled or disabled for each channel. The status for each channel is located in the associated peripheral status register. Transfers can be enabled and/or disabled by setting TXTEN/TXTDIS and RXTEN/RXTDIS in the peripheral's Transfer Control Register. At the end of a transfer, the PDC channel sends status flags to its associated peripheral. These flags are visible in the peripheral status register (ENDRX, ENDTX, RXBUFF, and TXBUFE). Refer to Section 25.3.3 and to the associated peripheral user interface.
25.3.2
Memory Pointers Each full duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC by a receive channel and a transmit channel. Both channels have 32-bit memory pointers that point respectively to a receive area and to a transmit area in on- and/or off-chip memory. Each half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC by a bidirectional channel. This channel has two 32-bit memory pointers, one for current transfer and the other for next transfer. These pointers point to transmit or receive data depending on the operating mode of the peripheral. Depending on the type of transfer (byte, half-word or word), the memory pointer is incremented respectively by 1, 2 or 4 bytes. If a memory pointer address changes in the middle of a transfer, the PDC channel continues operating using the new address.
25.3.3
Transfer Counters Each channel has two 16-bit counters, one for current transfer and the other one for next transfer. These counters define the size of data to be transferred by the channel. The current transfer counter is decremented first as the data addressed by current memory pointer starts to be transferred. When the current transfer counter reaches zero, the channel checks its next transfer counter. If the value of next counter is zero, the channel stops transferring data and sets the appropriate flag. But if the next counter value is greater then zero, the values of the next pointer/next counter are copied into the current pointer/current counter and the channel resumes the transfer whereas next pointer/next counter get zero/zero as values. At the end of this transfer the PDC channel sets the appropriate flags in the Peripheral Status Register.
241
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The following list gives an overview of how status register flags behave depending on the counters' values: * ENDRX flag is set when the PERIPH_RCR register reaches zero. * RXBUFF flag is set when both PERIPH_RCR and PERIPH_RNCR reach zero. * ENDTX flag is set when the PERIPH_TCR register reaches zero. * TXBUFE flag is set when both PERIPH_TCR and PERIPH_TNCR reach zero. These status flags are described in the Peripheral Status Register. 25.3.4 Data Transfers The serial peripheral triggers its associated PDC channels' transfers using transmit enable (TXEN) and receive enable (RXEN) flags in the transfer control register integrated in the peripheral's user interface. When the peripheral receives an external data, it sends a Receive Ready signal to its PDC receive channel which then requests access to the Matrix. When access is granted, the PDC receive channel starts reading the peripheral Receive Holding Register (RHR). The read data are stored in an internal buffer and then written to memory. When the peripheral is about to send data, it sends a Transmit Ready to its PDC transmit channel which then requests access to the Matrix. When access is granted, the PDC transmit channel reads data from memory and puts them to Transmit Holding Register (THR) of its associated peripheral. The same peripheral sends data according to its mechanism. 25.3.5 PDC Flags and Peripheral Status Register Each peripheral connected to the PDC sends out receive ready and transmit ready flags and the PDC sends back flags to the peripheral. All these flags are only visible in the Peripheral Status Register. Depending on the type of peripheral, half or full duplex, the flags belong to either one single channel or two different channels. 25.3.5.1 Receive Transfer End This flag is set when PERIPH_RCR register reaches zero and the last data has been transferred to memory. It is reset by writing a non zero value in PERIPH_RCR or PERIPH_RNCR. 25.3.5.2 Transmit Transfer End This flag is set when PERIPH_TCR register reaches zero and the last data has been written into peripheral THR. It is reset by writing a non zero value in PERIPH_TCR or PERIPH_TNCR. 25.3.5.3 Receive Buffer Full This flag is set when PERIPH_RCR register reaches zero with PERIPH_RNCR also set to zero and the last data has been transferred to memory. It is reset by writing a non zero value in PERIPH_TCR or PERIPH_TNCR.
242
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.3.5.4 Transmit Buffer Empty This flag is set when PERIPH_TCR register reaches zero with PERIPH_TNCR also set to zero and the last data has been written into peripheral THR. It is reset by writing a non zero value in PERIPH_TCR or PERIPH_TNCR.
243
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4
Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface
Memory Map
Register Receive Pointer Register Receive Counter Register Transmit Pointer Register Transmit Counter Register Receive Next Pointer Register Receive Next Counter Register Transmit Next Pointer Register Transmit Next Counter Register Transfer Control Register Transfer Status Register Name PERIPH _RPR PERIPH_RCR PERIPH_TPR PERIPH_TCR PERIPH_RNPR PERIPH_RNCR PERIPH_TNPR PERIPH_TNCR PERIPH_PTCR PERIPH_PTSR
(1)
Table 25-1.
Offset 0x100 0x104 0x108 0x10C 0x110 0x114 0x118 0x11C 0x120 0x124 Note:
Access Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Write Read
Reset State 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1. PERIPH: Ten registers are mapped in the peripheral memory space at the same offset. These can be defined by the user according to the function and the peripheral desired (DBGU, USART, SSC, SPI, MCI, etc.)
244
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.4.1 Receive Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_RPR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 RXPTR 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 RXPTR
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 RXPTR
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 RXPTR
3
2
1
0
* RXPTR: Receive Pointer Register RXPTR must be set to receive buffer address. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXPTR = TXPTR.
245
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4.2 Receive Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_RCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RXCTR 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 RXCTR
3
2
1
0
* RXCTR: Receive Counter Register RXCTR must be set to receive buffer size. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXCTR = TXCTR. 0 = Stops peripheral data transfer to the receiver 1 - 65535 = Starts peripheral data transfer if corresponding channel is active
246
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.4.3 Transmit Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_TPR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 TXPTR 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 TXPTR
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 TXPTR
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 TXPTR
3
2
1
0
* TXPTR: Transmit Counter Register TXPTR must be set to transmit buffer address. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXPTR = TXPTR.
247
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4.4 Transmit Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_TCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 TXCTR 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 TXCTR
3
2
1
0
* TXCTR: Transmit Counter Register TXCTR must be set to transmit buffer size. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXCTR = TXCTR. 0 = Stops peripheral data transfer to the transmitter 1- 65535 = Starts peripheral data transfer if corresponding channel is active
248
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.4.5 Receive Next Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_RNPR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 RXNPTR 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 RXNPTR
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 RXNPTR
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 RXNPTR
3
2
1
0
* RXNPTR: Receive Next Pointer RXNPTR contains next receive buffer address. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXNPTR = TXNPTR.
249
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4.6 Receive Next Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_RNCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RXNCTR 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 RXNCTR
3
2
1
0
* RXNCTR: Receive Next Counter RXNCTR contains next receive buffer size. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXNCTR = TXNCTR.
250
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.4.7 Transmit Next Pointer Register Register Name: PERIPH_TNPR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 TXNPTR 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 TXNPTR
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 TXNPTR
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 TXNPTR
3
2
1
0
* TXNPTR: Transmit Next Pointer TXNPTR contains next transmit buffer address. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXNPTR = TXNPTR.
251
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4.8 Transmit Next Counter Register Register Name: PERIPH_TNCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 TXNCTR 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 TXNCTR
3
2
1
0
* TXNCTR: Transmit Counter Next TXNCTR contains next transmit buffer size. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, RXNCTR = TXNCTR.
252
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
25.4.9 Transfer Control Register Register Name: PERIPH_PTCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 TXTDIS 1 RXTDIS 24 - 16 - 8 TXTEN 0 RXTEN
* RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables PDC receiver channel requests if RXTDIS is not set. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, enabling the receiver channel requests automatically disables the transmitter channel requests. It is forbidden to set both TXTEN and RXTEN for a half duplex peripheral. * RXTDIS: Receiver Transfer Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the PDC receiver channel requests. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, disabling the receiver channel requests also disables the transmitter channel requests. * TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the PDC transmitter channel requests. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, it enables the transmitter channel requests only if RXTEN is not set. It is forbidden to set both TXTEN and RXTEN for a half duplex peripheral. * TXTDIS: Transmitter Transfer Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the PDC transmitter channel requests. When a half duplex peripheral is connected to the PDC, disabling the transmitter channel requests disables the receiver channel requests.
253
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
25.4.10 Transfer Status Register Register Name: PERIPH_PTSR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 TXTEN 0 RXTEN
* RXTEN: Receiver Transfer Enable 0 = PDC Receiver channel requests are disabled. 1 = PDC Receiver channel requests are enabled. * TXTEN: Transmitter Transfer Enable 0 = PDC Transmitter channel requests are disabled. 1 = PDC Transmitter channel requests are enabled.
254
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
26. Clock Generator
26.1 Description
The Clock Generator is made up of one PLL, a 12 MHz Main Oscillator, as well as an RC Oscillator and a 32,768 Hz low-power Oscillator. It provides the following clocks: * SLCK, the Slow Clock, which is the only permanent clock within the system * MAINCK is the output of the 12 MHz Main Oscillator * PLLCK is the output of the Divider and PLL block The Clock Generator User Interface is embedded within the Power Management Controller one and is described in Section 27.8. However, the Clock Generator registers are named CKGR_.
26.2
Slow Clock Crystal Oscillator
The Clock Generator integrates a 32,768 Hz low-power oscillator. The XIN32 and XOUT32 pins must be connected to a 32,768 Hz crystal. Two external capacitors must be wired as shown in Figure 26-1. Figure 26-1. Typical Slow Clock Crystal Oscillator Connection
XIN32
32,768 Hz Crystal
XOUT32
GNDPLL
26.3
Slow Clock RC Oscillator
The user has to take into account the possible drifts of the RC Oscillator. More details are given in the section "DC Characteristics" of the product datasheet.
26.4
Slow Clock Selection
The AT91SAM9R64/RL64 slow clock can be generated either by an external 32,768 Hz crystal or by the on-chip RC oscillator. The 32,768 Hz crystal oscillator can be bypassed by setting the bit OSC32BYP to accept an external slow clock on XIN32. The internal RC oscillator and the 32,768 Hz oscillator can be enabled by setting to 1, respectively, RCEN bit and OSC32EN bit in the System Controller user interface. The OSCSEL command selects the slow clock source. By default the AT91SAM9R64/RL64 slow clock source is the internal RC oscillator. System startup time is 4 slow clock periods, typically 125 s.
255
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 26-2. Slow Clock Selection
Clock Generator
RCEN
On Chip RC OSC Slow Clock SLCK XIN32 XOUT32 Slow Clock Oscillator OSCSEL OSC32EN OSC32BYP
RCEN, OSC32EN,OSCSEL and OSC32BYP bits are located in the Slow Clock Control Register (SCKCR) located at address 0xFFFFFD50 in the backed up part of the System Controller and so are preserved while VDDBU is present. After a VDDBU power on reset, the default configuration is RCEN=1, OSC32EN=0 and OSCSEL=0, allowing the system to start on the internal RC oscillator. The programmer controls the slow clock switching by software and so must take precautions during the switching phase. 26.4.1 Switching from Internal RC Oscillator to the 32,768 Hz Crystal To switch from internal RC oscillator to the 32,768 Hz crystal, the programmer must execute the following sequence: * Switch the master clock to a source different from slow clock (PLL or Main Oscillator) through the Power Management Controller. * Enable the 32,768 Hz oscillator by setting the bit OSC32EN to 1. * Wait 32,768 Hz Startup Time for clock stabilization (software loop). * Switch from internal RC to 32,768 Hz oscillator by setting the bit OSCSEL to 1. * Wait 5 slow clock cycles for internal resynchronization. * Disable the RC oscillator by setting the bit RCEN to 0. 26.4.2 Bypassing the 32,768 Hz Oscillator Following steps must be added to bypass the 32,768 Hz oscillator: * An external clock must be connected on XIN32. * Enable the bypass path OSC32BYP bit set to 1. * Disable the 32,768 Hz oscillator by setting the bit OSC32EN to 0. 26.4.3 Switching from 32768 Hz Crystal to the Internal RC Oscillator The same procedure must be followed to switch from a 32,768 Hz crystal to the internal RC oscillator. * Switch the master clock to a source different from slow clock (PLL or Main Oscillator). * Enable the internal RC oscillator by setting the bit RCEN to 1. 256
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* Wait internal RC Startup Time for clock stabilization (software loop). * Switch from 32768 Hz oscillator to internal RC by setting the bit OSCSEL to 0. * Wait 5 slow clock cycles for internal resynchronization. * Disable the 32768 Hz oscillator by setting the bit OSC32EN to 0. 26.4.4 Name: Address: Acess:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Slow Clock Configuration Register SCKCR 0xFFFFFD50 Read-write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 OSCSEL 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 OSC32BYP 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 OSC32EN 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RCEN
* RCEN: Internal RC 0: RC is disabled 1: RC is enabled * OSC32EN: 32768 Hz oscillator 0: 32768Hz oscillator is disabled 1: 32768Hz oscillator is enabled * OSC32BYP: 32768Hz oscillator bypass 0: 32768Hz oscillator is not bypassed 1: 32768Hz oscillator is bypassed, accept an external slow clock on XIN32 * OSCSEL: Slow clock selector 0: Slow clock is internal RC 1: Slow clock is 32768 Hz oscillator
257
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
26.5
Main Oscillator
The Main Oscillator is designed for a 12 MHz fundamental crystal. The 12 MHz is also used to generate the 480 MHz USB High Speed Clock (HSCK) thanks to the UTMI PLL (UPLL). Figure 26-3 shows the Main Oscillator block diagram. Figure 26-3. Main Oscillator Block Diagram
OSCEN
UTMI
XIN XOUT
12MHz Main Oscillator
MAINCK Main Clock
UPLL
HSCK 480 MHz
OSCOUNT
SLCK Slow Clock
Main Oscillator Counter
MOSCS
26.5.1
Main Oscillator Connections The typical crystal connection is illustrated in Figure 26-4. For further details on the electrical characteristics of the Main Oscillator, see the section "DC Characteristics" of the product datasheet. Figure 26-4. Typical Crystal Connection
XIN
XOUT
GND
26.5.2
Main Oscillator Startup Time The startup time of the 12 MHz Main Oscillator is given in thesection "DC Characteristics" of the product datasheet. Main Oscillator Control To minimize the power required to start up the system, the main oscillator is disabled after reset and slow clock is selected. The software enables or disables the main oscillator so as to reduce power consumption by clearing the MOSCEN bit in the Main Oscillator Register (CKGR_MOR). When disabling the main oscillator by clearing the MOSCEN bit in CKGR_MOR, the MOSCS bit in PMC_SR is automatically cleared, indicating the main clock is off.
26.5.3
258
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
When enabling the main oscillator, the user must initiate the main oscillator counter with a value corresponding to the startup time of the oscillator. This startup time depends on the crystal frequency connected to the main oscillator. When the MOSCEN bit and the OSCOUNT are written in CKGR_MOR to enable the main oscillator, the MOSCS bit in PMC_SR (Status Register) is cleared and the counter starts counting down on the slow clock divided by 8 from the OSCOUNT value. Since the OSCOUNT value is coded with 8 bits, the maximum startup time is about 62 ms. When the counter reaches 0, the MOSCS bit is set, indicating that the main clock is valid. Setting the MOSCS bit in PMC_IMR can trigger an interrupt to the processor. 26.5.4 Main Oscillator Bypass The user can input a clock on the device instead of connecting a crystal. In this case, the user has to provide the external clock signal on the XIN pin. The input characteristics of the XIN pin under these conditions are given in the product electrical characteristics section. The programmer has to be sure to set the OSCBYPASS bit to 1 and the MOSCEN bit to 0 in the Main OSC register (CKGR_MOR) for the external clock to operate properly.
26.6
Divider and PLL Block
The PLL embeds an input divider to increase the accuracy of the resulting clock signals. However, the user must respect the PLL minimum input frequency when programming the divider. Figure 26-5 shows the block diagram of the divider and PLL block. Figure 26-5. Divider and PLL Block Diagram
DIV MUL OUT
MAINCK
Divider
PLL
PLLCK
PLLRC PLLCOUNT
SLCK
PLL Counter
LOCK
26.6.1
PLL Filter The PLL requires connection to an external second-order filter through the PLLRC pin. Figure 26-6 shows a schematic of these filters.
259
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 26-6. PLL Capacitors and Resistors
PLLRC PLL
R
C2 C1 GND
Values of R, C1 and C2 to be connected to the PLLRC pin must be calculated as a function of the PLL input frequency, the PLL output frequency and the phase margin. A trade-off has to be found between output signal overshoot and startup time. 26.6.2 Divider and Phase Lock Loop Programming The divider can be set between 1 and 255 in steps of 1. When a divider field (DIV) is set to 0, the output of the corresponding divider and the PLL output is a continuous signal at level 0. On reset, each DIV field is set to 0, thus the corresponding PLL input clock is set to 0. The PLL allows multiplication of the divider's outputs. The PLL clock signal has a frequency that depends on the respective source signal frequency and on the parameters DIV and MUL. The factor applied to the source signal frequency is (MUL + 1)/DIV. When MUL is written to 0, the corresponding PLL is disabled and its power consumption is saved. Re-enabling the PLL can be performed by writing a value higher than 0 in the MUL field. Whenever the PLL is re-enabled or one of its parameters is changed, the LOCK bit in PMC_SR is automatically cleared. The values written in the PLLCOUNT field in CKGR_PLLR are loaded in the PLL counter. The PLL counter then decrements at the speed of the Slow Clock until it reaches 0. At this time, the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. The user has to load the number of Slow Clock cycles required to cover the PLL transient time into the PLLCOUNT field. The transient time depends on the PLL filter. The initial state of the PLL and its target frequency can be calculated using a specific tool provided by Atmel. 26.6.3 UTMI Bias and Phase Lock Loop Programming The multiplier is hard-wired to 40 to obtain the USB High Speed 480 MHz.
UPLLEN
MAINCK
PLL
USBHSCK
PLLCOUNT
SLCK
PLL Counter
LOCKU
260
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Whenever the PLL is enabled by writing UPLLEN in CKGR_UCKR, the LOCKU bit in PMC_SR is automatically cleared, the BIAS is enabled by writing BIASEN in CKGR_UCKR in the same time. The values written in the PLLCOUNT field in CKGR_UCKR are loaded in the PLL counter. The PLL counter then decrements at the speed of the Slow Clock divided by 8 until it reaches 0. At this time, the LOCKU bit is set in PMC_SR and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. The user has to load the number of Slow Clock cycles required to cover the PLL transient time into the PLLCOUNT field.
261
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27. Power Management Controller (PMC)
27.1 Description
The Power Management Controller (PMC) optimizes power consumption by controlling all system and user peripheral clocks. The PMC enables/disables the clock inputs to many of the peripherals and the ARM Processor. The Power Management Controller provides the following clocks: * MCK, the Master Clock, programmable from a few hundred Hz to the maximum operating frequency of the device. It is available to the modules running permanently, such as the AIC and the Memory Controller. * Processor Clock (PCK), must be switched off when entering processor in idle mode. * Peripheral Clocks, typically MCK, provided to the embedded peripherals (USART, SSC, SPI, TWI, TC, MCI, etc.) and independently controllable. In order to reduce the number of clock names in a product, the Peripheral Clocks are named MCK in the product datasheet. * Programmable Clock Outputs can be selected from the clocks provided by the clock generator and driven on the PCKx pins.
27.2
Master Clock Controller
The Master Clock Controller provides selection and division of the Master Clock (MCK). MCK is the clock provided to all the peripherals and the memory controller. The Master Clock is selected from one of the clocks provided by the Clock Generator. Selecting the Slow Clock provides a Slow Clock signal to the whole device. Selecting the Main Clock saves power consumption of the PLL. The Master Clock Controller is made up of a clock selector and a prescaler. It also contains a Master Clock divider which allows the processor clock to be faster than the Master Clock. The Master Clock selection is made by writing the CSS field (Clock Source Selection) in PMC_MCKR (Master Clock Register). The prescaler supports the division by a power of 2 of the selected clock between 1 and 64. The PRES field in PMC_MCKR programs the prescaler. The Master Clock divider can be programmed through the MDIV field in PMC_MCKR.
Each time PMC_MCKR is written to define a new Master Clock, the MCKRDY bit is cleared in PMC_SR. It reads 0 until the Master Clock is established. Then, the MCKRDY bit is set and can trigger an interrupt to the processor. This feature is useful when switching from a high-speed clock to a lower one to inform the software when the change is actually done.
262
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 27-1. Master Clock Controller
PMC_MCKR CSS PMC_MCKR PRES PMC_MCKR MDIV Master Clock Divider
SLCK MAINCK PLLCK Master Clock Prescaler
MCK
To the Processor Clock Controller (PCK)
27.3
Processor Clock Controller
The PMC features a Processor Clock Controller (PCK) that implements the Processor Idle Mode. The Processor Clock can be disabled by writing the System Clock Disable Register (PMC_SCDR). The status of this clock (at least for debug purpose) can be read in the System Clock Status Register (PMC_SCSR). The Processor Clock PCK is enabled after a reset and is automatically re-enabled by any enabled interrupt. The Processor Idle Mode is achieved by disabling the Processor Clock and entering in Wait for Interrupt Mode. The Processor Clock is automatically re-enabled by any enabled fast or normal interrupt, or by the reset of the product. When the Processor Clock is disabled, the current instruction is finished before the clock is stopped, but this does not prevent data transfers from other masters of the system bus.
Notes: 1. The Processor clock is disabled in PMC_SCDR register. 2. The ARM Wait For Interrupt mode is entered with CP15 coprocessor operation. 3. Refer to the Atmel application note "Optimizing Power Consumption of AT91SAM9261-based Systems", lit. no. 6217 for details.
27.4
Peripheral Clock Controller
The Power Management Controller controls the clocks of each embedded peripheral by the way of the Peripheral Clock Controller. The user can individually enable and disable the Master Clock on the peripherals by writing into the Peripheral Clock Enable (PMC_PCER) and Peripheral Clock Disable (PMC_PCDR) registers. The status of the peripheral clock activity can be read in the Peripheral Clock Status Register (PMC_PCSR). When a peripheral clock is disabled, the clock is immediately stopped. The peripheral clocks are automatically disabled after a reset. In order to stop a peripheral, it is recommended that the system software wait until the peripheral has executed its last programmed operation before disabling the clock. This is to avoid data corruption or erroneous behavior of the system. The bit number within the Peripheral Clock Control registers (PMC_PCER, PMC_PCDR, and PMC_PCSR) is the Peripheral Identifier defined at the product level. Generally, the bit number corresponds to the interrupt source number assigned to the peripheral.
27.5
Programmable Clock Output Controller
The PMC controls 2 signals to be output on external pins PCKx. Each signal can be independently programmed via the PMC_PCKx registers.
263
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
PCKx can be independently selected between the Slow clock, the PLL output and the main clock by writing the CSS field in PMC_PCKx. Each output signal can also be divided by a power of 2 between 1 and 64 by writing the PRES (Prescaler) field in PMC_PCKx. Each output signal can be enabled and disabled by writing 1 in the corresponding bit, PCKx of PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR, respectively. Status of the active programmable output clocks are given in the PCKx bits of PMC_SCSR (System Clock Status Register). Moreover, like the PCK, a status bit in PMC_SR indicates that the Programmable Clock is actually what has been programmed in the Programmable Clock registers. As the Programmable Clock Controller does not manage with glitch prevention when switching clocks, it is strongly recommended to disable the Programmable Clock before any configuration change and to re-enable it after the change is actually performed.
27.6
Programming Sequence
1. Enabling the 12MHz Main Oscillator: The main oscillator is enabled by setting the MOSCEN field in the CKGR_MOR register. In some cases it may be advantageous to define a start-up time. This can be achieved by writing a value in the OSCOUNT field in the CKGR_MOR register. Once this register has been correctly configured, the user must wait for MOSCS field in the PMC_SR register to be set. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MOSCS has been enabled in the PMC_IER register.
2. Setting PLL and divider: All parameters needed to configure PLL and the divider are located in the CKGR_PLLR register. The DIV field is used to control divider itself. A value between 0 and 255 can be programmed. Divider output is divider input divided by DIV parameter. By default DIV parameter is set to 0 which means that divider is turned off. The OUT field is used to select the PLL output frequency range. The MUL field is the PLL multiplier factor. This parameter can be programmed between 0 and 2047. If MUL is set to 0, PLL will be turned off, otherwise the PLL output frequency is PLL input frequency multiplied by (MUL + 1). The PLLCOUNT field specifies the number of slow clock cycles before LOCK bit is set in the PMC_SR register after CKGR_PLLR register has been written. Once the PMC_PLL register has been written, the user must wait for the LOCK bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to LOCK has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. All parameters in CKGR_PLLR can be programmed in a single write operation. If at some stage one of the following parameters, MUL, DIV is modified, LOCK bit will go low to indicate that PLL is not ready yet. When PLL is locked, LOCK will be set again. The user is constrained to wait for LOCK bit to be set before using the PLL output clock. Code Example:
write_register(CKGR_PLLR,0x00040805)
264
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
If PLL and divider are enabled, the PLL input clock is the main clock. PLL output clock is PLL input clock multiplied by 5. Once CKGR_PLLR has been written, LOCK bit will be set after eight slow clock cycles.
3. Setting Bias and High Speed PLL (UPLL) for UTMI The UTMI PLL is enabled by setting the UPLLEN field in the CKGR_UCKR register. The UTMI Bias must be enabled by setting the BIASEN field in the CKGR_UCKR register in the same time. In some cases it may be advantageous to define a start-up time. This can be achieved by writing a value in the PLLCOUNT field in the CKGR_UCKR register.
Note: If UTMI Bias is not enabled, the USB Device works only in Full Speed Mode.
Once this register has been correctly configured, the user must wait for LOCKU field in the PMC_SR register to be set. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to LOCKU has been enabled in the PMC_IER register.
4. Selection of Master Clock and Processor Clock The Master Clock and the Processor Clock are configurable via the PMC_MCKR register. The CSS field is used to select the Master Clock divider source. By default, the selected clock source is slow clock. The PRES field is used to control the Master Clock prescaler. The user can choose between different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Master Clock output is prescaler input divided by PRES parameter. By default, PRES parameter is set to 1 which means that master clock is equal to slow clock. The MDIV field is used to control the Master Clock prescaler. It is possible to choose between different values (0, 1, 2). The Master Clock output is Processor Clock divided by 1, 2 or 4, depending on the value programmed in MDIV. By default, MDIV is set to 0, which indicates that the Processor Clock is equal to the Master Clock. Once the PMC_MCKR register has been written, the user must wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting for the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to MCKRDY has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. The PMC_MCKR register must not be programmed in a single write operation. The preferred programming sequence for the PMC_MCKR register is as follows: * If a new value for CSS field corresponds to PLL Clock, - Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register. - Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. - Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register. - Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. * If a new value for CSS field corresponds to Main Clock or Slow Clock, - Program the CSS field in the PMC_MCKR register. - Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register.
265
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- Program the PRES field in the PMC_MCKR register. - Wait for the MCKRDY bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. If at some stage one of the following parameters, CSS or PRES, is modified, the MCKRDY bit will go low to indicate that the Master Clock and the Processor Clock are not ready yet. The user must wait for MCKRDY bit to be set again before using the Master and Processor Clocks.
Note: IF PLLx clock was selected as the Master Clock and the user decides to modify it by writing in CKGR_PLLR, the MCKRDY flag will go low while PLL is unlocked. Once PLL is locked again, LOCK goes high and MCKRDY is set. While PLL is unlocked, the Master Clock selection is automatically changed to Main Clock. For further information, see Section 27.7.2. "Clock Switching Waveforms" on page 268.
Code Example:
write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000001)
wait (MCKRDY=1)
write_register(PMC_MCKR,0x00000011) wait (MCKRDY=1)
The Master Clock is main clock divided by 16. The Processor Clock is the Master Clock. 5. Selection of Programmable clocks Programmable clocks are controlled via registers; PMC_SCER, PMC_SCDR and PMC_SCSR. Programmable clocks can be enabled and/or disabled via the PMC_SCER and PMC_SCDR registers. Depending on the system used, 2 programmable clocks can be enabled or disabled. The PMC_SCSR provides a clear indication as to which Programmable clock is enabled. By default all Programmable clocks are disabled. PMC_PCKx registers are used to configure programmable clocks. The CSS field is used to select the programmable clock divider source. Four clock options are available: main clock, slow clock, PLLCK. By default, the clock source selected is slow clock. The PRES field is used to control the programmable clock prescaler. It is possible to choose between different values (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64). Programmable clock output is prescaler input divided by PRES parameter. By default, the PRES parameter is set to 1 which means that master clock is equal to slow clock. Once the PMC_PCKx register has been programmed, The corresponding programmable clock must be enabled and the user is constrained to wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be set in the PMC_SR register. This can be done either by polling the status register or by waiting the interrupt line to be raised if the associated interrupt to PCKRDYx has been enabled in the PMC_IER register. All parameters in PMC_PCKx can be programmed in a single write operation. If the CSS and PRES parameters are to be modified, the corresponding programmable clock must be disabled first. The parameters can then be modified. Once this has been
266
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
done, the user must re-enable the programmable clock and wait for the PCKRDYx bit to be set.
Code Example:
write_register(PMC_PCK0,0x00000015)
Programmable clock 0 is main clock divided by 32. 6. Enabling Peripheral Clocks Once all of the previous steps have been completed, the peripheral clocks can be enabled and/or disabled via registers PMC_PCER and PMC_PCDR. Depending on the system used, 19 peripheral clocks can be enabled or disabled. The PMC_PCSR provides a clear view as to which peripheral clock is enabled.
Note:
Each enabled peripheral clock corresponds to Master Clock.
Code Examples:
write_register(PMC_PCER,0x00000110)
Peripheral clocks 4 and 8 are enabled.
write_register(PMC_PCDR,0x00000010)
Peripheral clock 4 is disabled.
27.7
27.7.1
Clock Switching Details
Master Clock Switching Timings Table 27-1 gives the worst case timings required for the Master Clock to switch from one selected clock to another one. This is in the event that the prescaler is de-activated. When the prescaler is activated, an additional time of 64 clock cycles of the new selected clock has to be added. Table 27-1. Clock Switching Timings (Worst Case)
Main Clock SLCK PLL Clock
From To
267
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 27-1.
Clock Switching Timings (Worst Case)
Main Clock - 0.5 x Main Clock + 4.5 x SLCK 0.5 x Main Clock + 4 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK + 2.5 x PLLx Clock SLCK 4 x SLCK + 2.5 x Main Clock - 2.5 x PLL Clock + 5 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK PLL Clock 3 x PLL Clock + 4 x SLCK + 1 x Main Clock 3 x PLL Clock + 5 x SLCK 2.5 x PLL Clock + 4 x SLCK + PLLCOUNT x SLCK
From Main Clock
SLCK
PLL Clock
27.7.2
Clock Switching Waveforms Figure 27-2. Switch Master Clock from Slow Clock to PLL Clock
Slow Clock
PLL Clock
LOCK
MCKRDY
Master Clock
Write PMC_MCKR
268
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 27-3. Switch Master Clock from Main Clock to Slow Clock
Slow Clock
Main Clock
MCKRDY
Master Clock
Write PMC_MCKR
Figure 27-4. Change PLL Programming
Main Clock
PLL Clock
LOCK
MCKRDY
Master Clock Main Clock Write CKGR_PLLR
269
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 27-5. Programmable Clock Output Programming
PLL Clock
PCKRDY
PCKx Output
Write PMC_PCKx
PLL Clock is selected
Write PMC_SCER
PCKx is enabled
Write PMC_SCDR
PCKx is disabled
270
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8 Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register System Clock Enable Register System Clock Disable Register System Clock Status Register Reserved Peripheral Clock Enable Register Peripheral Clock Disable Register Peripheral Clock Status Register UTMI Clock Register Main Oscillator Register Main Clock Frequency Register PLL Register Reserved Master Clock Register Reserved Reserved Programmable Clock 0 Register Programmable Clock 1 Register Reserved Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Status Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved Name PMC_SCER PMC_SCDR PMC _SCSR - PMC _PCER PMC_PCDR PMC_PCSR CKGR_UCKR CKGR_MOR CKGR_MCFR CKGR_PLLR - PMC_MCKR - - PMC_PCK0 PMC_PCK1 - PMC_IER PMC_IDR PMC_SR PMC_IMR - Access Write-only Write-only Read-only - Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-write Read-write Read-only Read-write - Read-write - - Read-write Read-write - Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only - Reset Value - - 0x01 - - - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x3F00 - 0x0 - - 0x0 0x0 - --0x08 0x0 -
Table 27-2.
Offset 0x0000 0x0004 0x0008 0x000C 0x0010 0x0014 0x0018 0x001C 0x0020 0x0024 0x0028 0x002C 0x0030 0x0038 0x003C 0x0040 0x0044
0x0048 - 0x005C 0x0060 0x0064 0x0068 0x006C 0x0070 - 0x007C
271
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.1 Name: Acess:
31
PMC System Clock Enable Register PMC_SCER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCK1
1
PCK0
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
* PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding Programmable Clock output.
272
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.2 Name: Acess:
31
PMC System Clock Disable Register PMC_SCDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCK1
1
PCK0
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PCK
* PCK: Processor Clock Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Processor clock. This is used to enter the processor in Idle Mode. * PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding Programmable Clock output.
273
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.3 Name: Acess:
31
PMC System Clock Status Register PMC_SCSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCK1
1
PCK0
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PCK
* PCK: Processor Clock Status 0 = The Processor clock is disabled. 1 = The Processor clock is enabled. * PCKx: Programmable Clock x Output Status 0 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is disabled. 1 = The corresponding Programmable Clock output is enabled.
274
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.4 Name: Access :
31
PMC Peripheral Clock Enable Register PMC_PCER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
PID31
23
PID30
22
PID29
21
PID28
20
PID27
19
PID26
18
PID25
17
PID24
16
PID23
15
PID22
14
PID21
13
PID20
12
PID19
11
PID18
10
PID17
9
PID16
8
PID15
7
PID14
6
PID13
5
PID12
4
PID11
3
PID10
2
PID9
1
PID8
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
-
-
* PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding peripheral clock.
Note: Note: PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section "Peripheral Identifiers" in the product datasheet. Programming the control bits of the Peripheral ID that are not implemented has no effect on the behavior of the PMC.
27.8.5 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Peripheral Clock Disable Register PMC_PCDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
PID31
23
PID30
22
PID29
21
PID28
20
PID27
19
PID26
18
PID25
17
PID24
16
PID23
15
PID22
14
PID21
13
PID20
12
PID19
11
PID18
10
PID17
9
PID16
8
PID15
7
PID14
6
PID13
5
PID12
4
PID11
3
PID10
2
PID9
1
PID8
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
-
-
* PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding peripheral clock.
Note: PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section "Peripheral Identifiers" in the product datasheet.
275
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.6 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Peripheral Clock Status Register PMC_PCSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
PID31
23
PID30
22
PID29
21
PID28
20
PID27
19
PID26
18
PID25
17
PID24
16
PID23
15
PID22
14
PID21
13
PID20
12
PID19
11
PID18
10
PID17
9
PID16
8
PID15
7
PID14
6
PID13
5
PID12
4
PID11
3
PID10
2
PID9
1
PID8
0
PID7
PID6
PID5
PID4
PID3
PID2
-
-
* PIDx: Peripheral Clock x Status 0 = The corresponding peripheral clock is disabled. 1 = The corresponding peripheral clock is enabled.
Note: PID2 to PID31 refer to identifiers as defined in the section "Peripheral Identifiers" in the product datasheet.
276
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.7 Name: Acess:
31
PMC UTMI Clock Configuration Register CKGR_UCKR Read-write
30 BIASCOUNT 29 28 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 BIASEN 16 UPLLEN 8 - 0 -
23
22 PLLCOUNT
21
20
15 - 7 -
14 - 6 -
13 - 5 -
12 - 4 -
* UPLLEN: UTMI PLL Enable 0 = The UTMI PLL is disabled. 1 = The UTMI PLL is enabled. When UPLLEN is set, the LOCKU flag is set once the UTMI PLL startup time is achieved. * PLLCOUNT: UTMI PLL Start-up Time Specifies the number of Slow Clock cycles multiplied by 8 for the UTMI PLL start-up time. * BIASEN: UTMI BIAS Enable 0 = The UTMI BIAS is disabled. The USB Device works only in FS Mode. 1 = The UTMI BIAS is enabled. The USB Device works in HS Mode. * BIASCOUNT: UTMI BIAS Start-up Time Specifies the number of Slow Clock cycles for the UTMI BIAS start-up time.
277
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.8 Name: Acess:
31 - 23 - 15
PMC Clock Generator Main Oscillator Register CKGR_MOR Read-write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 OSCOUNT 7 - 6 - 5 - 4 - 3 - 2 - 1 OSCBYPASS 0 MOSCEN 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* MOSCEN: Main Oscillator Enable A crystal must be connected between XIN and XOUT. 0 = The Main Oscillator is disabled. 1 = The Main Oscillator is enabled. OSCBYPASS must be set to 0. When MOSCEN is set, the MOSCS flag is set once the Main Oscillator startup time is achieved. * OSCBYPASS: Oscillator Bypass 0 = No effect. 1 = The Main Oscillator is bypassed. MOSCEN must be set to 0. An external clock must be connected on XIN. When OSCBYPASS is set, the MOSCS flag in PMC_SR is automatically set. Clearing MOSCEN and OSCBYPASS bits allows resetting the MOSCS flag. * OSCOUNT: Main Oscillator Start-up Time Specifies the number of Slow Clock cycles multiplied by 8 for the Main Oscillator start-up time.
278
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.9 Name: Acess:
31 - 23 - 15
PMC Clock Generator Main Clock Frequency Register CKGR_MCFR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 MAINF 7 6 5 4 MAINF 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 MAINRDY 8
* MAINF: Main Clock Frequency Gives the number of Main Clock cycles within 16 Slow Clock periods. * MAINRDY: Main Clock Ready 0 = MAINF value is not valid or the Main Oscillator is disabled. 1 = The Main Oscillator has been enabled previously and MAINF value is available.
279
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.10 Name: Acess:
31 - 23
PMC Clock Generator PLL Register CKGR_PLLR Read-write
30 - 22 29 1 21 28 - 20 MUL 27 - 19 26 25 MUL 17 24
18
16
15 OUT 7
14
13
12
11 PLLCOUNT
10
9
8
6
5
4 DIV
3
2
1
0
Possible limitations on PLL input frequencies and multiplier factors should be checked before using the PMC. Warning: Bit 29 must always be set to 1 when programming the CKGR_PLLR register.
* DIV: Divider
DIV 0 1 2 - 255 Divider Selected Divider output is 0 Divider is bypassed Divider output is the selected clock divided by DIV.
* PLLCOUNT: PLL Counter Specifies the number of slow clock cycles before the LOCK bit is set in PMC_SR after CKGR_PLLR is written. * OUT: PLL Clock Frequency Range To optimize clock performance, this field must be programmed as specified in "PLL Characteristics" in the Electrical Characteristics section of the product datasheet. * MUL: PLL Multiplier 0 = The PLL is deactivated. 1 up to 2047 = The PLL Clock frequency is the PLL input frequency multiplied by MUL+ 1.
280
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.11 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Master Clock Register PMC_MCKR Read-write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2 1
MDIV
0
-
-
-
PRES
CSS
* CSS: Master Clock Selection
CSS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Clock Source Selection Slow Clock is selected Main Clock is selected PLL Clock is selected. Reserved
* PRES: Processor Clock Prescaler
PRES 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Processor Clock Selected clock Selected clock divided by 2 Selected clock divided by 4 Selected clock divided by 8 Selected clock divided by 16 Selected clock divided by 32 Selected clock divided by 64 Reserved
* MDIV: Master Clock Division
MDIV 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Master Clock Division Master Clock is Processor Clock. Master Clock is Processor Clock divided by 2. Master Clock is Processor Clock divided by 4. Reserved.
281
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.12 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Programmable Clock Register PMC_PCKx Read-write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
PRES
CSS
* CSS: Master Clock Selection
CSS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Clock Source Selection Slow Clock is selected Main Clock is selected PLL Clock is selected. Reserved
* PRES: Programmable Clock Prescaler
PRES 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Programmable Clock Selected clock Selected clock divided by 2 Selected clock divided by 4 Selected clock divided by 8 Selected clock divided by 16 Selected clock divided by 32 Selected clock divided by 64 Reserved
282
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.13 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Interrupt Enable Register PMC_IER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKRDY1
1
PCKRDY0
0
-
LOCKU
-
-
MCKRDY
-
LOCK
MOSCS
* MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Enable * LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Enable * MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Enable * LOCKU: UTMI PLL Lock Interrupt Enable * PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
283
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.14 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Interrupt Disable Register PMC_IDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKRDY1
1
PCKRDY0
0
-
LOCKU
-
-
MCKRDY
-
LOCK
MOSCS
* MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Disable * LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Disable * MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Disable * LOCKU: UTMI PLL Lock Interrupt Disable * PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
284
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
27.8.15 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Status Register PMC_SR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKRDY1
1
PCKRDY0
0
OSC_SEL
LOCKU
-
-
MCKRDY
-
LOCK
MOSCS
* MOSCS: MOSCS Flag Status 0 = Main oscillator is not stabilized. 1 = Main oscillator is stabilized. * LOCK: PLL Lock Status 0 = PLL is not locked 1 = PLL is locked. * MCKRDY: Master Clock Status 0 = Master Clock is not ready. 1 = Master Clock is ready. * LOCKU: UPLL Lock Status 0 = UPLL is not locked 1 = UPLL is locked. * OSC_SEL: Slow Clock Oscillator 0 = Internal slow clock RC oscillator is selected. 1 = External slow clock 32 kHz oscillator is selected. * PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready Status 0 = Programmable Clock x is not ready. 1 = Programmable Clock x is ready.
285
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.8.16 Name: Acess:
31
PMC Interrupt Mask Register PMC_IMR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKRDY1
1
PCKRDY0
0
-
LOCKU
-
-
MCKRDY
-
LOCK
MOSCS
* MOSCS: Main Oscillator Status Interrupt Mask * LOCK: PLL Lock Interrupt Mask * MCKRDY: Master Clock Ready Interrupt Mask * LOCKU: UTMI PLL Lock Interrupt Mask * PCKRDYx: Programmable Clock Ready x Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled.
286
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Bus Matrix
28.1 Description
Bus Matrix implements a multi-layer AHB, based on AHB-Lite protocol, that enables parallel access paths between multiple AHB masters and slaves in a system, which increases the overall bandwidth. Bus Matrix interconnects 6 AHB Masters to 6 AHB Slaves. The normal latency to connect a master to a slave is one cycle except for the default master of the accessed slave which is connected directly (zero cycle latency). The Bus Matrix user interface is compliant with ARM Advanced Peripheral Bus and provides a Chip Configuration User Interface with Registers that allow the Bus Matrix to support application specific features.
28.2
Memory Mapping
Bus Matrix provides one decoder for every AHB Master Interface. The decoder offers each AHB Master several memory mappings. In fact, depending on the product, each memory area may be assigned to several slaves. Booting at the same address while using different AHB slaves (i.e., external RAM, internal ROM or internal Flash, etc.) becomes possible. The Bus Matrix user interface provides Master Remap Control Register (MATRIX_MRCR) that allows to perform remap action for every master independently.
28.3
Special Bus Granting Techniques
The Bus Matrix provides some speculative bus granting techniques in order to anticipate access requests from some masters. This mechanism allows to reduce latency at first accesses of a burst or single transfer. The bus granting mechanism allows to set a default master for every slave. At the end of the current access, if no other request is pending, the slave remains connected to its associated default master. A slave can be associated with three kinds of default masters: no default master, last access master and fixed default master.
28.3.1
No Default Master At the end of the current access, if no other request is pending, the slave is disconnected from all masters. No Default Master, suits low power mode. Last Access Master At the end of the current access, if no other request is pending, the slave remains connected to the last master that performed an access request. Fixed Default Master At the end of the current access, if no other request is pending, the slave connects to its fixed default master. Unlike last access master, the fixed master doesn't change unless the user modifies it by a software action (field FIXED_DEFMSTR of the related MATRIX_SCFG). To change from one kind of default master to another, the Bus Matrix user interface provides the Slave Configuration Registers, one for each slave, that allow to set a default master for each slave. The Slave Configuration Register contains two fields: DEFMSTR_TYPE and FIXED_DEFMSTR. The 2-bit DEFMSTR_TYPE field allows to choose the default master type (no default, last access master, fixed default master) whereas the 4-bit
28.3.2
28.3.3
287
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
FIXED_DEFMSTR field allows to choose a fixed default master provided that DEFMSTR_TYPE is set to fixed default master. Please refer to the Bus Matrix user interface description.
28.4
Arbitration
The Bus Matrix provides an arbitration mechanism that allows to reduce latency when conflict cases occur, basically when two or more masters try to access the same slave at the same time. One arbiter per AHB slave is provided, allowing to arbitrate each slave differently. The Bus Matrix provides to the user the possibility to choose between 2 arbitration types, and this for each slave: 1. Round-Robin Arbitration (the default) 2. Fixed Priority Arbitration This choice is given through the field ARBT of the Slave Configuration Registers (MATRIX_SCFG). Each algorithm may be complemented by selecting a default master configuration for each slave. When a re-arbitration has to be done, it is realized only under some specific conditions detailed in the following paragraph.
28.4.1
Arbitration rules Each arbiter has the ability to arbitrate between two or more different master's requests. In order to avoid burst breaking and also to provide the maximum throughput for slave interfaces, arbitration may only take place during the following cycles: 1. Idle Cycles: when a slave is not connected to any master or is connected to a master which is not currently accessing it. 2. Single Cycles: when a slave is currently doing a single access. 3. End of Burst Cycles: when the current cycle is the last cycle of a burst transfer. For defined length burst, predicted end of burst matches the size of the transfer but is managed differently for undefined length burst (See "Undefined Length Burst Arbitration" on page iv.). 4. Slot Cycle Limit: when the slot cycle counter has reach the limit value indicating that the current master access is too long and must be broken (See "Slot Cycle Limit Arbitration" on page iv.).
28.4.1.1
Undefined Length Burst Arbitration In order to avoid too long slave handling during undefined length bursts (INCR), the Bus Matrix provides specific logic in order to re-arbitrate before the end of the INCR transfer. A predicted end of burst is used as for defined length burst transfer, which is selected between the following: 1. Infinite: no predicted end of burst is generated and therefore INCR burst transfer will never be broken. 2. Four beat bursts: predicted end of burst is generated at the end of each four beat boundary inside INCR transfer. 3. Eight beat bursts: predicted end of burst is generated at the end of each eight beat boundary inside INCR transfer. 4. Sixteen beat bursts: predicted end of burst is generated at the end of each sixteen beat boundary inside INCR transfer.
288
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
This selection can be done through the field ULBT of the Master Configuration Registers (MATRIX_MCFG). 28.4.1.2 Slot Cycle Limit Arbitration The Bus Matrix contains specific logic to break too long accesses such as very long bursts on a very slow slave (e.g. an external low speed memory). At the beginning of the burst access, a counter is loaded with the value previously written in the SLOT_CYCLE field of the related Slave Configuration Register (MATRIX_SCFG) and decreased at each clock cycle. When the counter reaches zero, the arbiter has the ability to re-arbitrate at the end of the current byte, half word or word transfer. Round-Robin Arbitration This algorithm allows the Bus Matrix arbiters to dispatch the requests from different masters to the same slave in a round-robin manner. If two or more master's requests arise at the same time, the master with the lowest number is first serviced then the others are serviced in a roundrobin manner. There are three round-robin algorithm implemented: * Round-Robin arbitration without default master * Round-Robin arbitration with last access master * Round-Robin arbitration with fixed default master 28.4.2.1 Round-Robin Arbitration without Default Master This is the main algorithm used by Bus Matrix arbiters. It allows the Bus Matrix to dispatch requests from different masters to the same slave in a pure round-robin manner. At the end of the current access, if no other request is pending, the slave is disconnected from all masters. This configuration incurs one latency cycle for the first access of a burst. Arbitration without default master can be used for masters that perform significant bursts. Round-Robin Arbitration with Last Access Master This is a biased round-robin algorithm used by Bus Matrix arbiters. It allows the Bus Matrix to remove the one latency cycle for the last master that accessed the slave. In fact, at the end of the current transfer, if no other master request is pending, the slave remains connected to the last master that performs the access. Other non privileged masters will still get one latency cycle if they want to access the same slave. This technique can be used for masters that mainly perform single accesses. Round-Robin Arbitration with Fixed Default Master This is another biased round-robin algorithm, it allows the Bus Matrix arbiters to remove the one latency cycle for the fixed default master per slave. At the end of the current access, the slave remains connected to its fixed default master. Every request attempted by this fixed default master will not cause any latency whereas other non privileged masters will still get one latency cycle. This technique can be used for masters that mainly perform single accesses. Fixed Priority Arbitration This algorithm allows the Bus Matrix arbiters to dispatch the requests from different masters to the same slave by using the fixed priority defined by the user. If two or more master's requests are active at the same time, the master with the highest priority number is serviced first. If two or
28.4.2
28.4.2.2
28.4.2.3
28.4.3
289
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
more master's requests with the same priority are active at the same time, the master with the highest number is serviced first. For each slave, the priority of each master may be defined through the Priority Registers for Slaves (MATRIX_PRAS and MATRIX_PRBS).
290
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5 Bus Matrix User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Master Configuration Register 0 Master Configuration Register 1 Master Configuration Register 2 Master Configuration Register 3 Master Configuration Register 4 Master Configuration Register 5 Reserved Slave Configuration Register 0 Slave Configuration Register 1 Slave Configuration Register 2 Slave Configuration Register 3 Slave Configuration Register 4 Slave Configuration Register 5 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 0 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 1 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 2 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 3 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 4 Reserved Priority Register A for Slave 5 Reserved Master Remap Control Register Reserved Reserved Bus Matrix TCM Configuration Register Reserved EBI Chip Select Assignment Register Reserved EBI_CSA - Name MATRIX_MCFG0 MATRIX_MCFG1 MATRIX_MCFG2 MATRIX_MCFG3 MATRIX_MCFG4 MATRIX_MCFG5 - MATRIX_SCFG0 MATRIX_SCFG1 MATRIX_SCFG2 MATRIX_SCFG3 MATRIX_SCFG4 MATRIX_SCFG5 - MATRIX_PRAS0 MATRIX_PRAS1 MATRIX_PRAS2 MATRIX_PRAS3 MATRIX_PRAS4 MATRIX_PRAS5 - MATRIX_MRCR - - MATRIX_TCR - Access Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - Write Write Write Write Write Write - Read/Write - - Read/Write - Read/Write - Reset Value 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 - 0x00010010 0x00050010 0x00000010 0x00000010 0x00000010 0x00000010 - 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 - 0x00000000 - - 0x00000000 - 0x00010000 -
Table 28-1.
Offset 0x0000 0x0004 0x0008 0x000C 0x0010 0x0014
0x0018 - 0x003C 0x0040 0x0044 0x0048 0x004C 0x0050 0x0054 0x0058 - 0x007C 0x0080 0x0084 0x0088 0x008C 0x0090 0x0094 0x0098 0x009C 0x00A0 0x00A4 0x00A8 0x00A8 - 0x00FC 0x0100 0x0104 - 0x010C 0x0110 0x0114 0x0118-0x11C 0x0120 0x0124 - 0x01FC
291
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.1 Bus Matrix Master Configuration Registers Register Name: MATRIX_MCFG0...MATRIX_MCFG5 Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 ULBT 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* ULBT: Undefined Length Burst Type 0: Infinite Length Burst No predicted end of burst is generated and therefore INCR bursts coming from this master cannot be broken. 1: Single Access The undefined length burst is treated as a succession of single accesses, allowing rearbitration at each beat of the INCR burst. 2: Four-beat Burst The undefined length burst is split into four-beat burst allowing rearbitration at each four-beat burst end. 3: Eight-beat Burst The undefined length burst is split into eight-beat burst allowing rearbitration at each eight-beat burst end. 4: Sixteen-beat Burst The undefined length burst is split into sixteen-beat burst allowing rearbitration at each sixteen-beat burst end.
292
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.2 Bus Matrix Slave Configuration Registers Register Name: MATRIX_SCFG0...MATRIX_SCFG5 Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 14 - 6 13 - 5
Read/Write
30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 27 - 19 26 - 18 17 25 ARBT 16 24
FIXED_DEFMSTR 12 - 4 SLOT_CYCLE 11 - 3 10 - 2
DEFMSTR_TYPE 9 - 1 8 - 0
* SLOT_CYCLE: Maximum Number of Allowed Cycles for a Burst When the SLOT_CYCLE limit is reached for a burst, it may be broken by another master trying to access this slave. This limit has been placed to avoid locking a very slow slave when very long bursts are used. Note that an unreasonably small value breaks every burst and the Bus Matrix then arbitrates without performing any data transfer. 16 cycles is a reasonable value for SLOT_CYCLE. * DEFMASTR_TYPE: Default Master Type 0: No Default Master At the end of current slave access, if no other master request is pending, the slave is disconnected from all masters. This results in a one-cycle latency for the first access of a burst transfer or for a single access. 1: Last Default Master At the end of current slave access, if no other master request is pending, the slave remains connected to the last master that accessed it. This results in not having the one cycle latency when the last master tries access to the slave again. 2: Fixed Default Master At the end of the current slave access, if no other master request is pending, the slave connects to the fixed master the number of which has been written in the FIXED_DEFMSTR field. This results in not having the one cycle latency when the fixed master tries access to the slave again. * FIXED_DEFMSTR: Fixed Default Master This is the number of the Default Master for this slave. Only used if DEFMASTR_TYPE is 2. Specifying the number of a master which is not connected to the selected slave is equivalent to setting DEFMASTR_TYPE to 0. * ARBT: Arbitration Type 0: Round-Robin Arbitration 1: Fixed Priority Arbitration 2: Reserved 3: Reserved
293
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.3 Bus Matrix Priority Registers A For Slaves Register Name: MATRIX_PRAS0...MATRIX_PRAS5 Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 5 M1PR 13 M3PR 4 29 - 21 M5PR 12 28 - 20 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 1 M0PR 9 M2PR 0 25 - 17 M4PR 8 24 - 16
* MxPR: Master x Priority Fixed priority of Master x for accessing to the selected slave.The higher the number, the higher the priority.
294
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.4 Bus Matrix Master Remap Control Register Register Name: MATRIX_MRCR Access Type: Reset:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write 0x0000_0000
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 RCB5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RCB4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 RCB3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 RCB2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 RCB1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 RCB0
* RCBx: Remap Command Bit for AHB Master x 0: Disable remapped address decoding for the selected Master. 1: Enable remapped address decoding for the selected Master. Table 28-2.
RCBx RCB0 RCB1 RCB2 RCB3 RCB4 RCB5
AT91SAM9R/RL64 Remap Control Bits
Master ARM926 Instruction ARM926 Data Peripheral DMA Controller USB Device High Speed DMA LCD Controller DMA DMA Controller
295
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.5 Bus Matrix TCM Configuration Register Register Name: MATRIX_TCR Access Type: Reset:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
Read/Write 0x0000_0000
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 DTCM_SIZE 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 ITCM_SIZE 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* ITCM_SIZE: Size of ITCM enabled memory block 0000: 0 KB (No ITCM Memory) 0101: 16 KB 0110: 32 KB Others: Reserved * DTCM_SIZE: Size of DTCM enabled memory block 0000: 0 KB (No DTCM Memory) 0101: 16 KB 0110: 32 KB Others: Reserved
296
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
28.5.6 EBI0 Chip Select Assignment Register Register Name: EBI_CSA Access Type: Reset:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write 0x0001_0000
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 EBI_CS5A 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 EBI_CS4A 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 EBI_CS3A 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 EBI_CS1A 24 - 16 VDDIOMSEL 8 EBI_DBPUC 0 -
* EBI0_CS1A: EBI0 Chip Select 1 Assignment 0 = EBI0 Chip Select 1 is assigned to the Static Memory Controller. 1 = EBI0 Chip Select 1 is assigned to the SDRAM Controller. * EBI0_CS3A: EBI0 Chip Select 3 Assignment 0 = EBI0 Chip Select 3 is only assigned to the Static Memory Controller and EBI0_NCS3 behaves as defined by the SMC. 1 = EBI0 Chip Select 3 is assigned to the Static Memory Controller and the NAND Flash Logic is activated. * EBI0_CS4A: EBI0 Chip Select 4 Assignment 0 = EBI0 Chip Select 4 is only assigned to the Static Memory Controller and EBI0_NCS4 behaves as defined by the SMC. 1 = EBI0 Chip Select 4 is assigned to the Static Memory Controller and the CompactFlash Logic (first slot) is activated. * EBI0_CS5A: EBI0 Chip Select 5 Assignment 0 = EBI0 Chip Select 5 is only assigned to the Static Memory Controller and EBI0_NCS5 behaves as defined by the SMC. 1 = EBI0 Chip Select 5 is assigned to the Static Memory Controller and the CompactFlash Logic (second slot) is activated. * EBI0_DBPUC: EBI0 Data Bus Pull-Up Configuration 0 = EBI0 D0 - D15 Data Bus bits are internally pulled-up to the VDDIOM0 power supply. 1 = EBI0 D0 - D15 Data Bus bits are not internally pulled-up. * VDDIOMSEL: Memory voltage selection 0 = Memories are 1.8V powered. 1 = Memories are 3.3V powered.
297
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
298
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29. Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC)
29.1 Description
The Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) is an 8-level priority, individually maskable, vectored interrupt controller, providing handling of up to thirty-two interrupt sources. It is designed to substantially reduce the software and real-time overhead in handling internal and external interrupts. The AIC drives the nFIQ (fast interrupt request) and the nIRQ (standard interrupt request) inputs of an ARM processor. Inputs of the AIC are either internal peripheral interrupts or external interrupts coming from the product's pins. The 8-level Priority Controller allows the user to define the priority for each interrupt source, thus permitting higher priority interrupts to be serviced even if a lower priority interrupt is being treated. Internal interrupt sources can be programmed to be level sensitive or edge triggered. External interrupt sources can be programmed to be positive-edge or negative-edge triggered or highlevel or low-level sensitive. The fast forcing feature redirects any internal or external interrupt source to provide a fast interrupt rather than a normal interrupt.
299
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.2
Block Diagram
Figure 29-1. Block Diagram
FIQ IRQ0-IRQn AIC ARM Processor Up to Thirty-two Sources nFIQ nIRQ
Embedded PeripheralEE Embedded
Peripheral Embedded
Peripheral
APB
29.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 29-2. Description of the Application Block
OS-based Applications Standalone Applications OS Drivers RTOS Drivers Hard Real Time Tasks General OS Interrupt Handler Advanced Interrupt Controller Embedded Peripherals External Peripherals (External Interrupts)
29.4
AIC Detailed Block Diagram
Figure 29-3. AIC Detailed Block Diagram
Advanced Interrupt Controller FIQ PIO Controller External Source Input Stage Fast Interrupt Controller ARM Processor nFIQ
nIRQ IRQ0-IRQn PIOIRQ Internal Source Input Stage Fast Forcing Interrupt Priority Controller Processor Clock Power Management Controller User Interface Wake Up
Embedded Peripherals
APB
300
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.5 I/O Line Description
I/O Line Description
Pin Description Fast Interrupt Interrupt 0 - Interrupt n Type Input Input
Table 29-1.
Pin Name FIQ IRQ0 - IRQn
29.6
29.6.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are normally multiplexed through the PIO controllers. Depending on the features of the PIO controller used in the product, the pins must be programmed in accordance with their assigned interrupt function. This is not applicable when the PIO controller used in the product is transparent on the input path.
29.6.2
Power Management The Advanced Interrupt Controller is continuously clocked. The Power Management Controller has no effect on the Advanced Interrupt Controller behavior. The assertion of the Advanced Interrupt Controller outputs, either nIRQ or nFIQ, wakes up the ARM processor while it is in Idle Mode. The General Interrupt Mask feature enables the AIC to wake up the processor without asserting the interrupt line of the processor, thus providing synchronization of the processor on an event.
29.6.3
Interrupt Sources The Interrupt Source 0 is always located at FIQ. If the product does not feature an FIQ pin, the Interrupt Source 0 cannot be used. The Interrupt Source 1 is always located at System Interrupt. This is the result of the OR-wiring of the system peripheral interrupt lines, such as the System Timer, the Real Time Clock, the Power Management Controller and the Memory Controller. When a system interrupt occurs, the service routine must first distinguish the cause of the interrupt. This is performed by reading successively the status registers of the above mentioned system peripherals. The interrupt sources 2 to 31 can either be connected to the interrupt outputs of an embedded user peripheral or to external interrupt lines. The external interrupt lines can be connected directly, or through the PIO Controller. The PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals in the scope of interrupt handling. Accordingly, the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected to the Interrupt Sources 2 to 31. The peripheral identification defined at the product level corresponds to the interrupt source number (as well as the bit number controlling the clock of the peripheral). Consequently, to simplify the description of the functional operations and the user interface, the interrupt sources are named FIQ, SYS, and PID2 to PID31.
301
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.7
29.7.1
Functional Description
Interrupt Source Control Interrupt Source Mode The Advanced Interrupt Controller independently programs each interrupt source. The SRCTYPE field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register) selects the interrupt condition of each source. The internal interrupt sources wired on the interrupt outputs of the embedded peripherals can be programmed either in level-sensitive mode or in edge-triggered mode. The active level of the internal interrupts is not important for the user. The external interrupt sources can be programmed either in high level-sensitive or low level-sensitive modes, or in positive edge-triggered or negative edge-triggered modes.
29.7.1.1
29.7.1.2
Interrupt Source Enabling Each interrupt source, including the FIQ in source 0, can be enabled or disabled by using the command registers; AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt Disable Command Register). This set of registers conducts enabling or disabling in one instruction. The interrupt mask can be read in the AIC_IMR register. A disabled interrupt does not affect servicing of other interrupts. Interrupt Clearing and Setting All interrupt sources programmed to be edge-triggered (including the FIQ in source 0) can be individually set or cleared by writing respectively the AIC_ISCR and AIC_ICCR registers. Clearing or setting interrupt sources programmed in level-sensitive mode has no effect. The clear operation is perfunctory, as the software must perform an action to reinitialize the "memorization" circuitry activated when the source is programmed in edge-triggered mode. However, the set operation is available for auto-test or software debug purposes. It can also be used to execute an AIC-implementation of a software interrupt. The AIC features an automatic clear of the current interrupt when the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register) is read. Only the interrupt source being detected by the AIC as the current interrupt is affected by this operation. (See "Priority Controller" on page 305.) The automatic clear reduces the operations required by the interrupt service routine entry code to reading the AIC_IVR. Note that the automatic interrupt clear is disabled if the interrupt source has the Fast Forcing feature enabled as it is considered uniquely as a FIQ source. (For further details, See "Fast Forcing" on page 309.) The automatic clear of the interrupt source 0 is performed when AIC_FVR is read.
29.7.1.3
29.7.1.4
Interrupt Status For each interrupt, the AIC operation originates in AIC_IPR (Interrupt Pending Register) and its mask in AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register). AIC_IPR enables the actual activity of the sources, whether masked or not. The AIC_ISR register reads the number of the current interrupt (see "Priority Controller" on page 305) and the register AIC_CISR gives an image of the signals nIRQ and nFIQ driven on the processor. Each status referred to above can be used to optimize the interrupt handling of the systems.
302
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.7.1.5 Figure 29-4. Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage Internal Interrupt Source Input Stage
AIC_SMRI (SRCTYPE) Source i Level/ Edge AIC_IPR AIC_IMR Fast Interrupt Controller or Priority Controller AIC_IECR
Edge
Detector Set Clear AIC_ISCR AIC_ICCR FF
AIC_IDCR
29.7.1.6
External Interrupt Source Input Stage
Figure 29-5. External Interrupt Source Input Stage
High/Low AIC_SMRi SRCTYPE Level/ Edge Source i AIC_IPR AIC_IMR Fast Interrupt Controller or Priority Controller Pos./Neg. Edge Detector Set AIC_ISCR AIC_ICCR Clear AIC_IDCR AIC_IECR
FF
303
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.7.2
Interrupt Latencies Global interrupt latencies depend on several parameters, including: * The time the software masks the interrupts. * Occurrence, either at the processor level or at the AIC level. * The execution time of the instruction in progress when the interrupt occurs. * The treatment of higher priority interrupts and the resynchronization of the hardware signals. This section addresses only the hardware resynchronizations. It gives details of the latency times between the event on an external interrupt leading in a valid interrupt (edge or level) or the assertion of an internal interrupt source and the assertion of the nIRQ or nFIQ line on the processor. The resynchronization time depends on the programming of the interrupt source and on its type (internal or external). For the standard interrupt, resynchronization times are given assuming there is no higher priority in progress. The PIO Controller multiplexing has no effect on the interrupt latencies of the external interrupt sources.
29.7.2.1 Figure 29-6.
External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source External Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
MCK IRQ or FIQ (Positive Edge) IRQ or FIQ (Negative Edge)
nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 4 Cycles
nFIQ Maximum FIQ Latency = 4 Cycles
29.7.2.2 Figure 29-7.
External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source External Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
MCK IRQ or FIQ (High Level) IRQ or FIQ (Low Level) nIRQ Maximum IRQ Latency = 3 Cycles
nFIQ Maximum FIQ Latency = 3 cycles
304
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.7.2.3 Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
Figure 29-8. Internal Interrupt Edge Triggered Source
MCK
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ Latency = 4.5 Cycles Peripheral Interrupt Becomes Active
29.7.2.4
Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
Figure 29-9. Internal Interrupt Level Sensitive Source
MCK
nIRQ
Maximum IRQ Latency = 3.5 Cycles Peripheral Interrupt Becomes Active
29.7.3 29.7.3.1
Normal Interrupt Priority Controller An 8-level priority controller drives the nIRQ line of the processor, depending on the interrupt conditions occurring on the interrupt sources 1 to 31 (except for those programmed in Fast Forcing). Each interrupt source has a programmable priority level of 7 to 0, which is user-definable by writing the PRIOR field of the corresponding AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register). Level 7 is the highest priority and level 0 the lowest. As soon as an interrupt condition occurs, as defined by the SRCTYPE field of the AIC_SMR (Source Mode Register), the nIRQ line is asserted. As a new interrupt condition might have happened on other interrupt sources since the nIRQ has been asserted, the priority controller determines the current interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register) is read. The read of AIC_IVR is the entry point of the interrupt handling which allows the AIC to consider that the interrupt has been taken into account by the software. The current priority level is defined as the priority level of the current interrupt. If several interrupt sources of equal priority are pending and enabled when the AIC_IVR is read, the interrupt with the lowest interrupt source number is serviced first.
305
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The nIRQ line can be asserted only if an interrupt condition occurs on an interrupt source with a higher priority. If an interrupt condition happens (or is pending) during the interrupt treatment in progress, it is delayed until the software indicates to the AIC the end of the current service by writing the AIC_EOICR (End of Interrupt Command Register). The write of AIC_EOICR is the exit point of the interrupt handling. 29.7.3.2 Interrupt Nesting The priority controller utilizes interrupt nesting in order for the high priority interrupt to be handled during the service of lower priority interrupts. This requires the interrupt service routines of the lower interrupts to re-enable the interrupt at the processor level. When an interrupt of a higher priority happens during an already occurring interrupt service routine, the nIRQ line is re-asserted. If the interrupt is enabled at the core level, the current execution is interrupted and the new interrupt service routine should read the AIC_IVR. At this time, the current interrupt number and its priority level are pushed into an embedded hardware stack, so that they are saved and restored when the higher priority interrupt servicing is finished and the AIC_EOICR is written. The AIC is equipped with an 8-level wide hardware stack in order to support up to eight interrupt nestings pursuant to having eight priority levels. 29.7.3.3 Interrupt Vectoring The interrupt handler addresses corresponding to each interrupt source can be stored in the registers AIC_SVR1 to AIC_SVR31 (Source Vector Register 1 to 31). When the processor reads AIC_IVR (Interrupt Vector Register), the value written into AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt is returned. This feature offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the handler corresponding to the current interrupt, as AIC_IVR is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F100 and thus accessible from the ARM interrupt vector at address 0x0000 0018 through the following instruction:
LDR PC,[PC,# -&F20]
When the processor executes this instruction, it loads the read value in AIC_IVR in its program counter, thus branching the execution on the correct interrupt handler. This feature is often not used when the application is based on an operating system (either real time or not). Operating systems often have a single entry point for all the interrupts and the first task performed is to discern the source of the interrupt. However, it is strongly recommended to port the operating system on AT91 products by supporting the interrupt vectoring. This can be performed by defining all the AIC_SVR of the interrupt source to be handled by the operating system at the address of its interrupt handler. When doing so, the interrupt vectoring permits a critical interrupt to transfer the execution on a specific very fast handler and not onto the operating system's general interrupt handler. This facilitates the support of hard real-time tasks (input/outputs of voice/audio buffers and software peripheral handling) to be handled efficiently and independently of the application running under an operating system. 29.7.3.4 Interrupt Handlers This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and the associated status bits.
306
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
It is assumed that: 1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR registers are loaded with corresponding interrupt service routine addresses and interrupts are enabled. 2. The instruction at the ARM interrupt exception vector address is required to work with the vectoring
LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20]
When nIRQ is asserted, if the bit "I" of CPSR is 0, the sequence is as follows: 1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_irq, the current value of the Program Counter is loaded in the Interrupt link register (R14_irq) and the Program Counter (R15) is loaded with 0x18. In the following cycle during fetch at address 0x1C, the ARM core adjusts R14_irq, decrementing it by four. 2. The ARM core enters Interrupt mode, if it has not already done so. 3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x18 is executed, the program counter is loaded with the value read in AIC_IVR. Reading the AIC_IVR has the following effects: - Sets the current interrupt to be the pending and enabled interrupt with the highest priority. The current level is the priority level of the current interrupt. - De-asserts the nIRQ line on the processor. Even if vectoring is not used, AIC_IVR must be read in order to de-assert nIRQ. - Automatically clears the interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge-triggered. - Pushes the current level and the current interrupt number on to the stack. - Returns the value written in the AIC_SVR corresponding to the current interrupt. 4. The previous step has the effect of branching to the corresponding interrupt service routine. This should start by saving the link register (R14_irq) and SPSR_IRQ. The link register must be decremented by four when it is saved if it is to be restored directly into the program counter at the end of the interrupt. For example, the instruction SUB PC, LR, #4 may be used. 5. Further interrupts can then be unmasked by clearing the "I" bit in CPSR, allowing reassertion of the nIRQ to be taken into account by the core. This can happen if an interrupt with a higher priority than the current interrupt occurs. 6. The interrupt handler can then proceed as required, saving the registers that are used and restoring them at the end. During this phase, an interrupt of higher priority than the current level restarts the sequence from step 1.
Note: If the interrupt is programmed to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase.
7. The "I" bit in CPSR must be set in order to mask interrupts before exiting to ensure that the interrupt is completed in an orderly manner. 8. The End of Interrupt Command Register (AIC_EOICR) must be written in order to indicate to the AIC that the current interrupt is finished. This causes the current level to be popped from the stack, restoring the previous current level if one exists on the stack. If another interrupt is pending, with lower or equal priority than the old current level but with higher priority than the new current level, the nIRQ line is re-asserted, but the interrupt sequence does not immediately start because the "I" bit is set in the core. SPSR_irq is restored. Finally, the saved value of the link register is restored directly into the PC. This has the effect of returning from the interrupt to whatever was being exe-
307
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
cuted before, and of loading the CPSR with the stored SPSR, masking or unmasking the interrupts depending on the state saved in SPSR_irq.
Note: The "I" bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was on the verge of masking an interrupt when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence, when SPSR is restored, the mask instruction is completed (interrupt is masked).
29.7.4 29.7.4.1
Fast Interrupt Fast Interrupt Source The interrupt source 0 is the only source which can raise a fast interrupt request to the processor except if fast forcing is used. The interrupt source 0 is generally connected to a FIQ pin of the product, either directly or through a PIO Controller. Fast Interrupt Control The fast interrupt logic of the AIC has no priority controller. The mode of interrupt source 0 is programmed with the AIC_SMR0 and the field PRIOR of this register is not used even if it reads what has been written. The field SRCTYPE of AIC_SMR0 enables programming the fast interrupt source to be positive-edge triggered or negative-edge triggered or high-level sensitive or low-level sensitive Writing 0x1 in the AIC_IECR (Interrupt Enable Command Register) and AIC_IDCR (Interrupt Disable Command Register) respectively enables and disables the fast interrupt. The bit 0 of AIC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register) indicates whether the fast interrupt is enabled or disabled.
29.7.4.2
29.7.4.3
Fast Interrupt Vectoring The fast interrupt handler address can be stored in AIC_SVR0 (Source Vector Register 0). The value written into this register is returned when the processor reads AIC_FVR (Fast Vector Register). This offers a way to branch in one single instruction to the interrupt handler, as AIC_FVR is mapped at the absolute address 0xFFFF F104 and thus accessible from the ARM fast interrupt vector at address 0x0000 001C through the following instruction:
LDR PC,[PC,# -&F20]
When the processor executes this instruction it loads the value read in AIC_FVR in its program counter, thus branching the execution on the fast interrupt handler. It also automatically performs the clear of the fast interrupt source if it is programmed in edge-triggered mode. 29.7.4.4 Fast Interrupt Handlers This section gives an overview of the fast interrupt handling sequence when using the AIC. It is assumed that the programmer understands the architecture of the ARM processor, and especially the processor interrupt modes and associated status bits. Assuming that: 1. The Advanced Interrupt Controller has been programmed, AIC_SVR0 is loaded with the fast interrupt service routine address, and the interrupt source 0 is enabled. 2. The Instruction at address 0x1C (FIQ exception vector address) is required to vector the fast interrupt:
LDR PC, [PC, # -&F20]
3. The user does not need nested fast interrupts. When nFIQ is asserted, if the bit "F" of CPSR is 0, the sequence is:
308
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
1. The CPSR is stored in SPSR_fiq, the current value of the program counter is loaded in the FIQ link register (R14_FIQ) and the program counter (R15) is loaded with 0x1C. In the following cycle, during fetch at address 0x20, the ARM core adjusts R14_fiq, decrementing it by four. 2. The ARM core enters FIQ mode. 3. When the instruction loaded at address 0x1C is executed, the program counter is loaded with the value read in AIC_FVR. Reading the AIC_FVR has effect of automatically clearing the fast interrupt, if it has been programmed to be edge triggered. In this case only, it de-asserts the nFIQ line on the processor. 4. The previous step enables branching to the corresponding interrupt service routine. It is not necessary to save the link register R14_fiq and SPSR_fiq if nested fast interrupts are not needed. 5. The Interrupt Handler can then proceed as required. It is not necessary to save registers R8 to R13 because FIQ mode has its own dedicated registers and the user R8 to R13 are banked. The other registers, R0 to R7, must be saved before being used, and restored at the end (before the next step). Note that if the fast interrupt is programmed to be level sensitive, the source of the interrupt must be cleared during this phase in order to de-assert the interrupt source 0. 6. Finally, the Link Register R14_fiq is restored into the PC after decrementing it by four (with instruction SUB PC, LR, #4 for example). This has the effect of returning from the interrupt to whatever was being executed before, loading the CPSR with the SPSR and masking or unmasking the fast interrupt depending on the state saved in the SPSR.
Note: The "F" bit in SPSR is significant. If it is set, it indicates that the ARM core was just about to mask FIQ interrupts when the mask instruction was interrupted. Hence when the SPSR is restored, the interrupted instruction is completed (FIQ is masked).
Another way to handle the fast interrupt is to map the interrupt service routine at the address of the ARM vector 0x1C. This method does not use the vectoring, so that reading AIC_FVR must be performed at the very beginning of the handler operation. However, this method saves the execution of a branch instruction. 29.7.4.5 Fast Forcing The Fast Forcing feature of the advanced interrupt controller provides redirection of any normal Interrupt source on the fast interrupt controller. Fast Forcing is enabled or disabled by writing to the Fast Forcing Enable Register (AIC_FFER) and the Fast Forcing Disable Register (AIC_FFDR). Writing to these registers results in an update of the Fast Forcing Status Register (AIC_FFSR) that controls the feature for each internal or external interrupt source. When Fast Forcing is disabled, the interrupt sources are handled as described in the previous pages. When Fast Forcing is enabled, the edge/level programming and, in certain cases, edge detection of the interrupt source is still active but the source cannot trigger a normal interrupt to the processor and is not seen by the priority handler. If the interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level is sampled, Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core. If the interrupt source is programmed in edge-triggered mode and an active edge is detected, Fast Forcing results in the assertion of the nFIQ line to the core.
309
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The Fast Forcing feature does not affect the Source 0 pending bit in the Interrupt Pending Register (AIC_IPR). The FIQ Vector Register (AIC_FVR) reads the contents of the Source Vector Register 0 (AIC_SVR0), whatever the source of the fast interrupt may be. The read of the FVR does not clear the Source 0 when the fast forcing feature is used and the interrupt source should be cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command Register (AIC_ICCR). All enabled and pending interrupt sources that have the fast forcing feature enabled and that are programmed in edge-triggered mode must be cleared by writing to the Interrupt Clear Command Register. In doing so, they are cleared independently and thus lost interrupts are prevented. The read of AIC_IVR does not clear the source that has the fast forcing feature enabled. The source 0, reserved to the fast interrupt, continues operating normally and becomes one of the Fast Interrupt sources. Figure 29-10. Fast Forcing
Source 0 _ FIQ Input Stage AIC_IMR AIC_IPR
Automatic Clear
nFIQ
Read FVR if Fast Forcing is disabled on Sources 1 to 31. AIC_FFSR Source n Input Stage Automatic Clear AIC_IMR AIC_IPR Priority Manager nIRQ
Read IVR if Source n is the current interrupt and if Fast Forcing is disabled on Source n.
29.7.5
Protect Mode The Protect Mode permits reading the Interrupt Vector Register without performing the associated automatic operations. This is necessary when working with a debug system. When a debugger, working either with a Debug Monitor or the ARM processor's ICE, stops the applications and updates the opened windows, it might read the AIC User Interface and thus the IVR. This has undesirable consequences: * If an enabled interrupt with a higher priority than the current one is pending, it is stacked. * If there is no enabled pending interrupt, the spurious vector is returned. In either case, an End of Interrupt command is necessary to acknowledge and to restore the context of the AIC. This operation is generally not performed by the debug system as the debug system would become strongly intrusive and cause the application to enter an undesired state. This is avoided by using the Protect Mode. Writing DBGM in AIC_DCR (Debug Control Register) at 0x1 enables the Protect Mode. When the Protect Mode is enabled, the AIC performs interrupt stacking only when a write access is performed on the AIC_IVR. Therefore, the Interrupt Service Routines must write (arbitrary data) to the AIC_IVR just after reading it. The new context of the AIC, including the value of the
310
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Interrupt Status Register (AIC_ISR), is updated with the current interrupt only when AIC_IVR is written. An AIC_IVR read on its own (e.g., by a debugger), modifies neither the AIC context nor the AIC_ISR. Extra AIC_IVR reads perform the same operations. However, it is recommended to not stop the processor between the read and the write of AIC_IVR of the interrupt service routine to make sure the debugger does not modify the AIC context. To summarize, in normal operating mode, the read of AIC_IVR performs the following operations within the AIC: 1. Calculates active interrupt (higher than current or spurious). 2. Determines and returns the vector of the active interrupt. 3. Memorizes the interrupt. 4. Pushes the current priority level onto the internal stack. 5. Acknowledges the interrupt. However, while the Protect Mode is activated, only operations 1 to 3 are performed when AIC_IVR is read. Operations 4 and 5 are only performed by the AIC when AIC_IVR is written. Software that has been written and debugged using the Protect Mode runs correctly in Normal Mode without modification. However, in Normal Mode the AIC_IVR write has no effect and can be removed to optimize the code. 29.7.6 Spurious Interrupt The Advanced Interrupt Controller features protection against spurious interrupts. A spurious interrupt is defined as being the assertion of an interrupt source long enough for the AIC to assert the nIRQ, but no longer present when AIC_IVR is read. This is most prone to occur when: * An external interrupt source is programmed in level-sensitive mode and an active level occurs for only a short time. * An internal interrupt source is programmed in level sensitive and the output signal of the corresponding embedded peripheral is activated for a short time. (As in the case for the Watchdog.) * An interrupt occurs just a few cycles before the software begins to mask it, thus resulting in a pulse on the interrupt source. The AIC detects a spurious interrupt at the time the AIC_IVR is read while no enabled interrupt source is pending. When this happens, the AIC returns the value stored by the programmer in AIC_SPU (Spurious Vector Register). The programmer must store the address of a spurious interrupt handler in AIC_SPU as part of the application, to enable an as fast as possible return to the normal execution flow. This handler writes in AIC_EOICR and performs a return from interrupt. 29.7.7 General Interrupt Mask The AIC features a General Interrupt Mask bit to prevent interrupts from reaching the processor. Both the nIRQ and the nFIQ lines are driven to their inactive state if the bit GMSK in AIC_DCR (Debug Control Register) is set. However, this mask does not prevent waking up the processor if it has entered Idle Mode. This function facilitates synchronizing the processor on a next event and, as soon as the event occurs, performs subsequent operations without having to handle an interrupt. It is strongly recommended to use this mask with caution.
311
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.8
29.8.1
Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface
Base Address The AIC is mapped at the address 0xFFFF F000. It has a total 4-Kbyte addressing space. This permits the vectoring feature, as the PC-relative load/store instructions of the ARM processor support only a 4-Kbyte offset.
29.8.2
Register Mapping Register Mapping
Register Source Mode Register 0 Source Mode Register 1 --Source Mode Register 31 Source Vector Register 0 Source Vector Register 1 --Source Vector Register 31 Interrupt Vector Register FIQ Interrupt Vector Register Interrupt Status Register Interrupt Pending Register Interrupt Mask Register(2) Core Interrupt Status Register Reserved Reserved Interrupt Enable Command Register
(2) (2) (2)
Table 29-2.
Offset 0000 0x04 --0x7C 0x80 0x84 --0xFC 0x100 0x104 0x108 0x10C 0x110 0x114 0x118 0x11C 0x120 0x124 0x128 0x12C 0x130 0x134 0x138 0x13C 0x140 0x144 0x148 Notes:
Name AIC_SMR0 AIC_SMR1 --AIC_SMR31 AIC_SVR0 AIC_SVR1 --AIC_SVR31 AIC_IVR AIC_FVR AIC_ISR AIC_IPR AIC_IMR AIC_CISR ----AIC_IECR AIC_IDCR AIC_ICCR AIC_ISCR AIC_EOICR AIC_SPU AIC_DCR --(2) (2)
Access Read-write Read-write --Read-write Read-write Read-write --Read-write Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only ----Write-only Write-only Write-only Write-only Write-only Read-write Read-write --Write-only Write-only Read-only
Reset Value 0x0 0x0 --0x0 0x0 0x0 --0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0(1) 0x0 0x0 --------------0x0 0x0 ------0x0
Interrupt Disable Command Register Interrupt Clear Command Register(2) Interrupt Set Command Register
(2)
End of Interrupt Command Register Spurious Interrupt Vector Register Debug Control Register Reserved Fast Forcing Enable Register
AIC_FFER AIC_FFDR AIC_FFSR
Fast Forcing Disable Register
Fast Forcing Status Register(2)
1. The reset value of this register depends on the level of the external interrupt source. All other sources are cleared at reset, thus not pending. 2. PID2...PID31 bit fields refer to the identifiers as defined in the section "Peripheral Identifiers" of the product datasheet.
312
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.3 AIC Source Mode Register Register Name: AIC_SMR0..AIC_SMR31 Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-write 0x0
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 SRCTYPE 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 PRIOR 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* PRIOR: Priority Level Programs the priority level for all sources except FIQ source (source 0). The priority level can be between 0 (lowest) and 7 (highest). The priority level is not used for the FIQ in the related SMR register AIC_SMRx. * SRCTYPE: Interrupt Source Type The active level or edge is not programmable for the internal interrupt sources.
SRCTYPE 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1
Internal Interrupt Sources High level Sensitive Positive edge triggered High level Sensitive Positive edge triggered
External Interrupt Sources Low level Sensitive Negative edge triggered High level Sensitive Positive edge triggered
313
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.8.4 AIC Source Vector Register Register Name: AIC_SVR0..AIC_SVR31 Access Type: Reset Value:
31
Read-write 0x0
30 29 28 VECTOR 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 VECTOR
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 VECTOR
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 VECTOR
3
2
1
0
* VECTOR: Source Vector The user may store in these registers the addresses of the corresponding handler for each interrupt source.
29.8.5 AIC Interrupt Vector Register Register Name: AIC_IVR Access Type: Reset Value:
31
Read-only 0x0
30 29 28 IRQV 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 IRQV
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 IRQV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 IRQV
3
2
1
0
* IRQV: Interrupt Vector Register The Interrupt Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register corresponding to the current interrupt. The Source Vector Register is indexed using the current interrupt number when the Interrupt Vector Register is read. When there is no current interrupt, the Interrupt Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU.
314
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.6 AIC FIQ Vector Register
Register Name: Access Type: Reset Value:
31
AIC_FVR Read-only 0x0
30 29 28 FIQV 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 FIQV
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 FIQV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 FIQV
3
2
1
0
* FIQV: FIQ Vector Register The FIQ Vector Register contains the vector programmed by the user in the Source Vector Register 0. When there is no fast interrupt, the FIQ Vector Register reads the value stored in AIC_SPU. 29.8.7 AIC Interrupt Status Register Register Name: AIC_ISR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only 0x0
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 IRQID 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* IRQID: Current Interrupt Identifier The Interrupt Status Register returns the current interrupt source number.
315
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.8.8 AIC Interrupt Pending Register Register Name: AIC_IPR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Read-only 0x0
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Pending 0 = Corresponding interrupt is not pending. 1 = Corresponding interrupt is pending.
29.8.9 AIC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: AIC_IMR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Read-only 0x0
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Mask 0 = Corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = Corresponding interrupt is enabled.
316
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.10 AIC Core Interrupt Status Register Register Name: AIC_CISR Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only 0x0
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 NIRQ 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 NIFQ
* NFIQ: NFIQ Status 0 = nFIQ line is deactivated. 1 = nFIQ line is active. * NIRQ: NIRQ Status 0 = nIRQ line is deactivated. 1 = nIRQ line is active.
29.8.11 AIC Interrupt Enable Command Register Register Name: AIC_IECR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID3: Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables corresponding interrupt.
317
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.8.12 AIC Interrupt Disable Command Register Register Name: AIC_IDCR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables corresponding interrupt.
29.8.13 AIC Interrupt Clear Command Register Register Name: AIC_ICCR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Clear 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears corresponding interrupt.
318
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.14 AIC Interrupt Set Command Register Register Name: AIC_ISCR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 FIQ
* FIQ, SYS, PID2-PID31: Interrupt Set 0 = No effect. 1 = Sets corresponding interrupt. 29.8.15 AIC End of Interrupt Command Register Register Name: AIC_EOICR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 -
The End of Interrupt Command Register is used by the interrupt routine to indicate that the interrupt treatment is complete. Any value can be written because it is only necessary to make a write to this register location to signal the end of interrupt treatment.
319
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
29.8.16 AIC Spurious Interrupt Vector Register Register Name: AIC_SPU Access Type: Reset Value:
31
Read-write 0x0
30 29 28 SIQV 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 SIQV
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 SIQV
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 SIQV
3
2
1
0
* SIQV: Spurious Interrupt Vector Register The user may store the address of a spurious interrupt handler in this register. The written value is returned in AIC_IVR in case of a spurious interrupt and in AIC_FVR in case of a spurious fast interrupt.
29.8.17 AIC Debug Control Register Register Name: AIC_DEBUG Access Type: Reset Value:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-write 0x0
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 GMSK 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 PROT
* PROT: Protection Mode 0 = The Protection Mode is disabled. 1 = The Protection Mode is enabled. * GMSK: General Mask 0 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are normally controlled by the AIC. 1 = The nIRQ and nFIQ lines are tied to their inactive state.
320
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.18 AIC Fast Forcing Enable Register Register Name: AIC_FFER Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 -
* SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the fast forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt.
29.8.19 AIC Fast Forcing Disable Register Register Name: AIC_FFDR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Write-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 -
* SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Fast Forcing feature on the corresponding interrupt.
321
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
29.8.20 AIC Fast Forcing Status Register Register Name: AIC_FFSR Access Type:
31 PID31 23 PID23 15 PID15 7 PID7
Read-only
30 PID30 22 PID22 14 PID14 6 PID6 29 PID29 21 PID21 13 PID13 5 PID5 28 PID28 20 PID20 12 PID12 4 PID4 27 PID27 19 PID19 11 PID11 3 PID3 26 PID26 18 PID18 10 PID10 2 PID2 25 PID25 17 PID17 9 PID9 1 SYS 24 PID24 16 PID16 8 PID8 0 -
* SYS, PID2-PID31: Fast Forcing Status 0 = The Fast Forcing feature is disabled on the corresponding interrupt. 1 = The Fast Forcing feature is enabled on the corresponding interrupt.
322
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30. Debug Unit (DBGU)
30.1 Description
The Debug Unit provides a single entry point from the processor for access to all the debug capabilities of Atmel's ARM-based systems. The Debug Unit features a two-pin UART that can be used for several debug and trace purposes and offers an ideal medium for in-situ programming solutions and debug monitor communications. Moreover, the association with two peripheral data controller channels permits packet handling for these tasks with processor time reduced to a minimum. The Debug Unit also makes the Debug Communication Channel (DCC) signals provided by the In-circuit Emulator of the ARM processor visible to the software. These signals indicate the status of the DCC read and write registers and generate an interrupt to the ARM processor, making possible the handling of the DCC under interrupt control. Chip Identifier registers permit recognition of the device and its revision. These registers inform as to the sizes and types of the on-chip memories, as well as the set of embedded peripherals. Finally, the Debug Unit features a Force NTRST capability that enables the software to decide whether to prevent access to the system via the In-circuit Emulator. This permits protection of the code, stored in ROM.
323
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
30.2
Block Diagram
Figure 30-1. Debug Unit Functional Block Diagram
Peripheral Bridge Peripheral DMA Controller
APB
Debug Unit
DTXD
Transmit Power Management Controller
MCK
Baud Rate Generator Receive
Parallel Input/ Output
DRXD
COMMRX ARM Processor
nTRST
COMMTX
DCC Handler
Chip ID
ICE Access Handler Power-on Reset
force_ntrst
Interrupt Control
dbgu_irq
Table 30-1.
Pin Name DRXD DTXD
Debug Unit Pin Description
Description Debug Receive Data Debug Transmit Data Type Input Output
Figure 30-2. Debug Unit Application Example
Boot Program Debug Monitor Trace Manager
Debug Unit
RS232 Drivers Programming Tool Debug Console Trace Console
324
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.3
30.3.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this case, the programmer must first configure the corresponding PIO Controller to enable I/O lines operations of the Debug Unit.
30.3.2
Power Management Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit clock may be controllable through the Power Management Controller. In this case, the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the Debug Unit clock. Usually, the peripheral identifier used for this purpose is 1. Interrupt Source Depending on product integration, the Debug Unit interrupt line is connected to one of the interrupt sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Interrupt handling requires programming of the AIC before configuring the Debug Unit. Usually, the Debug Unit interrupt line connects to the interrupt source 1 of the AIC, which may be shared with the real-time clock, the system timer interrupt lines and other system peripheral interrupts, as shown in Figure 30-1. This sharing requires the programmer to determine the source of the interrupt when the source 1 is triggered.
30.3.3
30.4
UART Operations
The Debug Unit operates as a UART, (asynchronous mode only) and supports only 8-bit character handling (with parity). It has no clock pin. The Debug Unit's UART is made up of a receiver and a transmitter that operate independently, and a common baud rate generator. Receiver timeout and transmitter time guard are not implemented. However, all the implemented features are compatible with those of a standard USART.
30.4.1
Baud Rate Generator The baud rate generator provides the bit period clock named baud rate clock to both the receiver and the transmitter. The baud rate clock is the master clock divided by 16 times the value (CD) written in DBGU_BRGR (Baud Rate Generator Register). If DBGU_BRGR is set to 0, the baud rate clock is disabled and the Debug Unit's UART remains inactive. The maximum allowable baud rate is Master Clock divided by 16. The minimum allowable baud rate is Master Clock divided by (16 x 65536). MCK Baud Rate = --------------------16 x CD
325
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 30-3. Baud Rate Generator
CD CD MCK 16-bit Counter
OUT
>1 1 0 0 Receiver Sampling Clock Divide by 16 Baud Rate Clock
30.4.2 30.4.2.1
Receiver Receiver Reset, Enable and Disable After device reset, the Debug Unit receiver is disabled and must be enabled before being used. The receiver can be enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit RXEN at 1. At this command, the receiver starts looking for a start bit. The programmer can disable the receiver by writing DBGU_CR with the bit RXDIS at 1. If the receiver is waiting for a start bit, it is immediately stopped. However, if the receiver has already detected a start bit and is receiving the data, it waits for the stop bit before actually stopping its operation. The programmer can also put the receiver in its reset state by writing DBGU_CR with the bit RSTRX at 1. In doing so, the receiver immediately stops its current operations and is disabled, whatever its current state. If RSTRX is applied when data is being processed, this data is lost.
30.4.2.2
Start Detection and Data Sampling The Debug Unit only supports asynchronous operations, and this affects only its receiver. The Debug Unit receiver detects the start of a received character by sampling the DRXD signal until it detects a valid start bit. A low level (space) on DRXD is interpreted as a valid start bit if it is detected for more than 7 cycles of the sampling clock, which is 16 times the baud rate. Hence, a space that is longer than 7/16 of the bit period is detected as a valid start bit. A space which is 7/16 of a bit period or shorter is ignored and the receiver continues to wait for a valid start bit. When a valid start bit has been detected, the receiver samples the DRXD at the theoretical midpoint of each bit. It is assumed that each bit lasts 16 cycles of the sampling clock (1-bit period) so the bit sampling point is eight cycles (0.5-bit period) after the start of the bit. The first sampling point is therefore 24 cycles (1.5-bit periods) after the falling edge of the start bit was detected. Each subsequent bit is sampled 16 cycles (1-bit period) after the previous one.
326
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 30-4. Start Bit Detection
Sampling Clock
DRXD
True Start Detection Baud Rate Clock
D0
Figure 30-5. Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, parity enabled 1 stop
0.5 bit period 1 bit period
DRXD
Sampling
D0 D1 True Start Detection
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7 Parity Bit
Stop Bit
30.4.2.3
Receiver Ready When a complete character is received, it is transferred to the DBGU_RHR and the RXRDY status bit in DBGU_SR (Status Register) is set. The bit RXRDY is automatically cleared when the receive holding register DBGU_RHR is read.
Figure 30-6. Receiver Ready
DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P
RXRDY
Read DBGU_RHR
30.4.2.4
Receiver Overrun If DBGU_RHR has not been read by the software (or the Peripheral Data Controller) since the last transfer, the RXRDY bit is still set and a new character is received, the OVRE status bit in DBGU_SR is set. OVRE is cleared when the software writes the control register DBGU_CR with the bit RSTSTA (Reset Status) at 1.
Figure 30-7. Receiver Overrun
DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop
RXRDY OVRE
RSTSTA
30.4.2.5
Parity Error Each time a character is received, the receiver calculates the parity of the received data bits, in accordance with the field PAR in DBGU_MR. It then compares the result with the received parity 327
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
bit. If different, the parity error bit PARE in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY is set. The parity bit is cleared when the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA (Reset Status) at 1. If a new character is received before the reset status command is written, the PARE bit remains at 1. Figure 30-8. Parity Error
DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop
RXRDY PARE
Wrong Parity Bit
RSTSTA
30.4.2.6
Receiver Framing Error When a start bit is detected, it generates a character reception when all the data bits have been sampled. The stop bit is also sampled and when it is detected at 0, the FRAME (Framing Error) bit in DBGU_SR is set at the same time the RXRDY bit is set. The bit FRAME remains high until the control register DBGU_CR is written with the bit RSTSTA at 1.
Figure 30-9. Receiver Framing Error
DRXD S D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P stop
RXRDY FRAME
Stop Bit Detected at 0
RSTSTA
30.4.3 30.4.3.1
Transmitter Transmitter Reset, Enable and Disable After device reset, the Debug Unit transmitter is disabled and it must be enabled before being used. The transmitter is enabled by writing the control register DBGU_CR with the bit TXEN at 1. From this command, the transmitter waits for a character to be written in the Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR before actually starting the transmission. The programmer can disable the transmitter by writing DBGU_CR with the bit TXDIS at 1. If the transmitter is not operating, it is immediately stopped. However, if a character is being processed into the Shift Register and/or a character has been written in the Transmit Holding Register, the characters are completed before the transmitter is actually stopped. The programmer can also put the transmitter in its reset state by writing the DBGU_CR with the bit RSTTX at 1. This immediately stops the transmitter, whether or not it is processing characters.
30.4.3.2
Transmit Format The Debug Unit transmitter drives the pin DTXD at the baud rate clock speed. The line is driven depending on the format defined in the Mode Register and the data stored in the Shift Register. One start bit at level 0, then the 8 data bits, from the lowest to the highest bit, one optional parity bit and one stop bit at 1 are consecutively shifted out as shown on the following figure. The field 328
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
PARE in the mode register DBGU_MR defines whether or not a parity bit is shifted out. When a parity bit is enabled, it can be selected between an odd parity, an even parity, or a fixed space or mark bit. Figure 30-10. Character Transmission
Example: Parity enabled Baud Rate Clock DTXD
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Bit
Stop Bit
30.4.3.3
Transmitter Control When the transmitter is enabled, the bit TXRDY (Transmitter Ready) is set in the status register DBGU_SR. The transmission starts when the programmer writes in the Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR, and after the written character is transferred from DBGU_THR to the Shift Register. The bit TXRDY remains high until a second character is written in DBGU_THR. As soon as the first character is completed, the last character written in DBGU_THR is transferred into the shift register and TXRDY rises again, showing that the holding register is empty. When both the Shift Register and the DBGU_THR are empty, i.e., all the characters written in DBGU_THR have been processed, the bit TXEMPTY rises after the last stop bit has been completed.
Figure 30-11. Transmitter Control
DBGU_THR
Data 0 Data 1
Shift Register
Data 0
Data 1
DTXD
S
Data 0
P
stop
S
Data 1
P
stop
TXRDY TXEMPTY
Write Data 0 in DBGU_THR
Write Data 1 in DBGU_THR
30.4.4
Peripheral Data Controller Both the receiver and the transmitter of the Debug Unit's UART are generally connected to a Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) channel. The peripheral data controller channels are programmed via registers that are mapped within the Debug Unit user interface from the offset 0x100. The status bits are reported in the Debug Unit status register DBGU_SR and can generate an interrupt.
329
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The RXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the receiver. This results in a read of the data in DBGU_RHR. The TXRDY bit triggers the PDC channel data transfer of the transmitter. This results in a write of a data in DBGU_THR. 30.4.5 Test Modes The Debug Unit supports three tests modes. These modes of operation are programmed by using the field CHMODE (Channel Mode) in the mode register DBGU_MR. The Automatic Echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the DRXD line, it is sent to the DTXD line. The transmitter operates normally, but has no effect on the DTXD line. The Local Loopback mode allows the transmitted characters to be received. DTXD and DRXD pins are not used and the output of the transmitter is internally connected to the input of the receiver. The DRXD pin level has no effect and the DTXD line is held high, as in idle state. The Remote Loopback mode directly connects the DRXD pin to the DTXD line. The transmitter and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows a bit-by-bit retransmission. Figure 30-12. Test Modes
Automatic Echo Receiver RXD
Transmitter
Disabled
TXD
Local Loopback Receiver
Disabled
RXD
VDD Transmitter
Disabled
TXD
Remote Loopback Receiver
VDD Disabled RXD
Transmitter
Disabled
TXD
30.4.6
Debug Communication Channel Support The Debug Unit handles the signals COMMRX and COMMTX that come from the Debug Communication Channel of the ARM Processor and are driven by the In-circuit Emulator.
330
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The Debug Communication Channel contains two registers that are accessible through the ICE Breaker on the JTAG side and through the coprocessor 0 on the ARM Processor side. As a reminder, the following instructions are used to read and write the Debug Communication Channel:
MRC p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0
Returns the debug communication data read register into Rd
MCR
p14, 0, Rd, c1, c0, 0
Writes the value in Rd to the debug communication data write register. The bits COMMRX and COMMTX, which indicate, respectively, that the read register has been written by the debugger but not yet read by the processor, and that the write register has been written by the processor and not yet read by the debugger, are wired on the two highest bits of the status register DBGU_SR. These bits can generate an interrupt. This feature permits handling under interrupt a debug link between a debug monitor running on the target system and a debugger. 30.4.7 Chip Identifier The Debug Unit features two chip identifier registers, DBGU_CIDR (Chip ID Register) and DBGU_EXID (Extension ID). Both registers contain a hard-wired value that is read-only. The first register contains the following fields: * EXT - shows the use of the extension identifier register * NVPTYP and NVPSIZ - identifies the type of embedded non-volatile memory and its size * ARCH - identifies the set of embedded peripherals * SRAMSIZ - indicates the size of the embedded SRAM * EPROC - indicates the embedded ARM processor * VERSION - gives the revision of the silicon The second register is device-dependent and reads 0 if the bit EXT is 0. 30.4.8 ICE Access Prevention The Debug Unit allows blockage of access to the system through the ARM processor's ICE interface. This feature is implemented via the register Force NTRST (DBGU_FNR), that allows assertion of the NTRST signal of the ICE Interface. Writing the bit FNTRST (Force NTRST) to 1 in this register prevents any activity on the TAP controller. On standard devices, the bit FNTRST resets to 0 and thus does not prevent ICE access. This feature is especially useful on custom ROM devices for customers who do not want their on-chip code to be visible.
331
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5 Debug Unit User Interface
Debug Unit Memory Map
Register Control Register Mode Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Status Register Receive Holding Register Transmit Holding Register Baud Rate Generator Register Reserved Chip ID Register Chip ID Extension Register Force NTRST Register Reserved PDC Area Name DBGU_CR DBGU_MR DBGU_IER DBGU_IDR DBGU_IMR DBGU_SR DBGU_RHR DBGU_THR DBGU_BRGR - DBGU_CIDR DBGU_EXID DBGU_FNR - - Access Write-only Read/Write Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Read/Write - Read-only Read-only Read/Write - - Reset Value - 0x0 - - 0x0 - 0x0 - 0x0 - - - 0x0 - -
Table 30-2.
Offset 0x0000 0x0004 0x0008 0x000C 0x0010 0x0014 0x0018 0x001C 0x0020
0x0024 - 0x003C 0x0040 0x0044 0x0048 0x004C - 0x00FC 0x0100 - 0x0124
332
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.1 Name: Debug Unit Control Register DBGU_CR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8 RSTSTA 0
-
7 TXDIS
-
6 TXEN
-
5 RXDIS
-
4 RXEN
-
3 RSTTX
-
2 RSTRX
-
1
-
-
* RSTRX: Reset Receiver 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being received, the reception is aborted. * RSTTX: Reset Transmitter 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter logic is reset and disabled. If a character is being transmitted, the transmission is aborted. * RXEN: Receiver Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver is enabled if RXDIS is 0. * RXDIS: Receiver Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The receiver is disabled. If a character is being processed and RSTRX is not set, the character is completed before the receiver is stopped. * TXEN: Transmitter Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter is enabled if TXDIS is 0. * TXDIS: Transmitter Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = The transmitter is disabled. If a character is being processed and a character has been written the DBGU_THR and RSTTX is not set, both characters are completed before the transmitter is stopped. * RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME and OVRE in the DBGU_SR.
333
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.2 Name: Debug Unit Mode Register DBGU_MR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15 CHMODE 7
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10 PAR
-
9
-
8
-
6 5
-
4 3
-
1 0
2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
* PAR: Parity Type
PAR 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 x 0 1 0 1 x Parity Type Even parity Odd parity Space: parity forced to 0 Mark: parity forced to 1 No parity
* CHMODE: Channel Mode
CHMODE 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Mode Description Normal Mode Automatic Echo Local Loopback Remote Loopback
334
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.3 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Enable Register DBGU_IER Write-only
30 COMMTX 22 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31 COMMRX 23
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX
-
11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX
-
10
-
9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY
-
8
-
7 PARE
-
6 FRAME
-
5 OVRE
-
2
-
0 RXRDY
-
* RXRDY: Enable RXRDY Interrupt * TXRDY: Enable TXRDY Interrupt * ENDRX: Enable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt * ENDTX: Enable End of Transmit Interrupt * OVRE: Enable Overrun Error Interrupt * FRAME: Enable Framing Error Interrupt * PARE: Enable Parity Error Interrupt * TXEMPTY: Enable TXEMPTY Interrupt * TXBUFE: Enable Buffer Empty Interrupt * RXBUFF: Enable Buffer Full Interrupt * COMMTX: Enable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt * COMMRX: Enable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
335
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.4 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Disable Register DBGU_IDR Write-only
30 COMMTX 22 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31 COMMRX 23
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX
-
11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX
-
10
-
9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY
-
8
-
7 PARE
-
6 FRAME
-
5 OVRE
-
2
-
0 RXRDY
-
* RXRDY: Disable RXRDY Interrupt * TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt * ENDRX: Disable End of Receive Transfer Interrupt * ENDTX: Disable End of Transmit Interrupt * OVRE: Disable Overrun Error Interrupt * FRAME: Disable Framing Error Interrupt * PARE: Disable Parity Error Interrupt * TXEMPTY: Disable TXEMPTY Interrupt * TXBUFE: Disable Buffer Empty Interrupt * RXBUFF: Disable Buffer Full Interrupt * COMMTX: Disable COMMTX (from ARM) Interrupt * COMMRX: Disable COMMRX (from ARM) Interrupt 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
336
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.5 Name: Debug Unit Interrupt Mask Register DBGU_IMR Read-only
30 COMMTX 22 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31 COMMRX 23
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX
-
11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX
-
10
-
9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY
-
8
-
7 PARE
-
6 FRAME
-
5 OVRE
-
2
-
0 RXRDY
-
* RXRDY: Mask RXRDY Interrupt * TXRDY: Disable TXRDY Interrupt * ENDRX: Mask End of Receive Transfer Interrupt * ENDTX: Mask End of Transmit Interrupt * OVRE: Mask Overrun Error Interrupt * FRAME: Mask Framing Error Interrupt * PARE: Mask Parity Error Interrupt * TXEMPTY: Mask TXEMPTY Interrupt * TXBUFE: Mask TXBUFE Interrupt * RXBUFF: Mask RXBUFF Interrupt * COMMTX: Mask COMMTX Interrupt * COMMRX: Mask COMMRX Interrupt 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
337
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.6 Name: Debug Unit Status Register DBGU_SR Read-only
30 COMMTX 22 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31 COMMRX 23
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX
-
11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX
-
10
-
9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY
-
8
-
7 PARE
-
6 FRAME
-
5 OVRE
-
2
-
0 RXRDY
-
* RXRDY: Receiver Ready 0 = No character has been received since the last read of the DBGU_RHR or the receiver is disabled. 1 = At least one complete character has been received, transferred to DBGU_RHR and not yet read. * TXRDY: Transmitter Ready 0 = A character has been written to DBGU_THR and not yet transferred to the Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled. 1 = There is no character written to DBGU_THR not yet transferred to the Shift Register. * ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer 0 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive. 1 = The End of Transfer signal from the receiver Peripheral Data Controller channel is active. * ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer 0 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is inactive. 1 = The End of Transfer signal from the transmitter Peripheral Data Controller channel is active. * OVRE: Overrun Error 0 = No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. * FRAME: Framing Error 0 = No framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one framing error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. * PARE: Parity Error 0 = No parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1 = At least one parity error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. * TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty 0 = There are characters in DBGU_THR, or characters being processed by the transmitter, or the transmitter is disabled. 1 = There are no characters in DBGU_THR and there are no characters being processed by the transmitter.
338
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty 0 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is inactive. 1 = The buffer empty signal from the transmitter PDC channel is active. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full 0 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is inactive. 1 = The buffer full signal from the receiver PDC channel is active. * COMMTX: Debug Communication Channel Write Status 0 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is inactive. 1 = COMMTX from the ARM processor is active. * COMMRX: Debug Communication Channel Read Status 0 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is inactive. 1 = COMMRX from the ARM processor is active.
339
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.7 Name: Debug Unit Receiver Holding Register DBGU_RHR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4 RXCHR
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
* RXCHR: Received Character Last received character if RXRDY is set.
30.5.8 Name:
Debug Unit Transmit Holding Register DBGU_THR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4 TXCHR
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
* TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set.
340
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.9 Name: Debug Unit Baud Rate Generator Register DBGU_BRGR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 CD
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
7
6
5
4 CD
3
2
1
0
* CD: Clock Divisor
CD 0 1 2 to 65535 Baud Rate Clock Disabled MCK MCK / (CD x 16)
341
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.10 Name: Debug Unit Chip ID Register DBGU_CIDR Read-only
30 29 NVPTYP 22 ARCH 15 14 NVPSIZ2 7 6 EPROC 5 4 3 2 VERSION 13 12 11 10 NVPSIZ 1 0 21 20 19 18 SRAMSIZ 9 8 28 27 26 ARCH 17 16 25 24
Access Type:
31 EXT 23
* VERSION: Version of the Device * EPROC: Embedded Processor
EPROC 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 1 Processor ARM946E-STM ARM7TDMI(R) ARM920TTM ARM926EJ-S
* NVPSIZ: Nonvolatile Program Memory Size
NVPSIZ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Size None 8K bytes 16K bytes 32K bytes Reserved 64K bytes Reserved 128K bytes Reserved 256K bytes 512K bytes Reserved 1024K bytes Reserved 2048K bytes Reserved
342
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* NVPSIZ2 Second Nonvolatile Program Memory Size
NVPSIZ2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Size None 8K bytes 16K bytes 32K bytes Reserved 64K bytes Reserved 128K bytes Reserved 256K bytes 512K bytes Reserved 1024K bytes Reserved 2048K bytes Reserved
* SRAMSIZ: Internal SRAM Size
SRAMSIZ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Size Reserved 1K bytes 2K bytes 6K bytes 112K bytes 4K bytes 80K bytes 160K bytes 8K bytes 16K bytes 32K bytes 64K bytes 128K bytes 256K bytes 96K bytes 512K bytes
343
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* ARCH: Architecture Identifier
ARCH Hex 0x19 0x29 0x34 0x37 0x39 0x3B 0x40 0x42 0x55 0x60 0x61 0x63 0x70 0x71 0x72 0x73 0x75 0x92 0xF0 Bin 0001 1001 0010 1001 0011 0100 0011 0111 0011 1001 0011 1011 0100 0000 0100 0010 0101 0101 0110 0000 0110 0001 0110 0011 0111 0000 0111 0001 0111 0010 0111 0011 0111 0101 1001 0010 1111 0000 Architecture AT91SAM9xx Series AT91SAM9XExx Series AT91x34 Series CAP7 Series CAP9 Series CAP11 Series AT91x40 Series AT91x42 Series AT91x55 Series AT91SAM7Axx Series AT91SAM7AQxx Series AT91x63 Series AT91SAM7Sxx Series AT91SAM7XCxx Series AT91SAM7SExx Series AT91SAM7Lxx Series AT91SAM7Xxx Series AT91x92 Series AT75Cxx Series
* NVPTYP: Nonvolatile Program Memory Type
NVPTYP 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 Memory ROM ROMless or on-chip Flash SRAM emulating ROM Embedded Flash Memory ROM and Embedded Flash Memory NVPSIZ is ROM size NVPSIZ2 is Flash size
* EXT: Extension Flag 0 = Chip ID has a single register definition without extension 1 = An extended Chip ID exists.
344
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
30.5.11 Name: Debug Unit Chip ID Extension Register DBGU_EXID Read-only
30 29 28 EXID 23 22 21 20 EXID 15 14 13 12 EXID 7 6 5 4 EXID 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
* EXID: Chip ID Extension Reads 0 if the bit EXT in DBGU_CIDR is 0.
345
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
30.5.12 Name:
Debug Unit Force NTRST Register DBGU_FNR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0 FNTRST
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
* FNTRST: Force NTRST 0 = NTRST of the ARM processor's TAP controller is driven by the power_on_reset signal. 1 = NTRST of the ARM processor's TAP controller is held low.
346
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31. Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO)
31.1 Description
The Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) manages up to 32 fully programmable input/output lines. Each I/O line may be dedicated as a general-purpose I/O or be assigned to a function of an embedded peripheral. This assures effective optimization of the pins of a product. Each I/O line is associated with a bit number in all of the 32-bit registers of the 32-bit wide User Interface. Each I/O line of the PIO Controller features: * An input change interrupt enabling level change detection on any I/O line. * A glitch filter providing rejection of pulses lower than one-half of clock cycle. * Multi-drive capability similar to an open drain I/O line. * Control of the pull-up of the I/O line. * Input visibility and output control. The PIO Controller also features a synchronous output providing up to 32 bits of data output in a single write operation.
347
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.2
Block Diagram
Figure 31-1. Block Diagram
PIO Controller
AIC PIO Interrupt
PMC
PIO Clock
Data, Enable
Embedded Peripheral
Up to 32 peripheral IOs
PIN 0 Data, Enable PIN 1 Up to 32 pins Embedded Peripheral Up to 32 peripheral IOs PIN 31
APB
Figure 31-2. Application Block Diagram
On-Chip Peripheral Drivers Keyboard Driver Control & Command Driver On-Chip Peripherals
PIO Controller
Keyboard Driver General Purpose I/Os External Devices
348
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.3
31.3.1
Product Dependencies
Pin Multiplexing Each pin is configurable, according to product definition as either a general-purpose I/O line only, or as an I/O line multiplexed with one or two peripheral I/Os. As the multiplexing is hardware-defined and thus product-dependent, the hardware designer and programmer must carefully determine the configuration of the PIO controllers required by their application. When an I/O line is general-purpose only, i.e. not multiplexed with any peripheral I/O, programming of the PIO Controller regarding the assignment to a peripheral has no effect and only the PIO Controller can control how the pin is driven by the product. External Interrupt Lines The interrupt signals FIQ and IRQ0 to IRQn are most generally multiplexed through the PIO Controllers. However, it is not necessary to assign the I/O line to the interrupt function as the PIO Controller has no effect on inputs and the interrupt lines (FIQ or IRQs) are used only as inputs. Power Management The Power Management Controller controls the PIO Controller clock in order to save power. Writing any of the registers of the user interface does not require the PIO Controller clock to be enabled. This means that the configuration of the I/O lines does not require the PIO Controller clock to be enabled. However, when the clock is disabled, not all of the features of the PIO Controller are available. Note that the Input Change Interrupt and the read of the pin level require the clock to be validated. After a hardware reset, the PIO clock is disabled by default. The user must configure the Power Management Controller before any access to the input line information.
31.3.2
31.3.3
31.3.4
Interrupt Generation For interrupt handling, the PIO Controllers are considered as user peripherals. This means that the PIO Controller interrupt lines are connected among the interrupt sources 2 to 31. Refer to the PIO Controller peripheral identifier in the product description to identify the interrupt sources dedicated to the PIO Controllers. The PIO Controller interrupt can be generated only if the PIO Controller clock is enabled.
349
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.4
Functional Description
The PIO Controller features up to 32 fully-programmable I/O lines. Most of the control logic associated to each I/O is represented in Figure 31-3. In this description each signal shown represents but one of up to 32 possible indexes.
Figure 31-3. I/O Line Control Logic
PIO_OER[0] PIO_OSR[0] PIO_ODR[0]
1
PIO_PUER[0] PIO_PUSR[0] PIO_PUDR[0]
Peripheral A Output Enable Peripheral B Output Enable PIO_ASR[0] PIO_ABSR[0] PIO_BSR[0] Peripheral A Output Peripheral B Output
0
0 0
1 PIO_PER[0] PIO_PSR[0] PIO_PDR[0] 0
0
1
PIO_MDER[0] PIO_MDSR[0] PIO_MDDR[0] 0
1
1
PIO_SODR[0] PIO_ODSR[0] PIO_CODR[0]
Pad 1
Peripheral A Input Peripheral B Input
PIO_PDSR[0] 0 Edge Detector Glitch Filter PIO_IFER[0] PIO_IFSR[0] PIO_IFDR[0] PIO_IER[0] 1
PIO_ISR[0]
(Up to 32 possible inputs) PIO Interrupt
PIO_IMR[0] PIO_IDR[0] PIO_ISR[31] PIO_IER[31] PIO_IMR[31] PIO_IDR[31]
350
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.4.1 Pull-up Resistor Control Each I/O line is designed with an embedded pull-up resistor. The pull-up resistor can be enabled or disabled by writing respectively PIO_PUER (Pull-up Enable Register) and PIO_PUDR (Pullup Disable Resistor). Writing in these registers results in setting or clearing the corresponding bit in PIO_PUSR (Pull-up Status Register). Reading a 1 in PIO_PUSR means the pull-up is disabled and reading a 0 means the pull-up is enabled. Control of the pull-up resistor is possible regardless of the configuration of the I/O line. After reset, all of the pull-ups are enabled, i.e. PIO_PUSR resets at the value 0x0. 31.4.2 I/O Line or Peripheral Function Selection When a pin is multiplexed with one or two peripheral functions, the selection is controlled with the registers PIO_PER (PIO Enable Register) and PIO_PDR (PIO Disable Register). The register PIO_PSR (PIO Status Register) is the result of the set and clear registers and indicates whether the pin is controlled by the corresponding peripheral or by the PIO Controller. A value of 0 indicates that the pin is controlled by the corresponding on-chip peripheral selected in the PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register). A value of 1 indicates the pin is controlled by the PIO controller. If a pin is used as a general purpose I/O line (not multiplexed with an on-chip peripheral), PIO_PER and PIO_PDR have no effect and PIO_PSR returns 1 for the corresponding bit. After reset, most generally, the I/O lines are controlled by the PIO controller, i.e. PIO_PSR resets at 1. However, in some events, it is important that PIO lines are controlled by the peripheral (as in the case of memory chip select lines that must be driven inactive after reset or for address lines that must be driven low for booting out of an external memory). Thus, the reset value of PIO_PSR is defined at the product level, depending on the multiplexing of the device. 31.4.3 Peripheral A or B Selection The PIO Controller provides multiplexing of up to two peripheral functions on a single pin. The selection is performed by writing PIO_ASR (A Select Register) and PIO_BSR (Select B Register). PIO_ABSR (AB Select Status Register) indicates which peripheral line is currently selected. For each pin, the corresponding bit at level 0 means peripheral A is selected whereas the corresponding bit at level 1 indicates that peripheral B is selected. Note that multiplexing of peripheral lines A and B only affects the output line. The peripheral input lines are always connected to the pin input. After reset, PIO_ABSR is 0, thus indicating that all the PIO lines are configured on peripheral A. However, peripheral A generally does not drive the pin as the PIO Controller resets in I/O line mode. Writing in PIO_ASR and PIO_BSR manages PIO_ABSR regardless of the configuration of the pin. However, assignment of a pin to a peripheral function requires a write in the corresponding peripheral selection register (PIO_ASR or PIO_BSR) in addition to a write in PIO_PDR. 31.4.4 Output Control When the I/0 line is assigned to a peripheral function, i.e. the corresponding bit in PIO_PSR is at 0, the drive of the I/O line is controlled by the peripheral. Peripheral A or B, depending on the value in PIO_ABSR, determines whether the pin is driven or not. When the I/O line is controlled by the PIO controller, the pin can be configured to be driven. This is done by writing PIO_OER (Output Enable Register) and PIO_ODR (Output Disable Register).
351
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The results of these write operations are detected in PIO_OSR (Output Status Register). When a bit in this register is at 0, the corresponding I/O line is used as an input only. When the bit is at 1, the corresponding I/O line is driven by the PIO controller. The level driven on an I/O line can be determined by writing in PIO_SODR (Set Output Data Register) and PIO_CODR (Clear Output Data Register). These write operations respectively set and clear PIO_ODSR (Output Data Status Register), which represents the data driven on the I/O lines. Writing in PIO_OER and PIO_ODR manages PIO_OSR whether the pin is configured to be controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. This enables configuration of the I/O line prior to setting it to be managed by the PIO Controller. Similarly, writing in PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR effects PIO_ODSR. This is important as it defines the first level driven on the I/O line. 31.4.5 Synchronous Data Output Controlling all parallel busses using several PIOs requires two successive write operations in the PIO_SODR and PIO_CODR registers. This may lead to unexpected transient values. The PIO controller offers a direct control of PIO outputs by single write access to PIO_ODSR (Output Data Status Register). Only bits unmasked by PIO_OWSR (Output Write Status Register) are written. The mask bits in the PIO_OWSR are set by writing to PIO_OWER (Output Write Enable Register) and cleared by writing to PIO_OWDR (Output Write Disable Register). After reset, the synchronous data output is disabled on all the I/O lines as PIO_OWSR resets at 0x0. 31.4.6 Multi Drive Control (Open Drain) Each I/O can be independently programmed in Open Drain by using the Multi Drive feature. This feature permits several drivers to be connected on the I/O line which is driven low only by each device. An external pull-up resistor (or enabling of the internal one) is generally required to guarantee a high level on the line. The Multi Drive feature is controlled by PIO_MDER (Multi-driver Enable Register) and PIO_MDDR (Multi-driver Disable Register). The Multi Drive can be selected whether the I/O line is controlled by the PIO controller or assigned to a peripheral function. PIO_MDSR (Multi-driver Status Register) indicates the pins that are configured to support external drivers. After reset, the Multi Drive feature is disabled on all pins, i.e. PIO_MDSR resets at value 0x0. 31.4.7 Output Line Timings Figure 31-4 shows how the outputs are driven either by writing PIO_SODR or PIO_CODR, or by directly writing PIO_ODSR. This last case is valid only if the corresponding bit in PIO_OWSR is set. Figure 31-4 also shows when the feedback in PIO_PDSR is available.
352
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 31-4. Output Line Timings
MCK
Write PIO_SODR Write PIO_ODSR at 1 Write PIO_CODR Write PIO_ODSR at 0
APB Access
APB Access
PIO_ODSR 2 cycles PIO_PDSR 2 cycles
31.4.8
Inputs The level on each I/O line can be read through PIO_PDSR (Pin Data Status Register). This register indicates the level of the I/O lines regardless of their configuration, whether uniquely as an input or driven by the PIO controller or driven by a peripheral. Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO controller to be enabled, otherwise PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled.
31.4.9
Input Glitch Filtering Optional input glitch filters are independently programmable on each I/O line. When the glitch filter is enabled, a glitch with a duration of less than 1/2 Master Clock (MCK) cycle is automatically rejected, while a pulse with a duration of 1 Master Clock cycle or more is accepted. For pulse durations between 1/2 Master Clock cycle and 1 Master Clock cycle the pulse may or may not be taken into account, depending on the precise timing of its occurrence. Thus for a pulse to be visible it must exceed 1 Master Clock cycle, whereas for a glitch to be reliably filtered out, its duration must not exceed 1/2 Master Clock cycle. The filter introduces one Master Clock cycle latency if the pin level change occurs before a rising edge. However, this latency does not appear if the pin level change occurs before a falling edge. This is illustrated in Figure 31-5. The glitch filters are controlled by the register set; PIO_IFER (Input Filter Enable Register), PIO_IFDR (Input Filter Disable Register) and PIO_IFSR (Input Filter Status Register). Writing PIO_IFER and PIO_IFDR respectively sets and clears bits in PIO_IFSR. This last register enables the glitch filter on the I/O lines. When the glitch filter is enabled, it does not modify the behavior of the inputs on the peripherals. It acts only on the value read in PIO_PDSR and on the input change interrupt detection. The glitch filters require that the PIO Controller clock is enabled.
353
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 31-5. Input Glitch Filter Timing
MCK up to 1.5 cycles Pin Level 1 cycle PIO_PDSR if PIO_IFSR = 0 2 cycles PIO_PDSR if PIO_IFSR = 1 up to 2.5 cycles 1 cycle up to 2 cycles 1 cycle 1 cycle 1 cycle
31.4.10
Input Change Interrupt The PIO Controller can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an input change on an I/O line. The Input Change Interrupt is controlled by writing PIO_IER (Interrupt Enable Register) and PIO_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register), which respectively enable and disable the input change interrupt by setting and clearing the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register). As Input change detection is possible only by comparing two successive samplings of the input of the I/O line, the PIO Controller clock must be enabled. The Input Change Interrupt is available, regardless of the configuration of the I/O line, i.e. configured as an input only, controlled by the PIO Controller or assigned to a peripheral function. When an input change is detected on an I/O line, the corresponding bit in PIO_ISR (Interrupt Status Register) is set. If the corresponding bit in PIO_IMR is set, the PIO Controller interrupt line is asserted. The interrupt signals of the thirty-two channels are ORed-wired together to generate a single interrupt signal to the Advanced Interrupt Controller. When the software reads PIO_ISR, all the interrupts are automatically cleared. This signifies that all the interrupts that are pending when PIO_ISR is read must be handled.
Figure 31-6. Input Change Interrupt Timings
MCK
Pin Level
PIO_ISR
Read PIO_ISR
APB Access
APB Access
31.5
I/O Lines Programming Example
The programing example as shown in Table 31-1 below is used to define the following configuration. * 4-bit output port on I/O lines 0 to 3, (should be written in a single write operation), open-drain, with pull-up resistor
354
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* Four output signals on I/O lines 4 to 7 (to drive LEDs for example), driven high and low, no pull-up resistor * Four input signals on I/O lines 8 to 11 (to read push-button states for example), with pull-up resistors, glitch filters and input change interrupts * Four input signals on I/O line 12 to 15 to read an external device status (polled, thus no input change interrupt), no pull-up resistor, no glitch filter * I/O lines 16 to 19 assigned to peripheral A functions with pull-up resistor * I/O lines 20 to 23 assigned to peripheral B functions, no pull-up resistor * I/O line 24 to 27 assigned to peripheral A with Input Change Interrupt and pull-up resistor Table 31-1. Programming Example
Register PIO_PER PIO_PDR PIO_OER PIO_ODR PIO_IFER PIO_IFDR PIO_SODR PIO_CODR PIO_IER PIO_IDR PIO_MDER PIO_MDDR PIO_PUDR PIO_PUER PIO_ASR PIO_BSR PIO_OWER PIO_OWDR Value to be Written 0x0000 FFFF 0x0FFF 0000 0x0000 00FF 0x0FFF FF00 0x0000 0F00 0x0FFF F0FF 0x0000 0000 0x0FFF FFFF 0x0F00 0F00 0x00FF F0FF 0x0000 000F 0x0FFF FFF0 0x00F0 00F0 0x0F0F FF0F 0x0F0F 0000 0x00F0 0000 0x0000 000F 0x0FFF FFF0
355
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6
Parallel Input/Output (PIO) Controller User Interface
Each I/O line controlled by the PIO Controller is associated with a bit in each of the PIO Controller User Interface registers. Each register is 32 bits wide. If a parallel I/O line is not defined, writing to the corresponding bits has no effect. Undefined bits read zero. If the I/O line is not multiplexed with any peripheral, the I/O line is controlled by the PIO Controller and PIO_PSR returns 1 systematically.
Table 31-2.
Offset 0x0000 0x0004 0x0008 0x000C 0x0010 0x0014 0x0018 0x001C 0x0020 0x0024 0x0028 0x002C 0x0030 0x0034 0x0038 0x003C 0x0040 0x0044 0x0048 0x004C 0x0050 0x0054 0x0058 0x005C 0x0060 0x0064 0x0068 0x006C
Register Mapping
Register PIO Enable Register PIO Disable Register PIO Status Register Reserved Output Enable Register Output Disable Register Output Status Register Reserved Glitch Input Filter Enable Register Glitch Input Filter Disable Register Glitch Input Filter Status Register Reserved Set Output Data Register Clear Output Data Register Output Data Status Register Pin Data Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Interrupt Status Register(4) Multi-driver Enable Register Multi-driver Disable Register Multi-driver Status Register Reserved Pull-up Disable Register Pull-up Enable Register Pad Pull-up Status Register Reserved PIO_PUDR PIO_PUER PIO_PUSR Write-only Write-only Read-only - - 0x00000000 PIO_SODR PIO_CODR PIO_ODSR PIO_PDSR PIO_IER PIO_IDR PIO_IMR PIO_ISR PIO_MDER PIO_MDDR PIO_MDSR Write-only Write-only Read-only or(2) Read/Write Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only -
(3)
Name PIO_PER PIO_PDR PIO_PSR
Access Write-only Write-only Read-only
Reset Value - -
(1)
PIO_OER PIO_ODR PIO_OSR
Write-only Write-only Read-only
- - 0x0000 0000
PIO_IFER PIO_IFDR PIO_IFSR
Write-only Write-only Read-only
- - 0x0000 0000
-
- - 0x00000000 0x00000000 - - 0x00000000
356
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 31-2.
Offset 0x0070 0x0074 0x0078 0x007C to 0x009C 0x00A0 0x00A4 0x00A8 0x00AC Notes:
Register Mapping (Continued)
Register Peripheral A Select Register Peripheral B Select Register AB Status Register Reserved Output Write Enable Output Write Disable Output Write Status Register Reserved PIO_OWER PIO_OWDR PIO_OWSR Write-only Write-only Read-only - - 0x00000000
(5) (5) (5)
Name PIO_ASR PIO_BSR PIO_ABSR
Access Write-only Write-only Read-only
Reset Value - - 0x00000000
1. Reset value of PIO_PSR depends on the product implementation. 2. PIO_ODSR is Read-only or Read/Write depending on PIO_OWSR I/O lines. 3. Reset value of PIO_PDSR depends on the level of the I/O lines. Reading the I/O line levels requires the clock of the PIO Controller to be enabled, otherwise PIO_PDSR reads the levels present on the I/O line at the time the clock was disabled. 4. PIO_ISR is reset at 0x0. However, the first read of the register may read a different value as input changes may have occurred. 5. Only this set of registers clears the status by writing 1 in the first register and sets the status by writing 1 in the second register.
357
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.1 Name:
PIO Controller PIO Enable Register PIO_PER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: PIO Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the PIO to control the corresponding pin (disables peripheral control of the pin). 31.6.2 Name: PIO Controller PIO Disable Register PIO_PDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: PIO Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the PIO from controlling the corresponding pin (enables peripheral control of the pin).
358
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.3 Name: PIO Controller PIO Status Register PIO_PSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: PIO Status 0 = PIO is inactive on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is active). 1 = PIO is active on the corresponding I/O line (peripheral is inactive). 31.6.4 Name: PIO Controller Output Enable Register PIO_OER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the output on the I/O line.
359
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.5 Name:
PIO Controller Output Disable Register PIO_ODR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the output on the I/O line. 31.6.6 Name: PIO Controller Output Status Register PIO_OSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Status 0 = The I/O line is a pure input. 1 = The I/O line is enabled in output.
360
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.7 Name: PIO Controller Input Filter Enable Register PIO_IFER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Filter Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the input glitch filter on the I/O line. 31.6.8 Name: PIO Controller Input Filter Disable Register PIO_IFDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Filter Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the input glitch filter on the I/O line.
361
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.9 Name:
PIO Controller Input Filter Status Register PIO_IFSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Filer Status 0 = The input glitch filter is disabled on the I/O line. 1 = The input glitch filter is enabled on the I/O line. 31.6.10 Name: PIO Controller Set Output Data Register PIO_SODR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Set Output Data 0 = No effect. 1 = Sets the data to be driven on the I/O line.
362
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.11 Name: PIO Controller Clear Output Data Register PIO_CODR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Set Output Data 0 = No effect. 1 = Clears the data to be driven on the I/O line. 31.6.12 Name: PIO Controller Output Data Status Register PIO_ODSR Read-only or Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Data Status 0 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 0. 1 = The data to be driven on the I/O line is 1.
363
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.13 Name:
PIO Controller Pin Data Status Register PIO_PDSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Data Status 0 = The I/O line is at level 0. 1 = The I/O line is at level 1. 31.6.14 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Enable Register PIO_IER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line.
364
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.15 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Disable Register PIO_IDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Input Change Interrupt on the I/O line. 31.6.16 Name: PIO Controller Interrupt Mask Register PIO_IMR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Mask 0 = Input Change Interrupt is disabled on the I/O line. 1 = Input Change Interrupt is enabled on the I/O line.
365
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.17 Name:
PIO Controller Interrupt Status Register PIO_ISR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Input Change Interrupt Status 0 = No Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset. 1 = At least one Input Change has been detected on the I/O line since PIO_ISR was last read or since reset. 31.6.18 Name: PIO Multi-driver Enable Register PIO_MDER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Multi Drive Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables Multi Drive on the I/O line.
366
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.19 Name: PIO Multi-driver Disable Register PIO_MDDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Multi Drive Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables Multi Drive on the I/O line. 31.6.20 Name: PIO Multi-driver Status Register PIO_MDSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Multi Drive Status. 0 = The Multi Drive is disabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at high and low level. 1 = The Multi Drive is enabled on the I/O line. The pin is driven at low level only.
367
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.21 Name:
PIO Pull Up Disable Register PIO_PUDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Pull Up Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the pull up resistor on the I/O line. 31.6.22 Name: PIO Pull Up Enable Register PIO_PUER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Pull Up Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the pull up resistor on the I/O line.
368
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.23 Name: PIO Pull Up Status Register PIO_PUSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Pull Up Status. 0 = Pull Up resistor is enabled on the I/O line. 1 = Pull Up resistor is disabled on the I/O line. 31.6.24 Name: PIO Peripheral A Select Register PIO_ASR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Peripheral A Select. 0 = No effect. 1 = Assigns the I/O line to the Peripheral A function.
369
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.25 Name:
PIO Peripheral B Select Register PIO_BSR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Peripheral B Select. 0 = No effect. 1 = Assigns the I/O line to the peripheral B function. 31.6.26 Name: PIO Peripheral A B Status Register PIO_ABSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Peripheral A B Status. 0 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral A. 1 = The I/O line is assigned to the Peripheral B.
370
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
31.6.27 Name: PIO Output Write Enable Register PIO_OWER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Write Enable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line. 31.6.28 Name: PIO Output Write Disable Register PIO_OWDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Write Disable. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables writing PIO_ODSR for the I/O line.
371
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
31.6.29 Name:
PIO Output Write Status Register PIO_OWSR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
P31
23
P30
22
P29
21
P28
20
P27
19
P26
18
P25
17
P24
16
P23
15
P22
14
P21
13
P20
12
P19
11
P18
10
P17
9
P16
8
P15
7
P14
6
P13
5
P12
4
P11
3
P10
2
P9
1
P8
0
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1
P0
* P0-P31: Output Write Status. 0 = Writing PIO_ODSR does not affect the I/O line. 1 = Writing PIO_ODSR affects the I/O line.
372
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32. Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
32.1 Description
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) circuit is a synchronous serial data link that provides communication with external devices in Master or Slave Mode. It also enables communication between processors if an external processor is connected to the system. The Serial Peripheral Interface is essentially a shift register that serially transmits data bits to other SPIs. During a data transfer, one SPI system acts as the "master"' which controls the data flow, while the other devices act as "slaves'' which have data shifted into and out by the master. Different CPUs can take turn being masters (Multiple Master Protocol opposite to Single Master Protocol where one CPU is always the master while all of the others are always slaves) and one master may simultaneously shift data into multiple slaves. However, only one slave may drive its output to write data back to the master at any given time. A slave device is selected when the master asserts its NSS signal. If multiple slave devices exist, the master generates a separate slave select signal for each slave (NPCS). The SPI system consists of two data lines and two control lines: * Master Out Slave In (MOSI): This data line supplies the output data from the master shifted into the input(s) of the slave(s). * Master In Slave Out (MISO): This data line supplies the output data from a slave to the input of the master. There may be no more than one slave transmitting data during any particular transfer. * Serial Clock (SPCK): This control line is driven by the master and regulates the flow of the data bits. The master may transmit data at a variety of baud rates; the SPCK line cycles once for each bit that is transmitted. * Slave Select (NSS): This control line allows slaves to be turned on and off by hardware.
373
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.2
Block Diagram
Figure 32-1. Block Diagram
PDC APB SPCK MISO MCK SPI Interface PIO MOSI NPCS0/NSS NPCS1 NPCS2 Interrupt Control NPCS3
PMC
SPI Interrupt
32.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 32-2. Application Block Diagram: Single Master/Multiple Slave Implementation
SPCK MISO MOSI SPI Master NPCS0 NPCS1 NPCS2 NPCS3 NC SPCK MISO Slave 0 MOSI NSS SPCK MISO Slave 1 MOSI NSS SPCK MISO Slave 2 MOSI NSS
374
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.4 Signal Description
Signal Description
Type Pin Name MISO MOSI SPCK NPCS1-NPCS3 NPCS0/NSS Pin Description Master In Slave Out Master Out Slave In Serial Clock Peripheral Chip Selects Peripheral Chip Select/Slave Select Master Input Output Output Output Output Slave Output Input Input Unused Input
Table 32-1.
32.5
32.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the SPI pins to their peripheral functions.
32.5.2
Power Management The SPI may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the SPI clock. Interrupt The SPI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the SPI interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the SPI.
32.5.3
375
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.6
32.6.1
Functional Description
Modes of Operation The SPI operates in Master Mode or in Slave Mode. Operation in Master Mode is programmed by writing at 1 the MSTR bit in the Mode Register. The pins NPCS0 to NPCS3 are all configured as outputs, the SPCK pin is driven, the MISO line is wired on the receiver input and the MOSI line driven as an output by the transmitter. If the MSTR bit is written at 0, the SPI operates in Slave Mode. The MISO line is driven by the transmitter output, the MOSI line is wired on the receiver input, the SPCK pin is driven by the transmitter to synchronize the receiver. The NPCS0 pin becomes an input, and is used as a Slave Select signal (NSS). The pins NPCS1 to NPCS3 are not driven and can be used for other purposes. The data transfers are identically programmable for both modes of operations. The baud rate generator is activated only in Master Mode.
32.6.2
Data Transfer Four combinations of polarity and phase are available for data transfers. The clock polarity is programmed with the CPOL bit in the Chip Select Register. The clock phase is programmed with the NCPHA bit. These two parameters determine the edges of the clock signal on which data is driven and sampled. Each of the two parameters has two possible states, resulting in four possible combinations that are incompatible with one another. Thus, a master/slave pair must use the same parameter pair values to communicate. If multiple slaves are used and fixed in different configurations, the master must reconfigure itself each time it needs to communicate with a different slave. Table 32-2 shows the four modes and corresponding parameter settings. Table 32-2. SPI Bus Protocol Mode
SPI Mode 0 1 2 3 CPOL 0 0 1 1 NCPHA 1 0 1 0
Figure 32-3 and Figure 32-4 show examples of data transfers.
376
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 32-3. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 1, 8 bits per transfer)
SPCK cycle (for reference) SPCK (CPOL = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SPCK (CPOL = 1)
MOSI (from master)
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
MISO (from slave)
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
*
NSS (to slave)
* Not defined, but normally MSB of previous character received.
Figure 32-4. SPI Transfer Format (NCPHA = 0, 8 bits per transfer)
SPCK cycle (for reference) SPCK (CPOL = 0) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SPCK (CPOL = 1)
MOSI (from master)
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
MISO (from slave)
*
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB
NSS (to slave)
* Not defined but normally LSB of previous character transmitted.
377
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.6.3
Master Mode Operations When configured in Master Mode, the SPI operates on the clock generated by the internal programmable baud rate generator. It fully controls the data transfers to and from the slave(s) connected to the SPI bus. The SPI drives the chip select line to the slave and the serial clock signal (SPCK). The SPI features two holding registers, the Transmit Data Register and the Receive Data Register, and a single Shift Register. The holding registers maintain the data flow at a constant rate. After enabling the SPI, a data transfer begins when the processor writes to the SPI_TDR (Transmit Data Register). The written data is immediately transferred in the Shift Register and transfer on the SPI bus starts. While the data in the Shift Register is shifted on the MOSI line, the MISO line is sampled and shifted in the Shift Register. Transmission cannot occur without reception. Before writing the TDR, the PCS field must be set in order to select a slave. If new data is written in SPI_TDR during the transfer, it stays in it until the current transfer is completed. Then, the received data is transferred from the Shift Register to SPI_RDR, the data in SPI_TDR is loaded in the Shift Register and a new transfer starts. The transfer of a data written in SPI_TDR in the Shift Register is indicated by the TDRE bit (Transmit Data Register Empty) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When new data is written in SPI_TDR, this bit is cleared. The TDRE bit is used to trigger the Transmit PDC channel. The end of transfer is indicated by the TXEMPTY flag in the SPI_SR register. If a transfer delay (DLYBCT) is greater than 0 for the last transfer, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of said delay. The master clock (MCK) can be switched off at this time. The transfer of received data from the Shift Register in SPI_RDR is indicated by the RDRF bit (Receive Data Register Full) in the Status Register (SPI_SR). When the received data is read, the RDRF bit is cleared. If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new data is received, the Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data is loaded in SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit. Figure 32-6 on page 380 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Master Mode. Figure 32-6 on page 380 shows a flow chart describing how transfers are handled.
378
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.6.3.1 Master Mode Block Diagram
Figure 32-5. Master Mode Block Diagram
SPI_CSR0..3 SCBR Baud Rate Generator
MCK
SPCK
SPI Clock SPI_CSR0..3 BITS NCPHA CPOL MISO LSB
SPI_RDR RD
RDRF OVRES
Shift Register
MSB
MOSI
SPI_TDR TD SPI_CSR0..3 CSAAT PS SPI_MR PCS 0 SPI_TDR PCS 1 NPCS0 PCSDEC Current Peripheral SPI_RDR PCS NPCS3 NPCS2 NPCS1 TDRE
MSTR NPCS0 MODFDIS
MODF
379
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.6.3.2
Master Mode Flow Diagram
Figure 32-6. Master Mode Flow Diagram S
SPI Enable - NPCS defines the current Chip Select - CSAAT, DLYBS, DLYBCT refer to the fields of the Chip Select Register corresponding to the Current Chip Select - When NPCS is 0xF, CSAAT is 0. 1 TDRE ?
0 1 CSAAT ? PS ? Variable peripheral yes 0 Fixed peripheral
0 0 PS ? Variable peripheral NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS) Fixed peripheral
1
SPI_TDR(PCS) = NPCS ? no NPCS = 0xF
SPI_MR(PCS) = NPCS ? no NPCS = 0xF
1
NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS)
Delay DLYBCS
Delay DLYBCS
NPCS = SPI_TDR(PCS)
NPCS = SPI_MR(PCS), SPI_TDR(PCS)
Delay DLYBS
Serializer = SPI_TDR(TD) TDRE = 1
Data Transfer
SPI_RDR(RD) = Serializer RDRF = 1
Delay DLYBCT
0 TDRE ?
1
1 CSAAT ?
0 NPCS = 0xF
Delay DLYBCS
380
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.6.3.3 Clock Generation The SPI Baud rate clock is generated by dividing the Master Clock (MCK) by a value between 1 and 255. This allows a maximum operating baud rate at up to Master Clock and a minimum operating baud rate of MCK divided by 255. Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead to unpredictable results. At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first transfer. The divisor can be defined independently for each chip select, as it has to be programmed in the SCBR field of the Chip Select Registers. This allows the SPI to automatically adapt the baud rate for each interfaced peripheral without reprogramming. 32.6.3.4 Transfer Delays Figure 32-7 shows a chip select transfer change and consecutive transfers on the same chip select. Three delays can be programmed to modify the transfer waveforms: * The delay between chip selects, programmable only once for all the chip selects by writing the DLYBCS field in the Mode Register. Allows insertion of a delay between release of one chip select and before assertion of a new one. * The delay before SPCK, independently programmable for each chip select by writing the field DLYBS. Allows the start of SPCK to be delayed after the chip select has been asserted. * The delay between consecutive transfers, independently programmable for each chip select by writing the DLYBCT field. Allows insertion of a delay between two transfers occurring on the same chip select These delays allow the SPI to be adapted to the interfaced peripherals and their speed and bus release time. Figure 32-7. Programmable Delays
Chip Select 1
Chip Select 2
SPCK DLYBCS DLYBS DLYBCT DLYBCT
32.6.3.5
Peripheral Selection The serial peripherals are selected through the assertion of the NPCS0 to NPCS3 signals. By default, all the NPCS signals are high before and after each transfer. The peripheral selection can be performed in two different ways: * Fixed Peripheral Select: SPI exchanges data with only one peripheral
381
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Variable Peripheral Select: Data can be exchanged with more than one peripheral Fixed Peripheral Select is activated by writing the PS bit to zero in SPI_MR (Mode Register). In this case, the current peripheral is defined by the PCS field in SPI_MR and the PCS field in the SPI_TDR has no effect. Variable Peripheral Select is activated by setting PS bit to one. The PCS field in SPI_TDR is used to select the current peripheral. This means that the peripheral selection can be defined for each new data. The Fixed Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with a single peripheral. Using the PDC is an optimal means, as the size of the data transfer between the memory and the SPI is either 8 bits or 16 bits. However, changing the peripheral selection requires the Mode Register to be reprogrammed. The Variable Peripheral Selection allows buffer transfers with multiple peripherals without reprogramming the Mode Register. Data written in SPI_TDR is 32 bits wide and defines the real data to be transmitted and the peripheral it is destined to. Using the PDC in this mode requires 32-bit wide buffers, with the data in the LSBs and the PCS and LASTXFER fields in the MSBs, however the SPI still controls the number of bits (8 to16) to be transferred through MISO and MOSI lines with the chip select configuration registers. This is not the optimal means in term of memory size for the buffers, but it provides a very effective means to exchange data with several peripherals without any intervention of the processor. 32.6.3.6 Peripheral Chip Select Decoding The user can program the SPI to operate with up to 15 peripherals by decoding the four Chip Select lines, NPCS0 to NPCS3 with an external logic. This can be enabled by writing the PCSDEC bit at 1 in the Mode Register (SPI_MR). When operating without decoding, the SPI makes sure that in any case only one chip select line is activated, i.e. driven low at a time. If two bits are defined low in a PCS field, only the lowest numbered chip select is driven low. When operating with decoding, the SPI directly outputs the value defined by the PCS field of either the Mode Register or the Transmit Data Register (depending on PS). As the SPI sets a default value of 0xF on the chip select lines (i.e. all chip select lines at 1) when not processing any transfer, only 15 peripherals can be decoded. The SPI has only four Chip Select Registers, not 15. As a result, when decoding is activated, each chip select defines the characteristics of up to four peripherals. As an example, SPI_CRS0 defines the characteristics of the externally decoded peripherals 0 to 3, corresponding to the PCS values 0x0 to 0x3. Thus, the user has to make sure to connect compatible peripherals on the decoded chip select lines 0 to 3, 4 to 7, 8 to 11 and 12 to 14. 32.6.3.7 Peripheral Deselection When operating normally, as soon as the transfer of the last data written in SPI_TDR is completed, the NPCS lines all rise. This might lead to runtime error if the processor is too long in responding to an interrupt, and thus might lead to difficulties for interfacing with some serial peripherals requiring the chip select line to remain active during a full set of transfers. To facilitate interfacing with such devices, the Chip Select Register can be programmed with the CSAAT bit (Chip Select Active After Transfer) at 1. This allows the chip select lines to remain in their current state (low = active) until transfer to another peripheral is required.
382
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 32-8 shows different peripheral deselection cases and the effect of the CSAAT bit. Figure 32-8. Peripheral Deselection
CSAAT = 0 CSAAT = 1
TDRE
DLYBCT A DLYBCS PCS = A A A
DLYBCT A DLYBCS PCS = A A
NPCS[0..3]
Write SPI_TDR
TDRE
DLYBCT A DLYBCS PCS=A A A
DLYBCT A DLYBCS PCS = A A
NPCS[0..3]
Write SPI_TDR
TDRE NPCS[0..3]
DLYBCT A DLYBCS PCS = B B A
DLYBCT B DLYBCS PCS = B
Write SPI_TDR
32.6.3.8
Mode Fault Detection A mode fault is detected when the SPI is programmed in Master Mode and a low level is driven by an external master on the NPCS0/NSS signal. NPCS0, MOSI, MISO and SPCK must be configured in open drain through the PIO controller, so that external pull up resistors are needed to guarantee high level. When a mode fault is detected, the MODF bit in the SPI_SR is set until the SPI_SR is read and the SPI is automatically disabled until re-enabled by writing the SPIEN bit in the SPI_CR (Control Register) at 1. By default, the Mode Fault detection circuitry is enabled. The user can disable Mode Fault detection by setting the MODFDIS bit in the SPI Mode Register (SPI_MR).
32.6.4
SPI Slave Mode When operating in Slave Mode, the SPI processes data bits on the clock provided on the SPI clock pin (SPCK). The SPI waits for NSS to go active before receiving the serial clock from an external master. When NSS falls, the clock is validated on the serializer, which processes the number of bits
383
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
defined by the BITS field of the Chip Select Register 0 (SPI_CSR0). These bits are processed following a phase and a polarity defined respectively by the NCPHA and CPOL bits of the SPI_CSR0. Note that BITS, CPOL and NCPHA of the other Chip Select Registers have no effect when the SPI is programmed in Slave Mode. The bits are shifted out on the MISO line and sampled on the MOSI line. When all the bits are processed, the received data is transferred in the Receive Data Register and the RDRF bit rises. If the SPI_RDR (Receive Data Register) has not been read before new data is received, the Overrun Error bit (OVRES) in SPI_SR is set. As long as this flag is set, data is loaded in SPI_RDR. The user has to read the status register to clear the OVRES bit. When a transfer starts, the data shifted out is the data present in the Shift Register. If no data has been written in the Transmit Data Register (SPI_TDR), the last data received is transferred. If no data has been received since the last reset, all bits are transmitted low, as the Shift Register resets at 0. When a first data is written in SPI_TDR, it is transferred immediately in the Shift Register and the TDRE bit rises. If new data is written, it remains in SPI_TDR until a transfer occurs, i.e. NSS falls and there is a valid clock on the SPCK pin. When the transfer occurs, the last data written in SPI_TDR is transferred in the Shift Register and the TDRE bit rises. This enables frequent updates of critical variables with single transfers. Then, a new data is loaded in the Shift Register from the Transmit Data Register. In case no character is ready to be transmitted, i.e. no character has been written in SPI_TDR since the last load from SPI_TDR to the Shift Register, the Shift Register is not modified and the last received character is retransmitted. Figure 32-9 shows a block diagram of the SPI when operating in Slave Mode. Figure 32-9. Slave Mode Functional Block Diagram
SPCK NSS SPIEN SPIENS SPIDIS SPI_CSR0 BITS NCPHA CPOL MOSI LSB SPI_RDR RD RDRF OVRES SPI Clock
Shift Register
MSB
MISO
SPI_TDR TD TDRE
384
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface
SPI Register Mapping
Register Control Register Mode Register Receive Data Register Transmit Data Register Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved Chip Select Register 0 Chip Select Register 1 Chip Select Register 2 Chip Select Register 3 Reserved Reserved Reserved for the PDC SPI_CSR0 SPI_CSR1 SPI_CSR2 SPI_CSR3 - - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 - - Register Name SPI_CR SPI_MR SPI_RDR SPI_TDR SPI_SR SPI_IER SPI_IDR SPI_IMR Access Write-only Read/Write Read-only Write-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Reset --0x0 0x0 --0x000000F0 ----0x0
Table 32-3.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C
0x20 - 0x2C 0x30 0x34 0x38 0x3C 0x004C - 0x00F8 0x004C - 0x00FC 0x100 - 0x124
385
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.7.1 Name:
SPI Control Register SPI_CR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
LASTXFER
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
SWRST
-
-
-
-
-
SPIDIS
SPIEN
* SPIEN: SPI Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the SPI to transfer and receive data. * SPIDIS: SPI Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the SPI. As soon as SPIDIS is set, SPI finishes its transfer. All pins are set in input mode and no data is received or transmitted. If a transfer is in progress, the transfer is finished before the SPI is disabled. If both SPIEN and SPIDIS are equal to one when the control register is written, the SPI is disabled. * SWRST: SPI Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Reset the SPI. A software-triggered hardware reset of the SPI interface is performed. The SPI is in slave mode after software reset. PDC channels are not affected by software reset. * LASTXFER: Last Transfer 0 = No effect. 1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD transfer has completed.
386
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.2 Name: SPI Mode Register SPI_MR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
DLYBCS
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 11 10
PCS
9 8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
LLB
-
-
MODFDIS
PCSDEC
PS
MSTR
* MSTR: Master/Slave Mode 0 = SPI is in Slave mode. 1 = SPI is in Master mode. * PS: Peripheral Select 0 = Fixed Peripheral Select. 1 = Variable Peripheral Select. * PCSDEC: Chip Select Decode 0 = The chip selects are directly connected to a peripheral device. 1 = The four chip select lines are connected to a 4- to 16-bit decoder. When PCSDEC equals one, up to 15 Chip Select signals can be generated with the four lines using an external 4- to 16-bit decoder. The Chip Select Registers define the characteristics of the 15 chip selects according to the following rules: SPI_CSR0 defines peripheral chip select signals 0 to 3. SPI_CSR1 defines peripheral chip select signals 4 to 7. SPI_CSR2 defines peripheral chip select signals 8 to 11. SPI_CSR3 defines peripheral chip select signals 12 to 14. * MODFDIS: Mode Fault Detection 0 = Mode fault detection is enabled. 1 = Mode fault detection is disabled. * LLB: Local Loopback Enable 0 = Local loopback path disabled. 1 = Local loopback path enabled. LLB controls the local loopback on the data serializer for testing in Master Mode only. (MISO is internally connected on MOSI.) * PCS: Peripheral Chip Select This field is only used if Fixed Peripheral Select is active (PS = 0).
387
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
If PCSDEC = 0: PCS = xxx0 PCS = xx01 PCS = x011 PCS = 0111 PCS = 1111 (x = don't care) If PCSDEC = 1: NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS. * DLYBCS: Delay Between Chip Selects This field defines the delay from NPCS inactive to the activation of another NPCS. The DLYBCS time guarantees non-overlapping chip selects and solves bus contentions in case of peripherals having long data float times. If DLYBCS is less than or equal to six, six MCK periods will be inserted by default. Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay: DLYBCS Delay Between Chip Selects = ---------------------MCK NPCS[3:0] = 1110 NPCS[3:0] = 1101 NPCS[3:0] = 1011 NPCS[3:0] = 0111 forbidden (no peripheral is selected)
388
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.3 Name: SPI Receive Data Register SPI_RDR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 11 10
PCS
9 8
RD
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RD
* RD: Receive Data Data received by the SPI Interface is stored in this register right-justified. Unused bits read zero. * PCS: Peripheral Chip Select In Master Mode only, these bits indicate the value on the NPCS pins at the end of a transfer. Otherwise, these bits read zero.
389
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.7.4 Name:
SPI Transmit Data Register SPI_TDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
LASTXFER
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12 11 10
PCS
9 8
TD
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
TD
* TD: Transmit Data Data to be transmitted by the SPI Interface is stored in this register. Information to be transmitted must be written to the transmit data register in a right-justified format. PCS: Peripheral Chip Select This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1). If PCSDEC = 0: PCS = xxx0 PCS = xx01 PCS = x011 PCS = 0111 PCS = 1111 (x = don't care) If PCSDEC = 1: NPCS[3:0] output signals = PCS * LASTXFER: Last Transfer 0 = No effect. 1 = The current NPCS will be deasserted after the character written in TD has been transferred. When CSAAT is set, this allows to close the communication with the current serial peripheral by raising the corresponding NPCS line as soon as TD transfer has completed. This field is only used if Variable Peripheral Select is active (PS = 1). NPCS[3:0] = 1110 NPCS[3:0] = 1101 NPCS[3:0] = 1011 NPCS[3:0] = 0111 forbidden (no peripheral is selected)
390
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.5 Name: SPI Status Register SPI_SR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
SPIENS
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
TXEMPTY
1
NSSR
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
* RDRF: Receive Data Register Full 0 = No data has been received since the last read of SPI_RDR 1 = Data has been received and the received data has been transferred from the serializer to SPI_RDR since the last read of SPI_RDR. * TDRE: Transmit Data Register Empty 0 = Data has been written to SPI_TDR and not yet transferred to the serializer. 1 = The last data written in the Transmit Data Register has been transferred to the serializer. TDRE equals zero when the SPI is disabled or at reset. The SPI enable command sets this bit to one. * MODF: Mode Fault Error 0 = No Mode Fault has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR. 1 = A Mode Fault occurred since the last read of the SPI_SR. * OVRES: Overrun Error Status 0 = No overrun has been detected since the last read of SPI_SR. 1 = An overrun has occurred since the last read of SPI_SR. An overrun occurs when SPI_RDR is loaded at least twice from the serializer since the last read of the SPI_RDR. * ENDRX: End of RX buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1). 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1). * ENDTX: End of TX buffer 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1). 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1). * RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = SPI_RCR(1) or SPI_RNCR(1) has a value other than 0. 1 = Both SPI_RCR(1) and SPI_RNCR(1) have a value of 0.
391
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = SPI_TCR(1) or SPI_TNCR(1) has a value other than 0. 1 = Both SPI_TCR(1) and SPI_TNCR(1) have a value of 0. * NSSR: NSS Rising 0 = No rising edge detected on NSS pin since last read. 1 = A rising edge occurred on NSS pin since last read. * TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty 0 = As soon as data is written in SPI_TDR. 1 = SPI_TDR and internal shifter are empty. If a transfer delay has been defined, TXEMPTY is set after the completion of such delay. * SPIENS: SPI Enable Status 0 = SPI is disabled. 1 = SPI is enabled.
Note:
1. SPI_RCR, SPI_RNCR, SPI_TCR, SPI_TNCR are physically located in the PDC.
392
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.6 Name: SPI Interrupt Enable Register SPI_IER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
TXEMPTY
1
NSSR
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
* RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Enable * TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable * MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Enable * OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable * TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Enable * NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
393
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
32.7.7 Name:
SPI Interrupt Disable Register SPI_IDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
TXEMPTY
1
NSSR
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
* RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Disable * TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Disable * MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Disable * OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable * TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Disable * NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
394
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.8 Name: SPI Interrupt Mask Register SPI_IMR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
TXEMPTY
1
NSSR
0
TXBUFE
RXBUFF
ENDTX
ENDRX
OVRES
MODF
TDRE
RDRF
* RDRF: Receive Data Register Full Interrupt Mask * TDRE: SPI Transmit Data Register Empty Interrupt Mask * MODF: Mode Fault Error Interrupt Mask * OVRES: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask * TXEMPTY: Transmission Registers Empty Mask * NSSR: NSS Rising Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
395
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.7.9 Name: SPI Chip Select Register SPI_CSR0... SPI_CSR3 Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
DLYBCT
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
DLYBS
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
SCBR
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
BITS
CSAAT
-
NCPHA
CPOL
* CPOL: Clock Polarity 0 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level zero. 1 = The inactive state value of SPCK is logic level one. CPOL is used to determine the inactive state value of the serial clock (SPCK). It is used with NCPHA to produce the required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices. * NCPHA: Clock Phase 0 = Data is changed on the leading edge of SPCK and captured on the following edge of SPCK. 1 = Data is captured on the leading edge of SPCK and changed on the following edge of SPCK. NCPHA determines which edge of SPCK causes data to change and which edge causes data to be captured. NCPHA is used with CPOL to produce the required clock/data relationship between master and slave devices. * CSAAT: Chip Select Active After Transfer 0 = The Peripheral Chip Select Line rises as soon as the last transfer is achieved. 1 = The Peripheral Chip Select does not rise after the last transfer is achieved. It remains active until a new transfer is requested on a different chip select. * BITS: Bits Per Transfer The BITS field determines the number of data bits transferred. Reserved values should not be used.
BITS 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 Bits Per Transfer 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
396
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
BITS 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Bits Per Transfer Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
* SCBR: Serial Clock Baud Rate In Master Mode, the SPI Interface uses a modulus counter to derive the SPCK baud rate from the Master Clock MCK. The Baud rate is selected by writing a value from 1 to 255 in the SCBR field. The following equations determine the SPCK baud rate: MCK SPCK Baudrate = -------------SCBR Programming the SCBR field at 0 is forbidden. Triggering a transfer while SCBR is at 0 can lead to unpredictable results. At reset, SCBR is 0 and the user has to program it at a valid value before performing the first transfer. * DLYBS: Delay Before SPCK This field defines the delay from NPCS valid to the first valid SPCK transition. When DLYBS equals zero, the NPCS valid to SPCK transition is 1/2 the SPCK clock period. Otherwise, the following equations determine the delay:
DLYBS Delay Before SPCK = -----------------MCK * DLYBCT: Delay Between Consecutive Transfers This field defines the delay between two consecutive transfers with the same peripheral without removing the chip select. The delay is always inserted after each transfer and before removing the chip select if needed. When DLYBCT equals zero, no delay between consecutive transfers is inserted and the clock keeps its duty cycle over the character transfers. Otherwise, the following equation determines the delay: Delay Between Consecutive Transfers = 32 x DLYBCT -----------------------------------MCK
397
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
398
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
33. Two-wire Interface (TWI)
33.1 Description
The Atmel Two-wire Interface (TWI) interconnects components on a unique two-wire bus, made up of one clock line and one data line with speeds of up to 400 Kbits per second, based on a byte-oriented transfer format. It can be used with any Atmel Two-wire Interface bus Serial EEPROM and IC compatible device such as Real Time Clock (RTC), Dot Matrix/Graphic LCD Controllers and Temperature Sensor, to name but a few. The TWI is programmable as a master or a slave with sequential or single-byte access. Multiple master capability is supported. Arbitration of the bus is performed internally and puts the TWI in slave mode automatically if the bus arbitration is lost. A configurable baud rate generator permits the output data rate to be adapted to a wide range of core clock frequencies. Below, Table 33-1 lists the compatibility level of the Atmel Two-wire Interface in Master Mode and a full I2C compatible device. Table 33-1.
I2C Standard Standard Mode Speed (100 KHz) Fast Mode Speed (400 KHz) 7 or 10 bits Slave Addressing START BYTE(1) Repeated Start (Sr) Condition ACK and NACK Management Slope control and input filtering (Fast mode) Clock stretching Note: 1. START + b000000001 + Ack + Sr
Atmel TWI Compatibility with i2C Standard
Atmel TWI Supported Supported Supported Not Supported Supported Supported Not Supported Supported
399
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.2
List of Abbreviations
Table 33-2.
Abbreviation TWI A NA P S RS SADR ADR R W
Abbreviations
Description Two-wire Interface Acknowledge Non Acknowledge Stop Start Repeated Start Slave Address Any address except SADR Read Write
33.3
Block Diagram
Figure 33-1. Block Diagram
APB Bridge
TWCK PIO Two-wire Interface TWD
PMC
MCK
TWI Interrupt
AIC
400
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.4
Application Block Diagram
Figure 33-2. Application Block Diagram
VDD Rp TWD TWCK Rp
Host with TWI Interface
Atmel TWI Serial EEPROM Slave 1
I2C RTC Slave 2
I2C LCD Controller Slave 3
I2C Temp. Sensor Slave 4
Rp: Pull up value as given by the I2C Standard
33.4.1
I/O Lines Description I/O Lines Description
Pin Description Two-wire Serial Data Two-wire Serial Clock Type Input/Output Input/Output
Table 33-3.
Pin Name TWD TWCK
33.5
33.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines Both TWD and TWCK are bidirectional lines, connected to a positive supply voltage via a current source or pull-up resistor (see Figure 33-2 on page 401). When the bus is free, both lines are high. The output stages of devices connected to the bus must have an open-drain or open-collector to perform the wired-AND function. TWD and TWCK pins may be multiplexed with PIO lines. To enable the TWI, the programmer must perform the following steps: * Program the PIO controller to: - Dedicate TWD and TWCK as peripheral lines. - Define TWD and TWCK as open-drain.
33.5.2
Power Management * Enable the peripheral clock. The TWI interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the TWI clock.
33.5.3
Interrupt The TWI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). In order to handle interrupts, the AIC must be programmed before configuring the TWI.
401
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.6
33.6.1
Functional Description
Transfer Format The data put on the TWD line must be 8 bits long. Data is transferred MSB first; each byte must be followed by an acknowledgement. The number of bytes per transfer is unlimited (see Figure 33-4). Each transfer begins with a START condition and terminates with a STOP condition (see Figure 33-3). * A high-to-low transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines the START condition. * A low-to-high transition on the TWD line while TWCK is high defines a STOP condition.
Figure 33-3.
START and STOP Conditions
TWD
TWCK Start Stop
Figure 33-4. Transfer Format
TWD
TWCK
Start
Address
R/W
Ack
Data
Ack
Data
Ack
Stop
33.6.2
Modes of Operation The TWI has six modes of operations: * Master transmitter mode * Master receiver mode * Multi-master transmitter mode * Multi-master receiver mode * Slave transmitter mode * Slave receiver mode These modes are described in the following chapters.
402
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.7
33.7.1
Master Mode
Definition The Master is the device which starts a transfer, generates a clock and stops it.
33.7.2
Application Block Diagram
Figure 33-5. Master Mode Typical Application Block Diagram
VDD Rp TWD TWCK Rp
Host with TWI Interface
Atmel TWI Serial EEPROM Slave 1
IC RTC Slave 2
IC LCD Controller Slave 3
IC Temp. Sensor Slave 4
Rp: Pull up value as given by the IC Standard
33.7.3
Programming Master Mode The following registers have to be programmed before entering Master mode: 1. DADR (+ IADRSZ + IADR if a 10 bit device is addressed): The device address is used to access slave devices in read or write mode. 2. CKDIV + CHDIV + CLDIV: Clock Waveform. 3. SVDIS: Disable the slave mode. 4. MSEN: Enable the master mode.
33.7.4
Master Transmitter Mode After the master initiates a Start condition when writing into the Transmit Holding Register, TWI_THR, it sends a 7-bit slave address, configured in the Master Mode register (DADR in TWI_MMR), to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address indicates the transfer direction, 0 in this case (MREAD = 0 in TWI_MMR). The TWI transfers require the slave to acknowledge each received byte. During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock pulse and sets the Not Acknowledge bit (NACK) in the status register if the slave does not acknowledge the byte. As with the other status bits, an interrupt can be generated if enabled in the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER). If the slave acknowledges the byte, the data written in the TWI_THR, is then shifted in the internal shifter and transferred. When an acknowledge is detected, the TXRDY bit is set until a new write in the TWI_THR. When no more data is written into the TWI_THR, the master generates a stop condition to end the transfer. The end of the complete transfer is marked by the TWI_TXCOMP bit set to one. See Figure 33-6, Figure 33-7, and Figure 33-8.
403
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
TXRDY is used as Transmit Ready for the PDC transmit channel. Figure 33-6. Master Write with One Data Byte
TWD S DADR W A DATA A P
TXCOMP
TXRDY Write THR (DATA) STOP sent automaticaly (ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
Figure 33-7. Master Write with Multiple Data Byte
TWD S DADR W A DATA n A DATA n+5 A DATA n+x A P
TXCOMP
TXRDY Write THR (Data n) Write THR (Data n+1) Write THR (Data n+x) Last data sent STOP sent automaticaly (ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
Figure 33-8. Master Write with One Byte Internal Address and Multiple Data Bytes
TWD S DADR W A IADR(7:0) A DATA n A DATA n+5 A DATA n+x A P
TXCOMP
TXRDY Write THR (Data n) Write THR (Data n+1) Write THR (Data n+x) STOP sent automaticaly Last data sent (ACK received and TXRDY = 1)
33.7.5
Master Receiver Mode The read sequence begins by setting the START bit. After the start condition has been sent, the master sends a 7-bit slave address to notify the slave device. The bit following the slave address indicates the transfer direction, 1 in this case (MREAD = 1 in TWI_MMR). During the acknowledge clock pulse (9th pulse), the master releases the data line (HIGH), enabling the slave to pull it down in order to generate the acknowledge. The master polls the data line during this clock pulse and sets the NACK bit in the status register if the slave does not acknowledge the byte. If an acknowledge is received, the master is then ready to receive data from the slave. After data has been received, the master sends an acknowledge condition to notify the slave that the data has been received except for the last data, after the stop condition. See Figure 33-9. When the
404
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
RXRDY bit is set in the status register, a character has been received in the receive-holding register (TWI_RHR). The RXRDY bit is reset when reading the TWI_RHR. When a single data byte read is performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the START and STOP bits must be set at the same time. See Figure 33-9. When a multiple data byte read is performed, with or without internal address (IADR), the STOP bit must be set after the next-tolast data received. See Figure 33-10. For Internal Address usage see Section 33.7.6. Figure 33-9. Master Read with One Data Byte
TWD S DADR R A DATA N P
TXCOMP Write START & STOP Bit RXRDY Read RHR
Figure 33-10. Master Read with Multiple Data Bytes
TWD S DADR R A DATA n A DATA (n+1) A DATA (n+m)-1 A DATA (n+m)
N
P
TXCOMP Write START Bit RXRDY Read RHR DATA n Read RHR DATA (n+1) Read RHR DATA (n+m)-1 Read RHR DATA (n+m)
Write STOP Bit after next-to-last data read
RXRDY is used as Receive Ready for the PDC receive channel. 33.7.6 Internal Address The TWI interface can perform various transfer formats: Transfers with 7-bit slave address devices and 10-bit slave address devices. 7-bit Slave Addressing When Addressing 7-bit slave devices, the internal address bytes are used to perform random address (read or write) accesses to reach one or more data bytes, within a memory page location in a serial memory, for example. When performing read operations with an internal address, the TWI performs a write operation to set the internal address into the slave device, and then switch to Master Receiver mode. Note that the second start condition (after sending the IADR) is sometimes called "repeated start" (Sr) in I2C fully-compatible devices. See Figure 33-12. See Figure 33-11 and Figure 33-13 for Master Write operation with internal address.
33.7.6.1
405
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The three internal address bytes are configurable through the Master Mode register (TWI_MMR). If the slave device supports only a 7-bit address, i.e. no internal address, IADRSZ must be set to 0. In the figures below the following abbreviations are used: Table 33-4. *S *P *W *R *A *N * DADR * IADR
Start Stop Write Read Acknowledge Not Acknowledge Device Address Internal Address
Figure 33-11. Master Write with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte
Three bytes internal address TWD
S DADR W A IADR(23:16) A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A DATA A P
Two bytes internal address TWD
S DADR W A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A DATA A P
One byte internal address TWD
S DADR W A IADR(7:0) A DATA A P
Figure 33-12. Master Read with One, Two or Three Bytes Internal Address and One Data Byte
Three bytes internal address TWD S DADR W A IADR(23:16) A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A S DADR R A
DATA Two bytes internal address TWD S DADR W A IADR(15:8) A IADR(7:0) A S DADR R A DATA
N
P
N
P
One byte internal address TWD S DADR W A IADR(7:0) A S DADR R A DATA N P
33.7.6.2
10-bit Slave Addressing For a slave address higher than 7 bits, the user must configure the address size (IADRSZ) and set the other slave address bits in the internal address register (TWI_IADR). The two remaining Internal address bytes, IADR[15:8] and IADR[23:16] can be used the same as in 7-bit Slave Addressing.
406
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Example: Address a 10-bit device (10-bit device address is b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10) 1. Program IADRSZ = 1, 2. Program DADR with 1 1 1 1 0 b1 b2 (b1 is the MSB of the 10-bit address, b2, etc.) 3. Program TWI_IADR with b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10 (b10 is the LSB of the 10-bit address) Figure 33-13 below shows a byte write to an Atmel AT24LC512 EEPROM. This demonstrates the use of internal addresses to access the device. Figure 33-13. Internal Address Usage
S T A R T W R I T E S T O P
Device Address 0 M S B
FIRST WORD ADDRESS
SECOND WORD ADDRESS
DATA
LRA S/C BW K
M S B
A C K
LA SC BK
A C K
407
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.7.7
Using the Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) The use of the PDC significantly reduces the CPU load. To assure correct implementation, respect the following programming sequences:
33.7.7.1
Data Transmit with the PDC 1. Initialize the transmit PDC (memory pointers, size, etc.). 2. Configure the master mode (DADR, CKDIV, etc.). 3. Start the transfer by setting the PDC TXTEN bit. 4. Wait for the PDC end TX flag. 5. Disable the PDC by setting the PDC TXDIS bit.
33.7.7.2
Data Receive with the PDC 1. Initialize the receive PDC (memory pointers, size - 1, etc.). 2. Configure the master mode (DADR, CKDIV, etc.). 3. Start the transfer by setting the PDC RXTEN bit. 4. Wait for the PDC end RX flag. 5. Disable the PDC by setting the PDC RXDIS bit.
408
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.7.8
Read/Write Flowcharts The following flowcharts shown in Figure 33-14, Figure 33-15 on page 410, Figure 33-16 on page 411, Figure 33-17 on page 412, Figure 33-18 on page 413 and Figure on page 413 give examples for read and write operations. A polling or interrupt method can be used to check the status bits. The interrupt method requires that the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER) be configured first.
Figure 33-14. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address (DADR) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
Load Transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
No TXRDY = 1? Yes Read Status register
No TXCOMP = 1? Yes Transfer finished
409
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-15. TWI Write Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address (DADR) - Internal address size (IADRSZ) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address
Load transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
No TXRDY = 1? Yes Read Status register
TXCOMP = 1? No Yes Transfer finished
410
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-16. TWI Write Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (if IADR used) - Transfer direction bit Write ==> bit MREAD = 0
No Internal address size = 0? Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address
Yes
Load Transmit register TWI_THR = Data to send
Read Status register
TWI_THR = data to send TXRDY = 1? Yes Data to send? Yes
No
Read Status register Yes No TXCOMP = 1?
END
411
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-17. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Start the transfer TWI_CR = START | STOP
Read status register
RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding Register
No
Read Status register
No TXCOMP = 1? Yes END
412
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-18. TWI Read Operation with Single Data Byte and Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (IADRSZ) - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address
Start the transfer TWI_CR = START | STOP
Read Status register
No RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding register
Read Status register
No TXCOMP = 1? Yes END
413
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-19. TWI Read Operation with Multiple Data Bytes with or without Internal Address
BEGIN
Set TWI clock (CLDIV, CHDIV, CKDIV) in TWI_CWGR (Needed only once)
Set the Control register: - Master enable TWI_CR = MSEN + SVDIS
Set the Master Mode register: - Device slave address - Internal address size (if IADR used) - Transfer direction bit Read ==> bit MREAD = 1
Internal address size = 0? Set the internal address TWI_IADR = address
Yes Start the transfer TWI_CR = START
Read Status register
RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR)
No
No
Last data to read but one? Yes Stop the transfer TWI_CR = STOP
Read Status register
No RXRDY = 1? Yes Read Receive Holding register (TWI_RHR)
Read status register
TXCOMP = 1? Yes END
No
414
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.8
33.8.1
Multi-master Mode
Definition More than one master may handle the bus at the same time without data corruption by using arbitration. Arbitration starts as soon as two or more masters place information on the bus at the same time, and stops (arbitration is lost) for the master that intends to send a logical one while the other master sends a logical zero. As soon as arbitration is lost by a master, it stops sending data and listens to the bus in order to detect a stop. When the stop is detected, the master who has lost arbitration may put its data on the bus by respecting arbitration. Arbitration is illustrated in Figure 33-21 on page 416.
33.8.2
Different Multi-master Modes Two multi-master modes may be distinguished: 1. TWI is considered as a Master only and will never be addressed. 2. TWI may be either a Master or a Slave and may be addressed.
Note: In both Multi-master modes arbitration is supported.
33.8.2.1
TWI as Master Only In this mode, TWI is considered as a Master only (MSEN is always at one) and must be driven like a Master with the ARBLST (ARBitration Lost) flag in addition. If arbitration is lost (ARBLST = 1), the programmer must reinitiate the data transfer. If the user starts a transfer (ex.: DADR + START + W + Write in THR) and if the bus is busy, the TWI automatically waits for a STOP condition on the bus to initiate the transfer (see Figure 3320 on page 416).
Note: The state of the bus (busy or free) is not indicated in the user interface.
33.8.2.2
TWI as Master or Slave The automatic reversal from Master to Slave is not supported in case of a lost arbitration. Then, in the case where TWI may be either a Master or a Slave, the programmer must manage the pseudo Multi-master mode described in the steps below. 1. Program TWI in Slave mode (SADR + MSDIS + SVEN) and perform Slave Access (if TWI is addressed). 2. If TWI has to be set in Master mode, wait until TXCOMP flag is at 1. 3. Program Master mode (DADR + SVDIS + MSEN) and start the transfer (ex: START + Write in THR). 4. As soon as the Master mode is enabled, TWI scans the bus in order to detect if it is busy or free. When the bus is considered as free, TWI initiates the transfer. 5. As soon as the transfer is initiated and until a STOP condition is sent, the arbitration becomes relevant and the user must monitor the ARBLST flag. 6. If the arbitration is lost (ARBLST is set to 1), the user must program the TWI in Slave mode in the case where the Master that won the arbitration wanted to access the TWI.
415
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
7. If TWI has to be set in Slave mode, wait until TXCOMP flag is at 1 and then program the Slave mode.
Note: In the case where the arbitration is lost and TWI is addressed, TWI will not acknowledge even if it is programmed in Slave mode as soon as ARBLST is set to 1. Then, the Master must repeat SADR.
Figure 33-20. Programmer Sends Data While the Bus is Busy
TWCK STOP sent by the master TWD DATA sent by a master Bus is busy Bus is free TWI DATA transfer Transfer is kept START sent by the TWI DATA sent by the TWI
A transfer is programmed (DADR + W + START + Write THR)
Bus is considered as free Transfer is initiated
Figure 33-21. Arbitration Cases
TWCK TWD
TWCK Data from a Master Data from TWI TWD S S S 1 1 1 0 0 11 0 1
Arbitration is lost TWI stops sending data
P
S S
1 1 1
0
1
Arbitration is lost The master stops sending data
0 01 0 01
1 1
Data from the TWI
00
11
Data from the master
P
S
ARBLST
Bus is busy Bus is free
TWI DATA transfer
A transfer is programmed (DADR + W + START + Write THR) Transfer is stopped
Transfer is kept
Transfer is programmed again (DADR + W + START + Write THR)
Bus is considered as free Transfer is initiated
The flowchart shown in Figure 33-22 on page 417 gives an example of read and write operations in Multi-master mode.
416
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-22. Multi-master Flowchart
START
Programm the SLAVE mode: SADR + MSDIS + SVEN
Read Status Register
SVACC = 1 ?
Yes
GACC = 1 ? SVREAD = 0 ?
EOSACC = 1 ? Yes TXCOMP = 1 ? Yes
Yes
TXRDY= 1 ? Yes Write in TWI_THR
RXRDY= 0 ? Yes Read TWI_RHR GENERAL CALL TREATMENT
Need to perform a master access ?
Yes Decoding of the programming sequence Prog seq OK ? Change SADR Program the Master mode DADR + SVDIS + MSEN + CLK + R / W
Read Status Register
Yes ARBLST = 1 ? Yes Yes RXRDY= 0 ? MREAD = 1 ? TXRDY= 0 ? Yes
Read TWI_RHR
Yes
Data to read?
Data to send ?
Yes
Write in TWI_THR
Stop transfer
Read Status Register Yes
TXCOMP = 0 ?
417
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9
33.9.1
Slave Mode
Definition The Slave Mode is defined as a mode where the device receives the clock and the address from another device called the master. In this mode, the device never initiates and never completes the transmission (START, REPEATED_START and STOP conditions are always provided by the master).
33.9.2
Application Block Diagram
Figure 33-23. Slave Mode Typical Application Block Diagram
VDD R TWD TWCK R
Master
Host with TWI Interface
Host with TWI Interface Slave 1
Host with TWI Interface Slave 2
LCD Controller Slave 3
33.9.3
Programming Slave Mode The following fields must be programmed before entering Slave mode: 1. SADR (TWI_SMR): The slave device address is used in order to be accessed by master devices in read or write mode. 2. MSDIS (TWI_CR): Disable the master mode. 3. SVEN (TWI_CR): Enable the slave mode. As the device receives the clock, values written in TWI_CWGR are not taken into account.
33.9.4
Receiving Data After a Start or Repeated Start condition is detected and if the address sent by the Master matches with the Slave address programmed in the SADR (Slave ADdress) field, SVACC (Slave ACCess) flag is set and SVREAD (Slave READ) indicates the direction of the transfer. SVACC remains high until a STOP condition or a repeated START is detected. When such a condition is detected, EOSACC (End Of Slave ACCess) flag is set.
33.9.4.1
Read Sequence In the case of a Read sequence (SVREAD is high), TWI transfers data written in the TWI_THR (TWI Transmit Holding Register) until a STOP condition or a REPEATED_START + an address different from SADR is detected. Note that at the end of the read sequence TXCOMP (Transmission Complete) flag is set and SVACC reset. As soon as data is written in the TWI_THR, TXRDY (Transmit Holding Register Ready) flag is reset, and it is set when the shift register is empty and the sent data acknowledged or not. If the data is not acknowledged, the NACK flag is set.
418
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Note that a STOP or a repeated START always follows a NACK. See Figure 33-24 on page 420. 33.9.4.2 Write Sequence In the case of a Write sequence (SVREAD is low), the RXRDY (Receive Holding Register Ready) flag is set as soon as a character has been received in the TWI_RHR (TWI Receive Holding Register). RXRDY is reset when reading the TWI_RHR. TWI continues receiving data until a STOP condition or a REPEATED_START + an address different from SADR is detected. Note that at the end of the write sequence TXCOMP flag is set and SVACC reset. See Figure 33-25 on page 420. 33.9.4.3 Clock Synchronization Sequence In the case where TWI_THR or TWI_RHR is not written/read in time, TWI performs a clock synchronization. Clock stretching information is given by the SCLWS (Clock Wait state) bit. See Figure 33-27 on page 422 and Figure 33-28 on page 423. 33.9.4.4 General Call In the case where a GENERAL CALL is performed, GACC (General Call ACCess) flag is set. After GACC is set, it is up to the programmer to interpret the meaning of the GENERAL CALL and to decode the new address programming sequence. See Figure 33-26 on page 421. 33.9.4.5 PDC As it is impossible to know the exact number of data to receive/send, the use of PDC is NOT recommended in SLAVE mode. 33.9.5 33.9.5.1 Data Transfer Read Operation The read mode is defined as a data requirement from the master. After a START or a REPEATED START condition is detected, the decoding of the address starts. If the slave address (SADR) is decoded, SVACC is set and SVREAD indicates the direction of the transfer. Until a STOP or REPEATED START condition is detected, TWI continues sending data loaded in the TWI_THR register. If a STOP condition or a REPEATED START + an address different from SADR is detected, SVACC is reset. Figure 33-24 on page 420 describes the write operation.
419
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 33-24. Read Access Ordered by a MASTER
SADR does not match, TWI answers with a NACK SADR matches, TWI answers with an ACK ACK/NACK from the Master A DATA NA S/RS
TWD TXRDY NACK SVACC SVREAD EOSVACC
S
ADR
R
NA
DATA
NA
P/S/RS
SADR R
A
DATA
A
Write THR
Read RHR
SVREAD has to be taken into account only while SVACC is active
Notes:
1. When SVACC is low, the state of SVREAD becomes irrelevant. 2. TXRDY is reset when data has been transmitted from TWI_THR to the shift register and set when this data has been acknowledged or non acknowledged.
33.9.5.2
Write Operation The write mode is defined as a data transmission from the master. After a START or a REPEATED START, the decoding of the address starts. If the slave address is decoded, SVACC is set and SVREAD indicates the direction of the transfer (SVREAD is low in this case). Until a STOP or REPEATED START condition is detected, TWI stores the received data in the TWI_RHR register. If a STOP condition or a REPEATED START + an address different from SADR is detected, SVACC is reset. Figure 33-25 on page 420 describes the Write operation.
Figure 33-25. Write Access Ordered by a Master
SADR does not match, TWI answers with a NACK SADR matches, TWI answers with an ACK Read RHR
TWD RXRDY SVACC SVREAD EOSVACC
Notes:
S
ADR
W
NA
DATA
NA
P/S/RS
SADR W
A
DATA
A
A
DATA
NA S/RS
SVREAD has to be taken into account only while SVACC is active
1. When SVACC is low, the state of SVREAD becomes irrelevant. 2. RXRDY is set when data has been transmitted from the shift register to the TWI_RHR and reset when this data is read.
420
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9.5.3
General Call The general call is performed in order to change the address of the slave. If a GENERAL CALL is detected, GACC is set. After the detection of General Call, it is up to the programmer to decode the commands which come afterwards. In case of a WRITE command, the programmer has to decode the programming sequence and program a new SADR if the programming sequence matches. Figure 33-26 on page 421 describes the General Call access.
Figure 33-26. Master Performs a General Call
0000000 + W RESET command = 00000110X WRITE command = 00000100X
TXD
S
GENERAL CALL
A
Reset or write DADD
A
DATA1
A
DATA2
A
New SADR
A
P
New SADR Programming sequence GCACC
Reset after read
SVACC
Note:
This method allows the user to create an own programming sequence by choosing the programming bytes and the number of them. The programming sequence has to be provided to the master.
421
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9.5.4
Clock Synchronization In both read and write modes, it may happen that TWI_THR/TWI_RHR buffer is not filled /emptied before the emission/reception of a new character. In this case, to avoid sending/receiving undesired data, a clock stretching mechanism is implemented. Clock Synchronization in Read Mode The clock is tied low if the shift register is empty and if a STOP or REPEATED START condition was not detected. It is tied low until the shift register is loaded. Figure 33-27 on page 422 describes the clock synchronization in Read mode.
33.9.5.5
Figure 33-27. Clock Synchronization in Read Mode
TWI_THR
DATA0 1 DATA1 DATA2
S
SADR
R
A
DATA0
A
DATA1
A
XXXXXXX 2
DATA2
NA
S
TWCK
Write THR CLOCK is tied low by the TWI as long as THR is empty
SCLWS TXRDY SVACC SVREAD TXCOMP
As soon as a START is detected
TWI_THR is transmitted to the shift register 1 2 The data is memorized in TWI_THR until a new value is written
Ack or Nack from the master
The clock is stretched after the ACK, the state of TWD is undefined during clock stretching
Notes:
1. TXRDY is reset when data has been written in the TWI_TH to the shift register and set when this data has been acknowledged or non acknowledged. 2. At the end of the read sequence, TXCOMP is set after a STOP or after a REPEATED_START + an address different from SADR. 3. SCLWS is automatically set when the clock synchronization mechanism is started.
422
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9.5.6
Clock Synchronization in Write Mode The c lock is tied lo w if the shift register and the TWI_RHR is full. If a STOP or REPEATED_START condition was not detected, it is tied low until TWI_RHR is read. Figure 33-28 on page 423 describes the clock synchronization in Read mode.
Figure 33-28. Clock Synchronization in Write Mode
TWCK CLOCK is tied low by the TWI as long as RHR is full TWD S SADR W A DATA0 A DATA1 A DATA2
NA
S
ADR
TWI_RHR SCLWS
DATA0 is not read in the RHR
DATA1
DATA2
SCL is stretched on the last bit of DATA1
RXRDY Rd DATA0 SVACC SVREAD TXCOMP
As soon as a START is detected
Rd DATA1
Rd DATA2
Notes:
1. At the end of the read sequence, TXCOMP is set after a STOP or after a REPEATED_START + an address different from SADR. 2. SCLWS is automatically set when the clock synchronization mechanism is started and automatically reset when the mechanism is finished.
423
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9.5.7 33.9.5.8
Reversal after a Repeated Start Reversal of Read to Write The master initiates the communication by a read command and finishes it by a write command. Figure 33-29 on page 424 describes the repeated start + reversal from Read to Write mode.
Figure 33-29. Repeated Start + Reversal from Read to Write Mode
TWI_THR DATA0 DATA1
TWD
S
SADR
R
A
DATA0
A
DATA1
NA
RS
SADR
W
A
DATA2
A
DATA3
A DATA3
P
TWI_RHR SVACC SVREAD TXRDY RXRDY EOSACC TXCOMP
As soon as a START is detected
DATA2
Cleared after read
1. TXCOMP is only set at the end of the transmission because after the repeated start, SADR is detected again.
33.9.5.9
Reversal of Write to Read The master initiates the communication by a write command and finishes it by a read command.Figure 33-30 on page 424 describes the repeated start + reversal from Write to Read mode.
Figure 33-30. Repeated Start + Reversal from Write to Read Mode
TWI_THR DATA2 DATA3
TWD TWI_RHR SVACC SVREAD TXRDY RXRDY EOSACC TXCOMP
S
SADR
W
A
DATA0
A
DATA1
A
RS
SADR
R
A
DATA2
A
DATA3
NA
P
DATA0
DATA1
Read TWI_RHR
As soon as a START is detected
Cleared after read
Notes:
1. In this case, if TWI_THR has not been written at the end of the read command, the clock is automatically stretched before the ACK. 2. TXCOMP is only set at the end of the transmission because after the repeated start, SADR is detected again.
424
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.9.6
Read Write Flowcharts The flowchart shown in Figure 33-31 on page 425 gives an example of read and write operations in Slave mode. A polling or interrupt method can be used to check the status bits. The interrupt method requires that the interrupt enable register (TWI_IER) be configured first.
Figure 33-31. Read Write Flowchart in Slave Mode
Set the SLAVE mode: SADR + MSDIS + SVEN
Read Status Register
SVACC = 1 ?
GACC = 1 ? SVREAD = 0 ?
EOSACC = 1 ?
TXRDY= 1 ?
Write in TWI_THR TXCOMP = 1 ? RXRDY= 0 ? END Read TWI_RHR
GENERAL CALL TREATMENT
Decoding of the programming sequence
Prog seq OK ?
Change SADR
425
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10 Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface
Table 33-5.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0x30 0x34 0x38 - 0xFC 0x100 - 0x124
Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface
Register Control Register Master Mode Register Slave Mode Register Internal Address Register Clock Waveform Generator Register Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Receive Holding Register Transmit Holding Register Reserved Reserved for the PDC Name TWI_CR TWI_MMR TWI_SMR TWI_IADR TWI_CWGR TWI_SR TWI_IER TWI_IDR TWI_IMR TWI_RHR TWI_THR - - Access Write-only Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Write-only - - Reset State N/A 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x0000F009 N/A N/A 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 - -
426
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.1 Name: Access:
TWI Control Register TWI_CR Write-only
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 SWRST 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 SVDIS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 SVEN 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 MSDIS 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 MSEN 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 STOP 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 START
* START: Send a START Condition 0 = No effect. 1 = A frame beginning with a START bit is transmitted according to the features defined in the mode register. This action is necessary when the TWI peripheral wants to read data from a slave. When configured in Master Mode with a write operation, a frame is sent as soon as the user writes a character in the Transmit Holding Register (TWI_THR). * STOP: Send a STOP Condition 0 = No effect. 1 = STOP Condition is sent just after completing the current byte transmission in master read mode. - In single data byte master read, the START and STOP must both be set. - In multiple data bytes master read, the STOP must be set after the last data received but one. - In master read mode, if a NACK bit is received, the STOP is automatically performed. - In multiple data write operation, when both THR and shift register are empty, a STOP condition is automatically sent. * MSEN: TWI Master Mode Enabled 0 = No effect. 1 = If MSDIS = 0, the master mode is enabled.
Note: Switching from Slave to Master mode is only permitted when TXCOMP = 1.
* MSDIS: TWI Master Mode Disabled 0 = No effect. 1 = The master mode is disabled, all pending data is transmitted. The shifter and holding characters (if it contains data) are transmitted in case of write operation. In read operation, the character being transferred must be completely received before disabling. * SVEN: TWI Slave Mode Enabled 0 = No effect.
427
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1 = If SVDIS = 0, the slave mode is enabled.
Note: Switching from Master to Slave mode is only permitted when TXCOMP = 1.
* SVDIS: TWI Slave Mode Disabled 0 = No effect. 1 = The slave mode is disabled. The shifter and holding characters (if it contains data) are transmitted in case of read operation. In write operation, the character being transferred must be completely received before disabling. * SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Equivalent to a system reset.
428
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.2 Name: Access:
TWI Master Mode Register TWI_MMR Read/Write
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 27 - 19 DADR 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 25 - 17 24 - 16
14 - 6 -
13 - 5 -
12 MREAD 4 -
10 - 2 -
9 IADRSZ 1 -
8
0 -
* IADRSZ: Internal Device Address Size
IADRSZ[9:8] 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 No internal device address One-byte internal device address Two-byte internal device address Three-byte internal device address
* MREAD: Master Read Direction 0 = Master write direction. 1 = Master read direction. * DADR: Device Address The device address is used to access slave devices in read or write mode. Those bits are only used in Master mode.
429
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.3 Name: Access:
TWI Slave Mode Register TWI_SMR Read/Write
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 27 - 19 SADR 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 25 - 17 24 - 16
14 - 6 -
13 - 5 -
12 - 4 -
10 - 2 -
9
8
1 -
0 -
* SADR: Slave Address The slave device address is used in Slave mode in order to be accessed by master devices in read or write mode. SADR must be programmed before enabling the Slave mode or after a general call. Writes at other times have no effect.
430
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.4 Name: Access:
TWI Internal Address Register TWI_IADR Read/Write
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 IADR 15 14 13 12 IADR 7 6 5 4 IADR 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 27 - 19 26 - 18 25 - 17 24 - 16
* IADR: Internal Address 0, 1, 2 or 3 bytes depending on IADRSZ.
431
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.5 Name: Access:
TWI Clock Waveform Generator Register TWI_CWGR Read/Write
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 27 - 19 26 - 18 25 - 17 CKDIV 9 24 - 16
15
14
13
12 CHDIV
11
10
8
7
6
5
4 CLDIV
3
2
1
0
TWI_CWGR is only used in Master mode. * CLDIV: Clock Low Divider The SCL low period is defined as follows:
T low = ( ( CLDIV x 2
CKDIV
) + 4 ) x T MCK
* CHDIV: Clock High Divider The SCL high period is defined as follows:
T high = ( ( CHDIV x 2
CKDIV
) + 4 ) x T MCK
* CKDIV: Clock Divider The CKDIV is used to increase both SCL high and low periods.
432
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.6 Name: Access:
TWI Status Register TWI_SR Read-only
Reset Value: 0x0000F009
31 - 23 - 15 TXBUFE 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 RXBUFF 6 OVRE 29 - 21 - 13 ENDTX 5 GACC 28 - 20 - 12 ENDRX 4 SVACC 27 - 19 - 11 EOSACC 3 SVREAD 26 - 18 - 10 SCLWS 2 TXRDY 25 - 17 - 9 ARBLST 1 RXRDY 24 - 16 - 8 NACK 0 TXCOMP
* TXCOMP: Transmission Completed (automatically set / reset) TXCOMP used in Master mode: 0 = During the length of the current frame. 1 = When both holding and shifter registers are empty and STOP condition has been sent. TXCOMP behavior in Master mode can be seen in Figure 33-8 on page 404 and in Figure 33-10 on page 405. TXCOMP used in Slave mode: 0 = As soon as a Start is detected. 1 = After a Stop or a Repeated Start + an address different from SADR is detected. TXCOMP behavior in Slave mode can be seen in Figure 33-27 on page 422, Figure 33-28 on page 423, Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424. * RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready (automatically set / reset) 0 = No character has been received since the last TWI_RHR read operation. 1 = A byte has been received in the TWI_RHR since the last read. RXRDY behavior in Master mode can be seen in Figure 33-10 on page 405. RXRDY behavior in Slave mode can be seen in Figure 33-25 on page 420, Figure 33-28 on page 423, Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424. * TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready (automatically set / reset) TXRDY used in Master mode: 0 = The transmit holding register has not been transferred into shift register. Set to 0 when writing into TWI_THR register. 1 = As soon as a data byte is transferred from TWI_THR to internal shifter or if a NACK error is detected, TXRDY is set at the same time as TXCOMP and NACK. TXRDY is also set when MSEN is set (enable TWI). TXRDY behavior in Master mode can be seen in Figure 33-8 on page 404.
433
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
TXRDY used in Slave mode: 0 = As soon as data is written in the TWI_THR, until this data has been transmitted and acknowledged (ACK or NACK). 1 = It indicates that the TWI_THR is empty and that data has been transmitted and acknowledged. If TXRDY is high and if a NACK has been detected, the transmission will be stopped. Thus when TRDY = NACK = 1, the programmer must not fill TWI_THR to avoid losing it. TXRDY behavior in Slave mode can be seen in Figure 33-24 on page 420, Figure 33-27 on page 422, Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424. * SVREAD: Slave Read (automatically set / reset) This bit is only used in Slave mode. When SVACC is low (no Slave access has been detected) SVREAD is irrelevant. 0 = Indicates that a write access is performed by a Master. 1 = Indicates that a read access is performed by a Master. SVREAD behavior can be seen in Figure 33-24 on page 420, Figure 33-25 on page 420, Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424. * SVACC: Slave Access (automatically set / reset) This bit is only used in Slave mode. 0 = TWI is not addressed. SVACC is automatically cleared after a NACK or a STOP condition is detected. 1 = Indicates that the address decoding sequence has matched (A Master has sent SADR). SVACC remains high until a NACK or a STOP condition is detected. SVACC behavior can be seen in Figure 33-24 on page 420, Figure 33-25 on page 420, Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424. * GACC: General Call Access (clear on read) This bit is only used in Slave mode. 0 = No General Call has been detected. 1 = A General Call has been detected. After the detection of General Call, the programmer decoded the commands that follow and the programming sequence. GACC behavior can be seen in Figure 33-26 on page 421. * OVRE: Overrun Error (clear on read) This bit is only used in Master mode. 0 = TWI_RHR has not been loaded while RXRDY was set 1 = TWI_RHR has been loaded while RXRDY was set. Reset by read in TWI_SR when TXCOMP is set. * NACK: Not Acknowledged (clear on read) NACK used in Master mode: 0 = Each data byte has been correctly received by the far-end side TWI slave component. 1 = A data byte has not been acknowledged by the slave component. Set at the same time as TXCOMP.
434
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
NACK used in Slave Read mode: 0 = Each data byte has been correctly received by the Master. 1 = In read mode, a data byte has not been acknowledged by the Master. When NACK is set the programmer must not fill TWI_THR even if TXRDY is set, because it means that the Master will stop the data transfer or re initiate it. Note that in Slave Write mode all data are acknowledged by the TWI. * ARBLST: Arbitration Lost (clear on read) This bit is only used in Master mode. 0: Arbitration won. 1: Arbitration lost. Another master of the TWI bus has won the multi-master arbitration. TXCOMP is set at the same time. * SCLWS: Clock Wait State (automatically set / reset) This bit is only used in Slave mode. 0 = The clock is not stretched. 1 = The clock is stretched. TWI_THR / TWI_RHR buffer is not filled / emptied before the emission / reception of a new character. SCLWS behavior can be seen in Figure 33-27 on page 422 and Figure 33-28 on page 423. * EOSACC: End Of Slave Access (clear on read) This bit is only used in Slave mode. 0 = A slave access is being performing. 1 = The Slave Access is finished. End Of Slave Access is automatically set as soon as SVACC is reset. EOSACC behavior can be seen in Figure 33-29 on page 424 and Figure 33-30 on page 424 * ENDRX: End of RX buffer This bit is only used in Master mode. 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TWI_RCR or TWI_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TWI_RCR or TWI_RNCR. * ENDTX: End of TX buffer This bit is only used in Master mode. 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TWI_TCR or TWI_TNCR. 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TWI_TCR or TWI_TNCR. * RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full This bit is only used in Master mode. 0 = TWI_RCR or TWI_RNCR have a value other than 0. 1 = Both TWI_RCR and TWI_RNCR have a value of 0.
435
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty This bit is only used in Master mode. 0 = TWI_TCR or TWI_TNCR have a value other than 0. 1 = Both TWI_TCR and TWI_TNCR have a value of 0.
436
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.7 Name: Access:
TWI Interrupt Enable Register TWI_IER Write-only
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 TXBUFE 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 RXBUFF 6 OVRE 29 - 21 - 13 ENDTX 5 GACC 28 - 20 - 12 ENDRX 4 SVACC 27 - 19 - 11 EOSACC 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 SCL_WS 2 TXRDY 25 - 17 - 9 ARBLST 1 RXRDY 24 - 16 - 8 NACK 0 TXCOMP
* TXCOMP: Transmission Completed Interrupt Enable * RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready Interrupt Enable * TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready Interrupt Enable * SVACC: Slave Access Interrupt Enable * GACC: General Call Access Interrupt Enable * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable * NACK: Not Acknowledge Interrupt Enable * ABRLST: Arbitration Lost Interrupt Enable * SCL_WS: Clock Wait State Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
437
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.8 Name: Access:
TWI Interrupt Disable Register TWI_IDR Write-only
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 TXBUFE 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 RXBUFF 6 OVRE 29 - 21 - 13 ENDTX 5 GACC 28 - 20 - 12 ENDRX 4 SVACC 27 - 19 - 11 EOSACC 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 SCL_WS 2 TXRDY 25 - 17 - 9 ARBLST 1 RXRDY 24 - 16 - 8 NACK 0 TXCOMP
* TXCOMP: Transmission Completed Interrupt Disable * RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready Interrupt Disable * TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready Interrupt Disable * SVACC: Slave Access Interrupt Disable * GACC: General Call Access Interrupt Disable * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable * NACK: Not Acknowledge Interrupt Disable * ABRLST: Arbitration Lost Interrupt Disable * SCL_WS: Clock Wait State Interrupt Disable * EOSACC: End Of Slave Access Interrupt Disable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
438
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.9 Name: Access:
TWI Interrupt Mask Register TWI_IMR Read-only
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 TXBUFE 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 RXBUFF 6 OVRE 29 - 21 - 13 ENDTX 5 GACC 28 - 20 - 12 ENDRX 4 SVACC 27 - 19 - 11 EOSACC 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 SCL_WS 2 TXRDY 25 - 17 - 9 ARBLST 1 RXRDY 24 - 16 - 8 NACK 0 TXCOMP
* TXCOMP: Transmission Completed Interrupt Mask * RXRDY: Receive Holding Register Ready Interrupt Mask * TXRDY: Transmit Holding Register Ready Interrupt Mask * SVACC: Slave Access Interrupt Mask * GACC: General Call Access Interrupt Mask * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask * NACK: Not Acknowledge Interrupt Mask * ABRLST: Arbitration Lost Interrupt Mask * SCL_WS: Clock Wait State Interrupt Mask * EOSACC: End Of Slave Access Interrupt Mask * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
439
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
33.10.10 TWI Receive Holding Register Name: TWI_RHR Access: Read-only
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXDATA 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* RXDATA: Master or Slave Receive Holding Data 33.10.11 TWI Transmit Holding Register Name: TWI_THR Access: Read/Write
Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 TXDATA 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* TXDATA: Master or Slave Transmit Holding Data
440
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34. Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver/Transceiver (USART)
34.1 Description
The Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transceiver (USART) provides one full duplex universal synchronous asynchronous serial link. Data frame format is widely programmable (data length, parity, number of stop bits) to support a maximum of standards. The receiver implements parity error, framing error and overrun error detection. The receiver time-out enables handling variable-length frames and the transmitter timeguard facilitates communications with slow remote devices. Multidrop communications are also supported through address bit handling in reception and transmission. The USART features three test modes: remote loopback, local loopback and automatic echo. The USART supports specific operating modes providing interfaces on RS485 buses, with ISO7816 T = 0 or T = 1 smart card slots, infrared transceivers and connection to modem ports. The hardware handshaking feature enables an out-of-band flow control by automatic management of the pins RTS and CTS. The USART supports the connection to the Peripheral DMA Controller, which enables data transfers to the transmitter and from the receiver. The PDC provides chained buffer management without any intervention of the processor.
441
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
34.2
Block Diagram
Figure 34-1. USART Block Diagram
Peripheral DMA Controller Channel Channel
USART
PIO Controller
RXD Receiver RTS AIC USART Interrupt TXD Transmitter CTS DTR PMC MCK MCK/DIV Modem Signals Control DSR DCD RI SLCK Baud Rate Generator SCK
DIV
User Interface
APB
442
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.3 Application Block Diagram
Figure 34-2. Application Block Diagram
PPP Modem Driver Serial Driver Field Bus Driver EMV Driver IrLAP IrDA Driver
USART
RS232 Drivers Modem PSTN
RS232 Drivers
RS485 Drivers
Smart Card Slot
IrDA Transceivers
Serial Port
Differential Bus
34.4
I/O Lines Description
I/O Line Description
Description Serial Clock Transmit Serial Data Receive Serial Data Ring Indicator Data Set Ready Data Carrier Detect Data Terminal Ready Clear to Send Request to Send Type I/O I/O Input Input Input Input Output Input Output Low Low Low Low Low Low Active Level
Table 34-1.
Name SCK TXD RXD RI DSR DCD DTR CTS RTS
443
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.5
34.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the USART may be multiplexed with the PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired USART pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the USART are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller. To prevent the TXD line from falling when the USART is disabled, the use of an internal pull up is mandatory. If the hardware handshaking feature or Modem mode is used, the internal pull up on TXD must also be enabled. All the pins of the modems may or may not be implemented on the USART. Only USART0 is fully equipped with all the modem signals. On USARTs not equipped with the corresponding pin, the associated control bits and statuses have no effect on the behavior of the USART.
34.5.2
Power Management The USART is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the USART Clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the USART. However, if the application does not require USART operations, the USART clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. In this case, the USART will resume its operations where it left off. Configuring the USART does not require the USART clock to be enabled.
34.5.3
Interrupt The USART interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the USART interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not recommended to use the USART interrupt line in edge sensitive mode.
444
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6 Functional Description
The USART is capable of managing several types of serial synchronous or asynchronous communications. It supports the following communication modes: * 5- to 9-bit full-duplex asynchronous serial communication - MSB- or LSB-first - 1, 1.5 or 2 stop bits - Parity even, odd, marked, space or none - By 8 or by 16 over-sampling receiver frequency - Optional hardware handshaking - Optional modem signals management - Optional break management - Optional multidrop serial communication * High-speed 5- to 9-bit full-duplex synchronous serial communication - MSB- or LSB-first - 1 or 2 stop bits - Parity even, odd, marked, space or none - By 8 or by 16 over-sampling frequency - Optional hardware handshaking - Optional modem signals management - Optional break management - Optional multidrop serial communication * RS485 with driver control signal * ISO7816, T0 or T1 protocols for interfacing with smart cards - NACK handling, error counter with repetition and iteration limit * InfraRed IrDA Modulation and Demodulation * Test modes - Remote loopback, local loopback, automatic echo 34.6.1 Baud Rate Generator The Baud Rate Generator provides the bit period clock named the Baud Rate Clock to both the receiver and the transmitter. The Baud Rate Generator clock source can be selected by setting the USCLKS field in the Mode Register (US_MR) between: * the Master Clock MCK * a division of the Master Clock, the divider being product dependent, but generally set to 8 * the external clock, available on the SCK pin The Baud Rate Generator is based upon a 16-bit divider, which is programmed with the CD field of the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). If CD is programmed at 0, the Baud Rate Generator does not generate any clock. If CD is programmed at 1, the divider is bypassed and becomes inactive.
445
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
If the external SCK clock is selected, the duration of the low and high levels of the signal provided on the SCK pin must be longer than a Master Clock (MCK) period. The frequency of the signal provided on SCK must be at least 4.5 times lower than MCK. Figure 34-3. Baud Rate Generator
USCLKS MCK MCK/DIV SCK Reserved CD CD 0 1 2 3 0 16-bit Counter >1 1 0 1 1 SYNC USCLKS = 3 Sampling Clock 0 OVER Sampling Divider 0 Baud Rate Clock FIDI SYNC
SCK
34.6.1.1
Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode If the USART is programmed to operate in asynchronous mode, the selected clock is first divided by CD, which is field programmed in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). The resulting clock is provided to the receiver as a sampling clock and then divided by 16 or 8, depending on the programming of the OVER bit in US_MR. If OVER is set to 1, the receiver sampling is 8 times higher than the baud rate clock. If OVER is cleared, the sampling is performed at 16 times the baud rate clock. The following formula performs the calculation of the Baud Rate.
SelectedClock Baudrate = -------------------------------------------( 8 ( 2 - Over )CD )
This gives a maximum baud rate of MCK divided by 8, assuming that MCK is the highest possible clock and that OVER is programmed at 1. Baud Rate Calculation Example Table 34-2 shows calculations of CD to obtain a baud rate at 38400 bauds for different source clock frequencies. This table also shows the actual resulting baud rate and the error. Table 34-2. Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0)
Expected Baud Rate Bit/s 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 6.00 8.00 8.14 12.00 6 8 8 12 Calculation Result CD Actual Baud Rate Bit/s 38 400.00 38 400.00 39 062.50 38 400.00 0.00% 0.00% 1.70% 0.00% Error
Source Clock MHz 3 686 400 4 915 200 5 000 000 7 372 800
446
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 34-2. Baud Rate Example (OVER = 0) (Continued)
Expected Baud Rate 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 38 400 Calculation Result 13.02 19.53 20.00 23.30 24.00 30.00 39.06 40.00 40.69 52.08 53.33 53.71 65.10 81.38 CD 13 20 20 23 24 30 39 40 40 52 53 54 65 81 Actual Baud Rate 38 461.54 37 500.00 38 400.00 38 908.10 38 400.00 38 400.00 38 461.54 38 400.00 38 109.76 38 461.54 38 641.51 38 194.44 38 461.54 38 580.25 Error 0.16% 2.40% 0.00% 1.31% 0.00% 0.00% 0.16% 0.00% 0.76% 0.16% 0.63% 0.54% 0.16% 0.47%
Source Clock 8 000 000 12 000 000 12 288 000 14 318 180 14 745 600 18 432 000 24 000 000 24 576 000 25 000 000 32 000 000 32 768 000 33 000 000 40 000 000 50 000 000
The baud rate is calculated with the following formula: BaudRate = MCK CD x 16 The baud rate error is calculated with the following formula. It is not recommended to work with an error higher than 5%.
ExpectedBaudRate Error = 1 - -------------------------------------------------- ActualBaudRate
34.6.1.2
Fractional Baud Rate in Asynchronous Mode The Baud Rate generator previously defined is subject to the following limitation: the output frequency changes by only integer multiples of the reference frequency. An approach to this problem is to integrate a fractional N clock generator that has a high resolution. The generator architecture is modified to obtain Baud Rate changes by a fraction of the reference source clock. This fractional part is programmed with the FP field in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). If FP is not 0, the fractional part is activated. The resolution is one eighth of the clock divider. This feature is only available when using USART normal mode. The fractional Baud Rate is calculated using the following formula:
SelectedClock Baudrate = --------------------------------------------------------------- 8 ( 2 - Over ) CD + FP ----- 8
The modified architecture is presented below:
447
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-4. Fractional Baud Rate Generator
FP
USCLKS MCK MCK/DIV SCK Reserved
CD
Modulus Control FP CD SCK FIDI 0 OVER Sampling Divider 1 1 SYNC USCLKS = 3 Sampling Clock 0 Baud Rate Clock SYNC
0 1 2 3 16-bit Counter glitch-free logic
>1 1
0
0
34.6.1.3
Baud Rate in Synchronous Mode If the USART is programmed to operate in synchronous mode, the selected clock is simply divided by the field CD in US_BRGR.
BaudRate = SelectedClock ------------------------------------CD
In synchronous mode, if the external clock is selected (USCLKS = 3), the clock is provided directly by the signal on the USART SCK pin. No division is active. The value written in US_BRGR has no effect. The external clock frequency must be at least 4.5 times lower than the system clock. When either the external clock SCK or the internal clock divided (MCK/DIV) is selected, the value programmed in CD must be even if the user has to ensure a 50:50 mark/space ratio on the SCK pin. If the internal clock MCK is selected, the Baud Rate Generator ensures a 50:50 duty cycle on the SCK pin, even if the value programmed in CD is odd. 34.6.1.4 Baud Rate in ISO 7816 Mode The ISO7816 specification defines the bit rate with the following formula:
Di B = ----- x f Fi
where: * B is the bit rate * Di is the bit-rate adjustment factor * Fi is the clock frequency division factor * f is the ISO7816 clock frequency (Hz)
448
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Di is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named DI, as represented in Table 34-3. Table 34-3.
DI field Di (decimal)
Binary and Decimal Values for Di
0001 1 0010 2 0011 4 0100 8 0101 16 0110 32 1000 12 1001 20
Fi is a binary value encoded on a 4-bit field, named FI, as represented in Table 34-4. Table 34-4.
FI field Fi (decimal
Binary and Decimal Values for Fi
0000 372 0001 372 0010 558 0011 744 0100 1116 0101 1488 0110 1860 1001 512 1010 768 1011 1024 1100 1536 1101 2048
Table 34-5 shows the resulting Fi/Di Ratio, which is the ratio between the ISO7816 clock and the baud rate clock. Table 34-5.
Fi/Di 1 2 4 8 16 32 12 20
Possible Values for the Fi/Di Ratio
372 372 186 93 46.5 23.25 11.62 31 18.6 558 558 279 139.5 69.75 34.87 17.43 46.5 27.9 774 744 372 186 93 46.5 23.25 62 37.2 1116 1116 558 279 139.5 69.75 34.87 93 55.8 1488 1488 744 372 186 93 46.5 124 74.4 1806 1860 930 465 232.5 116.2 58.13 155 93 512 512 256 128 64 32 16 42.66 25.6 768 768 384 192 96 48 24 64 38.4 1024 1024 512 256 128 64 32 85.33 51.2 1536 1536 768 384 192 96 48 128 76.8 2048 2048 1024 512 256 128 64 170.6 102.4
If the USART is configured in ISO7816 Mode, the clock selected by the USCLKS field in the Mode Register (US_MR) is first divided by the value programmed in the field CD in the Baud Rate Generator Register (US_BRGR). The resulting clock can be provided to the SCK pin to feed the smart card clock inputs. This means that the CLKO bit can be set in US_MR. This clock is then divided by the value programmed in the FI_DI_RATIO field in the FI_DI_Ratio register (US_FIDI). This is performed by the Sampling Divider, which performs a division by up to 2047 in ISO7816 Mode. The non-integer values of the Fi/Di Ratio are not supported and the user must program the FI_DI_RATIO field to a value as close as possible to the expected value. The FI_DI_RATIO field resets to the value 0x174 (372 in decimal) and is the most common divider between the ISO7816 clock and the bit rate (Fi = 372, Di = 1). Figure 34-5 shows the relation between the Elementary Time Unit, corresponding to a bit time, and the ISO 7816 clock.
449
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-5. Elementary Time Unit (ETU)
FI_DI_RATIO ISO7816 Clock Cycles ISO7816 Clock on SCK ISO7816 I/O Line on TXD
1 ETU
34.6.2
Receiver and Transmitter Control After reset, the receiver is disabled. The user must enable the receiver by setting the RXEN bit in the Control Register (US_CR). However, the receiver registers can be programmed before the receiver clock is enabled. After reset, the transmitter is disabled. The user must enable it by setting the TXEN bit in the Control Register (US_CR). However, the transmitter registers can be programmed before being enabled. The Receiver and the Transmitter can be enabled together or independently. At any time, the software can perform a reset on the receiver or the transmitter of the USART by setting the corresponding bit, RSTRX and RSTTX respectively, in the Control Register (US_CR). The software resets clear the status flag and reset internal state machines but the user interface configuration registers hold the value configured prior to software reset. Regardless of what the receiver or the transmitter is performing, the communication is immediately stopped. The user can also independently disable the receiver or the transmitter by setting RXDIS and TXDIS respectively in US_CR. If the receiver is disabled during a character reception, the USART waits until the end of reception of the current character, then the reception is stopped. If the transmitter is disabled while it is operating, the USART waits the end of transmission of both the current character and character being stored in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). If a timeguard is programmed, it is handled normally.
34.6.3 34.6.3.1
Synchronous and Asynchronous Modes Transmitter Operations The transmitter performs the same in both synchronous and asynchronous operating modes (SYNC = 0 or SYNC = 1). One start bit, up to 9 data bits, one optional parity bit and up to two stop bits are successively shifted out on the TXD pin at each falling edge of the programmed serial clock. The number of data bits is selected by the CHRL field and the MODE 9 bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). Nine bits are selected by setting the MODE 9 bit regardless of the CHRL field. The parity bit is set according to the PAR field in US_MR. The even, odd, space, marked or none parity bit can be configured. The MSBF field in US_MR configures which data bit is sent first. If written at 1, the most significant bit is sent first. At 0, the less significant bit is sent first. The number of stop bits is selected by the NBSTOP field in US_MR. The 1.5 stop bit is supported in asynchronous mode only.
450
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-6. Character Transmit
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled One Stop Baud Rate Clock TXD
Start Bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Bit
Stop Bit
The characters are sent by writing in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR). The transmitter reports two status bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR): TXRDY (Transmitter Ready), which indicates that US_THR is empty and TXEMPTY, which indicates that all the characters written in US_THR have been processed. When the current character processing is completed, the last character written in US_THR is transferred into the Shift Register of the transmitter and US_THR becomes empty, thus TXRDY raises. Both TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits are low since the transmitter is disabled. Writing a character in US_THR while TXRDY is active has no effect and the written character is lost. Figure 34-7. Transmitter Status
Baud Rate Clock TXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Start D0 Bit Bit Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
Write US_THR TXRDY
TXEMPTY
34.6.3.2
Manchester Encoder When the Manchester encoder is in use, characters transmitted through the USART are encoded based on biphase Manchester II format. To enable this mode, set the MAN field in the US_MR register to 1. Depending on polarity configuration, a logic level (zero or one), is transmitted as a coded signal one-to-zero or zero-to-one. Thus, a transition always occurs at the midpoint of each bit time. It consumes more bandwidth than the original NRZ signal (2x) but the receiver has more error control since the expected input must show a change at the center of a bit cell. An example of Manchester encoded sequence is: the byte 0xB1 or 10110001 encodes to 10 01 10 10 01 01 01 10, assuming the default polarity of the encoder. Figure 34-8 illustrates this coding scheme.
451
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-8. NRZ to Manchester Encoding
NRZ encoded data Manchester encoded data 1 0 1 1 0 0 0 1
Txd
The Manchester encoded character can also be encapsulated by adding both a configurable preamble and a start frame delimiter pattern. Depending on the configuration, the preamble is a training sequence, composed of a pre-defined pattern with a programmable length from 1 to 15 bit times. If the preamble length is set to 0, the preamble waveform is not generated prior to any character. The preamble pattern is chosen among the following sequences: ALL_ONE, ALL_ZERO, ONE_ZERO or ZERO_ONE, writing the field TX_PP in the US_MAN register, the field TX_PL is used to configure the preamble length. Figure 34-9 illustrates and defines the valid patterns. To improve flexibility, the encoding scheme can be configured using the TX_MPOL field in the US_MAN register. If the TX_MPOL field is set to zero (default), a logic zero is encoded with a zero-to-one transition and a logic one is encoded with a one-to-zero transition. If the TX_MPOL field is set to one, a logic one is encoded with a one-to-zero transition and a logic zero is encoded with a zero-to-one transition. Figure 34-9. Preamble Patterns, Default Polarity Assumed
Manchester encoded data
Txd
SFD
DATA
8 bit width "ALL_ONE" Preamble
Manchester encoded data
Txd
SFD
DATA
8 bit width "ALL_ZERO" Preamble Manchester encoded data
Txd
SFD
DATA
8 bit width "ZERO_ONE" Preamble
Manchester encoded data
Txd
SFD
DATA
8 bit width "ONE_ZERO" Preamble
A start frame delimiter is to be configured using the ONEBIT field in the US_MR register. It consists of a user-defined pattern that indicates the beginning of a valid data. Figure 34-10 illustrates these patterns. If the start frame delimiter, also known as start bit, is one bit, (ONEBIT at 1), a logic zero is Manchester encoded and indicates that a new character is being sent serially on the line. If the start frame delimiter is a synchronization pattern also referred to as sync (ONEBIT at 0), a sequence of 3 bit times is sent serially on the line to indicate the start of a new character. The sync waveform is in itself an invalid Manchester waveform as the transition
452
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
occurs at the middle of the second bit time. Two distinct sync patterns are used: the command sync and the data sync. The command sync has a logic one level for one and a half bit times, then a transition to logic zero for the second one and a half bit times. If the MODSYNC field in the US_MR register is set to 1, the next character is a command. If it is set to 0, the next character is a data. When direct memory access is used, the MODSYNC field can be immediately updated with a modified character located in memory. To enable this mode, VAR_SYNC field in US_MR register must be set to 1. In this case, the MODSYNC field in US_MR is bypassed and the sync configuration is held in the TXSYNH in the US_THR register. The USART character format is modified and includes sync information. Figure 34-10. Start Frame Delimiter
Preamble Length is set to 0 SFD Manchester encoded data Txd DATA One bit start frame delimiter SFD Manchester encoded data Txd DATA
SFD Manchester encoded data Txd
Command Sync start frame delimiter DATA Data Sync start frame delimiter
Drift Compensation Drift compensation is available only in 16X oversampling mode. An hardware recovery system allows a larger clock drift. To enable the hardware system, the bit in the USART_MAN register must be set. If the RXD edge is one 16X clock cycle from the expected edge, this is considered as normal jitter and no corrective actions is taken. If the RXD event is between 4 and 2 clock cycles before the expected edge, then the current period is shortened by one clock cycle. If the RXD event is between 2 and 3 clock cycles after the expected edge, then the current period is lengthened by one clock cycle. These intervals are considered to be drift and so corrective actions are automatically taken.
453
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-11. Bit Resynchronization
Oversampling 16x Clock RXD
Sampling point Expected edge Synchro. Error Synchro. Jump Tolerance Sync Jump Synchro. Error
34.6.3.3
Asynchronous Receiver If the USART is programmed in asynchronous operating mode (SYNC = 0), the receiver oversamples the RXD input line. The oversampling is either 16 or 8 times the Baud Rate clock, depending on the OVER bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). The receiver samples the RXD line. If the line is sampled during one half of a bit time at 0, a start bit is detected and data, parity and stop bits are successively sampled on the bit rate clock. If the oversampling is 16, (OVER at 0), a start is detected at the eighth sample at 0. Then, data bits, parity bit and stop bit are sampled on each 16 sampling clock cycle. If the oversampling is 8 (OVER at 1), a start bit is detected at the fourth sample at 0. Then, data bits, parity bit and stop bit are sampled on each 8 sampling clock cycle. The number of data bits, first bit sent and parity mode are selected by the same fields and bits as the transmitter, i.e. respectively CHRL, MODE9, MSBF and PAR. For the synchronization mechanism only, the number of stop bits has no effect on the receiver as it considers only one stop bit, regardless of the field NBSTOP, so that resynchronization between the receiver and the transmitter can occur. Moreover, as soon as the stop bit is sampled, the receiver starts looking for a new start bit so that resynchronization can also be accomplished when the transmitter is operating with one stop bit. Figure 34-12 and Figure 34-13 illustrate start detection and character reception when USART operates in asynchronous mode.
454
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-12. Asynchronous Start Detection
Baud Rate Clock Sampling Clock (x16) RXD Sampling 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 D0 Sampling
Start Detection RXD Sampling
1
2
3
4
5
6
01 Start Rejection
7
2
3
4
Figure 34-13. Asynchronous Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled
Baud Rate Clock RXD Start Detection
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples samples
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Parity Bit
Stop Bit
34.6.3.4
Manchester Decoder When the MAN field in US_MR register is set to 1, the Manchester decoder is enabled. The decoder performs both preamble and start frame delimiter detection. One input line is dedicated to Manchester encoded input data. An optional preamble sequence can be defined, its length is user-defined and totally independent of the emitter side. Use RX_PL in US_MAN register to configure the length of the preamble sequence. If the length is set to 0, no preamble is detected and the function is disabled. In addition, the polarity of the input stream is programmable with RX_MPOL field in US_MAN register. Depending on the desired application the preamble pattern matching is to be defined via the RX_PP field in US_MAN. See Figure 34-9 for available preamble patterns. Unlike preamble, the start frame delimiter is shared between Manchester Encoder and Decoder. So, if ONEBIT field is set to 1, only a zero encoded Manchester can be detected as a valid start frame delimiter. If ONEBIT is set to 0, only a sync pattern is detected as a valid start frame delimiter. Decoder operates by detecting transition on incoming stream. If RXD is sampled during one quarter of a bit time at zero, a start bit is detected. See Figure 34-14.. The sample pulse rejection mechanism applies.
455
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-14. Asynchronous Start Bit Detection
Sampling Clock (16 x) Manchester encoded data
Txd Start Detection 1 2 3 4
The receiver is activated and starts Preamble and Frame Delimiter detection, sampling the data at one quarter and then three quarters. If a valid preamble pattern or start frame delimiter is detected, the receiver continues decoding with the same synchronization. If the stream does not match a valid pattern or a valid start frame delimiter, the receiver re-synchronizes on the next valid edge.The minimum time threshold to estimate the bit value is three quarters of a bit time. If a valid preamble (if used) followed with a valid start frame delimiter is detected, the incoming stream is decoded into NRZ data and passed to USART for processing. Figure 34-15 illustrates Manchester pattern mismatch. When incoming data stream is passed to the USART, the receiver is also able to detect Manchester code violation. A code violation is a lack of transition in the middle of a bit cell. In this case, MANE flag in US_CSR register is raised. It is cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1. See Figure 34-16 for an example of Manchester error detection during data phase. Figure 34-15. Preamble Pattern Mismatch
Preamble Mismatch Manchester coding error Preamble Mismatch invalid pattern
Manchester encoded data
Txd
SFD
DATA
Preamble Length is set to 8
Figure 34-16. Manchester Error Flag
Preamble Length is set to 4 Elementary character bit time SFD Manchester encoded data Txd Entering USART character area
sampling points
Preamble subpacket and Start Frame Delimiter were successfully decoded
Manchester Coding Error detected
When the start frame delimiter is a sync pattern (ONEBIT field at 0), both command and data delimiter are supported. If a valid sync is detected, the received character is written as RXCHR 456
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
field in the US_RHR register and the RXSYNH is updated. RXCHR is set to 1 when the received character is a command, and it is set to 0 if the received character is a data. This mechanism alleviates and simplifies the direct memory access as the character contains its own sync field in the same register. As the decoder is setup to be used in unipolar mode, the first bit of the frame has to be a zero-toone transition.
34.6.3.5
Radio Interface: Manchester Encoded USART Application This section describes low data rate RF transmission systems and their integration with a Manchester encoded USART. These systems are based on transmitter and receiver ICs that support ASK and FSK modulation schemes. The goal is to perform full duplex radio transmission of characters using two different frequency carriers. See the configuration in Figure 34-17.
Figure 34-17. Manchester Encoded Characters RF Transmission
Fup frequency Carrier ASK/FSK Upstream Receiver
Upstream Emitter
LNA VCO RF filter Demod
Serial Configuration Interface
control Fdown frequency Carrier bi-dir line ASK/FSK downstream transmitter
Manchester decoder
USART Receiver
Downstream Receiver
Manchester encoder PA RF filter Mod VCO
USART Emitter
control
The USART module is configured as a Manchester encoder/decoder. Looking at the downstream communication channel, Manchester encoded characters are serially sent to the RF emitter. This may also include a user defined preamble and a start frame delimiter. Mostly, preamble is used in the RF receiver to distinguish between a valid data from a transmitter and signals due to noise. The Manchester stream is then modulated. See Figure 34-18 for an example of ASK modulation scheme. When a logic one is sent to the ASK modulator, the power amplifier, referred to as PA, is enabled and transmits an RF signal at downstream frequency. When a logic zero is transmitted, the RF signal is turned off. If the FSK modulator is activated, two different frequencies are used to transmit data. When a logic 1 is sent, the modulator outputs an RF signal at frequency F0 and switches to F1 if the data sent is a 0. See Figure 34-19. From the receiver side, another carrier frequency is used. The RF receiver performs a bit check operation examining demodulated data stream. If a valid pattern is detected, the receiver
457
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
switches to receiving mode. The demodulated stream is sent to the Manchester decoder. Because of bit checking inside RF IC, the data transferred to the microcontroller is reduced by a user-defined number of bits. The Manchester preamble length is to be defined in accordance with the RF IC configuration. Figure 34-18. ASK Modulator Output
1 NRZ stream Manchester encoded data default polarity unipolar output ASK Modulator Output Uptstream Frequency F0 0 0 1
Txd
Figure 34-19. FSK Modulator Output
1 NRZ stream Manchester encoded data default polarity unipolar output FSK Modulator Output Uptstream Frequencies [F0, F0+offset] 0 0 1
Txd
34.6.3.6
Synchronous Receiver In synchronous mode (SYNC = 1), the receiver samples the RXD signal on each rising edge of the Baud Rate Clock. If a low level is detected, it is considered as a start. All data bits, the parity bit and the stop bits are sampled and the receiver waits for the next start bit. Synchronous mode operations provide a high speed transfer capability. Configuration fields and bits are the same as in asynchronous mode. Figure 34-20 illustrates a character reception in synchronous mode.
Figure 34-20. Synchronous Mode Character Reception
Example: 8-bit, Parity Enabled 1 Stop Baud Rate Clock
RXD Sampling
Start
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7 Parity Bit
Stop Bit
458
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.3.7 Receiver Operations When a character reception is completed, it is transferred to the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR) and the RXRDY bit in the Status Register (US_CSR) rises. If a character is completed while the RXRDY is set, the OVRE (Overrun Error) bit is set. The last character is transferred into US_RHR and overwrites the previous one. The OVRE bit is cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA (Reset Status) bit at 1.
Figure 34-21. Receiver Status
Baud Rate Clock RXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Start D0 Bit Bit Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write US_CR Read US_RHR
RXRDY OVRE
459
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.3.8 Parity The USART supports five parity modes selected by programming the PAR field in the Mode Register (US_MR). The PAR field also enables the Multidrop mode, see "Multidrop Mode" on page 461. Even and odd parity bit generation and error detection are supported. If even parity is selected, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 1 if the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the receiver parity checker counts the number of received 1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If odd parity is selected, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 if a number of 1s in the character data bit is even, and at 0 if the number of 1s is odd. Accordingly, the receiver parity checker counts the number of received 1s and reports a parity error if the sampled parity bit does not correspond. If the mark parity is used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 1 for all characters. The receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 0. If the space parity is used, the parity generator of the transmitter drives the parity bit at 0 for all characters. The receiver parity checker reports an error if the parity bit is sampled at 1. If parity is disabled, the transmitter does not generate any parity bit and the receiver does not report any parity error. Table 34-6 shows an example of the parity bit for the character 0x41 (character ASCII "A") depending on the configuration of the USART. Because there are two bits at 1, 1 bit is added when a parity is odd, or 0 is added when a parity is even. Table 34-6.
Character A A A A A
Parity Bit Examples
Hexa 0x41 0x41 0x41 0x41 0x41 Binary 0100 0001 0100 0001 0100 0001 0100 0001 0100 0001 Parity Bit 1 0 1 0 None Parity Mode Odd Even Mark Space None
When the receiver detects a parity error, it sets the PARE (Parity Error) bit in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). The PARE bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1. Figure 34-22 illustrates the parity bit status setting and clearing.
460
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-22. Parity Error
Baud Rate Clock RXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Bad Stop Parity Bit Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write US_CR PARE
RXRDY
34.6.3.9
Multidrop Mode If the PAR field in the Mode Register (US_MR) is programmed to the value 0x6 or 0x07, the USART runs in Multidrop Mode. This mode differentiates the data characters and the address characters. Data is transmitted with the parity bit at 0 and addresses are transmitted with the parity bit at 1. If the USART is configured in multidrop mode, the receiver sets the PARE parity error bit when the parity bit is high and the transmitter is able to send a character with the parity bit high when the Control Register is written with the SENDA bit at 1. To handle parity error, the PARE bit is cleared when the Control Register is written with the bit RSTSTA at 1. The transmitter sends an address byte (parity bit set) when SENDA is written to US_CR. In this case, the next byte written to US_THR is transmitted as an address. Any character written in US_THR without having written the command SENDA is transmitted normally with the parity at 0.
34.6.3.10
Transmitter Timeguard The timeguard feature enables the USART interface with slow remote devices. The timeguard function enables the transmitter to insert an idle state on the TXD line between two characters. This idle state actually acts as a long stop bit. The duration of the idle state is programmed in the TG field of the Transmitter Timeguard Register (US_TTGR). When this field is programmed at zero no timeguard is generated. Otherwise, the transmitter holds a high level on TXD after each transmitted byte during the number of bit periods programmed in TG in addition to the number of stop bits. As illustrated in Figure 34-23, the behavior of TXRDY and TXEMPTY status bits is modified by the programming of a timeguard. TXRDY rises only when the start bit of the next character is sent, and thus remains at 0 during the timeguard transmission if a character has been written in US_THR. TXEMPTY remains low until the timeguard transmission is completed as the timeguard is part of the current character being transmitted.
461
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-23. Timeguard Operations
TG = 4 Baud Rate Clock TXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
TG = 4
Write US_THR TXRDY
TXEMPTY
Table 34-7 indicates the maximum length of a timeguard period that the transmitter can handle in relation to the function of the Baud Rate. Table 34-7. Maximum Timeguard Length Depending on Baud Rate
Bit time s 833 104 69.4 52.1 34.7 29.9 17.9 17.4 8.7 Timeguard ms 212.50 26.56 17.71 13.28 8.85 7.63 4.55 4.43 2.21
Baud Rate Bit/sec 1 200 9 600 14400 19200 28800 33400 56000 57600 115200
34.6.3.11
Receiver Time-out The Receiver Time-out provides support in handling variable-length frames. This feature detects an idle condition on the RXD line. When a time-out is detected, the bit TIMEOUT in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR) rises and can generate an interrupt, thus indicating to the driver an end of frame. The time-out delay period (during which the receiver waits for a new character) is programmed in the TO field of the Receiver Time-out Register (US_RTOR). If the TO field is programmed at 0, the Receiver Time-out is disabled and no time-out is detected. The TIMEOUT bit in US_CSR remains at 0. Otherwise, the receiver loads a 16-bit counter with the value programmed in TO. This counter is decremented at each bit period and reloaded each time a new character is received. If the counter reaches 0, the TIMEOUT bit in the Status Register rises. Then, the user can either: * Stop the counter clock until a new character is received. This is performed by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the STTTO (Start Time-out) bit at 1. In this case, the idle state
462
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
on RXD before a new character is received will not provide a time-out. This prevents having to handle an interrupt before a character is received and allows waiting for the next idle state on RXD after a frame is received. * Obtain an interrupt while no character is received. This is performed by writing US_CR with the RETTO (Reload and Start Time-out) bit at 1. If RETTO is performed, the counter starts counting down immediately from the value TO. This enables generation of a periodic interrupt so that a user time-out can be handled, for example when no key is pressed on a keyboard. If STTTO is performed, the counter clock is stopped until a first character is received. The idle state on RXD before the start of the frame does not provide a time-out. This prevents having to obtain a periodic interrupt and enables a wait of the end of frame when the idle state on RXD is detected. If RETTO is performed, the counter starts counting down immediately from the value TO. This enables generation of a periodic interrupt so that a user time-out can be handled, for example when no key is pressed on a keyboard. Figure 34-24 shows the block diagram of the Receiver Time-out feature. Figure 34-24. Receiver Time-out Block Diagram
Baud Rate Clock TO
1 STTTO
D
Q
Clock
16-bit Time-out Counter Load
16-bit Value = TIMEOUT
Character Received RETTO
Clear
0
Table 34-8 gives the maximum time-out period for some standard baud rates. Table 34-8. Maximum Time-out Period
Bit Time s 1 667 833 417 208 104 69 52 35 30 Time-out ms 109 225 54 613 27 306 13 653 6 827 4 551 3 413 2 276 1 962
Baud Rate bit/sec 600 1 200 2 400 4 800 9 600 14400 19200 28800 33400
463
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 34-8. Maximum Time-out Period (Continued)
Bit Time 18 17 5 Time-out 1 170 1 138 328
Baud Rate 56000 57600 200000
34.6.3.12
Framing Error The receiver is capable of detecting framing errors. A framing error happens when the stop bit of a received character is detected at level 0. This can occur if the receiver and the transmitter are fully desynchronized. A framing error is reported on the FRAME bit of the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). The FRAME bit is asserted in the middle of the stop bit as soon as the framing error is detected. It is cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTSTA bit at 1.
Figure 34-25. Framing Error Status
Baud Rate Clock RXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
RSTSTA = 1
Write US_CR FRAME
RXRDY
34.6.3.13
Transmit Break The user can request the transmitter to generate a break condition on the TXD line. A break condition drives the TXD line low during at least one complete character. It appears the same as a 0x00 character sent with the parity and the stop bits at 0. However, the transmitter holds the TXD line at least during one character until the user requests the break condition to be removed. A break is transmitted by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the STTBRK bit at 1. This can be performed at any time, either while the transmitter is empty (no character in either the Shift Register or in US_THR) or when a character is being transmitted. If a break is requested while a character is being shifted out, the character is first completed before the TXD line is held low. Once STTBRK command is requested further STTBRK commands are ignored until the end of the break is completed. The break condition is removed by writing US_CR with the STPBRK bit at 1. If the STPBRK is requested before the end of the minimum break duration (one character, including start, data, parity and stop bits), the transmitter ensures that the break condition completes.
464
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The transmitter considers the break as though it is a character, i.e. the STTBRK and STPBRK commands are taken into account only if the TXRDY bit in US_CSR is at 1 and the start of the break condition clears the TXRDY and TXEMPTY bits as if a character is processed. Writing US_CR with the both STTBRK and STPBRK bits at 1 can lead to an unpredictable result. All STPBRK commands requested without a previous STTBRK command are ignored. A byte written into the Transmit Holding Register while a break is pending, but not started, is ignored. After the break condition, the transmitter returns the TXD line to 1 for a minimum of 12 bit times. Thus, the transmitter ensures that the remote receiver detects correctly the end of break and the start of the next character. If the timeguard is programmed with a value higher than 12, the TXD line is held high for the timeguard period. After holding the TXD line for this period, the transmitter resumes normal operations. Figure 34-26 illustrates the effect of both the Start Break (STTBRK) and Stop Break (STPBRK) commands on the TXD line. Figure 34-26. Break Transmission
Baud Rate Clock TXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
Break Transmission STPBRK = 1
End of Break
STTBRK = 1 Write US_CR TXRDY
TXEMPTY
34.6.3.14
Receive Break The receiver detects a break condition when all data, parity and stop bits are low. This corresponds to detecting a framing error with data at 0x00, but FRAME remains low. When the low stop bit is detected, the receiver asserts the RXBRK bit in US_CSR. This bit may be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the bit RSTSTA at 1. An end of receive break is detected by a high level for at least 2/16 of a bit period in asynchronous operating mode or one sample at high level in synchronous operating mode. The end of break detection also asserts the RXBRK bit.
34.6.3.15
Hardware Handshaking The USART features a hardware handshaking out-of-band flow control. The RTS and CTS pins are used to connect with the remote device, as shown in Figure 34-27.
465
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-27. Connection with a Remote Device for Hardware Handshaking
USART TXD RXD CTS RTS Remote Device RXD TXD RTS CTS
Setting the USART to operate with hardware handshaking is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x2. The USART behavior when hardware handshaking is enabled is the same as the behavior in standard synchronous or asynchronous mode, except that the receiver drives the RTS pin as described below and the level on the CTS pin modifies the behavior of the transmitter as described below. Using this mode requires using the PDC channel for reception. The transmitter can handle hardware handshaking in any case. Figure 34-28 shows how the receiver operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The RTS pin is driven high if the receiver is disabled and if the status RXBUFF (Receive Buffer Full) coming from the PDC channel is high. Normally, the remote device does not start transmitting while its CTS pin (driven by RTS) is high. As soon as the Receiver is enabled, the RTS falls, indicating to the remote device that it can start transmitting. Defining a new buffer to the PDC clears the status bit RXBUFF and, as a result, asserts the pin RTS low. Figure 34-28. Receiver Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking
RXD RXEN = 1 Write US_CR RTS RXBUFF RXDIS = 1
Figure 34-29 shows how the transmitter operates if hardware handshaking is enabled. The CTS pin disables the transmitter. If a character is being processing, the transmitter is disabled only after the completion of the current character and transmission of the next character happens as soon as the pin CTS falls. Figure 34-29. Transmitter Behavior when Operating with Hardware Handshaking
CTS
TXD
466
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.4 ISO7816 Mode The USART features an ISO7816-compatible operating mode. This mode permits interfacing with smart cards and Security Access Modules (SAM) communicating through an ISO7816 link. Both T = 0 and T = 1 protocols defined by the ISO7816 specification are supported. Setting the USART in ISO7816 mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x4 for protocol T = 0 and to the value 0x5 for protocol T = 1. 34.6.4.1 ISO7816 Mode Overview The ISO7816 is a half duplex communication on only one bidirectional line. The baud rate is determined by a division of the clock provided to the remote device (see "Baud Rate Generator" on page 445). The USART connects to a smart card as shown in Figure 34-30. The TXD line becomes bidirectional and the Baud Rate Generator feeds the ISO7816 clock on the SCK pin. As the TXD pin becomes bidirectional, its output remains driven by the output of the transmitter but only when the transmitter is active while its input is directed to the input of the receiver. The USART is considered as the master of the communication as it generates the clock. Figure 34-30. Connection of a Smart Card to the USART
USART SCK TXD CLK I/O Smart Card
When operating in ISO7816, either in T = 0 or T = 1 modes, the character format is fixed. The configuration is 8 data bits, even parity and 1 or 2 stop bits, regardless of the values programmed in the CHRL, MODE9, PAR and CHMODE fields. MSBF can be used to transmit LSB or MSB first. Parity Bit (PAR) can be used to transmit in normal or inverse mode. Refer to "USART Mode Register" on page 479 and "PAR: Parity Type" on page 480. The USART cannot operate concurrently in both receiver and transmitter modes as the communication is unidirectional at a time. It has to be configured according to the required mode by enabling or disabling either the receiver or the transmitter as desired. Enabling both the receiver and the transmitter at the same time in ISO7816 mode may lead to unpredictable results. The ISO7816 specification defines an inverse transmission format. Data bits of the character must be transmitted on the I/O line at their negative value. The USART does not support this format and the user has to perform an exclusive OR on the data before writing it in the Transmit Holding Register (US_THR) or after reading it in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR). 34.6.4.2 Protocol T = 0 In T = 0 protocol, a character is made up of one start bit, eight data bits, one parity bit and one guard time, which lasts two bit times. The transmitter shifts out the bits and does not drive the I/O line during the guard time. If no parity error is detected, the I/O line remains at 1 during the guard time and the transmitter can continue with the transmission of the next character, as shown in Figure 34-31.
467
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
If a parity error is detected by the receiver, it drives the I/O line at 0 during the guard time, as shown in Figure 34-32. This error bit is also named NACK, for Non Acknowledge. In this case, the character lasts 1 bit time more, as the guard time length is the same and is added to the error bit time which lasts 1 bit time. When the USART is the receiver and it detects an error, it does not load the erroneous character in the Receive Holding Register (US_RHR). It appropriately sets the PARE bit in the Status Register (US_SR) so that the software can handle the error. Figure 34-31. T = 0 Protocol without Parity Error
Baud Rate Clock RXD Start Bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Guard Guard Next Bit Time 1 Time 2 Start Bit
Figure 34-32. T = 0 Protocol with Parity Error
Baud Rate Clock I/O Start Bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Error Parity Guard Bit Time 1 Guard Start Time 2 Bit D0 D1
Repetition
Receive Error Counter The USART receiver also records the total number of errors. This can be read in the Number of Error (US_NER) register. The NB_ERRORS field can record up to 255 errors. Reading US_NER automatically clears the NB_ERRORS field. Receive NACK Inhibit The USART can also be configured to inhibit an error. This can be achieved by setting the INACK bit in the Mode Register (US_MR). If INACK is at 1, no error signal is driven on the I/O line even if a parity bit is detected, but the INACK bit is set in the Status Register (US_SR). The INACK bit can be cleared by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the RSTNACK bit at 1. Moreover, if INACK is set, the erroneous received character is stored in the Receive Holding Register, as if no error occurred. However, the RXRDY bit does not raise. Transmit Character Repetition When the USART is transmitting a character and gets a NACK, it can automatically repeat the character before moving on to the next one. Repetition is enabled by writing the MAX_ITERATION field in the Mode Register (US_MR) at a value higher than 0. Each character can be transmitted up to eight times; the first transmission plus seven repetitions. If MAX_ITERATION does not equal zero, the USART repeats the character as many times as the value loaded in MAX_ITERATION.
468
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
When the USART repetition number reaches MAX_ITERATION, the ITERATION bit is set in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). If the repetition of the character is acknowledged by the receiver, the repetitions are stopped and the iteration counter is cleared. The ITERATION bit in US_CSR can be cleared by writing the Control Register with the RSIT bit at 1. Disable Successive Receive NACK The receiver can limit the number of successive NACKs sent back to the remote transmitter. This is programmed by setting the bit DSNACK in the Mode Register (US_MR). The maximum number of NACK transmitted is programmed in the MAX_ITERATION field. As soon as MAX_ITERATION is reached, the character is considered as correct, an acknowledge is sent on the line and the ITERATION bit in the Channel Status Register is set. 34.6.4.3 Protocol T = 1 When operating in ISO7816 protocol T = 1, the transmission is similar to an asynchronous format with only one stop bit. The parity is generated when transmitting and checked when receiving. Parity error detection sets the PARE bit in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR). IrDA Mode The USART features an IrDA mode supplying half-duplex point-to-point wireless communication. It embeds the modulator and demodulator which allows a glueless connection to the infrared transceivers, as shown in Figure 34-33. The modulator and demodulator are compliant with the IrDA specification version 1.1 and support data transfer speeds ranging from 2.4 Kb/s to 115.2 Kb/s. The USART IrDA mode is enabled by setting the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x8. The IrDA Filter Register (US_IF) allows configuring the demodulator filter. The USART transmitter and receiver operate in a normal asynchronous mode and all parameters are accessible. Note that the modulator and the demodulator are activated. Figure 34-33. Connection to IrDA Transceivers
34.6.5
USART Receiver Demodulator RXD RX TX Transmitter Modulator TXD
IrDA Transceivers
The receiver and the transmitter must be enabled or disabled according to the direction of the transmission to be managed.
469
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.5.1 IrDA Modulation For baud rates up to and including 115.2 Kbits/sec, the RZI modulation scheme is used. "0" is represented by a light pulse of 3/16th of a bit time. Some examples of signal pulse duration are shown in Table 34-9. Table 34-9.
Baud Rate 2.4 Kb/s 9.6 Kb/s 19.2 Kb/s 38.4 Kb/s 57.6 Kb/s 115.2 Kb/s
IrDA Pulse Duration
Pulse Duration (3/16) 78.13 s 19.53 s 9.77 s 4.88 s 3.26 s 1.63 s
Figure 34-34 shows an example of character transmission. Figure 34-34. IrDA Modulation
Start Bit Transmitter Output 0 1 0 1 Data Bits 0 0 1 1 0 Stop Bit 1
TXD
Bit Period
3 16 Bit Period
34.6.5.2
IrDA Baud Rate Table 34-10 gives some examples of CD values, baud rate error and pulse duration. Note that the requirement on the maximum acceptable error of 1.87% must be met. Table 34-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error
Peripheral Clock 3 686 400 20 000 000 32 768 000 40 000 000 3 686 400 20 000 000 32 768 000 40 000 000 3 686 400 20 000 000 Baud Rate 115 200 115 200 115 200 115 200 57 600 57 600 57 600 57 600 38 400 38 400 CD 2 11 18 22 4 22 36 43 6 33 Baud Rate Error 0.00% 1.38% 1.25% 1.38% 0.00% 1.38% 1.25% 0.93% 0.00% 1.38% Pulse Time 1.63 1.63 1.63 1.63 3.26 3.26 3.26 3.26 4.88 4.88
470
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 34-10. IrDA Baud Rate Error (Continued)
Peripheral Clock 32 768 000 40 000 000 3 686 400 20 000 000 32 768 000 40 000 000 3 686 400 20 000 000 32 768 000 40 000 000 3 686 400 20 000 000 32 768 000 Baud Rate 38 400 38 400 19 200 19 200 19 200 19 200 9 600 9 600 9 600 9 600 2 400 2 400 2 400 CD 53 65 12 65 107 130 24 130 213 260 96 521 853 Baud Rate Error 0.63% 0.16% 0.00% 0.16% 0.31% 0.16% 0.00% 0.16% 0.16% 0.16% 0.00% 0.03% 0.04% Pulse Time 4.88 4.88 9.77 9.77 9.77 9.77 19.53 19.53 19.53 19.53 78.13 78.13 78.13
34.6.5.3
IrDA Demodulator The demodulator is based on the IrDA Receive filter comprised of an 8-bit down counter which is loaded with the value programmed in US_IF. When a falling edge is detected on the RXD pin, the Filter Counter starts counting down at the Master Clock (MCK) speed. If a rising edge is detected on the RXD pin, the counter stops and is reloaded with US_IF. If no rising edge is detected when the counter reaches 0, the input of the receiver is driven low during one bit time. Figure 34-35 illustrates the operations of the IrDA demodulator.
Figure 34-35. IrDA Demodulator Operations
MCK
RXD
Counter Value
6
Receiver Input
43 Pulse Rejected
5
2
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Pulse Accepted
As the IrDA mode uses the same logic as the ISO7816, note that the FI_DI_RATIO field in US_FIDI must be set to a value higher than 0 in order to assure IrDA communications operate correctly.
471
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.6 RS485 Mode The USART features the RS485 mode to enable line driver control. While operating in RS485 mode, the USART behaves as though in asynchronous or synchronous mode and configuration of all the parameters is possible. The difference is that the RTS pin is driven high when the transmitter is operating. The behavior of the RTS pin is controlled by the TXEMPTY bit. A typical connection of the USART to a RS485 bus is shown in Figure 34-36. Figure 34-36. Typical Connection to a RS485 Bus
USART
RXD
TXD RTS
Differential Bus
The USART is set in RS485 mode by programming the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x1. The RTS pin is at a level inverse to the TXEMPTY bit. Significantly, the RTS pin remains high when a timeguard is programmed so that the line can remain driven after the last character completion. Figure 34-37 gives an example of the RTS waveform during a character transmission when the timeguard is enabled. Figure 34-37. Example of RTS Drive with Timeguard
TG = 4 Baud Rate Clock TXD
Start D0 Bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Parity Stop Bit Bit
Write US_THR TXRDY
TXEMPTY
RTS
472
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.6.7 Modem Mode The USART features modem mode, which enables control of the signals: DTR (Data Terminal Ready), DSR (Data Set Ready), RTS (Request to Send), CTS (Clear to Send), DCD (Data Carrier Detect) and RI (Ring Indicator). While operating in modem mode, the USART behaves as a DTE (Data Terminal Equipment) as it drives DTR and RTS and can detect level change on DSR, DCD, CTS and RI. Setting the USART in modem mode is performed by writing the USART_MODE field in the Mode Register (US_MR) to the value 0x3. While operating in modem mode the USART behaves as though in asynchronous mode and all the parameter configurations are available. Table 34-11 gives the correspondence of the USART signals with modem connection standards. Table 34-11. Circuit References
USART Pin TXD RTS DTR RXD CTS DSR DCD RI V24 2 4 20 3 5 6 8 22 CCITT 103 105 108.2 104 106 107 109 125 Direction From terminal to modem From terminal to modem From terminal to modem From modem to terminal From terminal to modem From terminal to modem From terminal to modem From terminal to modem
The control of the DTR output pin is performed by writing the Control Register (US_CR) with the DTRDIS and DTREN bits respectively at 1. The disable command forces the corresponding pin to its inactive level, i.e. high. The enable command forces the corresponding pin to its active level, i.e. low. RTS output pin is automatically controlled in this mode The level changes are detected on the RI, DSR, DCD and CTS pins. If an input change is detected, the RIIC, DSRIC, DCDIC and CTSIC bits in the Channel Status Register (US_CSR) are set respectively and can trigger an interrupt. The status is automatically cleared when US_CSR is read. Furthermore, the CTS automatically disables the transmitter when it is detected at its inactive state. If a character is being transmitted when the CTS rises, the character transmission is completed before the transmitter is actually disabled. 34.6.8 Test Modes The USART can be programmed to operate in three different test modes. The internal loopback capability allows on-board diagnostics. In the loopback mode the USART interface pins are disconnected or not and reconfigured for loopback internally or externally. 34.6.8.1 Normal Mode Normal mode connects the RXD pin on the receiver input and the transmitter output on the TXD pin.
473
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-38. Normal Mode Configuration
RXD Receiver
TXD Transmitter
34.6.8.2
Automatic Echo Mode Automatic echo mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission. When a bit is received on the RXD pin, it is sent to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 34-39. Programming the transmitter has no effect on the TXD pin. The RXD pin is still connected to the receiver input, thus the receiver remains active.
Figure 34-39. Automatic Echo Mode Configuration
RXD Receiver
TXD Transmitter
34.6.8.3
Local Loopback Mode Local loopback mode connects the output of the transmitter directly to the input of the receiver, as shown in Figure 34-40. The TXD and RXD pins are not used. The RXD pin has no effect on the receiver and the TXD pin is continuously driven high, as in idle state.
Figure 34-40. Local Loopback Mode Configuration
RXD Receiver
Transmitter
1
TXD
34.6.8.4
Remote Loopback Mode Remote loopback mode directly connects the RXD pin to the TXD pin, as shown in Figure 34-41. The transmitter and the receiver are disabled and have no effect. This mode allows bit-by-bit retransmission.
474
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 34-41. Remote Loopback Mode Configuration
Receiver 1 RXD
TXD Transmitter
475
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7 USART User Interface
USART Memory Map
Register Control Register Mode Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Channel Status Register Receiver Holding Register Transmitter Holding Register Baud Rate Generator Register Receiver Time-out Register Transmitter Timeguard Register Reserved FI DI Ratio Register Number of Errors Register Reserved IrDA Filter Register Manchester Encoder Decoder Register Reserved Reserved for PDC Registers Name US_CR US_MR US_IER US_IDR US_IMR US_CSR US_RHR US_THR US_BRGR US_RTOR US_TTGR - US_FIDI US_NER - US_IF US_MAN - - Access Write-only Read/Write Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - Read/Write Read-only - Read/Write Read/Write - - Reset State - - - - 0x0 - 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 0x0 - 0x174 - - 0x0 0x30011004 - -
Table 34-12.
Offset 0x0000 0x0004 0x0008 0x000C 0x0010 0x0014 0x0018 0x001C 0x0020 0x0024 0x0028
0x2C - 0x3C 0x0040 0x0044 0x0048 0x004C 0x0050 0x5C - 0xFC 0x100 - 0x128
476
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.1 Name: USART Control Register US_CR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 RSTNACK 6 TXEN 29 - 21 - 13 RSTIT 5 RXDIS 28 - 20 - 12 SENDA 4 RXEN 27 - 19 RTSDIS 11 STTTO 3 RSTTX 26 - 18 RTSEN 10 STPBRK 2 RSTRX 25 - 17 DTRDIS 9 STTBRK 1 - 24 - 16 DTREN 8 RSTSTA 0 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 RETTO 7 TXDIS
* RSTRX: Reset Receiver 0: No effect. 1: Resets the receiver. * RSTTX: Reset Transmitter 0: No effect. 1: Resets the transmitter. * RXEN: Receiver Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the receiver, if RXDIS is 0. * RXDIS: Receiver Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the receiver. * TXEN: Transmitter Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the transmitter if TXDIS is 0. * TXDIS: Transmitter Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the transmitter. * RSTSTA: Reset Status Bits 0: No effect. 1: Resets the status bits PARE, FRAME, OVRE, MANERR and RXBRK in US_CSR. * STTBRK: Start Break 0: No effect. 1: Starts transmission of a break after the characters present in US_THR and the Transmit Shift Register have been transmitted. No effect if a break is already being transmitted. 477
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* STPBRK: Stop Break 0: No effect. 1: Stops transmission of the break after a minimum of one character length and transmits a high level during 12-bit periods. No effect if no break is being transmitted. * STTTO: Start Time-out 0: No effect. 1: Starts waiting for a character before clocking the time-out counter. Resets the status bit TIMEOUT in US_CSR. * SENDA: Send Address 0: No effect. 1: In Multidrop Mode only, the next character written to the US_THR is sent with the address bit set. * RSTIT: Reset Iterations 0: No effect. 1: Resets ITERATION in US_CSR. No effect if the ISO7816 is not enabled. * RSTNACK: Reset Non Acknowledge 0: No effect 1: Resets NACK in US_CSR. * RETTO: Rearm Time-out 0: No effect 1: Restart Time-out * DTREN: Data Terminal Ready Enable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin DTR at 0. * DTRDIS: Data Terminal Ready Disable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin DTR to 1. * RTSEN: Request to Send Enable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin RTS to 0. * RTSDIS: Request to Send Disable 0: No effect. 1: Drives the pin RTS to 1.
478
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.2 Name: USART Mode Register US_MR Read/Write
30 MODSYNC- 22 VAR_SYNC 14 CHMODE 7 CHRL 6 5 USCLKS 29 MAN 21 DSNACK 13 NBSTOP 4 3 28 FILTER 20 INACK 12 27 - 19 OVER 11 26 25 MAX_ITERATION 17 MODE9 9 24
Access Type:
31 ONEBIT 23 - 15
18 CLKO 10 PAR 2
16 MSBF 8 SYNC 0
1 USART_MODE
* USART_MODE
USART_MODE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 x 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 x Mode of the USART Normal RS485 Hardware Handshaking Modem IS07816 Protocol: T = 0 Reserved IS07816 Protocol: T = 1 Reserved IrDA Reserved
* USCLKS: Clock Selection
USCLKS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Selected Clock MCK MCK/DIV (DIV = 8) Reserved SCK
* CHRL: Character Length.
CHRL 0 0 Character Length 5 bits
479
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
0 1 1 1 0 1 6 bits 7 bits 8 bits
* SYNC: Synchronous Mode Select 0: USART operates in Asynchronous Mode. 1: USART operates in Synchronous Mode. * PAR: Parity Type
PAR 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 x x Parity Type Even parity Odd parity Parity forced to 0 (Space) Parity forced to 1 (Mark) No parity Multidrop mode
* NBSTOP: Number of Stop Bits
NBSTOP 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Asynchronous (SYNC = 0) 1 stop bit 1.5 stop bits 2 stop bits Reserved Synchronous (SYNC = 1) 1 stop bit Reserved 2 stop bits Reserved
* CHMODE: Channel Mode
CHMODE 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Mode Description Normal Mode Automatic Echo. Receiver input is connected to the TXD pin. Local Loopback. Transmitter output is connected to the Receiver Input.. Remote Loopback. RXD pin is internally connected to the TXD pin.
* MSBF: Bit Order 0: Least Significant Bit is sent/received first. 1: Most Significant Bit is sent/received first. * MODE9: 9-bit Character Length 0: CHRL defines character length. 1: 9-bit character length.
480
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* CLKO: Clock Output Select 0: The USART does not drive the SCK pin. 1: The USART drives the SCK pin if USCLKS does not select the external clock SCK. * OVER: Oversampling Mode 0: 16x Oversampling. 1: 8x Oversampling. * INACK: Inhibit Non Acknowledge 0: The NACK is generated. 1: The NACK is not generated. * DSNACK: Disable Successive NACK 0: NACK is sent on the ISO line as soon as a parity error occurs in the received character (unless INACK is set). 1: Successive parity errors are counted up to the value specified in the MAX_ITERATION field. These parity errors generate a NACK on the ISO line. As soon as this value is reached, no additional NACK is sent on the ISO line. The flag ITERATION is asserted. * VAR_SYNC: Variable Synchronization of Command/Data Sync Start Frame Delimiter 0: User defined configuration of command or data sync field depending on SYNC value. 1: The sync field is updated when a character is written into US_THR register. * MAX_ITERATION Defines the maximum number of iterations in mode ISO7816, protocol T= 0. * FILTER: Infrared Receive Line Filter 0: The USART does not filter the receive line. 1: The USART filters the receive line using a three-sample filter (1/16-bit clock) (2 over 3 majority). * MAN: Manchester Encoder/Decoder Enable 0: Manchester Encoder/Decoder are disabled. 1: Manchester Encoder/Decoder are enabled. * MODSYNC: Manchester Synchronization Mode 0:The Manchester Start bit is a 0 to 1 transition 1: The Manchester Start bit is a 1 to 0 transition. * ONEBIT: Start Frame Delimiter Selector 0: Start Frame delimiter is COMMAND or DATA SYNC. 1: Start Frame delimiter is One Bit.
481
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.3 Name: USART Interrupt Enable Register US_IER Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 FRAME 29 - 21 - 13 NACK 5 OVRE 28 - 20 MANE 12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX 27 - 19 CTSIC 11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX 26 - 18 DCDIC 10 ITERATION 2 RXBRK 25 - 17 DSRIC 9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY 24 - 16 RIIC 8 TIMEOUT 0 RXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 PARE
* RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Enable * TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Enable * RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Enable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Enable * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable * FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Enable * PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Enable * TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Enable * TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Enable * ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Enable * TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Enable * NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Enable * RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Enable * DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Enable * DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Enable * CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Enable * MANE: Manchester Error Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the corresponding interrupt.
482
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.4 Name: USART Interrupt Disable Register US_IDR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 FRAME 29 - 21 - 13 NACK 5 OVRE 28 - 20 MANE 12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX 27 - 19 CTSIC 11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX 26 - 18 DCDIC 10 ITERATION 2 RXBRK 25 - 17 DSRIC 9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY 24 - 16 RIIC 8 TIMEOUT 0 RXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 PARE
* RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Disable * TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Disable * RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Disable * ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Disable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Disable * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable * FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Disable * PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Disable * TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Disable * TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Disable * ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Disable * TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable * RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Disable * NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Disable * RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Disable * DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Disable * DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Disable * CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Disable * MANE: Manchester Error Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the corresponding interrupt.
483
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.5 Name: USART Interrupt Mask Register US_IMR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 FRAME 29 - 21 - 13 NACK 5 OVRE 28 - 20 MANE 12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX 27 - 19 CTSIC 11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX 26 - 18 DCDIC 10 ITERATION 2 RXBRK 25 - 17 DSRIC 9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY 24 - 16 RIIC 8 TIMEOUT 0 RXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 PARE
* RXRDY: RXRDY Interrupt Mask * TXRDY: TXRDY Interrupt Mask * RXBRK: Receiver Break Interrupt Mask * ENDRX: End of Receive Transfer Interrupt Mask * ENDTX: End of Transmit Interrupt Mask * OVRE: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask * FRAME: Framing Error Interrupt Mask * PARE: Parity Error Interrupt Mask * TIMEOUT: Time-out Interrupt Mask * TXEMPTY: TXEMPTY Interrupt Mask * ITERATION: Iteration Interrupt Mask * TXBUFE: Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask * RXBUFF: Buffer Full Interrupt Mask * NACK: Non Acknowledge Interrupt Mask * RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Mask * DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Mask * DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Interrupt Mask * CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Interrupt Mask * MANE: Manchester Error Interrupt Mask 0: The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1: The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
484
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.6 Name: USART Channel Status Register US_CSR Read-only
30 - 22 DCD 14 - 6 FRAME 29 - 21 DSR 13 NACK 5 OVRE 28 - 20 RI 12 RXBUFF 4 ENDTX 27 - 19 CTSIC 11 TXBUFE 3 ENDRX 26 - 18 DCDIC 10 ITERATION 2 RXBRK 25 - 17 DSRIC 9 TXEMPTY 1 TXRDY 24 MANERR 16 RIIC 8 TIMEOUT 0 RXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 CTS 15 - 7 PARE
* RXRDY: Receiver Ready 0: No complete character has been received since the last read of US_RHR or the receiver is disabled. If characters were being received when the receiver was disabled, RXRDY changes to 1 when the receiver is enabled. 1: At least one complete character has been received and US_RHR has not yet been read. * TXRDY: Transmitter Ready 0: A character is in the US_THR waiting to be transferred to the Transmit Shift Register, or an STTBRK command has been requested, or the transmitter is disabled. As soon as the transmitter is enabled, TXRDY becomes 1. 1: There is no character in the US_THR. * RXBRK: Break Received/End of Break 0: No Break received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA. 1: Break Received or End of Break detected since the last RSTSTA. * ENDRX: End of Receiver Transfer 0: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is inactive. 1: The End of Transfer signal from the Receive PDC channel is active. * ENDTX: End of Transmitter Transfer 0: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive. 1: The End of Transfer signal from the Transmit PDC channel is active. * OVRE: Overrun Error 0: No overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one overrun error has occurred since the last RSTSTA. * FRAME: Framing Error 0: No stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one stop bit has been detected low since the last RSTSTA.
485
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* PARE: Parity Error 0: No parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one parity error has been detected since the last RSTSTA. * TIMEOUT: Receiver Time-out 0: There has not been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR) or the Time-out Register is 0. 1: There has been a time-out since the last Start Time-out command (STTTO in US_CR). * TXEMPTY: Transmitter Empty 0: There are characters in either US_THR or the Transmit Shift Register, or the transmitter is disabled. 1: There are no characters in US_THR, nor in the Transmit Shift Register. * ITERATION: Max number of Repetitions Reached 0: Maximum number of repetitions has not been reached since the last RSIT. 1: Maximum number of repetitions has been reached since the last RSIT. * TXBUFE: Transmission Buffer Empty 0: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is inactive. 1: The signal Buffer Empty from the Transmit PDC channel is active. * RXBUFF: Reception Buffer Full 0: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is inactive. 1: The signal Buffer Full from the Receive PDC channel is active. * NACK: Non Acknowledge 0: No Non Acknowledge has not been detected since the last RSTNACK. 1: At least one Non Acknowledge has been detected since the last RSTNACK. * RIIC: Ring Indicator Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the RI pin since the last read of US_CSR. * DSRIC: Data Set Ready Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the DSR pin since the last read of US_CSR. * DCDIC: Data Carrier Detect Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the DCD pin since the last read of US_CSR. * CTSIC: Clear to Send Input Change Flag 0: No input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR. 1: At least one input change has been detected on the CTS pin since the last read of US_CSR. * RI: Image of RI Input 0: RI is at 0. 1: RI is at 1. 486
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* DSR: Image of DSR Input 0: DSR is at 0 1: DSR is at 1. * DCD: Image of DCD Input 0: DCD is at 0. 1: DCD is at 1. * CTS: Image of CTS Input 0: CTS is at 0. 1: CTS is at 1. * MANERR: Manchester Error 0: No Manchester error has been detected since the last RSTSTA. 1: At least one Manchester error has been detected since the last RSTSTA.
487
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.7 Name: USART Receive Holding Register US_RHR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXCHR 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 RXCHR 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 RXSYNH 7
* RXCHR: Received Character Last character received if RXRDY is set. * RXSYNH: Received Sync 0: Last Character received is a Data. 1: Last Character received is a Command.
488
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.8 Name: USART Transmit Holding Register US_THR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 TXCHR 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 TXCHR 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 TXSYNH 7
* TXCHR: Character to be Transmitted Next character to be transmitted after the current character if TXRDY is not set. * TXSYNH: Sync Field to be transmitted 0: The next character sent is encoded as a data. Start Frame Delimiter is DATA SYNC. 1: The next character sent is encoded as a command. Start Frame Delimiter is COMMAND SYNC.
489
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
34.7.9 Name:
USART Baud Rate Generator Register US_BRGR Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 CD 7 6 5 4 CD 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 25 - 17 FP 9 24 - 16
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
10
8
* CD: Clock Divider
USART_MODE ISO7816 CD OVER = 0 0 1 to 65535 Baud Rate = Selected Clock/16/CD SYNC = 0 OVER = 1 Baud Rate Clock Disabled Baud Rate = Selected Clock/8/CD Baud Rate = Selected Clock /CD Baud Rate = Selected Clock/CD/FI_DI_RATIO SYNC = 1 USART_MODE = ISO7816
* FP: Fractional Part 0: Fractional divider is disabled. 1 - 7: Baudrate resolution, defined by FP x 1/8.
490
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.10 Name: USART Receiver Time-out Register US_RTOR Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
- 23 - 15
- 22 - 14
- 21 - 13
- 20 - 12 TO
- 19 - 11
- 18 - 10
- 17 - 9
- 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 TO
3
2
1
0
* TO: Time-out Value 0: The Receiver Time-out is disabled. 1 - 65535: The Receiver Time-out is enabled and the Time-out delay is TO x Bit Period.
491
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
34.7.11 Name:
USART Transmitter Timeguard Register US_TTGR Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 TG 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
* TG: Timeguard Value 0: The Transmitter Timeguard is disabled. 1 - 255: The Transmitter timeguard is enabled and the timeguard delay is TG x Bit Period.
492
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
34.7.12 Name: USART FI DI RATIO Register US_FIDI Read/Write 0x174
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 FI_DI_RATIO 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 FI_DI_RATIO 1 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type: Reset Value :
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
2
0
* FI_DI_RATIO: FI Over DI Ratio Value 0: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate Generator generates no signal. 1 - 2047: If ISO7816 mode is selected, the Baud Rate is the clock provided on SCK divided by FI_DI_RATIO. 34.7.13 Name: USART Number of Errors Register US_NER Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 NB_ERRORS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
* NB_ERRORS: Number of Errors Total number of errors that occurred during an ISO7816 transfer. This register automatically clears when read.
493
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
34.7.14 Name:
USART Manchester Configuration Register US_MAN Read/Write
30 DRIFT 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 RX_MPOL 20 - 12 TX_MPOL 4 - 27 - 19 26 - 18 RX_PL 11 - 3 10 - 2 TX_PL 9 TX_PP 1 0 8 25 RX_PP 17 16 24
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* TX_PL: Transmitter Preamble Length 0: The Transmitter Preamble pattern generation is disabled 1 - 15: The Preamble Length is TX_PL x Bit Period * TX_PP: Transmitter Preamble Pattern
TX_PP 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Preamble Pattern default polarity assumed (TX_MPOL field not set) ALL_ONE ALL_ZERO ZERO_ONE ONE_ZERO
* TX_MPOL: Transmitter Manchester Polarity 0: Logic Zero is coded as a zero-to-one transition, Logic One is coded as a one-to-zero transition. 1: Logic Zero is coded as a one-to-zero transition, Logic One is coded as a zero-to-one transition. * RX_PL: Receiver Preamble Length 0: The receiver preamble pattern detection is disabled 1 - 15: The detected preamble length is RX_PL x Bit Period * RX_PP: Receiver Preamble Pattern detected
RX_PP 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Preamble Pattern default polarity assumed (RX_MPOL field not set) ALL_ONE ALL_ZERO ZERO_ONE ONE_ZERO
* RX_MPOL: Receiver Manchester Polarity 494
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
0: Logic Zero is coded as a zero-to-one transition, Logic One is coded as a one-to-zero transition. 1: Logic Zero is coded as a one-to-zero transition, Logic One is coded as a zero-to-one transition. * DRIFT: Drift compensation 0: The USART can not recover from an important clock drift 1: The USART can recover from clock drift. The 16X clock mode must be enabled.
495
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
34.7.15 Name:
USART IrDA FILTER Register US_IF Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 IRDA_FILTER 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
* IRDA_FILTER: IrDA Filter Sets the filter of the IrDA demodulator.
496
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35. Serial Synchronous Controller (SSC)
35.1 Description
The Atmel Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) provides a synchronous communication link with external devices. It supports many serial synchronous communication protocols generally used in audio and telecom applications such as I2S, Short Frame Sync, Long Frame Sync, etc. The SSC contains an independent receiver and transmitter and a common clock divider. The receiver and the transmitter each interface with three signals: the TD/RD signal for data, the TK/RK signal for the clock and the TF/RF signal for the Frame Sync. The transfers can be programmed to start automatically or on different events detected on the Frame Sync signal. The SSC's high-level of programmability and its two dedicated PDC channels of up to 32 bits permit a continuous high bit rate data transfer without processor intervention. Featuring connection to two PDC channels, the SSC permits interfacing with low processor overhead to the following: * CODEC's in master or slave mode * DAC through dedicated serial interface, particularly I2S * Magnetic card reader
497
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.2
Block Diagram
Figure 35-1. Block Diagram
System Bus
APB Bridge
PDC Peripheral Bus TF TK TD SSC Interface PIO RF RK Interrupt Control RD
PMC
MCK
SSC Interrupt
35.3
Application Block Diagram
Figure 35-2. Application Block Diagram
OS or RTOS Driver Power Management SSC Time Slot Management Frame Management Interrupt Management Test Management
Serial AUDIO
Codec
Line Interface
498
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.4 Pin Name List
I/O Lines Description
Pin Description Receiver Frame Synchro Receiver Clock Receiver Data Transmitter Frame Synchro Transmitter Clock Transmitter Data Type Input/Output Input/Output Input Input/Output Input/Output Output
Table 35-1.
Pin Name RF RK RD TF TK TD
35.5
35.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. Before using the SSC receiver, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC receiver I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode. Before using the SSC transmitter, the PIO controller must be configured to dedicate the SSC transmitter I/O lines to the SSC peripheral mode.
35.5.2
Power Management The SSC is not continuously clocked. The SSC interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), therefore the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the SSC clock. Interrupt The SSC interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling interrupts requires programming the AIC before configuring the SSC. All SSC interrupts can be enabled/disabled configuring the SSC Interrupt mask register. Each pending and unmasked SSC interrupt will assert the SSC interrupt line. The SSC interrupt service routine can get the interrupt origin by reading the SSC interrupt status register.
35.5.3
35.6
Functional Description
This chapter contains the functional description of the following: SSC Functional Block, Clock Management, Data format, Start, Transmitter, Receiver and Frame Sync. The receiver and transmitter operate separately. However, they can work synchronously by programming the receiver to use the transmit clock and/or to start a data transfer when transmission starts. Alternatively, this can be done by programming the transmitter to use the receive clock and/or to start a data transfer when reception starts. The transmitter and the receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. The maximum clock speed allowed on the TK and RK pins is the master clock divided by 2.
499
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 35-3. SSC Functional Block Diagram
Transmitter
Clock Output Controller
TK
MCK
Clock Divider
TK Input RX clock TF RF Start Selector TX PDC Transmit Clock Controller
TX clock
Frame Sync Controller
TF
Transmit Shift Register Transmit Holding Register Transmit Sync Holding Register
TD
APB User Interface
Load Shift
Receiver
Clock Output Controller
RK
RK Input TX Clock RF TF Start Selector
Receive Clock RX Clock Controller
Frame Sync Controller
RF
Receive Shift Register Receive Holding Register Receive Sync Holding Register
RD
RX PDC PDC Interrupt Control
Load Shift
AIC
35.6.1
Clock Management The transmitter clock can be generated by: * an external clock received on the TK I/O pad * the receiver clock * the internal clock divider The receiver clock can be generated by: * an external clock received on the RK I/O pad * the transmitter clock * the internal clock divider Furthermore, the transmitter block can generate an external clock on the TK I/O pad, and the receiver block can generate an external clock on the RK I/O pad. This allows the SSC to support many Master and Slave Mode data transfers.
500
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.6.1.1 Clock Divider
Figure 35-4. Divided Clock Block Diagram
Clock Divider SSC_CMR MCK /2
12-bit Counter
Divided Clock
The Master Clock divider is determined by the 12-bit field DIV counter and comparator (so its maximal value is 4095) in the Clock Mode Register SSC_CMR, allowing a Master Clock division by up to 8190. The Divided Clock is provided to both the Receiver and Transmitter. When this field is programmed to 0, the Clock Divider is not used and remains inactive. When DIV is set to a value equal to or greater than 1, the Divided Clock has a frequency of Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. Each level of the Divided Clock has a duration of the Master Clock multiplied by DIV. This ensures a 50% duty cycle for the Divided Clock regardless of whether the DIV value is even or odd. Figure 35-5. Divided Clock Generation
Master Clock
Divided Clock DIV = 1 Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/2
Master Clock
Divided Clock DIV = 3 Divided Clock Frequency = MCK/6
Table 35-2.
Maximum MCK / 2 Minimum MCK / 8190
35.6.1.2
Transmitter Clock Management The transmitter clock is generated from the receiver clock or the divider clock or an external clock scanned on the TK I/O pad. The transmitter clock is selected by the CKS field in SSC_TCMR (Transmit Clock Mode Register). Transmit Clock can be inverted independently by the CKI bits in SSC_TCMR. The transmitter can also drive the TK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer. The clock output is configured by the SSC_TCMR register. The Transmit Clock Inversion (CKI) bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the TCMR register to select TK pin 501
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
(CKS field) and at the same time Continuous Transmit Clock (CKO field) might lead to unpredictable results. Figure 35-6. Transmitter Clock Management
TK (pin)
MUX Receiver Clock
Tri_state Controller
Clock Output
Divider Clock CKO Data Transfer
CKS
INV MUX
Tri-state Controller
Transmitter Clock
CKI
CKG
35.6.1.3
Receiver Clock Management The receiver clock is generated from the transmitter clock or the divider clock or an external clock scanned on the RK I/O pad. The Receive Clock is selected by the CKS field in SSC_RCMR (Receive Clock Mode Register). Receive Clocks can be inverted independently by the CKI bits in SSC_RCMR. The receiver can also drive the RK I/O pad continuously or be limited to the actual data transfer. The clock output is configured by the SSC_RCMR register. The Receive Clock Inversion (CKI) bits have no effect on the clock outputs. Programming the RCMR register to select RK pin (CKS field) and at the same time Continuous Receive Clock (CKO field) can lead to unpredictable results.
Figure 35-7. Receiver Clock Management
RK (pin) Tri-state Controller
MUX Transmitter Clock
Clock Output
Divider Clock CKO Data Transfer
CKS
INV MUX
Tri-state Controller
Receiver Clock
CKI
CKG
502
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.6.1.4 Serial Clock Ratio Considerations The Transmitter and the Receiver can be programmed to operate with the clock signals provided on either the TK or RK pins. This allows the SSC to support many slave-mode data transfers. In this case, the maximum clock speed allowed on the RK pin is: - Master Clock divided by 2 if Receiver Frame Synchro is input - Master Clock divided by 3 if Receiver Frame Synchro is output In addition, the maximum clock speed allowed on the TK pin is: - Master Clock divided by 6 if Transmit Frame Synchro is input - Master Clock divided by 2 if Transmit Frame Synchro is output 35.6.2 Transmitter Operations A transmitted frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data before data transmission. The start event is configured by setting the Transmit Clock Mode Register (SSC_TCMR). See "Start" on page 504. The frame synchronization is configured setting the Transmit Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR). See "Frame Sync" on page 506. To transmit data, the transmitter uses a shift register clocked by the transmitter clock signal and the start mode selected in the SSC_TCMR. Data is written by the application to the SSC_THR register then transferred to the shift register according to the data format selected. When both the SSC_THR and the transmit shift register are empty, the status flag TXEMPTY is set in SSC_SR. When the Transmit Holding register is transferred in the Transmit shift register, the status flag TXRDY is set in SSC_SR and additional data can be loaded in the holding register. Figure 35-8. Transmitter Block Diagram
SSC_CR.TXEN
SSC_SR.TXEN
SSC_CR.TXDIS SSC_TFMR.DATDEF
1 RF Transmitter Clock TF SSC_TFMR.MSBF 0
SSC_TCMR.STTDLY SSC_TFMR.FSDEN SSC_TFMR.DATNB TD
Start Selector
Transmit Shift Register
SSC_TFMR.FSDEN SSC_TCMR.STTDLY SSC_TFMR.DATLEN SSC_THR
0
1
SSC_TSHR
SSC_TFMR.FSLEN
503
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.6.3
Receiver Operations A received frame is triggered by a start event and can be followed by synchronization data before data transmission. The start event is configured setting the Receive Clock Mode Register (SSC_RCMR). See "Start" on page 504. The frame synchronization is configured setting the Receive Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR). See "Frame Sync" on page 506. The receiver uses a shift register clocked by the receiver clock signal and the start mode selected in the SSC_RCMR. The data is transferred from the shift register depending on the data format selected. When the receiver shift register is full, the SSC transfers this data in the holding register, the status flag RXRDY is set in SSC_SR and the data can be read in the receiver holding register. If another transfer occurs before read of the RHR register, the status flag OVERUN is set in SSC_SR and the receiver shift register is transferred in the RHR register.
Figure 35-9. Receiver Block Diagram
SSC_CR.RXEN SSC_SR.RXEN SSC_CR.RXDIS
RF Receiver Clock
TF
SSC_RFMR.MSBF
SSC_RFMR.DATNB
Start Selector
Receive Shift Register
RD
SSC_RSHR SSC_RCMR.STTDLY SSC_RFMR.FSLEN
SSC_RHR SSC_RFMR.DATLEN
35.6.4
Start The transmitter and receiver can both be programmed to start their operations when an event occurs, respectively in the Transmit Start Selection (START) field of SSC_TCMR and in the Receive Start Selection (START) field of SSC_RCMR. Under the following conditions the start event is independently programmable: * Continuous. In this case, the transmission starts as soon as a word is written in SSC_THR and the reception starts as soon as the Receiver is enabled. * Synchronously with the transmitter/receiver * On detection of a falling/rising edge on TF/RF * On detection of a low level/high level on TF/RF * On detection of a level change or an edge on TF/RF
504
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
A start can be programmed in the same manner on either side of the Transmit/Receive Clock Register (RCMR/TCMR). Thus, the start could be on TF (Transmit) or RF (Receive). Moreover, the Receiver can start when data is detected in the bit stream with the Compare Functions. Detection on TF/RF input/output is done by the field FSOS of the Transmit/Receive Frame Mode Register (TFMR/RFMR). Figure 35-10. Transmit Start Mode
TK TF (Input)
Start = Low Level on TF
TD (Output) TD (Output)
X
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Falling Edge on TF
X
BO
B1 STTDLY X BO B1 STTDLY
Start = High Level on TF
TD (Output) TD (Output) TD (Output) TD (Output) X
Start = Rising Edge on TF
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Level Change on TF
X
BO
B1
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Any Edge on TF
X
BO
B1
BO
B1 STTDLY
Figure 35-11. Receive Pulse/Edge Start Modes
RK RF (Input)
Start = Low Level on RF
RD (Input) RD (Input)
X
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Falling Edge on RF
X
BO
B1 STTDLY X BO B1 STTDLY
Start = High Level on RF
RD (Input) RD (Input) RD (Input) RD (Input) X
Start = Rising Edge on RF
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Level Change on RF
X
BO
B1
BO
B1 STTDLY
Start = Any Edge on RF
X
BO
B1
BO
B1 STTDLY
505
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.6.5
Frame Sync The Transmitter and Receiver Frame Sync pins, TF and RF, can be programmed to generate different kinds of frame synchronization signals. The Frame Sync Output Selection (FSOS) field in the Receive Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR) and in the Transmit Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR) are used to select the required waveform. * Programmable low or high levels during data transfer are supported. * Programmable high levels before the start of data transfers or toggling are also supported. If a pulse waveform is selected, the Frame Sync Length (FSLEN) field in SSC_RFMR and SSC_TFMR programs the length of the pulse, from 1 bit time up to 256 bit time. The periodicity of the Receive and Transmit Frame Sync pulse output can be programmed through the Period Divider Selection (PERIOD) field in SSC_RCMR and SSC_TCMR.
35.6.5.1
Frame Sync Data Frame Sync Data transmits or receives a specific tag during the Frame Sync signal. During the Frame Sync signal, the Receiver can sample the RD line and store the data in the Receive Sync Holding Register and the transmitter can transfer Transmit Sync Holding Register in the Shifter Register. The data length to be sampled/shifted out during the Frame Sync signal is programmed by the FSLEN field in SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR and has a maximum value of 16. Concerning the Receive Frame Sync Data operation, if the Frame Sync Length is equal to or lower than the delay between the start event and the actual data reception, the data sampling operation is performed in the Receive Sync Holding Register through the Receive Shift Register. The Transmit Frame Sync Operation is performed by the transmitter only if the bit Frame Sync Data Enable (FSDEN) in SSC_TFMR is set. If the Frame Sync length is equal to or lower than the delay between the start event and the actual data transmission, the normal transmission has priority and the data contained in the Transmit Sync Holding Register is transferred in the Transmit Register, then shifted out.
35.6.5.2
Frame Sync Edge Detection The Frame Sync Edge detection is programmed by the FSEDGE field in SSC_RFMR/SSC_TFMR. This sets the corresponding flags RXSYN/TXSYN in the SSC Status Register (SSC_SR) on frame synchro edge detection (signals RF/TF). Receive Compare Modes Figure 35-12. Receive Compare Modes
RK
35.6.6
RD (Input)
CMP0
CMP1
CMP2
CMP3 Start
Ignored
B0
B1
B2
FSLEN Up to 16 Bits (4 in This Example)
STDLY
DATLEN
506
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.6.6.1 Compare Functions Length of the comparison patterns (Compare 0, Compare 1) and thus the number of bits they are compared to is defined by FSLEN, but with a maximum value of 16 bits. Comparison is always done by comparing the last bits received with the comparison pattern. Compare 0 can be one start event of the Receiver. In this case, the receiver compares at each new sample the last bits received at the Compare 0 pattern contained in the Compare 0 Register (SSC_RC0R). When this start event is selected, the user can program the Receiver to start a new data transfer either by writing a new Compare 0, or by receiving continuously until Compare 1 occurs. This selection is done with the bit (STOP) in SSC_RCMR. Data Format The data framing format of both the transmitter and the receiver are programmable through the Transmitter Frame Mode Register (SSC_TFMR) and the Receiver Frame Mode Register (SSC_RFMR). In either case, the user can independently select: * the event that starts the data transfer (START) * the delay in number of bit periods between the start event and the first data bit (STTDLY) * the length of the data (DATLEN) * the number of data to be transferred for each start event (DATNB). * the length of synchronization transferred for each start event (FSLEN) * the bit sense: most or lowest significant bit first (MSBF) Additionally, the transmitter can be used to transfer synchronization and select the level driven on the TD pin while not in data transfer operation. This is done respectively by the Frame Sync Data Enable (FSDEN) and by the Data Default Value (DATDEF) bits in SSC_TFMR.
35.6.7
507
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 35-3.
Transmitter SSC_TFMR SSC_TFMR SSC_TFMR SSC_TFMR SSC_TFMR SSC_TFMR SSC_TCMR SSC_TCMR
Data Frame Registers
Receiver SSC_RFMR SSC_RFMR SSC_RFMR SSC_RFMR Field DATLEN DATNB MSBF FSLEN DATDEF FSDEN SSC_RCMR SSC_RCMR PERIOD STTDLY Up to 512 Up to 255 Up to 16 0 or 1 Length Up to 32 Up to 16 Comment Size of word Number of words transmitted in frame Most significant bit first Size of Synchro data register Data default value ended Enable send SSC_TSHR Frame size Size of transmit start delay
Figure 35-13. Transmit and Receive Frame Format in Edge/Pulse Start Modes
Start PERIOD TF/RF
(1)
Start
FSLEN TD (If FSDEN = 1) Sync Data Default Data From SSC_THR Data From SSC_THR Data To SSC_RHR DATLEN Data From SSC_THR Data From SSC_THR Data To SSC_RHR DATLEN Default FromDATDEF Default From DATDEF Ignored Sync Data Sync Data
From SSC_TSHR FromDATDEF Default From DATDEF Sync Data To SSC_RSHR STTDLY Ignored
TD (If FSDEN = 0) RD
DATNB
Note:
1. Example of input on falling edge of TF/RF.
508
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 35-14. Transmit Frame Format in Continuous Mode
Start
TD
Data From SSC_THR DATLEN
Data From SSC_THR DATLEN
Default
Start: 1. TXEMPTY set to 1 2. Write into the SSC_THR
Note:
1. STTDLY is set to 0. In this example, SSC_THR is loaded twice. FSDEN value has no effect on the transmission. SyncData cannot be output in continuous mode.
Figure 35-15. Receive Frame Format in Continuous Mode
Start = Enable Receiver
RD
Data To SSC_RHR DATLEN
Data To SSC_RHR DATLEN
Note:
1. STTDLY is set to 0.
35.6.8
Loop Mode The receiver can be programmed to receive transmissions from the transmitter. This is done by setting the Loop Mode (LOOP) bit in SSC_RFMR. In this case, RD is connected to TD, RF is connected to TF and RK is connected to TK.
35.6.9
Interrupt Most bits in SSC_SR have a corresponding bit in interrupt management registers. The SSC can be programmed to generate an interrupt when it detects an event. The interrupt is controlled by writing SSC_IER (Interrupt Enable Register) and SSC_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register) These registers enable and disable, respectively, the corresponding interrupt by setting and clearing the corresponding bit in SSC_IMR (Interrupt Mask Register), which controls the generation of interrupts by asserting the SSC interrupt line connected to the AIC.
509
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 35-16. Interrupt Block Diagram
SSC_IMR SSC_IER PDC TXBUFE ENDTX Transmitter TXRDY TXEMPTY TXSYNC RXBUFF ENDRX Receiver RXRDY OVRUN RXSYNC Interrupt Control Set SSC_IDR Clear
SSC Interrupt
35.7
SSC Application Examples
The SSC can support several serial communication modes used in audio or high speed serial links. Some standard applications are shown in the following figures. All serial link applications supported by the SSC are not listed here.
Figure 35-17. Audio Application Block Diagram
Clock SCK TK Word Select WS TF Data SD SSC TD RD RF RK I2S RECEIVER
Clock SCK Word Select WS
Data SD
MSB Left Channel
LSB
MSB Right Channel
510
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 35-18. Codec Application Block Diagram
Serial Data Clock (SCLK) TK Frame sync (FSYNC) TF Serial Data Out SSC TD Serial Data In RD RF RK CODEC
Serial Data Clock (SCLK) Frame sync (FSYNC) First Time Slot Dstart Serial Data Out Dend
Serial Data In
Figure 35-19. Time Slot Application Block Diagram
SCLK TK FSYNC TF Data Out TD SSC RD RF RK Data in CODEC First Time Slot
CODEC Second Time Slot
Serial Data Clock (SCLK) Frame sync (FSYNC) Serial Data Out First Time Slot Dstart Second Time Slot Dend
Serial Data in
511
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.8
Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Control Register Clock Mode Register Reserved Reserved Receive Clock Mode Register Receive Frame Mode Register Transmit Clock Mode Register Transmit Frame Mode Register Receive Holding Register Transmit Holding Register Reserved Reserved Receive Sync. Holding Register Transmit Sync. Holding Register Receive Compare 0 Register Receive Compare 1 Register Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved Reserved for Peripheral Data Controller (PDC) Register Name SSC_CR SSC_CMR - - SSC_RCMR SSC_RFMR SSC_TCMR SSC_TFMR SSC_RHR SSC_THR - - SSC_RSHR SSC_TSHR SSC_RC0R SSC_RC1R SSC_SR SSC_IER SSC_IDR SSC_IMR - - Access Write Read/Write - - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read Write - - Read Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read Write Write Read - - Reset - 0x0 - - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 - - - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x000000CC - - 0x0 - -
Table 35-4.
Offset 0x0 0x4 0x8 0xC 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0x30 0x34 0x38 0x3C 0x40 0x44 0x48 0x4C 0x50-0xFC 0x100- 0x124
512
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.1 Name: SSC Control Register SSC_CR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 TXDIS 1 RXDIS 24 - 16 - 8 TXEN 0 RXEN
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 SWRST 7 -
* RXEN: Receive Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables Receive if RXDIS is not set. * RXDIS: Receive Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables Receive. If a character is currently being received, disables at end of current character reception. * TXEN: Transmit Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables Transmit if TXDIS is not set. * TXDIS: Transmit Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables Transmit. If a character is currently being transmitted, disables at end of current character transmission. * SWRST: Software Reset 0: No effect. 1: Performs a software reset. Has priority on any other bit in SSC_CR.
513
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.8.2 Name:
SSC Clock Mode Register SSC_CMR Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 DIV 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 DIV 3 2 1 0 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7
* DIV: Clock Divider 0: The Clock Divider is not active. Any Other Value: The Divided Clock equals the Master Clock divided by 2 times DIV. The maximum bit rate is MCK/2. The minimum bit rate is MCK/2 x 4095 = MCK/8190.
514
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.3 Name: SSC Receive Clock Mode Register SSC_RCMR Read/Write
30 29 28 PERIOD 23 22 21 20 STDDLY 15 - 7 CKG 14 - 6 13 - 5 CKI 12 STOP 4 11 10 START 3 CKO 2 1 CKS 0 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
* CKS: Receive Clock Selection
CKS 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Selected Receive Clock Divided Clock TK Clock signal RK pin Reserved
* CKO: Receive Clock Output Mode Selection
CKO 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3-0x7 Receive Clock Output Mode None Continuous Receive Clock Receive Clock only during data transfers Reserved RK Pin Input-only Output Output
* CKI: Receive Clock Inversion 0: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock falling edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock rising edge. 1: The data inputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are sampled on Receive Clock rising edge. The Frame Sync signal output is shifted out on Receive Clock falling edge. CKI affects only the Receive Clock and not the output clock signal.
515
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* CKG: Receive Clock Gating Selection
CKG 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Receive Clock Gating None, continuous clock Receive Clock enabled only if RF Low Receive Clock enabled only if RF High Reserved
* START: Receive Start Selection
START 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9-0xF Receive Start Continuous, as soon as the receiver is enabled, and immediately after the end of transfer of the previous data. Transmit start Detection of a low level on RF signal Detection of a high level on RF signal Detection of a falling edge on RF signal Detection of a rising edge on RF signal Detection of any level change on RF signal Detection of any edge on RF signal Compare 0 Reserved
* STOP: Receive Stop Selection 0: After completion of a data transfer when starting with a Compare 0, the receiver stops the data transfer and waits for a new compare 0. 1: After starting a receive with a Compare 0, the receiver operates in a continuous mode until a Compare 1 is detected. * STTDLY: Receive Start Delay If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of reception. When the Receiver is programmed to start synchronously with the Transmitter, the delay is also applied. Note: It is very important that STTDLY be set carefully. If STTDLY must be set, it should be done in relation to TAG (Receive Sync Data) reception. * PERIOD: Receive Period Divider Selection This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Receive Clock in order to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no PERIOD signal is generated. If not 0, a PERIOD signal is generated each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Receive Clock.
516
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.4 Name: SSC Receive Frame Mode Register SSC_RFMR Read/Write
30 FSLEN_EXT 22 29 FSLEN_EXT 21 FSOS 13 - 5 LOOP 28
FSLEN_EXT
Access Type:
31 FSLEN_EXT 23 - 15 - 7 MSBF
27 - 19
26 - 18 FSLEN
25 - 17
24 FSEDGE 16
20
14 - 6 -
12 - 4
11
10 DATNB
9
8
3
2 DATLEN
1
0
* DATLEN: Data Length 0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported). Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the PDC2 assigned to the Receiver. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are in bytes. If DATLEN is between 8 and 15 (included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred. * LOOP: Loop Mode 0: Normal operating mode. 1: RD is driven by TD, RF is driven by TF and TK drives RK. * MSBF: Most Significant Bit First 0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream. 1: The most significant bit of the data register is sampled first in the bit stream. * DATNB: Data Number per Frame This field defines the number of data words to be received after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB + 1). * FSLEN: Receive Frame Sync Length This field defines the number of bits sampled and stored in the Receive Sync Data Register. When this mode is selected by the START field in the Receive Clock Mode Register, it also determines the length of the sampled data to be compared to the Compare 0 or Compare 1 register. This field is used with FSLEN_EXT to determine the pulse length of the Receive Frame Sync signal. Pulse length is equal to FSLEN + (FSLEN_EXT * 16) + 1 Receive Clock periods.
517
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* FSOS: Receive Frame Sync Output Selection
FSOS 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6-0x7 Selected Receive Frame Sync Signal None Negative Pulse Positive Pulse Driven Low during data transfer Driven High during data transfer Toggling at each start of data transfer Reserved RF Pin Input-only Output Output Output Output Output Undefined
* FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection Determines which edge on Frame Sync will generate the interrupt RXSYN in the SSC Status Register.
FSEDGE 0x0 0x1 Frame Sync Edge Detection Positive Edge Detection Negative Edge Detection
* FSLEN_EXT: FSLEN Field Extension Extends FSLEN field. For details, refer to FSLEN bit description on page 517.
518
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.5 Name: SSC Transmit Clock Mode Register SSC_TCMR Read/Write
30 29 28 PERIOD 23 22 21 20 STTDLY 15 - 7 CKG 14 - 6 13 - 5 CKI 12 - 4 11 10 START 3 CKO 2 1 CKS 0 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
* CKS: Transmit Clock Selection
CKS 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Selected Transmit Clock Divided Clock RK Clock signal TK Pin Reserved
* CKO: Transmit Clock Output Mode Selection
CKO 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3-0x7 Transmit Clock Output Mode None Continuous Transmit Clock Transmit Clock only during data transfers Reserved TK pin Input-only Output Output
* CKI: Transmit Clock Inversion 0: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock falling edge. The Frame sync signal input is sampled on Transmit clock rising edge. 1: The data outputs (Data and Frame Sync signals) are shifted out on Transmit Clock rising edge. The Frame sync signal input is sampled on Transmit clock falling edge. CKI affects only the Transmit Clock and not the output clock signal.
519
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* CKG: Transmit Clock Gating Selection
CKG 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Transmit Clock Gating None, continuous clock Transmit Clock enabled only if TF Low Transmit Clock enabled only if TF High Reserved
* START: Transmit Start Selection
START 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 - 0xF Transmit Start Continuous, as soon as a word is written in the SSC_THR Register (if Transmit is enabled), and immediately after the end of transfer of the previous data. Receive start Detection of a low level on TF signal Detection of a high level on TF signal Detection of a falling edge on TF signal Detection of a rising edge on TF signal Detection of any level change on TF signal Detection of any edge on TF signal Reserved
* STTDLY: Transmit Start Delay If STTDLY is not 0, a delay of STTDLY clock cycles is inserted between the start event and the actual start of transmission of data. When the Transmitter is programmed to start synchronously with the Receiver, the delay is also applied. Note: STTDLY must be set carefully. If STTDLY is too short in respect to TAG (Transmit Sync Data) emission, data is emitted instead of the end of TAG. * PERIOD: Transmit Period Divider Selection This field selects the divider to apply to the selected Transmit Clock to generate a new Frame Sync Signal. If 0, no period signal is generated. If not 0, a period signal is generated at each 2 x (PERIOD+1) Transmit Clock.
520
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.6 Name: SSC Transmit Frame Mode Register SSC_TFMR Read/Write
30 FSLEN_EXT 22 29 FSLEN_EXT 21 FSOS 13 - 5 DATDEF 28
FSLEN_EXT
Access Type:
31 FSLEN_EXT 23 FSDEN 15 - 7 MSBF
27 - 19
26 - 18 FSLEN
25 - 17
24 FSEDGE 16
20
14 - 6 -
12 - 4
11
10 DATNB
9
8
3
2 DATLEN
1
0
* DATLEN: Data Length 0: Forbidden value (1-bit data length not supported). Any other value: The bit stream contains DATLEN + 1 data bits. Moreover, it defines the transfer size performed by the PDC2 assigned to the Transmit. If DATLEN is lower or equal to 7, data transfers are bytes, if DATLEN is between 8 and 15 (included), half-words are transferred, and for any other value, 32-bit words are transferred. * DATDEF: Data Default Value This bit defines the level driven on the TD pin while out of transmission. Note that if the pin is defined as multi-drive by the PIO Controller, the pin is enabled only if the SCC TD output is 1. * MSBF: Most Significant Bit First 0: The lowest significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream. 1: The most significant bit of the data register is shifted out first in the bit stream. * DATNB: Data Number per frame This field defines the number of data words to be transferred after each transfer start, which is equal to (DATNB +1). * FSLEN: Transmit Frame Sync Length This field defines the length of the Transmit Frame Sync signal and the number of bits shifted out from the Transmit Sync Data Register if FSDEN is 1. This field is used with FSLEN_EXT to determine the pulse length of the Transmit Frame Sync signal. Pulse length is equal to FSLEN + (FSLEN_EXT * 16) + 1 Transmit Clock periods.
521
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* FSOS: Transmit Frame Sync Output Selection
FSOS 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6-0x7 Selected Transmit Frame Sync Signal None Negative Pulse Positive Pulse Driven Low during data transfer Driven High during data transfer Toggling at each start of data transfer Reserved TF Pin Input-only Output Output Output Output Output Undefined
* FSDEN: Frame Sync Data Enable 0: The TD line is driven with the default value during the Transmit Frame Sync signal. 1: SSC_TSHR value is shifted out during the transmission of the Transmit Frame Sync signal. * FSEDGE: Frame Sync Edge Detection Determines which edge on frame sync will generate the interrupt TXSYN (Status Register).
FSEDGE 0x0 0x1 Frame Sync Edge Detection Positive Edge Detection Negative Edge Detection
* FSLEN_EXT: FSLEN Field Extension Extends FSLEN field. For details, refer to FSLEN bit description on page 521.
522
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.7 Name: SSC Receive Holding Register SSC_RHR Read-only
30 29 28 RDAT 23 22 21 20 RDAT 15 14 13 12 RDAT 7 6 5 4 RDAT 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
* RDAT: Receive Data Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_RFMR.
35.8.8 Name:
SSC Transmit Holding Register SSC_THR Write-only
30 29 28 TDAT 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
20 TDAT
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 TDAT
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 TDAT
3
2
1
0
* TDAT: Transmit Data Right aligned regardless of the number of data bits defined by DATLEN in SSC_TFMR.
523
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.8.9 Name:
SSC Receive Synchronization Holding Register SSC_RSHR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RSDAT 7 6 5 4 RSDAT 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
* RSDAT: Receive Synchronization Data
35.8.10 Name:
SSC Transmit Synchronization Holding Register SSC_TSHR Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 TSDAT 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
7
6
5
4 TSDAT
3
2
1
0
* TSDAT: Transmit Synchronization Data
524
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.11 Name: SSC Receive Compare 0 Register SSC_RC0R Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 CP0 7 6 5 4 CP0 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
* CP0: Receive Compare Data 0
525
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.8.12 Name:
SSC Receive Compare 1 Register SSC_RC1R Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 CP1 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
7
6
5
4 CP1
3
2
1
0
* CP1: Receive Compare Data 1
526
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.13 Name: SSC Status Register SSC_SR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 ENDRX 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 RXSYN 3 TXBUFE 26 - 18 - 10 TXSYN 2 ENDTX 25 - 17 RXEN 9 CP1 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 TXEN 8 CP0 0 TXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 RXBUFF
* TXRDY: Transmit Ready 0: Data has been loaded in SSC_THR and is waiting to be loaded in the Transmit Shift Register (TSR). 1: SSC_THR is empty. * TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty 0: Data remains in SSC_THR or is currently transmitted from TSR. 1: Last data written in SSC_THR has been loaded in TSR and last data loaded in TSR has been transmitted. * ENDTX: End of Transmission 0: The register SSC_TCR has not reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR. 1: The register SSC_TCR has reached 0 since the last write in SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR. * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty 0: SSC_TCR or SSC_TNCR have a value other than 0. 1: Both SSC_TCR and SSC_TNCR have a value of 0. * RXRDY: Receive Ready 0: SSC_RHR is empty. 1: Data has been received and loaded in SSC_RHR. * OVRUN: Receive Overrun 0: No data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not been read since the last read of the Status Register. 1: Data has been loaded in SSC_RHR while previous data has not yet been read since the last read of the Status Register. * ENDRX: End of Reception 0: Data is written on the Receive Counter Register or Receive Next Counter Register. 1: End of PDC transfer when Receive Counter Register has arrived at zero. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full 0: SSC_RCR or SSC_RNCR have a value other than 0.
527
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1: Both SSC_RCR and SSC_RNCR have a value of 0. * CP0: Compare 0 0: A compare 0 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A compare 0 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * CP1: Compare 1 0: A compare 1 has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A compare 1 has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * TXSYN: Transmit Sync 0: A Tx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: A Tx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * RXSYN: Receive Sync 0: An Rx Sync has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1: An Rx Sync has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * TXEN: Transmit Enable 0: Transmit is disabled. 1: Transmit is enabled. * RXEN: Receive Enable 0: Receive is disabled. 1: Receive is enabled.
528
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.14 Name: SSC Interrupt Enable Register SSC_IER Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 ENDRX 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 RXSYN 3 TXBUFE 26 - 18 - 10 TXSYN 2 ENDTX 25 - 17 - 9 CP1 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 CP0 0 TXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 RXBUFF
* TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Ready Interrupt. * TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Empty Interrupt. * ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the End of Transmission Interrupt. * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt * RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Receive Ready Interrupt. * OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Receive Overrun Interrupt. * ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the End of Reception Interrupt. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable 0: No effect.
529
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1: Enables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt.
* CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Compare 0 Interrupt. * CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Compare 1 Interrupt. * TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Tx Sync Interrupt. * RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Enables the Rx Sync Interrupt.
530
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.15 Name: SSC Interrupt Disable Register SSC_IDR Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 ENDRX 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 RXSYN 3 TXBUFE 26 - 18 - 10 TXSYN 2 ENDTX 25 - 17 - 9 CP1 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 CP0 0 TXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 RXBUFF
* TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Ready Interrupt. * TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Empty Interrupt. * ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the End of Transmission Interrupt. * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt. * RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Receive Ready Interrupt. * OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Receive Overrun Interrupt. * ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the End of Reception Interrupt. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable 0: No effect.
531
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1: Disables the Receive Buffer Full Interrupt.
* CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Compare 0 Interrupt. * CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Disable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Compare 1 Interrupt. * TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Tx Sync Interrupt. * RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Enable 0: No effect. 1: Disables the Rx Sync Interrupt.
532
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
35.8.16 Name: SSC Interrupt Mask Register SSC_IMR Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 ENDRX 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 RXSYN 3 TXBUFE 26 - 18 - 10 TXSYN 2 ENDTX 25 - 17 - 9 CP1 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 CP0 0 TXRDY
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 RXBUF
* TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Ready Interrupt is enabled. * TXEMPTY: Transmit Empty Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Empty Interrupt is enabled. * ENDTX: End of Transmission Interrupt Mask 0: The End of Transmission Interrupt is disabled. 1: The End of Transmission Interrupt is enabled. * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask 0: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt is enabled. * RXRDY: Receive Ready Interrupt Mask 0: The Receive Ready Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Receive Ready Interrupt is enabled. * OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Mask 0: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Receive Overrun Interrupt is enabled. * ENDRX: End of Reception Interrupt Mask 0: The End of Reception Interrupt is disabled. 1: The End of Reception Interrupt is enabled. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask 0: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is disabled.
533
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1: The Receive Buffer Full Interrupt is enabled.
* CP0: Compare 0 Interrupt Mask 0: The Compare 0 Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Compare 0 Interrupt is enabled. * CP1: Compare 1 Interrupt Mask 0: The Compare 1 Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Compare 1 Interrupt is enabled. * TXSYN: Tx Sync Interrupt Mask 0: The Tx Sync Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Tx Sync Interrupt is enabled. * RXSYN: Rx Sync Interrupt Mask 0: The Rx Sync Interrupt is disabled. 1: The Rx Sync Interrupt is enabled.
534
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36. Timer Counter (TC)
36.1 Description
The Timer Counter (TC) includes three identical 16-bit Timer Counter channels. Each channel can be independently programmed to perform a wide range of functions including frequency measurement, event counting, interval measurement, pulse generation, delay timing and pulse width modulation. Each channel has three external clock inputs, five internal clock inputs and two multi-purpose input/output signals which can be configured by the user. Each channel drives an internal interrupt signal which can be programmed to generate processor interrupts. The Timer Counter block has two global registers which act upon all three TC channels. The Block Control Register allows the three channels to be started simultaneously with the same instruction. The Block Mode Register defines the external clock inputs for each channel, allowing them to be chained. Table 36-1 gives the assignment of the device Timer Counter clock inputs common to Timer Counter 0 to 2
Table 36-1.
Name
Timer Counter Clock Assignment
Definition MCK/2 MCK/8 MCK/32 MCK/128 SLCK
TIMER_CLOCK1 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5
535
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.2
Block Diagram
Figure 36-1. Timer Counter Block Diagram
Parallel I/O Controller TCLK0
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIMER_CLOCK1
TIOA1
TIMER_CLOCK3
TCLK0 TCLK1 TCLK2 TIOA0 TIOB0
TIOA2 TCLK1
XC0 XC1 XC2 TC0XC0S
Timer/Counter Channel 0
TIOA
TIOA0
TIOB
TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5
TCLK2
TIOB0
SYNC
INT0
TCLK0 TCLK1 TIOA0 TIOA2 TCLK2 XC0 XC1 XC2 TC1XC1S
SYNC
Timer/Counter Channel 1
TIOA
TIOA1
TIOB
TIOB1 INT1
TIOA1 TIOB1
TCLK0 TCLK1 TCLK2 TIOA0 TIOA1
XC0 XC1 XC2 TC2XC2S
Timer/Counter Channel 2
TIOA
TIOA2
TIOB
TIOB2
SYNC
TIOA2 TIOB2
INT2
Timer Counter Advanced Interrupt Controller
Table 36-2.
Signal Name Description
Signal Name XC0, XC1, XC2 TIOA Description External Clock Inputs Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Output Capture Mode: Timer Counter Input Waveform Mode: Timer Counter Input/Output Interrupt Signal Output Synchronization Input Signal
Block/Channel
Channel Signal
TIOB INT SYNC
536
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.3 Pin Name List
Table 36-3.
Pin Name TCLK0-TCLK2 TIOA0-TIOA2 TIOB0-TIOB2
TC Pin List
Description External Clock Input I/O Line A I/O Line B Type Input I/O I/O
36.4
36.4.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the TC pins to their peripheral functions.
36.4.2
Power Management The TC is clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), thus the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the Timer Counter clock. Interrupt The TC has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the TC interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the TC.
36.4.3
537
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.5
36.5.1
Functional Description
TC Description The three channels of the Timer Counter are independent and identical in operation. The registers for channel programming are listed in Table 36-5 on page 551. 16-bit Counter Each channel is organized around a 16-bit counter. The value of the counter is incremented at each positive edge of the selected clock. When the counter has reached the value 0xFFFF and passes to 0x0000, an overflow occurs and the COVFS bit in TC_SR (Status Register) is set. The current value of the counter is accessible in real time by reading the Counter Value Register, TC_CV. The counter can be reset by a trigger. In this case, the counter value passes to 0x0000 on the next valid edge of the selected clock.
36.5.2
36.5.3
Clock Selection At block level, input clock signals of each channel can either be connected to the external inputs TCLK0, TCLK1 or TCLK2, or be connected to the internal I/O signals TIOA0, TIOA1 or TIOA2 for chaining by programming the TC_BMR (Block Mode). See Figure 36-2 on page 539. Each channel can independently select an internal or external clock source for its counter: * Internal clock signals: TIMER_CLOCK1, TIMER_CLOCK2, TIMER_CLOCK3, TIMER_CLOCK4, TIMER_CLOCK5 * External clock signals: XC0, XC1 or XC2 This selection is made by the TCCLKS bits in the TC Channel Mode Register. The selected clock can be inverted with the CLKI bit in TC_CMR. This allows counting on the opposite edges of the clock. The burst function allows the clock to be validated when an external signal is high. The BURST parameter in the Mode Register defines this signal (none, XC0, XC1, XC2). See Figure 36-3 on page 539
Note: In all cases, if an external clock is used, the duration of each of its levels must be longer than the master clock period. The external clock frequency must be at least 2.5 times lower than the master clock
538
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 36-2. Clock Chaining Selection
TC0XC0S Timer/Counter Channel 0 TIOA1 TIOA2 XC0 XC1 = TCLK1 XC2 = TCLK2 TIOB0 TIOA0
TCLK0
SYNC
TC1XC1S Timer/Counter Channel 1 TCLK1 TIOA0 TIOA2 XC0 = TCLK2 XC1 XC2 = TCLK2 TIOB1 TIOA1
SYNC
TC2XC2S
Timer/Counter Channel 2 XC0 = TCLK0 TIOA2
TCLK2 TIOA0 TIOA1
XC1 = TCLK1 XC2 TIOB2
SYNC
Figure 36-3. Clock Selection
TCCLKS TIMER_CLOCK1 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5 XC0 XC1 XC2 CLKI
Selected Clock
BURST
1
539
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.5.4
Clock Control The clock of each counter can be controlled in two different ways: it can be enabled/disabled and started/stopped. See Figure 36-4. * The clock can be enabled or disabled by the user with the CLKEN and the CLKDIS commands in the Control Register. In Capture Mode it can be disabled by an RB load event if LDBDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. In Waveform Mode, it can be disabled by an RC Compare event if CPCDIS is set to 1 in TC_CMR. When disabled, the start or the stop actions have no effect: only a CLKEN command in the Control Register can re-enable the clock. When the clock is enabled, the CLKSTA bit is set in the Status Register. * The clock can also be started or stopped: a trigger (software, synchro, external or compare) always starts the clock. The clock can be stopped by an RB load event in Capture Mode (LDBSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) or a RC compare event in Waveform Mode (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR). The start and the stop commands have effect only if the clock is enabled.
Figure 36-4. Clock Control
Selected Clock Trigger
CLKSTA
CLKEN
CLKDIS
Q Q S R
S R
Counter Clock
Stop Event
Disable Event
36.5.5
TC Operating Modes Each channel can independently operate in two different modes: * Capture Mode provides measurement on signals. * Waveform Mode provides wave generation. The TC Operating Mode is programmed with the WAVE bit in the TC Channel Mode Register. In Capture Mode, TIOA and TIOB are configured as inputs. In Waveform Mode, TIOA is always configured to be an output and TIOB is an output if it is not selected to be the external trigger.
36.5.6
Trigger A trigger resets the counter and starts the counter clock. Three types of triggers are common to both modes, and a fourth external trigger is available to each mode. The following triggers are common to both modes:
540
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* Software Trigger: Each channel has a software trigger, available by setting SWTRG in TC_CCR. * SYNC: Each channel has a synchronization signal SYNC. When asserted, this signal has the same effect as a software trigger. The SYNC signals of all channels are asserted simultaneously by writing TC_BCR (Block Control) with SYNC set. * Compare RC Trigger: RC is implemented in each channel and can provide a trigger when the counter value matches the RC value if CPCTRG is set in TC_CMR. The channel can also be configured to have an external trigger. In Capture Mode, the external trigger signal can be selected between TIOA and TIOB. In Waveform Mode, an external event can be programmed on one of the following signals: TIOB, XC0, XC1 or XC2. This external event can then be programmed to perform a trigger by setting ENETRG in TC_CMR. If an external trigger is used, the duration of the pulses must be longer than the master clock period in order to be detected. Regardless of the trigger used, it will be taken into account at the following active edge of the selected clock. This means that the counter value can be read differently from zero just after a trigger, especially when a low frequency signal is selected as the clock. 36.5.7 Capture Operating Mode This mode is entered by clearing the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register). Capture Mode allows the TC channel to perform measurements such as pulse timing, frequency, period, duty cycle and phase on TIOA and TIOB signals which are considered as inputs. Figure 36-5 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Capture Mode. 36.5.8 Capture Registers A and B Registers A and B (RA and RB) are used as capture registers. This means that they can be loaded with the counter value when a programmable event occurs on the signal TIOA. The LDRA parameter in TC_CMR defines the TIOA edge for the loading of register A, and the LDRB parameter defines the TIOA edge for the loading of Register B. RA is loaded only if it has not been loaded since the last trigger or if RB has been loaded since the last loading of RA. RB is loaded only if RA has been loaded since the last trigger or the last loading of RB. Loading RA or RB before the read of the last value loaded sets the Overrun Error Flag (LOVRS) in TC_SR (Status Register). In this case, the old value is overwritten. 36.5.9 Trigger Conditions In addition to the SYNC signal, the software trigger and the RC compare trigger, an external trigger can be defined. The ABETRG bit in TC_CMR selects TIOA or TIOB input signal as an external trigger. The ETRGEDG parameter defines the edge (rising, falling or both) detected to generate an external trigger. If ETRGEDG = 0 (none), the external trigger is disabled.
541
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 36-5. Capture Mode
542
TCCLKS CLKI CLKSTA CLKEN CLKDIS
TIMER_CLOCK1
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIMER_CLOCK3
TIMER_CLOCK4
Q Q R S R
S
TIMER_CLOCK5
XC0
XC1 LDBSTOP BURST LDBDIS
XC2
Register C
1 16-bit Counter CLK OVF RESET Trig ABETRG ETRGEDG Edge Detector LDRA LDRB CPCTRG
Capture Register A SWTRG
Capture Register B
Compare RC =
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
CPCS LOVRS LDRAS LDRBS ETRGS COVFS TC1_SR
SYNC
MTIOB
TIOB
MTIOA If RA is not loaded or RB is Loaded
Edge Detector If RA is Loaded
Edge Detector
TC1_IMR
TIOA
Timer/Counter Channel
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
INT
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.5.10 Waveform Operating Mode Waveform operating mode is entered by setting the WAVE parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register). In Waveform Operating Mode the TC channel generates 1 or 2 PWM signals with the same frequency and independently programmable duty cycles, or generates different types of one-shot or repetitive pulses. In this mode, TIOA is configured as an output and TIOB is defined as an output if it is not used as an external event (EEVT parameter in TC_CMR). Figure 36-6 shows the configuration of the TC channel when programmed in Waveform Operating Mode. 36.5.11 Waveform Selection Depending on the WAVSEL parameter in TC_CMR (Channel Mode Register), the behavior of TC_CV varies. With any selection, RA, RB and RC can all be used as compare registers. RA Compare is used to control the TIOA output, RB Compare is used to control the TIOB output (if correctly configured) and RC Compare is used to control TIOA and/or TIOB outputs.
543
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 36-6. Waveform Mode
BURST Register A WAVSEL Register B Register C
ASWTRG Compare RA = Compare RB = Compare RC =
1
16-bit Counter
CLK RESET OVF
SWTRG
BCPC Trig BCPB WAVSEL EEVT BEEVT EEVTEDG TC1_SR ENETRG Edge Detector CPCS CPAS CPBS ETRGS COVFS MTIOB
TIOB TC1_IMR
BSWTRG
Timer/Counter Channel
INT
Output Controller
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
TCCLKS CLKSTA ACPC CLKI CLKEN CLKDIS
SYNC
Output Controller
544
Q
CPCDIS
TIMER_CLOCK1
TIMER_CLOCK2
TIMER_CLOCK3
TIMER_CLOCK4
S R
ACPA MTIOA
TIMER_CLOCK5
Q R
CPCSTOP
S
XC0
XC1
XC2
AEEVT
TIOA
TIOB
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.5.11.1 WAVSEL = 00 When WAVSEL = 00, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF has been reached, the value of TC_CV is reset. Incrementation of TC_CV starts again and the cycle continues. See Figure 36-7. An external event trigger or a software trigger can reset the value of TC_CV. It is important to note that the trigger may occur at any time. See Figure 36-8. RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration. At the same time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR). Figure 36-7. WAVSEL= 00 without trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF
RC RB
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
545
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 36-8. WAVSEL= 00 with trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by trigger Counter cleared by compare match with 0xFFFF
RC RB
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
36.5.11.2
WAVSEL = 10 When WAVSEL = 10, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to the value of RC, then automatically reset on a RC Compare. Once the value of TC_CV has been reset, it is then incremented and so on. See Figure 36-9. It is important to note that TC_CV can be reset at any time by an external event or a software trigger if both are programmed correctly. See Figure 36-10. In addition, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1 in TC_CMR) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1 in TC_CMR).
Figure 36-9. WAVSEL = 10 Without Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by compare match with RC RC RB
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
546
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 36-10. WAVSEL = 10 With Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter cleared by compare match with RC RC RB Counter cleared by trigger
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
36.5.11.3
WAVSEL = 01 When WAVSEL = 01, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to 0xFFFF. Once 0xFFFF is reached, the value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to 0xFFFF and so on. See Figure 36-11. A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 36-12. RC Compare cannot be programmed to generate a trigger in this configuration. At the same time, RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1).
547
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 36-11. WAVSEL = 01 Without Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF
RC RB
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
Figure 36-12. WAVSEL = 01 With Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by trigger RC RB Counter decremented by compare match with 0xFFFF
Counter incremented by trigger
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
36.5.11.4
WAVSEL = 11 When WAVSEL = 11, the value of TC_CV is incremented from 0 to RC. Once RC is reached, the value of TC_CV is decremented to 0, then re-incremented to RC and so on. See Figure 36-13. A trigger such as an external event or a software trigger can modify TC_CV at any time. If a trigger occurs while TC_CV is incrementing, TC_CV then decrements. If a trigger is received while TC_CV is decrementing, TC_CV then increments. See Figure 36-14. RC Compare can stop the counter clock (CPCSTOP = 1) and/or disable the counter clock (CPCDIS = 1).
548
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 36-13. WAVSEL = 11 Without Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by compare match with RC RC RB
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
Figure 36-14. WAVSEL = 11 With Trigger
Counter Value 0xFFFF Counter decremented by compare match with RC RC RB Counter decremented by trigger Counter incremented by trigger
RA
Waveform Examples TIOB
Time
TIOA
549
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.5.12
External Event/Trigger Conditions An external event can be programmed to be detected on one of the clock sources (XC0, XC1, XC2) or TIOB. The external event selected can then be used as a trigger. The EEVT parameter in TC_CMR selects the external trigger. The EEVTEDG parameter defines the trigger edge for each of the possible external triggers (rising, falling or both). If EEVTEDG is cleared (none), no external event is defined. If TIOB is defined as an external event signal (EEVT = 0), TIOB is no longer used as an output and the compare register B is not used to generate waveforms and subsequently no IRQs. In this case the TC channel can only generate a waveform on TIOA. When an external event is defined, it can be used as a trigger by setting bit ENETRG in TC_CMR. As in Capture Mode, the SYNC signal and the software trigger are also available as triggers. RC Compare can also be used as a trigger depending on the parameter WAVSEL.
36.5.13
Output Controller The output controller defines the output level changes on TIOA and TIOB following an event. TIOB control is used only if TIOB is defined as output (not as an external event). The following events control TIOA and TIOB: software trigger, external event and RC compare. RA compare controls TIOA and RB compare controls TIOB. Each of these events can be programmed to set, clear or toggle the output as defined in the corresponding parameter in TC_CMR.
550
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6 Timer Counter (TC) User Interface
TC Global Memory Map
Channel/Register TC Channel 0 TC Channel 1 TC Channel 2 TC Block Control Register TC Block Mode Register TC_BCR TC_BMR Name Access See Table 36-5 See Table 36-5 See Table 36-5 Write-only Read/Write - 0 Reset Value
Table 36-4.
Offset 0x00 0x40 0x80 0xC0 0xC4
TC_BCR (Block Control Register) and TC_BMR (Block Mode Register) control the whole TC block. TC channels are controlled by the registers listed in Table 36-5. The offset of each of the channel registers in Table 36-5 is in relation to the offset of the corresponding channel as mentioned in Table 36-5.
Table 36-5.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0xFC Notes:
TC Channel Memory Map
Register Channel Control Register Channel Mode Register Reserved Reserved Counter Value Register A Register B Register C Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved TC_CV TC_RA TC_RB TC_RC TC_SR TC_IER TC_IDR TC_IMR - Read-only Read/Write(1) Read/Write
(1)
Name TC_CCR TC_CMR
Access Write-only Read/Write
Reset Value - 0 - - 0 0 0 0 0 - - 0 -
Read/Write Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only -
1. Read-only if WAVE = 0
551
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.1 TC Block Control Register Register Name: TC_BCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 SYNC
* SYNC: Synchro Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Asserts the SYNC signal which generates a software trigger simultaneously for each of the channels.
552
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.2 TC Block Mode Register Register Name: TC_BMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 TC2XC2S 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 TCXC1S 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 TC0XC0S 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* TC0XC0S: External Clock Signal 0 Selection
TC0XC0S 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Signal Connected to XC0 TCLK0 none TIOA1 TIOA2
* TC1XC1S: External Clock Signal 1 Selection
TC1XC1S 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Signal Connected to XC1 TCLK1 none TIOA0 TIOA2
* TC2XC2S: External Clock Signal 2 Selection
TC2XC2S 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Signal Connected to XC2 TCLK2 none TIOA0 TIOA1
553
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.3 TC Channel Control Register Register Name: TC_CCR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 SWTRG 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CLKDIS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CLKEN
* CLKEN: Counter Clock Enable Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the clock if CLKDIS is not 1. * CLKDIS: Counter Clock Disable Command 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the clock. * SWTRG: Software Trigger Command 0 = No effect. 1 = A software trigger is performed: the counter is reset and the clock is started.
554
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.4 TC Channel Mode Register: Capture Mode Register Name: TC_CMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 WAVE = 0 7 LDBDIS
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 CPCTRG 6 LDBSTOP 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 BURST 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 11 - 3 CLKI 27 - 19 LDRB 10 ABETRG 2 1 TCCLKS 9 ETRGEDG 0 26 - 18 25 - 17 LDRA 8 24 - 16
* TCCLKS: Clock Selection
TCCLKS 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Clock Selected TIMER_CLOCK1 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5 XC0 XC1 XC2
* CLKI: Clock Invert 0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock. 1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock. * BURST: Burst Signal Selection
BURST 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 The clock is not gated by an external signal. XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock. XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock. XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock.
* LDBSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RB Loading 0 = Counter clock is not stopped when RB loading occurs. 1 = Counter clock is stopped when RB loading occurs. * LDBDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RB Loading 0 = Counter clock is not disabled when RB loading occurs. 1 = Counter clock is disabled when RB loading occurs. 555
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* ETRGEDG: External Trigger Edge Selection
ETRGEDG 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Edge none rising edge falling edge each edge
* ABETRG: TIOA or TIOB External Trigger Selection 0 = TIOB is used as an external trigger. 1 = TIOA is used as an external trigger. * CPCTRG: RC Compare Trigger Enable 0 = RC Compare has no effect on the counter and its clock. 1 = RC Compare resets the counter and starts the counter clock. * WAVE 0 = Capture Mode is enabled. 1 = Capture Mode is disabled (Waveform Mode is enabled). * LDRA: RA Loading Selection
LDRA 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Edge none rising edge of TIOA falling edge of TIOA each edge of TIOA
* LDRB: RB Loading Selection
LDRB 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Edge none rising edge of TIOA falling edge of TIOA each edge of TIOA
556
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.5 TC Channel Mode Register: Waveform Mode Register Name: TC_CMR Access Type:
31 BSWTRG 23 ASWTRG 15 WAVE = 1 7 CPCDIS 6 CPCSTOP 14 WAVSEL 5 BURST 13 22 21 AEEVT 12 ENETRG 4 3 CLKI 11 EEVT 2 1 TCCLKS
Read/Write
30 29 BEEVT 20 19 ACPC 10 9 EEVTEDG 0 28 27 BCPC 18 17 ACPA 8 26 25 BCPB 16 24
* TCCLKS: Clock Selection
TCCLKS 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Clock Selected TIMER_CLOCK1 TIMER_CLOCK2 TIMER_CLOCK3 TIMER_CLOCK4 TIMER_CLOCK5 XC0 XC1 XC2
* CLKI: Clock Invert 0 = Counter is incremented on rising edge of the clock. 1 = Counter is incremented on falling edge of the clock. * BURST: Burst Signal Selection
BURST 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 The clock is not gated by an external signal. XC0 is ANDed with the selected clock. XC1 is ANDed with the selected clock. XC2 is ANDed with the selected clock.
* CPCSTOP: Counter Clock Stopped with RC Compare 0 = Counter clock is not stopped when counter reaches RC. 1 = Counter clock is stopped when counter reaches RC. * CPCDIS: Counter Clock Disable with RC Compare 0 = Counter clock is not disabled when counter reaches RC. 1 = Counter clock is disabled when counter reaches RC. 557
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* EEVTEDG: External Event Edge Selection
EEVTEDG 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Edge none rising edge falling edge each edge
* EEVT: External Event Selection
EEVT 0 0 1 1 Note: 0 1 0 1 Signal selected as external event TIOB XC0 XC1 XC2 TIOB Direction input (1) output output output
1. If TIOB is chosen as the external event signal, it is configured as an input and no longer generates waveforms and subsequently no IRQs.
* ENETRG: External Event Trigger Enable 0 = The external event has no effect on the counter and its clock. In this case, the selected external event only controls the TIOA output. 1 = The external event resets the counter and starts the counter clock. * WAVSEL: Waveform Selection
WAVSEL 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 Effect UP mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare UP mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare UPDOWN mode without automatic trigger on RC Compare UPDOWN mode with automatic trigger on RC Compare
* WAVE = 1 0 = Waveform Mode is disabled (Capture Mode is enabled). 1 = Waveform Mode is enabled. * ACPA: RA Compare Effect on TIOA
ACPA 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
558
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* ACPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOA
ACPC 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
* AEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOA
AEEVT 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
* ASWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOA
ASWTRG 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
* BCPB: RB Compare Effect on TIOB
BCPB 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
* BCPC: RC Compare Effect on TIOB
BCPC 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
559
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* BEEVT: External Event Effect on TIOB
BEEVT 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
* BSWTRG: Software Trigger Effect on TIOB
BSWTRG 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Effect none set clear toggle
560
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.6 TC Counter Value Register Register Name: TC_CV Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 CV 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 CV
3
2
1
0
* CV: Counter Value CV contains the counter value in real time.
561
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.7 TC Register A Register Name: TC_RA Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read/Write if WAVE = 1
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RA 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 RA
3
2
1
0
* RA: Register A RA contains the Register A value in real time. 36.6.8 TC Register B Register Name: TC_RB Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read-only if WAVE = 0, Read/Write if WAVE = 1
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RB 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 RB
3
2
1
0
* RB: Register B RB contains the Register B value in real time.
562
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.9 TC Register C Register Name: TC_RC Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 RC 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
7
6
5
4 RC
3
2
1
0
* RC: Register C RC contains the Register C value in real time.
563
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.10 TC Status Register Register Name: TC_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 ETRGS
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 LDRBS 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 LDRAS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CPCS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CPBS 26 - 18 MTIOB 10 - 2 CPAS 25 - 17 MTIOA 9 - 1 LOVRS 24 - 16 CLKSTA 8 - 0 COVFS
* COVFS: Counter Overflow Status 0 = No counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = A counter overflow has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * LOVRS: Load Overrun Status 0 = Load overrun has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RA or RB have been loaded at least twice without any read of the corresponding register since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. * CPAS: RA Compare Status 0 = RA Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0. 1 = RA Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1. * CPBS: RB Compare Status 0 = RB Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 0. 1 = RB Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 1. * CPCS: RC Compare Status 0 = RC Compare has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = RC Compare has occurred since the last read of the Status Register. * LDRAS: RA Loading Status 0 = RA Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RA Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. * LDRBS: RB Loading Status 0 = RB Load has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register or WAVE = 1. 1 = RB Load has occurred since the last read of the Status Register, if WAVE = 0. * ETRGS: External Trigger Status 0 = External trigger has not occurred since the last read of the Status Register. 1 = External trigger has occurred since the last read of the Status Register.
564
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* CLKSTA: Clock Enabling Status 0 = Clock is disabled. 1 = Clock is enabled. * MTIOA: TIOA Mirror 0 = TIOA is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven low. 1 = TIOA is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOA pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOA is driven high. * MTIOB: TIOB Mirror 0 = TIOB is low. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is low. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven low. 1 = TIOB is high. If WAVE = 0, this means that TIOB pin is high. If WAVE = 1, this means that TIOB is driven high.
565
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.11 TC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: TC_IER Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 ETRGS
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 LDRBS 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 LDRAS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CPCS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CPBS 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CPAS 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LOVRS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 COVFS
* COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Counter Overflow Interrupt. * LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Load Overrun Interrupt. * CPAS: RA Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RA Compare Interrupt. * CPBS: RB Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RB Compare Interrupt. * CPCS: RC Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RC Compare Interrupt. * LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RA Load Interrupt. * LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the RB Load Interrupt. * ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the External Trigger Interrupt.
566
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
36.6.12 TC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: TC_IDR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 ETRGS
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 LDRBS 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 LDRAS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CPCS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CPBS 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CPAS 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LOVRS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 COVFS
* COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Counter Overflow Interrupt. * LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Load Overrun Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). * CPAS: RA Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RA Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1). * CPBS: RB Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RB Compare Interrupt (if WAVE = 1). * CPCS: RC Compare 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RC Compare Interrupt. * LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RA Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). * LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the RB Load Interrupt (if WAVE = 0). * ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the External Trigger Interrupt. 567
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
36.6.13 TC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: TC_IMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 ETRGS
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 LDRBS 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 LDRAS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CPCS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CPBS 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CPAS 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LOVRS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 COVFS
* COVFS: Counter Overflow 0 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Counter Overflow Interrupt is enabled. * LOVRS: Load Overrun 0 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load Overrun Interrupt is enabled. * CPAS: RA Compare 0 = The RA Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RA Compare Interrupt is enabled. * CPBS: RB Compare 0 = The RB Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RB Compare Interrupt is enabled. * CPCS: RC Compare 0 = The RC Compare Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The RC Compare Interrupt is enabled. * LDRAS: RA Loading 0 = The Load RA Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load RA Interrupt is enabled. * LDRBS: RB Loading 0 = The Load RB Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The Load RB Interrupt is enabled. * ETRGS: External Trigger 0 = The External Trigger Interrupt is disabled. 1 = The External Trigger Interrupt is enabled.
568
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37. DMA Controller (DMAC)
37.1 Description
The DMA Controller (DMAC) is an AHB-central DMA controller core that transfers data from a source peripheral to a destination peripheral over one or more AMBA buses. One channel is required for each source/destination pair. In the most basic configuration, the DMAC has one master interface and one channel. The master interface reads the data from a source and writes it to a destination. Two AMBA transfers are required for each DMAC data transfer. This is also known as a dual-access transfer. The DMAC is programmed via the APB interface.
569
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
37.2
Block Diagram
Figure 37-1. DMA Controller (DMAC) Block Diagram
AMBA AHB Layer 1
DMA AHB Lite Master Interface 1
DMA Global Control and Data Mux
DMA Global Request Arbiter DMA Destination Requests Pool
DMA Write Datapath Bundles
DMA Channel n DMA Destination DMA Channel 2 DMA Channel 1 DMA Channel 0
DMA Channel 0 Write data path to destination
Atmel APB rev2 Interface Status Registers Configuration Registers
DMA Atmel APB Interface
DMA Destination Control State Machine Destination Pointer Management
DMA Interrupt Controller
DMA Interrupt
DMA FIFO Controller
DMA FIFO Up to 64 bytes
DMA Channel 0 Read data path from source
DMA Source Control State Machine Source Pointer Management
DMA Read Datapath Bundles DMA Global Control and Data Mux
DMA Source Requests Pool DMA Global Request Arbiter
DMA AHB Lite Master Interface 0
AMBA AHB Layer 0
570
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.3
37.3.1
Functional Description
Basic Definitions Source peripheral: Device on an AMBA layer from where the DMAC reads data, which is then stored in the channel FIFO. The source peripheral teams up with a destination peripheral to form a channel. Destination peripheral: Device to which the DMAC writes the stored data from the FIFO (previously read from the source peripheral). Memory: Source or destination that is always "ready" for a DMAC transfer and does not require a handshaking interface to interact with the DMAC. Channel: Read/write datapath between a source peripheral on one configured AMBA layer and a destination peripheral on the same or different AMBA layer that occurs through the channel FIFO. Master interface: DMAC is a master on the AHB bus reading data from the source and writing it to the destination over the AHB bus. Slave interface: The APB interface over which the DMAC is programmed. The slave interface in practice could be on the same layer as any of the master interfaces or on a separate layer.
Figure 37-2. DMAC Transfer Hierarchy for Memory
HDMA Transfer
DMA Transfer Level
Buffer
Buffer
Buffer
Buffer Transfer Level
AMBA Burst Transfer
AMBA Burst Transfer
AMBA Burst Transfer
AMBA Single Transfer
AMBA Transfer Level
Buffer: A buffer of DMAC data. The amount of data (length) is determined by the flow controller. For transfers between the DMAC and memory, a buffer is broken directly into a sequence of AMBA bursts and AMBA single transfers.
DMAC transfer: Software controls the number of buffers in a DMAC transfer. Once the DMAC transfer has completed, then hardware within the DMAC disables the channel and can generate an interrupt to signal the completion of the DMAC transfer. You can then re-program the channel for a new DMAC transfer. Single-buffer DMAC transfer: Consists of a single buffer. Multi-buffer DMAC transfer: A DMAC transfer may consist of multiple DMAC buffers. Multi-buffer DMAC transfers are supported through buffer chaining (linked list pointers), auto-reloading of channel registers, and contiguous buffers. The source and destination can independently select which method to use.
571
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- Linked lists (buffer chaining) - A descriptor pointer (DSCR) points to the location in system memory where the next linked list item (LLI) exists. The LLI is a set of registers that describe the next buffer (buffer descriptor) and a descriptor pointer register. The DMAC fetches the LLI at the beginning of every buffer when buffer chaining is enabled. - Replay - The DMAC automatically reloads the channel registers at the end of each buffers to the value when the channel was first enabled. - Contiguous buffers - Where the address of the next buffer is selected to be a continuation from the end of the previous buffer. Picture-in-Picture Mode: DMAC contains a picture-in-picture mode support. When this mode is enabled, addresses are automatically incremented by a programmable value when the DMAC channel transfer count reaches a user defined boundary. Figure 37-3 on page 572 illustrates a memory mapped image 4:2:2 encoded located at image_base_address in memory. A user defined start address is defined at Picture_start_address. The incremented value is set to memory_hole_size = image_width picture_width, and the boundary is set to picture_width. Figure 37-3. Picture-In-Picture Mode Support
Bus locking: Software can program a channel to maintain control of the AMBA bus by asserting hmastlock for the duration of a DMAC transfer. Channel locking is asserted for the duration of bus locking at a minimum. 37.3.2 Memory Peripherals Figure 37-2 on page 571 shows the DMAC transfer hierarchy of the DMAC for a memory peripheral. There is no handshaking interface with the DMAC, and therefore the memory peripheral can never be a flow controller. Once the channel is enabled, the transfer proceeds immediately without waiting for a transaction request. The alternative to not having a transaction-level hand-
572
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
shaking interface is to allow the DMAC to attempt AMBA transfers to the peripheral once the channel is enabled. If the peripheral slave cannot accept these AMBA transfers, it inserts wait states onto the bus until it is ready; it is not recommended that more than 16 wait states be inserted onto the bus. 37.3.3 DMAC Transfer Types A DMAC transfer may consist of single or multi-buffers transfers. On successive buffers of a multi-buffer transfer, the DMAC_SADDRx/DMAC_DADDRx registers in the DMAC are reprogrammed using either of the following methods: * Buffer chaining using linked lists * Replay mode * Contiguous address between buffers On successive buffers of a multi-buffer transfer, the DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx registers in the DMAC are re-programmed using either of the following methods: * Buffer chaining using linked lists * Replay mode When buffer chaining, using linked lists is the multi-buffer method of choice, and on successive buffers, the DMAC_DSCRx register in the DMAC is re-programmed using the following method: * Buffer chaining using linked lists A buffer descriptor (LLI) consists of following registers, DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_DSCRx, DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx.These registers, along with the DMAC_CFGx register, are used by the DMAC to set up and describe the buffer transfer. 37.3.3.1 37.3.3.2 Multi-buffer Transfers Buffer Chaining Using Linked Lists In this case, the DMAC re-programs the channel registers prior to the start of each buffer by fetching the buffer descriptor for that buffer from system memory. This is known as an LLI update. DMAC buffer chaining is supported by using a Descriptor Pointer register (DMAC_DSCRx) that stores the address in memory of the next buffer descriptor. Each buffer descriptor contains the corresponding buffer descriptor (DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_DSCRx, DMAC_CTRLAx DMAC_CTRLBx). To set up buffer chaining, a sequence of linked lists must be programmed in memory. The DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_DSCRx, DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx registers are fetched from system memory on an LLI update. The updated content of the DMAC_CTRLAx register is written back to memory on buffer completion. Figure 37-4 on page 574 shows how to use chained linked lists in memory to define multi-buffer transfers using buffer chaining. The Linked List multi-buffer transfer is initiated by programming DMAC_DSCRx with DSCRx(0) (LLI(0) base address) and DMAC_CTRLBx register with both SRC_DSCR and DST_DSCR set to 0. Other fields and registers are ignored and overwritten when the descriptor is retrieved from memory. The last transfer descriptor must be written to memory with its next descriptor address set to 0.
573
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-4. Multi Buffer Transfer Using Linked List
System Memory LLI(0) DSCRx(1)= DSCRx(0) + 0x10 CTRLBx= DSCRx(0) + 0xC CTRLAx= DSCRx(0) + 0x8 DADDRx= DSCRx(0) + 0x4 SADDRx= DSCRx(0) + 0x0 DSCRx(1) LLI(1) DSCRx(2)= DSCRx(1) + 0x10 CTRLBx= DSCRx(1) + 0xC CTRLBx= DSCRx(1) + 0x8 DADDRx= DSCRx(1) + 0x4 SADDRx= DSCRx(1) + 0x0 DSCRx(2) (points to 0 if LLI(1) is the last transfer descriptor
DSCRx(0)
574
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.3.3.3 Table 37-1. Programming DMAC for Multiple Buffer Transfers Multiple Buffers Transfer Management Table
AUTO 0 SRC_REP - DST_REP - SRC_DSCR 1 DST_DSCR 1 BTSIZE USR SADDR USR DADDR USR Other Fields USR
Transfer Type 1) Single Buffer or Last buffer of a multiple buffer transfer 2) Multi Buffer transfer with contiguous DADDR 3) Multi Buffer transfer with contiguous SADDR 4) Multi Buffer transfer with LLI support 5) Multi Buffer transfer with DADDR reloaded 6) Multi Buffer transfer with SADDR reloaded 7) Multi Buffer transfer with BTSIZE reloaded and contiguous DADDR 8) Multi Buffer transfer with BTSIZE reloaded and contiguous SADDR 9) Automatic mode channel is stalling BTsize is reloaded 10) Automatic mode BTSIZE, SADDR and DADDR reloaded 11) Automatic mode BTSIZE, SADDR reloaded and DADDR contiguous
0 0 0 0 0
- 0 - - 1
0 - - 1 -
0 1 0 0 1
1 0 0 1 0
LLI LLI LLI LLI LLI
LLI CONT LLI LLI REP
CONT LLI LLI REP LLI
LLI LLI LLI LLI LLI
1
-
0
0
1
REP
LLI
CONT
LLI
1
0
-
1
0
REP
CONT
LLI
LLI
1
0
0
1
1
REP
CONT
CONT
REP
1
1
1
1
1
REP
REP
REP
REP
1
1
0
1
1
REP
REP
CONT
REP
Notes:
1. USR means that the register field is manually programmed by the user. 2. CONT means that address are contiguous. 3. REP means that the register field is updated with its previous value. If the transfer is the first one, then the user must manually program the value. 4. Channel stalled is true if the relevant BTC interrupt is not masked. 5. LLI means that the register field is updated with the content of the linked list item.
37.3.3.4
Replay Mode of Channel Registers During automatic replay mode, the channel registers are reloaded with their initial values at the completion of each buffer and the new values used for the new buffer. Depending on the row number in Table 37-1 on page 575, some or all of the DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx channel registers are reloaded from their initial value at the start of a buffer transfer. Contiguous Address Between Buffers In this case, the address between successive buffers is selected to be a continuation from the end of the previous buffer. Enabling the source or destination address to be contiguous between
37.3.3.5
575
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
buffers is a function of DMAC_CTRLAx.SRC_DSCR, DMAC_CFGx.SRC_REP, DMAC_CTRLAx.DST_DSCR and DMAC_CFGx.DST_REP registers. 37.3.3.6 Suspension of Transfers Between buffers At the end of every buffer transfer, an end of buffer interrupt is asserted if: * the channel buffer interrupt is unmasked, DMAC_EBCIMR.BTC[n] = `1', where n is the channel number.
Note: The buffer complete interrupt is generated at the completion of the buffer transfer to the destination.
At the end of a chain of multiple buffers, an end of linked list interrupt is asserted if: * the channel end of chained buffer interrupt is unmasked, DMAC_EBCIMR.CBTC[n] = `1', when n is the channel number. 37.3.3.7 Ending Multi-buffer Transfers All multi-buffer transfers must end as shown in Row 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575. At the end of every buffer transfer, the DMAC samples the row number, and if the DMAC is in Row 1 state, then the previous buffer transferred was the last buffer and the DMAC transfer is terminated. For rows 9, 10 and 11 of Table 37-1 on page 575, (DMAC_DSCRx = 0 and DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO is set), multi-buffer DMAC transfers continue until the automatic mode is disabled by writing a `1' in DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO bit. This bit should be programmed to zero in the end of buffer interrupt service routine that services the next-to-last buffer transfer. This puts the DMAC into Row 1 state. For rows 2, 3, 4, 5, and 6 (DMAC_CRTLBx.AUTO cleared) the user must setup the last buffer descriptor in memory such that both LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx.SRC_DSCR and LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx.DST_DSCR are one and LLI.DMAC_DSCRx is set to 0.
576
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.3.4 Programming a Channel Four registers, the DMAC_DSCRx, the DMAC_CTRLAx, the DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CFGx, need to be programmed to set up whether single or multi-buffer transfers take place, and which type of multi-buffer transfer is used. The different transfer types are shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. The "BTSIZE, SADDR and DADDR" columns indicate where the values of DMAC_SARx, DMAC_DARx, DMAC_CTLx, and DMAC_LLPx are obtained for the next buffer transfer when multi-buffer DMAC transfers are enabled. 37.3.4.1 37.3.4.2 Programming Examples Single-buffer Transfer (Row 1) 1. Read the Channel Handler Status Register DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE Field to choose a free (disabled) channel. 2. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading the interrupt status register, DMAC_EBCISR. 3. Program the following channel registers: a. Write the starting source address in the DMAC_SADDRx register for channel x. b. c. Write the starting destination address in the DMAC_DADDRx register for channel x. Program DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CFGx according to Row 1 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. Program the DMAC_CTRLBx register with both DST_DSCR and SRC_DSCR fields set to one and AUTO field set to 0.
d. Write the control information for the DMAC transfer in the DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx registers for channel x. For example, in the register, you can program the following: - Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field. - Source AHB Master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - Destination AHB Master Interface layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INC field. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination in DST_INC field. e. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. f. If source picture-in-picture mode is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SRC_PIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x.
g. If destination picture-in-picture mode is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DST_PIP is enabled), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x. 4. After the DMAC selected channel has been programmed, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit, where n is the channel number. Make sure that bit 0 of DMAC_EN.ENABLE register is enabled. 5. Once the transfer completes, hardware sets the interrupts and disables the channel. At this time you can either respond to the buffer Complete or Transfer Complete interrupts, or poll for the Channel Handler Status Register (DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n]) bit until it is cleared by hardware, to detect when the transfer is complete.
577
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.3.4.3 Multi-buffer Transfer with Linked List for Source and Linked List for Destination (Row 4) 1. Read the Channel Enable register to choose a free (disabled) channel. 2. Set up the chain of Linked List Items (otherwise known as buffer descriptors) in memory. Write the control information in the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx and LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx registers location of the buffer descriptor for each LLI in memory (see Figure 37-5 on page 579) for channel x. For example, in the register, you can program the following: h. Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - i. Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - ii. Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field. - iii. Source AHB master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - iv. Destination AHB master interface layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - v. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INCR field. - vi. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination DST_INCR field. 3. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. 4. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register locations of all LLI entries in memory (except the last) are set as shown in Row 4 of Table 37-1 on page 575. The LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register of the last Linked List Item must be set as described in Row 1 of Table 37-1. Figure 37-4 on page 574 shows a Linked List example with two list items. 5. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_DSCRx register locations of all LLI entries in memory (except the last) are non-zero and point to the base address of the next Linked List Item. 6. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_SADDRx/LLI.DMAC_DADDRx register locations of all LLI entries in memory point to the start source/destination buffer address preceding that LLI fetch. 7. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE field of the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx register locations of all LLI entries in memory are cleared. 8. If source picture-picture mode is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SRC_PIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x. 9. If destination picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DST_PIP is enabled), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x. 10. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading the status register: DMAC_EBCISR. 11. Program the DMAC_CTRLBx, DMAC_CFGx registers according to Row 4 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. 12. Program the DMAC_DSCRx register with DMAC_DSCRx(0), the pointer to the first Linked List item. 13. Finally, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit, where n is the channel number. The transfer is performed. 14. The DMAC fetches the first LLI from the location pointed to by DMAC_DSCRx(0).
Note: The LLI.DMAC_SADDRx, LLI. DMAC_DADDRx, LLI.DMAC_DSCRx, LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx and LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx registers are fetched. The DMAC automatically reprograms the DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_DSCRx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CTRLAx channel registers from the DMAC_DSCRx(0).
15. Once the buffer of data is transferred, the DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out to system memory at the same location and on the same layer (DMAC_DSCRx.DSCR_IF) where it was originally fetched, that is, the location of the DMAC_CTRLAx register of 578
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
the linked list item fetched prior to the start of the buffer transfer. Only DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out because only the DMAC_CTRLAx.BTSIZE and DMAC_CTRLAX.DONE bits have been updated by DMAC hardware. Additionally, the DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted when the buffer transfer has completed.
Note: Do not poll the DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the DMAC memory map. Instead, poll the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the LLI for that buffer. If the poll LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted, then this buffer transfer has completed. This LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit was cleared at the start of the transfer.
16. The DMAC does not wait for the buffer interrupt to be cleared, but continues fetching the next LLI from the memory location pointed to by current DMAC_DSCRx register and automatically reprograms the DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_DSCRx, DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx channel registers. The DMAC transfer continues until the DMAC determines that the DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_DSCRx registers at the end of a buffer transfer match described in Row 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575. The DMAC then knows that the previous buffer transferred was the last buffer in the DMAC transfer. The DMAC transfer might look like that shown in Figure 37-5 on page 579. Figure 37-5. Multi-buffer with Linked List Address for Source and Destination
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Buffer 2 SADDR(2) DADDR(2)
Buffer 2
Buffer 1 SADDR(1) DADDR(1)
Buffer 1
Buffer 0 SADDR(0) Source Buffers DADDR(0)
Buffer 0
Destination Buffers
If the user needs to execute a DMAC transfer where the source and destination address are contiguous but the amount of data to be transferred is greater than the maximum buffer size DMAC_CTRLAx.BTSIZE, then this can be achieved using the type of multi-buffer transfer as shown in Figure 37-6 on page 580.
579
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-6. Multi-buffer with Linked Address for Source and Destination Buffers are Contiguous
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Buffer 2 DADDR(3) Buffer 2 SADDR(3) Buffer 2 SADDR(2) Buffer 1 SADDR(1) Buffer 0 SADDR(0) Source Buffers Destination Buffers Buffer 0 DADDR(0) Buffer 1 DADDR(1) Buffer 2 DADDR(2)
The DMAC transfer flow is shown in Figure 37-7 on page 581.
580
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-7. DMAC Transfer Flow for Source and Destination Linked List Address
Channel enabled by software
LLI Fetch
Hardware reprograms SADDRx, DADDRx, CTRLA/Bx, DSCRx
DMAC buffer transfer
Writeback of HDMA_CTRLAx register in system memory Buffer Complete interrupt generated here
Is HDMA in Row1 of HDMA State Machine Table?
no
HDMA Transfer Complete interrupt generated here
yes
Channel Disabled by hardware
37.3.4.4
Multi-buffer Transfer with Source Address Auto-reloaded and Destination Address Auto-reloaded (Row 10) 1. Read the Channel Enable register to choose an available (disabled) channel. 2. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading the interrupt status register. Program the following channel registers:
581
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
a. Write the starting source address in the DMAC_SADDRx register for channel x. b. c. Write the starting destination address in the DMAC_DADDRx register for channel x. Program DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CFGx according to Row 10 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. Program the DMAC_DSCRx register with `0'.
d. Write the control information for the DMAC transfer in the DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx register for channel x. For example, in the register, you can program the following: - Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field. - Source AHB master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - Destination AHB master interface layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INCR field. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination in DST_INCR field. e. If source picture-in-picture mode is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x. f. If destination picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DPIP), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x.
g. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. Ensure that the reload bits, DMAC_CFGx.SRC_REP, DMAC_CFGx.DST_REP and DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO are enabled. 3. After the DMAC selected channel has been programmed, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit where is the channel number. Make sure that bit 0 of the DMAC_EN register is enabled. 4. When the buffer transfer has completed, the DMAC reloads the DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_DADDRx and DMAC_CTRLAx registers. Hardware sets the buffer Complete interrupt. The DMAC then samples the row number as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. If the DMAC is in Row 1, then the DMAC transfer has completed. Hardware sets the transfer complete interrupt and disables the channel. So you can either respond to the Buffer Complete or Chained buffer transfer Complete interrupts, or poll for the Channel Enable in the Channel Status Register (DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n]) until it is disabled, to detect when the transfer is complete. If the DMAC is not in Row 1, the next step is performed. 5. The DMAC transfer proceeds as follows: a. If interrupts is un-masked (DMAC_EBCIMR.BTC[x] = `1', where x is the channel number) hardware sets the buffer complete interrupt when the buffer transfer has completed. It then stalls until the STALLED[n] bit of DMAC_CHSR register is cleared by software, writing `1' to DMAC_CHER.KEEPON[n] bit where n is the channel number. If the next buffer is to be the last buffer in the DMAC transfer, then the buffer complete ISR (interrupt service routine) should clear the automatic mode bit in the DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO bit. This put the DMAC into Row 1 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. If the next buffer is not the last buffer in the DMAC transfer, then the reload bits should remain enabled to keep the DMAC in Row 4. b. If the buffer complete interrupt is masked (DMAC_EBCIMR.BTC[x] = `1', where x is the channel number), then hardware does not stall until it detects a write to the buffer complete interrupt enable register DMAC_EBCIER register but starts the next buffer transfer immediately. In this case software must clear the automatic mode bit 582
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
in the DMAC_CTRLB to put the DMAC into ROW 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575 before the last buffer of the DMAC transfer has completed. The transfer is similar to that shown in Figure 37-8 on page 583. The DMAC transfer flow is shown in Figure 37-9 on page 584. Figure 37-8. Multi-buffer DMAC Transfer with Source and Destination Address Auto-reloaded
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Block0 Block1 Block2
SADDR
DADDR
BlockN Source Buffers Destination Buffers
583
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-9. DMAC Transfer Flow for Source and Destination Address Auto-reloaded
Channel Enabled by software
Buffer Transfer
Replay mode for SADDRx, DADDRx, CTRLAx, CTRLBx Buffer Complete interrupt generated here HDMA Transfer Complete Interrupt generated here
yes
Is HDMA in Row1 of HDMA State Machine table?
Channel Disabled by hardware
no
EBCIMR[x]=1?
no
yes
Stall until STALLED is cleared by writing to KEEPON field
37.3.4.5
Multi-buffer Transfer with Source Address Auto-reloaded and Linked List Destination Address (Row 6) 1. Read the Channel Enable register to choose a free (disabled) channel. 2. Set up the chain of linked list items (otherwise known as buffer descriptors) in memory. Write the control information in the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx and DMAC_CTRLBx registers location of the buffer descriptor for each LLI in memory for channel x. For example, in the register you can program the following: c. Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - i. Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - ii. Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field. - iii. Source AHB master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - iv. Destination AHB master interface layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - v. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INCR field. - vi. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination DST_INCR field. 3. Write the starting source address in the DMAC_SADDRx register for channel x.
Note: The values in the LLI.DMAC_SADDRx register locations of each of the Linked List Items (LLIs) setup up in memory, although fetched during a LLI fetch, are not used.
584
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
4. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. 5. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register locations of all LLIs in memory (except the last) are set as shown in Row 6 of Table 37-1 on page 575 while the LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register of the last Linked List item must be set as described in Row 1 of Table 37-1. Figure 37-4 on page 574 shows a Linked List example with two list items. 6. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_DSCRx register locations of all LLIs in memory (except the last) are non-zero and point to the next Linked List Item. 7. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_DADDRx register location of all LLIs in memory point to the start destination buffer address proceeding that LLI fetch. 8. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_CTLx.DONE field of the LLI.DMAC_CTRLA register locations of all LLIs in memory is cleared. 9. If source picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x. 10. If destination picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x. 11. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading to the DMAC_EBCISR register. 12. Program the DMAC_CTLx, DMAC_CFGx registers according to Row 6 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. 13. Program the DMAC_DSCRx register with DMAC_DSCRx(0), the pointer to the first Linked List item. 14. Finally, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit where n is the channel number. The transfer is performed. Make sure that bit 0 of the DMAC_EN register is enabled. 15. The DMAC fetches the first LLI from the location pointed to by DMAC_DSCRx(0).
Note: The LLI.DMAC_SADDRx, LLI.DMAC_DADDRx, LLI. DMAC_LLPx LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx and LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx registers are fetched. The LLI.DMAC_SADDRx register although fetched is not used.
16. The DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out to system memory. The DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out to the same location on the same layer (DMAC_DSCRx.DSCR_IF) where it was originally fetched, that is the location of the DMAC_CTRLAx register of the linked list item fetched prior to the start of the buffer transfer. Only DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out, because only the DMAC_CTRLAx.BTSIZE and DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE fields have been updated by hardware within the DMAC. The LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted to indicate buffer completion Therefore, software can poll the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE field of the DMAC_CTRLAx register in the LLi to ascertain when a buffer transfer has completed.
Note: Do not poll the DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the DMAC memory map. Instead poll the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the LLI for that buffer. If the polled LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted, then this buffer transfer has completed. This LLI.DMAC_CTRLA.DONE bit was cleared at the start of the transfer.
17. The DMAC reloads the DMAC_SADDRx register from the initial value. Hardware sets the buffer complete interrupt. The DMAC samples the row number as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. If the DMAC is in Row 1, then the DMAC transfer has completed. Hardware sets the transfer complete interrupt and disables the channel. You can either respond to the Buffer Complete or Chained buffer Transfer Complete interrupts, or poll for the Channel Enable (DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE) bit until it is cleared by hardware, to
585
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
detect when the transfer is complete. If the DMAC is not in Row 1 as shown in Table 371 on page 575, the following step is performed. 18. The DMAC fetches the next LLI from memory location pointed to by the current DMAC_DSCRx register, and automatically reprograms the DMAC_DADDRx, DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_DSCRx channel registers. Note that the DMAC_SADDRx is not re-programmed as the reloaded value is used for the next DMAC buffer transfer. If the next buffer is the last buffer of the DMAC transfer then the DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_DSCRx registers just fetched from the LLI should match Row 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575. The DMAC transfer might look like that shown in Figure 37-10 on page 586. Figure 37-10. Multi-buffer DMAC Transfer with Source Address Auto-reloaded and Linked List Destination Address
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Buffer0 DADDR(0)
Buffer1 DADDR(1) SADDR Buffer2 DADDR(2)
BufferN DADDR(N)
Source Buffers
Destination Buffers
The DMAC Transfer flow is shown in Figure 37-11 on page 587.
586
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-11. DMAC Transfer Flow for Replay Mode at Source and Linked List Destination Address
Channel Enabled by software
LLI Fetch
Hardware reprograms DADDRx, CTRLAx, CTRLBx, DSCRx
DMA buffer transfer
Writeback of control status information in LLI
Reload SADDRx Buffer Complete interrupt generated here yes Is HDMA in Row1 of HDMA State Machine Table?
HDMA Transfer Complete interrupt generated here
Channel Disabled by hardware
no
37.3.4.6
Multi-buffer Transfer with Source Address Auto-reloaded and Contiguous Destination Address (Row 11) 1. Read the Channel Enable register to choose a free (disabled) channel. 2. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading to the Interrupt Status Register. 3. Program the following channel registers: a. Write the starting source address in the DMAC_SADDRx register for channel x. b. c. Write the starting destination address in the DMAC_DADDRx register for channel x. Program DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CFGx according to Row 11 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. Program the DMAC_DSCRx register with `0'. DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO field is set to `1' to enable automatic mode support.
d. Write the control information for the DMAC transfer in the DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CTRLAx register for channel x. For example, in this register, you can program the following: - Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field.
587
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- Source AHB master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - Destination AHB master interface master layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INCR field. - Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination in DST_INCR field. e. If source picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x. f. If destination picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DPIP), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x.
g. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. 4. After the DMAC channel has been programmed, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit where n is the channel number. Make sure that bit 0 of the DMAC_EN.ENABLE register is enabled. 5. When the buffer transfer has completed, the DMAC reloads the DMAC_SADDRx register. The DMAC_DADDRx register remains unchanged. Hardware sets the buffer complete interrupt. The DMAC then samples the row number as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. If the DMAC is in Row 1, then the DMAC transfer has completed. Hardware sets the transfer complete interrupt and disables the channel. So you can either respond to the Buffer Complete or Transfer Complete interrupts, or poll for ENABLE field in the Channel Status Register (DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n] bit) until it is cleared by hardware, to detect when the transfer is complete. If the DMAC is not in Row 1, the next step is performed. 6. The DMAC transfer proceeds as follows: a. If the buffer complete interrupt is un-masked (DMAC_EBCIMR.BTC[x] = `1', where x is the channel number) hardware sets the buffer complete interrupt when the buffer transfer has completed. It then stalls until STALLED[n] bit of DMAC_CHSR is cleared by writing in the KEEPON[n] field of DMAC_CHER register where n is the channel number. If the next buffer is to be the last buffer in the DMAC transfer, then the buffer complete ISR (interrupt service routine) should clear the automatic mode bit, DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO. This puts the DMAC into Row 1 as shown in Table 371 on page 575. If the next buffer is not the last buffer in the DMAC transfer then the automatic transfer mode bit should remain enabled to keep the DMAC in Row 11 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575. b. If the buffer complete interrupt is masked (DMAC_EBCIMR.BTC[x] = `1', where x is the channel number) then hardware does not stall until it detects a write to the buffer transfer completed interrupt enable register but starts the next buffer transfer immediately. In this case software must clear the automatic mode bit, DMAC_CTRLBx.AUTO, to put the device into ROW 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575 before the last buffer of the DMAC transfer has completed.
The transfer is similar to that shown in Figure 37-12 on page 589. The DMAC Transfer flow is shown in Figure 37-13 on page 590.
588
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-12. Multi-buffer Transfer with Source Address Auto-reloaded and Contiguous Destination Address
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Buffer2 DADDR(2) Buffer1 DADDR(1) Buffer0 SADDR DADDR(0)
Source Buffers
Destination Buffers
589
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-13. DMAC Transfer Replay Mode is Enabled for the Source and Contiguous Destination Address
Channel Enabled by software
Buffer Transfer
Replay mode for SADDRx, Contiguous mode for DADDRx CTRLAx, CTRLBx Buffer Complete interrupt generated here Buffer Transfer Complete interrupt generated here Is HDMA in Row1of HDMA State Machine Table?
yes
Channel Disabled by hardware
no
no DMA_EBCIMR[x]=1?
yes Stall until STALLED field is cleared by software writing KEEPON Field
37.3.4.7
Multi-buffer DMAC Transfer with Linked List for Source and Contiguous Destination Address (Row 2) 1. Read the Channel Enable register to choose a free (disabled) channel. 2. Set up the linked list in memory. Write the control information in the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx and LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register location of the buffer descriptor for each LLI in memory for channel x. For example, in the register, you can program the following: c. Set up the transfer characteristics, such as: - i. Transfer width for the source in the SRC_WIDTH field. - ii. Transfer width for the destination in the DST_WIDTH field. - iii. Source AHB master interface layer in the SIF field where source resides. - iv. Destination AHB master interface layer in the DIF field where destination resides. - v. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for source in SRC_INCR field. - vi. Incrementing/decrementing or fixed address for destination DST_INCR field.
590
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
3. Write the starting destination address in the DMAC_DADDRx register for channel x.
Note: The values in the LLI.DMAC_DADDRx register location of each Linked List Item (LLI) in memory, although fetched during an LLI fetch, are not used.
4. Write the channel configuration information into the DMAC_CFGx register for channel x. 5. Make sure that all LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register locations of the LLI (except the last) are set as shown in Row 2 of Table 37-1 on page 575, while the LLI.DMAC_CTRLBx register of the last Linked List item must be set as described in Row 1 of Table 37-1. Figure 37-4 on page 574 shows a Linked List example with two list items. 6. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_DSCRx register locations of all LLIs in memory (except the last) are non-zero and point to the next Linked List Item. 7. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_SADDRx register location of all LLIs in memory point to the start source buffer address proceeding that LLI fetch. 8. Make sure that the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE field of the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx register locations of all LLIs in memory is cleared. 9. If source picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.SPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_SPIPx register for channel x. 10. If destination picture-in-picture is enabled (DMAC_CTRLBx.DPIP is enabled), program the DMAC_DPIPx register for channel x. 11. Clear any pending interrupts on the channel from the previous DMAC transfer by reading the interrupt status register. 12. Program the DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_CFGx registers according to Row 2 as shown in Table 37-1 on page 575 13. Program the DMAC_DSCRx register with DMAC_DSCRx(0), the pointer to the first Linked List item. 14. Finally, enable the channel by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit. The transfer is performed. Make sure that bit 0 of the DMAC_EN register is enabled. 15. The DMAC fetches the first LLI from the location pointed to by DMAC_DSCRx(0).
Note: The LLI.DMAC_SADDRx, LLI.DMAC_DADDRx, LLI.DMAC_DSCRx and LLI.DMAC_CTRLA/Bx registers are fetched. The LLI.DMAC_DADDRx register location of the LLI although fetched is not used. The DMAC_DADDRx register in the DMAC remains unchanged.
16. Once the buffer of data is transferred, the DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out to system memory at the same location and on the same layer (DMAC_DSCRx.DSCR_IF) where it was originally fetched, that is, the location of the DMAC_CTRLAx register of the linked list item fetched prior to the start of the buffer transfer. Only DMAC_CTRLAx register is written out because only the DMAC_CTRLAx.BTSIZE and DMAC_CTRLAX.DONE fields have been updated by DMAC hardware. Additionally, the DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted when the buffer transfer has completed.
Note: Do not poll the DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the DMAC memory map. Instead, poll the LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit in the LLI for that buffer. If the poll LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit is asserted, then this buffer transfer has completed. This LLI.DMAC_CTRLAx.DONE bit was cleared at the start of the transfer.
17. The DMAC does not wait for the buffer interrupt to be cleared, but continues and fetches the next LLI from the memory location pointed to by current DMAC_DSCRx register and automatically reprograms the DMAC_SADDRx, DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_DSCRx channel registers. The DMAC_DADDRx register is left unchanged. The DMAC transfer continues until the DMAC samples the DMAC_CTRLAx, DMAC_CTRLBx and DMAC_DSCRx registers at the end of a buffer transfer match that described in Row 1 of Table 37-1 on page 575. The DMAC then knows that the previous buffer transferred was the last buffer in the DMAC transfer.
591
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The DMAC transfer might look like that shown in Figure 37-14 on page 592 Note that the destination address is decrementing. Figure 37-14. DMAC Transfer with Linked List Source Address and Contiguous Destination Address
Address of Source Layer Address of Destination Layer
Buffer 2 SADDR(2) Buffer 2 DADDR(2)
Buffer 1 SADDR(1)
Buffer 1 DADDR(1)
Buffer 0 Buffer 0 SADDR(0) DADDR(0)
Source Buffers
Destination Buffers
The DMAC transfer flow is shown in Figure 37-15 on page 593.
592
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 37-15. DMAC Transfer Flow for Linked List Source Address and Contiguous Destination Address
Channel Enabled by software
LLI Fetch
Hardware reprograms SADDRx, CTRLAx,CTRLBx, DSCRx
HDMA buffer transfer
Writeback of control information of LLI
Buffer Complete interrupt generated here
Is HDMA in Row 1 ?
no
HDMA Transfer Complete interrupt generated here
yes
Channel Disabled by hardware
37.3.5
Disabling a Channel Prior to Transfer Completion Under normal operation, software enables a channel by writing a `1' to the Channel Handler Enable Register, DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n], and hardware disables a channel on transfer completion by clearing the DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n] register bit. The recommended way for software to disable a channel without losing data is to use the SUSPEND[n] bit in conjunction with the EMPTY[n] bit in the Channel Handler Status Register.
593
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
1. If software wishes to disable a channel n prior to the DMAC transfer completion, then it can set the DMAC_CHER.SUSPEND[n] bit to tell the DMAC to halt all transfers from the source peripheral. Therefore, the channel FIFO receives no new data. 2. Software can now poll the DMAC_CHSR.EMPTY[n] bit until it indicates that the channel n FIFO is empty, where n is the channel number. 3. The DMAC_CHER.ENABLE[n] bit can then be cleared by software once the channel n FIFO is empty, where n is the channel number. When DMAC_CTRLAx.SRC_WIDTH is less than DMAC_CTRLAx.DST_WIDTH and the DMAC_CHSRx.SUSPEND[n] bit is high, the DMAC_CHSRx.EMPTY[n] is asserted once the contents of the FIFO do not permit a single word of DMAC_CTRLAx.DST_WIDTH to be formed. However, there may still be data in the channel FIFO but not enough to form a single transfer of DMAC_CTLx.DST_WIDTH width. In this configuration, once the channel is disabled, the remaining data in the channel FIFO are not transferred to the destination peripheral. It is permitted to remove the channel from the suspension state by writing a `1' to the DMAC_CHER.RESUME[n] field register. The DMAC transfer completes in the normal manner. n defines the channel number. 37.3.5.1 Abnormal Transfer Termination A DMAC transfer may be terminated abruptly by software by clearing the channel enable bit, DMAC_CHDR.ENABLE[n] where n is the channel number. This does not mean that the channel is disabled immediately after the DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n] bit is cleared over the APB interface. Consider this as a request to disable the channel. The DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE[n] must be polled and then it must be confirmed that the channel is disabled by reading back 0. Software may terminate all channels abruptly by clearing the global enable bit in the DMAC Configuration Register (DMAC_EN.ENABLE bit). Again, this does not mean that all channels are disabled immediately after the DMAC_EN.ENABLE is cleared over the APB slave interface. Consider this as a request to disable all channels. The DMAC_CHSR.ENABLE must be polled and then it must be confirmed that all channels are disabled by reading back `0'.
Note: If the channel enable bit is cleared while there is data in the channel FIFO, this data is not sent to the destination peripheral and is not present when the channel is re-enabled. For read sensitive source peripherals, such as a source FIFO, this data is therefore lost. When the source is not a read sensitive device (i.e., memory), disabling a channel without waiting for the channel FIFO to empty may be acceptable as the data is available from the source peripheral upon request and is not lost.
37.4
DMAC Software Requirements
* There must not be any write operation to Channel registers in an active channel after the channel enable is made HIGH. If any channel parameters must be reprogrammed, this can only be done after disabling the DMAC channel. * You must program the DMAC_SADDRx and DMAC_DADDRx channel registers with a byte, half-word and word aligned address depending on the source width and destination width. * After the software disables a channel by writing into the channel disable register, it must reenable the channel only after it has polled a 0 in the corresponding channel enable status register. This is because the current AHB Burst must terminate properly. * If you program the BTSIZE field in the DMAC_CTRLA, as zero, and the DMAC is defined as the flow controller, then the channel is automatically disabled. * When AUTO Field is set to TRUE, then the BTSIZE Field is automatically reloaded from its previous value. BTSIZE must be initialized to a non zero value if the first transfer is initiated
594
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
with AUTO field set to TRUE even if LLI mode is enabled because the LLI fetch operation will not update this field.
595
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5 DMA Controller (DMAC) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register DMAC Global Configuration Register DMAC Enable Register Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved DMAC Error, Chained Buffer transfer completed and Buffer transfer completed Interrupt Enable register. DMAC Error, Chained Buffer transfer completed and Buffer transfer completed Interrupt Disable register. DMAC Error, Chained Buffer transfer completed and Buffer transfer completed Mask Register. DMAC Error, Chained Buffer transfer completed and Buffer transfer completed Status Register. DMAC Channel Handler Enable Register DMAC Channel Handler Disable Register DMAC Channel Handler Status Register Reserved Reserved DMAC Channel 0 Source Address Register DMAC Channel 0 Destination Address Register DMAC Channel 0 Descriptor Address Register DMAC Channel 0 Control A Register DMAC Channel 0 Control B Register DMAC Channel 0 Configuration Register DMAC Channel 0 Source Picture in Picture Configuration Register DMAC Channel 0 Destination Picture in Picture Configuration Register Reserved Reserved DMAC Channel 1 Source Address Register DMAC Channel 1 Destination Address Register DMAC Channel 1 Descriptor Address Register DMAC Channel 1 Control A Register DMAC Channel 1 Control B Register Name DMAC_GCFG DMAC_EN - - - - DMAC_EBCIER DMAC_EBCIDR DMAC_EBCIMR DMAC_EBCISR DMAC_CHER DMAC_CHDR DMAC_CHSR - - DMAC_SADDR0 DMAC_DADDR0 DMAC_DSCR0 DMAC_CTRLA0 DMAC_CTRLB0 DMAC_CFG0 DMAC_SPIP0 DMAC_DPIP0 - - DMAC_SADDR1 DMAC_DADDR1 DMAC_DSCR1 DMAC_CTRLA1 DMAC_CTRLB1 Access Read/Write Read/Write - - - - Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only - - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x01000000 0x0 0x0 - - 0x0 0x0 - - 0x00FF0000 - - Reset State 0x10 0x0 - - - - - -
Table 37-2.
Offset 0x000 0x004 0x008 0x00C 0x010 0x014 0x018 0x01C 0x020 0x024 0x028 0x02C 0x030 0x034 0x038 0x03C 0x040 0x044 0x048 0x04C 0x050 0x054 0x058 0x05C 0x060 0x064 0x068 0x06C 0x070 0x074
596
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 37-2.
Offset 0x078 0x07C 0x080
Register Mapping
Register DMAC Channel 1 Configuration Register DMAC Channel 1 Source Picture in Picture Configuration Register DMAC Channel 1 Destination Picture in Picture Configuration Register Name DMAC_CFG1 DMAC_SPIP1 DMAC_DPIP1 Access Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Reset State 0x01000000 0x0 0x0
597
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.1 DMAC Global Configuration Register Name: DMAC_GCFG Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000010
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 ARB_CFG 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 IF0_BIGEND
* IF0_BIGEND 0: AHB-Lite Interface 0 is little endian. 1: AHB-Lite Interface 0 is big endian. * ARB_CFG 0: Fixed priority arbiter. 1: Modified round robin arbiter.
598
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.2 DMAC Enable Register Name: DMAC_EN Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 ENABLE
* ENABLE 0: DMA Controller is disabled. 1: DMA Controller is enabled.
599
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.3 DMAC Error, Buffer Transfer and Chained Buffer Transfer Interrupt Enable Register Name: DMAC_EBCIER Access: Write-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 ERR1 9 CBTC1 1 BTC1 24 - 16 ERR0 8 CBTC0 0 BTC0
* BTC[1:0] Buffer Transfer Completed Interrupt Enable Register. Set the relevant bit in the BTC field to enable the interrupt for channel i. * CBTC[1:0] Chained Buffer Transfer Completed Interrupt Enable Register. Set the relevant bit in the CBTC field to enable the interrupt for channel i. * ERR[1:0] Access Error Interrupt Enable Register. Set the relevant bit in the ERR field to enable the interrupt for channel i.
600
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.4 DMAC Error, Buffer Transfer and Chained Buffer Transfer Interrupt Disable Register Name: DMAC_EBCIDR Access: Write-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 ERR1 9 CBTC1 1 BTC1 24 - 16 ERR0 8 CBTC0 0 BTC0
* BTC[1:0] Buffer transfer completed Disable Interrupt Register. When set, a bit of the BTC field disables the interrupt from the relevant DMAC channel. * CBTC[1:0] Chained Buffer transfer completed Disable Register. When set, a bit of the CBTC field disables the interrupt from the relevant DMAC channel. * ERR[1:0] Access Error Interrupt Disable Register. When set, a bit of the ERR field disables the interrupt from the relevant DMAC channel.
601
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.5 DMAC Error, Buffer Transfer and Chained Buffer Transfer Interrupt Mask Register Name: DMAC_EBCIMR Access: Read-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 ERR1 9 CBTC1 1 BTC1 24 - 16 ERR0 8 CBTC0 0 BTC0
* BTC[1:0] 0: Buffer Transfer completed interrupt is disabled for channel i. 1: Buffer Transfer completed interrupt is enabled for channel i. * CBTC[1:0] 0: Chained Buffer Transfer interrupt is disabled for channel i. 1: Chained Buffer Transfer interrupt is enabled for channel i. * ERR[1:0] 0: Transfer Error Interrupt is disabled for channel i. 1: Transfer Error Interrupt is enabled for channel i.
602
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.6 DMAC Error, Buffer Transfer and Chained Buffer Transfer Status Register Name: DMAC_EBCISR Access: Read-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 ERR1 9 CBTC1 1 BTC1 24 - 16 ERR0 8 CBTC0 0 BTC0
* BTC[1:0] When BTC[i] is set, Channel i buffer transfer has terminated. * CBTC[1:0] When CBTC[i] is set, Channel i Chained buffer has terminated. LLI Fetch operation is disabled. * ERR[1:0] When ERR[i] is set, Channel i has detected an AHB Read or Write Error Access.
603
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.7 DMAC Channel Handler Enable Register Name: DMAC_CHER Access: Write-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 KEEP1 17 - 9 SUSP1 1 ENA1 24 KEEP0 16 - 8 SUSP0 0 ENA0
* ENA[1:0] When set, a bit of the ENA field enables the relevant channel. * SUSP[1:0] When set, a bit of the SUSP field freezes the relevant channel and its current context. * KEEP[1:0] When set, a bit of the KEEP field resumes the current channel from an automatic stall state.
604
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.8 DMAC Channel Handler Disable Register Name: DMAC_CHDR Access: Write-only Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 RES1 1 DIS1 24 - 16 - 8 RES0 0 DIS0
* DIS[1:0] Write one to this field to disable the relevant DMAC Channel. The content of the FIFO is lost and the current AHB access is terminated. Software must poll DIS[1:0] field in the DMAC_CHSR register to be sure that the channel is disabled. * RES[1:0] Write one to this field to resume the channel transfer restoring its context.
605
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.9 DMAC Channel Handler Status Register Name: DMAC_CHSR Access: Read-only Reset Value: 0x00FF0000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 STAL1 17 EMPT1 9 SUSP1 1 ENA1 24 STAL0 16 EMPT0 8 SUSP0 0 ENA0
* ENA[1:0] A one in any position of this field indicates that the relevant channel is enabled. * SUSP[1:0] A one in any position of this field indicates that the channel transfer is suspended. * EMPT[1:0] A one in any position of this field indicates that the relevant channel is empty. * STAL[1:0] A one in any position of this field indicates that the relevant channel is stalling.
606
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.10 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Source Address Register Name: DMAC_SADDRx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 30 29 28 SADDRx 23 22 21 20 SADDRx 15 14 13 12 SADDRx 7 6 5 4 SADDRx 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* SADDRx Channel x source address. This register must be aligned with the source transfer width.
37.5.11 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Destination Address Register Name: DMAC_DADDRx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 30 29 28 DADDRx 23 22 21 20 DADDRx 15 14 13 12 DADDRx 7 6 5 4 DADDRx 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* DADDRx Channel x destination address. This register must be aligned with the destination transfer width.
607
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.12 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Descriptor Address Register Name: DMAC_DSCRx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 30 29 28 DSCRx 23 22 21 20 DSCRx 15 14 13 12 DSCRx 7 6 5 DSCRx 4 3 2 1 DSCRx_IF 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* DSCRx_IF 00: The Buffer Transfer descriptor is fetched via AHB-Lite Interface 0. 01: Reserved. 10: Reserved. 11: Reserved. * DSCRx Buffer Transfer descriptor address. This address is word aligned.
608
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.13 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Control A Register Name: DMAC_CTRLAx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 DONE 23 - 15 30 - 22 - 14 29 DST_WIDTH 21 - 13 20 - 12 BTSIZE 7 6 5 4 BTSIZE 3 2 1 0 28 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 SRC_WIDTH 17 - 9 16 - 8 24
* BTSIZE Buffer Transfer Size. The transfer size relates to the number of transfers to be performed, that is, for writes it refers to the number of source width transfers to perform when DMAC is flow controller. For Reads, BTSIZE refers to the number of transfers completed on the Source Interface. When this field is set to 0, the DMAC module is automatically disabled when the relevant channel is enabled. * SRC_WIDTH
SRC_WIDTH 00 01 1X Single Transfer Size BYTE HALF-WORD WORD
* DST_WIDTH
DST_WIDTH 00 01 1X Single Transfer Size BYTE HALF-WORD WORD
* DONE 0: The transfer is performed. 1: If SOD field of DMAC_CFG register is set to true, then the DMAC is automatically disabled when an LLI updates the content of this register. The DONE field is written back to memory at the end of the transfer.
609
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.14 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Control B Register Name: DMAC_CTRLBx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 AUTO 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 DST_INCR 21 - 13 20 DST_DSCR 12 DST_PIP 4 DIF 28 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 SRC_INCR 17 - 9 - 1 SIF 16 SRC_DSCR 8 SRC_PIP 0 24
5
* SIF Source Interface Selection Field. 00: The source transfer is done via AHB-Lite Interface 0. 01: Reserved. 10: Reserved. 11: Reserved. * DIF Destination Interface Selection Field. 00: The destination transfer is done via AHB-Lite Interface 0. 01: Reserved. 10: Reserved. 11: Reserved. * SRC_PIP 0: Picture-in-Picture mode is disabled. The source data area is contiguous. 1: Picture-in-Picture mode is enabled. When the source PIP counter reaches the programmable boundary, the address is automatically increment of a user defined amount. * DST_PIP 0: Picture-in-Picture mode is disabled. The Destination data area is contiguous. 1: Picture-in-Picture mode is enabled. When the Destination PIP counter reaches the programmable boundary the address is automatically incremented by a user-defined amount. * SRC_DSCR 0: Source address is updated when the descriptor is fetched from the memory. 1: Buffer Descriptor Fetch operation is disabled for the source.
610
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* DST_DSCR 0: Destination address is updated when the descriptor is fetched from the memory. 1: Buffer Descriptor Fetch operation is disabled for the destination. * SRC_INCR
SRC_INCR 00 01 10 Type of addressing mode INCREMENTING DECREMENTING FIXED
* DST_INCR
DST_INCR 00 01 10 Type of addressing scheme INCREMENTING DECREMENTING FIXED
* AUTO Automatic multiple buffer transfer is enabled. When set, this bit enables replay mode or contiguous mode when several buffers are transferred.
611
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.15 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Configuration Register Name: DMAC_CFGx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x0100000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 DST_REP 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 - 24 - 16 SOD 8 SRC_REP 0 -
* SRC_REP 0: When automatic mode is activated, source address is contiguous between two buffers. 1: When automatic mode is activated, the source address and the control register are reloaded from previous transfer. * DST_REP 0: When automatic mode is activated, destination address is contiguous between two buffers. 1: When automatic mode is activated, the destination and the control register are reloaded from the previous transfer. * SOD 0: STOP ON DONE disabled, the descriptor fetch operation ignores DONE Field of CTRLA register. 1: STOP ON DONE activated, the DMAC module is automatically disabled if DONE FIELD is set to 1.
612
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.16 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Source Picture in Picture Configuration Register Name: DMAC_SPIPx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 27 - 26 - 18 25 24 SPIP_BOUNDARY 17 16
20 19 SPIP_BOUNDARY 12 SPIP_HOLE 11
15
14
13
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 SPIP_HOLE
3
2
1
0
* SPIP_HOLE This field indicates the value to add to the address when the programmable boundary has been reached. * SPIP_BOUNDARY This field indicates the number of source transfers to perform before the automatic address increment operation.
613
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
37.5.17 DMAC Channel x [x = 0..1] Destination Picture in Picture Configuration Register Name: DMAC_DPIPx [x = 0..1] Access: Read/Write Reset Value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 27 - 26 - 18 25 24 DPIP_BOUNDARY 17 16
20 19 DPIP_BOUNDARY 12 DPIPE_HOLE 11
15
14
13
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 DPIPE_HOLE
3
2
1
0
* DPIP_HOLE This field indicates the value to add to the address when the programmable boundary has been reached. * DPIP_BOUNDARY This field indicates the number of source transfers to perform before the automatic address increment operation.
614
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38. MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI)
38.1 Description
The MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI) supports the MultiMedia Card (MMC) Specification V3.11, the SDIO Specification V1.1 and the SD Memory Card Specification V1.0. The MCI includes a command register, response registers, data registers, timeout counters and error detection logic that automatically handle the transmission of commands and, when required, the reception of the associated responses and data with a limited processor overhead. The MCI supports stream, block and multi-block data read and write, and is compatible with the Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) channels, minimizing processor intervention for large buffer transfers. The MCI operates at a rate of up to Master Clock divided by 2 and supports the interfacing of 2 slot(s). Each slot may be used to interface with a MultiMediaCard bus (up to 30 Cards) or with a SD Memory Card. Only one slot can be selected at a time (slots are multiplexed). A bit field in the SD Card Register performs this selection. The SD Memory Card communication is based on a 9-pin interface (clock, command, four data and three power lines) and the MultiMedia Card on a 7-pin interface (clock, command, one data, three power lines and one reserved for future use). The SD Memory Card interface also supports MultiMedia Card operations. The main differences between SD and MultiMedia Cards are the initialization process and the bus topology.
615
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.2
Block Diagram
Figure 38-1. Block Diagram
APB Bridge
PDC APB MCCK(1) MCCDA(1) MCDA0(1) PMC MCK MCDA1(1) MCDA2(1) MCDA3(1) MCI Interface PIO MCCDB(1) MCDB0(1) MCDB1(1) MCDB2(1) Interrupt Control MCDB3(1)
MCI Interrupt
Note:
1. When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB,MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
616
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.3 Application Block Diagram
Figure 38-2. Application Block Diagram
Application Layer ex: File System, Audio, Security, etc.
Physical Layer MCI Interface
1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1234567 MMC 9
SDCard
38.4
Pin Name List
I/O Lines Description
Pin Description Command/response Clock Data 0..3 of Slot A Data 0..3 of Slot B Type(1) I/O/PP/OD I/O I/O/PP I/O/PP Comments CMD of an MMC or SDCard/SDIO CLK of an MMC or SD Card/SDIO DAT0 of an MMC DAT[0..3] of an SD Card/SDIO DAT0 of an MMC DAT[0..3] of an SD Card/SDIO
Table 38-1.
Pin Name(2)
MCCDA/MCCDB MCCK MCDA0 - MCDA3 MCDB0 - MCDB3 Notes:
1. I: Input, O: Output, PP: Push/Pull, OD: Open Drain. 2. When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB, MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
38.5
38.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the MultiMedia Cards or SD Cards may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controllers to assign the peripheral functions to MCI pins.
38.5.2
Power Management The MCI may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), so the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the MCI clock.
617
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.5.3
Interrupt The MCI interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling the MCI interrupt requires programming the AIC before configuring the MCI.
38.6
Bus Topology
Figure 38-3. Multimedia Memory Card Bus Topology
1234567 MMC
The MultiMedia Card communication is based on a 7-pin serial bus interface. It has three communication lines and four supply lines. Table 38-2.
Pin Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Notes:
Bus Topology
Name RSV CMD VSS1 VDD CLK VSS2 DAT[0] Type(1) NC I/O/PP/OD S S I/O S I/O/PP Description Not connected Command/response Supply voltage ground Supply voltage Clock Supply voltage ground Data 0 MCI Pin Name(2) (Slot z) MCCDz VSS VDD MCCK VSS MCDz0
1. I: Input, O: Output, PP: Push/Pull, OD: Open Drain. 2. When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB, MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
Figure 38-4. MMC Bus Connections (One Slot)
MCI
MCDA0
MCCDA
MCCK
1234567 MMC1
1234567 MMC2
1234567 MMC3
Note:
When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA MCDAy to MCIx_DAy.
618
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 38-5. SD Memory Card Bus Topology
1 2 3 4 5 6 78 9
SD CARD
The SD Memory Card bus includes the signals listed in Table 38-3. Table 38-3.
Pin Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Notes:
SD Memory Card Bus Signals
Name CD/DAT[3] CMD VSS1 VDD CLK VSS2 DAT[0] DAT[1] DAT[2] Type
(1)
Description Card detect/ Data line Bit 3 Command/response Supply voltage ground Supply voltage Clock Supply voltage ground Data line Bit 0 Data line Bit 1 or Interrupt Data line Bit 2
MCI Pin Name(2) (Slot z) MCDz3 MCCDz VSS VDD MCCK VSS MCDz0 MCDz1 MCDz2
I/O/PP PP S S I/O S I/O/PP I/O/PP I/O/PP
1. I: input, O: output, PP: Push Pull, OD: Open Drain. 2. When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB, MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
Figure 38-6. SD Card Bus Connections with One Slot
MCDA0 - MCDA3 MCCK MCCDA 1 2 3 4 5 6 78
SD CARD
Note:
When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA MCDAy to MCIx_DAy.
9
619
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 38-7. SD Card Bus Connections with Two Slots
MCDA0 - MCDA3 MCCK MCCDA 1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1234567 MMC1 1 2 3 4 5 6 78
SD CARD 1
MCDB0 - MCDB3
MCCDB
Note:
When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK,MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
Figure 38-8. Mixing MultiMedia and SD Memory Cards with Two Slots
MCDA0 MCCDA MCCK
1234567 MMC2
9
9
SD CARD 2
1234567 MMC3
MCDB0 - MCDB3
SD CARD
MCCDB
Note:
When several MCI (x MCI) are embedded in a product, MCCK refers to MCIx_CK, MCCDA to MCIx_CDA, MCDAy to MCIx_DAy, MCCDB to MCIx_CDB, MCDBy to MCIx_DBy.
When the MCI is configured to operate with SD memory cards, the width of the data bus can be selected in the MCI_SDCR register. Clearing the SDCBUS bit in this register means that the width is one bit; setting it means that the width is four bits. In the case of multimedia cards, only the data line 0 is used. The other data lines can be used as independent PIOs.
620
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
9
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.7 MultiMedia Card Operations
After a power-on reset, the cards are initialized by a special message-based MultiMedia Card bus protocol. Each message is represented by one of the following tokens: * Command: A command is a token that starts an operation. A command is sent from the host either to a single card (addressed command) or to all connected cards (broadcast command). A command is transferred serially on the CMD line. * Response: A response is a token which is sent from an addressed card or (synchronously) from all connected cards to the host as an answer to a previously received command. A response is transferred serially on the CMD line. * Data: Data can be transferred from the card to the host or vice versa. Data is transferred via the data line. Card addressing is implemented using a session address assigned during the initialization phase by the bus controller to all currently connected cards. Their unique CID number identifies individual cards. The structure of commands, responses and data blocks is described in the MultiMedia-Card System Specification. See also Table 38-4 on page 622. MultiMediaCard bus data transfers are composed of these tokens. There are different types of operations. Addressed operations always contain a command and a response token. In addition, some operations have a data token; the others transfer their information directly within the command or response structure. In this case, no data token is present in an operation. The bits on the DAT and the CMD lines are transferred synchronous to the clock MCI Clock. Two types of data transfer commands are defined: * Sequential commands: These commands initiate a continuous data stream. They are terminated only when a stop command follows on the CMD line. This mode reduces the command overhead to an absolute minimum. * Block-oriented commands: These commands send a data block succeeded by CRC bits. Both read and write operations allow either single or multiple block transmission. A multiple block transmission is terminated when a stop command follows on the CMD line similarly to the sequential read or when a multiple block transmission has a pre-defined block count (See "Data Transfer Operation" on page 623.). The MCI provides a set of registers to perform the entire range of MultiMedia Card operations. 38.7.1 Command - Response Operation After reset, the MCI is disabled and becomes valid after setting the MCIEN bit in the MCI_CR Control Register. The PWSEN bit saves power by dividing the MCI clock by 2PWSDIV + 1 when the bus is inactive. The two bits, RDPROOF and WRPROOF in the MCI Mode Register (MCI_MR) allow stopping the MCI Clock during read or write access if the internal FIFO is full. This guarantees data integrity, not bandwidth. The command and the response of the card are clocked out with the rising edge of the MCI Clock. All the timings for MultiMedia Card are defined in the MultiMediaCard System Specification.
621
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The two bus modes (open drain and push/pull) needed to process all the operations are defined in the MCI command register. The MCI_CMDR allows a command to be carried out. For example, to perform an ALL_SEND_CID command:
Host Command CMD S T Content CRC E Z NID Cycles ****** Z S T CID Content Z Z Z
The command ALL_SEND_CID and the fields and values for the MCI_CMDR Control Register are described in Table 38-4 and Table 38-5. Table 38-4.
CMD Index
ALL_SEND_CID Command Description
Type Argument Resp Abbreviation Command Description Asks all cards to send their CID numbers on the CMD line
CMD2
bcr
[31:0] stuff bits
R2
ALL_SEND_CID
Note:
bcr means broadcast command with response.
Table 38-5.
Field
Fields and Values for MCI_CMDR Command Register
Value 2 (CMD2) 2 (R2: 136 bits response) 0 (not a special command) 1 0 (NID cycles ==> 5 cycles) 0 (No transfer) X (available only in transfer command) X (available only in transfer command) 0 (not a special command)
CMDNB (command number) RSPTYP (response type) SPCMD (special command) OPCMD (open drain command) MAXLAT (max latency for command to response) TRCMD (transfer command) TRDIR (transfer direction) TRTYP (transfer type) IOSPCMD (SDIO special command)
The MCI_ARGR contains the argument field of the command. To send a command, the user must perform the following steps: * Fill the argument register (MCI_ARGR) with the command argument. * Set the command register (MCI_CMDR) (see Table 38-5). The command is sent immediately after writing the command register. The status bit CMDRDY in the status register (MCI_SR) is asserted when the command is completed. If the command requires a response, it can be read in the MCI response register (MCI_RSPR). The response size can be from 48 bits up to 136 bits depending on the command. The MCI embeds an error detection to prevent any corrupted data during the transfer. The following flowchart shows how to send a command to the card and read the response if needed. In this example, the status register bits are polled but setting the appropriate bits in the interrupt enable register (MCI_IER) allows using an interrupt method. 622
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 38-9. Command/Response Functional Flow Diagram
Set the command argument MCI_ARGR = Argument(1)
Set the command MCI_CMDR = Command
Read MCI_SR
Wait for command ready status flag
0 CMDRDY
1
Check error bits in the status register (1)
Yes Status error flags?
Read response if required RETURN ERROR(1) RETURN OK
Note:
1. If the command is SEND_OP_COND, the CRC error flag is always present (refer to R3 response in the MultiMedia Card specification).
38.7.2
Data Transfer Operation The MultiMedia Card allows several read/write operations (single block, multiple blocks, stream, etc.). These kind of transfers can be selected setting the Transfer Type (TRTYP) field in the MCI Command Register (MCI_CMDR). These operations can be done using the features of the Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC). If the PDCMODE bit is set in MCI_MR, then all reads and writes use the PDC facilities. In all cases, the block length (BLKLEN field) must be defined either in the mode register MCI_MR, or in the Block Register MCI_BLKR. This field determines the size of the data block. Enabling PDC Force Byte Transfer (PDCFBYTE bit in the MCI_MR) allows the PDC to manage with internal byte transfers, so that transfer of blocks with a size different from modulo 4 can be supported. When PDC Force Byte Transfer is disabled, the PDC type of transfers are in words, otherwise the type of transfers are in bytes. 623
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Consequent to MMC Specification 3.1, two types of multiple block read (or write) transactions are defined (the host can use either one at any time): * Open-ended/Infinite Multiple block read (or write): The number of blocks for the read (or write) multiple block operation is not defined. The card continuously transfers (or programs) data blocks until a stop transmission command is received. * Multiple block read (or write) with pre-defined block count (since version 3.1 and higher): The card transfers (or programs) the requested number of data blocks and terminate the transaction. The stop command is not required at the end of this type of multiple block read (or write), unless terminated with an error. In order to start a multiple block read (or write) with pre-defined block count, the host must correctly program the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR). Otherwise the card starts an open-ended multiple block read. The BCNT field of the Block Register defines the number of blocks to transfer (from 1 to 65535 blocks). Programming the value 0 in the BCNT field corresponds to an infinite block transfer. 38.7.3 Read Operation The following flowchart shows how to read a single block with or without use of PDC facilities. In this example (see Figure 38-10), a polling method is used to wait for the end of read. Similarly, the user can configure the interrupt enable register (MCI_IER) to trigger an interrupt at the end of read.
624
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 38-10. Read Functional Flow Diagram
Send SELECT/DESELECT_CARD command(1) to select the card
(1) Send SET_BLOCKLEN command
No Read with PDC
Yes
Reset the PDCMODE bit MCI_MR &= ~PDCMODE Set the block length (in bytes) MCI_MR |= (BlockLenght <<16)(2) Set the block count (if necessary) MCI_BLKR |= (BlockCount << 0)
Set the PDCMODE bit MCI_MR |= PDCMODE Set the block length (in bytes) (2) MCI_MR |= (BlockLength << 16) Set the block count (if necessary) MCI_BLKR |= (BlockCount << 0)
Send READ_SINGLE_BLOCK command(1)
Configure the PDC channel MCI_RPR = Data Buffer Address MCI_RCR = BlockLength/4 MCI_PTCR = RXTEN
Number of words to read = BlockLength/4 Send READ_SINGLE_BLOCK command(1)
Yes Number of words to read = 0 ? Read status register MCI_SR No Read status register MCI_SR Poll the bit ENDRX = 0? Yes
Poll the bit RXRDY = 0?
Yes No
No Read data = MCI_RDR Number of words to read = Number of words to read -1
RETURN
RETURN
Note:
1. It is assumed that this command has been correctly sent (see Figure 38-9). 2. This field is also accessible in the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR).
625
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.7.4
Write Operation In write operation, the MCI Mode Register (MCI_MR) is used to define the padding value when writing non-multiple block size. If the bit PDCPADV is 0, then 0x00 value is used when padding data, otherwise 0xFF is used. If set, the bit PDCMODE enables PDC transfer. The following flowchart shows how to write a single block with or without use of PDC facilities (see Figure 38-11). Polling or interrupt method can be used to wait for the end of write according to the contents of the Interrupt Mask Register (MCI_IMR).
626
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 38-11. Write Functional Flow Diagram
Send SELECT/DESELECT_CARD command(1) to select the card
Send SET_BLOCKLEN command(1)
No Write using PDC
Yes
Reset the PDCMODE bit MCI_MR &= ~PDCMODE Set the block length (in bytes) MCI_MR |= (BlockLenght <<16)(2) Set the block count (if necessary) MCI_BLKR |= (BlockCount << 0)
Set the PDCMODE bit MCI_MR |= PDCMODE Set the block length (in bytes) (2) MCI_MR |= (BlockLength << 16) Set the block count (if necessary) MCI_BLKR |= (BlockCount << 0)
Send WRITE_SINGLE_BLOCK command(1)
Configure the PDC channel MCI_TPR = Data Buffer Address to write MCI_TCR = BlockLength/4
Number of words to write = BlockLength/4
Send WRITE_SINGLE_BLOCK command(1)
MCI_PTCR = TXTEN Yes Number of words to write = 0 ? Read status register MCI_SR No Read status register MCI_SR Poll the bit NOTBUSY= 0? Poll the bit TXRDY = 0? Yes No Yes
No MCI_TDR = Data to write Number of words to write = Number of words to write -1 RETURN
RETURN
Note:
1. It is assumed that this command has been correctly sent (see Figure 38-9). 2. This field is also accessible in the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR).
627
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The following flowchart shows how to manage a multiple write block transfer with the PDC (see Figure 38-12). Polling or interrupt method can be used to wait for the end of write according to the contents of the Interrupt Mask Register (MCI_IMR).
628
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 38-12. Multiple Write Functional Flow Diagram
Send SELECT/DESELECT_CARD command(1) to select the card
(1) Send SET_BLOCKLEN command
Set the PDCMODE bit MCI_MR |= PDCMODE Set the block length (in bytes) MCI_MR |= (BlockLength << 16)(2) Set the block count (if necessary) MCI_BLKR |= (BlockCount << 0)
Configure the PDC channel MCI_TPR = Data Buffer Address to write MCI_TCR = BlockLength/4
Send WRITE_MULTIPLE_BLOCK command(1)
MCI_PTCR = TXTEN
Read status register MCI_SR
Poll the bit BLKE = 0?
Yes
No Send STOP_TRANSMISSION (1) command
Poll the bit NOTBUSY = 0?
Yes
No RETURN
Note:
1. It is assumed that this command has been correctly sent (see Figure 38-9). 2. This field is also accessible in the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR).
629
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.8
SD/SDIO Card Operations
The MultiMedia Card Interface allows processing of SD Memory (Secure Digital Memory Card) and SDIO (SD Input Output) Card commands. SD/SDIO cards are based on the Multi Media Card (MMC) format, but are physically slightly thicker and feature higher data transfer rates, a lock switch on the side to prevent accidental overwriting and security features. The physical form factor, pin assignment and data transfer protocol are forward-compatible with the MultiMedia Card with some additions. SD slots can actually be used for more than flash memory cards. Devices that support SDIO can use small devices designed for the SD form factor, such as GPS receivers, Wi-Fi or Bluetooth(R) adapters, modems, barcode readers, IrDA adapters, FM radio tuners, RFID readers, digital cameras and more. SD/SDIO is covered by numerous patents and trademarks, and licensing is only available through the Secure Digital Card Association. The SD/SDIO Card communication is based on a 9-pin interface (Clock, Command, 4 x Data and 3 x Power lines). The communication protocol is defined as a part of this specification. The main difference between the SD/SDIO Card and the MultiMedia Card is the initialization process. The SD/SDIO Card Register (MCI_SDCR) allows selection of the Card Slot and the data bus width. The SD/SDIO Card bus allows dynamic configuration of the number of data lines. After power up, by default, the SD/SDIO Card uses only DAT0 for data transfer. After initialization, the host can change the bus width (number of active data lines).
38.8.1
SDIO Data Transfer Type SDIO cards may transfer data in either a multi-byte (1 to 512 bytes) or an optional block format (1 to 511 blocks), while the SD memory cards are fixed in the block transfer mode. The TRTYP field in the MCI Command Register (MCI_CMDR) allows to choose between SDIO Byte or SDIO Block transfer. The number of bytes/blocks to transfer is set through the BCNT field in the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR). In SDIO Block mode, the field BLKLEN must be set to the data block size while this field is not used in SDIO Byte mode. An SDIO Card can have multiple I/O or combined I/O and memory (called Combo Card). Within a multi-function SDIO or a Combo card, there are multiple devices (I/O and memory) that share access to the SD bus. In order to allow the sharing of access to the host among multiple devices, SDIO and combo cards can implement the optional concept of suspend/resume (Refer to the SDIO Specification for more details). To send a suspend or a resume command, the host must set the SDIO Special Command field (IOSPCMD) in the MCI Command Register.
38.8.2
SDIO Interrupts Each function within an SDIO or Combo card may implement interrupts (Refer to the SDIO Specification for more details). In order to allow the SDIO card to interrupt the host, an interrupt function is added to a pin on the DAT[1] line to signal the card's interrupt to the host. An SDIO interrupt on each slot can be enabled through the MCI Interrupt Enable Register. The SDIO interrupt is sampled regardless of the currently selected slot.
630
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9 MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Control Register Mode Register Data Timeout Register SD/SDIO Card Register Argument Register Command Register Block Register Reserved Response Register
(1) (1) (1)
Table 38-6.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0x30 0x34
Register Name MCI_CR MCI_MR MCI_DTOR MCI_SDCR MCI_ARGR MCI_CMDR MCI_BLKR - MCI_RSPR MCI_RSPR MCI_RSPR MCI_RSPR MCI_RDR MCI_TDR - MCI_SR MCI_IER MCI_IDR MCI_IMR - -
Read/Write Write Read/write Read/write Read/write Read/write Write Read/write - Read Read Read Read Read Write - Read Write Write Read - -
Reset - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 - 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 - - 0xC0E5 - - 0x0 - -
Response Register Response Register
Response Register(1) Receive Data Register Transmit Data Register Reserved Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved Reserved for the PDC
0x38 - 0x3C 0x40 0x44 0x48 0x4C 0x50-0xFC 0x100-0x124 Note:
1. The response register can be read by N accesses at the same MCI_RSPR or at consecutive addresses (0x20 to 0x2C). N depends on the size of the response.
631
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.1 Name:
MCI Control Register MCI_CR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
SWRST
-
-
-
PWSDIS
PWSEN
MCIDIS
MCIEN
* MCIEN: Multi-Media Interface Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Multi-Media Interface if MCDIS is 0. * MCIDIS: Multi-Media Interface Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Multi-Media Interface. * PWSEN: Power Save Mode Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the Power Saving Mode if PWSDIS is 0. Warning: Before enabling this mode, the user must set a value different from 0 in the PWSDIV field (Mode Register MCI_MR). * PWSDIS: Power Save Mode Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the Power Saving Mode. * SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the MCI. A software triggered hardware reset of the MCI interface is performed.
632
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.2 Name: MCI Mode Register MCI_MR Read/write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
BLKLEN
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
BLKLEN
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
PDCMODE
7
PDCPADV
6
PDCFBYTE
5
WRPROOF
4
RDPROOF
3 2
PWSDIV
1 0
CLKDIV
* CLKDIV: Clock Divider Multimedia Card Interface clock (MCCK or MCI_CK) is Master Clock (MCK) divided by (2*(CLKDIV+1)). * PWSDIV: Power Saving Divider Multimedia Card Interface clock is divided by 2(PWSDIV) + 1 when entering Power Saving Mode. Warning: This value must be different from 0 before enabling the Power Save Mode in the MCI_CR (MCI_PWSEN bit). * RDPROOF Read Proof Enable Enabling Read Proof allows to stop the MCI Clock during read access if the internal FIFO is full. This guarantees data integrity, not bandwidth. 0 = Disables Read Proof. 1 = Enables Read Proof. * WRPROOF Write Proof Enable Enabling Write Proof allows to stop the MCI Clock during write access if the internal FIFO is full. This guarantees data integrity, not bandwidth. 0 = Disables Write Proof. 1 = Enables Write Proof. * PDCFBYTE: PDC Force Byte Transfer Enabling PDC Force Byte Transfer allows the PDC to manage with internal byte transfers, so that transfer of blocks with a size different from modulo 4 can be supported. Warning: BLKLEN value depends on PDCFBYTE. 0 = Disables PDC Force Byte Transfer. PDC type of transfer are in words. 1 = Enables PDC Force Byte Transfer. PDC type of transfer are in bytes. * PDCPADV: PDC Padding Value 0 = 0x00 value is used when padding data in write transfer (not only PDC transfer). 1 = 0xFF value is used when padding data in write transfer (not only PDC transfer).
633
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* PDCMODE: PDC-oriented Mode 0 = Disables PDC transfer 1 = Enables PDC transfer. In this case, UNRE and OVRE flags in the MCI Mode Register (MCI_SR) are deactivated after the PDC transfer has been completed. * BLKLEN: Data Block Length This field determines the size of the data block. This field is also accessible in the MCI Block Register (MCI_BLKR). Bits 16 and 17 must be set to 0 if PDCFBYTE is disabled.
Note: In SDIO Byte mode, BLKLEN field is not used.
634
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.3 Name: MCI Data Timeout Register MCI_DTOR Read/write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
DTOMUL
DTOCYC
* DTOCYC: Data Timeout Cycle Number * DTOMUL: Data Timeout Multiplier These fields determine the maximum number of Master Clock cycles that the MCI waits between two data block transfers. It equals (DTOCYC x Multiplier). Multiplier is defined by DTOMUL as shown in the following table:
DTOMUL 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Multiplier 1 16 128 256 1024 4096 65536 1048576
If the data time-out set by DTOCYC and DTOMUL has been exceeded, the Data Time-out Error flag (DTOE) in the MCI Status Register (MCI_SR) raises.
635
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.4 Name:
MCI SDCard/SDIO Register MCI_SDCR Read/write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
SDCBUS
-
-
-
-
-
SDCSEL
* SDCSEL: SDCard/SDIO Slot
SDCSEL 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 SDCard/SDIO Slot
Slot A is selected.
Slot B selected Reserved Reserved
* SDCBUS: SDCard/SDIO Bus Width 0 = 1-bit data bus 1 = 4-bit data bus
636
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.5 Name: MCI Argument Register MCI_ARGR Read/write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
ARG
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
ARG
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
ARG
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
ARG
* ARG: Command Argument
637
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.6 Name:
MCI Command Register MCI_CMDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18 17
IOSPCMD
16
-
15
-
14 13
TRTYP
12 11
TRDIR
10 9
TRCMD
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
MAXLAT
4
OPDCMD
3 2
SPCMD
1 0
RSPTYP
CMDNB
This register is write-protected while CMDRDY is 0 in MCI_SR. If an Interrupt command is sent, this register is only writeable by an interrupt response (field SPCMD). This means that the current command execution cannot be interrupted or modified. * CMDNB: Command Number * RSPTYP: Response Type
RSP 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Response Type No response. 48-bit response. 136-bit response. Reserved.
* SPCMD: Special Command
SPCMD 0 0 0 0 0 1 Command Not a special CMD. Initialization CMD: 74 clock cycles for initialization sequence. Synchronized CMD: Wait for the end of the current data block transfer before sending the pending command. Reserved. Interrupt command: Corresponds to the Interrupt Mode (CMD40). Interrupt response: Corresponds to the Interrupt Mode (CMD40).
0 0 1 1
1 1 0 0
0 1 0 1
* OPDCMD: Open Drain Command 0 = Push pull command 1 = Open drain command
638
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* MAXLAT: Max Latency for Command to Response 0 = 5-cycle max latency 1 = 64-cycle max latency * TRCMD: Transfer Command
TRCMD 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Transfer Type No data transfer Start data transfer Stop data transfer Reserved
* TRDIR: Transfer Direction 0 = Write 1 = Read * TRTYP: Transfer Type
TRTYP 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Transfer Type MMC/SDCard Single Block MMC/SDCard Multiple Block MMC Stream Reserved SDIO Byte SDIO Block Reserved Reserved
* IOSPCMD: SDIO Special Command
IOSPCMD 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 SDIO Special Command Type Not a SDIO Special Command SDIO Suspend Command SDIO Resume Command Reserved
639
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.7 Name:
MCI Block Register MCI_BLKR Read/write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
BLKLEN
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
BLKLEN
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
BCNT
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
BCNT
* BCNT: MMC/SDIO Block Count - SDIO Byte Count This field determines the number of data byte(s) or block(s) to transfer. The transfer data type and the authorized values for BCNT field are determined by the TRTYP field in the MCI Command Register (MCI_CMDR):
TRTYP 0 1 1 0 0 0 Other values 1 0 1 Type of Transfer MMC/SDCard Multiple Block SDIO Byte SDIO Block BCNT Authorized Values From 1 to 65536: Value 0 corresponds to an infinite block transfer. From 1 to 512 bytes: value 0 corresponds to a 512-byte transfer. Values from 0x200 to 0xFFFF are forbidden. From 1 to 511 blocks: value 0 corresponds to an infinite block transfer. Values from 0x200 to 0xFFFF are forbidden. Reserved.
Warning: In SDIO Byte and Block modes, writing to the 7 last bits of BCNT field, is forbidden and may lead to unpredictable results. * BLKLEN: Data Block Length This field determines the size of the data block. This field is also accessible in the MCI Mode Register (MCI_MR). Bits 16 and 17 must be set to 0 if PDCFBYTE is disabled.
Note: In SDIO Byte mode, BLKLEN field is not used.
640
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.8 Name: MCI Response Register MCI_RSPR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
RSP
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
RSP
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
RSP
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
RSP
* RSP: Response
Note: 1. The response register can be read by N accesses at the same MCI_RSPR or at consecutive addresses (0x20 to 0x2C). N depends on the size of the response.
641
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.9 Name:
MCI Receive Data Register MCI_RDR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
DATA
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
DATA
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
DATA
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
DATA
* DATA: Data to Read 38.9.10 Name: MCI Transmit Data Register MCI_TDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
DATA
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
DATA
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
DATA
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
DATA
* DATA: Data to Write
642
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.11 Name: MCI Status Register MCI_SR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
UNRE
23
OVRE
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
DTOE
14
DCRCE
13
RTOE
12
RENDE
11
RCRCE
10
RDIRE
9
RINDE
8
TXBUFE
7
RXBUFF
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
SDIOIRQB
1
SDIOIRQA
0
ENDTX
ENDRX
NOTBUSY
DTIP
BLKE
TXRDY
RXRDY
CMDRDY
* CMDRDY: Command Ready 0 = A command is in progress. 1 = The last command has been sent. Cleared when writing in the MCI_CMDR. * RXRDY: Receiver Ready 0 = Data has not yet been received since the last read of MCI_RDR. 1 = Data has been received since the last read of MCI_RDR. * TXRDY: Transmit Ready 0= The last data written in MCI_TDR has not yet been transferred in the Shift Register. 1= The last data written in MCI_TDR has been transferred in the Shift Register. * BLKE: Data Block Ended This flag must be used only for Write Operations. 0 = A data block transfer is not yet finished. Cleared when reading the MCI_SR. 1 = A data block transfer has ended, including the CRC16 Status transmission. In PDC mode (PDCMODE=1), the flag is set when the CRC Status of the last block has been transmitted (TXBUFE already set). Otherwise (PDCMODE=0), the flag is set for each transmitted CRC Status. Refer to the MMC or SD Specification for more details concerning the CRC Status. * DTIP: Data Transfer in Progress 0 = No data transfer in progress. 1 = The current data transfer is still in progress, including CRC16 calculation. Cleared at the end of the CRC16 calculation. * NOTBUSY: MCI Not Busy This flag must be used only for Write Operations. A block write operation uses a simple busy signalling of the write operation duration on the data (DAT0) line: during a data transfer block, if the card does not have a free data receive buffer, the card indicates this condition by pulling down the data line (DAT0) to LOW. The card stops pulling down the data line as soon as at least one receive buffer for the defined data transfer block length becomes free. The NOTBUSY flag allows to deal with these different states.
643
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
0 = The MCI is not ready for new data transfer. Cleared at the end of the card response. 1 = The MCI is ready for new data transfer. Set when the busy state on the data line has ended. This corresponds to a free internal data receive buffer of the card. Refer to the MMC or SD Specification for more details concerning the busy behavior. * ENDRX: End of RX Buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in MCI_RCR or MCI_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in MCI_RCR or MCI_RNCR. * ENDTX: End of TX Buffer 0 = The Transmit Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in MCI_TCR or MCI_TNCR. 1 = The Transmit Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in MCI_TCR or MCI_TNCR.
Note: BLKE and NOTBUSY flags can be used to check that the data has been successfully transmitted on the data lines and not only transferred from the PDC to the MCI Controller.
* RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = MCI_RCR or MCI_RNCR has a value other than 0. 1 = Both MCI_RCR and MCI_RNCR have a value of 0. * TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = MCI_TCR or MCI_TNCR has a value other than 0. 1 = Both MCI_TCR and MCI_TNCR have a value of 0.
Note: BLKE and NOTBUSY flags can be used to check that the data has been successfully transmitted on the data lines and not only transferred from the PDC to the MCI Controller.
* RINDE: Response Index Error 0 = No error. 1 = A mismatch is detected between the command index sent and the response index received. Cleared when writing in the MCI_CMDR. * RDIRE: Response Direction Error 0 = No error. 1 = The direction bit from card to host in the response has not been detected. * RCRCE: Response CRC Error 0 = No error. 1 = A CRC7 error has been detected in the response. Cleared when writing in the MCI_CMDR. * RENDE: Response End Bit Error 0 = No error. 1 = The end bit of the response has not been detected. Cleared when writing in the MCI_CMDR. * RTOE: Response Time-out Error 0 = No error. 1 = The response time-out set by MAXLAT in the MCI_CMDR has been exceeded. Cleared when writing in the MCI_CMDR.
644
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* DCRCE: Data CRC Error 0 = No error. 1 = A CRC16 error has been detected in the last data block. Reset by reading in the MCI_SR register. * DTOE: Data Time-out Error 0 = No error. 1 = The data time-out set by DTOCYC and DTOMUL in MCI_DTOR has been exceeded. Reset by reading in the MCI_SR register. * OVRE: Overrun 0 = No error. 1 = At least one 8-bit received data has been lost (not read). Cleared when sending a new data transfer command. * UNRE: Underrun 0 = No error. 1 = At least one 8-bit data has been sent without valid information (not written). Cleared when sending a new data transfer command. * SDIOIRQA: SDIO Interrupt for Slot A 0 = No interrupt detected on SDIO Slot A. 1 = A SDIO Interrupt on Slot A has reached. Cleared when reading the MCI_SR. * SDIOIRQB: SDIO Interrupt for Slot B 0 = No interrupt detected on SDIO Slot B. 1 = A SDIO Interrupt on Slot B has reached. Cleared when reading the MCI_SR. * RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = MCI_RCR or MCI_RNCR has a value other than 0. 1 = Both MCI_RCR and MCI_RNCR have a value of 0. * TXBUFE: TX Buffer Empty 0 = MCI_TCR or MCI_TNCR has a value other than 0. 1 = Both MCI_TCR and MCI_TNCR have a value of 0.
645
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.12 Name:
MCI Interrupt Enable Register MCI_IER Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
UNRE
23
OVRE
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
DTOE
14
DCRCE
13
RTOE
12
RENDE
11
RCRCE
10
RDIRE
9
RINDE
8
TXBUFE
7
RXBUFF
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
SDIOIRQB
1
SDIOIRQA
0
ENDTX
ENDRX
NOTBUSY
DTIP
BLKE
TXRDY
RXRDY
CMDRDY
* CMDRDY: Command Ready Interrupt Enable * RXRDY: Receiver Ready Interrupt Enable * TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Enable * BLKE: Data Block Ended Interrupt Enable * DTIP: Data Transfer in Progress Interrupt Enable * NOTBUSY: Data Not Busy Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Enable * SDIOIRQA: SDIO Interrupt for Slot A Interrupt Enable * SDIOIRQB: SDIO Interrupt for Slot B Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable * RINDE: Response Index Error Interrupt Enable * RDIRE: Response Direction Error Interrupt Enable * RCRCE: Response CRC Error Interrupt Enable * RENDE: Response End Bit Error Interrupt Enable * RTOE: Response Time-out Error Interrupt Enable * DCRCE: Data CRC Error Interrupt Enable * DTOE: Data Time-out Error Interrupt Enable * OVRE: Overrun Interrupt Enable * UNRE: UnderRun Interrupt Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt. 646
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
38.9.13 Name: MCI Interrupt Disable Register MCI_IDR Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
UNRE
23
OVRE
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
DTOE
14
DCRCE
13
RTOE
12
RENDE
11
RCRCE
10
RDIRE
9
RINDE
8
TXBUFE
7
RXBUFF
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
SDIOIRQB
1
SDIOIRQA
0
ENDTX
ENDRX
NOTBUSY
DTIP
BLKE
TXRDY
RXRDY
CMDRDY
* CMDRDY: Command Ready Interrupt Disable * RXRDY: Receiver Ready Interrupt Disable * TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Disable * BLKE: Data Block Ended Interrupt Disable * DTIP: Data Transfer in Progress Interrupt Disable * NOTBUSY: Data Not Busy Interrupt Disable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Disable * SDIOIRQA: SDIO Interrupt for Slot A Interrupt Disable * SDIOIRQB: SDIO Interrupt for Slot B Interrupt Disable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Disable * RINDE: Response Index Error Interrupt Disable * RDIRE: Response Direction Error Interrupt Disable * RCRCE: Response CRC Error Interrupt Disable * RENDE: Response End Bit Error Interrupt Disable * RTOE: Response Time-out Error Interrupt Disable * DCRCE: Data CRC Error Interrupt Disable * DTOE: Data Time-out Error Interrupt Disable * OVRE: Overrun Interrupt Disable * UNRE: UnderRun Interrupt Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt. 647
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
38.9.14 Name:
MCI Interrupt Mask Register MCI_IMR Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
UNRE
23
OVRE
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
DTOE
14
DCRCE
13
RTOE
12
RENDE
11
RCRCE
10
RDIRE
9
RINDE
8
TXBUFE
7
RXBUFF
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
SDIOIRQB
1
SDIOIRQA
0
ENDTX
ENDRX
NOTBUSY
DTIP
BLKE
TXRDY
RXRDY
CMDRDY
* CMDRDY: Command Ready Interrupt Mask * RXRDY: Receiver Ready Interrupt Mask * TXRDY: Transmit Ready Interrupt Mask * BLKE: Data Block Ended Interrupt Mask * DTIP: Data Transfer in Progress Interrupt Mask * NOTBUSY: Data Not Busy Interrupt Mask * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask * ENDTX: End of Transmit Buffer Interrupt Mask * SDIOIRQA: SDIO Interrupt for Slot A Interrupt Mask * SDIOIRQB: SDIO Interrupt for Slot B Interrupt Mask * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Mask * RINDE: Response Index Error Interrupt Mask * RDIRE: Response Direction Error Interrupt Mask * RCRCE: Response CRC Error Interrupt Mask * RENDE: Response End Bit Error Interrupt Mask * RTOE: Response Time-out Error Interrupt Mask * DCRCE: Data CRC Error Interrupt Mask * DTOE: Data Time-out Error Interrupt Mask * OVRE: Overrun Interrupt Mask * UNRE: UnderRun Interrupt Mask 0 = The corresponding interrupt is not enabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled. 648
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39. LCD Controller (LCDC)
39.1 Description
The LCD Controller (LCDC) consists of logic for transferring LCD image data from an external display buffer to an LCD module with integrated common and segment drivers. The LCD Controller supports single and double scan monochrome and color passive STN LCD modules and single scan active TFT LCD modules. On monochrome STN displays, up to 16 gray shades are supported using a time-based dithering algorithm and Frame Rate Control (FRC) method. This method is also used in color STN displays to generate up to 4096 colors. The LCD Controller has a display input buffer (FIFO) to allow a flexible connection of the external AHB master interface, and a lookup table to allow palletized display configurations. The LCD Controller is programmable in order to support many different requirements such as resolutions up to 2048 x 2048; pixel depth (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 24 bits per pixel); data line width (4, 8, 16 or 24 bits) and interface timing. The LCD Controller is connected to the ARM Advanced High Performance Bus (AHB) as a master for reading pixel data. However, the LCD Controller interfaces with the AHB as a slave in order to configure its registers.
649
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.2
Block Diagram
Figure 39-1. LCD Macrocell Block Diagram
AHB MASTER
AHB SLAVE
DMA Controller
SPLIT
AHB IF CFG
AHB SLAVE DMA Data Dvalid Dvalid
CH-U
Upper Push
CH-L
Lower Push
CTRL
Input Interface
LCD Controller Core
FIFO
Configuration IF
CFG
AHB SLAVE
SERIALIZER
DATAPATH
LUT Mem Interface
PALETTE
LUT Mem Interface FIFO Mem Interface
DITHERING
Control Interface
FIFO MEM OUTPUT SHIFTER
LUT MEM
Timegen
LCDD
DISPLAY IF Control signals
Display
PWM
DISPLAY IF
650
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.3 I/O Lines Description
I/O Lines Description
Description Contrast control signal Line synchronous signal (STN) or Horizontal synchronous signal (TFT) LCD clock signal (STN/TFT) Frame synchronous signal (STN) or Vertical synchronization signal (TFT) Data enable signal LCD Data Bus output Type Output Output Output Output Output Output
Table 39-1.
Name LCDCC LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDD[23:0]
39.4
39.4.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the LCD Controller may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO Controller to assign the pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the LCD Controller are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO Controller.
39.4.2
Power Management The LCD Controller is not continuously clocked. The user must first enable the LCD Controller clock in the Power Management Controller before using it (PMC_PCER). Interrupt Sources The LCD Controller interrupt line is connected to one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the LCD Controller interrupt requires prior programming of the AIC.
39.4.3
39.5
Functional Description
The LCD Controller consists of two main blocks (Figure 39-1 on page 650), the DMA controller and the LCD controller core (LCDC core). The DMA controller reads the display data from an external memory through a AHB master interface. The LCD controller core formats the display data. The LCD controller core continuously pumps the pixel data into the LCD module via the LCD data bus (LCDD[23:0]); this bus is timed by the LCDDOTCK, LCDDEN, LCDHSYNC, and LCDVSYNC signals.
39.5.1 39.5.1.1
DMA Controller Configuration Block The configuration block is a set of programmable registers that are used to configure the DMA controller operation. These registers are written via the AHB slave interface. Only word access is allowed. For details on the configuration registers, see "LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface" on page 677.
39.5.1.2
AHB Interface This block generates the AHB transactions. It generates undefined-length incrementing bursts as well as 4-, 8- or 16-beat incrementing bursts. The size of the transfer can be configured in the 651
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
BRSTLN field of the DMAFRMCFG register. For details on this register, see "DMA Frame Configuration Register" on page 682. 39.5.1.3 Channel-U This block stores the base address and the number of words transferred for this channel (frame in single scan mode and Upper Panel in dual scan mode) since the beginning of the frame. It also generates the end of frame signal. It has two pointers, the base address and the number of words to transfer. When the module receives a new_frame signal, it reloads the number of words to transfer pointer with the size of the frame/panel. When the module receives the new_frame signal, it also reloads the base address with the base address programmed by the host. The size of the frame/panel can be programmed in the FRMSIZE field of the DMAFRMCFG Register. This size is calculated as follows: X_size*Y_size Frame_size = ------------------------------------32 X_size = ((LINESIZE+1)*Bpp+PIXELOFF)/32 Y_size = (LINEVAL+1)
* LINESIZE is the horizontal size of the display in pixels, minus 1, as programmed in the LINESIZE field of the LCDFRMCFG register of the LCD Controller. * Bpp is the number of bits per pixel configured. * PIXELOFF is the pixel offset for 2D addressing, as programmed in the DMA2DCFG register. Applicable only if 2D addressing is being used. * LINEVAL is the vertical size of the display in pixels, minus 1, as programmed in the LINEVAL field of the LCDFRMCFG register of the LCD Controller.
Note: X_size is calculated as an up-rounding of a division by 32. (This can also be done adding 31 to the dividend before using an integer division by 32). When using the 2D-addressing mode (see "2D Memory Addressing" on page 674), it is important to note that the above calculation must be executed and the FRMSIZE field programmed with every movement of the displaying window, since a change in the PIXELOFF field can change the resulting FRMSIZE value.
39.5.1.4
Channel-L This block has the same functionality as Channel-U, but for the Lower Panel in dual scan mode only.
39.5.1.5
Control This block receives the request signals from the LCDC core and generates the requests for the channels.
652
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.5.2 39.5.2.1 LCD Controller Core Configuration Block The configuration block is a set of programmable registers that are used to configure the LCDC core operation. These registers are written via the AHB slave interface. Only word access is allowed. The description of the configuration registers can be found in "LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface" on page 677. 39.5.2.2 Datapath The datapath block contains five submodules: FIFO, Serializer, Palette, Dithering and Shifter. The structure of the datapath is shown in Figure 39-2. Figure 39-2. Datapath Structure
Input Interface
FIFO
Serializer Configuration IF
Palette
Control Interface Dithering
Output Shifter
Output Interface
This module transforms the data read from the memory into a format according to the LCD module used. It has four different interfaces: the input interface, the output interface, the configuration interface and the control interface. * The input interface connects the datapath with the DMA controller. It is a dual FIFO interface with a data bus and two push lines that are used by the DMA controller to fill the FIFOs.
653
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* The output interface is a 24-bit data bus. The configuration of this interface depends on the type of LCD used (TFT or STN, Single or Dual Scan, 4-bit, 8-bit, 16-bit or 24-bit interface). * The configuration interface connects the datapath with the configuration block. It is used to select between the different datapath configurations. * The control interface connects the datapath with the timing generation block. The main control signal is the data-request signal, used by the timing generation module to request new data from the datapath. The datapath can be characterized by two parameters: initial_latency and cycles_per_data. The parameter initial_latency is defined as the number of LCDC Core Clock cycles until the first data is available at the output of the datapath. The parameter cycles_per_data is the minimum number of LCDC Core clock cycles between two consecutive data at the output interface. These parameters are different for the different configurations of the LCD Controller and are shown in Table 39-2. Table 39-2. Datapath Parameters
Configuration DISTYPE TFT STN Mono STN Mono STN Mono STN Mono STN Color STN Color STN Color STN Color Single Single Dual Dual Single Single Dual Dual 4 8 8 16 4 8 8 16 SCAN IFWIDTH initial_latency 9 13 17 17 25 11 12 14 15 cycles_per_data 1 4 8 8 16 2 3 4 6
39.5.2.3
FIFO The FIFO block buffers the input data read by the DMA module. It contains two input FIFOs to be used in Dual Scan configuration that are configured as a single FIFO when used in single scan configuration. The size of the FIFOs allows a wide range of architectures to be supported. The upper threshold of the FIFOs can be configured in the FIFOTH field of the LCDFIFO register. The LCDC core will request a DMA transfer when the number of words in each FIFO is less than FIFOTH words. To avoid overwriting in the FIFO and to maximize the FIFO utilization, the FIFOTH should be programmed with: FIFOTH (in words) = 512 - (2 x DMA_BURST_LENGTH + 3) where: * 512 is the effective size of the FIFO in words. It is the total FIFO memory size in single scan mode and half that size in dual scan mode. * DMA_burst_length is the burst length of the transfers made by the DMA in words.
654
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.5.2.4 Serializer This block serializes the data read from memory. It reads words from the FIFO and outputs pixels (1 bit, 2 bits, 4 bits, 8 bits, 16 bits or 24 bits wide) depending on the format specified in the PIXELSIZE field of the LCDCON2 register. It also adapts the memory-ordering format. Both bigendian and little-endian formats are supported. They are configured in the MEMOR field of the LCDCON2 register. The organization of the pixel data in the memory depends on the configuration and is shown in Table 39-3 and Table 39-4.
Note: For a color depth of 24 bits per pixel there are two different formats supported: packed and unpacked. The packed format needs less memory but has some limitations when working in 2D addressing mode (See "2D Memory Addressing" on page 674.).
Table 39-3.
Mem Addr
Little Endian Memory Organization
0x3 0x2 0x1 8 8 4 2 1 0 7 7 6 6 3 1 0 5 5 4 4 2 0x0 3 3 2 2 1 0 1 1 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Pixel 1bpp 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Pixel 2bpp Pixel 4bpp Pixel 8bpp Pixel 16bpp Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp unpacked not used 0 3 2 1 15 7 3 1 14 13 6 12 11 5 2 10 9 4 8 7 3 6 5
0
1
2
655
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 39-4.
Mem Addr
Big Endian Memory Organization
0x3 0x2 0x1 8 7 6 5 4 0x0 3 2 1 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Pixel 1bpp Pixel 2bpp Pixel 4bpp Pixel 8bpp Pixel 16bpp Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp unpacked not used 0 4 2 3 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 2 3 1 4 5 2 1 6 7 3 8 9 4 2 1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 5 6 3 7 8 4 2 1 9 10 5 11 12 6 3 13 14 7 15
0
1
2
5
656
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 39-5.
Mem Addr
WinCE Pixel Memory Organization
0x3 0x2 0x1 8 7 6 1 0 0 0 0 5 2 4 3 1 0x0 3 4 2 5 3 1 1 6 0 7 3
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Pixel 1bpp Pixel 2bpp Pixel 4bpp Pixel 8bpp Pixel 16bpp Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp packed Pixel 24bpp unpacked not used 0 3 2 1 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 8 12 6 3 1 13 14 7 15 8 4 2 9 10 5 11 9 4 2 1
10 11 12 13 14 15 0 5 6 3 7
0
1
2
39.5.2.5
Palette This block is used to generate the pixel gray or color information in palletized configurations. The different modes with the palletized/non-palletized configuration can be found in Table 39-6. In these modes, 1, 2, 4 or 8 input bits index an entry in the lookup table. The corresponding entry in the lookup table contains the color or gray shade information for the pixel. Table 39-6. Palette Configurations
Configuration DISTYPE TFT TFT STN Mono STN Mono STN Color STN Color PIXELSIZE 1, 2, 4, 8 16, 24 1, 2 4 1, 2, 4, 8 16 Palette Palletized Non-palletized Palletized Non-palletized Palletized Non-palletized
The lookup table can be accessed by the host in R/W mode to allow the host to program and check the values stored in the palette. It is mapped in the LCD controller configuration memory map. The LUT is mapped as 16-bit half-words aligned at word boundaries, only word write
657
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
access is allowed (the 16 MSB of the bus are not used). For the detailed memory map, see Table 39-13 on page 677. The lookup table contains 256 16-bit wide entries. The 256 entries are chosen by the programmer from the 216 possible combinations. For the structure of each LUT entry, see Table 39-7. Table 39-7.
Address 00 01 ... FE FF Intensity_bit_254 Intensity_bit_255 Blue_value_254[4:0] Blue_value_255[4:0] Green_value_254[4:0] Green_value_255[4:0] Red_value_254[4:0] Red_value_255[4:0] Intensity_bit_0 Intensity_bit_1 Blue_value_0[4:0] Blue_value_1[4:0]
Lookup Table Structure in the Memory
Data Output [15:0] Green_value_0[4:0] Green_value_1[4:0] Red_value_0[4:0] Red_value_1[4:0]
In STN Monochrome, only the four most significant bits of the red value are used (16 gray shades). In STN Color, only the four most significant bits of the blue, green and red value are used (4096 colors). In TFT mode, all the bits in the blue, green and red values are used (32768 colors). In this mode, there is also a common intensity bit that can be used to double the possible colors. This bit is the least significant bit of each color component in the LCDD interface (LCDD[18], LCDD[10], LCDD[2]). The LCDD unused bits are tied to 0 when TFT palletized configurations are used (LCDD[17:16], LCDD[9:8], LCDD[1:0]). 39.5.2.6 Dithering The dithering block is used to generate the shades of gray or color when the LCD Controller is used with an STN LCD Module. It uses a time-based dithering algorithm and Frame Rate Control method. The Frame Rate Control varies the duty cycle for which a given pixel is turned on, giving the display an appearance of multiple shades. In order to reduce the flicker noise caused by turning on and off adjacent pixels at the same time, a time-based dithering algorithm is used to vary the pattern of adjacent pixels every frame. This algorithm is expressed in terms of Dithering Pattern registers (DP_i) and considers not only the pixel gray level number, but also its horizontal coordinate. Table 39-8 shows the correspondences between the gray levels and the duty cycle. Table 39-8.
Gray Level 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
Dithering Duty Cycle
Duty Cycle 1 6/7 4/5 3/4 5/7 2/3 3/5 Pattern Register DP6_7 DP4_5 DP3_4 DP5_7 DP2_3 DP3_5
658
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 39-8.
Gray Level 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Dithering Duty Cycle
Duty Cycle 4/7 1/2 3/7 2/5 1/3 1/4 1/5 1/7 0 Pattern Register DP4_7 ~DP1_2 ~DP4_7 ~DP3_5 ~DP2_3 ~DP3_4 ~DP4_5 ~DP6_7 -
The duty cycles for gray levels 0 and 15 are 0 and 1, respectively. The same DP_i register can be used for the pairs for which the sum of duty cycles is 1 (e.g., 1/7 and 6/7). The dithering pattern for the first pair member is the inversion of the one for the second. The DP_i registers contain a series of 4-bit patterns. The (3-m)th bit of the pattern determines if a pixel with horizontal coordinate x = 4n + m (n is an integer and m ranges from 0 to 3) should be turned on or off in the current frame. The operation is shown by the examples below. Consider the pixels a, b, c and d with the horizontal coordinates 4*n+0, 4*n+1, 4*n+2 and 4*n+3, respectively. The four pixels should be displayed in gray level 9 (duty cycle 3/5) so the register used is DP3_5 ="1010 0101 1010 0101 1111". The output sequence obtained in the data output for monochrome mode is shown in Table 39-9. Table 39-9.
Frame Number N N+1 N+2 N+3 N+4 N+5 N+6 N+7 ...
Dithering Algorithm for Monochrome Mode
Pattern 1010 0101 1010 0101 1111 1010 0101 1010 ... Pixel a ON OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF ON ... Pixel b OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF ON OFF ... Pixel c ON OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF ON ... Pixel d OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF ON OFF ...
Consider now color display mode and two pixels p0 and p1 with the horizontal coordinates 4*n+0, and 4*n+1. A color pixel is composed of three components: {R, G, B}. Pixel p0 will be displayed sending the color components {R0, G0, B0} to the display. Pixel p1 will be displayed sending the color components {R1, G1, B1}. Suppose that the data read from memory and mapped to the lookup tables corresponds to shade level 10 for the three color components of
659
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
both pixels, with the dithering pattern to apply to all of them being DP2_3 = "1101 1011 0110". Table 39-10 shows the output sequence in the data output bus for single scan configurations. (In Dual Scan Configuration, each panel data bus acts like in the equivalent single scan configuration.) Table 39-10. Dithering Algorithm for Color Mode
Frame N N N N N N ... N+1 N+1 N+1 N+1 N+1 N+1 ... N+2 N+2 N+2 N+2 N+2 N+2 ... Note: Signal red_data_0 green_data_0 blue_data_0 red_data_1 green_data_1 blue_data_1 ... red_data_0 green_data_0 blue_data_0 red_data_1 green_data_1 blue_data_1 ... red_data_0 green_data_0 blue_data_0 red_data_1 green_data_1 blue_data_1 ... Shadow Level 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 ... 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 ... 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 ... Bit used 3 2 1 0 3 2 ... 3 2 1 0 3 2 ... 3 2 1 0 3 2 ... Dithering Pattern 1101 1101 1101 1101 1101 1101 ... 1011 1011 1011 1011 1011 1011 ... 0110 0110 0110 0110 0110 0110 ... 4-bit LCDD LCDD[3] LCDD[2] LCDD[1] LCDD[0] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... LCDD[3] LCDD[2] LCDD[1] LCDD[0] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... LCDD[3] LCDD[2] LCDD[1] LCDD[0] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... 8-bit LCDD LCDD[7] LCDD[6] LCDD[5] LCDD[4] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... LCDD[7] LCDD[6] LCDD[5] LCDD[4] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... LCDD[7] LCDD[6] LCDD[5] LCDD[4] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] ... Output R0 G0 b0 R1 G1 B1 ... R0 g0 B0 R1 G1 b1 ... r0 G0 B0 r1 g1 B1 ...
Ri = red pixel component ON. Gi = green pixel component ON. Bi = blue pixel component ON. ri = red pixel component OFF. gi = green pixel component OFF. bi = blue pixel component OFF.
39.5.2.7
Shifter The FIFO, Serializer, Palette and Dithering modules process one pixel at a time in monochrome mode and three sub-pixels at a time in color mode (R,G,B components). This module packs the data according to the output interface. This interface can be programmed in the DISTYPE, SCANMOD, and IFWIDTH fields of the LDCCON3 register. The DISTYPE field selects between TFT, STN monochrome and STN color display. The SCANMODE field selects between single and dual scan modes; in TFT mode, only single scan is supported. The IFWIDTH field configures the width of the interface in STN mode: 4-bit (in single scan mode only), 8-bit and 16-bit (in dual scan mode only). For a more detailed description of the fields, see "LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface" on page 677.
660
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
For a more detailed description of the LCD Interface, see "LCD Interface" on page 666. 39.5.2.8 Timegen The time generator block generates the control signals LCDDOTCK, LCDHSYNC, LCDVSYNC, LCDDEN, used by the LCD module. This block is programmable in order to support different types of LCD modules and obtain the output clock signals, which are derived from the LCDC Core clock.
The LCDDOTCK signal is used to clock the data into the LCD drivers' shift register. The data is sent through LCDD[23:0] synchronized by default with LCDDOTCK falling edge (rising edge can be selected). The CLKVAL field of LCDCON1 register controls the rate of this signal. The divisor can also be bypassed with the BYPASS bit in the LCDCON1 register. In this case, the rate of LCDDOTCK is equal to the frequency of the LCDC Core clock. The minimum period of the LCDDOTCK signal depends on the configuration. This information can be found in Table 39-11. f LCDC_clock f LCDDOTCK = -------------------------------2 x CLKVAL The LCDDOTCK signal has two different timings that are selected with the CLKMOD field of the LCDCON2 register: * Always Active (used with TFT LCD Modules) * Active only when data is available (used with STN LCD Modules)
Table 39-11. Minimum LCDDOTCK Period in LCDC Core Clock Cycles
Configuration DISTYPE TFT STN Mono STN Mono STN Mono STN Mono STN Color STN Color STN Color STN Color Single Single Dual Dual Single Single Dual Dual 4 8 8 16 4 8 8 16 SCAN IFWIDTH LCDDOTCK Period 1 4 8 8 16 2 2 4 6
The LCDDEN signal indicates valid data in the LCD Interface. After each horizontal line of data has been shifted into the LCD, the LCDHSYNC is asserted to cause the line to be displayed on the panel. The following timing parameters can be configured:
661
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* Vertical to Horizontal Delay (VHDLY): The delay between begin_of_line and the generation of LCDHSYNC is configurable in the VHDLY field of the LCDTIM1 register. The delay is equal to (VHDLY+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. * Horizontal Pulse Width (HPW): The LCDHSYNC pulse width is configurable in HPW field of LCDTIM2 register. The width is equal to (HPW + 1) LCDDOTCK cycles. * Horizontal Back Porch (HBP): The delay between the LCDHSYNC falling edge and the first LCDDOTCK rising edge with valid data at the LCD Interface is configurable in the HBP field of the LCDTIM2 register. The delay is equal to (HBP+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. * Horizontal Front Porch (HFP): The delay between end of valid data and the end of the line is configurable in the HFP field of the LCDTIM2 register. The delay is equal to (HFP+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. There is a limitation in the minimum values of VHDLY, HPW and HBP parameters imposed by the initial latency of the datapath. The total delay in LCDC clock cycles must be higher than or equal to the latency column in Table 39-2 on page 654. This limitation is given by the following formula: 39.5.2.9 Equation 1 ( VHDLY + HPW + HBP + 3 ) x PCLK_PERIOD DPATH_LATENCY where: * VHDLY, HPW, HBP are the value of the fields of LCDTIM1 and LCDTIM2 registers * PCLK_PERIOD is the period of LCDDOTCK signal measured in LCDC Clock cycles * DPATH_LATENCY is the datapath latency of the configuration, given in Table 39-2 on page 654 The LCDVSYNC is asserted once per frame. This signal is asserted to cause the LCD's line pointer to start over at the top of the display. The timing of this signal depends on the type of LCD: STN or TFT LCD. In STN mode, the high phase corresponds to the complete first line of the frame. In STN mode, this signal is synchronized with the first active LCDDOTCK rising edge in a line. In TFT mode, the high phase of this signal starts at the beginning of the first line. The following timing parameters can be selected: * Vertical Pulse Width (VPW): LCDVSYNC pulse width is configurable in VPW field of the LCDTIM1 register. The pulse width is equal to (VPW+1) lines. * Vertical Back Porch: Number of inactive lines at the beginning of the frame is configurable in VBP field of LCDTIM1 register. The number of inactive lines is equal to VBP. This field should be programmed with 0 in STN Mode. * Vertical Front Porch: Number of inactive lines at the end of the frame is configurable in VFP field of LCDTIM2 register. The number of inactive lines is equal to VFP. This field should be programmed with 0 in STN mode. There are two other parameters to configure in this module, the HOZVAL and the LINEVAL fields of the LCDFRMCFG: * HOZVAL configures the number of active LCDDOTCK cycles in each line. The number of active cycles in each line is equal to (HOZVAL+1) cycles. The minimum value of this parameter is 1.
662
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* LINEVAL configures the number of active lines per frame. This number is equal to (LINEVAL+1) lines. The minimum value of this parameter is 1. Figure 39-3, Figure 39-4 and Figure 39-5 show the timing of LCDDOTCK, LCDDEN, LCDHSYNC and LCDVSYNC signals:
Figure 39-3. STN Panel Timing, CLKMOD 0
Frame Period LCDVSYNC
LCDHSYNC LCDDEN LCDDOTCK LCDD
Line Period VHDLY+ LCDVSYNC HPW+1 HBP+1 HOZVAL+1 HFP+1
LCDHSYNC LCDDEN LCDDOTCK LCDD 1 PCLK 1/2 PCLK 1/2 PCLK
663
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 39-4. TFT Panel Timing, CLKMOD = 0, VPW = 2, VBP = 2, VFP = 1
Frame Period
(VPW+1) Lines LCDVSYNC Vertical Back Porch = VBP Lines VHDLY+1 LCDHSYNC LCDDEN LCDDOTCK LCDD Vertical Fron t Porch = VFP Lines
Line Period VHDLY+1 LCDVSYNC LCDHSYNC LCDDEN LCDDOTCK LCDD 1 PCLK 1/2 PCLK 1/2 PCLK HPW+1 HBP+1 HOZVAL+1 HFP+1
Figure 39-5. TFT Panel Timing (Line Expanded View), CLKMOD=1
Line Period VHDLY+1 LCDVSYNC LCDHSYNC LCDDEN LCDDOTCK LCDD 1 PCLK 1/2 PCLK 1/2 PCLK HPW+1 HBP+1 HOZVAL+1 HFP+1
Usually the LCD_FRM rate is about 70 Hz to 75 Hz. It is given by the following equation: VHDLY + HPW + HBP + HOZVAL + HFP + 5 1 --------------------------- = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ( VBP + LINEVAL + VFP + 1 ) f LCDDOTCK f LCDVSYNC where: * HOZVAL determines de number of LCDDOTCK cycles per line * LINEVAL determines the number of LCDHSYNC cycles per frame, according to the expressions shown below: In STN Mode: Horizontal_display_size HOZVAL = -------------------------------------------------------------- - 1 Number_data_lines
664
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
LINEVAL = Vertical_display_size - 1
In monochrome mode, Horizontal_display_size is equal to the number of horizontal pixels. The number_data_lines is equal to the number of bits of the interface in single scan mode; number_data_lines is equal to half the bits of the interface in dual scan mode. In color mode, Horizontal_display_size equals three times the number of horizontal pixels. In TFT Mode: HOZVAL = Horizontal_display_size - 1 LINEVAL = Vertical_display_size - 1 The frame rate equation is used first without considering the clock periods added at the end beginning or at the end of each line to determine, approximately, the LCDDOTCK rate: f lcd_pclk = ( HOZVAL + 5 ) x ( f lcd_vsync x ( LINEVAL + 1 ) )
With this value, the CLKVAL is fixed, as well as the corresponding LCDDOTCK rate. Then select VHDLY, HPW and HBP according to the type of LCD used and "Equation 1" on page 662. Finally, the frame rate is adjusted to 70 Hz - 75 Hz with the HFP value: 1 HFP = f LCDDOTCK x -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - ( VHDLY + VPW + VBP + HOZVAL + 5 ) f LCDVSYNC x ( LINEVAL + VBP + VFP + 1 ) The line counting is controlled by the read-only field LINECNT of LCDCON1 register. The LINECNT field decreases by one unit at each falling edge of LCDHSYNC. 39.5.2.10 Display This block is used to configure the polarity of the data and control signals. The polarity of all clock signals can be configured by LCDCON2[12:8] register setting. This block also generates the lcd_pwr signal internally used to control the state of the LCD pins and to turn on and off by software the LCD module.
This signal is controlled by the PWRCON register and respects the number of frames configured in the GUARD_TIME field of PWRCON register (PWRCON[7:1]) between the write access to LCD_PWR field (PWRCON[0]) and the activation/deactivation of lcd_pwr signal. The minimum value for the GUARD_TIME field is one frame. This gives the DMA Controller enough time to fill the FIFOs before the start of data transfer to the LCD. 39.5.2.11 PWM This block generates the LCD contrast control signal (LCDCC) to make possible the control of the display's contrast by software. This is an 8-bit PWM (Pulse Width Modulation) signal that can be converted to an analog voltage with a simple passive filter. The PWM module has a free-running counter whose value is compared against a compare register (CONSTRAST_VAL register). If the value in the counter is less than that in the register, the
665
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
output brings the value of the polarity (POL) bit in the PWM control register: CONTRAST_CTR. Otherwise, the opposite value is output. Thus, a periodic waveform with a pulse width proportional to the value in the compare register is generated. Due to the comparison mechanism, the output pulse has a width between zero and 255 PWM counter cycles. Thus by adding a simple passive filter outside the chip, an analog voltage between 0 and (255/256) x VDD can be obtained (for the positive polarity case, or between (1/256) x VDD and VDD for the negative polarity case). Other voltage values can be obtained by adding active external circuitry. For PWM mode, the frequency of the counter can be adjusted to four different values using field PS of CONTRAST_CTR register. 39.5.3 LCD Interface The LCD Controller interfaces with the LCD Module through the LCD Interface (Table 39-12 on page 671). The Controller supports the following interface configurations: 24-bit TFT single scan, 16-bit STN Dual Scan Mono (Color), 8-bit STN Dual (Single) Scan Mono (Color), 4-bit single scan Mono (Color). A 4-bit single scan STN display uses 4 parallel data lines to shift data to successive single horizontal lines one at a time until the entire frame has been shifted and transferred. The 4 LSB pins of LCD Data Bus (LCDD [3:0]) can be directly connected to the LCD driver; the 20 MSB pins (LCDD [23:4]) are not used. An 8-bit single scan STN display uses 8 parallel data lines to shift data to successive single horizontal lines one at a time until the entire frame has been shifted and transferred. The 8 LSB pins of LCD Data Bus (LCDD [7:0]) can be directly connected to the LCD driver; the 16 MSB pins (LCDD [23:8]) are not used. An 8-bit Dual Scan STN display uses two sets of 4 parallel data lines to shift data to successive upper and lower panel horizontal lines one at a time until the entire frame has been shifted and transferred. The bus LCDD[3:0] is connected to the upper panel data lines and the bus LCDD[7:4] is connected to the lower panel data lines. The rest of the LCD Data Bus lines (LCDD[23:8]) are not used. A 16-bit Dual Scan STN display uses two sets of 8 parallel data lines to shift data to successive upper and lower panel horizontal lines one at a time until the entire frame has been shifted and transferred. The bus LCDD[7:0] is connected to the upper panel data lines and the bus LCDD[15:8] is connected to the lower panel data lines. The rest of the LCD Data Bus lines (LCDD[23:16]) are not used. STN Mono displays require one bit of image data per pixel. STN Color displays require three bits (Red, Green and Blue) of image data per pixel, resulting in a horizontal shift register of length three times the number of pixels per horizontal line. This RGB or Monochrome data is shifted to the LCD driver as consecutive bits via the parallel data lines. A TFT single scan display uses up to 24 parallel data lines to shift data to successive horizontal lines one at a time until the entire frame has been shifted and transferred. The 24 data lines are divided in three bytes that define the color shade of each color component of each pixel. The LCDD bus is split as LCDD[23:16] for the blue component, LCDD[15:8] for the green component and LCDD[7:0] for the red component. If the LCD Module has lower color resolution (fewer bits per color component), only the most significant bits of each component are used.
666
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
All these interfaces are shown in Figure 39-6 to Figure 39-10. Figure 39-6 on page 667 shows the 24-bit single scan TFT display timing; Figure 39-7 on page 667 shows the 4-bit single scan STN display timing for monochrome and color modes; Figure 39-8 on page 668 shows the 8-bit single scan STN display timing for monochrome and color modes; Figure 39-9 on page 669 shows the 8-bit Dual Scan STN display timing for monochrome and color modes; Figure 39-10 on page 670 shows the 16-bit Dual Scan STN display timing for monochrome and color modes. Figure 39-6. TFT Timing (First Line Expanded View)
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDD [24:16] LCDD [15:8] LCDD [7:0]
B0 G0 R0
B1 G1 R1
Figure 39-7. Single Scan Monochrome and Color 4-bit Panel Timing (First Line Expanded View)
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0] P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0] R0 G0 B0 R1 G1 B1 R2 G2
667
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 39-8. Single Scan Monochrome and Color 8-bit Panel Timing (First Line Expanded View)
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4] LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0] P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 P8 P9 P10 P11 P12 P13 P14 P15
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK LCDD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4] LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0] R0 G0 B0 R1 G1 B1 R2 G2 B2 R3 G3 B3 R4 G4 B4 R5
668
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 39-9. Dual Scan Monochrome and Color 8-bit Panel Timing (First Line Expanded View)
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK
Lower Pane
LCDD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4]
Upper Pane
LP0 LP1 L2 L3
LP4 LP5 LP6 LP7
LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0]
UP0 UP4 UP1 UP5 UP2 UP6 UP3 UP7
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK
Lower Pane
LCDD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4]
Upper Pane
LR0 LG0 LB0 LR1
LG1 LB1 LR2 LG2
LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0]
UR0 UG1 UG0 UB1 UB0 UR2 UR1 UG2
669
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 39-10. Dual Scan Monochrome and Color 16-bit Panel Timing (First Line Expanded View)
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LCDHSYNC LCDDOTCK
Lower Panel
LCDD [15] LCDD [14] LCDD [13] LCDD [12] LCDD [11] LCDD [10] LCDD [9] LCDD [8]
Upper Panel
LP0 LP1
LP8 LP9
LP2 LP10 LP3 LP11 LP4 LP12 LP5 LP13 LP6 LP14 LP7 LP15 UP0 UP8 UP1 UP9 UP2 UP10 UP3 UP11 UP4 UP12 UP5 UP13 UP6 UP14 UP7 UP15
LC DD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4] LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0]
LCDVSYNC LCDDEN LC DHSYNC LCDDOTCK
Lower Panel
LCDD [15] LCDD [14] LCDD [13] LCDD [12] LCDD [11] LCDD [10] LCDD [9] LCDD [8]
Upper Panel
LR0
LB2
LG0 LR3 LB0 LR1 LG3 LB3
LG1 LR4 LB1 LR2 LG4 LB4
LG2 LR5 UR0 UB2 UG0 UR3 UB0 UG3 UR1 UB3 UG1 UR4 UB1 UG4 UR2 UB4 UG2 UR5
LCDD [7] LCDD [6] LCDD [5] LCDD [4] LCDD [3] LCDD [2] LCDD [1] LCDD [0]
670
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 39-12. LCD Signal Multiplexing
LCD Data Bus LCDD[23] LCDD[22] LCDD[21] LCDD[20] LCDD[19] LCDD[18] LCDD[17] LCDD[16] LCDD[15] LCDD[14] LCDD[13] LCDD[12] LCDD[11] LCDD[10] LCDD[9] LCDD[8] LCDD[7] LCDD[6] LCDD[5] LCDD[4] LCDD[3] LCDD[2] LCDD[1] LCDD[0] LCD3 LCD2 LCD1 LCD0 LCD7 LCD6 LCD5 LCD4 LCD3 LCD2 LCD1 LCD0 LCDLP3 LCDLP2 LCDLP1 LCDLP0 LCDUP3 LCDUP2 LCDUP1 LCDUP0 LCDLP7 LCDLP6 LCDLP5 LCDLP4 LCDLP3 LCDLP2 LCDLP1 LCDLP0 LCDUP7 LCDUP6 LCDUP5 LCDUP4 LCDUP3 LCDUP2 LCDUP1 LCDUP0 4-bit STN Single Scan (mono, color) 8-bit STN Single Scan (mono, color) 8-bit STN Dual Scan (mono, color) 16-bit STN Dual Scan (mono, color)
24-bit TFT LCD_BLUE7 LCD_BLUE6 LCD_BLUE5 LCD_BLUE4 LCD_BLUE3 LCD_BLUE2 LCD_BLUE1 LCD_BLUE0 LCD_GREEN7 LCD_GREEN6 LCD_GREEN5 LCD_GREEN4 LCD_GREEN3 LCD_GREEN2 LCD_GREEN1 LCD_GREEN0 LCD_RED7 LCD_RED6 LCD_RED5 LCD_RED4 LCD_RED3 LCD_RED2 LCD_RED1 LCD_RED0
16-bit TFT LCD_BLUE4 LCD_BLUE3 LCD_BLUE2 LCD_BLUE1 LCD_BLUE0 Intensity Bit
LCD_GREEN4 LCD_GREEN3 LCD_GREEN2 LCD_GREEN1 LCD_GREEN0 Intensity Bit
LCD_RED4 LCD_RED3 LCD_RED2 LCD_RED1 LCD_RED0 Intensity Bit
671
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.6
Interrupts
The LCD Controller generates six different IRQs. All the IRQs are synchronized with the internal LCD Core Clock. The IRQs are: * DMA Memory error IRQ. Generated when the DMA receives an error response from an AHB slave while it is doing a data transfer. * FIFO underflow IRQ. Generated when the Serializer tries to read a word from the FIFO when the FIFO is empty. * FIFO overwrite IRQ. Generated when the DMA Controller tries to write a word in the FIFO while the FIFO is full. * DMA end of frame IRQ. Generated when the DMA controller updates the Frame Base Address pointers. This IRQ can be used to implement a double-buffer technique. For more information, see "Double-buffer Technique" on page 673. * End of Line IRQ. This IRQ is generated when the LINEBLANK period of each line is reached and the DMA Controller is in inactive state. * End of Last Line IRQ. This IRQ is generated when the LINEBLANK period of the last line of the current frame is reached and the DMA Controller is in inactive state. Each IRQ can be individually enabled, disabled or cleared, in the LCD_IER (Interrupt Enable Register), LCD_IDR (Interrupt Disable Register) and LCD_ICR (Interrupt Clear Register) registers. The LCD_IMR register contains the mask value for each IRQ source and the LDC_ISR contains the status of each IRQ source. A more detailed description of these registers can be found in "LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface" on page 677.
39.7
Configuration Sequence
The DMA Controller starts to transfer image data when the LCDC Core is activated (Write to LCD_PWR field of PWRCON register). Thus, the user should configure the LCDC Core and configure and enable the DMA Controller prior to activation of the LCD Controller. In addition, the image data to be shows should be available when the LCDC Core is activated, regardless of the value programmed in the GUARD_TIME field of the PWRCON register. To disable the LCD Controller, the user should disable the LCDC Core and then disable the DMA Controller. The user should not enable LIP again until the LCDC Core is in IDLE state. This is checked by reading the LCD_BUSY bit in the PWRCON register. The initialization sequence that the user should follow to make the LCDC work is: * Create or copy the first image to show in the display buffer memory. * If a palletized mode is used, create and store a palette in the internal LCD Palette memory(See "Palette" on page 657. * Configure the LCD Controller Core without enabling it: - LCDCON1 register: Program the CLKVAL and BYPASS fields: these fields control the pixel clock divisor that is used to generate the pixel clock LCDDOTCK. The value to program depends on the LCD Core clock and on the type and size of the LCD Module used. There is a minimum value of the LCDDOTCK clock period that depends on the LCD Controller Configuration, this minimum value can be found in Table 39-11 on page 661. The equations that are used to calculate the value of the pixel clock divisor can be found at the end of the section "Timegen" on page 661
672
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- LCDCON2 register: Program its fields following their descriptions in the LCD Controller User Interface section below and considering the type of LCD module used and the desired working mode. Consider that not all combinations are possible. - LCDTIM1 and LCDTIM2 registers: Program their fields according to the datasheet of the LCD module used and with the help of the Timegen section in page 10. Note that some fields are not applicable to STN modules and must be programmed with 0 values. Note also that there is a limitation on the minimum value of VHDLY, HPW, HBP that depends on the configuration of the LCDC. - LCDFRMCFG register: program the dimensions of the LCD module used. - LCDFIFO register: To program it, use the formula in section "FIFO" on page 654 - DP1_2 to DP6_7 registers: they are only used for STN displays. They contain the dithering patterns used to generate gray shades or colors in these modules. They are loaded with recommended patterns at reset, so it is not necessary to write anything on them. They can be used to improve the image quality in the display by tuning the patterns in each application. - PWRCON Register: this register controls the power-up sequence of the LCD, so take care to use it properly. Do not enable the LCD (writing a 1 in LCD_PWR field) until the previous steps and the configuration of the DMA have been finished. - CONTRAST_CTR and CONTRAST_VAL: use this registers to adjust the contrast of the display, when the LCDCC line is used. * Configure the DMA Controller. The user should configure the base address of the display buffer memory, the size of the AHB transaction and the size of the display image in memory. When the DMA is configured the user should enable the DMA. To do so the user should configure the following registers: - DMABADDR1 and DMABADDR2 registers: In single scan mode only DMABADDR1 register must be configured with the base address of the display buffer in memory. In dual scan mode DMABADDR1 should be configured with the base address of the Upper Panel display buffer and DMABADDR2 should be configured with the base address of the Lower Panel display buffer. - DMAFRMCFG register: Program the FRMSIZE field. Note that in dual scan mode the vertical size to use in the calculation is that of each panel. Respect to the BRSTLN field, a recommended value is a 4-word burst. - DMACON register: Once both the LCD Controller Core and the DMA Controller have been configured, enable the DMA Controller by writing a "1" to the DMAEN field of this register. If using a dual scan module or the 2D addressing feature, do not forget to write the DMAUPDT bit after every change to the set of DMA configuration values. - DMA2DCFG register: Required only in 2D memory addressing mode (see "2D Memory Addressing" on page 674). * Finally, enable the LCD Controller Core by writing a "1" in the LCD_PWR field of the PWRCON register and do any other action that may be required to turn the LCD module on.
39.8
Double-buffer Technique
The double-buffer technique is used to avoid flickering while the frame being displayed is updated. Instead of using a single buffer, there are two different buffers, the backbuffer (background buffer) and the primary buffer (the buffer being displayed).
673
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The host updates the backbuffer while the LCD Controller is displaying the primary buffer. When the backbuffer has been updated the host updates the DMA Base Address registers. When using a Dual Panel LCD Module, both base address pointers should be updated in the same frame. There are two possibilities: * Check the DMAFRMPTx register to ensure that there is enough time to update the DMA Base Address registers before the end of frame. * Update the Frame Base Address Registers when the End Of Frame IRQ is generated. Once the host has updated the Frame Base Address Registers and the next DMA end of frame IRQ arrives, the backbuffer and the primary buffer are swapped and the host can work with the new backbuffer. When using a dual-panel LCD module, both base address pointers should be updated in the same frame. In order to achieve this, the DMAUPDT bit in DMACON register must be used to validate the new base address.
39.9
2D Memory Addressing
The LCDC can be configured to work on a frame buffer larger than the actual screen size. By changing the values in a few registers, it is easy to move the displayed area along the frame buffer width and height.
Figure 39-11. Frame Buffer Addressing
Frame Buffer Displayed Image Base word address & pixel offset
Line-to-line address increment
In order to locate the displayed window within a larger frame buffer, the software must: * Program the DMABADDR1 (DMABADDR2) register(s) to make them point to the word containing the first pixel of the area of interest. * Program the PIXELOFF field of DMA2DCFG register to specify the offset of this first pixel within the 32-bit memory word that contains it. * Define the width of the complete frame buffer by programming in the field ADDRINC of DMA2DCFG register the address increment between the last word of a line and the first word of the next line (in number of 32-bit words). * Enable the 2D addressing mode by writing the DMA2DEN bit in DMACON register. If this bit is not activated, the values in the DMA2DCFG register are not considered and the controller assumes that the displayed area occupies a continuous portion of the memory.
674
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The above configuration can be changed frame to frame, so the displayed window can be moved rapidly. Note that the FRMSIZE field of DMAFRMCFG register must be updated with any movement of the displaying window. Note also that the software must write bit DMAUPDT in DMACON register after each configuration for it to be accepted by LCDC.
Note: In 24 bpp packed mode, the DMA base address must point to a word containing a complete pixel (possible values of PIXELOFF are 0 and 8). This means that the horizontal origin of the displaying window must be a multiple of 4 pixels or a multiple of 4 pixels minus 1 (x = 4n or x = 4n-1, valid origins are pixel 0,3,4,7,8,11,12, etc.).
675
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.10 Register Configuration Guide
Program the PIO Controller to enable LCD signals. Enable the LCD controller clock in the Power Management Controller. 39.10.1 STN Mode Example STN color(R,G,B) 320*240, 8-bit single scan, 70 frames/sec, Master clock = 60 Mhz Data rate: 320*240*70*3/8 = 2.016 MHz HOZVAL= ((3*320)/8) - 1 LINEVAL= 240 -1 CLKVAL = (60 MHz/ (2*2.016 MHz)) - 1= 14 LCDCON1= CLKVAL << 12 LCDCON2 = LITTLEENDIAN | SINGLESCAN | STNCOLOR | DISP8BIT| PS8BPP; LCDTIM1 = 0; LCDTIM2 = 10 | (10 << 21); LCDFRMCFG = (HOZVAL << 21) | LINEVAL; DMAFRMCFG = (7 << 24) + (320 * 240 * 8) / 32; 39.10.2 TFT Mode Example This example is based on the NEC TFT color LCD module NL6448BC20-08. TFT 640*480, 16-bit single scan, 60 frames/sec, pixel clock frequency = [21MHz..29MHz] with a typical value = 25.175 MHz. The Master clock must be (2*(n + 1))*pixel clock frequency HOZVAL = 640 - 1 LINEVAL = 480 - 1 If Master clock is 50 MHz CLKVAL = (50 MHz/ (2*25.175 MHz)) - 1= 0 VFP = (12 -1), VBP = (31-1), VPW = (2-1), VHDLY= (2-1) HFP = (16-1), HBP = (48 -1), HPW= (96-1)
LCDCON1= CLKVAL << 12 LCDCON2 = LITTLEENDIAN | CLKMOD | INVERT_CLK | INVERT_LINE | INVERT_FRM | PS16BPP | SINGLESCAN | TFT LCDTIM1 = VFP | (VBP << 8) | (VPW << 16) | (VHDLY << 24) LCDTIM2 = HBP | (HPW << 8) | (HFP << 21) LCDFRMCFG = (HOZVAL << 21) | LINEVAL DMAFRMCFG = (7 << 24) + (640 * 480* 16) / 32;
676
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11 LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface
Table 39-13. LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface
Offset 0x0 0x4 0x8 0xC 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x800 0x804 0x808 0x80C 0x810 0x814 0x818 0x81C 0x820 0x824 0x828 0x82C 0x830 0x834 0x838 0x83C 0x840 0x844 0x848 0x84C 0x850 0x854 0x858 0x860 0x864 Register DMA Base Address Register 1 DMA Base Address Register 2 DMA Frame Pointer Register 1 DMA Frame Pointer Register 2 DMA Frame Address Register 1 DMA Frame Address Register 2 DMA Frame Configuration Register DMA Control Register DMA Control Register LCD Control Register 1 LCD Control Register 2 LCD Timing Register 1 LCD Timing Register 2 LCD Frame Configuration Register LCD FIFO Register Reserved Dithering Pattern DP1_2 Dithering Pattern DP4_7 Dithering Pattern DP3_5 Dithering Pattern DP2_3 Dithering Pattern DP5_7 Dithering Pattern DP3_4 Dithering Pattern DP4_5 Dithering Pattern DP6_7 Power Control Register Contrast Control Register Contrast Value Register LCD Interrupt Enable Register LCD Interrupt Disable Register LCD Interrupt Mask Register LCD Interrupt Status Register LCD Interrupt Clear Register LCD Interrupt Test Register LCD Interrupt Raw Status Register Register Name DMABADDR1 DMABADDR2 DMAFRMPT1 DMAFRMPT2 DMAFRMADD1 DMAFRMADD2 DMAFRMCFG DMACON DMA2DCFG LCDCON1 LCDCON2 LCDTIM1 LCDTIM2 LCDFRMCFG LCDFIFO - DP1_2 DP4_7 DP3_5 DP2_3 DP5_7 DP3_4 DP4_5 DP6_7 PWRCON CONTRAST_CTR CONTRAST_VAL LCD_IER LCD_IDR LCD_IMR LCD_ISR LCD_ICR LCD_ITR LCD_IRR Access R/W R/W Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W - R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Reset Value 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00002000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 - 0xA5 0x5AF0FA5 0xA5A5F 0xA5F 0xFAF5FA5 0xFAF5 0xFAF5F 0xF5FFAFF 0x0000000e 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0 0
677
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 39-13. LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface (Continued)
Offset 0xC00 0xC04 0xC08 0xC0C ... 0xFFC Palette entry 255 Register Palette entry 0 Palette entry 1 Palette entry 2 Palette entry 3 Register Name LUT ENTRY 0 LUT ENTRY 1 LUT ENTRY 2 LUT ENTRY 3 ... LUT ENTRY 255 R/W Access R/W R/W R/W R/W Reset Value
678
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.1 DMA Base Address Register 1 Name: DMABADDR1 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 23 15 7 30 22 14 6 29 21 13 5 28 BADDR-U 20 BADDR-U 12 BADDR-U 4 BADDR-U 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* BADDR-U Base Address for the upper panel in dual scan mode. Base Address for the complete frame in single scan mode. If a dual scan configuration is selected in LCDCON2 register or bit DMA2DEN in register DMACON is set, the bit DMAUPDT in that same register must be written after writing any new value to this field in order to make the DMA controller use this new value. 39.11.2 DMA Base Address Register 2 Name: DMABADDR2 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 23 15 7 30 22 14 6 29 21 13 5 28 BADDR-L 20 BADDR-L 12 BADDR-L 4 BADDR-L 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* BADDR-L Base Address for the lower panel in dual scan mode only. If a dual scan configuration is selected in LCDCON2 register or bit DMA2DEN in register DMACON is set, the bit DMAUPDT in that same register must be written after writing any new value to this field in order to make the DMA controller use this new value.
679
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.3 DMA Frame Pointer Register 1 Name: DMAFRMPT1 Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 12 4 27 - 19 FRMPT-U 11 FRMPT-U 3 FRMPT-U 26 - 18 10 2 25 - 17 9 1 24 - 16 8 0
* FRMPT-U Current value of frame pointer for the upper panel in dual scan mode. Current value of frame pointer for the complete frame in single scan mode. Down count from FRMSIZE to 0.
Note: This register is read-only and contains the current value of the frame pointer (number of words to the end of the frame). It can be used as an estimation of the number of words transferred from memory for the current frame.
39.11.4 DMA Frame Pointer Register 2 Name: DMAFRMPT2 Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 15 7 30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 12 4 27 - 19 FRMPT-L 11 FRMPT-L 3 FRMPT-L 26 - 18 10 2 25 - 17 9 1 24 - 16 8 0
* FRMPT-L Current value of frame pointer for the Lower panel in dual scan mode only. Down count from FRMSIZE to 0.
Note: This register is read-only and contains the current value of the frame pointer (number of words to the end of the frame). It can be used as an estimation of the number of words transferred from memory for the current frame.
680
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.5 DMA Frame Address Register 1 Name: DMAFRMADD1 Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x00000000
31 23 15 7 30 22 14 6 29 21 13 5 28 FRMADD-U 20 FRMADD-U 12 FRMADD-U 4 FRMADD-U 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* FRMADD-U Current value of frame address for the upper panel in dual scan mode. Current value of frame address for the complete frame in single scan.
Note: This register is read-only and contains the current value of the last DMA transaction in the bus for the panel/frame.
39.11.6 DMA Frame Address Register 2 Name: DMAFRMADD2 Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x00000000
31 23 15 7 30 22 14 6 29 21 13 5 28 FRMADD-L 20 FRMADD-L 12 FRMADD-L 4 FRMADD-L 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 19 18 17 16 27 26 25 24
* FRMADD-L Current value of frame address for the lower panel in single scan mode only.
Note: This register is read-only and contains the current value of the last DMA transaction in the bus for the panel.
681
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.7 DMA Frame Configuration Register Name: DMAFRMCFG Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 22 14 6 29 21 13 5 28 27 BRSTLN 20 19 FRMSIZE 12 11 FRMSIZE 4 3 FRMSIZE 26 18 10 2 25 17 9 1 24 16 8 0
* FRMSIZE: Frame Size In single scan mode, this is the frame size in words. In dual scan mode, this is the size of each panel. If a dual scan configuration is selected in LCDCON2 register or bit DMA2DEN in register DMACON is set, the bit DMAUPDT in that same register must be written after writing any new value to this field in order to make the DMA controller use this new value. * BRSTLN: Burst Length in words Program with the desired burst length - 1
682
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.8 DMA Control Register Name: DMACON Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 DMA2DEN 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 DMAUPDT 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 DMABUSY 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 DMARST 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 DMAEN
* DMAEN: DMA Enable 0: DMA is disabled. 1: DMA is enabled. * DMARST: DMA Reset (Write-only) 0: No effect. 1: Reset DMA module. DMA Module should be reset only when disabled and in idle state. * DMABUSY: DMA Busy 0: DMA module is idle. 1: DMA module is busy (doing a transaction on the AHB bus). * DMAUPDT: DMA Configuration Update 0: No effect 1: Update DMA Configuration. Used for simultaneous updating of DMA parameters in dual scan mode or when using 2D addressing. The values written in the registers DMABADDR1, DMABADDR2 and DMA2DCFG, and in the field FRMSIZE of register DMAFRMCFG, are accepted by the DMA controller and are applied at the next frame. This bit is used only if a dual scan configuration is selected (bit SCANMOD of LCDCON2 register) or 2D addressing is enabled (bit DMA2DEN in this register). Otherwise, the LCD controller accepts immediately the values written in the registers referred to above. * DMA2DEN: DMA 2D Addressing Enable 0: 2D addressing is disabled (values in register DMA2DCFG are "don't care"). 1: 2D addressing is enabled.
683
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.9 LCD DMA 2D Addressing Register Name: DMA2DCFG Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 20 - 12 ADDRINC 4 ADDRINC 3 2 1 0 27 19 - 11 26 PIXELOFF 18 - 10 25 17 - 9 24 16 - 8
* ADDRINC: DMA 2D Addressing Address increment When 2-D DMA addressing is enabled (bit DMA2DEN is set in register DMACON), this field specifies the number of bytes that the DMA controller must jump between screen lines. Itb must be programmed as: [({address of first 32-bit word in a screen line} - {address of last 32-bit word in previous line})]. In other words, it is equal to 4*[number of 32-bit words occupied by each line in the complete frame buffer minus the number of 32-bit words occupied by each displayed line]. Bit DMAUPDT in register DMACON must be written after writing any new value to this field in order to make the DMA controller use this new value. * PIXELOFF: DAM2D Addressing Pixel offset When 2D DMA addressing is enabled (bit DMA2DEN is set in register DMACON), this field specifies the offset of the first pixel in each line within the memory word that contains this pixel. The offset is specified in number of bits in the range 0-31, so for example a value of 4 indicates that the first pixel in the screen starts at bit 4 of the 32-bit word pointed by register DMABADDR1. Bits 0 to 3 of that word are not used. This example is valid for little endian memory organization. When using big endian memory organization, this offset is considered from bit 31 downwards, or equivalently, a given value of this field always selects the pixel in the same relative position within the word, independently of the memory ordering configuration. Bit DMAUPDT in register DMACON must be written after writing any new value to this field in order to make the DMA controller use this new value.
684
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.10 LCD Control Register 1 Name: LCDCON1 Access: Read/Write, except LINECNT: Read-only Reset value: 0x00002000
31 23 15 7 - 30 22 LINECNT 14 CLKVAL 6 - 29 21 13 5 - 28 LINECNT 20 12 4 - 19 11 - 3 - 18 CLKVAL 10 - 2 - 17 9 - 1 - 16 8 - 0 BYPASS 27 26 25 24
* BYPASS: Bypass LCDDOTCK divider 0: The divider is not bypassed. LCDDOTCK frequency defined by the CLKVAL field. 1: The LCDDOTCK divider is bypassed. LCDDOTCK frequency is equal to the LCDC Clock frequency. * CLKVAL: Clock divider 9-bit divider for pixel clock (LCDDOTCK) frequency. Pixel_clock = system_clock ( CLKVAL + 1 ) x 2 * LINECNT: Line Counter (Read-only) Current Value of 11-bit line counter. Down count from LINEVAL to 0.
685
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.11 LCD Control Register 2 Name: LCDCON2 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000
31 30 MEMOR 23 22 - - 15 14 CLKMOD - 7 6 PIXELSIZE 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 27 - - 20 19 - - 12 11 INVDVAL INVCLK 4 3 IFWIDTH 26 - 18 - 10 INVLINE 2 SCANMOD 25 24 - - 17 16 - - 9 8 INVFRAME INVVD 1 0 DISTYPE
* DISTYPE: Display Type
DISTYPE 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 STN Monochrome STN Color TFT Reserved
* SCANMOD: Scan Mode 0: Single Scan 1: Dual Scan * IFWIDTH: Interface width (STN)
IFWIDTH 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 4-bit (Only valid in single scan STN mono or color) 8-bit (Only valid in STN mono or Color) 16-bit (Only valid in dual scan STN mono or color) Reserved
686
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* PIXELSIZE: Bits per pixel
PIXELSIZE 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 bit per pixel 2 bits per pixel 4 bits per pixel 8 bits per pixel 16 bits per pixel 24 bits per pixel, packed (Only valid in TFT mode) 24 bits per pixel, unpacked (Only valid in TFT mode) Reserved
* INVVD: LCDD polarity 0: Normal 1: Inverted * INVFRAME: LCDVSYNC polarity 0: Normal (active high) 1: Inverted (active low) * INVLINE: LCDHSYNC polarity 0: Normal (active high) 1: Inverted (active low) * INVCLK: LCDDOTCK polarity 0: Normal (LCDD fetched at LCDDOTCK falling edge) 1: Inverted (LCDD fetched at LCDDOTCK rising edge) * INVDVAL: LCDDEN polarity 0: Normal (active high) 1: Inverted (active low) * CLKMOD: LCDDOTCK mode 0: LCDDOTCK only active during active display period 1: LCDDOTCK always active * MEMOR: Memory Ordering Format 00: Big Endian 10: Little Endian 11: WinCE format
687
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.12 LCD Timing Configuration Register 1 Name: LCDTIM1 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 12 VBP 4 VFP 3 2 1 0 27 19 VPW 11 10 9 8 26 VHDLY 18 17 16 25 24
* VFP: Vertical Front Porch In TFT mode, these bits equal the number of idle lines at the end of the frame. In STN mode, these bits should be set to 0. * VBP: Vertical Back Porch In TFT mode, these bits equal the number of idle lines at the beginning of the frame. In STN mode, these bits should be set to 0. * VPW: Vertical Synchronization pulse width In TFT mode, these bits equal the vertical synchronization pulse width, given in number of lines. LCDVSYNC width is equal to (VPW+1) lines. In STN mode, these bits should be set to 0. * VHDLY: Vertical to horizontal delay In TFT mode, this is the delay between LCDVSYNC rising or falling edge and LCDHSYNC rising edge. Delay is (VHDLY+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. In STN mode, these bits should be set to 0.
688
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.13 LCD Timing Configuration Register 2 Name: LCDTIM2 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000
31 23 15 - 7 30 22 HFP 14 - 6 29 21 13 5 28 HFP 20 - 12 4 HBP 19 - 11 HPW 3 2 1 0 18 - 10 17 - 9 16 - 8 27 26 25 24
* HBP: Horizontal Back Porch Number of idle LCDDOTCK cycles at the beginning of the line. Idle period is (HBP+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. * HPW: Horizontal synchronization pulse width Width of the LCDHSYNC pulse, given in LCDDOTCK cycles. Width is (HPW+1) LCDDOTCK cycles. * HFP: Horizontal Front Porch Number of idle LCDDOTCK cycles at the end of the line. Idle period is (HFP+1) LCDDOTCK cycles.
689
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.14 LCD Frame Configuration Register Name: LCDFRMCFG Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000
31 23 15 - 7 30 22 LINESIZE 14 - 6 29 21 13 - 5 28 LINESIZE 20 - 12 - 4 LINEVAL 19 - 11 - 3 18 - 10 2 17 - 9 LINEVAL 1 16 - 8 0 27 26 25 24
* LINEVAL: Vertical size of LCD module In single scan mode: vertical size of LCD Module, in pixels, minus 1 In dual scan mode: vertical display size of each LCD panel, in pixels, minus 1 * LINESIZE: Horizontal size of LCD module, in pixels, minus 1
690
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.15 LCD FIFO Register Name: LCDFIFO Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 FIFOTH 4 FIFOTH 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* FIFOTH: FIFO Threshold Must be programmed with: FIFOTH (in words) = 512 - (2 x DMA_BURST_LENGTH + 3) where: * 512 is the effective size of the FIFO in words. It is the total FIFO memory size in single scan mode and half that size in dual scan mode. * DMA_burst_length is the burst length of the transfers made by the DMA in words. Refer to "BRSTLN: Burst Length in words" on page 682.
691
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.16 Dithering Pattern DP1_2 Register Name: DP1_2 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xA5
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 DP1_2 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* DP1_2: Pattern value for 1/2 duty cycle 39.11.17 Dithering Pattern DP4_7 Register Name: DP4_7 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x5AF0FA5
31 - 23 15 7 30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 DP4_7 12 DP4_7 4 DP4_7 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 27 19 26 DP4_7 18 17 16 25 24
* DP4_7: Pattern value for 4/7 duty cycle 39.11.18 Dithering Pattern DP3_5 Register Name: DP3_5 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xA5A5F
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 DP3_5 4 DP3_5 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 11 26 - 18 DP3_5 10 9 8 25 - 17 24 - 16
* DP3_5: Pattern value for 3/5 duty cycle
692
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.19 Dithering Pattern DP2_3 Register Name: DP2_3: Dithering Pattern DP2_3 Register Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xA5F
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 DP2_3 27 - 19 - 11 3 26 - 18 - 10 DP2_3 2 1 0 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* DP2_3: Pattern value for 2/3 duty cycle
39.11.20 Dithering Pattern DP5_7 Register Name: DP5_7: Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xFAF5FA5
31 - 23 15 7 30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 DP5_7 12 DP5_7 4 DP5_7 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 27 19 26 DP5_7 18 17 16 25 24
* DP5_7: Pattern value for 5/7 duty cycle 39.11.21 Dithering Pattern DP3_4 Register Name: DP3_4 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xFAF5
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 DP3_4 4 DP3_4 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* DP3_4: Pattern value for 3/4 duty cycle
693
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
39.11.22 Dithering Pattern DP4_5 Register Name: DP4_5 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xFAF5F
31 - 23 - 15 7 30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 DP4_5 4 DP4_5 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 11 26 - 18 DP4_5 10 9 8 25 - 17 24 - 16
* DP4_5: Pattern value for 4/5 duty cycle 39.11.23 Dithering Pattern DP6_7 Register Name: DP6_7 Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0xF5FFAFF
31 - 23 15 7 30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 DP6_7 12 DP6_7 4 DP6_7 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 27 19 26 DP6_7 18 17 16 25 24
* DP6_7: Pattern value for 6/7 duty cycle
694
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.24 Power Control Register Name: PWRCON Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x0000000e
31 LCD_BUSY 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 GUARD_TIME 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LCD_PWR
* LCD_PWR: LCD module power control 0 = lcd_pwr signal is low, other lcd_* signals are low. 0->1 = lcd_* signals activated, lcd_pwr is set high with the delay of GUARD_TIME frame periods. 1 = lcd_pwr signal is high, other lcd_* signals are active. 1->0 = lcd_pwr signal is low, other lcd_* signals are active, but are set low after GUARD_TIME frame periods. * GUARD_TIME Delay in frame periods between applying control signals to the LCD module and setting LCD_PWR high, and between setting LCD_PWR low and removing control signals from LCD module * LCD_BUSY Read-only field. If 1, it indicates that the LCD is busy (active and displaying data, in power on sequence or in power off sequence).
695
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.25 Contrast Control Register Name: CONTRAST_CTR Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 ENA 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 POL 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 PS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* PS This 2-bit value selects the configuration of a counter prescaler. The meaning of each combination is as follows:
PS 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 The counter advances at a rate of fCOUNTER = fLCDC_CLOCK. The counter advances at a rate of fCOUNTER = fLCDC_CLOCK/2. The counter advances at a rate of fCOUNTER = fLCDC_CLOCK/4. The counter advances at a rate of fCOUNTER = fLCDC_CLOCK/8.
* POL This bit defines the polarity of the output. If 1, the output pulses are high level (the output will be high whenever the value in the counter is less than the value in the compare register CONSTRAST_VAL). If 0, the output pulses are low level. * ENA When 1, this bit enables the operation of the PWM generator. When 0, the PWM counter is stopped.
696
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.26 Contrast Value Register Name: CONSTRAST_VAL Access: Read/Write Reset value: 0x00000000
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CVAL 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
* CVAL PWM compare value. Used to adjust the analog value obtained after an external filter to control the contrast of the display.
697
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.27 LCD Interrupt Enable Register Name: LCD_IER Access: Write-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIE 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIE 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIE 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIE 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIE 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIE
* LNIE: Line interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable each line interrupt * LSTLNIE: Last line interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable last line interrupt * EOFIE: DMA End of frame interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable End Of Frame interrupt * UFLWIE: FIFO underflow interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable FIFO underflow interrupt * OWRIE: FIFO overwrite interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable FIFO overwrite interrupt * MERIE: DMA memory error interrupt enable 0: No effect 1: Enable DMA memory error interrupt
698
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.28 LCD Interrupt Disable Register Name: LCD_IDR Access: Write-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERID 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRID 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWID 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFID 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNID 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNID
* LNID: Line interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable each line interrupt * LSTLNID: Last line interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable last line interrupt * EOFID: DMA End of frame interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable End Of Frame interrupt * UFLWID: FIFO underflow interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable FIFO underflow interrupt * OWRID: FIFO overwrite interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable FIFO overwrite interrupt * MERID: DMA Memory error interrupt disable 0: No effect 1: Disable DMA Memory error interrupt
699
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.29 LCD Interrupt Mask Register Name: LCD_IMR Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIM 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIM 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIM 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIM 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIM 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIM
* LNIM: Line interrupt mask 0: Line Interrupt disabled 1: Line interrupt enabled * LSTLNIM: Last line interrupt mask 0: Last Line Interrupt disabled 1: Last Line Interrupt enabled * EOFIM: DMA End of frame interrupt mask 0: End Of Frame interrupt disabled 1: End Of Frame interrupt enabled * UFLWIM: FIFO underflow interrupt mask 0: FIFO underflow interrupt disabled 1: FIFO underflow interrupt enabled * OWRIM: FIFO overwrite interrupt mask 0: FIFO overwrite interrupt disabled 1: FIFO overwrite interrupt enabled * MERIM: DMA Memory error interrupt mask 0: DMA Memory error interrupt disabled 1: DMA Memory error interrupt enabled
700
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.30 LCD Interrupt Status Register Name: LCD_ISR Access: Read-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIS 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIS 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIS 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIS 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIS 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIS
* LNIS: Line interrupt status 0: Line Interrupt not active 1: Line Interrupt active * LSTLNIS: Last line interrupt status 0: Last Line Interrupt not active 1: Last Line Interrupt active * EOFIS: DMA End of frame interrupt status 0: End Of Frame interrupt not active 1: End Of Frame interrupt active * UFLWIS: FIFO underflow interrupt status 0: FIFO underflow interrupt not active 1: FIFO underflow interrupt active * OWRIS: FIFO overwrite interrupt status 0: FIFO overwrite interrupt not active 1: FIFO overwrite interrupt active * MERIS: DMA Memory error interrupt status 0: DMA Memory error interrupt not active 1: DMA Memory error interrupt active
701
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.31 LCD Interrupt Clear Register Name: LCD_ICR Access: Write-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIC 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIC 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIC 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIC 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIC 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIC
* LNIC: Line interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear each line interrupt * LSTLNIC: Last line interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear Last line Interrupt * EOFIC: DMA End of frame interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear End Of Frame interrupt * UFLWIC: FIFO underflow interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear FIFO underflow interrupt * OWRIC: FIFO overwrite interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear FIFO overwrite interrupt * MERIC: DMA Memory error interrupt clear 0: No effect 1: Clear DMA Memory error interrupt
702
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.32 LCD Interrupt Test Register Name: LCD_ITR Access: Write-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIT 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIT 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIT 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIT 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIT
* LNIT: Line interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set each line interrupt * LSTLNIT: Last line interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set Last line interrupt * EOFIT: DMA End of frame interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set End Of Frame interrupt * UFLWIT: FIFO underflow interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set FIFO underflow interrupt * OWRIT: FIFO overwrite interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set FIFO overwrite interrupt * MERIT: DMA Memory error interrupt test 0: No effect 1: Set DMA Memory error interrupt
703
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11.33 LCD Interrupt Raw Status Register Name: LCD_IRR Access: Write-only Reset value: 0x0
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 - 30 - 22 - 14 - 6 MERIR 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OWRIR 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 UFLWIR 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EOFIR 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 LSTLNIR 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 LNIR
* LNIR: Line interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: Line interrupt condition present * LSTLNIR: Last line interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: Last line Interrupt condition present * EOFIR: DMA End of frame interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: End Of Frame interrupt condition present * UFLWIR: FIFO underflow interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: FIFO underflow interrupt condition present * OWRIR: FIFO overwrite interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: FIFO overwrite interrupt condition present * MERIR: DMA Memory error interrupt raw status 0: No effect 1: DMA Memory error interrupt condition present
704
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40. AC'97 Controller (AC'97C)
40.1 Description
The AC`97 Controller is the hardware implementation of the AC'97 digital controller (DC'97) compliant with AC'97 Component Specification 2.2. The AC'97 Controller communicates with an audio codec (AC'97) or a modem codec (MC'97) via the AC-link digital serial interface. All digital audio, modem and handset data streams, as well as control (command/status) informations are transferred in accordance to the AC-link protocol. The AC'97 Controller features a Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) for audio streaming transfers. It also supports variable sampling rate and four Pulse Code Modulation (PCM) sample resolutions of 10, 16, 18 and 20 bits.
705
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.2
Block Diagram
Figure 40-1. Functional Block Diagram
MCK Clock Domain Slot Number AC97 Slot Controller SYNC
Slot Number 16/20 bits Slot #0 AC97 Tag Controller Receive Shift Register Slot #0,1 AC97 CODEC Channel Transmit Shift Register Receive Shift Register SDATA_IN AC97 Channel A AC97C_CATHR AC97C_CARHR Slot #3...12 Receive Shift Register Transmit Shift Register Transmit Shift Register
M U X
Slot #1,2 SDATA_OUT
AC97C_COTHR AC97C_CORHR
Slot #2
D E
BITCLK
AC97 Channel B AC97C Interrupt AC97C_CBTHR Slot #3...12 AC97C_CBRHR Receive Shift Register Transmit Shift Register
M U X
MCK
User Interface Bit Clock Domain
APB Interface
706
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.3 Pin Name List
I/O Lines Description
Pin Description 12.288-MHz bit-rate clock Receiver Data (Referred as SDATA_IN in AC-link spec) 48-KHz frame indicator and synchronizer Transmitter Data (Referred as SDATA_OUT in AC-link spec) Type Input Input Output Output
Table 40-1.
Pin Name AC97CK AC97RX AC97FS AC97TX
The AC`97 reset signal provided to the primary codec can be generated by a PIO.
40.4
Application Block Diagram
Figure 40-2. Application Block diagram
AC 97 Controller
AC-link
PIOx AC97_RESET
AC'97 Primary Codec
AC97_SYNC AC97FS AC97_BITCLK AC97CK AC97_SDATA_OUT AC97_SDATA_IN AC97RX
AC97TX
707
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.5
40.5.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the compliant external devices may be multiplexed with PIO lines. Before using the AC`97 Controller receiver, the PIO controller must be configured in order for the AC97C receiver I/O lines to be in AC`97 Controller peripheral mode. Before using the AC`97 Controller transmitter, the PIO controller must be configured in order for the AC97C transmitter I/O lines to be in AC`97 Controller peripheral mode.
40.5.2
Power Management The AC`97 Controller is not continuously clocked. Its interface may be clocked through the Power Management Controller (PMC), therefore the programmer must first configure the PMC to enable the AC'97 Controller clock. The AC'97 Controller has two clock domains. The first one is supplied by PMC and is equal to MCK. The second one is AC97CK which is sent by the AC97 Codec (Bit clock). Signals that cross the two clock domains are re-synchronized. MCK clock frequency must be higher than the AC97CK (Bit Clock) clock frequency.
40.5.3
Interrupt The AC'97 Controller interface has an interrupt line connected to the Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC). Handling interrupts requires programming the AIC before configuring the AC97C. All AC'97 Controller interrupts can be enabled/disabled by writing to the AC'97 Controller Interrupt Enable/Disable Registers. Each pending and unmasked AC'97 Controller interrupt will assert the interrupt line. The AC'97 Controller interrupt service routine can get the interrupt source in two steps: * Reading and ANDing AC'97 Controller Interrupt Mask Register (AC97C_IMR) and AC'97 Controller Status Register (AC97C_SR). * Reading AC'97 Controller Channel x Status Register (AC97C_CxSR).
708
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.6
40.6.1
Functional Description
Protocol overview AC-link protocol is a bidirectional, fixed clock rate, serial digital stream. AC-link handles multiple input and output Pulse Code Modulation PCM audio streams, as well as control register accesses employing a Time Division Multiplexed (TDM) scheme that divides each audio frame in 12 outgoing and 12 incoming 20-bit wide data slots.
Figure 40-3. Bidirectional AC-link Frame with Slot Assignment
Slot # AC97FS
CMD ADDR CMD DATA PCM L Front PCM R Front LINE 1 DAC PCM Center PCM L SURR PCM R SURR PCM LFE LINE 2 DAC HSET DAC IO CTRL
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
AC97TX (Controller Output)
TAG
AC97RX (Codec output)
TAG
STATUS ADDR
STATUS DATA
PCM LEFT
PCM RIGHT
LINE 1 DAC
PCM MIC
RSVED
RSVED
RSVED
LINE 2 ADC
HSET ADC
IO STATUS
Table 40-2.
Slot # 0 1 2 3,4 5 6, 7, 8 9 10 11 12
AC-link Output Slots Transmitted from the AC'97C Controller
Pin Description TAG Command Address Port Command Data Port PCM playback Left/Right Channel Modem Line 1 Output Channel PCM Center/Left Surround/Right Surround PCM LFE DAC Modem Line 2 Output Channel Modem Handset Output Channel Modem GPIO Control Channel
Table 40-3.
Slot # 0 1 2 3,4 5 6 7, 8, 9
AC-link Input Slots Transmitted from the AC'97C Controller
Pin Description TAG Status Address Port Status Data Port PCM playback Left/Right Channel Modem Line 1 ADC Dedicated Microphone ADC Vendor Reserved
709
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 40-3.
Slot # 10 11 12
AC-link Input Slots Transmitted from the AC'97C Controller
Pin Description Modem Line 2 ADC Modem Handset Input ADC Modem IO Status
40.6.1.1 Slot Description Tag Slot The tag slot, or slot 0, is a 16-bit wide slot that always goes at the beginning of an outgoing or incoming frame. Within tag slot, the first bit is a global bit that flags the entire frame validity. The next 12 bit positions sampled by the AC'97 Controller indicate which of the corresponding 12 time slots contain valid data. The slot's last two bits (combined) called Codec ID, are used to distinguish primary and secondary codec. The 16-bit wide tag slot of the output frame is automatically generated by the AC`97 Controller according to the transmit request of each channel and to the SLOTREQ from the previous input frame, sent by the AC`97 Codec, in Variable Sample Rate mode. Codec Slot 1 The command/status slot is a 20-bit wide slot used to control features, and monitors status for AC`97 Codec functions. The control interface architecture supports up to sixty-four 16-bit wide read/write registers. Only the even registers are currently defined and addressed. Slot 1's bitmap is the following: * Bit 19 is for read/write command, 1= read, 0 = write. * Bits [18:12] are for control register index. * Bits [11:0] are reserved. Codec Slot 2 Slot 2 is a 20-bit wide slot used to carry 16-bit wide AC97 Codec control register data. If the current command port operation is a read, the entire slot time is stuffed with zeros. Its bitmap is the following: * Bits [19:4] are the control register data * Bits [3:0] are reserved and stuffed with zeros. Data Slots [3:12] Slots [3:12] are 20-bit wide data slots, they usually carry audio PCM or/and modem I/O data.
710
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.6.2 AC`97 Controller Channel Organization The AC'97 Controller features a Codec channel and 2 logical channels; Channel A and Channel B. The Codec channel controls AC`97 Codec registers, it enables write and read configuration values in order to bring the AC97 Codec to an operating state. The Codec channel always runs slot 1 and slot 2 exclusively, in both input and output directions. Channel A and Channel B transfer data to/from AC97 codec. All audio samples and modem data must transit by these two channels. However, Channel A is connected to PDC channels thus making it suitable for audio streaming applications. Each slot of the input or the output frame that belongs to this range [3 to 12] can be operated by either Channel A or Channel B. The slot to channel assignment is configured by two registers: * AC'97 Controller Input Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_ICA) * AC'97 Controller Output Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_OCA) The AC'97 Controller Input Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_ICA) configures the input slot to channel assignment. The AC'97 Controller Output Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_OCA) configures the output slot to channel assignment. A slot can be left unassigned to a channel by the AC'97 Controller. Slots 0, 1,and 2 cannot be assigned to Channel A or to Channel B through the AC97C_OCA and AC97C_ICA Registers. The width of sample data, that transit via Channel A and Channel B varies and can take one of these values; 10, 16, 18 or 20 bits. Figure 40-4. Logical Channel Assignment
Slot # AC97FS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AC97TX (Controller Output)
TAG
CMD ADDR
CMD DATA
PCM L Front
PCM R Front
LINE 1 DAC
PCM Center
PCM L SURR
PCM R SURR
PCM LFE
LINE 2 DAC
HSET DAC
IO CTRL
Codec Channel
Channel A
AC97C_OCA = 0x0000_0209
AC97RX (Codec output)
TAG
STATUS ADDR
STATUS DATA
PCM LEFT
PCM RIGHT
LINE 1 DAC
PCM MIC
RSVED
RSVED
RSVED
LINE 2 ADC
HSET ADC
IO STATUS
Codec Channel AC97C_ICA = 0x0000_0009
Channel A
711
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.6.2.1
AC97 Controller Setup The following operations must be performed in order to bring the AC'97 Controller into an operating state: 1. Enable the AC97 Controller clock in the PMC controller. 2. Turn on AC97 function by enabling the ENA bit in AC97 Controller Mode Register (AC97C_MR). 3. Configure the input channel assignment by controlling the AC'97 Controller Input Assignment Register (AC97C_ICA). 4. Configure the output channel assignment by controlling the AC'97 Controller Input Assignment Register (AC97C_OCA). 5. Configure sample width for Channel A and Channel B by writing the SIZE bit field in AC97C Channel A Mode Register (AC97C_CAMR) and AC97C Channel B Mode Register (AC97C_CBMR). The application can write 10, 16, 18,or 20-bit wide PCM samples through the AC'97 interface and they will be transferred into 20-bit wide slots. 6. Configure data Endianness for Channel A and Channel B by writing CEM bit field in AC97C_CAMR and AC97C_CBMR registers. Data on the AC-link are shifted MSB first. The application can write little- or big-endian data to the AC'97 Controller interface. 7. Configure the PIO controller to drive the RESET signal of the external Codec. The RESET signal must fulfill external AC97 Codec timing requirements. 8. Enable Channel A and/or Channel B by writing CEN bit field in AC97C_CAMR and AC97C_CBMR registers.
40.6.2.2
Transmit Operation The application must perform the following steps in order to send data via a channel to the AC97 Codec: * Check if previous data has been sent by polling TXRDY flag in the AC97C Channel x Status Register (AC97_CxSR). x being one of the 2 channels. * Write data to the AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR). Once data has been transferred to the Channel x Shift Register, the TXRDY flag is automatically set by the AC'97 Controller which allows the application to start a new write action. The application can also wait for an interrupt notice associated with TXRDY in order to send data. The interrupt remains active until TXRDY flag is cleared..
712
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 40-5. Audio Transfer (PCM L Front, PCM R Front) on Channel x
Slot # AC97FS AC97TX (Controller Output)
TAG CMD ADDR CMD DATA PCM L Front PCM R Front LINE 1 DAC PCM Center PCM L SURR PCM R SURR PCM LFE LINE 2 DAC HSET DAC IO CTRL
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
TXRDYCx (AC97C_SR)
TXEMPTY (AC97C_SR) Write access to AC97C_THRx
PCM L Front transfered to the shift register PCM R Front transfered to the shift register
The TXEMPTY flag in the AC'97 Controller Channel x Status Register (AC97C_CxSR) is set when all requested transmissions for a channel have been shifted on the AC-link. The application can either poll TXEMPTY flag in AC97C_CxSR or wait for an interrupt notice associated with the same flag. In most cases, the AC'97 Controller is embedded in chips that target audio player devices. In such cases, the AC`97 Controller is exposed to heavy audio transfers. Using the polling technique increases processor overhead and may fail to keep the required pace under an operating system. In order to avoid these polling drawbacks, the application can perform audio streams by using PDC connected to channel A, which reduces processor overhead and increases performance especially under an operating system. The PDC transmit counter values must be equal to the number of PCM samples to be transmitted, each sample goes in one slot. 40.6.2.3 AC`97 Output Frame The AC'97 Controller outputs a thirteen-slot frame on the AC-Link. The first slot (tag slot or slot 0) flags the validity of the entire frame and the validity of each slot; whether a slot carries valid data or not. Slots 1 and 2 are used if the application performs control and status monitoring actions on AC97 Codec control/status registers. Slots [3:12] are used according to the content of the AC'97 Controller Output Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_OCA). If the application performs many transmit requests on a channel, some of the slots associated to this channel or all of them will carry valid data. Receive Operation The AC'97 Controller can also receive data from AC`97 Codec. Data is received in the channel's shift register and then transferred to the AC'97 Controller Channel x Read Holding Register. To read the newly received data, the application must perform the following steps: * Poll RXRDY flag in AC'97 Controller Channel x Status Register (AC97C_CxSR). x being one of the 2 channels. * Read data from AC'97 Controller Channel x Read Holding Register.
40.6.2.4
713
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
The application can also wait for an interrupt notice in order to read data from AC97C_CxRHR. The interrupt remains active until RXRDY is cleared by reading AC97C_CxSR. The RXRDY flag in AC97C_CxSR is set automatically when data is received in the Channel x shift register. Data is then shifted to AC97C_CxRHR. Figure 40-6. Audio Transfer (PCM L Front, PCM R Front) on Channel x
Slot # AC97FS
STATUS ADDR STATUS DATA PCM LEFT PCM RIGHT LINE 1 DAC PCM MIC LINE 2 ADC HSET ADC IO STATUS
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
AC97RX (Codec output) RXRDYCx (AC97C_SR) Read access to AC97C_RHRx
TAG
RSVED
RSVED
RSVED
If the previously received data has not been read by the application, the new data overwrites the data already waiting in AC97C_CxRHR, therefore the OVRUN flag in AC97C_CxSR is raised. The application can either poll the OVRUN flag in AC97C_CxSR or wait for an interrupt notice. The interrupt remains active until the OVRUN flag in AC97C_CxSR is set. The AC'97 Controller can also be used in sound recording devices in association with an AC97 Codec. The AC`97 Controller may also be exposed to heavy PCM transfers. The application can use the PDC connected to channel A in order to reduce processor overhead and increase performance especially under an operating system. The PDC receive counter values must be equal to the number of PCM samples to be received, each sample goes in one slot. 40.6.2.5 AC`97 Input Frame The AC'97 Controller receives a thirteen slot frame on the AC-Link sent by the AC97 Codec. The first slot (tag slot or slot 0) flags the validity of the entire frame and the validity of each slot; whether a slot carries valid data or not. Slots 1 and 2 are used if the application requires status informations from AC97 Codec. Slots [3:12] are used according to AC'97 Controller Output Channel Assignment Register (AC97C_ICA) content. The AC'97 Controller will not receive any data from any slot if AC97C_ICA is not assigned to a channel in input. Configuring and Using Interrupts Instead of polling flags in AC'97 Controller Global Status Register (AC97C_SR) and in AC'97 Controller Channel x Status Register (AC97C_CxSR), the application can wait for an interrupt notice. The following steps show how to configure and use interrupts correctly: * Set the interruptible flag in AC'97 Controller Channel x Mode Register (AC97C_CxMR). * Set the interruptible event and channel event in AC'97 Controller Interrupt Enable Register (AC97C_IER). The interrupt handler must read both AC'97 Controller Global Status Register (AC97C_SR) and AC'97 Controller Interrupt Mask Register (AC97C_IMR) and AND them to get the real interrupt source. Furthermore, to get which event was activated, the interrupt handler has to read AC'97 Controller Channel x Status Register (AC97C_CxSR), x being the channel whose event triggers the interrupt. 714
40.6.2.6
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
The application can disable event interrupts by writing in AC'97 Controller Interrupt Disable Register (AC97C_IDR). The AC`97 Controller Interrupt Mask Register (AC97C_IMR) shows which event can trigger an interrupt and which one cannot. 40.6.2.7 Endianness Endianness can be managed automatically for each channel, except for the Codec channel, by writing to Channel Endianness Mode (CEM) in AC97C_CxMR. This enables transferring data on AC-link in Big Endian format without any additional operation. To Transmit a Word Stored in Big Endian Format on AC-link Word to be written in AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR) (as it is stored in memory or microprocessor register).
31 Byte0[7:0] 24 23 Byte1[7:0] 16 15 Byte2[7:0] 8 7 Byte3[7:0] 0
Word stored in Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR) (data to transmit).
31 - 24 23 - 20 19 16 Byte2[3:0] 15 Byte1[7:0] 8 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data transmitted on appropriate slot: data[19:0] = {Byte2[3:0], Byte1[7:0], Byte0[7:0]}. To Transmit A Halfword Stored in Big Indian Format on AC-link Halfword to be written in AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR).
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte0[7:0] 8 7 Byte1[7:0] 0
Halfword stored in AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR) (data to transmit).
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte1[7:0] 8 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data emitted on related slot: data[19:0] = {0x0, Byte1[7:0], Byte0[7:0]}. To Transmit a10-bit Sample Stored in Big Endian Format on AC-link Halfword to be written in AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR).
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte0[7:0] 8 7 {0x00, Byte1[1:0]} 0
Halfword stored in AC'97 Controller Channel x Transmit Holding Register (AC97C_CxTHR) (data to transmit).
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 - 10 9 8 Byte1 [1:0] 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data emitted on related slot: data[19:0] = {0x000, Byte1[1:0], Byte0[7:0]}.
715
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
To Receive Word transfers Data received on appropriate slot: data[19:0] = {Byte2[3:0], Byte1[7:0], Byte0[7:0]}. Word stored in AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) (Received Data).
31 - 24 23 - 20 19 16 Byte2[3:0] 15 Byte1[7:0] 8 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data is read from AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) when Channel x data size is greater than 16 bits and when big-endian mode is enabled (data written to memory).
31 Byte0[7:0] 24 23 Byte1[7:0] 16 15 {0x0, Byte2[3:0]} 8 7 0x00 0
To Receive Halfword Transfers Data received on appropriate slot: data[19:0] = {0x0, Byte1[7:0], Byte0[7:0]}. Halfword stored in AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) (Received Data).
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte1[7:0] 8 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data is read from AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) when data size is equal to 16 bits and when big-endian mode is enabled.
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte0[7:0] 8 7 Byte1[7:0] 0
To Receive 10-bit Samples Data received on appropriate slot: data[19:0] = {0x000, Byte1[1:0], Byte0[7:0]}.Halfword stored in AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) (Received Data)
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 - 10 9 8 Byte1 [1:0] 7 Byte0[7:0] 0
Data read from AC'97 Controller Channel x Receive Holding Register (AC97C_CxRHR) when data size is equal to 10 bits and when big-endian mode is enabled.
31 - 24 23 - 16 15 Byte0[7:0] 8 7 0x00 3 1 0 Byte1 [1:0]
40.6.3
Variable Sample Rate The problem of variable sample rate can be summarized by a simple example. When passing a 44.1 kHz stream across the AC-link, for every 480 audio output frames that are sent across, 441 of them must contain valid sample data. The new AC'97 standard approach calls for the addition of "on-demand" slot request flags. The AC`97 Codec examines its sample rate control register, the state of its FIFOs, and the incoming SDATA_OUT tag bits (slot 0) of each output frame and then determines which SLOTREQ bits to set active (low). These bits are passed from the AC97
716
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Codec to the AC'97 Controller in slot 1/SLOTREQ in every audio input frame. Each time the AC`97 controller sees one or more of the newly defined slot request flags set active (low) in a given audio input frame, it must pass along the next PCM sample for the corresponding slot(s) in the AC-link output frame that immediately follows. The variable Sample Rate mode is enabled by performing the following steps: * Setting the VRA bit in the AC'97 Controller Mode Register (AC97C_MR). * Enable Variable Rate mode in the AC`97 Codec by performing a transfer on the Codec channel. Slot 1 of the input frame is automatically interpreted as SLOTREQ signaling bits. The AC'97 Controller will automatically fill the active slots according to both SLOTREQ and AC97C_OCA register in the next transmitted frame. 40.6.4 40.6.4.1 Power Management Powering Down the AC-Link The AC97 Codecs can be placed in low power mode. The application can bring AC97 Codec to a power down state by performing sequential writes to AC97 Codec powerdown register. Both the bit clock (clock delivered by AC97 Codec, AC97CK) and the input line (AC97RX) are held at a logic low voltage level. This puts AC97 Codec in power down state while all its registers are still holding current values. Without the bit clock, the AC-link is completely in a power down state. The AC'97 Controller should not attempt to play or capture audio data until it has awakened AC97 Codec. To set the AC'97 Codec in low power mode, the PR4 bit in the AC'97 Codec powerdown register (Codec address 0x26) must be set to 1. Then the primary Codec drives both AC97CK and AC97RX to a low logic voltage level. The following operations must be done to put AC97 Codec in low power mode: * Disable Channel A clearing CEN in the AC97C_CAMR register. * Disable Channel B clearing CEN field in the AC97C_CBMR register. * Write 0x2680 value in the AC97C_COTHR register. * Poll the TXEMPTY flag in AC97C_CxSR registers for the 2 channels. At this point AC97 Codec is in low power mode. 40.6.4.2 Waking up the AC-link There are two methods to bring the AC-link out of low power mode. Regardless of the method, it is always the AC97 Controller that performs the wake-up.
Wake-up Triggered by the AC'97 Controller The AC'97 Controller can wake up the AC97 Codec by issuing either a cold or a warm reset. The AC'97 Controller can also wake up the AC97 Codec by asserting AC97FS signal, however this action should not be performed for a minimum period of four audio frames following the frame in which the powerdown was issued. Wake-up Triggered by the AC97 Codec
717
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
This feature is implemented in AC97 modem codecs that need to report events such as CallerID and wake-up on ring. The AC97 Codec can drive AC97RX signal from low to high level and holding it high until the controller issues either a cold or a worm reset. The AC97RX rising edge is asynchronously (regarding AC97FS) detected by the AC'97 Controller. If WKUP bit is enabled in AC97C_IMR register, an interrupt is triggered that wakes up the AC`97 Controller which should then immediately issue a cold or a warm reset. If the processor needs to be awakened by an external event, the AC97RX signal must be externally connected to the WAKEUP entry of the system controller. Figure 40-7. AC'97 Power-Down/Up Sequence
Wake Event Power Down Frame AC97CK Sleep State Warm Reset New Audio Frame
AC97FS
AC97TX
TAG
Write to 0x26
Data PR4
TAG
Slot1
Slot2
AC97RX
TAG
Write to 0x26
Data PR4
TAG
Slot1
Slot2
40.6.4.3
AC97 Codec Reset There are three ways to reset an AC97 Codec.
Cold AC'97 Reset A cold reset is generated by asserting the RESET signal low for the minimum specified time (depending on the AC97 Codec) and then by de-asserting RESET high. AC97CK and AC97FS is reactivated and all AC97 Codec registers are set to their default power-on values. Transfers on AC-link can resume. The RESET signal will be controlled via a PIO line. This is how an application should perform a cold reset: * Clear and set ENA flag in the AC97C_MR register to reset the AC'97 Controller * Clear PIO line output controlling the AC'97 RESET signal * Wait for the minimum specified time * Set PIO line output controlling the AC'97 RESET signal AC97CK, the clock provided by AC97 Codec, is detected by the controller. Warm AC'97 Reset A warm reset reactivates the AC-link without altering AC97 Codec registers. A warm reset is signaled by driving AC97FX signal high for a minimum of 1us in the absence of AC97CK. In the absence of AC97CK, AC97FX is treated as an asynchronous (regarding AC97FX) input used to signal a warm reset to AC97 Codec. This is the right way to perform a warm reset: * Set WRST in the AC97C_MR register.
718
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* Wait for at least 1 us * Clear WRST in the AC97C_MR register. The application can check that operations have resumed by checking SOF flag in the AC97C_SR register or wait for an interrupt notice if SOF is enabled in AC97C_IMR.
719
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.7
AC'97 Controller (AC97C) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register Reserved Mode Register Reserved Input Channel Assignment Register Output Channel Assignment Register Reserved Channel A Receive Holding Register Channel A Transmit Holding Register Channel A Status Register Channel A Mode Register Channel B Receive Holding Register Channel B Transmit Holding Register Channel B Status Register Channel B Mode Register Codec Receive Holding Register Codec Transmit Holding Register Codec Status Register Codec Mode Register Status Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Reserved Register Name - AC97C_MR - AC97C_ICA AC97C_OCA - AC97C_CARHR AC97C_CATHR AC97C_CASR AC97C_CAMR AC97C_CBRHR AC97C_CBTHR AC97C_CBSR AC97C_CBMR AC97C_CORHR AC'97C_COTHR AC'97C_COSR AC'97C_COMR AC97C_SR AC97C_IER AC97C_IDR AC97C_IMR - AC97C_CARPR, AC97C_CARCR, AC97C_CATPR, AC97C_CATCR, AC97C_CARNPR, AC97C_CARNCR, AC97C_CATNPR, AC97C_CATNCR, AC97C_CAPTCR, AC97C_CAPTSR Access - Read/Write - Read/Write Read/Write - Read Write Read Read/Write Read Write Read Read/Write Read Write Read Read/Write Read Write Write Read - Reset - 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 - 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 0x0 - 0x0 0x0 0x0 - - 0x0 -
Table 40-4.
Offset 0x0-0x4 0x8 0xC 0x10 0x14 0x18-0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0x30 0x34 0x38 0x3C 0x40 0x44 0x48 0x4C 0x50 0x54 0x58 0x5C 0x60-0xFB
0x100- 0x124
Reserved for Peripheral Data Controller (PDC), registers related to Channel A transfers
-
-
720
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.1 Name: AC'97 Controller Mode Register AC97C_MR Read-Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 VRA 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WRST 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 ENA
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* VRA: Variable Rate (for Data Slots 3-12) 0: Variable Rate is inactive. (48 KHz only) 1: Variable Rate is active. * WRST: Warm Reset 0: Warm Reset is inactive. 1: Warm Reset is active. * ENA: AC'97 Controller Global Enable 0: No effect. AC'97 function as well as access to other AC'97 Controller registers are disabled. 1: Activates the AC'97 function. 40.7.2 AC'97 Controller Input Channel Assignment Register Register Name: AC97C_ICA Access Type:
31 - 23 15 CHID8 7 CHID5
Read/Write
30 - 22 CHID10 14 6 29 21 13 CHID7 5 28 CHID12 20 12 4 CHID4 27 19 CHID9 11 3 26 18 10 CHID6 2 25 CHID11 17 CHID8 9 1 CHID3 8 CHID5 0 24 16
* CHIDx: Channel ID for the input slot x
CHIDx 0x0 0x1 0x2 Selected Receive Channel None. No data will be received during this Slot x Channel A data will be received during this slot time. Channel B data will be received during this slot time
721
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.7.3 AC'97 Controller Output Channel Assignment Register Register Name: AC97C_OCA Access Type:
31 - 23 15 CHID8 7 CHID5
Read/Write
30 - 22 CHID10 14 6 29 21 13 CHID7 5 28 CHID12 20 12 4 CHID4 27 19 CHID9 11 3 26 18 10 CHID6 2 25 CHID11 17 CHID8 9 1 CHID3 8 CHID5 0 24 16
* CHIDx: Channel ID for the output slot x
CHIDx 0x0 0x1 0x2 Selected Transmit Channel None. No data will be transmitted during this Slot x Channel A data will be transferred during this slot time. Channel B data will be transferred during this slot time
722
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.4 AC'97 Controller Codec Channel Receive Holding Register Register Name: AC97C_CORHR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 7
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 SDATA 4 SDATA 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 - 11 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
* SDATA: Status Data Data sent by the CODEC in the third AC'97 input frame slot (Slot 2).
40.7.5 AC'97 Controller Codec Channel Transmit Holding Register Register Name: AC97C_COTHR Access Type:
31 - 23 READ 15 7
Write-only
30 - 22 14 6 29 - 21 13 5 28 - 20 12 CDATA 4 CDATA 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 CADDR 11 26 - 18 10 25 - 17 9 24 - 16 8
* READ: Read/Write command 0: Write operation to the CODEC register indexed by the CADDR address. 1: Read operation to the CODEC register indexed by the CADDR address. This flag is sent during the second AC'97 frame slot * CADDR: CODEC control register index Data sent to the CODEC in the second AC'97 frame slot. * CDATA: Command Data Data sent to the CODEC in the third AC'97 frame slot (Slot 2).
723
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.7.6 AC'97 Controller Channel A, Channel B Receive Holding Register Register Name: AC97C_CARHR, AC97C_CBRHR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 7
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 RDATA 4 RDATA 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 11 26 - 18 RDATA 10 9 8 25 - 17 24 - 16
* RDATA: Receive Data Received Data on channel x.
40.7.7 AC'97 Controller Channel A, Channel B Transmit Holding Register Register Name: AC97C_CATHR, AC97C_CBTHR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 7
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 6 29 - 21 - 13 5 28 - 20 - 12 TDATA 4 TDATA 3 2 1 0 27 - 19 11 26 - 18 TDATA 10 9 8 25 - 17 24 - 16
* TDATA: Transmit Data Data to be sent on channel x.
724
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.8 AC'97 Controller Channel A Status Register Register Name: AC97C_CASR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 RXBUFF 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 ENDRX 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 TXBUFE 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 ENDTX 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 TXRDY
40.7.9 AC'97 Controller Channel B Status Register Register Name: AC97C_CBSR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 TXRDY
40.7.10 AC'97 Controller Codec Channel Status Register Register Name: AC97C_COSR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 TXRDY
* TXRDY: Channel Transmit Ready 0: Data has been loaded in Channel Transmit Register and is waiting to be loaded in the Channel Transmit Shift Register. 1: Channel Transmit Register is empty. * TXEMPTY: Channel Transmit Empty 0: Data remains in the Channel Transmit Register or is currently transmitted from the Channel Transmit Shift Register. 1: Data in the Channel Transmit Register have been loaded in the Channel Transmit Shift Register and sent to the codec.
725
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* UNRUN: Transmit Underrun Active only when Variable Rate Mode is enabled (VRA bit set in the AC97C_MR register). Automatically cleared by a processor read operation. 0: No data has been requested from the channel since the last read of the Status Register, or data has been available each time the CODEC requested new data from the channel since the last read of the Status Register. 1: Data has been emitted while no valid data to send has been previously loaded into the Channel Transmit Shift Register since the last read of the Status Register. * RXRDY: Channel Receive Ready 0: Channel Receive Holding Register is empty. 1: Data has been received and loaded in Channel Receive Holding Register. * OVRUN: Receive Overrun Automatically cleared by a processor read operation. 0: No data has been loaded in the Channel Receive Holding Register while previous data has not been read since the last read of the Status Register. 1: Data has been loaded in the Channel Receive Holding Register while previous data has not yet been read since the last read of the Status Register. * ENDRX: End of Reception for Channel x 0: The register AC97C_CxRCR has not reached 0 since the last write in AC97C_CxRCR or AC97C_CxRNCR. 1: The register AC97C_CxRCR has reached 0 since the last write in AC97C_CxRCR or AC97C_CxRNCR. * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full for Channel x 0: AC97C_CxRCR or AC97C_CxRNCR have a value other than 0. 1: Both AC97C_CxRCR and AC97C_CxRNCR have a value of 0. * ENDTX: End of Transmission for Channel x 0: The register AC97C_CxTCR has not reached 0 since the last write in AC97C_CxTCR or AC97C_CxNCR. 1: The register AC97C_CxTCR has reached 0 since the last write in AC97C_CxTCR or AC97C_CxTNCR. * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty for Channel x 0: AC97C_CxTCR or AC97C_CxTNCR have a value other than 0. 1: Both AC97C_CxTCR and AC97C_CxTNCR have a value of 0.
726
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.11 AC'97 Controller Channel A Mode Register Register Name: AC97C_CAMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 RXBUFF 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 PDCEN 14 ENDRX 6 - 29 - 21 CEN 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 TXBUFE 3 - 26 - 18 CEM 10 ENDTX 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 SIZE 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 8 - 0 TXRDY 24 - 16
40.7.12 AC'97 Controller Channel B Mode Register Register Name: AC97C_CBMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 CEN 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 CEM 10 - 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 SIZE 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 8 - 0 TXRDY 24 - 16
* CEM: Channel x Endian Mode 0: Transferring data through Channel x is straightforward (Little-endian). 1: Transferring data through Channel x from/to a memory is performed with from/to Big-endian format translation. * SIZE: Channel x Data Size SIZE Encoding
SIZE 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Note: Selected Channel 20 bits 18bits 16 bits 10 bits
Each time slot in the data phase is 20 bits long. For example, if a 16-bit sample stream is being played to an AC97 DAC, the first 16 bit positions are presented to the DAC MSB-justified. They are followed by the next four bit positions that the AC'97 Controller fills with zeroes. This process ensures that the least significant bits do not introduce any DC biasing, regardless of the implemented DAC's resolution (16-, 18-, or 20-bit).
* CEN: Channel x Enable 0: Data transfer is disabled on Channel x. 1: Data transfer is enabled on Channel x.
727
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* PDCCEN: Peripheral Data Controller Channel Enable 0: Channel x is not transferred through a Peripheral Data Controller Channel. Related PDC flags are ignored or not generated. 1: Channel x is transferred through a Peripheral Data Controller Channel. Related PDC flags are taken into account or generated.
728
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.13 AC'97 Controller Codec Channel Mode Register Register Name: AC97C_COMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OVRUN 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 RXRDY 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 UNRUN 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 TXEMPTY 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 TXRDY
* TXRDY: Channel Transmit Ready Interrupt Enable * TXEMPTY: Channel Transmit Empty Interrupt Enable * UNRUN: Transmit Underrun Interrupt Enable * RXRDY: Channel Receive Ready Interrupt Enable * OVRUN: Receive Overrun Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Reception for channel x Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full for channel x Interrupt Enable * ENDTX: End of Transmission for channel x Interrupt Enable * TXBUFE: Transmit Buffer Empty for channel x Interrupt Enable 0: Read: the corresponding interrupt is disabled. Write: disables the corresponding interrupt. 1: Read: the corresponding interrupt is enabled. Write: enables the corresponding interrupt.
729
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.7.14 AC'97 Controller Status Register Register Name: AC97C_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CBEVT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CAEVT 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 COEVT 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WKUP 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 SOF
WKUP and SOF flags in AC97C_SR register are automatically cleared by a processor read operation. * SOF: Start Of Frame 0: No Start of Frame has been detected since the last read of the Status Register. 1: At least one Start of frame has been detected since the last read of the Status Register. * WKUP: Wake Up detection 0: No Wake-up has been detected. 1: At least one rising edge on SDATA_IN has been asynchronously detected. That means AC'97 Codec has notified a wake-up. * COEVT: CODEC Channel Event A Codec channel event occurs when AC97C_COSR AND AC97C_COMR is not 0. COEVT flag is automatically cleared when the channel event condition is cleared. 0: No event on the CODEC channel has been detected since the last read of the Status Register. 1: At least one event on the CODEC channel is active. * CAEVT: Channel A Event A channel A event occurs when AC97C_CASR AND AC97C_CAMR is not 0. CAEVT flag is automatically cleared when the channel event condition is cleared. 0: No event on the channel A has been detected since the last read of the Status Register. 1: At least one event on the channel A is active. * CBEVT: Channel B Event A channel B event occurs when AC97C_CBSR AND AC97C_CBMR is not 0. CBEVT flag is automatically cleared when the channel event condition is cleared. 0: No event on the channel B has been detected since the last read of the Status Register. 1: At least one event on the channel B is active.
730
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
40.7.15 AC'97 Controller Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: AC97C_IER Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CBEVT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CAEVT 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 COEVT 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WKUP 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 SOF
* SOF: Start Of Frame * WKUP: Wake Up * COEVT: Codec Event * CAEVT: Channel A Event * CBEVT: Channel B Event 0: No effect. 1: Enables the corresponding interrupt.
40.7.16 AC'97 Controller Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: AC97C_IDR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CBEVT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CAEVT 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 COEVT 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WKUP 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 SOF
* SOF: Start Of Frame * WKUP: Wake Up * COEVT: Codec Event * CAEVT: Channel A Event * CBEVT: Channel B Event 0: No effect. 1: Disables the corresponding interrupt. 731
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
40.7.17 AC'97 Controller Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: AC97C_IMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 CBEVT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CAEVT 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 COEVT 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 WKUP 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 SOF
* SOF: Start Of Frame * WKUP: Wake Up * COEVT: Codec Event * CAEVT: Channel A Event * CBEVT: Channel B Event 0: The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1: The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
732
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41. USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS)
41.1 Description
The USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) is compliant with the Universal Serial Bus (USB), rev 2.0 High Speed device specification. Each endpoint can be configured in one of several USB transfer types. It can be associated with one, two or three banks of a dual-port RAM used to store the current data payload. If two or three banks are used, one DPR bank is read or written by the processor, while the other is read or written by the USB device peripheral. This feature is mandatory for isochronous endpoints.
Table 41-1.
Endpoint # 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Note:
UDPHS Endpoint Description
Mnemonic EPT_0 EPT_1 EPT_2 EPT_3 EPT_4 EPT_5 EPT_6 Nb Bank 1 2 2 3 3 3 3 DMA N Y Y Y Y Y Y High Band Width N N N Y Y Y Y Max. Endpoint Size 64 1024 1024 1024 1024 1024 1024 Endpoint Type Control Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt Ctrl/Bulk/Iso(1)/Interrupt
1. In Isochronous Mode (Iso), it is preferable that High Band Width capability is available.
The size of internal DPRAM is 4 KB. Suspend and resume are automatically detected by the UDPHS device, which notifies the processor by raising an interrupt.
733
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.2
Block Diagram
Figure 41-1. Block Diagram:
APB Interface ctrl status USB2.0 CORE Rd/Wr/Ready AHB1 DMA AHB0
APB bus
UTMI
AHB bus
Master AHB Multiplexeur Slave Local AHB Slave interface
APB bus
EPT Alloc
16/8 bits DPRAM
32 bits
USB Clock Domain
System Clock Domain
734
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.3 Typical Connection
Figure 41-2. Board Schematic
PIO (VBUS DETECT) "B" Receptacle 1 = VBUS 2 = D3 = D+ 4 = GND
1 2
DHSDM 39 5% DFSDM Shell = Shield DHSDP 39 5%
15k 22k
(1)
(1)
CRPB
3
4
CRPB:1F to 10F
DFSDP 6K8 1% VBG 10 pF GND
Note:
The values shown on the 22 k and 15 k resistors are only valid with 3V3 supplied PIOs.
41.4
41.4.1
Functional Description
USB V2.0 High Speed Device Port Introduction The USB V2.0 High Speed Device Port provides communication services between host and attached USB devices. Each device is offered with a collection of communication flows (pipes) associated with each endpoint. Software on the host communicates with a USB Device through a set of communication flows. USB V2.0 High Speed Transfer Types A communication flow is carried over one of four transfer types defined by the USB device. A device provides several logical communication pipes with the host. To each logical pipe is associated an endpoint. Transfer through a pipe belongs to one of the four transfer types: * Control Transfers: Used to configure a device at attach time and can be used for other devicespecific purposes, including control of other pipes on the device. * Bulk Data Transfers: Generated or consumed in relatively large burst quantities and have wide dynamic latitude in transmission constraints. * Interrupt Data Transfers: Used for timely but reliable delivery of data, for example, characters or coordinates with human-perceptible echo or feedback response characteristics. * Isochronous Data Transfers: Occupy a prenegotiated amount of USB bandwidth with a prenegotiated delivery latency. (Also called streaming real time transfers.) As indicated below, transfers are sequential events carried out on the USB bus. Endpoints must be configured according to the transfer type they handle.
41.4.2
735
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 41-2.
Transfer Control Isochronous Interrupt Bulk
USB Communication Flow
Direction Bidirectional Unidirectional Unidirectional Unidirectional Bandwidth Not guaranteed Guaranteed Not guaranteed Not guaranteed Endpoint Size 8,16,32,64 8-1024 8-1024 8-512 Error Detection Yes Yes Yes Yes Retrying Automatic No Yes Yes
41.4.3
USB Transfer Event Definitions A transfer is composed of one or several transactions; USB Transfer Events
Control Transfers (1) * Setup transaction Data IN transactions Status OUT transaction * Setup transaction Data OUT transactions Status IN transaction * Setup transaction Status IN transaction * Data IN transaction Data IN transaction * Data IN transaction Data IN transaction
(2)
Table 41-3.
CONTROL (bidirectional)
Bulk IN Transfer IN (device toward host) Interrupt IN Transfer Isochronous IN Transfer Bulk OUT Transfer OUT (host toward device) Interrupt OUT Transfer Isochronous OUT Transfer (2) Notes:
* Data IN transaction Data IN transaction * Data OUT transaction Data OUT transaction * Data OUT transaction Data OUT transaction * Data OUT transaction Data OUT transaction
1. Control transfer must use endpoints with one bank and can be aborted using a stall handshake. 2. Isochronous transfers must use endpoints configured with two or three banks.
An endpoint handles all transactions related to the type of transfer for which it has been configured. 41.4.4 USB V2.0 High Speed BUS Transactions Each transfer results in one or more transactions over the USB bus. There are five kinds of transactions flowing across the bus in packets: 1. Setup Transaction 2. Data IN Transaction 3. Data OUT Transaction 4. Status IN Transaction 5. Status OUT Transaction
736
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 41-3. Control Read and Write Sequences
Setup Stage Data Stage Status Stage
Control Write
Setup TX
Data OUT TX
Data OUT TX
Status IN TX
Setup Stage
Data Stage
Status Stage
Control Read
Setup TX
Data IN TX
Data IN TX
Status OUT TX
Setup Stage
Status Stage
No Data Control
Setup TX
Status IN TX
A status IN or OUT transaction is identical to a data IN or OUT transaction. 41.4.5 Endpoint Configuration The endpoint 0 is always a control endpoint, it must be programmed and active in order to be enabled when the End Of Reset interrupt occurs. To configure the endpoints: * Fill the configuration register (UDPHS_EPTCFG) with the endpoint size, direction (IN or OUT), type (CTRL, Bulk, IT, ISO) and the number of banks. * Fill the number of transactions (NB_TRANS) for isochronous endpoints. Note: For control endpoints the direction has no effect. * Verify that the EPT_MAPD flag is set. This flag is set if the endpoint size and the number of banks are correct compared to the FIFO maximum capacity and the maximum number of allowed banks. * Configure control flags of the endpoint and enable it in UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx according to "UDPHS Endpoint Control Register" on page 787. Control endpoints can generate interrupts and use only 1 bank. All endpoints (except endpoint 0) can be configured either as Bulk, Interrupt or Isochronous. See Table 41-1. UDPHS Endpoint Description. The maximum packet size they can accept corresponds to the maximum endpoint size. Note: The endpoint size of 1024 is reserved for isochronous endpoints. The size of the DPRAM is 4 KB. The DPR is shared by all active endpoints. The memory size required by the active endpoints must not exceed the size of the DPRAM.
SIZE_DPRAM = SIZE _EPT0
737
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
+ NB_BANK_EPT1 x SIZE_EPT1 + NB_BANK_EPT2 x SIZE_EPT2 + NB_BANK_EPT3 x SIZE_EPT3 + NB_BANK_EPT4 x SIZE_EPT4 + NB_BANK_EPT5 x SIZE_EPT5 + NB_BANK_EPT6 x SIZE_EPT6 +... (refer to 41.5.16 UDPHS Endpoint Configuration Register) If a user tries to configure endpoints with a size the sum of which is greater than the DPRAM, then the EPT_MAPD is not set. The application has access to the physical block of DPR reserved for the endpoint through a 64 KB logical address space. The physical block of DPR allocated for the endpoint is remapped all along the 64 KB logical address space. The application can write a 64 KB buffer linearly. Figure 41-4. Logical Address Space for DPR Access:
DPR x banks Logical address 8 to 64 B 8 to 64 B 8 to 64 B ... 8 to 64 B
64 KB EP0
8 to1024 B
y banks
8 to1024 B 64 KB 8 to1024 B 8 to1024 B EP1 ... 64 KB EP2 64 KB EP3 ...
z banks 8 to1024 B
8 to1024 B
Configuration examples of UDPHS_EPTCTLx (UDPHS Endpoint Control Register) for Bulk IN endpoint type follow below. * With DMA - AUTO_VALID: Automatically validate the packet and switch to the next bank. - EPT_ENABL: Enable endpoint.
* Without DMA: - TX_BK_RDY: An interrupt is generated after each transmission.
738
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
- EPT_ENABL: Enable endpoint. Configuration examples of Bulk OUT endpoint type follow below. * With DMA - AUTO_VALID: Automatically validate the packet and switch to the next bank. - EPT_ENABL: Enable endpoint. * Without DMA - RX_BK_RDY: An interrupt is sent after a new packet has been stored in the endpoint FIFO. - EPT_ENABL: Enable endpoint.
739
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.4.6
Transfer With DMA USB packets of any length may be transferred when required by the UDPHS Device. These transfers always feature sequential addressing. Packet data AHB bursts may be locked on a DMA buffer basis for drastic overall AHB bus bandwidth performance boost with paged memories. These clock-cycle consuming memory row (or bank) changes will then likely not occur, or occur only once instead of dozens times, during a single big USB packet DMA transfer in case another AHB master addresses the memory. This means up to 128-word single-cycle unbroken AHB bursts for Bulk endpoints and 256-word single-cycle unbroken bursts for isochronous endpoints. This maximum burst length is then controlled by the lowest programmed USB endpoint size (EPT_SIZE bit in the UDPHS_EPTCFGx register) and DMA Size (BUFF_LENGTH bit in the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register). The USB 2.0 device average throughput may be up to nearly 60 MBytes. Its internal slave average access latency decreases as burst length increases due to the 0 wait-state side effect of unchanged endpoints. If at least 0 wait-state word burst capability is also provided by the external DMA AHB bus slaves, each of both DMA AHB busses need less than 50% bandwidth allocation for full USB 2.0 bandwidth usage at 30 MHz, and less than 25% at 60 MHz. The UDPHS DMA Channel Transfer Descriptor is described in "UDPHS DMA Channel Transfer Descriptor" on page 798. Note: In case of debug, be careful to address the DMA to an SRAM address even if a remap is done.
Figure 41-5. Example of DMA Chained List:
Transfer Descriptor UDPHS Registers (Current Transfer Descriptor) UDPHS Next Descriptor Next Descriptor Address DMA Channel Address DMA Channel Control DMA Channel Address Transfer Descriptor Next Descriptor Address DMA Channel Address DMA Channel Control DMA Channel Control DMA Channel Address DMA Channel Control Null Memory Area Data Buff 1 Transfer Descriptor Next Descriptor Address
Data Buff 2 Data Buff 3
740
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.4.7 Transfer Without DMA Important. If the DMA is not to be used, it is necessary that it be disabled because otherwise it can be enabled by previous versions of software without warning. If this should occur, the DMA can process data before an interrupt without knowledge of the user. The recommended means to disable DMA is as follows:
// Reset IP UDPHS AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_CTRL &= ~AT91C_UDPHS_EN_UDPHS; AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_CTRL |= AT91C_UDPHS_EN_UDPHS; // With OR without DMA !!! for( i=1; i<=((AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_IPFEATURES & AT91C_UDPHS_DMA_CHANNEL_NBR)>>4); i++ ) { // RESET endpoint canal DMA: // DMA stop channel command AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_DMA[i].UDPHS_DMACONTROL = 0; command // Disable endpoint AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_EPT[i].UDPHS_EPTCTLDIS |= 0XFFFFFFFF; // Reset endpoint config AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_EPT[i].UDPHS_EPTCTLCFG = 0; // Reset DMA channel (Buff count and Control field) AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_DMA[i].UDPHS_DMACONTROL = 0x02; STOP command // Reset DMA channel 0 (STOP) AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_DMA[i].UDPHS_DMACONTROL = 0; command // Clear DMA channel status (read the register for clear it) AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_DMA[i].UDPHS_DMASTATUS = AT91C_BASE_UDPHS->UDPHS_DMA[i].UDPHS_DMASTATUS; } // STOP // NON // STOP
41.4.8 41.4.8.1
Handling Transactions with USB V2.0 Device Peripheral Setup Transaction The setup packet is valid in the DPR while RX_SETUP is set. Once RX_SETUP is cleared by the application, the UDPHS accepts the next packets sent over the device endpoint. When a valid setup packet is accepted by the UDPHS: * the UDPHS device automatically acknowledges the setup packet (sends an ACK response) * payload data is written in the endpoint * sets the RX_SETUP interrupt * the BYTE_COUNT field in the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register is updated An endpoint interrupt is generated while RX_SETUP in the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register is not cleared. This interrupt is carried out to the microcontroller if interrupts are enabled for this endpoint.
741
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Thus, firmware must detect RX_SETUP polling UDPHS_EPTSTAx or catching an interrupt, read the setup packet in the FIFO, then clear the RX_SETUP bit in the UDPHS_EPTCLRSTA register to acknowledge the setup stage. If STALL_SNT was set to 1, then this bit is automatically reset when a setup token is detected by the device. Then, the device still accepts the setup stage. (See Section 41.4.8.15 "STALL" on page 753). 41.4.8.2 NYET NYET is a High Speed only handshake. It is returned by a High Speed endpoint as part of the PING protocol. High Speed devices must support an improved NAK mechanism for Bulk OUT and control endpoints (except setup stage). This mechanism allows the device to tell the host whether it has sufficient endpoint space for the next OUT transfer (see USB 2.0 spec 8.5.1 NAK Limiting via Ping Flow Control). The NYET/ACK response to a High Speed Bulk OUT transfer and the PING response are automatically handled by hardware in the UDPHS_EPTCTLx register (except when the user wants to force a NAK response by using the NYET_DIS bit). If the endpoint responds instead to the OUT/DATA transaction with an NYET handshake, this means that the endpoint accepted the data but does not have room for another data payload. The host controller must return to using a PING token until the endpoint indicates it has space available. Figure 41-6. NYET Example with Two Endpoint Banks
data 0 ACK
data 1 NYET
PING
ACK
data 0 NYET
PING
NACK
PING
ACK
t=0
t = 125 s
t = 250 s
t = 375 s
t = 500 s
t = 625 s
E: empty E': begin to empty F: full
Bank 1 E Bank 0 F
Bank 1 F Bank 1 F Bank 0 E' Bank 0 E
Bank 1 F Bank 0 E
Bank 1 F Bank 0 F
Bank 1 E' Bank 0 F
Bank 1 E Bank 0 F
41.4.8.3 41.4.8.4
Data IN Bulk IN or Interrupt IN Data IN packets are sent by the device during the data or the status stage of a control transfer or during an (interrupt/bulk/isochronous) IN transfer. Data buffers are sent packet by packet under the control of the application or under the control of the DMA channel. There are three ways for an application to transfer a buffer in several packets over the USB: * packet by packet (see 41.4.8.5 below) * 64 KB (see 41.4.8.5 below) * DMA (see 41.4.8.6 below)
41.4.8.5
Bulk IN or Interrupt IN: Sending a Packet Under Application Control (Device to Host) The application can write one or several banks.
742
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
A simple algorithm can be used by the application to send packets regardless of the number of banks associated to the endpoint. Algorithm Description for Each Packet: * The application waits for TX_PK_RDY flag to be cleared in the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register before it can perform a write access to the DPR. * The application writes one USB packet of data in the DPR through the 64 KB endpoint logical memory window. * The application sets TX_PK_RDY flag in the UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx register. The application is notified that it is possible to write a new packet to the DPR by the TX_PK_RDY interrupt. This interrupt can be enabled or masked by setting the TX_PK_RDY bit in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENB/UDPHS_EPTCTLDIS register. Algorithm Description to Fill Several Packets: Using the previous algorithm, the application is interrupted for each packet. It is possible to reduce the application overhead by writing linearly several banks at the same time. The AUTO_VALID bit in the UDPHS_EPTCTLx must be set by writing the AUTO_VALID bit in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx register. The auto-valid-bank mechanism allows the transfer of data (IN and OUT) without the intervention of the CPU. This means that bank validation (set TX_PK_RDY or clear the RX_BK_RDY bit) is done by hardware. * The application checks the BUSY_BANK_STA field in the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register. The application must wait that at least one bank is free. * The application writes a number of bytes inferior to the number of free DPR banks for the endpoint. Each time the application writes the last byte of a bank, the TX_PK_RDY signal is automatically set by the UDPHS. * If the last packet is incomplete (i.e., the last byte of the bank has not been written) the application must set the TX_PK_RDY bit in the UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx register. The application is notified that all banks are free, so that it is possible to write another burst of packets by the BUSY_BANK interrupt. This interrupt can be enabled or masked by setting the BUSY_BANK flag in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENB and UDPHS_EPTCTLDIS registers. This algorithm must not be used for isochronous transfer. In this case, the ping-pong mechanism does not operate. A Zero Length Packet can be sent by setting just the TX_PKTRDY flag in the UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx register. 41.4.8.6 Bulk IN or Interrupt IN: Sending a Buffer Using DMA (Device to Host) The UDPHS integrates a DMA host controller. This DMA controller can be used to transfer a buffer from the memory to the DPR or from the DPR to the processor memory under the UDPHS control. The DMA can be used for all transfer types except control transfer. Example DMA configuration: 1. Program UDPHS_DMAADDRESS x with the address of the buffer that should be transferred. 2. Enable the interrupt of the DMA in UDPHS_IEN 3. Program UDPHS_ DMACONTROLx:
743
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- Size of buffer to send: size of the buffer to be sent to the host. - END_B_EN: The endpoint can validate the packet (according to the values programmed in the AUTO_VALID and SHRT_PCKT fields of UDPHS_EPTCTLx.) (See "UDPHS Endpoint Control Register" on page 787 and Figure 41-11. Autovalid with DMA) - END_BUFFIT: generate an interrupt when the BUFF_COUNT in UDPHS_DMASTATUSx reaches 0. - CHANN_ENB: Run and stop at end of buffer The auto-valid-bank mechanism allows the transfer of data (IN & OUT) without the intervention of the CPU. This means that bank validation (set TX_PK_RDY or clear the RX_BK_RDY bit) is done by hardware. A transfer descriptor can be used. Instead of programming the register directly, a descriptor should be programmed and the address of this descriptor is then given to UDPHS_DMANXTDSC to be processed after setting the LDNXT_DSC field (Load Next Descriptor Now) in UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register. The structure that defines this transfer descriptor must be aligned. Each buffer to be transferred must be described by a DMA Transfer descriptor (see "UDPHS DMA Channel Transfer Descriptor" on page 798). Transfer descriptors are chained. Before executing transfer of the buffer, the UDPHS may fetch a new transfer descriptor from the memory address pointed by the UDPHS_DMANXTDSCx register. Once the transfer is complete, the transfer status is updated in the UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register. To chain a new transfer descriptor with the current DMA transfer, the DMA channel must be stopped. To do so, INTDIS_DMA and TX_BK_RDY may be set in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx register. It is also possible for the application to wait for the completion of all transfers. In this case the LDNXT_DSC field in the last transfer descriptor UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register must be set to 0 and CHANN_ENB set to 1. Then the application can chain a new transfer descriptor. The INTDIS_DMA can be used to stop the current DMA transfer if an enabled interrupt is triggered. This can be used to stop DMA transfers in case of errors. The application can be notified at the end of any buffer transfer (ENB_BUFFIT bit in the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register).
744
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 41-7. Data IN Transfer for Endpoint with One Bank
Prevous Data IN TX Microcontroller Loads Data in FIFO Data is Sent on USB Bus
USB Bus Packets
Token IN
Data IN 1
ACK
Token IN
NAK
Token IN
Data IN 2
ACK
TX_PK_RDY Flag (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Set by firmware
Cleared by hardware
Set by the firmware Interrupt Pending
Cleared by hardware Interrupt Pending Payload in FIFO
TX_COMPLT Flag (UDPHS_EPTSTAx)
Set by hardware DPR access by firmware
Cleared by firmware DPR access by hardware Data IN 2
Cleared by firmware
FIFO Content
Data IN 1
Load in progress
Figure 41-8. Data IN Transfer for Endpoint with Two Banks
Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 0 USB Bus Packets Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 1 UDPHS Device Send Bank 0 Microcontroller Load Data IN Bank 0 UDPHS Device Send Bank 1
Token IN
Data IN
ACK
Token IN
Data IN
ACK
Set by Firmware, Cleared by Hardware Data Payload Written switch to next bank in FIFO Bank 0 Virtual TX_PK_RDY bank 0 (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Virtual TX_PK_RDY bank 1 (UDPHS_EPTSTAx)
Cleared by Hardware Data Payload Fully Transmitted
Set by Firmware, Data Payload Written in FIFO Bank 1 Interrupt Pending Set by Hardware Interrupt Cleared by Firmware Set by Hardware
TX_COMPLT Flag (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) FIFO (DPR) Bank 0
Written by Microcontroller
Read by USB Device
Written by Microcontroller
FIFO (DPR) Bank1
Written by Microcontroller
Read by UDPHS Device
745
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 41-9. Data IN Followed By Status OUT Transfer at the End of a Control Transfer
Device Sends the Last Data Payload to Host USB Bus Packets Device Sends a Status OUT to Host ACK ACK
Token IN
Data IN
ACK
Token OUT
Data OUT (ZLP)
Token OUT
Data OUT (ZLP)
Interrupt Pending
RX_BK_RDY (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Set by Hardware Cleared by Firmware TX_COMPLT (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Set by Hardware Cleared by Firmware
Note: A NAK handshake is always generated at the first status stage token. Figure 41-10. Data OUT Followed by Status IN Transfer
Host Sends the Last Data Payload to the Device Device Sends a Status IN to the Host
USB Bus Packets
Token OUT
Data OUT
ACK
Token IN
Data IN
ACK
Interrupt Pending RX_BK_RDY (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Set by Hardware TX_PK_RDY (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) Set by Firmware Clear by Hardware
Cleared by Firmware
Note: Before proceeding to the status stage, the software should determine that there is no risk of extra data from the host (data stage). If not certain (non-predictable data stage length), then the software should wait for a NAK-IN interrupt before proceeding to the status stage. This precaution should be taken to avoid collision in the FIFO.
746
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 41-11. Autovalid with DMA
Bank (system) Bank 0 Bank 1 Bank 0 Bank 1
Write
write bank 0
write bank 1 bank 1 is full
write bank 0 bank 0 is full
bank 0 is full
Bank 1
Bank 0 IN data 0 IN data 1 IN data 0
Bank (usb)
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank 0
Bank 1
Virtual TX_PK_RDY Bank 0
Virtual TX_PK_RDY Bank 1
TX_PK_RDY (Virtual 0 & Virtual 1)
Note:
In the illustration above Autovalid validates a bank as full, although this might not be the case, in order to continue processing data and to send to DMA.
41.4.8.7
Isochronous IN Isochronous-IN is used to transmit a stream of data whose timing is implied by the delivery rate. Isochronous transfer provides periodic, continuous communication between host and device. It guarantees bandwidth and low latencies appropriate for telephony, audio, video, etc. If the endpoint is not available (TX_PK_RDY = 0), then the device does not answer to the host. An ERR_FL_ISO interrupt is generated in the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register and once enabled, then sent to the CPU. The STALL_SNT command bit is not used for an ISO-IN endpoint.
41.4.8.8
High Bandwidth Isochronous Endpoint Handling: IN Example For high bandwidth isochronous endpoints, the DMA can be programmed with the number of transactions (BUFF_LENGTH field in UDPHS_DMACONTROLx) and the system should provide
747
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
the required number of packets per microframe, otherwise, the host will notice a sequencing problem. A response should be made to the first token IN recognized inside a microframe under the following conditions: * If at least one bank has been validated, the correct DATAx corresponding to the programmed Number Of Transactions per Microframe (NB_TRANS) should be answered. In case of a subsequent missed or corrupted token IN inside the microframe, the USB 2.0 Core available data bank(s) that should normally have been transmitted during that microframe shall be flushed at its end. If this flush occurs, an error condition is flagged (ERR_FLUSH is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). * If no bank is validated yet, the default DATA0 ZLP is answered and underflow is flagged (ERR_FL_ISO is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). Then, no data bank is flushed at microframe end. * If no data bank has been validated at the time when a response should be made for the second transaction of NB_TRANS = 3 transactions microframe, a DATA1 ZLP is answered and underflow is flagged (ERR_FL_ISO is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). If and only if remaining untransmitted banks for that microframe are available at its end, they are flushed and an error condition is flagged (ERR_FLUSH is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). * If no data bank has been validated at the time when a response should be made for the last programmed transaction of a microframe, a DATA0 ZLP is answered and underflow is flagged (ERR_FL_ISO is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). If and only if the remaining untransmitted data bank for that microframe is available at its end, it is flushed and an error condition is flagged (ERR_FLUSH is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). * If at the end of a microframe no valid token IN has been recognized, no data bank is flushed and no error condition is reported. At the end of a microframe in which at least one data bank has been transmitted, if less than NB_TRANS banks have been validated for that microframe, an error condition is flagged (ERR_TRANS is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx). Cases of Error (in UDPHS_EPTSTAx) * ERR_FL_ISO: There was no data to transmit inside a microframe, so a ZLP is answered by default. * ERR_FLUSH: At least one packet has been sent inside the microframe, but the number of token IN received is lesser than the number of transactions actually validated (TX_BK_RDY) and likewise with the NB_TRANS programmed. * ERR_TRANS: At least one packet has been sent inside the microframe, but the number of token IN received is lesser than the number of programmed NB_TRANS transactions and the packets not requested were not validated. * ERR_FL_ISO + ERR_FLUSH: At least one packet has been sent inside the microframe, but the data has not been validated in time to answer one of the following token IN. * ERR_FL_ISO + ERR_TRANS: At least one packet has been sent inside the microframe, but the data has not been validated in time to answer one of the following token IN and the data can be discarded at the microframe end. * ERR_FLUSH + ERR_TRANS: The first token IN has been answered and it was the only one received, a second bank has been validated but not the third, whereas NB_TRANS was waiting for three transactions.
748
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* ERR_FL_ISO + ERR_FLUSH + ERR_TRANS: The first token IN has been treated, the data for the second Token IN was not available in time, but the second bank has been validated before the end of the microframe. The third bank has not been validated, but three transactions have been set in NB_TRANS. 41.4.8.9 41.4.8.10 Data OUT Bulk OUT or Interrupt OUT Like data IN, data OUT packets are sent by the host during the data or the status stage of control transfer or during an interrupt/bulk/isochronous OUT transfer. Data buffers are sent packet by packet under the control of the application or under the control of the DMA channel. Bulk OUT or Interrupt OUT: Receiving a Packet Under Application Control (Host to Device) Algorithm Description for Each Packet: * The application enables an interrupt on RX_BK_RDY. * When an interrupt on RX_BK_RDY is received, the application knows that UDPHS_EPTSTAx register BYTE_COUNT bytes have been received. * The application reads the BYTE_COUNT bytes from the endpoint. * The application clears RX_BK_RDY. Note: If the application does not know the size of the transfer, it may not be a good option to use AUTO_VALID. Because if a zero-length-packet is received, the RX_BK_RDY is automatically cleared by the AUTO_VALID hardware and if the endpoint interrupt is triggered, the software will not find its originating flag when reading the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register. Algorithm to Fill Several Packets: * The application enables the interrupts of BUSY_BANK and AUTO_VALID. * When a BUSY_BANK interrupt is received, the application knows that all banks available for the endpoint have been filled. Thus, the application can read all banks available. If the application doesn't know the size of the receive buffer, instead of using the BUSY_BANK interrupt, the application must use RX_BK_RDY. 41.4.8.12 Bulk OUT or Interrupt OUT: Sending a Buffer Using DMA (Host To Device) To use the DMA setting, the AUTO_VALID field is mandatory. See 41.4.8.6 Bulk IN or Interrupt IN: Sending a Buffer Using DMA (Device to Host) for more information. DMA Configuration Example: 1. First program UDPHS_DMAADDRESSx with the address of the buffer that should be transferred. 2. Enable the interrupt of the DMA in UDPHS_IEN 3. Program the DMA Channelx Control Register: - Size of buffer to be sent. - END_B_EN: Can be used for OUT packet truncation (discarding of unbuffered packet data) at the end of DMA buffer.
41.4.8.11
749
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- END_BUFFIT: Generate an interrupt when BUFF_COUNT in the UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register reaches 0. - END_TR_EN: End of transfer enable, the UDPHS device can put an end to the current DMA transfer, in case of a short packet. - END_TR_IT: End of transfer interrupt enable, an interrupt is sent after the last USB packet has been transferred by the DMA, if the USB transfer ended with a short packet. (Beneficial when the receive size is unknown.) - CHANN_ENB: Run and stop at end of buffer. For OUT transfer, the bank will be automatically cleared by hardware when the application has read all the bytes in the bank (the bank is empty). Note: When a zero-length-packet is received, RX_BK_RDY bit in UDPHS_EPTSTAx is cleared automatically by AUTO_VALID, and the application knows of the end of buffer by the presence of the END_TR_IT. Note: If the host sends a zero-length packet, and the endpoint is free, then the device sends an ACK. No data is written in the endpoint, the RX_BY_RDY interrupt is generated, and the BYTE_COUNT field in UDPHS_EPTSTAx is null. Figure 41-12. Data OUT Transfer for Endpoint with One Bank
Host Sends Data Payload Microcontroller Transfers Data Host Sends the Next Data Payload Host Resends the Next Data Payload
USB Bus Packets
Token OUT
Data OUT 1
ACK
Token OUT
Data OUT 2
NAK
Token OUT
Data OUT 2
ACK
RX_BK_RDY (UDPHS_EPTSTAx)
Interrupt Pending Set by Hardware Cleared by Firmware, Data Payload Written in FIFO Data OUT 2 Written by UDPHS Device
FIFO (DPR) Content
Data OUT 1 Written by UDPHS Device
Data OUT 1 Microcontroller Read
750
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 41-13. Data OUT Transfer for an Endpoint with Two Banks
Host sends first data payload Microcontroller reads Data 1 in bank 0, Host sends second data payload Microcontroller reads Data 2 in bank 1, Host sends third data payload
USB Bus Packets
Token OUT
Data OUT 1
ACK
Token OUT
Data OUT 2
ACK
Token OUT
Data OUT 3
Virtual RX_BK_RDY Bank 0
Interrupt pending Set by Hardware, Data payload written in FIFO endpoint bank 0 Set by Hardware Data Payload written in FIFO endpoint bank 1
Cleared by Firmware
Cleared by Firmware Interrupt pending
Virtual RX_BK_RDY Bank 1 RX_BK_RDY = (virtual bank 0 | virtual bank 1) (UDPHS_EPTSTAx) FIFO (DPR) Bank 0 Data OUT 1 Write by UDPHS Device FIFO (DPR) Bank 1
Data OUT 1 Read by Microcontroller
Data OUT 3 Write in progress
Data OUT 2 Write by Hardware
Data OUT 2 Read by Microcontroller
41.4.8.13
High Bandwidth Isochronous Endpoint OUT
Figure 41-14. Bank Management, Example of Three Transactions per Microframe
USB bus Transactions
MDATA0
MDATA1
DATA2
MDATA0
MDATA1
DATA2
t=0 RX_BK_RDY Microcontroller FIFO (DPR) Access
t = 52.5 s (40% of 125 s)
t = 125 s RX_BK_RDY
USB line
Read Bank 1
Read Bank 2
Read Bank 3
Read Bank 1
USB 2.0 supports individual High Speed isochronous endpoints that require data rates up to 192 Mb/s (24 MB/s): 3x1024 data bytes per microframe. To support such a rate, two or three banks may be used to buffer the three consecutive data packets. The microcontroller (or the DMA) should be able to empty the banks very rapidly (at least 24 MB/s on average). NB_TRANS field in UDPHS_EPTCFGx register = Number Of Transactions per Microframe. If NB_TRANS > 1 then it is High Bandwidth.
751
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Example: * If NB_TRANS = 3, the sequence should be either - MData0 - MData0/Data1 - MData0/Data1/Data2 * If NB_TRANS = 2, the sequence should be either - MData0 - MData0/Data1 * If NB_TRANS = 1, the sequence should be - Data0 41.4.8.14 Isochronous Endpoint Handling: OUT Example The user can ascertain the bank status (free or busy), and the toggle sequencing of the data packet for each bank with the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register in the three bit fields as follows: * TOGGLESQ_STA: PID of the data stored in the current bank * CURRENT_BANK: Number of the bank currently being accessed by the microcontroller. * BUSY_BANK_STA: Number of busy bank This is particularly useful in case of a missing data packet. If the inter-packet delay between the OUT token and the Data is greater than the USB standard, then the ISO-OUT transaction is ignored. (Payload data is not written, no interrupt is generated to the CPU.) If there is a data CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) error, the payload is, none the less, written in the endpoint. The ERR_CRISO flag is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx register. If the endpoint is already full, the packet is not written in the DPRAM. The ERR_FL_ISO flag is set in UDPHS_EPTSTAx. If the payload data is greater than the maximum size of the endpoint, then the ERR_OVFLW flag is set. It is the task of the CPU to manage this error. The data packet is written in the endpoint (except the extra data). If the host sends a Zero Length Packet, and the endpoint is free, no data is written in the endpoint, the RX_BK_RDY flag is set, and the BYTE_COUNT field in UDPHS_EPTSTAx register is null. The FRCESTALL command bit is unused for an isochronous endpoint. Otherwise, payload data is written in the endpoint, the RX_BK_RDY interrupt is generated and the BYTE_COUNT in UDPHS_EPTSTAx register is updated.
752
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.4.8.15 STALL STALL is returned by a function in response to an IN token or after the data phase of an OUT or in response to a PING transaction. STALL indicates that a function is unable to transmit or receive data, or that a control pipe request is not supported.
* OUT To stall an endpoint, set the FRCESTALL bit in UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx register and after the STALL_SNT flag has been set, set the TOGGLE_SEG bit in the UDPHS_EPTCLRSTAx register. * IN Set the FRCESTALL bit in UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx register. Figure 41-15. Stall Handshake Data OUT Transfer
USB Bus Packets Token OUT Data OUT Stall PID
FRCESTALL Set by Firmware Cleared by Firmware Interrupt Pending
STALL_SNT Set by Hardware Cleared by Firmware
Figure 41-16. Stall Handshake Data IN Transfer
USB Bus Packets Token IN Stall PID
FRCESTALL Set by Firmware Cleared by Firmware Interrupt Pending STALL_SNT Set by Hardware Cleared by Firmware
753
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.4.9
Speed Identification The high speed reset is managed by the hardware. At the connection, the host makes a reset which could be a classic reset (full speed) or a high speed reset. At the end of the reset process (full or high), the ENDRESET interrupt is generated. Then the CPU should read the SPEED bit in UDPHS_INTSTAx to ascertain the speed mode of the device.
41.4.10
USB V2.0 High Speed Global Interrupt Interrupts are defined in Section 41.5.3 "UDPHS Interrupt Enable Register" (UDPHS_IEN) and in Section 41.5.4 "UDPHS Interrupt Status Register" (UDPHS_INTSTA). Endpoint Interrupts Interrupts are enabled in UDPHS_IEN (see Section 41.5.3 "UDPHS Interrupt Enable Register") and individually masked in UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx (see Section 41.5.17 "UDPHS Endpoint Control Enable Register"). . Table 41-4.
SHRT_PCKT BUSY_BANK NAK_OUT NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NB_TRA RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO TX_PK_RD /ERR_TRANS TX_COMPLT RX_BK_RDY ERR_OVFLW MDATA_RX DATAX_RX
41.4.11
Endpoint Interrupt Source Masks
Short Packet Interrupt Busy Bank Interrupt NAKOUT Interrupt NAKIN/Error Flush Interrupt Stall Sent/CRC error/Number of Transaction Error Interrupt Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt TX Packet Read/Transaction Error Interrupt Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt Received OUT Data Interrupt Overflow Error Interrupt MDATA Interrupt DATAx Interrupt
754
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 41-17. UDPHS Interrupt Control Interface
(UDPHS_IEN) DET_SUSPD MICRO_SOF USB Global IT Sources IEN_SOF ENDRESET WAKE_UP ENDOFRSM UPSTR_RES Global IT mask Global IT sources
(UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx) SHRT_PCKT BUSY_BANK NAK_OUT NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NB_TRA EPT0 IT Sources RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO TX_BK_RDY/ERR_TRANS TX_COMPLT RX_BK_RDY ERR_OVFLW MDATA_RX DATAX_RX EP mask EP sources (UDPHS_IEN) EPT_INT_x EP sources EP mask (UDPHS_IEN) EPT_INT_0 husb2dev interrupt
EPT1-6 IT Sources
(UDPHS_EPTCTLx) INT_DIS_DMA disable DMA channelx request
(UDPHS_DMACONTROLx) EN_BUFFIT
mask (UDPHS_IEN) DMA_INT_x mask
DMA CH x
END_TR_IT mask DESC_LD_IT
755
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.4.12 41.4.12.1
Power Modes Controlling Device States A USB device has several possible states. Refer to Chapter 9 (USB Device Framework) of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0.
Figure 41-18. UDPHS Device State Diagram
Attached
Hub Reset Hub or Configured Deconfigured Bus Inactive Powered Bus Activity Power Interruption Reset Bus Inactive Default Reset Address Assigned Bus Inactive Address Bus Activity Device Deconfigured Device Configured Bus Inactive Configured Bus Activity Suspended Suspended Bus Activity Suspended Suspended
Movement from one state to another depends on the USB bus state or on standard requests sent through control transactions via the default endpoint (endpoint 0). After a period of bus inactivity, the USB device enters Suspend Mode. Accepting Suspend/Resume requests from the USB host is mandatory. Constraints in Suspend Mode are very strict for bus-powered applications; devices may not consume more than 500 A on the USB bus. While in Suspend Mode, the host may wake up a device by sending a resume signal (bus activity) or a USB device may send a wake-up request to the host, e.g., waking up a PC by moving a USB mouse. The wake-up feature is not mandatory for all devices and must be negotiated with the host.
756
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.4.12.2 Not Powered State Self powered devices can detect 5V VBUS using a PIO. When the device is not connected to a host, device power consumption can be reduced by the DETACH bit in UDPHS_CTRL. Disabling the transceiver is automatically done. HSDM, HSDP, FSDP and FSDP lines are tied to GND pull-downs integrated in the hub downstream ports. Entering Attached State When no device is connected, the USB FSDP and FSDM signals are tied to GND by 15 K pulldowns integrated in the hub downstream ports. When a device is attached to an hub downstream port, the device connects a 1.5 K pull-up on FSDP. The USB bus line goes into IDLE state, FSDP is pulled-up by the device 1.5 K resistor to 3.3V and FSDM is pulled-down by the 15 K resistor to GND of the host. After pull-up connection, the device enters the powered state. The transceiver remains disabled until bus activity is detected. In case of low power consumption need, the device can be stopped. When the device detects the VBUS, the software must enable the USB transceiver by enabling the EN_UDPHS bit in UDPHS_CTRL register. The software can detach the pull-up by setting DETACH bit in UDPHS_CTRL register. 41.4.12.4 From Powered State to Default State (Reset) After its connection to a USB host, the USB device waits for an end-of-bus reset. The unmasked flag ENDRESET is set in the UDPHS_IEN register and an interrupt is triggered. Once the ENDRESET interrupt has been triggered, the device enters Default State. In this state, the UDPHS software must: * Enable the default endpoint, setting the EPT_ENABL flag in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENB[0] register and, optionally, enabling the interrupt for endpoint 0 by writing 1 in EPT_INT_0 of the UDPHS_IEN register. The enumeration then begins by a control transfer. * Configure the Interrupt Mask Register which has been reset by the USB reset detection * Enable the transceiver. In this state, the EN_UDPHS bit in UDPHS_CTRL register must be enabled. 41.4.12.5 From Default State to Address State (Address Assigned) After a Set Address standard device request, the USB host peripheral enters the address state. Warning: before the device enters address state, it must achieve the Status IN transaction of the control transfer, i.e., the UDPHS device sets its new address once the TX_COMPLT flag in the UDPHS_EPTCTL[0] register has been received and cleared. To move to address state, the driver software sets the DEV_ADDR field and the FADDR_EN flag in the UDPHS_CTRL register. 41.4.12.6 From Address State to Configured State (Device Configured) Once a valid Set Configuration standard request has been received and acknowledged, the device enables endpoints corresponding to the current configuration. This is done by setting the BK_NUMBER, EPT_TYPE, EPT_DIR and EPT_SIZE fields in the UDPHS_EPTCFGx registers and enabling them by setting the EPT_ENABL flag in the UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx registers, and, optionally, enabling corresponding interrupts in the UDPHS_IEN register.
41.4.12.3
757
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.4.12.7
Entering Suspend State (Bus Activity) When a Suspend (no bus activity on the USB bus) is detected, the DET_SUSPD signal in the UDPHS_STA register is set. This triggers an interrupt if the corresponding bit is set in the UDPHS_IEN register. This flag is cleared by writing to the UDPHS_CLRINT register. Then the device enters Suspend Mode. In this state bus powered devices must drain less than 500 A from the 5V VBUS. As an example, the microcontroller switches to slow clock, disables the PLL and main oscillator, and goes into Idle Mode. It may also switch off other devices on the board. The UDPHS device peripheral clocks can be switched off. Resume event is asynchronously detected.
41.4.12.8
Receiving a Host Resume In Suspend mode, a resume event on the USB bus line is detected asynchronously, transceiver and clocks disabled (however the pull-up should not be removed). Once the resume is detected on the bus, the signal WAKE_UP in the UDPHS_INTSTA is set. It may generate an interrupt if the corresponding bit in the UDPHS_IEN register is set. This interrupt may be used to wake-up the core, enable PLL and main oscillators and configure clocks.
41.4.12.9
Sending an External Resume In Suspend State it is possible to wake-up the host by sending an external resume. The device waits at least 5 ms after being entered in Suspend State before sending an external resume. The device must force a K state from 1 to 15 ms to resume the host.
758
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.4.13 Test Mode A device must support the TEST_MODE feature when in the Default, Address or Configured High Speed device states. TEST_MODE can be: * Test_J * Test_K * Test_Packet * Test_SEO_NAK (See Section 41.5.11 "UDPHS Test Register" on page 775 for definitions of each test mode.)
const char test_packet_buffer[] = { 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, 9 0xAA,0xAA,0xAA,0xAA,0xAA,0xAA,0xAA,0xAA, 8 0xEE,0xEE,0xEE,0xEE,0xEE,0xEE,0xEE,0xEE, 8 0xFE,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF,0xFF, // JJJJJJJKKKKKKK * 8 0x7F,0xBF,0xDF,0xEF,0xF7,0xFB,0xFD, 0xFC,0x7E,0xBF,0xDF,0xEF,0xF7,0xFB,0xFD,0x7E * 10}, JK }; // JJJJJJJK * 8 // {JKKKKKKK // JJKKJJKK * // JJKKJJKK * // JKJKJKJK *
759
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5
USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) User Interface
Register Mapping
Register
UDPHS Control Register UDPHS Frame Number Register Reserved UDPHS Interrupt Enable Register UDPHS Interrupt Status Register UDPHS Clear Interrupt Register UDPHS Endpoints Reset Register Reserved UDPHS Test Register Reserved UDPHS PADDRSIZE Register UDPHS Name1 Register UDPHS Name2 Register UDPHS Features Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Configuration Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Control Enable Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Control Disable Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Control Register Reserved (for endpoint 0) UDPHS Endpoint0 Set Status Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Clear Status Register UDPHS Endpoint0 Status Register UDPHS Endpoint1 to 6 Reserved UDPHS DMA Next Descriptor1 Address Register UDPHS DMA Channel1 Address Register UDPHS DMA Channel1 Control Register UDPHS DMA Channel1 Status Register DMA Channel2 to 5
(3) (2)
Table 41-5.
Offset
0x00 0x04 0x08 - 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 - 0xCC 0xE0 0xE4 - 0xE8 0xEC 0xF0 0xF4 0xF8 0x100 0x104 0x108 0x10C 0x110 0x114 0x118 0x11C 0x120 - 0x1DC 0x300 - 0x30C 0x310 0x314 0x318 0x31C 0x320 - 0x370
Name
UDPHS_CTRL UDPHS_FNUM - UDPHS_IEN UDPHS_INTSTA UDPHS_CLRINT UDPHS_EPTRST - UDPHS_TST - UDPHS_IPPADDRSIZE UDPHS_IPNAME1 UDPHS_IPNAME2 UDPHS_IPFEATURES UDPHS_EPTCFG0 UDPHS_EPTCTLENB0 UDPHS_EPTCTLDIS0 UDPHS_EPTCTL0 - UDPHS_EPTSETSTA0 UDPHS_EPTCLRSTA0 UDPHS_EPTSTA0
Access
Read/Write Read - Read/Write Read Write Write - Read/Write - Read Read Read Read Read/Write Write Write Read - Write Write Read
Reset
0x0000_0200 0x0000_0000 - 0x0000_0010 0x0000_0000 - - - 0x0000_0000 - 0x0000_4000 0x4855_5342 0x3244_4556
0x0000_0000 - - 0x0000_0000(1) - - - 0x0000_0040
Registers - UDPHS_DMANXTDSC1 UDPHS_DMAADDRESS1 UDPHS_DMACONTROL1 UDPHS_DMASTATUS1 - Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write - 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000
Registers
Notes:
1. The reset value for UDPHS_EPTCTL0 is 0x0000_0001. 2. The addresses for the UDPHS Endpoint registers shown here are for UDPHS Endpoint0. The structure of this group of registers is repeated successively for each endpoint according to the consecution of endpoint registers located between 0x120 and 0x1DC. 3. The addresses for the UDPHS DMA registers shown here are for UDPHS DMA Channel1. (There is no Channel0) The structure of this group of registers is repeated successively for each DMA channel according to the consecution of DMA registers located between 0x320 and 0x370.
760
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.1 Name: UDPHS Control Register UDPHS_CTRL Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 PULLD_DIS 3 DEV_ADDR 26 - 18 - 10 REWAKEUP 2 25 - 17 - 9 DETACH 1 24 - 16 - 8 EN_UDPHS 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 FADDR_EN
* DEV_ADDR: UDPHS Address Read: This field contains the default address (0) after power-up or UDPHS bus reset. Write: This field is written with the value set by a SET_ADDRESS request received by the device firmware. * FADDR_EN: Function Address Enable Read: 0 = Device is not in address state. 1 = Device is in address state. Write: 0 = only the default function address is used (0). 1 = this bit is set by the device firmware after a successful status phase of a SET_ADDRESS transaction. When set, the only address accepted by the UDPHS controller is the one stored in the UDPHS Address field. It will not be cleared afterwards by the device firmware. It is cleared by hardware on hardware reset, or when UDPHS bus reset is received (see above). * EN_UDPHS: UDPHS Enable Read: 0 = UDPHS is disabled. 1 = UDPHS is enabled. Write: 0 = disable and reset the UDPHS controller, disable the UDPHS transceiver. 1 = enables the UDPHS controller.
761
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* DETACH: Detach Command Read: 0 = UDPHS is attached. 1 = UDPHS is detached, UTMI transceiver is suspended. Write: 0 = pull up the DP line (attach command). 1 = simulate a detach on the UDPHS line and force the UTMI transceiver into suspend state (Suspend M = 0). * REWAKEUP: Send Remote Wake Up Read: 0 = Remote Wake Up is disabled. 1 = Remote Wake Up is enabled. Write: 0 = no effect. 1 = force an external interrupt on the UDPHS controller for Remote Wake UP purposes. An Upstream Resume is sent only after the UDPHS bus has been in SUSPEND state for at least 5 ms. This bit is automatically cleared by hardware at the end of the Upstream Resume. * PULLD_DIS: Pull-Down Disable When set, there is no pull-down on DP & DM. (DM Pull-Down = DP Pull-Down = 0). Note: If the DETACH bit is also set, device DP & DM are left in high impedance state.
762
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.2 Name: UDPHS Frame Number Register UDPHS_FNUM Read
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 27 - 19 - 26 - 18 - 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 FNUM_ERR 23 - 15 - 7
11 10 FRAME_NUMBER 3 2
5 FRAME_NUMBER
4
1 MICRO_FRAME_NUM
0
* MICRO_FRAME_NUM: Microframe Number Number of the received microframe (0 to 7) in one frame.This field is reset at the beginning of each new frame (1 ms). One microframe is received each 125 microseconds (1 ms/8). * FRAME_NUMBER: Frame Number as defined in the Packet Field Formats This field is provided in the last received SOF packet (see INT_SOF in the UDPHS Interrupt Status Register). * FNUM_ERR: Frame Number CRC Error This bit is set by hardware when a corrupted Frame Number in Start of Frame packet (or Micro SOF) is received. This bit and the INT_SOF (or MICRO_SOF) interrupt are updated at the same time.
763
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.3 Name:
UDPHS Interrupt Enable Register UDPHS_IEN Read/Write
30 DMA_6 22 - 14 EPT_6 6 ENDOFRSM 29 DMA_5 21 - 13 EPT_5 5 WAKE_UP 28 DMA_4 20 - 12 EPT_4 4 ENDRESET 27 DMA_3 19 - 11 EPT_3 3 INT_SOF 26 DMA_2 18 - 10 EPT_2 2 MICRO_SOF 25 DMA_1 17 - 9 EPT_1 1 DET_SUSPD 24 - 16 - 8 EPT_0 0 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 UPSTR_RES
* DET_SUSPD: Suspend Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = Suspend Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Suspend Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable Suspend Interrupt. 1 = enable Suspend Interrupt. * MICRO_SOF: Micro-SOF Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = Micro-SOF Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Micro-SOF Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable Micro-SOF Interrupt. 1 = enable Micro-SOF Interrupt. * INT_SOF: SOF Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = SOF Interrupt is disabled. 1 = SOF Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable SOF Interrupt. 1 = enable SOF Interrupt.
764
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* ENDRESET: End Of Reset Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = End Of Reset Interrupt is disabled. 1 = End Of Reset Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable End Of Reset Interrupt. 1 = enable End Of Reset Interrupt. Automatically enabled after USB reset. * WAKE_UP: Wake Up CPU Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = Wake Up CPU Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Wake Up CPU Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable Wake Up CPU Interrupt. 1 = enable Wake Up CPU Interrupt. * ENDOFRSM: End Of Resume Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = Resume Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Resume Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable Resume Interrupt. 1 = enable Resume Interrupt. * UPSTR_RES: Upstream Resume Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = Upstream Resume Interrupt is disabled. 1 = Upstream Resume Interrupt is enabled. Write 0 = disable Upstream Resume Interrupt. 1 = enable Upstream Resume Interrupt. * EPT_x: Endpoint x Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = the interrupts for this endpoint are disabled. 1 = the interrupts for this endpoint are enabled. Write 0 = disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
765
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
1 = enable the interrupts for this endpoint. * DMA_INT_x: DMA Channel x Interrupt Enable Read: 0 = the interrupts for this channel are disabled. 1 = the interrupts for this channel are enabled. Write 0 = disable the interrupts for this channel. 1 = enable the interrupts for this channel.
766
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.4 Name: UDPHS Interrupt Status Register UDPHS_INTSTA Read-only
30 DMA_6 22 - 14 EPT_6 6 ENDOFRSM 29 DMA_5 21 - 13 EPT_5 5 WAKE_UP 28 DMA_4 20 - 12 EPT_4 4 ENDRESET 27 DMA_3 19 - 11 EPT_3 3 INT_SOF 26 DMA_2 18 - 10 EPT_2 2 MICRO_SOF 25 DMA_1 17 - 9 EPT_1 1 DET_SUSPD 24 - 16 - 8 EPT_0 0 SPEED
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 UPSTR_RES
* SPEED: Speed Status 0 = reset by hardware when the hardware is in Full Speed mode. 1 = set by hardware when the hardware is in High Speed mode * DET_SUSPD: Suspend Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the DET_SUSPD bit in UDPHS_CLRINT register 1 = set by hardware when a UDPHS Suspend (Idle bus for three frame periods, a J state for 3 ms) is detected. This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the DET_SUSPD bit is set in UDPHS_IEN register. * MICRO_SOF: Micro Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the MICRO_SOF bit in UDPHS_CLRINT register. 1 = set by hardware when an UDPHS micro start of frame PID (SOF) has been detected (every 125 us) or synthesized by the macro. This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the MICRO_SOF bit is set in UDPHS_IEN. In case of detected SOF, the MICRO_FRAME_NUM field in UDPHS_FNUM register is incremented and the FRAME_NUMBER field doesn't change.
Note: The Micro Start Of Frame Interrupt (MICRO_SOF), and the Start Of Frame Interrupt (INT_SOF) are not generated at the same time.
* INT_SOF: Start Of Frame Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the INT_SOF bit in UDPHS_CLRINT. 1 = set by hardware when an UDPHS Start Of Frame PID (SOF) has been detected (every 1 ms) or synthesized by the macro. This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the INT_SOF bit is set in UDPHS_IEN register. In case of detected SOF, in High Speed mode, the MICRO_FRAME_NUMBER field is cleared in UDPHS_FNUM register and the FRAME_NUMBER field is updated. * ENDRESET: End Of Reset Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the ENDRESET bit in UDPHS_CLRINT. 1 = set by hardware when an End Of Reset has been detected by the UDPHS controller. This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the ENDRESET bit is set in UDPHS_IEN.
767
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* WAKE_UP: Wake Up CPU Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the WAKE_UP bit in UDPHS_CLRINT. 1 = set by hardware when the UDPHS controller is in SUSPEND state and is re-activated by a filtered non-idle signal from the UDPHS line (not by an upstream resume). This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the WAKE_UP bit is set in UDPHS_IEN register. When receiving this interrupt, the user has to enable the device controller clock prior to operation.
Note: this interrupt is generated even if the device controller clock is disabled.
* ENDOFRSM: End Of Resume Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the ENDOFRSM bit in UDPHS_CLRINT. 1 = set by hardware when the UDPHS controller detects a good end of resume signal initiated by the host. This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the ENDOFRSM bit is set in UDPHS_IEN. * UPSTR_RES: Upstream Resume Interrupt 0 = cleared by setting the UPSTR_RES bit in UDPHS_CLRINT. 1 = set by hardware when the UDPHS controller is sending a resume signal called "upstream resume". This triggers a UDPHS interrupt when the UPSTR_RES bit is set in UDPHS_IEN. * EPT_x: Endpoint x Interrupt 0 = reset when the UDPHS_EPTSTAx interrupt source is cleared. 1 = set by hardware when an interrupt is triggered by the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register and this endpoint interrupt is enabled by the EPT_INT_x bit in UDPHS_IEN. * DMA_INT_x: DMA Channel x Interrupt 0 = reset when the UDPHS_DMASTATUSx interrupt source is cleared. 1 = set by hardware when an interrupt is triggered by the DMA Channelx and this endpoint interrupt is enabled by the DMA_INT_x bit in UDPHS_IEN.
768
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.5 Name: UDPHS Clear Interrupt Register UDPHS_CLRINT Write only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 ENDOFRSM 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 WAKE_UP 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 ENDRESET 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 INT_SOF 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 MICRO_SOF 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 DET_SUSPD 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 UPSTR_RES
* DET_SUSPD: Suspend Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the DET_SUSPD bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * MICRO_SOF: Micro Start Of Frame Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the MICRO_SOF bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * INT_SOF: Start Of Frame Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the INT_SOF bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * ENDRESET: End Of Reset Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the ENDRESET bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * WAKE_UP: Wake Up CPU Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the WAKE_UP bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * ENDOFRSM: End Of Resume Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the ENDOFRSM bit in UDPHS_INTSTA. * UPSTR_RES: Upstream Resume Interrupt Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the UPSTR_RES bit in UDPHS_INTSTA.
769
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.6 Name:
UDPHS Endpoints Reset Register UDPHS_EPTRST Write only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 EPT_6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 EPT_5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 EPT_4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 EPT_3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 EPT_2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 EPT_1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 EPT_0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* EPT_x: Endpoint x Reset 0 = no effect. 1 = reset the Endpointx state. Setting this bit clears the Endpoint status UDPHS_EPTSTAx register, except for the TOGGLESQ_STA field.
770
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.7 Name: UDPHS Test SOF Counter Register UDPHS_TSTSOFCNT Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 SOFCNTMAX 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 SOFCTLOAD
* SOFCNTMAX: SOF Counter Max Value * SOFCTLOAD: SOF Counter Load
771
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.8 Name:
UDPHS Test A Counter Register UDPHS_TSTCNTA Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 27 - 19 - 11 CNTAMAX 3 CNTAMAX 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 CNTALOAD 7
6
5
4
2
1
0
* CNTALOAD: A Counter Load * CNTAMAX: A Counter Max Value
772
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.9 Name: UDPHS Test B Counter Register UDPHS_TSTCNTB Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 29 - 21 - 13 28 - 20 - 12 27 - 19 - 11 CNTBMAX 3 CNTBMAX 26 - 18 - 10 25 - 17 - 9 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 CNTBLOAD 7
6
5
4
2
1
0
* CNTBLOAD: B Counter Load * CNTBMAX: B Counter Max Value
773
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.10 Name:
UDPHS Test Mode Register UDPHS_TSTMODEREG Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 TSTMODE 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* TSTMODE: UDPHS Core TestModeReg
774
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.11 Name: UDPHS Test Register UDPHS_TST Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 OPMODE2 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 TST_PKT 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 TST_K 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 TST_J 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 SPEED_CFG 24 - 16 - 8 - 0
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* SPEED_CFG: Speed Configuration Read/Write: Speed Configuration:
00 01 10 11 Normal Mode: The macro is in Full Speed mode, ready to make a High Speed identification, if the host supports it and then to automatically switch to High Speed mode Reserved Force High Speed: Set this value to force the hardware to work in High Speed mode. Only for debug or test purpose. Force Full Speed: Set this value to force the hardware to work only in Full Speed mode. In this configuration, the macro will not respond to a High Speed reset handshake
* TST_J: Test J Mode Read and write: 0 = no effect. 1 = set to send the J state on the UDPHS line. This enables the testing of the high output drive level on the D+ line. * TST_K: Test K Mode Read and write: 0 = no effect. 1 = set to send the K state on the UDPHS line. This enables the testing of the high output drive level on the D- line. * TST_PKT: Test Packet Mode Read and write: 0 = no effect. 1 = set to repetitively transmit the packet stored in the current bank. This enables the testing of rise and fall times, eye patterns, jitter, and any other dynamic waveform specifications. * OPMODE2: OpMode2 Read and write:
775
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
0 = no effect. 1 = set to force the OpMode signal (UTMI interface) to "10", to disable the bit-stuffing and the NRZI encoding.
Note: For the Test mode, Test_SE0_NAK (see Universal Serial Bus Specification, Revision 2.0: 7.1.20, Test Mode Support). Force the device in High Speed mode, and configure a bulk-type endpoint. Do not fill this endpoint for sending NAK to the host. Upon command, a port's transceiver must enter the High Speed receive mode and remain in that mode until the exit action is taken. This enables the testing of output impedance, low level output voltage and loading characteristics. In addition, while in this mode, upstream facing ports (and only upstream facing ports) must respond to any IN token packet with a NAK handshake (only if the packet CRC is determined to be correct) within the normal allowed device response time. This enables testing of the device squelch level circuitry and, additionally, provides a general purpose stimulus/response test for basic functional testing.
776
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.12 Name: UDPHS PADDRSIZE Register UDPHS_IPPADDRSIZE Read-only
30 29 28 27 IP_PADDRSIZE 20 19 IP_PADDRSIZE 12 11 IP_PADDRSIZE 4 3 IP_PADDRSIZE 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
18
17
16
15
14
13
10
9
8
7
6
5
2
1
0
* IP_PADDRSIZE 2^UDPHS_PADDR_SIZE APB address bus aperture of the UDPHS
777
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.13 Name:
UDPHS Name1 Register UDPHS_IPNAME1 Read-only
30 29 28 IP_NAME1 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
20 IP_NAME1
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 IP_NAME1
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 IP_NAME1
3
2
1
0
* IP_NAME1 ASCII string "HUSB"
41.5.14 Name:
UDPHS Name2 Register UDPHS_IPNAME2 Read-only
30 29 28 IP_NAME2 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
20 IP_NAME2
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 IP_NAME2
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 IP_NAME2
3
2
1
0
* IP_NAME2 ASCII string "2DEV"
778
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.15 Name: UDPHS Features Register UDPHS_IPFEATURES Read-only
30 ISO_EPT_14 22 ISO_EPT_6 14 29 ISO_EPT_13 21 ISO_EPT_5 13 FIFO_MAX_SIZE 5 DMA_CHANNEL_NBR 28 ISO_EPT_12 20 ISO_EPT_4 12 27 ISO_EPT_11 19 ISO_EPT_3 11 26 ISO_EPT_10 18 ISO_EPT_2 25 ISO_EPT_9 17 ISO_EPT_1 24 ISO_EPT_8 16 DATAB16_8 8
Access Type:
31 ISO_EPT_15 23 ISO_EPT_7 15 BW_DPRAM 7 DMA_B_SIZ
10 9 DMA_FIFO_WORD_DEPTH 2 1 EPT_NBR_MAX
6
4
3
0
* EPT_NBR_MAX: Max Number of Endpoints Give the max number of endpoints. 0 = if 16 endpoints are hardware implemented. 1 = if 1 endpoint is hardware implemented. 2 = if 2 endpoints are hardware implemented. ... 15 = if 15 endpoints are hardware implemented. * DMA_CHANNEL_NBR: Number of DMA Channels Give the number of DMA channels. 1 = if 1 DMA channel is hardware implemented. 2 = if 2 DMA channels are hardware implemented. ... 7 = if 7 DMA channels are hardware implemented. * DMA_B_SIZ: DMA Buffer Size 0 = if the DMA Buffer size is 16 bits. 1 = if the DMA Buffer size is 24 bits. * DMA_FIFO_WORD_DEPTH: DMA FIFO Depth in Words 0 = if FIFO is 16 words deep. 1 = if FIFO is 1 word deep. 2 = if FIFO is 2 words deep. ... 15 = if FIFO is 15 words deep.
779
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* FIFO_MAX_SIZE: DPRAM Size 0 = if DPRAM is 128 bytes deep. 1 = if DPRAM is 256 bytes deep. 2 = if DPRAM is 512 bytes deep. 3 = if DPRAM is 1024 bytes deep. 4 = if DPRAM is 2048 bytes deep. 5 = if DPRAM is 4096 bytes deep. 6 = if DPRAM is 8192 bytes deep. 7 = if DPRAM is 16384 bytes deep. * BW_DPRAM: DPRAM Byte Write Capability 0 = if DPRAM Write Data Shadow logic is implemented. 1 = if DPRAM is byte write capable. * DATAB16_8: UTMI DataBus16_8 0 = if the UTMI uses an 8-bit parallel data interface (60 MHz, unidirectional). 1 = if the UTMI uses a 16-bit parallel data interface (30 MHz, bidirectional). * ISO_EPT_x: Endpointx High Bandwidth Isochronous Capability 0 = if the endpoint does not have isochronous High Bandwidth Capability. 1 = if the endpoint has isochronous High Bandwidth Capability.
780
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.16 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Configuration Register UDPHS_EPTCFGx [x=0..6] Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 BK_NUMBER 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 EPT_TYPE 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 EPT_DIR 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 25 - 17 - 9 NB_TRANS 1 EPT_SIZE 0 24 - 16 - 8
Access Type:
31 EPT_MAPD 23 - 15 - 7
* EPT_SIZE: Endpoint Size Read and write: Set this field according to the endpoint size in bytes (see Section 41.4.5 "Endpoint Configuration"). Endpoint Size
000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Note: 8 bytes 16 bytes 32 bytes 64 bytes 128 bytes 256 bytes 512 bytes 1024 bytes(1) 1. 1024 bytes is only for isochronous endpoint.
* EPT_DIR: Endpoint Direction Read and write: 0 = Clear this bit to configure OUT direction for Bulk, Interrupt and Isochronous endpoints. 1 = set this bit to configure IN direction for Bulk, Interrupt and Isochronous endpoints. For Control endpoints this bit has no effect and should be left at zero. * EPT_TYPE: Endpoint Type Read and write: Set this field according to the endpoint type (see Section 41.4.5 "Endpoint Configuration"). (Endpoint 0 should always be configured as control)
781
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
:Endpoint Type
00 01 10 11 Control endpoint Isochronous endpoint Bulk endpoint Interrupt endpoint
* BK_NUMBER: Number of Banks Read and write: Set this field according to the endpoint's number of banks (see Section 41.4.5 "Endpoint Configuration"). Number of Banks
00 01 10 11 Zero bank, the endpoint is not mapped in memory One bank (bank 0) Double bank (Ping-Pong: bank 0/bank 1) Triple bank (bank 0/bank 1/bank 2)
* NB_TRANS: Number Of Transaction per Microframe Read and Write: The Number of transactions per microframe is set by software.
Note: Meaningful for high bandwidth isochronous endpoint only.
* EPT_MAPD: Endpoint Mapped Read-only: 0 = the user should reprogram the register with correct values. 1 = set by hardware when the endpoint size (EPT_SIZE) and the number of banks (BK_NUMBER) are correct regarding: - the fifo max capacity (FIFO_MAX_SIZE in UDPHS_IPFEATURES register) - the number of endpoints/banks already allocated - the number of allowed banks for this endpoint
782
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.17 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Control Enable Register UDPHS_EPTCTLENBx [x=0..6] Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 NAK_IN/ ERR_FLUSH 29 - 21 - 13 STALL_SNT/ ERR_CRISO/ ERR_NBTRA 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 RX_SETUP/ ERR_FL_ISO 27 - 19 - 11 TX_PK_RDY/ ERR_TRANS 26 - 18 BUSY_BANK 10 TX_COMPLT 25 - 17 - 9 RX_BK_RDY 24 - 16 - 8 ERR_OVFLW
Access Type:
31 SHRT_PCKT 23 - 15 NAK_OUT
7 MDATA_RX
6 DATAX_RX
4 NYET_DIS
3 INTDIS_DMA
2 -
1 AUTO_VALID
0 EPT_ENABL
For additional Information, see "UDPHS Endpoint Control Register" on page 787. * EPT_ENABL: Endpoint Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable endpoint according to the device configuration. * AUTO_VALID: Packet Auto-Valid Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable this bit to automatically validate the current packet and switch to the next bank for both IN and OUT transfers. * INTDIS_DMA: Interrupts Disable DMA 0 = no effect. 1 = If set, when an enabled endpoint-originated interrupt is triggered, the DMA request is disabled. * NYET_DIS: NYET Disable (Only for High Speed Bulk OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = forces an ACK response to the next High Speed Bulk OUT transfer instead of a NYET response. * DATAX_RX: DATAx Interrupt Enable (Only for high bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = enable DATAx Interrupt. * MDATA_RX: MDATA Interrupt Enable (Only for high bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = enable MDATA Interrupt. * ERR_OVFLW: Overflow Error Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Overflow Error Interrupt. 783
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* RX_BK_RDY: Received OUT Data Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Received OUT Data Interrupt. * TX_COMPLT: Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt. * TX_PK_RDY/ERR_TRANS: TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt. * RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO: Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable RX_SETUP/Error Flow ISO Interrupt. * STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NBTRA: Stall Sent /ISO CRC Error/Number of Transaction Error Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Stall Sent/Error CRC ISO/Error Number of Transaction Interrupt. * NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH: NAKIN/Bank Flush Error Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable NAKIN/Bank Flush Error Interrupt. * NAK_OUT: NAKOUT Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable NAKOUT Interrupt. * BUSY_BANK: Busy Bank Interrupt Enable 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Busy Bank Interrupt. * SHRT_PCKT: Short Packet Send/Short Packet Interrupt Enable For OUT endpoints: 0 = no effect. 1 = enable Short Packet Interrupt. For IN endpoints: Guarantees short packet at end of DMA Transfer if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_B_EN and UDPHS_EPTCTLx register AUTOVALID bits are also set.
784
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.18 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Control Disable Register UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx [x=0..6] Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 NAK_IN/ ERR_FLUSH 29 - 21 - 13 STALL_SNT/ ERR_CRISO/ ERR_NBTRA 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 RX_SETUP/ ERR_FL_ISO 27 - 19 - 11 TX_PK_RDY/ ERR_TRANS 26 - 18 BUSY_BANK 10 TX_COMPLT 25 - 17 - 9 RX_BK_RDY 24 - 16 - 8 ERR_OVFLW
Access Type:
31 SHRT_PCKT 23 - 15 NAK_OUT
7 MDATA_RX
6 DATAX_RX
4 NYET_DIS
3 INTDIS_DMA
2 -
1 AUTO_VALID
0 EPT_DISABL
For additional Information, see "UDPHS Endpoint Control Register" on page 787. * EPT_DISABL: Endpoint Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable endpoint. * AUTO_VALID: Packet Auto-Valid Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable this bit to not automatically validate the current packet. * INTDIS_DMA: Interrupts Disable DMA 0 = no effect. 1 = disable the "Interrupts Disable DMA". * NYET_DIS: NYET Enable (Only for High Speed Bulk OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = let the hardware handle the handshake response for the High Speed Bulk OUT transfer. * DATAX_RX: DATAx Interrupt Disable (Only for High Bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = disable DATAx Interrupt. * MDATA_RX: MDATA Interrupt Disable (Only for High Bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = disable MDATA Interrupt. * ERR_OVFLW: Overflow Error Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Overflow Error Interrupt. 785
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* RX_BK_RDY: Received OUT Data Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Received OUT Data Interrupt. * TX_COMPLT: Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt. * TX_PK_RDY/ERR_TRANS: TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt. * RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO: Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable RX_SETUP/Error Flow ISO Interrupt. * STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NBTRA: Stall Sent/ISO CRC Error/Number of Transaction Error Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Stall Sent/Error CRC ISO/Error Number of Transaction Interrupt. * NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH: NAKIN/bank flush error Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable NAKIN/ Bank Flush Error Interrupt. * NAK_OUT: NAKOUT Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable NAKOUT Interrupt. * BUSY_BANK: Busy Bank Interrupt Disable 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Busy Bank Interrupt. * SHRT_PCKT: Short Packet Interrupt Disable For OUT endpoints: 0 = no effect. 1 = disable Short Packet Interrupt. For IN endpoints: Never automatically add a zero length packet at end of DMA transfer.
786
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.19 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Control Register UDPHS_EPTCTLx [x=0..6] Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 NAK_IN/ ERR_FLUSH 29 - 21 - 13 STALL_SNT/ ERR_CRISO/ ERR_NBTRA 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 RX_SETUP/ ERR_FL_ISO 27 - 19 - 11 TX_PK_RDY/ ERR_TRANS 26 - 18 BUSY_BANK 10 TX_COMPLT 25 - 17 - 9 RX_BK_RDY 24 - 16 - 8 ERR_OVFLW
Access Type:
31 SHRT_PCKT 23 - 15 NAK_OUT
7 MDATA_RX
6 DATAX_RX
4 NYET_DIS
3 INTDIS_DMA
2 -
1 AUTO_VALID
0 EPT_ENABL
* EPT_ENABL: Endpoint Enable 0 = If cleared, the endpoint is disabled according to the device configuration. Endpoint 0 should always be enabled after a hardware or UDPHS bus reset and participate in the device configuration. 1 = If set, the endpoint is enabled according to the device configuration. * AUTO_VALID: Packet Auto-Valid Enabled (Not for CONTROL Endpoints) Set this bit to automatically validate the current packet and switch to the next bank for both IN and OUT endpoints. For IN Transfer: If this bit is set, then the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register TX_PK_RDY bit is set automatically when the current bank is full and at the end of DMA buffer if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_B_EN bit is set. The user may still set the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register TX_PK_RDY bit if the current bank is not full, unless the user wants to send a Zero Length Packet by software. For OUT Transfer: If this bit is set, then the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register RX_BK_RDY bit is automatically reset for the current bank when the last packet byte has been read from the bank FIFO or at the end of DMA buffer if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_B_EN bit is set. For example, to truncate a padded data packet when the actual data transfer size is reached. The user may still clear the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register RX_BK_RDY bit, for example, after completing a DMA buffer by software if UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_B_EN bit was disabled or in order to cancel the read of the remaining data bank(s). * INTDIS_DMA: Interrupt Disables DMA If set, when an enabled endpoint-originated interrupt is triggered, the DMA request is disabled regardless of the UDPHS_IEN register EPT_INT_x bit for this endpoint. Then, the firmware will have to clear or disable the interrupt source or clear this bit if transfer completion is needed. If the exception raised is associated with the new system bank packet, then the previous DMA packet transfer is normally completed, but the new DMA packet transfer is not started (not requested).
787
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
If the exception raised is not associated to a new system bank packet (NAK_IN, NAK_OUT, ERR_FL_ISO...), then the request cancellation may happen at any time and may immediately stop the current DMA transfer. This may be used, for example, to identify or prevent an erroneous packet to be transferred into a buffer or to complete a DMA buffer by software after reception of a short packet, or to perform buffer truncation on ERR_FL_ISO interrupt for adaptive rate. * NYET_DIS: NYET Disable (Only for High Speed Bulk OUT endpoints) 0 = If clear, this bit lets the hardware handle the handshake response for the High Speed Bulk OUT transfer. 1 = If set, this bit forces an ACK response to the next High Speed Bulk OUT transfer instead of a NYET response.
Note: According to the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0 (8.5.1.1 NAK Responses to OUT/DATA During PING Protocol), a NAK response to an HS Bulk OUT transfer is expected to be an unusual occurrence.
* DATAX_RX: DATAx Interrupt Enabled (Only for High Bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = send an interrupt when a DATA2, DATA1 or DATA0 packet has been received meaning the whole microframe data payload has been received. * MDATA_RX: MDATA Interrupt Enabled (Only for High Bandwidth Isochronous OUT endpoints) 0 = no effect. 1 = send an interrupt when an MDATA packet has been received and so at least one packet of the microframe data payload has been received. * ERR_OVFLW: Overflow Error Interrupt Enabled 0 = Overflow Error Interrupt is masked. 1 = Overflow Error Interrupt is enabled. * RX_BK_RDY: Received OUT Data Interrupt Enabled 0 = Received OUT Data Interrupt is masked. 1 = Received OUT Data Interrupt is enabled. * TX_COMPLT: Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt Enabled 0 = Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt is masked. 1 = Transmitted IN Data Complete Interrupt is enabled. * TX_PK_RDY/ERR_TRANS: TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt Enabled 0 = TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt is masked. 1 = TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error Interrupt is enabled. Caution: Interrupt source is active as long as the corresponding UDPHS_EPTSTAx register TX_PK_RDY flag remains low. If there are no more banks available for transmitting after the software has set UDPHS_EPTSTAx/TX_PK_RDY for the last transmit packet, then the interrupt source remains inactive until the first bank becomes free again to transmit at UDPHS_EPTSTAx/TX_PK_RDY hardware clear. * RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO: Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt Enabled 0 = Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt is masked. 1 = Received SETUP/Error Flow Interrupt is enabled.
788
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NBTRA: Stall Sent/ISO CRC Error/Number of Transaction Error Interrupt Enabled 0 = Stall Sent/ISO CRC error/number of Transaction Error Interrupt is masked. 1 = Stall Sent /ISO CRC error/number of Transaction Error Interrupt is enabled. * NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH: NAKIN/Bank Flush Error Interrupt Enabled 0 = NAKIN Interrupt is masked. 1 = NAKIN/Bank Flush Error Interrupt is enabled. * NAK_OUT: NAKOUT Interrupt Enabled 0 = NAKOUT Interrupt is masked. 1 = NAKOUT Interrupt is enabled. * BUSY_BANK: Busy Bank Interrupt Enabled 0 = BUSY_BANK Interrupt is masked. 1 = BUSY_BANK Interrupt is enabled. For OUT endpoints: an interrupt is sent when all banks are busy. For IN endpoints: an interrupt is sent when all banks are free. * SHRT_PCKT: Short Packet Interrupt Enabled For OUT endpoints: send an Interrupt when a Short Packet has been received. 0 = Short Packet Interrupt is masked. 1 = Short Packet Interrupt is enabled. For IN endpoints: a Short Packet transmission is guaranteed upon end of the DMA Transfer, thus signaling a BULK or INTERRUPT end of transfer or an end of isochronous (micro-)frame data, but only if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_B_EN and UDPHS_EPTCTLx register AUTO_VALID bits are also set.
789
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.20 Name:
UDPHS Endpoint Set Status Register UDPHS_EPTSETSTAx [x=0..6] Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 FRCESTALL 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 TX_PK_RDY 3 - 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 - 25 - 17 - 9 KILL_BANK 1 - 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
* FRCESTALL: Stall Handshake Request Set 0 = no effect. 1 = set this bit to request a STALL answer to the host for the next handshake Refer to chapters 8.4.5 (Handshake Packets) and 9.4.5 (Get Status) of the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0 for more information on the STALL handshake. * KILL_BANK: KILL Bank Set (for IN Endpoint) 0 = no effect. 1 = kill the last written bank. * TX_PK_RDY: TX Packet Ready Set 0 = no effect. 1 = set this bit after a packet has been written into the endpoint FIFO for IN data transfers - This flag is used to generate a Data IN transaction (device to host). - Device firmware checks that it can write a data payload in the FIFO, checking that TX_PK_RDY is cleared. - Transfer to the FIFO is done by writing in the "Buffer Address" register. - Once the data payload has been transferred to the FIFO, the firmware notifies the UDPHS device setting TX_PK_RDY to one. - UDPHS bus transactions can start. - TXCOMP is set once the data payload has been received by the host. - Data should be written into the endpoint FIFO only after this bit has been cleared. - Set this bit without writing data to the endpoint FIFO to send a Zero Length Packet.
790
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.21 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Clear Status Register UDPHS_EPTCLRSTAx [x=0..6] Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 NAK_IN/ ERR_FLUSH 6 TOGGLESQ 29 - 21 - 13 STALL_SNT/ ERR_NBTRA 5 FRCESTALL 28 - 20 - 12 RX_SETUP/ ERR_FL_ISO 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 26 - 18 - 10 TX_COMPLT 25 - 17 - 9 RX_BK_RDY 24 - 16 - 8 -
Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 NAK_OUT
7 -
3 -
2 -
1 -
0 -
* FRCESTALL: Stall Handshake Request Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the STALL request. The next packets from host will not be STALLed. * TOGGLESQ: Data Toggle Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the PID data of the current bank For OUT endpoints, the next received packet should be a DATA0. For IN endpoints, the next packet will be sent with a DATA0 PID. * RX_BK_RDY: Received OUT Data Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the RX_BK_RDY flag of UDPHS_EPTSTAx. * TX_COMPLT: Transmitted IN Data Complete Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the TX_COMPLT flag of UDPHS_EPTSTAx. * RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO: Received SETUP/Error Flow Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO flags of UDPHS_EPTSTAx. * STALL_SNT/ERR_NBTRA: Stall Sent/Number of Transaction Error Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the STALL_SNT/ERR_NBTRA flags of UDPHS_EPTSTAx. * NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH: NAKIN/Bank Flush Error Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH flags of UDPHS_EPTSTAx. 791
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* NAK_OUT: NAKOUT Clear 0 = no effect. 1 = clear the NAK_OUT flag of UDPHS_EPTSTAx.
792
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.22 Name: UDPHS Endpoint Status Register UDPHS_EPTSTAx [x=0..6] Read-only
30 29 28 27 BYTE_COUNT 19 26 25 24
Access Type:
31 SHRT_PCKT 23
22
21
20
18
BYTE_COUNT
BUSY_BANK_STA
17 16 CURRENT_BANK/ CONTROL_DIR 9 RX_BK_RDY/ KILL_BANK 8 ERR_OVFLW
15 NAK_OUT
14 NAK_IN/ ERR_FLUSH
13 STALL_SNT/ ERR_CRISO/ ERR_NBTRA 5 FRCESTALL
12 RX_SETUP/ ERR_FL_ISO
11 TX_PK_RDY/ ERR_TRANS
10 TX_COMPLT
7 6 TOGGLESQ_STA
4 -
3 -
2 -
1 -
0 -
* FRCESTALL: Stall Handshake Request 0 = no effect. 1= If set a STALL answer will be done to the host for the next handshake. This bit is reset by hardware upon received SETUP. * TOGGLESQ_STA: Toggle Sequencing Toggle Sequencing: IN endpoint: it indicates the PID Data Toggle that will be used for the next packet sent. This is not relative to the current bank. CONTROL and OUT endpoint: These bits are set by hardware to indicate the PID data of the current bank:
00 01 10 11 Data0 Data1 Data2 (only for High Bandwidth Isochronous Endpoint) MData (only for High Bandwidth Isochronous Endpoint)
Note 1: In OUT transfer, the Toggle information is meaningful only when the current bank is busy (Received OUT Data = 1). Note 2:These bits are updated for OUT transfer: - a new data has been written into the current bank. - the user has just cleared the Received OUT Data bit to switch to the next bank. Note 3: For High Bandwidth Isochronous Out endpoint, it is recommended to check the UDPHS_EPTSTAx/ERR_TRANS bit to know if the toggle sequencing is correct or not. Note 4: This field is reset to DATA1 by the UDPHS_EPTCLRSTAx register TOGGLESQ bit, and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint).
793
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* ERR_OVFLW: Overflow Error This bit is set by hardware when a new too-long packet is received. Example: If the user programs an endpoint 64 bytes wide and the host sends 128 bytes in an OUT transfer, then the Overflow Error bit is set. This bit is updated at the same time as the BYTE_COUNT field. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). * RX_BK_RDY/KILL_BANK: Received OUT Data/KILL Bank - Received OUT Data: (For OUT endpoint or Control endpoint) This bit is set by hardware after a new packet has been stored in the endpoint FIFO. This bit is cleared by the device firmware after reading the OUT data from the endpoint. For multi-bank endpoints, this bit may remain active even when cleared by the device firmware, this if an other packet has been received meanwhile. Hardware assertion of this bit may generate an interrupt if enabled by the UDPHS_EPTCTLx register RX_BK_RDY bit. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). - KILL Bank: (For IN endpoint) - the bank is really cleared or the bank is sent, BUSY_BANK_STA is decremented. - the bank is not cleared but sent on the IN transfer, TX_COMPLT - the bank is not cleared because it was empty. The user should wait that this bit is cleared before trying to clear another packet. Note: "Kill a packet" may be refused if at the same time, an IN token is coming and the current packet is sent on the UDPHS line. In this case, the TX_COMPLT bit is set. Take notice however, that if at least two banks are ready to be sent, there is no problem to kill a packet even if an IN token is coming. In fact, in that case, the current bank is sent (IN transfer) and the last bank is killed. * TX_COMPLT: Transmitted IN Data Complete This bit is set by hardware after an IN packet has been transmitted for isochronous endpoints and after it has been accepted (ACK'ed) by the host for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint), and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). * TX_PK_RDY/ERR_TRANS: TX Packet Ready/Transaction Error - TX Packet Ready: This bit is cleared by hardware, as soon as the packet has been sent for isochronous endpoints, or after the host has acknowledged the packet for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints. For Multi-bank endpoints, this bit may remain clear even after software is set if another bank is available to transmit. Hardware clear of this bit may generate an interrupt if enabled by the UDPHS_EPTCTLx register TX_PK_RDY bit. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint), and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). - Transaction Error: (For high bandwidth isochronous OUT endpoints) (Read-Only) This bit is set by hardware when a transaction error occurs inside one microframe.
794
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
If one toggle sequencing problem occurs among the n-transactions (n = 1, 2 or 3) inside a microframe, then this bit is still set as long as the current bank contains one "bad" n-transaction. (see "CURRENT_BANK/CONTROL_DIR: Current Bank/Control Direction" on page 796) As soon as the current bank is relative to a new "good" n-transactions, then this bit is reset. Note1: A transaction error occurs when the toggle sequencing does not respect the Universal Serial Bus Specification, Rev 2.0 (5.9.2 High Bandwidth Isochronous endpoints) (Bad PID, missing data....) Note2: When a transaction error occurs, the user may empty all the "bad" transactions by clearing the Received OUT Data flag (RX_BK_RDY). If this bit is reset, then the user should consider that a new n-transaction is coming. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint), and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). * RX_SETUP/ERR_FL_ISO: Received SETUP/Error Flow - Received SETUP: (for Control endpoint only) This bit is set by hardware when a valid SETUP packet has been received from the host. It is cleared by the device firmware after reading the SETUP data from the endpoint FIFO. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint), and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). - Error Flow: (for isochronous endpoint only) This bit is set by hardware when a transaction error occurs. - Isochronous IN transaction is missed, the micro has no time to fill the endpoint (underflow). - Isochronous OUT data is dropped because the bank is busy (overflow). This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). * STALL_SNT/ERR_CRISO/ERR_NBTRA: Stall Sent/CRC ISO Error/Number of Transaction Error - STALL_SNT: (for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints) This bit is set by hardware after a STALL handshake has been sent as requested by the UDPHS_EPTSTAx register FRCESTALL bit. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). - ERR_CRISO: (for Isochronous OUT endpoints) (Read-only) This bit is set by hardware if the last received data is corrupted (CRC error on data). This bit is updated by hardware when new data is received (Received OUT Data bit). - ERR_NBTRA: (for High Bandwidth Isochronous IN endpoints) This bit is set at the end of a microframe in which at least one data bank has been transmitted, if less than the number of transactions per micro-frame banks (UDPHS_EPTCFGx register NB_TRANS) have been validated for transmission inside this microframe. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). * NAK_IN/ERR_FLUSH: NAK IN/Bank Flush Error - NAK_IN: This bit is set by hardware when a NAK handshake has been sent in response to an IN request from the Host. This bit is cleared by software.
795
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
- ERR_FLUSH: (for High Bandwidth Isochronous IN endpoints) This bit is set when flushing unsent banks at the end of a microframe. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by EPT_CTL_DISx (disable endpoint). * NAK_OUT: NAK OUT This bit is set by hardware when a NAK handshake has been sent in response to an OUT or PING request from the Host. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by EPT_CTL_DISx (disable endpoint). * CURRENT_BANK/CONTROL_DIR: Current Bank/Control Direction - Current Bank: (all endpoints except Control endpoint) These bits are set by hardware to indicate the number of the current bank.
00 01 10 11 Bank 0 (or single bank) Bank 1 Bank 2 Invalid
Note: the current bank is updated each time the user: - Sets the TX Packet Ready bit to prepare the next IN transfer and to switch to the next bank. - Clears the received OUT data bit to access the next bank. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint). - Control Direction: (for Control endpoint only) 0 = a Control Write is requested by the Host. 1 = a Control Read is requested by the Host. Note1: This bit corresponds with the 7th bit of the bmRequestType (Byte 0 of the Setup Data). Note2: This bit is updated after receiving new setup data. * BUSY_BANK_STA: Busy Bank Number These bits are set by hardware to indicate the number of busy banks. IN endpoint: it indicates the number of busy banks filled by the user, ready for IN transfer. OUT endpoint: it indicates the number of busy banks filled by OUT transaction from the Host.
00 01 10 11 All banks are free 1 busy bank 2 busy banks 3 busy banks
* BYTE_COUNT: UDPHS Byte Count Byte count of a received data packet. This field is incremented after each write into the endpoint (to prepare an IN transfer). This field is decremented after each reading into the endpoint (OUT transfer).
796
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
This field is also updated at RX_BK_RDY flag clear with the next bank. This field is also updated at TX_PK_RDY flag set with the next bank. This field is reset by EPT_x of UDPHS_EPTRST register. * SHRT_PCKT: Short Packet An OUT Short Packet is detected when the receive byte count is less than the configured UDPHS_EPTCFGx register EPT_Size. This bit is updated at the same time as the BYTE_COUNT field. This bit is reset by UDPHS_EPTRST register EPT_x (reset endpoint) and by UDPHS_EPTCTLDISx (disable endpoint).
797
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.23
UDPHS DMA Channel Transfer Descriptor The DMA channel transfer descriptor is loaded from the memory. Be careful with the alignment of this buffer. The structure of the DMA channel transfer descriptor is defined by three parameters as described below: Offset 0: The address must be aligned: 0xXXXX0 Next Descriptor Address Register: UDPHS_DMANXTDSCx Offset 4: The address must be aligned: 0xXXXX4 DMA Channelx Address Register: UDPHS_DMAADDRESSx Offset 8: The address must be aligned: 0xXXXX8 DMA Channelx Control Register: UDPHS_DMACONTROLx To use the DMA channel transfer descriptor, fill the structures with the correct value (as described in the following pages). Then write directly in UDPHS_DMANXTDSCx the address of the descriptor to be used first. Then write 1 in the LDNXT_DSC bit of UDPHS_DMACONTROLx (load next channel transfer descriptor). The descriptor is automatically loaded upon Endpointx request for packet transfer.
798
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.24 Name: UDPHS DMA Next Descriptor Address Register UDPHS_DMANXTDSCx [x = 1..5] Read/Write
30 29 28 27 NXT_DSC_ADD 20 19 NXT_DSC_ADD 12 11 NXT_DSC_ADD 4 3 NXT_DSC_ADD 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
18
17
16
15
14
13
10
9
8
7
6
5
2
1
0
* NXT_DSC_ADD This field points to the next channel descriptor to be processed. This channel descriptor must be aligned, so bits 0 to 3 of the address must be equal to zero.
799
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
41.5.25 Name:
UDPHS DMA Channel Address Register UDPHS_DMAADDRESSx [x = 1..5] Read/Write
30 29 28 BUFF_ADD 27 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
20 BUFF_ADD
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 BUFF_ADD
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 BUFF_ADD
3
2
1
0
* BUFF_ADD This field determines the AHB bus starting address of a DMA channel transfer. Channel start and end addresses may be aligned on any byte boundary. The firmware may write this field only when the UDPHS_DMASTATUS register CHANN_ENB bit is clear. This field is updated at the end of the address phase of the current access to the AHB bus. It is incrementing of the access byte width. The access width is 4 bytes (or less) at packet start or end, if the start or end address is not aligned on a word boundary. The packet start address is either the channel start address or the next channel address to be accessed in the channel buffer. The packet end address is either the channel end address or the latest channel address accessed in the channel buffer. The channel start address is written by software or loaded from the descriptor, whereas the channel end address is either determined by the end of buffer or the UDPHS device, USB end of transfer if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register END_TR_EN bit is set.
800
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.26 Name: UDPHS DMA Channel Control Register UDPHS_DMACONTROLx [x = 1..5] Read/Write
30 29 28 27 BUFF_LENGTH 20 19 BUFF_LENGTH 12 - 4 END_TR_IT 11 - 3 END_B_EN 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
18
17
16
15 - 7 BURST_LCK
14 - 6 DESC_LD_IT
13 - 5 END_BUFFIT
10 - 2 END_TR_EN
9 - 1 LDNXT_DSC
8 - 0 CHANN_ENB
* CHANN_ENB (Channel Enable Command) 0 = DMA channel is disabled at and no transfer will occur upon request. This bit is also cleared by hardware when the channel source bus is disabled at end of buffer. If the UDPHS_DMACONTROL register LDNXT_DSC bit has been cleared by descriptor loading, the firmware will have to set the corresponding CHANN_ENB bit to start the described transfer, if needed. If the UDPHS_DMACONTROL register LDNXT_DSC bit is cleared, the channel is frozen and the channel registers may then be read and/or written reliably as soon as both UDPHS_DMASTATUS register CHANN_ENB and CHANN_ACT flags read as 0. If a channel request is currently serviced when this bit is cleared, the DMA FIFO buffer is drained until it is empty, then the UDPHS_DMASTATUS register CHANN_ENB bit is cleared. If the LDNXT_DSC bit is set at or after this bit clearing, then the currently loaded descriptor is skipped (no data transfer occurs) and the next descriptor is immediately loaded. 1 = UDPHS_DMASTATUS register CHANN_ENB bit will be set, thus enabling DMA channel data transfer. Then any pending request will start the transfer. This may be used to start or resume any requested transfer. * LDNXT_DSC: Load Next Channel Transfer Descriptor Enable (Command) 0 = no channel register is loaded after the end of the channel transfer. 1 = the channel controller loads the next descriptor after the end of the current transfer, i.e. when the UDPHS_DMASTATUS/CHANN_ENB bit is reset. If the UDPHS_DMA CONTROL/CHANN_ENB bit is cleared, the next descriptor is immediately loaded upon transfer request.
LDNXT_DSC 0 0 1 1 CHANN_ENB 0 1 0 1 Stop now Run and stop at end of buffer Load next descriptor now Run and link at end of buffer Description
801
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* END_TR_EN: End of Transfer Enable (Control) Used for OUT transfers only. 0 = USB end of transfer is ignored. 1 = UDPHS device can put an end to the current buffer transfer. When set, a BULK or INTERRUPT short packet or the last packet of an ISOCHRONOUS (micro) frame (DATAX) will close the current buffer and the UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register END_TR_ST flag will be raised. This is intended for UDPHS non-prenegotiated end of transfer (BULK or INTERRUPT) or ISOCHRONOUS microframe data buffer closure. * END_B_EN: End of Buffer Enable (Control) 0 = DMA Buffer End has no impact on USB packet transfer. 1 = endpoint can validate the packet (according to the values programmed in the UDPHS_EPTCTLx register AUTO_VALID and SHRT_PCKT fields) at DMA Buffer End, i.e. when the UDPHS_DMASTATUS register BUFF_COUNT reaches 0. This is mainly for short packet IN validation initiated by the DMA reaching end of buffer, but could be used for OUT packet truncation (discarding of unwanted packet data) at the end of DMA buffer. * END_TR_IT: End of Transfer Interrupt Enable 0 = UDPHS device initiated buffer transfer completion will not trigger any interrupt at UDPHS_STATUSx/END_TR_ST rising. 1 = an interrupt is sent after the buffer transfer is complete, if the UDPHS device has ended the buffer transfer. Use when the receive size is unknown. * END_BUFFIT: End of Buffer Interrupt Enable 0 = UDPHS_DMA_STATUSx/END_BF_ST rising will not trigger any interrupt. 1 = an interrupt is generated when the UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register BUFF_COUNT reaches zero. * DESC_LD_IT: Descriptor Loaded Interrupt Enable 0 = UDPHS_DMASTATUSx/DESC_LDST rising will not trigger any interrupt. 1 = an interrupt is generated when a descriptor has been loaded from the bus. * BURST_LCK: Burst Lock Enable 0 = the DMA never locks bus access. 1 = USB packets AHB data bursts are locked for maximum optimization of the bus bandwidth usage and maximization of fly-by AHB burst duration. * BUFF_LENGTH: Buffer Byte Length (Write-only) This field determines the number of bytes to be transferred until end of buffer. The maximum channel transfer size (64 KBytes) is reached when this field is 0 (default value). If the transfer size is unknown, this field should be set to 0, but the transfer end may occur earlier under UDPHS device control. When this field is written, The UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register BUFF_COUNT field is updated with the write value.
Note: Note: Bits [31:2] are only writable when issuing a channel Control Command other than "Stop Now". For reliability it is highly recommended to wait for both UDPHS_DMASTATUSx register CHAN_ACT and CHAN_ENB flags are at 0, thus ensuring the channel has been stopped before issuing a command other than "Stop Now".
802
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
41.5.27 Name: UDPHS DMA Channel Status Register UDPHS_DMASTATUSx [x = 1..5] Read/Write
30 29 28 27 BUFF_COUNT 20 19 BUFF_COUNT 12 - 4 END_TR_ST 11 - 3 - 26 25 24
Access Type:
31
23
22
21
18
17
16
15 - 7 -
14 - 6 DESC_LDST
13 - 5 END_BF_ST
10 - 2 -
9 - 1 CHANN_ACT
8 - 0 CHANN_ENB
* CHANN_ENB: Channel Enable Status 0 = if cleared, the DMA channel no longer transfers data, and may load the next descriptor if the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register LDNXT_DSC bit is set. When any transfer is ended either due to an elapsed byte count or a UDPHS device initiated transfer end, this bit is automatically reset. 1 = if set, the DMA channel is currently enabled and transfers data upon request. This bit is normally set or cleared by writing into the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register CHANN_ENB bit field either by software or descriptor loading. If a channel request is currently serviced when the UDPHS_DMACONTROLx register CHANN_ENB bit is cleared, the DMA FIFO buffer is drained until it is empty, then this status bit is cleared. * CHANN_ACT: Channel Active Status 0 = the DMA channel is no longer trying to source the packet data. When a packet transfer is ended this bit is automatically reset. 1 = the DMA channel is currently trying to source packet data, i.e. selected as the highest-priority requesting channel. When a packet transfer cannot be completed due to an END_BF_ST, this flag stays set during the next channel descriptor load (if any) and potentially until UDPHS packet transfer completion, if allowed by the new descriptor. * END_TR_ST: End of Channel Transfer Status 0 = cleared automatically when read by software. 1 = set by hardware when the last packet transfer is complete, if the UDPHS device has ended the transfer. Valid until the CHANN_ENB flag is cleared at the end of the next buffer transfer. * END_BF_ST: End of Channel Buffer Status 0 = cleared automatically when read by software. 1 = set by hardware when the BUFF_COUNT downcount reach zero. Valid until the CHANN_ENB flag is cleared at the end of the next buffer transfer.
803
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
* DESC_LDST: Descriptor Loaded Status 0 = cleared automatically when read by software. 1 = set by hardware when a descriptor has been loaded from the system bus. Valid until the CHANN_ENB flag is cleared at the end of the next buffer transfer. * BUFF_COUNT: Buffer Byte Count This field determines the current number of bytes still to be transferred for this buffer. This field is decremented from the AHB source bus access byte width at the end of this bus address phase. The access byte width is 4 by default, or less, at DMA start or end, if the start or end address is not aligned on a word boundary. At the end of buffer, the DMA accesses the UDPHS device only for the number of bytes needed to complete it. This field value is reliable (stable) only if the channel has been stopped or frozen (UDPHS_EPTCTLx register NT_DIS_DMA bit is used to disable the channel request) and the channel is no longer active CHANN_ACT flag is 0.
Note:
For OUT endpoints, if the receive buffer byte length (BUFF_LENGTH) has been defaulted to zero because the USB transfer length is unknown, the actual buffer byte length received will be 0x10000-BUFF_COUNT.
804
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42. Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Controller
42.1 Description
The PWM macrocell controls several channels independently. Each channel controls one square output waveform. Characteristics of the output waveform such as period, duty-cycle and polarity are configurable through the user interface. Each channel selects and uses one of the clocks provided by the clock generator. The clock generator provides several clocks resulting from the division of the PWM macrocell master clock. All PWM macrocell accesses are made through APB mapped registers. Channels can be synchronized, to generate non overlapped waveforms. All channels integrate a double buffering system in order to prevent an unexpected output waveform while modifying the period or the duty-cycle.
42.2
Block Diagram
Figure 42-1. Pulse Width Modulation Controller Block Diagram
PWM Controller
PWMx Channel
Period Update Duty Cycle Comparator
PWMx PWMx
Clock Selector
Counter
PIO
PWM0 Channel
Period Update Duty Cycle Comparator
PWM0 PWM0
Clock Selector
MCK
Counter
PMC
Clock Generator
APB Interface
Interrupt Generator
AIC
APB
805
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.3
I/O Lines Description
Each channel outputs one waveform on one external I/O line. Table 42-1.
Name PWMx
I/O Line Description
Description PWM Waveform Output for Channel x Type Output
42.4
42.4.1
Product Dependencies
I/O Lines The pins used for interfacing the PWM may be multiplexed with PIO lines. The programmer must first program the PIO controller to assign the desired PWM pins to their peripheral function. If I/O lines of the PWM are not used by the application, they can be used for other purposes by the PIO controller. All of the PWM outputs may or may not be enabled. If an application requires only four channels, then only four PIO lines will be assigned to PWM outputs.
42.4.2
Power Management The PWM is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the PWM clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the PWM. However, if the application does not require PWM operations, the PWM clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. In this case, the PWM will resume its operations where it left off. Configuring the PWM does not require the PWM clock to be enabled.
42.4.3
Interrupt Sources The PWM interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the PWM interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Note that it is not recommended to use the PWM interrupt line in edge sensitive mode.
42.5
Functional Description
The PWM macrocell is primarily composed of a clock generator module and 4 channels. - Clocked by the system clock, MCK, the clock generator module provides 13 clocks. - Each channel can independently choose one of the clock generator outputs. - Each channel generates an output waveform with attributes that can be defined independently for each channel through the user interface registers.
806
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.5.1 PWM Clock Generator
Figure 42-2. Functional View of the Clock Generator Block Diagram
MCK modulo n counter MCK MCK/2 MCK/4 MCK/8 MCK/16 MCK/32 MCK/64 MCK/128 MCK/256 MCK/512 MCK/1024
Divider A
clkA
PREA
DIVA
PWM_MR
Divider B
clkB
PREB
DIVB
PWM_MR
Caution: Before using the PWM macrocell, the programmer must first enable the PWM clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC). The PWM macrocell master clock, MCK, is divided in the clock generator module to provide different clocks available for all channels. Each channel can independently select one of the divided clocks. The clock generator is divided in three blocks: - a modulo n counter which provides 11 clocks: FMCK, FMCK/2, FMCK/4, FMCK/8, FMCK/16, FMCK/32, FMCK/64, FMCK/128, FMCK/256, FMCK/512, FMCK/1024 - two linear dividers (1, 1/2, 1/3, ... 1/255) that provide two separate clocks: clkA and clkB Each linear divider can independently divide one of the clocks of the modulo n counter. The selection of the clock to be divided is made according to the PREA (PREB) field of the PWM Mode register (PWM_MR). The resulting clock clkA (clkB) is the clock selected divided by DIVA (DIVB) field value in the PWM Mode register (PWM_MR).
807
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
After a reset of the PWM controller, DIVA (DIVB) and PREA (PREB) in the PWM Mode register are set to 0. This implies that after reset clkA (clkB) are turned off. At reset, all clocks provided by the modulo n counter are turned off except clock "clk". This situation is also true when the PWM master clock is turned off through the Power Management Controller. 42.5.2 42.5.2.1 PWM Channel Block Diagram
Figure 42-3. Functional View of the Channel Block Diagram
inputs from clock generator
Channel
Clock Selector Internal Counter
Comparator
PWMx output waveform
inputs from APB bus
Each of the 4 channels is composed of three blocks: * A clock selector which selects one of the clocks provided by the clock generator described in Section 42.5.1 "PWM Clock Generator" on page 807. * An internal counter clocked by the output of the clock selector. This internal counter is incremented or decremented according to the channel configuration and comparators events. The size of the internal counter is 16 bits. * A comparator used to generate events according to the internal counter value. It also computes the PWMx output waveform according to the configuration. 42.5.2.2 Waveform Properties The different properties of output waveforms are: * the internal clock selection. The internal channel counter is clocked by one of the clocks provided by the clock generator described in the previous section. This channel parameter is defined in the CPRE field of the PWM_CMRx register. This field is reset at 0. * the waveform period. This channel parameter is defined in the CPRD field of the PWM_CPRDx register. - If the waveform is left aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024), the resulting period formula will be:
( X x CPRD ) ------------------------------MCK
By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
808
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
( CRPD x DIVA ) ------------------------------------------ or ( CRPD x DIVAB ) ---------------------------------------------MCK MCK
If the waveform is center aligned then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be:
( 2 x X x CPRD ) -----------------------------------------MCK
By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
( 2 x CPRD x DIVA ) ----------------------------------------------------- or ( 2 x CPRD x DIVB ) ----------------------------------------------------MCK MCK
* the waveform duty cycle. This channel parameter is defined in the CDTY field of the PWM_CDTYx register. If the waveform is left aligned then: ( period - 1 fchannel_x_clock x CDTY ) duty cycle = ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------period If the waveform is center aligned, then: ( ( period 2 ) - 1 fchannel_x_clock x CDTY ) ) duty cycle = ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------( period 2 ) * the waveform polarity. At the beginning of the period, the signal can be at high or low level. This property is defined in the CPOL field of the PWM_CMRx register. By default the signal starts by a low level. * the waveform alignment. The output waveform can be left or center aligned. Center aligned waveforms can be used to generate non overlapped waveforms. This property is defined in the CALG field of the PWM_CMRx register. The default mode is left aligned. Figure 42-4. Non Overlapped Center Aligned Waveforms
No overlap
PWM0
PWM1
Period
Note:
1. See Figure 42-5 on page 811 for a detailed description of center aligned waveforms.
When center aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and.decreases down to 0. This ends the period. When left aligned, the internal channel counter increases up to CPRD and is reset. This ends the period. 809
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Thus, for the same CPRD value, the period for a center aligned channel is twice the period for a left aligned channel. Waveforms are fixed at 0 when:
* CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 0 * CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 1
Waveforms are fixed at 1 (once the channel is enabled) when:
* CDTY = 0 and CPOL = 0 * CDTY = CPRD and CPOL = 1
The waveform polarity must be set before enabling the channel. This immediately affects the channel output level. Changes on channel polarity are not taken into account while the channel is enabled.
810
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 42-5. Waveform Properties
PWM_MCKx
CHIDx(PWM_SR)
CHIDx(PWM_ENA) CHIDx(PWM_DIS) Center Aligned CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 1
PWM_CCNTx CPRD(PWM_CPRDx) CDTY(PWM_CDTYx)
Period Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0
Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1
CHIDx(PWM_ISR)
PWM_CCNTx CPRD(PWM_CPRDx) CDTY(PWM_CDTYx)
Left Aligned CALG(PWM_CMRx) = 0
Period Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 0
Output Waveform PWMx CPOL(PWM_CMRx) = 1
CHIDx(PWM_ISR)
811
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.5.3 42.5.3.1
PWM Controller Operations Initialization Before enabling the output channel, this channel must have been configured by the software application: * Configuration of the clock generator if DIVA and DIVB are required * Selection of the clock for each channel (CPRE field in the PWM_CMRx register) * Configuration of the waveform alignment for each channel (CALG field in the PWM_CMRx register) * Configuration of the period for each channel (CPRD in the PWM_CPRDx register). Writing in PWM_CPRDx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of the channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CPRDx as explained below. * Configuration of the duty cycle for each channel (CDTY in the PWM_CDTYx register). Writing in PWM_CDTYx Register is possible while the channel is disabled. After validation of the channel, the user must use PWM_CUPDx Register to update PWM_CDTYx as explained below. * Configuration of the output waveform polarity for each channel (CPOL in the PWM_CMRx register) * Enable Interrupts (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_IER register) * Enable the PWM channel (Writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register) It is possible to synchronize different channels by enabling them at the same time by means of writing simultaneously several CHIDx bits in the PWM_ENA register. * In such a situation, all channels may have the same clock selector configuration and the same period specified.
42.5.3.2
Source Clock Selection Criteria The large number of source clocks can make selection difficult. The relationship between the value in the Period Register (PWM_CPRDx) and the Duty Cycle Register (PWM_CDTYx) can help the user in choosing. The event number written in the Period Register gives the PWM accuracy. The Duty Cycle quantum cannot be lower than 1/PWM_CPRDx value. The higher the value of PWM_CPRDx, the greater the PWM accuracy. For example, if the user sets 15 (in decimal) in PWM_CPRDx, the user is able to set a value between 1 up to 14 in PWM_CDTYx Register. The resulting duty cycle quantum cannot be lower than 1/15 of the PWM period.
42.5.3.3
Changing the Duty Cycle or the Period It is possible to modulate the output waveform duty cycle or period. To prevent unexpected output waveform, the user must use the update register (PWM_CUPDx) to change waveform parameters while the channel is still enabled. The user can write a new period value or duty cycle value in the update register (PWM_CUPDx). This register holds the new value until the end of the current cycle and updates the value for the next cycle. Depending on the CPD field in the PWM_CMRx register, PWM_CUPDx either updates PWM_CPRDx or PWM_CDTYx. Note that even if the update register is used, the period must not be smaller than the duty cycle.
812
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 42-6. Synchronized Period or Duty Cycle Update
User's Writing
PWM_CUPDx Value
1
0
PWM_CMRx. CPD
PWM_CPRDx
PWM_CDTYx
End of Cycle
To prevent overwriting the PWM_CUPDx by software, the user can use status events in order to synchronize his software. Two methods are possible. In both, the user must enable the dedicated interrupt in PWM_IER at PWM Controller level. The first method (polling method) consists of reading the relevant status bit in PWM_ISR Register according to the enabled channel(s). See Figure 42-7. The second method uses an Interrupt Service Routine associated with the PWM channel.
Note: Reading the PWM_ISR register automatically clears CHIDx flags.
Figure 42-7. Polling Method
PWM_ISR Read Acknowledgement and clear previous register state
Writing in CPD field Update of the Period or Duty Cycle
CHIDx = 1
YES Writing in PWM_CUPDx The last write has been taken into account
Note:
Polarity and alignment can be modified only when the channel is disabled.
813
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.5.3.4
Interrupts Depending on the interrupt mask in the PWM_IMR register, an interrupt is generated at the end of the corresponding channel period. The interrupt remains active until a read operation in the PWM_ISR register occurs. A channel interrupt is enabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IER register. A channel interrupt is disabled by setting the corresponding bit in the PWM_IDR register.
814
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.6 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Controller User Interface
PWM Controller Registers
Register PWM Mode Register PWM Enable Register PWM Disable Register PWM Status Register PWM Interrupt Enable Register PWM Interrupt Disable Register PWM Interrupt Mask Register PWM Interrupt Status Register Reserved Reserved Channel 0 Mode Register Channel 0 Duty Cycle Register Channel 0 Period Register Channel 0 Counter Register Channel 0 Update Register Reserved Channel 1 Mode Register Channel 1 Duty Cycle Register Channel 1 Period Register Channel 1 Counter Register Channel 1 Update Register ... PWM_CMR1 PWM_CDTY1 PWM_CPRD1 PWM_CCNT1 PWM_CUPD1 ... Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read-only Write-only ... 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 ... PWM_CMR0 PWM_CDTY0 PWM_CPRD0 PWM_CCNT0 PWM_CUPD0 Read/Write Read/Write Read/Write Read-only Write-only 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 Name PWM_MR PWM_ENA PWM_DIS PWM_SR PWM_IER PWM_IDR PWM_IMR PWM_ISR - Access Read/Write Write-only Write-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only - Peripheral Reset Value 0 0 0 0 -
Table 42-2.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x4C - 0xFC
0x100 - 0x1FC 0x200 0x204 0x208 0x20C 0x210 ... 0x220 0x224 0x228 0x22C 0x230 ...
815
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.6.1 PWM Mode Register Register Name: PWM_MR Access Type:
31 - 23
Read/Write
30 - 22 29 - 21 28 - 20 DIVB 27 26 PREB 19 18 17 16 25 24
15 - 7
14 - 6
13 - 5
12 - 4 DIVA
11
10 PREA
9
8
3
2
1
0
* DIVA, DIVB: CLKA, CLKB Divide Factor
DIVA, DIVB 0 1 2-255 CLKA, CLKB CLKA, CLKB clock is turned off CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB CLKA, CLKB clock is clock selected by PREA, PREB divided by DIVA, DIVB factor.
* PREA, PREB
PREA, PREB 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 Other 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 MCK. MCK/2 MCK/4 MCK/8 MCK/16 MCK/32 MCK/64 MCK/128 MCK/256 MCK/512 MCK/1024 Reserved Divider Input Clock
816
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.6.2 PWM Enable Register Register Name: PWM_ENA Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable PWM output for channel x.
42.6.3 PWM Disable Register Register Name: PWM_DIS Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable PWM output for channel x.
817
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.6.4 PWM Status Register Register Name: PWM_SR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = PWM output for channel x is disabled. 1 = PWM output for channel x is enabled.
818
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.6.5 PWM Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: PWM_IER Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = No effect. 1 = Enable interrupt for PWM channel x. 42.6.6 PWM Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: PWM_IDR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Write-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = No effect. 1 = Disable interrupt for PWM channel x.
819
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.6.7 PWM Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: PWM_IMR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID. 0 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is disabled. 1 = Interrupt for PWM channel x is enabled. 42.6.8 PWM Interrupt Status Register Register Name: PWM_ISR Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read-only
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 CHID3 26 - 18 - 10 - 2 CHID2 25 - 17 - 9 - 1 CHID1 24 - 16 - 8 - 0 CHID0
* CHIDx: Channel ID 0 = No new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register. 1 = At least one new channel period has been achieved since the last read of the PWM_ISR register.
Note: Reading PWM_ISR automatically clears CHIDx flags.
820
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.6.9 PWM Channel Mode Register Register Name: PWM_CMRx Access Type:
31 - 23 - 15 - 7 -
Read/Write
30 - 22 - 14 - 6 - 29 - 21 - 13 - 5 - 28 - 20 - 12 - 4 - 27 - 19 - 11 - 3 26 - 18 - 10 CPD 2 CPRE 25 - 17 - 9 CPOL 1 24 - 16 - 8 CALG 0
* CPRE: Channel Pre-scaler
CPRE
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 Other 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 MCK MCK/2 MCK/4 MCK/8 MCK/16 MCK/32 MCK/64 MCK/128 MCK/256 MCK/512 MCK/1024 CLKA CLKB Reserved
Channel Pre-scaler
* CALG: Channel Alignment 0 = The period is left aligned. 1 = The period is center aligned. * CPOL: Channel Polarity 0 = The output waveform starts at a low level. 1 = The output waveform starts at a high level. * CPD: Channel Update Period 0 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the duty cycle at the next period start event. 1 = Writing to the PWM_CUPDx will modify the period at the next period start event.
821
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.6.10 PWM Channel Duty Cycle Register Register Name: PWM_CDTYx Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 CDTY 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 CDTY
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 CDTY
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CDTY
3
2
1
0
Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant. * CDTY: Channel Duty Cycle Defines the waveform duty cycle. This value must be defined between 0 and CPRD (PWM_CPRx).
822
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
42.6.11 PWM Channel Period Register Register Name: PWM_CPRDx Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 CPRD 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 CPRD
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 CPRD
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CPRD
3
2
1
0
Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant. * CPRD: Channel Period If the waveform is left-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: - By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be:
( X x CPRD ) ------------------------------MCK
- By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
( CRPD x DIVA ) ------------------------------------------ or ( CRPD x DIVAB ) ---------------------------------------------MCK MCK
If the waveform is center-aligned, then the output waveform period depends on the counter source clock and can be calculated: - By using the Master Clock (MCK) divided by an X given prescaler value (with X being 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512, or 1024). The resulting period formula will be:
( 2 x X x CPRD ) -----------------------------------------MCK
- By using a Master Clock divided by one of both DIVA or DIVB divider, the formula becomes, respectively:
( 2 x CPRD x DIVA ) ----------------------------------------------------- or ( 2 x CPRD x DIVB ) ----------------------------------------------------MCK MCK
823
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
42.6.12 PWM Channel Counter Register Register Name: PWM_CCNTx Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 CNT 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 CNT
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 CNT
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CNT
3
2
1
0
* CNT: Channel Counter Register Internal counter value. This register is reset when: * the channel is enabled (writing CHIDx in the PWM_ENA register). * the counter reaches CPRD value defined in the PWM_CPRDx register if the waveform is left aligned. 42.6.13 PWM Channel Update Register Register Name: PWM_CUPDx Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 CUPD 27 26 25 24
23
22
21
20 CUPD
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12 CUPD
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4 CUPD
3
2
1
0
This register acts as a double buffer for the period or the duty cycle. This prevents an unexpected waveform when modifying the waveform period or duty-cycle. Only the first 16 bits (internal channel counter size) are significant.
CPD (PWM_CMRx Register) 0 1 The duty-cycle (CDTC in the PWM_CDRx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the beginning of the next period. The period (CPRD in the PWM_CPRx register) is updated with the CUPD value at the beginning of the next period.
824
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43. Touch Screen ADC Controller
43.1 Description
The Touch Screen ADC Controller is based on a Successive Approximation Register (SAR) 10bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). It also integrates: * a 6-to-1 analog multiplexer for analog-to-digital conversions of up to 6 analog lines * 4 power switches that measure both axis positions on the resistive touch screen panel * 1 additional power switch and an embedded resistor that detects pen-interrupt and pen loss The conversions extend from 0V to TSADVREF. The TSADCC supports an 8-bit or 10-bit resolution mode, and conversion results are reported in a common register for all channels, as well as in a channel-dedicated register. Conversions can be started for all enabled channels, either by a software trigger, by detection of a rising edge on the external trigger pin TSADTRG or by an integrated programmable timer. When the Touch Screen is enabled, a timer-triggered sequencer automatically configures the power switches, performs the conversions and stores the results in dedicated registers. The TSADCC also integrates a Sleep Mode and a Pen-Detect Mode and connects with one PDC channel. These features reduce both power consumption and processor intervention. The TSADCC timings, like the Startup Time and Sample and Hold Time, are fully configurable.
825
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
43.2
Block Diagram
Figure 43-1. TSADCC Block Diagram
TSADC
VDDANA
TSADCC
Memory Controller ADTRG Trigger Selection Timer PDC
PIO
Touch Screen Sequencer
ADC Control Logic User Interface Peripheral Bridge APB
AD0XP
Analog Multiplexer
AD1XM AD2YP AD3YM GPAD4 ....
Touch Screen Switches
Successive Approximation Register Analog-to-Digital Converter
TSADC Clock
PMC
GPADx ADVREF GND
TSADC Interrupt
AIC
GPADx: last general-purpose ADC channel defined by the number of channels
826
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.3 Signal Description
TSADCC Pin Description
Description Analog power supply Reference voltage Analog input channel 0 or Touch Screen Top channel Analog input channel 1 or Touch Screen Bottom channel Analog input channel 2 or Touch Screen Right channel Analog input channel 3 or Touch Screen Left channel General-purpose analog input channels 4 to 5 External trigger
Table 43-1.
Pin Name VDDANA TSADVREF AD0XP AD1XM AD2YP AD3YM
GPAD4 - GPAD5 TSADTRG
43.4
43.4.1
Product Dependencies
Power Management The TSADC controller is not continuously clocked. The programmer must first enable the TSADC controller Clock in the Power Management Controller (PMC) before using the TSADC controller. However, if the application does not require TSADC controller operations, the TSADC controller clock can be stopped when not needed and be restarted later. Configuring the TSADC controller does not require the TSADC controller clock to be enabled.
43.4.2
Interrupt Sources The TSADCC interrupt line is connected on one of the internal sources of the Advanced Interrupt Controller. Using the TSADCC interrupt requires the AIC to be programmed first. Analog Inputs The analog input pins can be multiplexed with PIO lines. In this case, the assignment of the TSADCC input is automatically done as soon as the corresponding channel is enabled by writing the register TSADCC_CHER. By default, after reset, the PIO lines are configured as input with its pull-up enabled and the TSADCC inputs are connected to the GND.
43.4.3
43.4.4
I/O Lines The pin TSADTRG may be shared with other peripheral functions through the PIO Controller. In this case, the PIO Controller should be set accordingly to assign the pin TSADTRG to the TSADCC function.
43.4.5
Conversion Performances For performance and electrical characteristics of the TSADCC, see the section "Electrical Characteristics" of the full datasheet.
827
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
43.5
Analog-to-digital Converter Functional Description
The TSADCC embeds a Successive Approximation Register (SAR) Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). The ADC supports 8-bit or 10-bit resolutions. The conversion is performed on a full range between 0V and the reference voltage pin TSADVREF. Analog inputs between these voltages convert to values based on a linear conversion.
43.5.1
ADC Resolution The ADC supports 8-bit or 10-bit resolutions. The 8-bit selection is performed by setting the bit LOWRES in the TSADCC Mode Register. See Section 43.10.2 "TSADCC Mode Register" on page 840. By default, after a reset, the resolution is the highest and the DATA field in the "TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5)" are fully used. By setting the bit LOWRES, the ADC switches in the lowest resolution and the conversion results can be read in the eight lowest significant bits of the data registers. The two highest bits of the DATA field in the corresponding TSADCC_CDR register and of the LDATA field in the TSADCC_LCDR register read 0. Moreover, when a PDC channel is connected to the TSADCC, 10-bit resolution sets the transfer request sizes to 16-bit. Setting the bit LOWRES automatically switches to 8-bit data transfers. In this case, the destination buffers are optimized. All the conversions for the Touch Screen forces the ADC in 10-bit resolution, regardless of the LOWRES setting. Further details are given in the section "Operating Modes" on page 835.
43.5.2
ADC Clock The TSADCC uses the ADC Clock to perform conversions. Converting a single analog value to a 10-bit digital data requires Sample and Hold Clock cycles as defined in the field SHTIM of the "TSADCC Mode Register" and 10 ADC Clock cycles. The ADC Clock frequency is selected in the PRESCAL field of the "TSADCC Mode Register". The ADC clock range is between MCK/2, if PRESCAL is 0, and MCK/128, if PRESCAL is set to 63 (0x3F). PRESCAL must be programmed in order to provide an ADC clock frequency according to the maximum sampling rate parameter given in the Electrical Characteristics section.
43.5.3
Sleep Mode The TSADCC Sleep Mode maximizes power saving by automatically deactivating the Analog-toDigital Converter cell when it is not being used for conversions. Sleep Mode is enabled by setting the bit SLEEP in "TSADCC Mode Register". The SLEEP of the ADC is automatically managed by the conversion sequencer, which can automatically process the conversions of all channels at lowest power consumption. When a trigger occurs, the Analog-to-Digital Converter cell is automatically activated. As the analog cell requires a start-up time, the logic waits during this time and then starts the conversion on the enabled channels. When all conversions are complete, the ADC is deactivated until the next trigger.
43.5.4
Startup Time The Touch Screen ADC has a minimal Startup Time when it exits the Sleep Mode. As the ADC Clock depends on the application, the user has to program the field STARTUP in the "TSADCC
828
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Mode Register", which defines how many ADC Clock cycles to wait before performing the first conversion of the sequence. The field STARTUP can define a Startup Time between 8 and 1024 ADC Clock cycles by steps of 8. The user must assure that ADC Startup Time given in the section "Electrical Characteristics" is covered by this wait time. 43.5.5 Sample and Hold Time In the same way, a minimal Sample and Hold Time is necessary for the TSADCC to guarantee the best converted final value between selection of two channels. This time depends on the input impedance of the analog input, but also on the output impedance of the driver providing the signal to the analog input, as there is no input buffer amplifier. The Sample and Hold time has to be programmed through the bitfields SHTIM in the "TSADCC Mode Register" and TSSHTIM in the "TSADCC Touch Screen Register". The field SHTIM defines the number of ADC Clock cycles for an analog input, while the field TSSHTIM defines the number of ADC Clock cycles for a Touch Screen input. These both fields can define a Sample and Hold time between 1 and 16 ADC Clock cycles. The field TSSHTIM defines also the time the power switches of the Touch Screen are closed when the TSADCC performs a conversion for the Touch Screen.
43.6
43.6.1
Touch Screen
Resistive Touch Screen Principles A resistive touch screen is based on two resistive films, each one being fitted with a pair of electrodes, placed at the top and bottom on one film, and on the right and left on the other. Between the two, there is a layer that acts as an insulator, but also enables contact when you press the screen. This is illustrated in Figure 43-2.
829
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 43-2. Touch Screen Position Measurement
Pen Contact XP
YM
YP
XM
XP
VDD
YP
VDD
YP
XP
Volt XM Vertical Position Detection YM
Volt
GND
GND
Horizontal Position Detection
43.6.2
Position Measurement Method As shown in Figure 43-2, to detect the position of a contact, a supply is first applied from top to bottom. Due to the linear resistance of the film, there is a voltage gradient from top to bottom. When a contact is performed on the screen, the voltage propagates at the point the two surfaces come into contact with the second film. If the input impedance on the right and left electrodes sense is high enough, the film does not affect this voltage, despite its resistive nature. For the horizontal direction, the same method is used, but by applying supply from left to right. The range depends on the supply voltage and on the loss in the switches that connect to the top and bottom electrodes. In an ideal world (linear, with no loss through switches), the horizontal position is equal to: VYM / VDD or VYP / VDD. The proposed implementation with on-chip power switches is shown in Figure 43-3. The voltage measurement at the output of the switch compensates for the switches loss. It is possible to correct for the switch loss by performing the operation: [VYP - VXM] / [VXP - VXM] . This requires additional measurements, as shown in Figure 43-3.
830
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 43-3. Touch Screen Switches Implementation
XP VDDANA
XM
GND To the ADC VDDANA
YP
YM
GND
VDDANA Switch Resistor
VDDANA Switch Resistor
XP
YP
YP
XP
XM Switch Resistor
YM Switch Resistor
GND Horizontal Position Detection
GND Vertical Position Detection
43.6.3
Pen Detect Method When there is no contact, it is not necessary to perform conversion. However, it is important to detect a contact by keeping the power consumption as low as possible. The proposed implementation polarizes the vertical panel by closing the switch on XP and ties the horizontal panel by an embedded resistor connected to YM. This resistor is enabled by a fifth switch. Since there is no contact, no current is flowing and there is no related power consumption. As soon as a contact occurs, a current is flowing in the touch screen and a schmitt trigger detects the voltage in the resistor. The Touch Screen Interrupt configuration is entered by programming the bit PENDET in the "TSADCC Mode Register". If this bit is written at 1, the switch on XP and the switch on the resistor are both closed, except when a touch screen conversion is in progress. To complete the circuit, a programmable debouncer is placed at the output of the schmitt trigger. This debouncer is programmable at 1 ADC Clock period, useful when the system is running at Slow Clock, or at up to 2 15 ADC Clock periods, but better used to filter noise on the Touch 831
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Screen panel when the system is running at high speed. The debouncer length can be selected by programming the field PENDBC in "TSADCC Mode Register". Figure 43-4. Touch Screen Pen Detect
XP VDDANA
XM
GND To the ADC VDDANA
YP
YM
GND PENDBC Debouncer Pen Interrupt
GND
The Touch Screen Pen Detect can be used to generate a TSADCC interrupt to wake up the system or it can be programmed to trig a conversion, so that a position can be measured as soon as a contact is detected if the TSADCC is programmed for an operating mode involving the Touch Screen. The Pen Detect generates two types of status, reported in the "TSADCC Status Register": * the bit PENCNT is set as soon as a current flows for a time over the debouncing time as defined by PENDBC and remains set until TSADCC_SR is read. * the bit NOCNT is set as soon as no current flows for a time over the debouncing time as defined by PENDBC and remains set until TSADCC_SR is read. Both bits are automatically cleared as soon as the Status Register TSADCC_SR is read, and can generate an interrupt by writing accordingly the "TSADCC Interrupt Enable Register".
43.7
Conversion Results
When a conversion is completed, the resulting 8-bit or 10-bit digital value is right-aligned and stored in the "TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5)" of the current channel and in the "TSADCC Last Converted Data Register". The channel EOC bit and the bit DRDY in the "TSADCC Status Register" are both set. If the PDC channel is enabled, DRDY rising triggers a data transfer. In any case, either EOC and DRDY can trigger an interrupt. Reading one of the "TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5)" registers clears the corresponding EOC bit. Reading "TSADCC Last Converted Data Register" clears the DRDY bit and the EOC bit corresponding to the last converted channel.
832
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 43-5. EOCx and DRDY Flag Behavior
Write the ADC_CR with START = 1 Read the ADC_CDRx Write the ADC_CR with START = 1 Read the ADC_LCDR
CHx (ADC_CHSR) EOCx (ADC_SR)
SHTIM
Conversion Time
SHTIM
Conversion Time
DRDY (ADC_SR)
If the "TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5)" is not read before further incoming data is converted, the corresponding Overrun Error (OVRE) flag is set in the "TSADCC Status Register". In the same way, new data converted when DRDY is high sets the bit GOVRE (General Overrun Error) in the "TSADCC Status Register". The OVRE and GOVRE flags are automatically cleared when the "TSADCC Status Register"is read. Figure 43-6. GOVRE and OVREx Flag Behavior
Read ADC_SR
ADTRG CH0 (ADC_CHSR) CH1 (ADC_CHSR) ADC_LCDR ADC_CDR0 ADC_CDR1 Undefined Data Undefined Data Undefined Data Data A Data A Data B
Data C
Data C Data B
EOC0 (ADC_SR)
SHTIM
Conversion SHTIM Conversion
Read ADC_CDR0
EOC1 (ADC_SR)
SHTIM
Conversion
Read ADC_CDR1
GOVRE (ADC_SR) DRDY (ADC_SR) OVRE0 (ADC_SR)
833
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled and then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE flags in TSADCC_SR are unpredictable.
834
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.8 Conversion Triggers
Conversions of the active analog channels are started with a software or a hardware trigger. The software trigger is provided by writing the "TSADCC Control Register" with the bit START at 1. The hardware trigger can be selected by the filed TRGMOD in the TSADCC Trigger Register (TSADCC_TRGR) between: * an edge, either rising or falling or any, detected on the external trigger pin TSADTRG * the Pen Detect, depending on how the PENDET bit is set in the "TSADCC Mode Register" * a continuous trigger, meaning the TSADCC restarts the next sequence as soon as it finishes the current one, in this case, only one software trigger is required at the beginning * a periodic trigger, which is defined by programming the field TRGPER in the "TSADCC Trigger Register" Enabling hardware triggers does not disable the software trigger functionality. Thus, if a hardware trigger is selected, the start of a conversion can still be initiated by the software trigger.
43.9
Operating Modes
The Touch Screen ADC Controller features several operating modes, each defining a conversion sequence: * The ADC Mode: at each trigger, all the enabled channels are converted * The Touch Screen Mode: at each trigger, the touch screen inputs are converted with the switches accordingly set and the results are processed and stored in the corresponding data registers The Operating Mode of the TSADCC is programmed in the field TSAMOD in the "TSADCC Mode Register". The conversion sequences for each Operating Mode are described in the following paragraphs. The conversion sequencer, combined with the Sleep Modes, allows automatic processing with minimum processor intervention and optimized power consumption. In any case, the sequence starts with a trigger event.
Note: The reference voltage pins always remain connected in normal mode as in sleep mode.
43.9.1
ADC Mode In the ADC Mode, the active channels are defined by the "TSADCC Channel Status Register", which is defined by writing the "TSADCC Channel Enable Register" and "TSADCC Channel Disable Register". The results are stored in the "TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5)" and in the "TSADCC Last Converted Data Register", so that data transfers by using the PDC are possible. At each trigger, the following sequence is performed: 4. If SLEEP is set, wake up the ADC cell and wait for the Startup Time. 5. If Channel 0 is enabled, convert Channel 0 and store result in both TSADCC_CDR0 and TSADCC_LCDR. 6. If Channel 1 is enabled, convert Channel 1 and store result in both TSADCC_CDR1 and TSADCC_LCDR.
835
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
7. If Channel 2 is enabled, convert Channel 2 and store result in both TSADCC_CDR2 and TSADCC_LCDR. 8. If Channel 3 is enabled, convert Channel 3 and store result in both TSADCC_CDR3 and TSADCC_LCDR. 9. If Channel 4 to Channel 5 are enabled, convert the Channels and store result in the corresponding TSADCC_CDRx and TSADCC_LCDR. 10. If SLEEP is set, sleep down the ADC cell. If the PDC is enabled, all the converted data are transferred contiguously in the memory buffer. The bit LOWRES defines which resolution is used, either 8-bit or 10-bit, and thus the width of the PDC memory buffer. 43.9.2 Touch Screen Mode Writing TSAMOD to "Touch Screen Only Mode" automatically enables the touch screen pins as analog inputs, and thus disables the digital function of the corresponding pins. In Touch Screen Mode, the channels 0 to 3 corresponding to the Touch Screen inputs are automatically activated and the bits CH0 to CH3 are automatically set in the "TSADCC Channel Status Register". The remaining channels can be either enabled or disabled by the user and their conversions are performed at the end of each touch screen sequence. The resolution is forced to 10 bits, regardless of the LOWRES bit setting. At each trigger, the following sequence is performed: 1. If SLEEP is set, wake up the ADC cell and wait for the Startup Time. 2. Close the switches on the inputs XP and XM during the Sample and Hold Time. 3. Convert Channel XM and store the result in TSADCC_CDR1. 4. Close the switches on the inputs XP and XM during the Sample and Hold Time. 5. Convert Channel XP, subtract TSADCC_CDR1 from the result and store the subtraction result in both TSADCC_CDR0 and TSADCC_LCDR. 6. Close the switches on the inputs XP and XM during the Sample and Hold Time. 7. Convert Channel YP, subtract TSADCC_CDR1 from the result and store the subtraction result in both TSADCC_CDR1 and TSADCC_LCDR. 8. Close the switches on the inputs YP and YM during the Sample and Hold Time. 9. Convert Channel YM and store the result in TSADCC_CDR3. 10. Close the switches on the inputs YP and YM during the Sample and Hold Time. 11. Convert Channel YP, subtract TSADCC_CDR3 from the result and store the subtraction result in both TSADCC_CDR2 and TSADCC_LCDR. 12. Close the switches on the inputs YP and YM during the Sample and Hold Time. 13. Convert Channel XP, subtract TSADCC_CDR3 from the result and store the subtraction result in both TSADCC_CDR3 and TSADCC_LCDR. 14. If Channel 4 to Channel 5 are enabled, convert the Channels and store result in the corresponding TSADCC_CDRx and TSADCC_LCDR. 15. If SLEEP is set, sleep down the ADC cell. The resulting buffer is 16 bits wide and its structure stored in memory is: 1. XP - XM 2. YP - XM
836
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
3. YP - YM 4. XP - YM 5. AD4 to AD5 if enabled. The vertical position can be easily calculated by dividing the data at offset 0 (XP - XM) by the data at offset 1 (YP - XM). The horizontal position can be easily calculated by dividing the data at offset 2 (YP - YM) by the data at offset 3 (XP - YM).
837
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10 Touch Screen ADC Controller (TSADCC) User Interface
Table 43-2.
Offset 0x00 0x04 0x08 0x0C 0x10 0x14 0x18 0x1C 0x20 0x24 0x28 0x2C 0x30 0x34 0x38 0x3C 0x40 0x44 0x48 - 0xFC
Register Mapping
Register Control Register Mode Register Trigger Register Touch Screen Register Channel Enable Register Channel Disable Register Channel Status Register Status Register Last Converted Data Register Interrupt Enable Register Interrupt Disable Register Interrupt Mask Register Channel Data Register 0 Channel Data Register 1 Channel Data Register 2 Channel Data Register 3 Channel Data Register 4 Channel Data Register 5 Reserved Name TSADCC_CR TSADCC_MR TSADCC_TRGR TSADCC_TSR TSADCC_CHER TSADCC_CHDR TSADCC_CHSR TSADCC_SR TSADCC_LCDR TSADCC_IER TSADCC_IDR TSADCC_IMR TSADCC_CDR0 TSADCC_CDR1 TSADCC_CDR2 TSADCC_CDR3 TSADCC_CDR4 TSADCC_CDR5 - Access Write-only Read-write Read-write Read-write Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Write-only Write-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only Read-only - Reset - 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 - - 0x0000_0000 0x000C_0000 0x0000_0000 - - 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 0x0000_0000 -
838
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.1 TSADCC Control Register Register Name: TSADCC_CR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
START
SWRST
* SWRST: Software Reset 0 = No effect. 1 = Resets the TSADCC simulating a hardware reset. * START: Start Conversion 0 = No effect. 1 = Begins analog-to-digital conversion.
839
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.2 TSADCC Mode Register Register Name: TSADCC_MR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
PENDBC
23 22 21 20 19 18
SHTIM
17 16
-
15 14 13 12
STARTUP
11 10 9 8
-
7
-
6 5 4 3
PRESCAL
2 1 0
-
PENDET
SLEEP
LOWRES
-
-
TSAMOD
* TSAMOD: Touch Screen ADC Mode
TSAMOD 0 1 2 3 Touch Screen ADC Operating Mode ADC Mode Touch Screen Only Mode Reserved Reserved
* LOWRES: Resolution Selection
LOWRES 0 1 Selected Resolution 10-bit resolution 8-bit resolution
This option is only valid in ADC mode. * SLEEP: Sleep Mode
SLEEP 0 1 Selected Mode Normal Mode Sleep Mode
* PRESCAL: Prescaler Rate Selection ADCCLK = MCK / ( (PRESCAL+1) * 2 ) * PENDET: Pen Detect Selection 0: Disable the Touch screen pins as analog inputs 1: enable the Touch screen pins as analog inputs * STARTUP: Start Up Time Startup Time = (STARTUP+1) * 8 / ADCCLK * SHTIM: Sample & Hold Time for ADC Channels
840
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Programming 0 for SHTIM gives a Sample & Hold Time equal to (2/ADCCLK). Sample & Hold Time = (SHTIM+1) / ADCCLK * PENDBC: Pen Detect debouncing period Period = 2PENDBC/ADCCLK
841
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.3 TSADCC Trigger Register Register Name: TSADCC_TRGR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
TRGPER
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16
TRGPER
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
TRGMOD
* TRGMOD: Trigger Mode
TRGMOD 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Selected Trigger Mode No trigger, only software trigger can start conversions External Trigger Rising Edge External Trigger Falling Edge External Trigger Any Edge Pen Detect Trigger (shall be selected only if PENDET is set and TSAMOD = Touch Screen only mode) Periodic Trigger (TRGPER shall be initiated appropriately) Continuous Mode Reserved
* TRGPER: Trigger Period Effective only if TRGMOD defines a Periodic Trigger Defines the periodic trigger period, with the following equations: Trigger Period = (TRGPER+1) / ADCCLK
842
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.4 TSADCC Touch Screen Register Register Name: TSADCC_TSR Access Type:
31
Read/Write
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20 19 18
TSSHTIM
17 16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
* TSSHTIM: Sample & Hold Time for Touch Screen Channels Programming 0 for TSSHTIM gives a Touch Screen Sample & Hold Time equal to (2/ADCCLK). Touch Screen Sample & Hold Time = (TSSHTIM+1) / ADCCLK
43.10.5 TSADCC Channel Enable Register Register Name: TSADCC_CHER Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
CH0
* CHx: Channel x Enable 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding channel.
843
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.6 TSADCC Channel Disable Register Register Name: TSADCC_CHDR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
CH0
* CHx: Channel x Disable 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding channel. Warning: If the corresponding channel is disabled during a conversion or if it is disabled then reenabled during a conversion, its associated data and its corresponding EOC and OVRE flags in TSADCC_SR are unpredictable.
844
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.7 TSADCC Channel Status Register Register Name: TSADCC_CHSR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
CH0
* CHx: Channel x Status 0 = Corresponding channel is disabled. 1 = Corresponding channel is enabled.
845
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.8 TSADCC Status Register Register Name: TSADCC_SR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
NOCNT
13
PENCNT
12
RXBUFF
11
ENDRX
10
GOVRE
9
DRDY
8
-
7
-
6
OVRE5
5
OVRE4
4
OVRE3
3
OVRE2
2
OVRE1
1
OVRE0
0
-
-
EOC5
EOC4
EOC3
EOC2
EOC1
EOC0
* EOCx: End of Conversion x 0 = Corresponding analog channel is disabled, or the conversion is not finished. 1 = Corresponding analog channel is enabled and conversion is complete. * OVREx: Overrun Error x 0 = No overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of TSADCC_SR. 1 = There has been an overrun error on the corresponding channel since the last read of TSADCC_SR. * DRDY: Data Ready 0 = No data has been converted since the last read of TSADCC_LCDR. 1 = At least one data has been converted and is available in TSADCC_LCDR. * GOVRE: General Overrun Error 0 = No General Overrun Error occurred since the last read of TSADCC_SR. 1 = At least one General Overrun Error has occurred since the last read of TSADCC_SR. * ENDRX: End of RX Buffer 0 = The Receive Counter Register has not reached 0 since the last write in TSADCC_RCR or TSADCC_RNCR. 1 = The Receive Counter Register has reached 0 since the last write in TSADCC_RCR or TSADCC_RNCR. * RXBUFF: RX Buffer Full 0 = TSADCC_RCR or TSADCC_RNCR have a value other than 0. 1 = Both TSADCC_RCR and TSADCC_RNCR have a value of 0. * PENCNT: Pen Contact 0 = No contact has been detected since the last read of TSADCC_SR or PENDET is at 0. 1 = At least one contact has been detected since the last read of TSADCC_SR. * NOCNT: No Contact 0 = No contact loss has been detected since the last read of TSADCC_SR or PENDET is at 0. 1 = At least one contact loss has been detected since the last read of TSADCC_SR.
846
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.9 TSADCC Channel Data Register x (x = 0..5) Register Name: TSADCC_CDR0..TSADCC_CDR5 Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2 1
DATA
0
DATA
* DATA: Channel Data The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion of the corresponding channel and remains until a new conversion on the same channel is completed.
847
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.10 TSADCC Last Converted Data Register Register Name: TSADCC_LCDR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
-
13
-
12
-
11
-
10
-
9
-
8
-
7
-
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2 1
LDATA
0
LDATA
* LDATA: Last Data Converted The analog-to-digital conversion data is placed into this register at the end of a conversion on any analog channel and remains until a new conversion on any analog channel is completed.
43.10.11 TSADCC Interrupt Enable Register Register Name: TSADCC_IER Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
NOCNT
13
PENCNT
12
RXBUFF
11
ENDRX
10
GOVRE
9
DRDY
8
-
7
-
6
OVRE5
5
OVRE4
4
OVRE3
3
OVRE2
2
OVRE1
1
OVRE0
0
-
-
EOC5
EOC4
EOC3
EOC2
EOC1
EOC0
* EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Enable x * OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Enable x * DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Enable * GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Enable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Enable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Enable * PENCNT: Pen Contact * NOCNT: No Contact 0 = No effect. 1 = Enables the corresponding interrupt.
848
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.12 TSADCC Interrupt Disable Register Register Name: TSADCC_IDR Access Type:
31
Write-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
NOCNT
13
PENCNT
12
RXBUFF
11
ENDRX
10
GOVRE
9
DRDY
8
-
7
-
6
OVRE5
5
OVRE4
4
OVRE3
3
OVRE2
2
OVRE1
1
OVRE0
0
-
-
EOC5
EOC4
EOC3
EOC2
EOC1
EOC0
* EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Disable x * OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Disable x * DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Disable * GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Disable * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Disable * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Disable * PENCNT: Pen Contact * NOCNT: No Contact 0 = No effect. 1 = Disables the corresponding interrupt.
849
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
43.10.13 TSADCC Interrupt Mask Register Register Name: TSADCC_IMR Access Type:
31
Read-only
30 29 28 27 26 25 24
-
23
-
22
-
21
-
20
-
19
-
18
-
17
-
16
-
15
-
14
NOCNT
13
PENCNT
12
RXBUFF
11
ENDRX
10
GOVRE
9
DRDY
8
-
7
-
6
OVRE5
5
OVRE4
4
OVRE3
3
OVRE2
2
OVRE1
1
OVRE0
0
-
-
EOC5
EOC4
EOC3
EOC2
EOC1
EOC0
* EOCx: End of Conversion Interrupt Mask x * OVREx: Overrun Error Interrupt Mask x * DRDY: Data Ready Interrupt Mask * GOVRE: General Overrun Error Interrupt Mask * ENDRX: End of Receive Buffer Interrupt Mask * RXBUFF: Receive Buffer Full Interrupt Mask * PENCNT: Pen Contact * NOCNT: No Contact 0 = The corresponding interrupt is disabled. 1 = The corresponding interrupt is enabled.
850
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
44. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Electrical Characteristics
44.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Absolute Maximum Ratings
*NOTICE: Stresses beyond those listed under "Absolute Maximum Ratings" may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
Table 44-1.
Operating Temperature (Industrial)...............-40 C to +85C Storage Temperature .................................. -60C to +150C Voltage on Input Pins with Respect to Ground ................................. -0.3V to +4.0V Maximum Operating Voltage (VDDCORE and VDDBU).............................................. 1.5V Maximum Operating Voltage (VDDOSC, VDDPLL, VDDIOMx and VDDIOPx)............ 4.0V Total DC Output Current on all I/O lines ................... 500 mA
44.2
DC Characteristics
The following characteristics are applicable to the operating temperature range: TA = -40C to 85C, unless otherwise specified. Table 44-2.
Symbol VVDDCORE VVDDBU VVDDPLLA VVDDPLLB VVDDPLLB IVDDPLLB VVDDIOM VVDDIOP VVDDUTMII VVDDUTMIC VVDDANA
DC Characteristics
Parameter DC Supply Core DC Supply Backup DC Supply PLLA DC Supply PLLB Ripple on VVDDPLLB Current Supply DC Supply Memory I/Os DC Supply Peripheral I/Os USB UTMI+ Interface Power Supply USB UTMI+ Core Power Supply ADC Analog Power Supply Input Low-level Voltage VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V rms value, from 10k Hz to 10 MHz Normal operating mode 1.65 Selectable by software in Bus Matrix 3.0 3.0 3.0 1.08 3.0 -0.3 -0.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 1.2 3.3 3.6 3.6 3.6 1.32 3.6 0.8 0.3 x VVDDIO V V V V V V V 1.8 Conditions Min 1.08 1.08 3.0 1.08 Typ 1.2 1.2 3.3 1.2 Max 1.32 1.32 3.6 1.32 10 30 1.95 Units V V V V mV mA V
VIL
851
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 44-2.
Symbol
DC Characteristics (Continued)
Parameter Conditions VVDDIO = VVDDIOM or VVDDIOP from 3.0V to 3.6V VVDDIO = VVDDIOM or VVDDIOP from 1.65V to 1.95V IO Max, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V Min 2.0 0.7 x VVDDIO Typ Max VVDDIO +0.3V VVDDIO +0.3V 0.4 0.1 0.4 VVDDIO 0.4 VVDDIO 0.1 VVDDIO 0.4 70 100 175 8 250 450 A TA =85C TA =25C TA =85C 4 4000 5 A 30 kOhm mA Units V V V V V V V
VIH
Input High-level Voltage
VOL
Output Low-level Voltage
CMOS (IO <0.3 mA) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V TTL (IO Max) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V IO Max, VVDDIO from 3.0V to 3.6V
VOH
Output High-level Voltage
CMOS (IO <0.3 mA) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V TTL (IO Max) VVDDIO from 1.65V to 1.95V
RPULLUP IO
Pull-up Resistance Output Current
PA0-PA31, PB0-PB31, PC0-PC31, PD0-PD21 PA0-PA31, PB0-PB31, PC0-PC31, PD0-PD21 On VVDDCORE = 1.2V, MCK = 0 Hz, excluding POR All inputs driven TMS, TDI, TCK, NRST = 1 On VVDDBU = 1.2V, Logic cells consumption, excluding POR All inputs driven WKUP = 0 TA =25C
ISC
Static Current
44.3
Power Consumption
* Typical power consumption of PLLs, Slow Clock and Main Oscillator. * Power consumption of power supply in four different modes: Active, Idle, Ultra Low-power and Backup. * Power consumption by peripheral: calculated as the difference in current measurement after having enabled then disabled the corresponding clock.
44.3.1
Power Consumption versus Modes The values in Table 44-3 and Table 44-4 on page 853 are measured values of the power consumption with operating conditions as follows: * VDDIOM = VDDIOP = 3.3 V * VDDPLLA = 3.3V * VDDCORE = VDDBU = VDDPLLB = 1.2V * VDDANA = 3.3V * There is no consumption on the I/Os of the device
852
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 44-1. Measures Schematics
VDDBU AMP1 VDDCORE AMP2
These figures represent the power consumption measured on the power supplies. Table 44-3.
Mode
Power Consumption for Different Modes
Conditions ARM Core clock is 200MHz. MCK is 100MHz. All peripheral clocks de-activated. Icache enabled. on AMP2 Idle state, waiting an interrupt. All peripheral clocks de-activated. on AMP2 ARM Core clock is 500 Hz. All peripheral clocks de-activated. on AMP2 Device only VDDBU powered on AMP1 Consumption Unit
Active
47
mA
Idle
12
mA
Ultra low power
175 4
A A
Backup
Table 44-4.
Peripheral PIO Controller USART UDPHS on AMP2 TWI SPI MCI SSC
Power Consumption by Peripheral in Active Mode on VDDCORE
Consumption 5.5 12 44 6 8.5 15.5 14 4 6.5 45 7.5 11.5 A/MHz Unit
Timer Counter Channels PWMC LCDC ADC/TSC AC97
853
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.4
Crystal Oscillator Characteristics
The following characteristics are applicable to the operating temperature range: TA = -40C to 85C and worst case of power supply, unless otherwise specified. 44.4.1 32 kHz Oscillator Characteristics 32 kHz Oscillator Characteristics
Parameter Crystal Oscillator Frequency Crystal Load Capacitance External Load Capacitance Duty Cycle RS = 50 k, CL = 6pF tST Startup Time
(1) (1)
Table 44-5.
Symbol 1/(tCP32KHz) CCRYSTAL32 CLEXT32 (2)
Conditions
Min
Typ 32.768
Max
Unit kHz
Crystal @ 32.768 kHz CCRYSTAL32 = 6pF
(3)
6 4 17 40
12.5 pF
CCRYSTAL32 = 12.5pF(3)
60 400 900
%
RS = 50 k, CL = 12.5 pF RS = 100 k, CL = 6pF(1)
ms 600 1200 0.65 1.6 1.8 A 1 1.2 2.2 2.4
RS = 100 k, CL = 12.5 pF(1) RS = 50 k, CL = 6pF IDD ON Current Dissipation
(1) (1)
RS = 50 k, CL = 12.5 pF RS = 100 k, CL = 6pF(1)
0.85
RS = 100 k, CL = 12.5 pF(1) Notes:
1. RS is the equivalent series resistance, CL is the equivalent load capacitance. 2. CLEXT32 is determined by taking into account internal parasitic and package load capacitance. 3. Additional user load capacitance should be subtracted from CLEXT32.
AT91SAM9RL
XIN32 CCRYSTAL32
XOUT32
CLEXT32
CLEXT32
Table 44-6.
Symbol ESR CM CS
32 kHz Crystal Characteristics
Parameter Equivalent Series Resistor Rs Motional Capacitance Shunt Capacitance Conditions Crystal @ 32.768 kHz Crystal @ 32.768 kHz Crystal @ 32.768 kHz 0.6 0.6 Min Typ 50 Max 100 3 2 Unit k fF pF
854
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
44.4.2 RC Oscillator Characteristics RC Oscillator Characteristics
Parameter Crystal Oscillator Frequency Duty Cycle tST IDD Startup Time Current Consumption After Startup Time 0.7 Conditions Min 20 45 Typ 32 50 Max 44 55 75 1.0 Unit kHz % s A
Table 44-7.
Symbol 1/(tCPRCz)
44.4.3
12 MHz Main Oscillator Characteristics Main Oscillator Characteristics
Parameter Crystal Oscillator Frequency Crystal Load Capacitance External Load Capacitance Duty Cycle CCRYSTAL = 15 pF(1) CCRYSTAL = 20 pF
(1)
Table 44-8.
Symbol 1/(tCPMAIN) CCRYSTAL CLEXT
Conditions
Min 8 15
Typ 12
Max 16 20
Unit MHz pF pF
24 34 40 50 60 2 % ms A W A W/MHz
tST IDDST PON IDD ON IBYPASS Notes:
Startup Time Standby Current Consumption Drive Level Current Dissipation Bypass Current Dissipation 1. Additional user load capacitance should be subtracted from CLEXT. @ 12MHz 550 3.3 Standby mode
1 150 950 5
AT91SAM9RL
XIN
XOUT
CLEXT
CCRYSTAL
CLEXT
855
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.4.4
XIN Clock Characteristics XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics
Parameter XIN Clock Frequency XIN Clock Period XIN Clock High Half-period XIN Clock Low Half-period XIN Input Capacitance XIN Pulldown Resistor XIN Voltage XIN32 Voltage
(1) (1) (1) (2)
Table 44-9.
Symbol 1/(tCPXIN) tCPXIN tCHXIN tCLXIN CIN RIN VIN VIN32 Note:
Conditions
Min
Max 50.0
Units MHz ns
20.0 0.4 x tCPXIN 0.4 x tCPXIN 0.6 x tCPXIN 0.6 x tCPXIN 25 500 1.2 1.2
pF k V V
1. These characteristics apply only when the Main Oscillator is in bypass mode (i.e., when MOSCEN = 0 and OSCBYPASS = 1 in the CKGR_MOR register). 2. These characteristics apply only when the 32K Oscillator is in bypass mode.
44.4.5
Crystal Characteristics
Table 44-10. Crystal Characteristics
Symbol ESR CM CS Parameter Equivalent Series Resistor Rs Motional Capacitance Shunt Capacitance 5 Conditions Min Typ Max 80 9 7 Unit fF pF
44.4.6
PLLA Characteristics
Table 44-11. Phase Lock Loop Characteristics(1)
Symbol FIN FOUT Parameter Input Frequency Field OUT of CKGR_PLL is 00 Output Frequency Field OUT of CKGR_PLL is 10 active mode IPLL Current Consumption standby mode 1. Startup time depends on PLL RC filter. A calculation tool is provided by Atmel. 1 A 190 240 3 MHz mA Conditions Min 1 80 Typ Max 32 200 Unit MHz MHz
Note:
856
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
44.4.7 UTMI PLL Characteristics
Table 44-12. Phase Lock Loop Characteristics
Symbol FIN FOUT IPLL Parameter Input Frequency Output Frequency active mode Current Consumption standby mode TBD A Conditions Min 4 450 Typ 12 480 5 Max 32 600 8 Unit MHz MHz mA
44.5
44.5.1
USB HS Characteristics
Electrical Characteristics
Table 44-13. Electrical Parameters
Symbol RPUI Parameter Bus Pull-up Resistor on Upstream Port (idle bus) Bus Pull-up Resistor on Upstream Port (upstream port receiving) Conditions in LS or FS Mode Min Typ 1.5 Max Unit kOhm
RPUA Settling time TBIAS TOSC TSETTLING
in LS or FS Mode
15
kOhm
Bias settling time Oscillator settling time Settling time With 12 MHz crystal FIN = 12 MHz 0.3
20 2 0.5
s ms ms
44.5.2
Static Power Consumption
Table 44-14. Static Power Consumption
Symbol IBIAS Parameter Bias current consumption on VBG HS Transceiver and I/O current consumption IVDDUTMII LS / FS Transceiver and I/O current consumption Core, PLL, and Oscillator current consumption no connection(1) Conditions Min Typ Max 1 8 3 2 Unit A A A A
IVDDUTMIC Note:
1. If cable is connected, add 200 A (Typical) due to Pull-up/Pull-down current consumption.
857
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.5.3
Dynamic Power Consumption
Table 44-15. Dynamic Power Consumption
Symbol IBIAS Parameter Bias current consumption on VBG HS Transceiver current consumption HS Transceiver current consumption IVDDUTMII LS / FS Transceiver current consumption LS / FS Transceiver current consumption LS / FS Transceiver current consumption IVDDUTMIC Note: PLL, Core and Oscillator current consumption HS transmission HS reception FS transmission 0m cable(1) FS transmission 5m cable(1) FS reception(1) Conditions Min Typ 0.7 47 18 4 26 3 5.5 Max 0.8 60 27 6 30 4.5 9 Unit mA mA mA mA mA mA mA
1. Including 1 mA due to Pull-up/Pull-down current consumption.
44.6
ADC
Table 44-16. Channel Conversion Time and ADC Clock
Parameter ADC Clock Frequency Startup Time Track and Hold Acquisition Time Conversion Time Throughput Rate Note: Conditions 10-bit resolution mode Return from Idle Mode ADC Clock = 4 MHz ADC Clock = 4 MHz
(1) (1) (1)
Min
Typ
Max 4 40
Units MHz s s
1.0 3.33 220
s kSPS
ADC Clock = 4 MHz
1. In worst case, the Track-and-Hold Acquisition Time is given by:
TTH (ns) = 500 + ( 0.08 x Z IN ) ( Ohm )
The full speed is obtained for tTH = 1000 ns with an input source impedance of 6250Ohm max, corresponding to 8 clock periods at maximum clock frequency. To achieve optimal performance of the ADC, the analog power supply VDDANA and the ADVREF input voltage must be decoupled with a 4.7F capacitor in parallel with a 100 nF capacitor.
Table 44-17. External Voltage Reference Input
Parameter ADVREF Input Voltage Range ADVREF Average Current Current Consumption on VDDANA Conditions Min 2.6 Typ 3.3 Max VDDANA 1100 200 Units V A A
858
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 44-18. Analog Inputs
Parameter Input Voltage Range Input Leakage Current Input Capacitance Input Impedance 4 50 Min 0 Typ Max ADVREF 1 6 6250 Units V A pF Ohm
Table 44-19. Transfer Characteristics
Parameter Resolution Integral Non-linearity Differential Non-linearity Offset Error Gain Error Note: No missing code -1.5 -2 0.5 Conditions Min Typ 10 2 0.9 +2.5 +2.5 Max Units bit LSB LSB LSB LSB
1. For more information on data converter terminology, refer to the Atmel application note Data Converter Terminology, lit. no. 6022.
44.7
44.7.1
Power Supply Characteristics
POR Characteristics
Table 44-20. Power-On-Reset Characteristics
Symbol VTH+ VTHTRES Parameter Threshold Voltage Rising Threshold Voltage Falling Reset Time Conditions Minimum Slope of +2.0V/30ms Min 0.70 0.60 80 Typ 0.85 0.80 150 Max 1.08 1.00 230 Units V V s
VDDCORE and VDDBU are controlled by internal POR (Power On Reset) to guarantee that these power sources reach their target values prior to the release of POR. 44.7.2 Power Sequence Requirements Switch on the VDDIOM and VDDIOP power supply prior to or at the same time as VDDCORE. The AT91SAM9RL64 board design must comply with this sequence to guarantee reliable operation of the device. Any deviation from this sequence may prevent the device from booting.
859
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.8
44.8.1
Timings
Corner Definition
Table 44-21. Corner Definition
Corner MAX STH MIN Process Slow Slow Fast Temp (External) 85 C 85 C -40 C VDDCORE: 1.2V 1.10 1.2 1.32 VDDIO: 1.8V 1.65 1.8 1.95 VDDIO: 3.3V 3.0 3.3 3.6
44.8.2
Processor Clock
Table 44-22. Processor Clock Waveform Parameters
Symbol 1/(tCPPCK) 1/(tCPPCK) Parameter Processor Clock Frequency Processor Clock Frequency Conditions MAX corner STH corner Min Max 200 240 Units MHz MHz
44.8.3
Master Clock
Table 44-23. Master Clock Waveform Parameters
Symbol 1/(tCPMCK) 1/(tCPMCK) Parameter Master Clock Frequency Master Clock Frequency Conditions MAX corner STH corner Min Max 100 120 Units MHz MHz
44.8.4
I/Os Criteria used to define the maximum frequency of the I/Os: * output duty cycle (40%-60%) * minimum output swing: 100 mV to VDDIO - 100 mV * Addition of rising and falling time inferior to 75% of the period
Table 44-24. I/O Characteristics
Symbol FreqMax Note: Parameter VDDIOP powered pins frequency Conditions 3.3V domain (1) Min Max 73 Units MHz
1. 3.3V domain: VVDDIOP from 3.0V to 3.6V, maximum external capacitor = 40 pF.
860
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
44.8.5 SMC SMC timings are given in MAX (T = 85C, VDDCORE = 1.08V) and STH (T = 85C, VDDCORE = 1.2V) corners. Timings are given assuming a capacitance load on data, control and address pads: Table 44-25. Capacitance Load
Corner IO Supply 3.3V 1.8V MAX 50 pF 30 pF STH 50 pF 30 pF
In following tables tCPMCK is MCK period. 44.8.5.1 Read Timings
Table 44-26. SMC Read Signals - NRD Controlled (READ_MODE = 1)
Symbol Parameter VDDIOM supply Min in STH corner 1.8V 3.3V Min in MAX corner 1.8V 3.3V Units
NO HOLD SETTINGS (nrd hold = 0) SMC1 SMC2 SMC3 SMC4 Data Setup before NRD High Data Hold after NRD High 10.9 0 10.1 0 12.1 0 11.4 0 ns ns
HOLD SETTINGS (nrd hold 0) Data Setup before NRD High Data Hold after NRD High 8.8 0 8.0 0 9.6 0 8.8 0 ns ns
HOLD or NO HOLD SETTINGS (nrd hold 0, nrd hold =0) SMC5 NBS0/A0, NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25 Valid before NRD High (nrd setup + nrd pulse)* tCPMCK - 1.9 (nrd setup + nrd pulse - ncs rd setup) * tCPMCK - 1.6 nrd pulse * tCPMCK - 0.2 (nrd setup + nrd pulse)* tCPMCK - 1.9 (nrd setup + nrd pulse - ncs rd setup) * tCPMCK - 3.2 nrd pulse * tCPMCK - 0.3 (nrd setup + nrd pulse)* tCPMCK - 2.3 (nrd setup + nrd pulse - ncs rd setup) * tCPMCK - 2.2 nrd pulse * tCPMCK - 0.3 (nrd setup + nrd pulse)* tCPMCK - 2.3 (nrd setup + nrd pulse - ncs rd setup) * tCPMCK - 3.6 nrd pulse * tCPMCK - 0.4 ns
SMC6
NCS low before NRD High
ns
SMC7
NRD Pulse Width
ns
Table 44-27. SMC Read Signals - NCS Controlled (Read_MODE = 0)
Symbol Parameter VDDIOM supply Min in STH corner 1.8V 3.3V Min in MAX corner 1.8V 3.3V Units
NO HOLD SETTINGS (ncs rd hold = 0) SMC8 SMC9 Data Setup before NCS High Data Hold after NCS High 11.2 0 10.4 0 12.5 0 12.6 0 ns ns
861
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 44-27. SMC Read Signals - NCS Controlled (Read_MODE = 0) (Continued)
Symbol Parameter VDDIOM supply Min in STH corner 1.8V 3.3V HOLD SETTINGS (ncs rd hold 0) SMC10 SMC11 Data Setup before NCS High Data Hold after NCS High 9.1 0 8.4 0 9.8 0 10.0 0 ns ns Min in MAX corner 1.8V 3.3V Units
HOLD or NO HOLD SETTINGS (ncs rd hold 0, ncs rd hold = 0) NBS0/A0, NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25 valid before NCS High (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse)* tCPMCK - 5.0 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse - nrd setup)* tCPMCK - 2.8 ncs rd pulse length * tCPMCK - 1.0 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse)* tCPMCK - 4.8 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse nrd setup)* tCPMCK - 2.6 ncs rd pulse length * tCPMCK - 1.0 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse)* tCPMCK - 5.1 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse nrd setup)* tCPMCK - 2.4 ncs rd pulse length * tCPMCK - 1.1 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse)* tCPMCK - 4.8 (ncs rd setup + ncs rd pulse nrd setup)* tCPMCK - 2.1 ncs rd pulse length * tCPMCK - 1.1
SMC12
ns
SMC13
NRD low before NCS High
ns
SMC14
NCS Pulse Width
ns
44.8.5.2
Write Timings
Table 44-28. SMC Write Signals - NWE controlled (WRITE_MODE = 1)
Min in STH corner Symbol Parameter 1.8V Supply 3.3V Supply Min in MAX corner 1.8V Supply 3.3V Supply Units
HOLD or NO HOLD SETTINGS (nwe hold 0, nwe hold = 0) SMC15 SMC16 SMC17 Data Out Valid before NWE High NWE Pulse Width NBS0/A0 NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25 valid before NWE low nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 1.8 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 0.3 nwe setup * tCPMCK - 2.2 (nwe setup ncs rd setup + nwe pulse) * tCPMCK - 1.8 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 2.9 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 0.3 nwe setup * tCPMCK - 3.8 (nwe setup ncs rd setup + nwe pulse) * tCPMCK - 3.4 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 2.2 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 0.4 nwe setup * tCPMCK - 2.9 (nwe setup ncs rd setup + nwe pulse) * tCPMCK - 2.5 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 3.4 nwe pulse * tCPMCK - 9.9 nwe setup * tCPMCK - 4.4 (nwe setup ncs rd setup + nwe pulse) * tCPMCK - 3.9 ns ns ns
SMC18
NCS low before NWE high
ns
HOLD SETTINGS (nwe hold 0) SMC19 NWE High to Data OUT, NBS0/A0 NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25 change NWE High to NCS Inactive (1) nwe hold * tCPMCK - 3.7 (nwe hold - ncs wr hold)* tCPMCK - 3.3 nwe hold * tCPMCK - 3.4 (nwe hold - ncs wr hold)* tCPMCK - 3.1 nwe hold * tCPMCK - 3.5 (nwe hold ncs wr hold)* tCPMCK - 3.0 nwe hold * tCPMCK - 3.2 (nwe hold ncs wr hold)* tCPMCK - 2.8 ns
SMC20
ns
NO HOLD SETTINGS (nwe hold = 0) SMC21 NWE High to Data OUT, NBS0/A0 NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25, NCS change(1) 5.7 7.9 5.8 7.2 ns
Note:
1. hold length = total cycle duration - setup duration - pulse duration. "hold length" is for "ncs wr hold length" or "NWE hold length".
862
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 44-29. SMC Write NCS Controlled (WRITE_MODE = 0)
Min in STH corner Symbol SMC22 SMC23 SMC24 Parameter Data Out Valid before NCS High NCS Pulse Width NBS0/A0 NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25 valid before NCS low 1.8V Supply ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 4.6 ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 4.6 ncs wr setup * tCPMCK - 2.3 (ncs wr setup nwe setup + ncs pulse)* tCPMCK - 3.1 ncs wr hold * tCPMCK - 3.7 (ncs wr hold nwe hold)* tCPMCK - 0.5 3.3V Supply ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 5.5 ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 6.0 ncs wr setup * tCPMCK - 2.3 (ncs wr setup nwe setup + ncs pulse)* tCPMCK - 2.8 ncs wr hold * tCPMCK - 3.5 (ncs wr hold nwe hold)* tCPMCK - 0.6 Min in MAX corner 1.8V Supply ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 4.6 ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 4.9 ncs wr setup * tCPMCK - 2.8 (ncs wr setup nwe setup + ncs pulse)* tCPMCK - 2.8 ncs wr hold * tCPMCK - 3.6 (ncs wr hold nwe hold)* tCPMCK - 0.7 3.3V Supply ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 5.6 ncs wr pulse * tCPMCK - 6.2 ncs wr setup * tCPMCK - 2.8 (ncs wr setup nwe setup + ncs pulse)* tCPMCK - 2.5 ncs wr hold * tCPMCK - 4.1 (ncs wr hold nwe hold)* tCPMCK - 1.5 Units ns ns ns
SMC25
NWE low before NCS high
ns
SMC26
NCS High to Data Out, NBS0/A0, NBS1, NBS2/A1, NBS3, A2 - A25, change NCS High to NWE Inactive
ns
SMC27
ns
Figure 44-2. SMC Timings - NCS Controlled Read and Write
SMC12
SMC12
SMC24
SMC26
A0/A1/NBS[3:0]/A2-A25
SMC13
SMC13
NRD
NCS
SMC14 SMC9
SMC14
SMC23
SMC8
SMC10
SMC11
SMC22
SMC26
D0 - D15
SMC25 SMC27
NWE
NCS Controlled READ with NO HOLD
NCS Controlled READ with HOLD
NCS Controlled WRITE
863
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 44-3. SMC Timings - NRD Controlled Read and NWE Controlled Write
SMC5 SMC17 SMC21 SMC5 SMC17 SMC19
A0/A1/NBS[3:0]/A2-A25
SMC6 SMC18 SMC21 SMC6 SMC18 SMC20
NCS
NRD
SMC7
SMC7
SMC1
SMC2
SMC15
SMC21
SMC3
SMC4
SMC15
SMC19
D0 - D31
NWE
SMC16
SMC16
NRD Controlled READ with NO HOLD
NWE Controlled WRITE with NO HOLD
NRD Controlled READ with HOLD
NWE Controlled WRITE with HOLD
44.8.6
SDRAMC Timings are given assuming a capacitance load on data, control and address pads: Table 44-30. Capacitance Load on Data, Control and Address Pads
Corner IO Supply 3.3V 1.8V MAX 50 pF 30 pF STH 50 pF 30 pF
Table 44-31. Capacitance Load on SDCK Pad
Corner IO Supply 3.3V 1.8V MAX 10 pF 10 pF STH 10 pF 10 pF
The SDRAM Controller satisfies the timings of standard PC100, PC133 (3.3V supply) and Mobile SDRAM (1.8V supply) which are given in Table 44-32, Table 44-33 and Table 44-34. Table 44-32. SDRAM PC100 Characteristics
Min Parameter SDRAM Controller Clock Frequency Control/Address/Data In Setup
(1)(2)
Max 3.3V Supply 100 Units MHz ns ns 6 ns ns
3.3V Supply
2 1
Control/Address/Data In Hold(1)(2) Data Out Access time after SDCK rising Data Out change time after SDCK rising
3
864
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 44-33. SDRAM PC133 Characteristics
Min Parameter SDRAM Controller Clock Frequency Control/Address/Data In Setup(1)(2) Control/Address/Data In Hold
(1)(2)
Max 3.3V Supply
(4)
3.3V Supply
Units MHz ns ns
133
1.5 0.8 5.4 3.0
Data Out Access time after SDCK rising Data Out change time after SDCK rising
ns ns
Table 44-34. Mobile Characteristics
Min Parameter SDRAM Controller Clock Frequency Control/Address/Data In Setup(1)(2) Control/Address/Data In Hold
(1)(2)
Max 1.8V Supply
(4)
1.8V Supply
Units MHz ns ns
133/100 (3)
1.5 1 6/8 2.5
(3)
Data Out Access time after SDCK rising Data Out change time after SDCK rising Notes:
ns ns
1. Control is the set of following signals: SDCKE, SDCS, RAS, CAS, SDA10, BAx, DQMx, and SDWE. 2. Address is the set of A0-A9, A11-A13. 3. 133 MHz with CL=3, 100 MHz with CL=2. 4. Minimum of 133 MHz and MCK frequency for the operating conditions (Table 44-2)
44.8.7
SPI Timings are given assuming a capacitance load on MISO, SPCK and MOSI. Table 44-35. Capacitance Load for MISO, SPCK and MOSI
Corner IO Supply 3.3V 1.8V MAX 40 pF 20 pF STH 40 pF 20 pf
865
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 44-4. SPI Master Mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0)
SPCK
SPI0 MISO
SPI1
SPI2 MOSI
Figure 44-5. SPI Master Mode with (CPOL = NCPHA = 0) or (CPOL= NCPHA= 1)
SPCK
SPI3 MISO
SPI4
SPI5 MOSI
Figure 44-6. SPI Slave Mode with (CPOL=0 and NCPHA=1) or (CPOL=1 and NCPHA=0)
SPCK
SPI6 MISO
SPI7 MOSI
SPI8
866
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 44-7. SPI Slave Mode with (CPOL = NCPHA = 0) or (CPOL= NCPHA= 1)
SPCK
SPI9 MISO
SPI10 MOSI
SPI11
Figure 44-8. SPI Slave Mode - NPCS Timings
SPI14 SPI6 SPCK (CPOL = 0) SPI12 SPCK (CPOL = 1) SPI16 MISO SPI9
SPI15
SPI13
Table 44-36. SPI Timings
Symbol Parameter Cond Master Mode SPI0 MISO Setup time before SPCK rises MISO Hold time after SPCK rises SPCK rising to MOSI MISO Setup time before SPCK falls MISO Hold time after SPCK falls STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner 10.4 + 0.5*tCPMCK 12.4 + 0.5*tCPMCK -8.6 - 0.5* tCPMCK -10.2 - 0.5* tCPMCK 0.6 0.7 11.1 + 0.5*tCPMCK 13.0 + 0.5*tCPMCK -9 - 0.5* tCPMCK -10.6 - 0.5* tCPMCK ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Min Max Units
SPI1
SPI2
SPI3
SPI4
867
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 44-36. SPI Timings (Continued)
Symbol SPI5 Parameter SPCK falling to MOSI Cond STH corner MAX corner Slave Mode SPI6 SPCK falling to MISO MOSI Setup time before SPCK rises MOSI Hold time after SPCK rises SPCK rising to MISO MOSI Setup time before SPCK falls MOSI Hold time after SPCK falls NPCS0 setup to SPCK rising NPCS0 hold after SPCK falling NPCS0 setup to SPCK falling NPCS0 hold after SPCK rising NPCS0 falling to MISO valid STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner STH corner MAX corner 11.5 13.5 9.7 9.4 0 0 9.2 10.8 0 0 0 12.0 0 0 10.2 12.5 0 0 10.1 12.5 9.2 10.7 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Min 0.1 0.3 Max Units ns ns
SPI7
SPI8
SPI9
SPI10
SPI11
SPI12
SPI13
SPI14
SPI15
SPI16
44.8.8
SSC Timings are given assuming a capacitance load on TBC. Table 44-37. Capacitance Load
Corner IO Supply 3.3V 1.8V MAX 30 pF 20 pF STH 30 pF 20 pF
868
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 44-9. SSC Transmitter, TK and TF in Output
TK (CKI =0)
TK (CKI =1)
SSC0 TF/TD
Figure 44-10. SSC Transmitter, TK in Input and TF in Output
TK (CKI =0)
TK (CKI =1)
SSC1 TF/TD
Figure 44-11. SSC Transmitter, TK in Output and TF in Input
TK (CKI=0)
TK (CKI=1)
SSC2 TF
SSC3
SSC4 TD
869
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 44-12. SSC Transmitter, TK and TF in Input
TK (CKI=1)
TK (CKI=0)
SSC5 TF SSC7 TD
SSC6
Figure 44-13. SSC Receiver RK and RF in Input
RK (CKI=0)
RK (CKI=1)
SSC8 RF/RD
SSC9
Figure 44-14. SSC Receiver, RK in Input and RF in Output
RK (CKI=1)
RK (CKI=0)
SSC8 RD SSC10 RF
SSC9
870
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 44-15. SSC Receiver, RK and RF in Output
RK (CKI=1)
RK (CKI=0)
SSC11 RD SSC13 RF
SSC12
Figure 44-16. SSC Receiver, RK in Output and RF in Input
RK (CKI=0)
RK (CKI=1)
SSC11 RF/RD
SSC12
Table 44-38. SSC Timings
Symbol Parameter Cond Transmitter STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC0 TK edge to TF/TD (TK output, TF output) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC1 TK edge to TF/TD (TK input, TF output) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V 0(2) 0 (2) 0 (2) 0 0
(2) (2) (2) (2) (2)
Min
Max
Units
1.5 (2) 2.6 (2) 1.5 (2) 2.6 1.5 2.6 1.5 2.6
(2) (2) (2) (2) (2)
ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
0 0 0
871
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Table 44-38. SSC Timings (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Cond STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V SSC2 TF setup time before TK edge (TK output) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V SSC3 TF hold time after TK edge (TK output) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V SSC4
(1)
Min 10.0 tCPMCK 11.0 tCPMCK 11.6 tCPMCK 12.8 tCPMCK tCPMCK - 8.7 tCPMCK - 8.7 tCPMCK 10.4 tCPMCK 10.4 2 * tCPMCK 0.7(1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK 1.7(1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK 0.5(1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK 1.6(1)(2) 0 0 0 0 tCPMCK tCPMCK tCPMCK tCPMCK 10.8(1) 10.8(1) 13.1(1) 13.1(1)
Max
Units ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
2 * tCPMCK + 1.9 (1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK + 2.9 (1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK + 1.9 (1)(2) 2 * tCPMCK + 3.1 (1)(2)
ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
TK edge to TF/TD (TK output, TF input) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V
SSC5
TF setup time before TK edge (TK input)
STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V
SSC6
TF hold time after TK edge (TK input)
STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V
3 * tCPMCK + 11(1) 3 * tCPMCK + 12(1) 3 * tCPMCK + 12.8(1) 3 * tCPMCK + 13.9(1)
ns ns ns ns
SSC7(1)
TK edge to TF/TD (TK input, TF input) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V Receiver
872
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table 44-38. SSC Timings (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Cond STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC8 RF/RD setup time before RK edge (RK input) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC9 RF/RD hold time after RK edge (RK input) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC10 RK edge to RF (RK input) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V SSC11 RF/RD setup time before RK edge (RK output) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V SSC12 RF/RD hold time after RK edge (RK output) MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V STH corner, VDDIO = 1.8V SSC13 RK edge to RF (RK output) STH corner, VDDIO = 3.3V MAX corner, VDDIO = 1.8V MAX corner, VDDIO = 3.3V Notes: Min 0 0 0 0 tCPMCK tCPMCK tCPMCK tCPMCK 11.1(2) 11.1
(2) (2) (2)
Max
Units ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
12.9(2) 13.9 15.2 16.3
(2) (2) (2)
ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
13.3 13.3
11.1 tCPMCK 11.8 tCPMCK 12.6 tCPMCK 13.7 tCPMCK tCPMCK - 8.8 tCPMCK - 8.8 tCPMCK 10.7 tCPMCK 10.7 0(2) 0 0 0
(2) (2) (2)
1.8(2) 2.8 1.8 2.9
(2) (2) (2)
ns ns ns ns
1. Timings SSC4 and SSC7 depend on the start condition. When STTDLY = 0 (Receive start delay) and START = 4, or 5 or 7 (Receive Start Selection), two Periods of the MCK must be added to timings. 2. For output signals (TF, TD, RF), Min and Max access times are defined. The Min access time is the time between the TK (or RK) edge and the signal change. The Max access timing is the time between the TK edge and the signal stabilization. Figure 18 illustrates Min and Max accesses for SSC0. The same applies for SSC1, SSC4, and SSC7, SSC10 and SSC13.
873
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.8.9
MCI Capacitance loads on data and clock are given in Table 44-39. Figure 44-17. MMC Timings
MMC1 CLK MMC2 CMD_DAT Input MMC4 CMD_DAT Output Shaded areas are not valid MMC5 MMC3
Table 44-39. MMC Timings
Symbol Parameter CLoad C = 25 pf MMC1 CLK frequency at Data transfer Mode C= 100 pf C= 250 pf CLK frequency at Identification Mode CLK Low time CLK High time CLK Rise time CLK Fall time CLK Low time CLK High time CLK Rise time CLK Fall time MMC2 MMC3 MMC4 MMC5 Input hold time Input setup time Output change after CLK rising Output valid before CLK rising C= 100 pf C= 100 pf C= 100 pf C= 100 pf C= 250 pf C= 250 pf C= 250 pf C= 250 pf 3 3 5 5 50 50 50 50 10 10 10 10 Min Max 25 20 20 400 Units MHz MHz MHz kHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
874
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Figure 44-18. SD Card Timings
SD1 CLK SD3 SD2 CMD_DAT Input SD4 CMD_DAT Output Shaded areas are not valid
Table 44-40. SD Card Timings
Symbol SD1 Parameter CLK frequency at Data transfer Mode CLK frequency at Identification Mode CLK Low time CLK High time CLK Rise time CLK Fall time CLK Low time CLK High time CLK Rise time CLK Fall time SD2 SD3 SD4 Input hold time Input setup time Output change after CLK falling C= 25 pf C= 25 pf C= 25 pf C= 25 pf C= 100 pf C= 100 pf C= 100 pf C= 100 pf 0.8 0 4 10 10 10 10 5 5 3 3 CLoad C = 25 pf Min Max 50 400 Units MHz kHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns
875
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.8.10
UDP HS Transceiver Figure 44-19. USB Control/Data Signals
Table 44-41. USB Control/Data Timings
Symbol Tcsu / dsu Tch / dh Tcco / dco Parameter Control/Data Signal Setup Time Control/Data Signal Hold Time Control/Data Signal Clock to Out Time Min 7 0 4 8 Typ Max Unit ns ns ns
For more information see: Section 5.1.1 "USB Power Supply Considerations" on page 16.
876
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
45. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Mechanical Characteristics
45.1 Package Drawings
Figure 45-1. 144-ball BGA Package Drawing
Table 45-1.
Ball Land
Soldering Information (Substrate Level)
0.380 mm 0.280 mm
Soldering Mask Opening
Table 45-2.
300
Device and 144-ball BGA Package Maximum Weight
mg
Table 45-3.
144-ball BGA Package Characteristics
3
Moisture Sensitivity Level
Table 45-4.
Package Reference
none e1
JEDEC Drawing Reference JESD97 Classification
This package respects the recommendations of the NEMI User Group. 877
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Figure 45-2. 217-ball LFBGA Package Drawing
Table 45-5.
Ball Land
Soldering Information (Substrate Level)
0.43 mm 0.05 0.30 mm 0.05
Solder Mask Opening
Table 45-6.
450
Device and 217-ball LFBGA Package Maximum Weight
mg
Table 45-7.
217-ball LFBGA Package Characteristics
3
Moisture Sensitivity Level
Table 45-8.
Package Reference
MO-205 e1
JEDEC Drawing Reference JESD97 Classification
878
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
45.2 Soldering Profile
Table 45-9 gives the recommended soldering profile from J-STD-020C. Table 45-9. Soldering Profile
Green Package 3 C/sec. max. 180 sec. max. 60 sec. to 150 sec. 20 sec. to 40 sec. 260 +0 C 6 C/sec. max. 8 min. max.
Profile Feature Average Ramp-up Rate (217C to Peak) Preheat Temperature 175C 25C Temperature Maintained Above 217C Time within 5 C of Actual Peak Temperature Peak Temperature Range Ramp-down Rate Time 25 C to Peak Temperature Note:
It is recommended to apply a soldering temperature higher than 250C
A maximum of three reflow passes is allowed per component.
879
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
46. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Ordering Information
Table 46-1. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Ordering Information
MRL A A Package LFBGA144 LFBGA217 Package Type Green Green Temperature Operating Range Industrial -40C to 85C Ordering Code AT91SAM9R64-CU AT91SAM9RL64-CU
880
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
47. AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Errata
47.1 Marking
All devices are marked with the Atmel logo and the ordering code. Additional marking has the following format:
YYWW V XXXXXXXXX
where: * "YY": manufactory year * "WW": manufactory week * "V": revision * "XXXXXXXXX": lot number
ARM
881
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
47.2
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Errata - Revision A Parts
Refer to Section 47.1 "Marking" on page 881.
47.2.1 47.2.1.1
Bus Matrix DEFAULT_MASTER functionality The DEFAULT_MASTER functionality is not available for the following slaves: * Slave 2: USB Device High-Speed * Slave 3: LCDC User Interface Problem Fix/ Workaround None.
47.2.1.2
FIXED_PRIORITY functionality The FIXED_PRIORITY arbitration scheme is not available for the following slaves: * Slave 2: USB Device High-Speed * Slave 3: LCDC User Interface * Slave 5: Peripheral bridge Problem Fix/ Workaround None.
47.2.2 47.2.2.1
DMA Controller Transfer size is limited in some conditions DMA Controller may be frozen if BTSIZE field is too big. * BTSIZE is limited to 16383 (0x3FFF) when SRC_WIDTH = WORD and DST_WIDTH = BYTE * BTSIZE is limited to 32767 (0x7FFF) when SRC_WIDTH = HALFWORD and DST_WIDTH = BYTE * BTSIZE is limited to 32767 (0x7FFF) when SRC_WIDTH = WORD and DST_WIDTH = HALF_WORD Problem Fix/Workaround Choose another transfer configuration.
47.2.3 47.2.3.1
LCD LCD Screen Shifting After a Reset When a FIFO underflow occurs, a reset of the DMA and FIFO pointers is necessary. Performing the following sequence : * DMA disable * Wait for DMABUSY * DMA reset * DMA enable leads to reset DMA pointers but not FIFO pointers, the displayed image is shifted. Problem Fix/Workaround Apply the following sequence:
882
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
* LCD power off * DMA disable * Wait for DMABUSY * DMA reset * LCD power on * DMA enable. 47.2.3.2 LCD Periodic Bad Pixels LCD periodic bad pixels is due to mis-aligned DMA base address in frame buffer. LCD DMA performs bursts to read memory. These bursts must not cross 1 Kb AMBA boundary. Problem Fix/Workaround The burst size in 32-bit words is programmed by field BRSTLN in DMA_FRMCFG register. The LCD DMA Base Address is programmed in DMA_BADDR1 register. DMA Base Address must be programmed with a value aligned onto LCD DMA burst size. e.g.: BRSTLN = 15 For a 16-word burst, the LCD DMA Base Address must start on 16-word offset: 0x0, 0x40, 0x80 or 0xc0. BRSTLN = 3 For a 4-word burst, the LCD DMA Base Address must start on 0x0, 0x10, ..., 0xf0. 47.2.3.3 24-bit Packed Mode LCD DMA Base Address and LCD DMA burst size must be selected with care in 24-bit packed mode. A 32-bit word contains some bits of a pixel and some bits of the following. If LCD DMA Base Address is not aligned with a pixel start, the colors will be modified. Respect "LCD periodic bad pixels" erratum constrains lead to select the LCD DMA Base Address regarding the LCD DMA burst size. Problem Fix/Workaround LCD DMA Base Address is to be set on a pixel start, every three 32-bit word. The offset of the LCD DMA Base Address must be a multiple of 0x30 plus 0x0, 0xc, 0x18 or 0x24. (0x0, 0xc, 0x18, 0x24, 0x30, 0x3c, 0x48, 0x54, 0x60,0x6c, 0x78, 0x84, 0x90, 0x9c, 0xa8, 0xb4, 0xc0 ...) e.g. regarding the bursts size: 1) BRSTLN = 3 implies the following LCD DMA Base Address offsets : 0x0, 0x30, 0x60, ... 2) BRSTLN = 15 implies the following LCD DMA Base Address offsets : 0x0 and 0xc0 only 47.2.4 47.2.4.1 MCI MCI: Busy signal of R1b responses is not taken in account The busy status of the card during the response (R1b) is ignored for the commands CMD7, CMD28, CMD29, CMD38, CMD42, CMD56. Additionally, for commands CMD42 and CMD56 a
883
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
conflict can occur on data line0 if the MCI sends data to the card while the card is still busy.The behavior is correct for CMD12 command (STOP_TRANSFER). Problem Fix/Workaround None 47.2.4.2 MCI: SDIO Interrupt does not work with slots other than A when 1-bit databus is selected If 1-bit data bus width and on slots other than slot A, the SDIO interrupt can not be captured. The sample is made on the wrong data line. Problem Fix/Workaround None 47.2.4.3 MCI: Data Timeout Error Flag As the data Timeout error flag checking the Naac timing cannot rise, the MCI can be stalled waiting indefinitely the Data start bit. Problem Fix/Workaround A STOP command must be sent with a software timeout. 47.2.4.4 MCI: Data Write Operation and number of bytes The Data Write operation with a number of bytes less than 12 is impossible. Problem Fix/Workaround The PDC counters must always be equal to 12 bytes for data transfers lower than 12 bytes. The BLKLEN or BCNT field are used to specify the real count number. 47.2.4.5 MCI: Flag Reset is not correct in half duplex mode In half duplex mode, the reset of the flags ENDRX, RXBUFF, ENDTX and TXBUFE can be incorrect. These flags are reset correctly after a PDC channel enable. Problem Fix/Workaround Enable the interrupts related to ENDRX, ENDTX, RXBUFF and TXBUFE only after enabling the PDC channel by writing PDC_TXTEN or PDC_RXTEN. 47.2.5 47.2.5.1 Reset Controller (RSTC) RSTC: Reset during SDRAM Accesses When a User Reset occurs during SDRAM read access, the SDRAM clock is turned off while data are ready to be read on the data bus. The SDRAM maintains the data until the clock restarts. If the User Reset is programmed to assert a general reset, the data maintained by the SDRAM leads to a data bus conflict and adversely affects the boot memories connected on the EBI: * NAND Flash boot functionality, if the system boots out of internal ROM. * NOR Flash boot, if the system boots on an external memory connected on the EBI CS0. Problem Fix/Workaround 1. Avoid User Reset to generate a system reset. 2. Trap the User Reset with an interrupt. In the interrupt routine, power down the SDRAM properly and perform Peripheral and Processor Reset with software in assembler.
884
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Example with libV3. * The main code:
//user reset interrupt setting // Configure AIC controller to handle SSC interrupts AT91F_AIC_ConfigureIt ( AT91C_BASE_AIC, AT91C_ID_SYS, AT91C_AIC_PRIOR_HIGHEST, sysc_handler ); // Enable SYSC interrupt in AIC AT91F_AIC_EnableIt(AT91C_BASE_AIC, AT91C_ID_SYS); *AT91C_RSTC_RMR = (0xA5<<24) | (0x4<<8) | AT91C_RSTC_URSTIEN; // AIC base address // System peripheral ID // Max priority
AT91C_AIC_SRCTYPE_INT_EDGE_TRIGGERED, // Level sensitive
* The C SYS handler:
extern void soft_user_reset(void); void sysc_handler(void){ //check if interrupt comes from RSTC if( (*AT91C_RSTC_RSR & AT91C_RSTC_URSTS ) == AT91C_RSTC_URSTS){ soft_user_reset(); //never reached while(1); } }
* The assembler routine:
AREA TEST, CODE INCLUDEAT91SAM9xxx.inc EXPORTsoft_user_reset soft_user_reset ;disable IRQs MRS r0, CPSR ORR r0, r0, #0x80 MSR CPSR_c, r0 ;change refresh rate to block all data accesses LDR r0, =AT91C_SDRAMC_TR LDR r1, =1 STR r1, [r0]
885
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
;prepare power down command LDR r0, =AT91C_SDRAMC_LPR LDR r1, =2 ;prepare proc_reset and periph_reset LDR r2, =AT91C_RSTC_RCR LDR r3, =0xA5000005 ;perform power down command STR r1, [r0] ;perform proc_reset and periph_reset (in the ARM pipeline) STR r3, [r2] END
47.2.6 47.2.6.1
Serial Synchronous Controller (SSC) SSC: Transmitter Limitations in Slave Mode If TK is programmed as output and TF is programmed as input, it is impossible to emit data when start of edge (rising or falling) of synchro with a Start Delay equal to zero. Problem Fix/Workaround None.
47.2.6.2
SSC: Periodic Transmission Limitations in Master Mode If Last Significant Bit is sent first (MSBF = 0) the first TAG during the frame synchro is not sent. Problem Fix/Workaround None.
47.2.6.3
SSC: Unexpected RK clock cycle when RK outputs a clock during data transfer When the SSC receiver is used in the following configuration: * the internal clock divider is used (CKS =0 and DIV different from 0), * RK pin set as output and provides the clock during data transfer (CKO=2) * data sampled on RK falling edge (CKI =0) then, at the end of the data, the RK pin is set in high impedance which may be interpreted as an unexpected clock cycle. Problem Fix/Workaround Enable the pull-up on RK pin.
47.2.6.4
SSC: Incorrect first RK clock cycle when RK outputs a clock during data transfer When the SSC receiver is used in the following configuration: * RX clock is divided clock (CKS =0 and DIV different from 0) * RK pin set as output and provides the clock during data transfer (CKO=2) * data sampled on RK falling edge (CKI =0)
886
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
then the first clock cycle time generated by the RK pin is equal to MCK/(2 x (DIV +1)) instead of MCK/(2 x DIV). Problem Fix/Workaround None. 47.2.7 47.2.7.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) SPI: Bad Serial Clock Generation on second chip_select when SCBR = 1, CPOL = 1 and NCPHA = 0 If the SPI is used in the following configuration: * master mode * CPOL=1 and NCPHA =0 * multiple chip selects used with one transfer with Baud rate (SCBR) equal to 1 (i.e., when serial clock frequency equals the system clock frequency) and the other transfers set with SCBR not equal to 1 * transmit with the slowest chip select and then with the fastest one then an additional pulse will be generated on output PSCK during the second transfer. Problem Fix/Workaround Do not use a multiple Chip Select configuration where at least one SCRx register is configured with SCBR = 1 and the others differ from 1 if CPHA = 0 and CPOL = 1. If all chip selects are configured with Baudrate = 1, the issue does not appear. 47.2.8 47.2.8.1 Shutdown Controller SHDN Signal may be Driven to Low Level Voltage During Device Power-on If only VDDBU is powered during boot sequence (No VDDCORE), the SHDN signal may be driven to low level voltage after a delay. This delay is linked to the startup time of the slow clock selected by OSCSEL signal. If SHDN pin is connected to the Enable pin (EN) of the VDDCORE regulator, VDDCORE establishment does not occur and the system does not start. Problem Fix/Workaround 1. VDDCORE must be established within the delay corresponding to the startup time of the slow clock selected by OSCSEL. 2. Add a glue logic to latch the rising edge of the SHDN signal. The reset of the latch output (EN_REG) can be connected to a PIO and used to enter the shutdown mode. 47.2.9 47.2.9.1 Static Memory Controller (SMC) SMC: Chip Select Parameters Modification The user must not change the configuration parameters of an SMC Chip Select (Setup, Pulse, Cycle, Mode) if accesses are performed on this CS during the modification. For example, the modification of the Chip Select 0 (CS0) parameters, while fetching the code from a memory connected on this CS0, may lead to unpredictable behavior. Problem Fix/Workaround The code used to modify the parameters of an SMC Chip Select can be executed from the internal RAM or from a memory connected to another Chip Select.
887
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
47.2.10 47.2.10.1
System Controller Possible event loss when reading RTT_SR If an event (RTTINC or ALMS) occurs within the same slow clock cycle the RTT_SR is read, the corresponding bit might be cleared. This might lead in the loss of this event. Problem Fix/Workaround The software must handle RTT event as interrupt and should not poll RTT_SR.
47.2.11 47.2.11.1
TSADCC TSADCC: Multiple PENCNT detections without NOCNT In addition to the "Pen Contact" bit (PENCNT), the TSADCC provides a "No Contact" bit (NOCNT) in its Status Register. When a contact loss is detected by the analog block of the peripheral, an internal debouncer is started. However, if the contact loss is not validated by the debouncer (e.g. if it was a glitch), the PENCNT flag is incorrectly set again in the Status Register. This results in the PENCNT flag being set multiple times before NOCNT is set. Problem Fix/Workaround The user must disregard the value of the PENCNT flag after it has been set once and before the NOCNT flag has been set. When using interrupts, the interrupt on PENCNT must be disabled after it has occurred once, and re-enabled when NOCNT occurs.
47.2.12 47.2.12.1
USART USART: RXBREAK problem when no timeguard The RXBREAK flag is not correctly handled (FRAME ERROR is set instead) when the timeguard is 0 and the break character is located just after STOP BIT. Problem Fix/Workaround If the NBSTOP = 1, => TIMEGUARD should be different from 0. SYNCHRONOUS mode is not affected, only ASYNCHRONOUS.
47.2.12.2
USART: DCD is active High instead of Low DCD signal is active at high level in the USART block (Modem Mode). DCD should be active at low level. Problem Fix/Workaround Add an inverter.
888
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
48. Revision History
The most recent versionof the datasheet appears first in the tables that follow. Note: Table continued on next page.
Change Request Ref. 6142 RFO 6345 6345 6345 5935
Doc. Rev. 6289C
Comments Product Overview: "Features", removed mid-level Embedded Trace Macrocell feature "Features", updated figures on CPU speed "Features", updated SDIO and MMC version Removed paragraph Section 5.2 "Power Consumption". Section 6.5 "Shutdown Logic Pins", removed information on the shutdown pin Section 8.1.2.1 "BMS = 1, boot on embedded ROM", - SDCard, (boot ROM does not support high capacity SDCards) clarification added. Boot Program: Section 14.5 "SD Card Boot", added clarification boot ROM does not support high capacity SDCards. Section 14.7.3 "USB High Speed Device Port", removed paragraph on device class CDC. SMC: Table 22-9, "SMC Register Mapping", updated reset state for SMC_CYCLE PMC: Section 26.4 "Slow Clock Selection", changed reference from internal slow clock oscillator to internal RC oscillator.
6345 6195 6345 5982
889
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Doc. Rev. 6289C
Comments (Continued) LCDC: Section 39.5.2.3 "FIFO" and Section 39.11.15 "LCD FIFO Register", updated FIFO size and specified that it is in words. Section 39.11.7 "DMA Frame Configuration Register", specified burst length is in words. Electrical Characteristics: Table 44-2, "DC Characteristics", updated ISC values Table 44-4, "Power Consumption by Peripheral in Active Mode on VDDCORE", updated consumption figure for LCDC. Section 44.7 "Power Supply Characteristics", all new and updated information on power supply characteristics. Table 44-9, "XIN Clock Electrical Characteristics", added data on VIN and VIN32. Removed EMAC section, former Section 44.8.7. Table 44-23, "Master Clock Waveform Parameters", corrected MAX value of Master Clock Frequency, STH corner. Table 44-24, "I/O Characteristics", corrected MAX value of FreqMax. Section 44.8.9 "MCI", all new and updated information on MMC and SD Card timings. Table 46-1, "AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Ordering Information" updated with MRL information. Errata: Section 47.2.3 "LCD", added section with errata Section 47.2.3.1 "LCD Screen Shifting After a Reset", Section 47.2.3.2 "LCD Periodic Bad Pixels" and Section 47.2.3.3 "24-bit Packed Mode" Section 47.2.4.2 "MCI: SDIO Interrupt does not work with slots other than A when 1-bit databus is selected", corrected errata description. Section 47.2.5.1 "RSTC: Reset during SDRAM Accesses", added errata. Section 47.2.8.1 "SHDN Signal may be Driven to Low Level Voltage During Device Power-on", added errata. Section 47.2.9.1 "SMC: Chip Select Parameters Modification", added errata.
Change Request Ref.
RFO
6268 5902 6269 6166 6184 RFO RFO 6344 RFO 6382 6169 6082 6345 5642
Doc. Rev. 6289B
Comments Product Overview: "Features", "Debug Unit (DBGU)" on page 2, updated Figure 8-1 "AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Memory Mapping", Internal Memory Mapping updated. Table 7-2, "List of Bus Matrix Slaves", Table 7-3, "AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Master to Slave Access", Slave 3 updated. Section 5.1 "Power Supplies", updated with caution on VDDCORE and VDDIO constraints. Section 5.1.1 "USB Power Supply Considerations" and Figure 5-1 added to datasheet. Section 5.2 "Power Consumption", first two sentences updated. Table 3-1, "Signal Description List", additional comments on BMS. SHDN comments updated. Table 10-3 and Table 10-7 PB8, PB9 , Peripheral A column: typos corrected, "CFCE1," "CFCE2".
Change Request Ref. 5846 5276
5291 5420 5388 5423 rfo 5788
890
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Doc. Rev. 6289B Change Request Ref. 5602 5853 5856 5711/5281 5688
Comments (Continued) PMC: Section 27.8.10 "PMC Clock Generator PLL Register", inserted a 1 into bit field 29 and warning: "Bit 29 must always be set to 1 when programming CKGR_PLLR register. TSADCC: Section 43.4.1 "Power Management", updated. UDPHS: Figure 41-2 "Board Schematic", updated. Table 41-1, "UDPHS Endpoint Description", High Bandwidth column updated. "USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) User Interface", internal test registers added. Table 41-5, "Register Mapping" Section 41.5.7 "UDPHS Test SOF Counter Register" Section 41.5.8 "UDPHS Test A Counter Register" Section 41.5.9 "UDPHS Test B Counter Register" Section 41.5.10 "UDPHS Test Mode Register" Electrical Characteristics: Table 44-1, "Absolute Maximum Ratings", updated industrial operating temperature. Table 44-2, "DC Characteristics", ISCrows updated. VOL and VOH rows updated with new conditions Table 44-19, "Transfer Characteristics", Gain Error row updated. Section 44.6 "ADC", section upgraded one level in chapter organization. Figure 44-8 "SPI Slave Mode - NPCS Timings", illustration replaced. Section 44.8 "Timings", except in formulas, negative values replaced by 0 in timing tables. Table 44-22, "Processor Clock Waveform Parameters", STH corner, MAX updated Table 44-40, "MCI Timings High Speed", added to datasheet. Table 44-3, "Power Consumption for Different Modes",Active mode updated. Section 44.7 "Power Supply Characteristics", section updated. Mechanical Characteristics: Table 45-1 and Table 45-5 Soldering Information is for Substrate Level. ERRATA: Section 47.2.11 "TSADCC", added to errata.
5555 5277 5289 5278 5525 5613 5614 5622 5708 5803 rfo 5744 5549
Doc. Rev. 6289A
Comments First Issue
Change Request Ref.
891
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
892
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
Table of Contents
1 2 3 4 Description ............................................................................................... 3 Block Diagrams ........................................................................................ 5 Signal Description ................................................................................... 7 Package and Pinout ............................................................................... 12
4.1 144-ball BGA Package Outline ..............................................................................12 4.2 Pinout ....................................................................................................................13 4.3 217-ball LFBGA Package Outline .........................................................................14 4.4 Pinout ....................................................................................................................15
5
Power Considerations ........................................................................... 16
5.1 Power Supplies .....................................................................................................16 5.2 Programmable I/O Lines Power Supplies ..............................................................17
6
I/O Line Considerations ......................................................................... 18
6.1 JTAG Port Pins ......................................................................................................18 6.2 Test Pin .................................................................................................................18 6.3 Reset Pins .............................................................................................................18 6.4 PIO Controllers ......................................................................................................18 6.5 Shutdown Logic Pins .............................................................................................18
7
Processor and Architecture .................................................................. 18
7.1 ARM926EJ-S Processor .......................................................................................18 7.2 Matrix Masters .......................................................................................................19 7.3 Matrix Slaves .........................................................................................................20 7.4 Master to Slave Access .........................................................................................20 7.5 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) ..........................................................................20 7.6 DMA Controller ......................................................................................................21 7.7 Debug and Test Features ......................................................................................21
8
Memories ................................................................................................ 22
8.1 Embedded Memories ............................................................................................23 8.2 External Memories ................................................................................................26
9
System Controller .................................................................................. 28
9.1 System Controller Mapping ...................................................................................28 9.2 Block Diagram .......................................................................................................29 9.3 Reset Controller ....................................................................................................30 1
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
9.4 Shutdown Controller ..............................................................................................30 9.5 Clock Generator ....................................................................................................30 9.6 Slow Clock Selection .............................................................................................31 9.7 Power Management Controller ..............................................................................31 9.8 Periodic Interval Timer ..........................................................................................32 9.9 Watchdog Timer ....................................................................................................32 9.10 Real-Time Timer ..................................................................................................32 9.11 Real-Time Clock ..................................................................................................32 9.12 General-Purpose Backed-up Registers ...............................................................33 9.13 Advanced Interrupt Controller .............................................................................33 9.14 Debug Unit ..........................................................................................................33 9.15 Chip Identification ................................................................................................34 9.16 PIO Controllers ....................................................................................................34
10 Peripherals ............................................................................................. 34
10.1 Peripheral Mapping .............................................................................................34 10.2 Peripheral Identifiers ...........................................................................................35 10.3 Peripheral Interrupts and Clock Control ..............................................................36 10.4 Peripherals Signals Multiplexing on I/O Lines .....................................................36
11 Embedded Peripherals Overview ......................................................... 44
11.1 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ..........................................................................44 11.2 Two-wire Interface (TWI) .....................................................................................44 11.3 USART ................................................................................................................44 11.4 Serial Synchronous Controller (SSC) ..................................................................45 11.5 AC97 Controller ...................................................................................................45 11.6 Timer Counter (TC) .............................................................................................45 11.7 Pulse Width Modulation Controller (PWM) ..........................................................46 11.8 Multimedia Card Interface (MCI) .........................................................................46 11.9 USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) ..............................................................46 11.10 LCD Controller (LCDC) ......................................................................................47 11.11 Touch Screen Analog-to-digital Converter (TSADCC) ......................................47
12 ARM926EJ-S Processor Overview ....................................................... 49
12.1 Overview .............................................................................................................49 12.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................50 12.3 ARM9EJ-S Processor .........................................................................................50 12.4 CP15 Coprocessor ..............................................................................................58
2
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
12.5 Memory Management Unit (MMU) ......................................................................61 12.6 Caches and Write Buffer .....................................................................................62 12.7 Tightly-Coupled Memory Interface ......................................................................64 12.8 Bus Interface Unit ................................................................................................65
13 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Debug and Test .................................................. 67
13.1 Description ..........................................................................................................67 13.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................68 13.3 Application Examples ..........................................................................................69 13.4 Debug and Test Pin Description ..........................................................................70 13.5 Functional Description .........................................................................................70
14 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Boot Program ..................................................... 73
14.1 Description ..........................................................................................................73 14.2 Flow Diagram ......................................................................................................73 14.3 Device Initialization ..............................................................................................74 14.4 DataFlash Boot ....................................................................................................75 14.5 SD Card Boot ......................................................................................................78 14.6 NAND Flash Boot ................................................................................................78 14.7 SAM-BA Boot ......................................................................................................79 14.8 Hardware and Software Constraints ...................................................................82
15 Reset Controller (RSTC) ........................................................................ 85
15.1 Description ..........................................................................................................85 15.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................85 15.3 Functional Description .........................................................................................86 15.4 Reset Controller (RSTC) User Interface ..............................................................95
16 Real-time Timer (RTT) ............................................................................ 99
16.1 Overview .............................................................................................................99 16.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................99 16.3 Functional Description .........................................................................................99 16.4 Real-time Timer (RTT) User Interface ...............................................................101
17 Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) ............................................................... 105
17.1 Overview ...........................................................................................................105 17.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................105 17.3 Functional Description .......................................................................................106 17.4 Periodic Interval Timer (PIT) User Interface ......................................................108
3
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
18 Watchdog Timer (WDT) ....................................................................... 111
18.1 Description ........................................................................................................111 18.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................111 18.3 Functional Description .......................................................................................112 18.4 Watchdog Timer (WDT) User Interface .............................................................114
19 Shutdown Controller (SHDWC) .......................................................... 117
19.1 Description ........................................................................................................117 19.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................117 19.3 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................117 19.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................117 19.5 Functional Description .......................................................................................118 19.6 Shutdown Controller (SHDWC) User Interface .................................................119
20 Real-time Clock (RTC) ......................................................................... 123
20.1 Description ........................................................................................................123 20.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................123 20.3 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................123 20.4 Functional Description .......................................................................................123 20.5 Real-time Clock (RTC) User Interface ..............................................................125
21 External Bus Interface (EBI) ................................................................ 139
21.1 Description ........................................................................................................139 21.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................140 21.3 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................141 21.4 Application Example ..........................................................................................143 21.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................146 21.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................146 21.7 Implementation Examples .................................................................................154
22 Static Memory Controller (SMC) ......................................................... 163
22.1 Description ........................................................................................................163 22.2 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................163 22.3 Multiplexed Signals ...........................................................................................163 22.4 Application Example ..........................................................................................164 22.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................164 22.6 External Memory Mapping ................................................................................165 22.7 Connection to External Devices ........................................................................165 22.8 Standard Read and Write Protocols ..................................................................169 4
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
22.9 Automatic Wait States .......................................................................................178 22.10 Data Float Wait States ....................................................................................183 22.11 External Wait ...................................................................................................187 22.12 Slow Clock Mode .............................................................................................193 22.13 Asynchronous Page Mode ..............................................................................196 22.14 Static Memory Controller (SMC) User Interface ..............................................199
23 SDRAM Controller (SDRAMC) ............................................................ 205
23.1 Description ........................................................................................................205 23.2 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................205 23.3 Application Example ..........................................................................................206 23.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................208 23.5 Functional Description .......................................................................................210 23.6 SDRAM Controller User Interface .....................................................................218
24 Error Corrected Code (ECC) Controller ............................................. 229
24.1 Description ........................................................................................................229 24.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................229 24.3 Functional Description .......................................................................................229 24.4 Error Corrected Code (ECC) Controller User Interface .....................................234
25 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) ....................................................... 239
25.1 Description ........................................................................................................239 25.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................240 25.3 Functional Description .......................................................................................241 25.4 Peripheral DMA Controller (PDC) User Interface ..............................................244
26 Clock Generator ................................................................................... 255
26.1 Description ........................................................................................................255 26.2 Slow Clock Crystal Oscillator .............................................................................255 26.3 Slow Clock RC Oscillator ...................................................................................255 26.4 Slow Clock Selection .........................................................................................255 26.5 Main Oscillator ...................................................................................................258 26.6 Divider and PLL Block .......................................................................................259
27 Power Management Controller (PMC) ................................................ 262
27.1 Description ........................................................................................................262 27.2 Master Clock Controller .....................................................................................262 27.3 Processor Clock Controller ................................................................................263
5
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
27.4 Peripheral Clock Controller ...............................................................................263 27.5 Programmable Clock Output Controller .............................................................263 27.6 Programming Sequence ....................................................................................264 27.7 Clock Switching Details .....................................................................................267 27.8 Power Management Controller (PMC) User Interface ......................................271
28 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Bus Matrix ........................................................ 287
28.1 Description ........................................................................................................287 28.2 Memory Mapping ...............................................................................................287 28.3 Special Bus Granting Techniques .....................................................................287 28.4 Arbitration ..........................................................................................................288 28.5 Bus Matrix User Interface ..................................................................................291
29 Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) .................................................. 299
29.1 Description ........................................................................................................299 29.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................300 29.3 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................300 29.4 AIC Detailed Block Diagram ..............................................................................300 29.5 I/O Line Description ...........................................................................................301 29.6 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................301 29.7 Functional Description .......................................................................................302 29.8 Advanced Interrupt Controller (AIC) User Interface ...........................................312
30 Debug Unit (DBGU) .............................................................................. 323
30.1 Description ........................................................................................................323 30.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................324 30.3 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................325 30.4 UART Operations ..............................................................................................325 30.5 Debug Unit User Interface ................................................................................332
31 Parallel Input/Output Controller (PIO) ................................................ 347
31.1 Description ........................................................................................................347 31.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................348 31.3 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................349 31.4 Functional Description .......................................................................................350 31.5 I/O Lines Programming Example ......................................................................354 31.6 Parallel Input/Output (PIO) Controller User Interface ........................................356
32 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) ......................................................... 373
6
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
32.1 Description ........................................................................................................373 32.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................374 32.3 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................374 32.4 Signal Description ............................................................................................375 32.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................375 32.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................376 32.7 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) User Interface ................................................385
33 Two-wire Interface (TWI) ..................................................................... 399
33.1 Description ........................................................................................................399 33.2 List of Abbreviations ..........................................................................................400 33.3 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................400 33.4 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................401 33.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................401 33.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................402 33.7 Master Mode .....................................................................................................403 33.8 Multi-master Mode .............................................................................................415 33.9 Slave Mode .......................................................................................................418 33.10 Two-wire Interface (TWI) User Interface ........................................................426
34 Universal Synchronous/Asynchronous Receiver/Transceiver (USART) 441
34.1 Description ........................................................................................................441 34.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................442 34.3 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................443 34.4 I/O Lines Description ........................................................................................443 34.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................444 34.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................445 34.7 USART User Interface ......................................................................................476
35 Serial Synchronous Controller (SSC) ................................................ 497
35.1 Description ........................................................................................................497 35.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................498 35.3 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................498 35.4 Pin Name List ....................................................................................................499 35.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................499 35.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................499 35.7 SSC Application Examples ................................................................................510
7
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
35.8 Synchronous Serial Controller (SSC) User Interface ........................................512
36 Timer Counter (TC) .............................................................................. 535
36.1 Description ........................................................................................................535 36.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................536 36.3 Pin Name List ....................................................................................................537 36.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................537 36.5 Functional Description .......................................................................................538 36.6 Timer Counter (TC) User Interface ....................................................................551
37 DMA Controller (DMAC) ...................................................................... 569
37.1 Description ........................................................................................................569 37.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................570 37.3 Functional Description .......................................................................................571 37.4 DMAC Software Requirements .........................................................................594 37.5 DMA Controller (DMAC) User Interface ............................................................596
38 MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI) ......................................................... 615
38.1 Description ........................................................................................................615 38.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................616 38.3 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................617 38.4 Pin Name List ...................................................................................................617 38.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................617 38.6 Bus Topology ....................................................................................................618 38.7 MultiMedia Card Operations ..............................................................................621 38.8 SD/SDIO Card Operations ................................................................................630 38.9 MultiMedia Card Interface (MCI) User Interface ................................................631
39 LCD Controller (LCDC) ........................................................................ 649
39.1 Description ........................................................................................................649 39.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................650 39.3 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................651 39.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................651 39.5 Functional Description .......................................................................................651 39.6 Interrupts ...........................................................................................................672 39.7 Configuration Sequence ....................................................................................672 39.8 Double-buffer Technique ...................................................................................673 39.9 2D Memory Addressing .....................................................................................674 39.10 Register Configuration Guide ..........................................................................676 8
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
39.11 LCD Controller (LCDC) User Interface ............................................................677
40 AC'97 Controller (AC'97C) .................................................................. 705
40.1 Description ........................................................................................................705 40.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................706 40.3 Pin Name List ....................................................................................................707 40.4 Application Block Diagram ................................................................................707 40.5 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................708 40.6 Functional Description .......................................................................................709 40.7 AC'97 Controller (AC97C) User Interface ..........................................................720
41 USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) .............................................. 733
41.1 Description ........................................................................................................733 41.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................734 41.3 Typical Connection ............................................................................................735 41.4 Functional Description .......................................................................................735 41.5 USB High Speed Device Port (UDPHS) User Interface ....................................760
42 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Controller ........................................ 805
42.1 Description ........................................................................................................805 42.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................805 42.3 I/O Lines Description .........................................................................................806 42.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................806 42.5 Functional Description .......................................................................................806 42.6 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Controller User Interface ...............................815
43 Touch Screen ADC Controller ............................................................ 825
43.1 Description ........................................................................................................825 43.2 Block Diagram ...................................................................................................826 43.3 Signal Description .............................................................................................827 43.4 Product Dependencies ......................................................................................827 43.5 Analog-to-digital Converter Functional Description ...........................................828 43.6 Touch Screen ....................................................................................................829 43.7 Conversion Results ...........................................................................................832 43.8 Conversion Triggers ..........................................................................................835 43.9 Operating Modes ...............................................................................................835 43.10 Touch Screen ADC Controller (TSADCC) User Interface ...............................838
44 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Electrical Characteristics ................................ 851
9
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
44.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ...............................................................................851 44.2 DC Characteristics ............................................................................................851 44.3 Power Consumption ..........................................................................................852 44.4 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics .......................................................................854 44.5 USB HS Characteristics ....................................................................................857 44.6 ADC ..................................................................................................................858 44.7 Power Supply Characteristics ...........................................................................859 44.8 Timings ..............................................................................................................860
45 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Mechanical Characteristics ............................ 877
45.1 Package Drawings ............................................................................................877 45.2 Soldering Profile ................................................................................................879
46 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Ordering Information ...................................... 880 47 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Errata ................................................................ 881
47.1 Marking ..............................................................................................................881 47.2 AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Errata - Revision A Parts ...............................................882
48 Revision History ................................................................................... 889
10
AT91SAM9R64/RL64 Preliminary
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09
Headquarters
Atmel Corporation 2325 Orchard Parkway San Jose, CA 95131 USA Tel: 1(408) 441-0311 Fax: 1(408) 487-2600
International
Atmel Asia Room 1219 Chinachem Golden Plaza 77 Mody Road Tsimshatsui East Kowloon Hong Kong Tel: (852) 2721-9778 Fax: (852) 2722-1369 Atmel Europe Le Krebs 8, Rue Jean-Pierre Timbaud BP 309 78054 Saint-Quentin-enYvelines Cedex France Tel: (33) 1-30-60-70-00 Fax: (33) 1-30-60-71-11 Atmel Japan 9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg. 1-24-8 Shinkawa Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033 Japan Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551 Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581
Product Contact
Web Site www.atmel.com www.atmel.com/AT91SAM Technical Support AT91SAM Support Sales Contacts www.atmel.com/contacts/
Literature Requests www.atmel.com/literature
Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL'S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL'S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel's products are not intended, authorized, or warranted for use as components in applications intended to support or sustain life.
(c) 2009 Atmel Corporation. All rights reserved. Atmel (R), Atmel logo and combinations thereof, DataFlash (R), SAM-BA (R) and others are registered trademarks or trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. ARM(R), the ARMPowered (R) logo, Thumb (R) and others are the registered trademarks or trademarks of ARM Ltd. Windows (R) and others are the registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the US and/or other countries. Other terms and product names may be the trademarks of others.
6289C-ATARM-28-May-09


▲Up To Search▲   

 
Price & Availability of AT91SAM9R641

All Rights Reserved © IC-ON-LINE 2003 - 2022  

[Add Bookmark] [Contact Us] [Link exchange] [Privacy policy]
Mirror Sites :  [www.datasheet.hk]   [www.maxim4u.com]  [www.ic-on-line.cn] [www.ic-on-line.com] [www.ic-on-line.net] [www.alldatasheet.com.cn] [www.gdcy.com]  [www.gdcy.net]


 . . . . .
  We use cookies to deliver the best possible web experience and assist with our advertising efforts. By continuing to use this site, you consent to the use of cookies. For more information on cookies, please take a look at our Privacy Policy. X